Location via proxy:   [ UP ]  
[Report a bug]   [Manage cookies]                

Advanced Satellite Modem (18 Kbps - 25 MBPS) Installation and Operation Manual

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 690

CDM-625

Advanced Satellite Modem (18 kbps 25 Mbps)


Installation and Operation Manual
For Firmware Version 2.3.1 or higher

IMPORTANT NOTE: The information contained in this document supersedes all previously published
information regarding this product. Product specifications are subject to change without prior notice.

Part Number MN-CDM625 Revision 13

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Errata A

Comtech EF Data Documentation Update


Subject: ReviseAppendixD,QDIremotecommand

OriginalManualPart MNCDM625Rev13
Number/Rev:

ErrataNumber/PLM ERCDM625EA13
DocumentID:

PLMCONumber: C0027959

Comments: PageD45,QDIcommandchangesfollow.

Thisinformationwillbeaddedtothenextformalrevisionofthe
manual.

ER-CDM625-EA13 THIS DOCUMENT IS NOT SUBJECT TO REVISION/UPDATE! PLM CO C-0027959 Page 1 of 2

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


Quad Drop & QDI= 73 bytes Command or Query. QDI= QDI?p QDI=pccddddddddd
Insert Quad Drop & Insert Commands (E1 CCS Only) QDI? QDI?pn dddddddddddddddd
QDI=pccddddddddddddddddddddddddddddddddCCssssssssssssssssssssssssssssssssmrrr, where: QDI* (where n = 0 to 9 dddddddCCssssssss
p = Port number 1 thru 4 QDI# returns the QDI ssssssssssssssssss
cc = Number of Drop Channels, 0-32. portion of 1 of 10 ssssssmrrr
Used to decide Port ps TX Tributary Rate if Interface Type is Quad Drop & Insert (TFM=8). stored
d = 32 bytes defining Timeslot locations (or channels) configurations for (Returns current
CC = Number of Insert Channels, 0-32. a single port p) Quad D&I
Used to decide Port ps RX Tributary Rate if Interface Type is Quad Drop & Insert (RFM=8). configuration of a
s = 32 bytes defining Timeslot locations (or channels) single port p)
Timeslot definition:
0 = Unused
1-9 for timeslots 19,
A=10, B=11, C=12, D=13V=31
z=timeslot zero
m = E1 Clock Sync/Async mode (Read/Write on Port 1 string, Read-Only on other Ports strings). This is
NOT a per port setting, but a global setting. 0=E1's are asynchronous, 1=E1's are synchronous.
r = reserved (set to value 0)
Example 1:
131123456789ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUV031123456789ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUV00000
Port 1s Drop channels 131 using timeslots 131. Same for Insert. E1 clock mode is synchronous (Read-
Write using Port 1 string).

Example 2:
30412340000000000000000000000000000204123400000000000000000000000000002001000
Port 3s Drop channels 14 using timeslots 14. Same for Insert. E1 clock mode is asynchronous (Read-
only parameter in Port 3 string).

Note: This command is a bit forgiving in the sense that the modem accepts the command even though the
interface type is other than Quad Drop & Insert. This is intentional for use with the CRS-300 switch for 1:N
redundancy.

ER-CDM625-EA13 THIS DOCUMENT IS NOT SUBJECT TO REVISION/UPDATE! PLM CO C-0027959 Page 2 of 2

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625
Advanced Satellite Modem (18 kbps 25 Mbps)
Installation and Operation Manual
For Firmware Version 2.3.1 or higher

Part Number MN-CDM625


Revision 13

Copyright 2013 Comtech EF Data. All rights reserved. Printed in the USA.
Comtech EF Data, 2114 West 7th Street, Tempe, Arizona 85281 USA, 480.333.2200, FAX: 480.333.2161

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


This page is intentionally blank.

ii

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


TABLE OF CONTENTS
TABLE OF CONTENTS ............................................................................................................III

TABLES ................................................................................................................................ XXII

FIGURES .............................................................................................................................. XXIII

PREFACE ........................................................................................................................... XXVII

About this Manual ....................................................................................................................... xxvii


Reporting Comments or Suggestions Concerning this Manual ............................................................................ xxvii

Conventions and References ........................................................................................................ xxvii


Patents and Trademarks ........................................................................................................................................... xxvii
Warnings, Cautions, and Notes ................................................................................................................................ xxvii
Recommended Standard Designations .................................................................................................................. xxviii
Metric Conversion ..................................................................................................................................................... xxviii

Safety and Compliance .................................................................................................................xxviii


Electrical Safety and Compliance ............................................................................................................................ xxviii
Grounding .................................................................................................................................................................. xxviii
Electrical Installation ................................................................................................................................................... xxix
Battery ..................................................................................................................................................................... xxix
Fuses ..................................................................................................................................................................... xxix
Operating Environment ............................................................................................................................................... xxx
European Union Radio Equipment and Telecommunications Terminal Equipment (R&TTE) Directive
(1999/5/EC) and EN 301 489-1................................................................................................................................... xxx
European Union Electromagnetic Compatibility (EMC) Directive (2004/108/EC) ...........................................xxx
European Union Low Voltage Directive (LVD) (2006/95/EC) ............................................................................ xxxi
European Union RoHS Directive (2002/95/EC) .................................................................................................. xxxii
E uropean Union Telecommunications Terminal E quipment Directive (91/263/E E C ).......... xxxii
CE Mark ............................................................................................................................................................... xxxii

Warranty Policy ............................................................................................................................xxxii


Limitations of Warranty............................................................................................................................................. xxxii
Exclusive Remedies ................................................................................................................................................... xxxiii

Getting Help ................................................................................................................................xxxiv


Contacting Comtech EF Data ................................................................................................................................... xxxiv
Returning a Product for Upgrade or Repair ............................................................................................................ xxxv

CHAPTER 1. INTRODUCTION ............................................................................................11

1.1 Overview ............................................................................................................................ 11

iii

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Table of Contents MN-CDM625

1.2 Functional Description ........................................................................................................ 12

1.3 Features ............................................................................................................................. 13


1.3.1 Physical Description .................................................................................................................................. 13
1.3.2 Modem Compatibility .............................................................................................................................. 13
1.3.3 Ethernet/IP Interface Compatibility........................................................................................................ 14
1.3.4 Verification................................................................................................................................................. 14
1.3.5 Updating Modem Firmware .................................................................................................................... 14
1.3.6 Standard Data Interfaces ......................................................................................................................... 15
1.3.7 Optional Hardware and Accessories....................................................................................................... 15
1.3.8 Fully Accessible System Topology (FAST) ............................................................................................... 17
1.3.9 Supporting Hardware and Software .....................................................................................................110
1.3.10 Physical Features.....................................................................................................................................111
1.3.10.1 Dimensional Envelope .......................................................................................................................111
1.3.10.2 Front Panel ..........................................................................................................................................112
1.3.10.3 Rear Panel ...........................................................................................................................................113

1.4 Summary of Specifications ................................................................................................ 114


1.4.1 Modulator ................................................................................................................................................ 114
1.4.2 Demodulator ...........................................................................................................................................116
1.4.3 Data Interfaces ........................................................................................................................................121
1.4.4 Automatic Uplink Power Control (AUPC) .............................................................................................122
1.4.5 DoubleTalk Carrier- in-Carrier (CnC) ...................................................................................................122
1.4.6 Framing Summary...................................................................................................................................123
1.4.7 Data Rate Ranges ....................................................................................................................................124
1.4.8 VersaFEC Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM)............................................................................129
1.4.9 Miscellaneous..........................................................................................................................................130
1.4.10 Approvals ................................................................................................................................................. 130

CHAPTER 2. INSTALLATION .............................................................................................21

2.1 Unpacking and Inspecting the Shipment .............................................................................. 21

2.2 Installing Into a Rack Enclosure ........................................................................................... 22


2.2.1 Installing the Optional Rear-Mounting Support Brackets Kits ............................................................. 24

2.3 Configuring the CDM-625 .................................................................................................... 25

2.4 Selecting the Internal IF Loop .............................................................................................. 25

2.5 Connecting the External Cables ........................................................................................... 25

CHAPTER 3. REAR PANEL CONNECTORS AND PINOUTS ............................................31

3.1 CDM-625 Rear Panel Overview ............................................................................................ 31

3.2 CDM-625 Cable Connections ............................................................................................... 32


3.2.1 IF Connection Group................................................................................................................................. 33

iv

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Table of Contents MN-CDM625

3.2.1.1 Rx IF Connectors ................................................................................................................................... 33


3.2.1.2 Tx IF Connectors ................................................................................................................................... 33
3.2.2 Terrestrial Data Connection Group......................................................................................................... 34
3.2.2.1 Data Interface (DB-25F) ....................................................................................................................... 34
3.2.2.1.1 HSSI Operation via the CIC-60 Interface Adapter Module.......................................... 35
3.2.2.2 G.703 Connectors................................................................................................................................. 37
3.2.2.2.1 Balanced G.703 (DB-9F) .............................................................................................. 37
3.2.2.2.2 Aux G.703 (DB-9F) ....................................................................................................... 37
3.2.2.2.3 Quad E1 Operation via the Balanced G.703 / Aux G.703 Connectors ........................ 38
3.2.2.2.3.1 CA-0000163 Adapter Cable.................................................................................. 38
3.2.2.2.3.2 CA-0000164 Adapter Cable.................................................................................. 39
3.2.2.2.3.3 KT-0000122/KT-0020570 Quad E1 Balanced/Unbalanced Adapter Cable Kits .... 310
3.2.2.2.4 Unbal G.703 / ASI Out (IDO), In (DDI) .................................................................... 311
3.2.2.2.5 G.703 IDI (Insert Data In), DDO (Drop Data Out) ...................................................... 311
3.2.2.3 Quad 10/100 Ethernet (RJ-45) ..........................................................................................................311
3.2.2.4 IDR Data / Alarms / Audio (HD-44F) .................................................................................................311
3.2.2.5 ESC (DB-9F)..........................................................................................................................................312
3.2.3 Utility Connections Group......................................................................................................................312
3.2.3.1 Remote Control (DB-9M) ..................................................................................................................312
3.2.3.2 Alarms (DB-15M) ................................................................................................................................313
3.2.3.3 PMSI Connector, DB-9F .....................................................................................................................313
3.2.3.4 1:1 Control (DB-9F).............................................................................................................................314
3.2.3.5 Ext Ref In/Out .....................................................................................................................................314

3.3 CDM-625 Ground and Power Connections ......................................................................... 315


3.3.1 Chassis Ground Interface .......................................................................................................................315
3.3.2 Standard 100V/240V Alternating Current (AC) Power Interface ......................................................316
3.3.2.1 AC Operation CDM-625 Accessories .............................................................................................316
3.3.2.2 AC Operation Applying Power .......................................................................................................317
3.3.2.3 AC Operation Replacing Fuses .......................................................................................................317
3.3.3 Optional 48V Direct Current (DC) Power Interface .............................................................................318
3.3.3.1 Optional DC Operation CDM-625 Accessories.............................................................................319
3.3.3.2 Optional DC Operation Applying Power .......................................................................................319
3.3.3.3 Optional DC Operation Replacing Fuses .......................................................................................320

CHAPTER 4. UPDATING FIRMWARE ................................................................................41

4.1 Updating Firmware via Internet........................................................................................... 41

4.2 About Firmware Files, Naming, Versions, and Archive Formats ............................................ 41

4.3 Firmware Update Procedure ............................................................................................... 43


4.3.1 Getting Started: Preparing for the Firmware Download...................................................................... 43
4.3.2 Downloading and Extracting the Firmware Update ............................................................................. 45
4.3.3 Executing the Ethernet FTP Upload Procedure ..................................................................................... 47

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Table of Contents MN-CDM625

CHAPTER 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION ........................................................................51

5.1 Introduction ....................................................................................................................... 51


5.1.1 LED Indicators ............................................................................................................................................ 52
5.1.2 Keypad........................................................................................................................................................ 53
5.1.3 Vacuum Fluorescent Display (VFD) ......................................................................................................... 54
5.1.3.1 Screen Saver.......................................................................................................................................... 54
5.1.3.2 Opening Screen .................................................................................................................................... 54
5.1.3.2.1 Feature Availability/Operation Indicators via the Opening Screen ............................ 54

5.2 SELECT: (Main) Menu .......................................................................................................... 56


5.2.1 SELECT: Configuration Menus ................................................................................................................. 58
5.2.1.1 CONFIG: All ............................................................................................................................................ 59
5.2.1.2 CONFIG: Mode...................................................................................................................................510
5.2.1.3 CONFIG: Tx ..........................................................................................................................................512
5.2.1.3.1 CONFIG: Tx Tx-IF................................................................................................... 512
5.2.1.3.2 CONFIG: Tx Freq (Frequency) ............................................................................... 513
5.2.1.3.3 CONFIG: Tx Power ................................................................................................ 513
5.2.1.3.3.1 CONFIG: Tx Power Mode AUPC .......................................................... 514
5.2.1.3.4 CONFIG: Tx FEC .................................................................................................... 515
5.2.1.3.5 CONFIG: Tx Mod (Modulation) ............................................................................ 517
5.2.1.3.6 CONFIG: Tx Data ................................................................................................... 518
5.2.1.3.7 CONFIG: Tx Symb (IP-ACM Mode Only) ............................................................... 519
5.2.1.3.8 CONFIG: Tx Scrambler .......................................................................................... 520
5.2.1.4 CONFIG: Rx ..........................................................................................................................................521
5.2.1.4.1 CONFIG: Rx Rx-IF .................................................................................................. 521
5.2.1.4.2 CONFIG: Rx Freq (Frequency) ............................................................................... 522
5.2.1.4.3 CONFIG: Rx FEC .................................................................................................... 522
5.2.1.4.4 CONFIG: Rx Demod (Demodulation) .................................................................... 524
5.2.1.4.5 CONFIG: Rx Data .................................................................................................. 525
5.2.1.4.6 CONFIG: Rx Symb (IP-ACM Mode Only) ............................................................... 526
5.2.1.4.7 CONFIG: Rx Descram (Descrambler) .................................................................... 527
5.2.1.4.8 CONFIG: Rx Eq (Equalizer) .................................................................................... 527
5.2.1.4.9 CONFIG: Rx EbNo ................................................................................................. 528
5.2.1.5 CONFIG: Clocks ...................................................................................................................................529
5.2.1.5.1 CONFIG: Clocks Tx Clock....................................................................................... 529
5.2.1.5.2 CONFIG: Clocks Rx Buffer/Clock ........................................................................... 530
5.2.1.5.3 CONFIG: Clocks Clk-Ext (G.703 Clock Extension).................................................. 531
5.2.1.5.4 CONFIG: Clocks Freq-Ref ...................................................................................... 532
5.2.1.5.5 CONFIG: Clocks Int-Ref-Adjust ............................................................................. 532
5.2.1.6 CONFIG: D&I (Drop & Insert) ............................................................................................................533
5.2.1.6.1 CONFIG: D&I Loop ................................................................................................ 533
5.2.1.6.2 CONFIG: D&I Drp-Type or Ins-Type ...................................................................... 533
5.2.1.6.3 CONFIG: D&I (Drop or Insert) Chan/TS (Channel Timeslots) ............................... 534
5.2.1.6.4 CONFIG: Quad D&I (QDI) .......................................................................................... 534
5.2.1.7 CONFIG: ACM (Adaptive Coding and Modulation) (IP-ACM Mode Only) ...................................536
5.2.1.7.1 CONFIG: ACM Min/Max-ModCod ........................................................................ 536
5.2.1.7.2 CONFIG: ACM Unlock-Action ............................................................................... 536

vi

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Table of Contents MN-CDM625

5.2.1.7.3 CONFIG: ACM Target-EbNo-Margin ..................................................................... 537


5.2.1.8 CONFIG: CnC .......................................................................................................................................537
5.2.1.8.1 CONFIG: CnC Mode .............................................................................................. 537
5.2.1.8.2 CONFIG: CnC CONFIG: CnC Freq-Offset .......................................................... 538
5.2.1.8.3 CONFIG: CnC Search-Delay .................................................................................. 538
5.2.1.8.4 CONFIG: CnC PMSI-Control .................................................................................. 539
5.2.1.9 CONFIG: EDMAC.................................................................................................................................540
5.2.1.10 CONFIG: Misc ......................................................................................................................................541
5.2.1.10.1 CONFIG: Misc G.703-LineCode (Ternary Code).................................................. 541
5.2.1.10.2 CONFIG: Misc IDR-ESC ........................................................................................ 541
5.2.1.10.3 CONFIG: Misc HSSI ............................................................................................. 542
5.2.1.10.4 CONFIG: Misc RTS .............................................................................................. 542
5.2.1.10.5 CONFIG: Misc Audio-Vol (ADPCM Audio Volumes) ........................................... 542
5.2.1.10.6 CONFIG: Misc HiRateESC .................................................................................... 543
5.2.1.10.7 CONFIG: Misc Warm-Up..................................................................................... 544
5.2.1.10.8 CONFIG: Misc Stats (Statistics) ........................................................................... 544
5.2.1.10.9 CONFIG: Misc MEO ............................................................................................ 545
5.2.1.10.9.1 CONFIG: Misc MEO Antenna Handover .................................................. 546
5.2.1.11 CONFIG: Mask.....................................................................................................................................546
5.2.1.11.1 CONFIG: Mask AIS .............................................................................................. 546
5.2.1.11.2 CONFIG: Mask Buffer or Ref............................................................................... 547
5.2.1.11.3 CONFIG: Mask RxIF............................................................................................. 547
5.2.1.11.4 CONFIG: Mask TxClk ........................................................................................... 547
5.2.1.11.5 CONFIG: Mask TxSat (Satellite Tx Alarms) ......................................................... 548
5.2.1.11.6 CONFIG: Mask RxSat (Satellite Rx Alarms) ......................................................... 548
5.2.1.11.7 CONFIG: Mask Terr............................................................................................. 548
5.2.1.11.8 CONFIG: Mask ROp (RAN Optimization) (FUTURE) ............................................ 549
5.2.1.11.9 CONFIG: Mask BUC ............................................................................................ 549
5.2.1.11.10 CONFIG: Mask LNB ........................................................................................... 549
5.2.1.11.11 CONFIG: Mask CEX (G.703 Clock Extension mask)........................................... 549
5.2.1.12 CONFIG: Remote (Remote Control) .................................................................................................550
5.2.1.12.1 CONFIG: Remote Local or Serial remote settings .............................................. 550
5.2.1.13 CONFIG: IP ...........................................................................................................................................550
5.2.1.13.1 CONFIG: IP Addresses ........................................................................................ 550
5.2.1.13.2 CONFIG: IP SNMP ............................................................................................... 551
5.2.1.13.3 CONFIG: IP Setup................................................................................................ 553
5.2.1.13.4 CONFIG: IP ANT (Advanced Network Timing) .................................................... 564
5.2.1.13.4.1 CONFIG: IP ANT SNTP (Simple Network Time Protocol) ........................ 564
5.2.1.13.4.2 CONFIG: IP ANT PTP (Precision Time Protocol) ...................................... 565
5.2.1.13.5 CONFIG: IP AccessList.......................................................................................... 565
5.2.1.13.6 CONFIG: IP PktP-Enable ..................................................................................... 566
5.2.2 SELECT: Test Menus................................................................................................................................567
5.2.2.1 SELECT: TEST Mode.......................................................................................................................567
5.2.2.2 SELECT: TEST BERT ........................................................................................................................569
5.2.2.2.1 SELECT: TEST BERT Config ............................................................................... 569
5.2.2.2.2 SELECT: TEST BERT Monitor ............................................................................ 569
5.2.2.3 SELECT: TEST CnC-APC-Monitor ..................................................................................................569
5.2.2.4 SELECT: TEST Uncorrected-BER ...................................................................................................570

vii

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Table of Contents MN-CDM625

5.2.3 SELECT: Monitor Menus.........................................................................................................................571


5.2.3.1 Monitor: Live-Alarms .........................................................................................................................571
5.2.3.2 Monitor: Stored Events .....................................................................................................................572
5.2.3.3 Monitor: ACM .....................................................................................................................................573
5.2.3.4 Monitor: Statistics ..............................................................................................................................573
5.2.3.5 Monitor: Rx Parameters ....................................................................................................................575
5.2.3.6 Monitor: AUPC-Parameters ..............................................................................................................575
5.2.3.7 Monitor: CnC-Parameters .................................................................................................................575
5.2.3.8 Monitor: IP Statistics ..........................................................................................................................576
5.2.4 SELECT: Info (Information) Menus ........................................................................................................576
5.2.4.1 Info: All ................................................................................................................................................. 576
5.2.4.2 Info: ID ................................................................................................................................................. 576
5.2.4.3 Info: Mode...........................................................................................................................................577
5.2.4.4 Info: Tx ................................................................................................................................................. 577
5.2.4.5 Info: Rx ................................................................................................................................................. 577
5.2.4.6 Info: Clocks ..........................................................................................................................................578
5.2.4.7 Info: EDMAC........................................................................................................................................578
5.2.4.8 Info: Drop ............................................................................................................................................ 578
5.2.4.9 Info: Insert ...........................................................................................................................................579
5.2.4.10 Info: Remote .......................................................................................................................................579
5.2.4.11 Info: Alarms Mask...............................................................................................................................579
5.2.4.12 Info: Misc ............................................................................................................................................. 579
5.2.5 SELECT: Store/Ld (Store/Load) Menus .................................................................................................580
5.2.6 SELECT: Utility Menus.............................................................................................................................581
5.2.6.1 Utilities: Set-RTC .................................................................................................................................581
5.2.6.2 Utilities: Display-Bright.......................................................................................................................581
5.2.6.3 Utilities: CarrID ....................................................................................................................................581
5.2.6.4 Utilities: LED ........................................................................................................................................582
5.2.6.5 Utilities: Redundancy .........................................................................................................................582
5.2.6.5.1 Utilities: Redundancy Traffic-IP-Addr/Range ....................................................... 582
5.2.6.5.2 Utilities: Redundancy 1:1 ..................................................................................... 582
5.2.6.5.3 Utilities: Redundancy 1:N..................................................................................... 582
5.2.6.6 Utilities: Circuit-ID...............................................................................................................................583
5.2.6.7 Utilities: Firmware ..............................................................................................................................584
5.2.6.7.1 Utilities: Firmware Base-Modem ......................................................................... 584
5.2.6.7.1.1 Utilities: Firmware Base-Modem Boot-ROM, Image#X ........................... 584
5.2.6.7.1.2 Utilities: Firmware Base-Modem Select.................................................... 584
5.2.6.7.2 Utilities: Firmware Packet-Processor ................................................................... 585
5.2.6.7.2.1 Utilities: Firmware Packet-Processor Boot-ROM, Image#X ..................... 585
5.2.6.7.2.2 Utilities: Firmware Packet-Processor Select ............................................. 585
5.2.6.8 Utilities: Em (CDM-600/600L Emulation) ........................................................................................586
5.2.7 SELECT: ODU Menus (Summary Only) .................................................................................................586
5.2.8 SELECT: FAST Menus ..............................................................................................................................587
5.2.8.1 FAST: Options......................................................................................................................................587
5.2.8.1.1 FAST: Options View Options ................................................................................ 587
5.2.8.1.2 FAST: Options Set Registers ................................................................................. 588
5.2.8.2 FAST: Demo-Mode .............................................................................................................................589
5.2.8.3 FAST: CnC ............................................................................................................................................ 590

viii

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Table of Contents MN-CDM625

CHAPTER 6. ETHERNET-BASED REMOTE PRODUCT MANAGEMENT .........................61

6.1 Introduction ....................................................................................................................... 61

6.2 Ethernet Management Interface Protocols .......................................................................... 61

6.3 SNMP Interface................................................................................................................... 62


6.3.1 Management Information Base (MIB) Files........................................................................................... 62
6.3.2 SNMP Community Strings........................................................................................................................ 63
6.3.3 SNMP Traps ............................................................................................................................................... 63

6.4 Telnet Interface .................................................................................................................. 65


6.4.1 Using the Telnet Interface for Remote Control Operation .................................................................. 65
6.4.1.1 Using HyperTerminal for Telnet Remote Control Operation .......................................................... 65
6.4.2 Using the Telnet Interface for Telnet Command Line Interface (CLI) Operation............................... 67

6.5 Web Server (HTTP) Interface ............................................................................................... 68


6.5.1 User Login .................................................................................................................................................. 68
6.5.2 Web Server Interface Operational Features....................................................................................... 69
6.5.2.1 Navigation ............................................................................................................................................. 69
6.5.2.2 Page Sections ........................................................................................................................................ 69
6.5.2.3 Action Buttons ...................................................................................................................................... 69
6.5.2.4 Drop-down Lists..................................................................................................................................610
6.5.2.5 Text or Data Entry...............................................................................................................................610
6.5.3 Web Server Interface Menu Tree ......................................................................................................611
6.5.3.1 Conditional Access to IP Packet Processor Pages ...........................................................................612
6.5.4 Web Server Page Descriptions ..............................................................................................................613
6.5.4.1 Home Pages ........................................................................................................................................613
6.5.4.1.1 Home | Home ........................................................................................................... 613
6.5.4.1.2 Home | Contact ........................................................................................................ 614
6.5.4.1.3 Home | Support ........................................................................................................ 615
6.5.4.2 Admin Pages .......................................................................................................................................616
6.5.4.2.1 Admin | Access ......................................................................................................... 616
6.5.4.2.2 Admin | SNMP .......................................................................................................... 618
6.5.4.2.3 Admin | Firmware Pages .......................................................................................... 619
6.5.4.2.3.1 Admin | Firmware | Base Modem ..................................................................... 619
6.5.4.2.3.2 Admin | Firmware | Packet Processor............................................................... 620
6.5.4.2.4 Admin | Reboot ........................................................................................................ 621
6.5.4.2.5 Admin | FAST ............................................................................................................ 622
6.5.4.2.6 Admin | Utilities ........................................................................................................ 623
6.5.4.3 Configuration Pages ...........................................................................................................................624
6.5.4.3.1 Configuration | Modem ............................................................................................ 624
6.5.4.3.2 Configuration | LAN Pages ........................................................................................ 625
6.5.4.3.2.1 Configuration | LAN | IP .................................................................................... 625
6.5.4.3.2.2 Configuration | LAN | ARP ................................................................................. 629
6.5.4.3.3 Configuration | Routing Pages .................................................................................. 631
6.5.4.3.3.1 Configuration | Routing | Routes ...................................................................... 631
6.5.4.3.3.2 Configuration | Routing | IGMP ........................................................................ 633

ix

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Table of Contents MN-CDM625

6.5.4.3.3.3 Configuration | Routing | DHCP ........................................................................ 635


6.5.4.3.3.4 Configuration | Routing | DNS .......................................................................... 636
6.5.4.3.4 Configuration | Managed Switch.............................................................................. 637
6.5.4.3.5 Configuration | WAN Pages ...................................................................................... 639
6.5.4.3.5.1 Configuration | WAN | QoS Pages..................................................................... 639
6.5.4.3.5.1.1 Configuration | WAN | QoS Pages Max/Priority, Min/Max Modes ........ 640
6.5.4.3.5.1.2 Configuration | WAN | QoS Pages DiffServ Mode................................... 644
6.5.4.3.5.2 Configuration | WAN | Compression ................................................................ 646
6.5.4.3.5.3 Configuration | WAN | Encryption .................................................................... 647
6.5.4.3.6 Configuration | Overhead......................................................................................... 649
6.5.4.3.7 Configuration | Utilities ............................................................................................ 651
6.5.4.3.8 Configuration | D&I (Drop and Insert) ...................................................................... 654
6.5.4.3.9 Configuration | BUC (Block Up Converter) ............................................................... 655
6.5.4.3.10 Configuration | LNB (Low Noise Block Down Converter) ....................................... 655
6.5.4.3.11 Configuration | ANT (Advanced Network Timing) Pages ....................................... 656
6.5.4.3.11.1 Configuration | ANT | PTP (Precision Time Protocol) ..................................... 656
6.5.4.3.11.2 Configuration | ANT | SNTP (Simple Network Timing Protocol) ..................... 658
6.5.4.3.12 Configuration | MEO (Mid-Earth Orbit).................................................................. 659
6.5.4.4 Status Pages ........................................................................................................................................660
6.5.4.4.1 Status | Modem Status ............................................................................................. 660
6.5.4.4.2 Status | Modem Logs ................................................................................................ 661
6.5.4.4.2.1 Status | Modem Logs | Base Modem ................................................................ 661
6.5.4.4.2.2 Status | Modem Logs | Packet Processor.......................................................... 663
6.5.4.4.3 Status | Modem Info................................................................................................. 664
6.5.4.4.4 Status | Traffic Statistics Pages ................................................................................. 665
6.5.4.4.4.1 Status | Traffic Statistics | Ethernet .................................................................. 665
6.5.4.4.4.2 Status | Traffic Statistics | Router ..................................................................... 666
6.5.4.4.4.3 Status | Traffic Statistics | Managed Switch...................................................... 667
6.5.4.4.4.4 Status | Traffic Statistics | WAN ........................................................................ 668
6.5.4.4.4.5 Status | Traffic Statistics | Compression ........................................................... 669
6.5.4.4.4.6 Status | Traffic Statistics | QoS .......................................................................... 670
6.5.4.4.4.7 Status | Traffic Statistics | PTP .......................................................................... 671
6.5.4.4.4.8 Status | Traffic Statistics | MAC Table ............................................................... 673
6.5.4.4.4.9 Status | Traffic Statistics | Clear Counters......................................................... 674
6.5.4.4.5 Status | Performance Pages ..................................................................................... 675
6.5.4.4.5.1 Status | Performance | Performance ................................................................ 675
6.5.4.4.5.2 Status | Performance | Graphs ......................................................................... 676
6.5.4.5 ODU (Outdoor Unit) Pages (Summary Only)...................................................................................677
6.5.4.6 Redundancy page ...............................................................................................................................678

CHAPTER 7. FORWARD ERROR CORRECTION OPTIONS ............................................71

7.1 Introduction ....................................................................................................................... 71

7.2 Viterbi ................................................................................................................................ 71

7.3 Sequential .......................................................................................................................... 72

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Table of Contents MN-CDM625

7.4 Reed-Solomon Outer Codec ................................................................................................ 73


7.4.1 Closed Network Modes............................................................................................................................ 73
7.4.2 Open Network Modes.............................................................................................................................. 74

7.5 Trellis Coding (FAST Option) ................................................................................................ 74

7.6 Turbo Product Codec (Hardware Option) ............................................................................. 75

7.7 TPC and Low Density Parity Check (LDPC) coding ................................................................. 76
7.7.1 Introduction ............................................................................................................................................... 76
7.7.2 LDPC versus TPC ........................................................................................................................................ 77
7.7.3 End-to-End Processing Delay .................................................................................................................710

7.8 VersaFEC (Short-block LDPC).............................................................................................. 711


7.8.1 VersaFEC Extensions ...............................................................................................................................713
7.8.1.1 Extended CCM Codes.........................................................................................................................713
7.8.1.2 Ultra-Low-Latency (ULL) Codes.........................................................................................................713

7.9 Uncoded Operation (No FEC) ............................................................................................. 714

CHAPTER 8. AUTOMATIC UPLINK POWER CONTROL (AUPC) ....................................81

8.1 Introduction ....................................................................................................................... 81

8.2 Setting AUPC Parameters .................................................................................................... 82


8.2.1 Target Eb/No ............................................................................................................................................. 82
8.2.2 Max Range ................................................................................................................................................. 82
8.2.3 Alarm .......................................................................................................................................................... 83
8.2.4 Demod Unlock........................................................................................................................................... 83

8.3 Compensation Rate............................................................................................................. 83

8.4 Monitoring ......................................................................................................................... 84

CHAPTER 9. CLOCK MODES AND DROP AND INSERT (D&I)........................................91

9.1 Introduction ....................................................................................................................... 91

9.2 Transmit Clocking ............................................................................................................... 91


9.2.1 Internal Clock ............................................................................................................................................. 91
9.2.2 TX Terrestrial.............................................................................................................................................. 92
9.2.3 RX Loop-Timed, RX=TX ............................................................................................................................. 92
9.2.4 RX Loop-Timed, RX<>TX (Asymmetric Loop Timing) ............................................................................ 92
9.2.5 External TT with ST = RX Satellite ............................................................................................................ 92

9.3 Receive Clocking ................................................................................................................. 94


9.3.1 Buffer Disabled (RX Satellite) ................................................................................................................... 94
9.3.2 Buffer Enabled, TX=RX (TX Terrestrial or Int (SCT) Clock) ..................................................................... 94

xi

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Table of Contents MN-CDM625

9.3.3 Buffer Enabled, RX<>TX (TX Terrestrial or Int (SCT) Clock)................................................................... 94

9.4 X.21 Notes .......................................................................................................................... 96

9.5 Drop and Insert ................................................................................................................... 96

9.6 Frame Formats.................................................................................................................... 97

9.7 Timeslot Selection............................................................................................................... 98

9.8 Drop and Insert (D&I) Clocking ............................................................................................ 99

9.9 RX Buffer Clock = Insert (D&I only) .................................................................................... 910

9.10 Single-Source Multiple Modems ........................................................................................ 910

9.11 G.703 Clock Extension ....................................................................................................... 911


9.11.1 Clock Extension Mode 1 .........................................................................................................................911
9.11.2 Clock Extension Mode 2 .........................................................................................................................912
9.11.3 Clock Extension Mode 3 .........................................................................................................................912

9.12 Quad E1 Operation ........................................................................................................... 916

CHAPTER 10. DOUBLETALK CARRIER-IN-CARRIER OPTION .....................................101

10.1 Introduction ..................................................................................................................... 101

10.2 What is DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier? .............................................................................. 101

10.3 Application Requirements ................................................................................................. 102


10.3.1 Operational Recommendations ............................................................................................................104

10.4 System Functionality and Operational Considerations........................................................ 105


10.4.1 DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Cancellation Process ............................................................................107
10.4.2 Margin Requirements ............................................................................................................................109
10.4.3 Carrier-in-Carrier Latency.......................................................................................................................109
10.4.4 Carrier-in-Carrier and Adaptive Coding and Modulation ...................................................................109
10.4.5 Carrier-in-Carrier Link Design.................................................................................................................109
10.4.5.1 Symmetric Data Rate Link .............................................................................................................. 1010
10.4.5.2 Asymmetric Data Rate Link ............................................................................................................ 1012
10.4.5.3 Power Limited Links ........................................................................................................................ 1013
10.4.6 Carrier-in-Carrier Commissioning and Deployment ........................................................................ 1015
10.4.7 Validating Carrier-in-Carrier Performance ........................................................................................ 1016

10.5 Operational References................................................................................................... 1017


10.5.1 Carrier-in-Carrier Link Budget Calculation ........................................................................................ 1017
10.5.2 Estimating PSD Ratio ........................................................................................................................... 1018
10.5.2.1 Estimating PSD Ratio from LST....................................................................................................... 1018
10.5.2.2 Estimating PSD Ratio from Satmaster........................................................................................... 1019

xii

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Table of Contents MN-CDM625

10.5.2.3 Estimating PSD Ratio Using Spectrum Analyzer .......................................................................... 1019

10.6 Carrier-in-Carrier Automatic Power Control (CnC-APC) ..................................................... 1020


10.6.1 Introduction .......................................................................................................................................... 1020
10.6.2 AUPC and Carrier-in-Carrier in the CDM-625 ................................................................................... 1020
10.6.3 The CnC Automatic Power Control Algorithm.................................................................................. 1020
10.6.4 CnC-APC Framing ................................................................................................................................. 1023
10.6.5 Solving the Problem of Self-Locking................................................................................................... 1024
10.6.6 CnC-APC Response Time ..................................................................................................................... 1024
10.6.7 CnC-APC Setup ..................................................................................................................................... 1024
10.6.8 CnC-APC Redundancy Support Notes ............................................................................................... 1028

10.7 DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Specifications ..................................................................... 1029

10.8 Carrier-in-Carrier Summary ............................................................................................. 1030

10.9 Glossary.......................................................................................................................... 1030

CHAPTER 11. EDMAC CHANNEL ....................................................................................111

11.1 Theory of Operation.......................................................................................................... 111


11.1.1 EDMAC ..................................................................................................................................................... 111
11.1.2 Drop & Insert ++ ......................................................................................................................................112
11.1.3 EDMAC-3.................................................................................................................................................. 112

11.2 M&C Connection............................................................................................................... 112

11.3 Setup Summary ................................................................................................................ 114

CHAPTER 12. ESC++........................................................................................................121

12.1 Introduction ..................................................................................................................... 121

12.2 Overhead Details .............................................................................................................. 121

12.3 Available Baud Rates......................................................................................................... 122

12.4 Configuration.................................................................................................................... 122

12.5 Effect on Eb/No Performance ............................................................................................ 122

CHAPTER 13. OFFSET QPSK OPERATION ....................................................................131

CHAPTER 14. OPEN NETWORK OPERATIONS .............................................................141

14.1 Overview .......................................................................................................................... 141

14.2 IBS .................................................................................................................................... 141

xiii

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Table of Contents MN-CDM625

14.2.1 IBS Clock/Data Recovery and De-jitter .................................................................................................142


14.2.2 IBS Framing .............................................................................................................................................. 142
14.2.3 IBS Engineering Service Channel ...........................................................................................................142
14.2.4 IBS Scrambling .........................................................................................................................................142

14.3 Drop and Insert (D&I) ........................................................................................................ 143


14.3.1 D&I Primary Data Interfaces ..................................................................................................................144
14.3.2 D&I Framing............................................................................................................................................. 144

14.4 IDR ................................................................................................................................... 145


14.4.1 IDR Primary Data Interfaces...................................................................................................................146
14.4.2 IDR Engineering Service Channel ..........................................................................................................146

CHAPTER 15. IP SUB-MUX ..............................................................................................151

15.1 Introduction ..................................................................................................................... 151

15.2 Available Ratios ................................................................................................................ 151

15.3 Data Rate vs. Composite Rate............................................................................................ 152

CHAPTER 16. ETHERNET NETWORK CONFIGURATION ..............................................161

16.1 Introduction ..................................................................................................................... 161

16.2 CDM-625 Ethernet Overview ............................................................................................. 161


16.2.1 Interface Architecture ............................................................................................................................161
16.2.2 Modes of Ethernet Operation ...............................................................................................................162
16.2.3 Ethernet Networking Loops...................................................................................................................162
16.2.3.1 Networking Loops in Managed Switch Mode.................................................................................163
16.2.3.1.1 Hub-to-Hub using Ethernet Switches ..................................................................... 163
16.2.3.1.2 Hub-to-Hub using Ethernet Routers ....................................................................... 164
16.2.3.1.3 Hub-to-Remotes using Ethernet Switches or Routers ............................................ 165
16.2.3.2 Networking Loops in Router Mode (with IP Packet Processor) ....................................................166

16.3 Ethernet Network Configurations in Managed Switch Mode .............................................. 167


16.3.1 Point-to-Multipoint Hub-to-Remotes, Split-path Traffic Using Routers ........................................167
16.3.2 Point-to-Multipoint Hub-to-Remotes, Split-path Traffic Using Switches ......................................168

16.4 Ethernet Network Configurations in Router Mode (with IP Packet Processor) ..................... 169
16.4.1 Point-to-Multipoint (Router Multipoint Hub) Mode ..........................................................................169
16.4.1.1 Router Multipoint Hub Configuration..............................................................................................169
16.4.2 Multicast Routing Mode ..................................................................................................................... 1611
16.4.2.1 Multicast Routing Configuration ................................................................................................... 1612

16.5 Ethernet Overhead over WAN Interface .......................................................................... 1613


16.5.1 Managed Switch Mode (without IP Packet Processor) ................................................................... 1613
16.5.2 Router Mode or Managed Switch Mode (with IP Packet Processor) ............................................ 1613

xiv

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Table of Contents MN-CDM625

16.6 Ethernet Redundancy...................................................................................................... 1614

16.7 Advanced Network Timing .............................................................................................. 1615


16.7.1 Overview ............................................................................................................................................... 1615
16.7.2 SNTP (Simple Network Time Protocol).............................................................................................. 1615
16.7.3 PTP (Precision Time Protocol)............................................................................................................. 1615

CHAPTER 17. ADAPTIVE CODING AND MODULATION (ACM) .....................................171

17.1 Introduction ..................................................................................................................... 171

17.2 Background ...................................................................................................................... 172

17.3 Requirements for ACM...................................................................................................... 173

17.4 An Existing Satellite ACM Scheme...................................................................................... 175

17.5 Disadvantages of DVB-S2 .................................................................................................. 175

17.6 VersaFEC ACM .................................................................................................................. 176

17.7 VersaFEC ACM Latency ...................................................................................................... 178

17.8 Configuring VersaFEC ACM in the CDM-625 ....................................................................... 179

17.9 Monitoring ACM performance......................................................................................... 1711

17.10 ACM Congestion Control ............................................................................................. 1712

17.11 Notes and Recommendations ...................................................................................... 1713

17.12 VersaFEC ACM Summary of Specifications ................................................................. 1715

CHAPTER 18. IP PACKET PROCESSOR OPTION ..........................................................181

18.1 Introduction ..................................................................................................................... 181


18.1.1 IP Packet Processor Operational Requirements ..............................................................................181
18.1.2 Interoperability Compatibility/Limitations...........................................................................................182

18.2 IP Packet Processor Features ............................................................................................. 183


18.2.1 Streamline Encapsulation (SLE) .............................................................................................................183
18.2.2 Modes of Operation ...............................................................................................................................183
18.2.3 Subsystem Multiplex (Sub-Mux) ...........................................................................................................183
18.2.4 Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM) .............................................................................................183
18.2.5 FAST Options ...........................................................................................................................................184
18.2.5.1 Header Compression .........................................................................................................................184
18.2.5.2 Payload Compression ........................................................................................................................185
18.2.5.3 Advanced Quality of Service (QoS)...................................................................................................185
18.2.5.4 Advanced Encryption Standard (AES) Encryption ..........................................................................185

xv

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Table of Contents MN-CDM625

18.3 CDM-625 Operation with IP Packet Processor .................................................................... 186


18.3.1 Front Panel Operation ............................................................................................................................186
18.3.2 Ethernet-based Remote Product Management .................................................................................186
18.3.2.1 SNMP Interface...................................................................................................................................186
18.3.2.2 Telnet Interface ..................................................................................................................................187
18.3.2.3 Web Server (HTTP) Interface ............................................................................................................187

18.4 List of Supported Internet RFCs (Requests for Comment) ................................................... 188

18.5 IP Packet Processor Field Upgrade Procedure .................................................................... 189


18.5.1 Overview .................................................................................................................................................. 189
18.5.2 Requirements for Field Upgrade ...........................................................................................................189
18.5.3 Field Upgrade Procedure .................................................................................................................... 1810

CHAPTER 19. CARRIER ID (METACARRIER ) ...............................................................191

19.1 Introduction ..................................................................................................................... 191

19.2 About MetaCarrier ............................................................................................................ 191

19.3 Functional Description ...................................................................................................... 192

19.4 Configuring the CDM-625 for Carrier ID Operation ............................................................. 193


19.4.1 Enabling Carrier ID Operation................................................................................................................194
19.4.1.1 Enabling Operation via the CDM-625 Front Panel and VFD..........................................................194
19.4.1.2 Enabling Operation via the CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface............................................194
19.4.2 Creating the MetaCarrier Custom Message ........................................................................................195
19.4.2.1 Creating the Message via the CDM-625 Front Panel and VFD .....................................................195
19.4.2.2 Creating the Message via the CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface .......................................196

CHAPTER 20. QUALITY OF SERVICE (QOS) ..................................................................201

20.1 Overview .......................................................................................................................... 201


20.1.1 QoS Terminology.....................................................................................................................................201

20.2 Layer 2 QoS....................................................................................................................... 202


20.2.1 Modem Tx Data Rate vs. QoS Tx Data Rate .........................................................................................202
20.2.2 Flow Control ............................................................................................................................................ 203
20.2.3 Port-based Layer 2 QoS ..........................................................................................................................203
20.2.4 VLAN-based Layer 2 QoS........................................................................................................................206

20.3 Layer 3 QoS..................................................................................................................... 2010


20.3.1 Layer 3 QoS Max-Pri Mode ................................................................................................................. 2010
20.3.2 Layer 3 QoS Min-Max Mode............................................................................................................... 2012
20.3.3 Layer 3 QoS DiffServ Mode ................................................................................................................. 2014
20.3.3.1 Layer 3 QoS Congestion Avoidance............................................................................................... 2014
20.3.3.2 Layer 3 QoS List of Supported RFCs (Requests for Comment)................................................... 2015

xvi

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Table of Contents MN-CDM625

20.4 QoS with ACM (Adaptive Coding and Modulation) ........................................................... 2016
20.4.1 Maximum Clipping............................................................................................................................... 2016
20.4.2 Minimum Data Rate ............................................................................................................................ 2016

APPENDIX A. CABLE DRAWINGS ..................................................................................... A-1

A.1 Overview ............................................................................................................................ A-1


A.1.1 EIA-530 to RS-422/449 DCE Conversion Cable ...................................................................................... A-2
A.1.2 EIA-530 to V.35 DCE Conversion Cable .................................................................................................. A-3
A.1.3 RS-232 Remote Control Cable ................................................................................................................. A-4

APPENDIX B. EB/NO MEASUREMENT............................................................................... B1

APPENDIX C. FAST ACTIVATION PROCEDURE ............................................................. C1

C.1 FAST System Overview ........................................................................................................ C1

C.2 FAST Activation Procedure .................................................................................................. C2


C.2.1 FAST Activation via the CDM-625 Front Panel ......................................................................................C2
C.2.2 FAST Activation via the CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface.........................................................C4

APPENDIX D. REMOTE CONTROL ................................................................................... D1

D.1 Introduction ...................................................................................................................... D1

D.2 EIA-485 .............................................................................................................................. D1

D.3 EIA-232 .............................................................................................................................. D2

D.4 Basic Protocol .................................................................................................................... D2


D.4.1 Packet Structure ....................................................................................................................................... D3
D.4.1.1 Start of Packet...................................................................................................................................... D3
D.4.1.2 Target Address ..................................................................................................................................... D4
D.4.1.3 Address Delimiter ................................................................................................................................ D4
D.4.1.4 Instruction Code .................................................................................................................................. D4
D.4.1.5 Instruction Code Qualifier .................................................................................................................. D4
D.4.1.6 Optional Message Arguments ........................................................................................................... D6
D.4.1.7 End Of Packet....................................................................................................................................... D6

D.5 Remote Commands and Queries ........................................................................................ D7


D.5.1 Table Indexes............................................................................................................................................ D7
D.5.2 Tx Parameters ........................................................................................................................................ D10
D.5.3 Rx Parameters ........................................................................................................................................ D19
D.5.4 Unit Parameters ..................................................................................................................................... D27
D.5.5 Bulk Configuration Strings..................................................................................................................... D41
D.5.6 Modem Information.............................................................................................................................. D47
D.5.7 Modem Performance Information ...................................................................................................... D50

xvii

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Table of Contents MN-CDM625

D.5.8 BUC Parameters (L-Band Device) ......................................................................................................... D57


D.5.9 LNB Parameters (L-Band Device) ......................................................................................................... D59
D.5.10 Ethernet Parameters ............................................................................................................................. D60

APPENDIX E. TELNET COMMAND LINE INTERFACE (CLI) OPERATION ...................... E1

E.1 Overview ............................................................................................................................ E1


E.1.1 Interface Access ........................................................................................................................................ E1
E.1.2 Terminal Emulator Considerations ......................................................................................................... E2
E.1.2.1 Using the PuTTY Terminal Emulator .................................................................................................. E2
E.1.2.2 Using the Tera Term Terminal Emulator ........................................................................................... E4

E.2 Using the Telnet Command Line Interface (CLI) .................................................................... E7


E.2.1 Telnet CLI Menu System Parallel Functionality .................................................................................. E7
E.2.2 CLI Menus Common Navigation and Operation Features ................................................................ E7

E.3 Command Line Interface Pages.......................................................................................... E10


E.3.1 Home (Main) Menu ................................................................................................................................ E10
E.3.1.1 Home > Remote Access Mode ......................................................................................................... E11
E.3.2 Home > Administration Submenu ........................................................................................................ E12
E.3.2.1 Home > Administration > Host Access List ...................................................................................... E13
E.3.2.2 Home > Administration > SNMP ...................................................................................................... E14
E.3.2.3 Home > Administration > Firmware (Base Modem) or (Packet Processor) ................................E15
E.3.2.4 Home > Administration > Reboot..................................................................................................... E16
E.3.2.5 Home > Administration > FAST......................................................................................................... E17
E.3.2.6 Home > Administration > Save Modem Configuration / Load Modem Configuration..............E19
E.3.2.7 Home > Administration > Restore Factory Defaults ......................................................................E21
E.3.3 Home > Modem Submenu .................................................................................................................... E22
E.3.3.1 Home > Modem > Interface.............................................................................................................. E23
E.3.3.2 Home > Modem > Modem TX .......................................................................................................... E24
E.3.3.3 Home > Modem > Modem RX.......................................................................................................... E26
E.3.3.4 Home > Modem > Carrier-in-Carrier (CnC) ..................................................................................... E28
E.3.3.5 Home > Modem > Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM)........................................................E29
E.3.3.6 Home > Modem > Drop and Insert (D&I) ........................................................................................ E30
E.3.3.6.1 Home > Modem > Drop and Insert (D&I) > D&I Tables ............................................ E31
E.3.3.7 Home > Administration > Block Upconverter (BUC) ......................................................................E33
E.3.3.8 Home > Modem > (Low-Noise Block Downconverter) LNB ..........................................................E34
E.3.3.9 Home > Modem > MEO (Medium-Earth Orbit) .............................................................................E35
E.3.3.10 Home > Modem > Utilities ................................................................................................................ E36
E.3.3.11 Home > Modem > Overhead ............................................................................................................ E38
E.3.4 Home > Network Submenu ................................................................................................................... E40
E.3.4.1 Home > Network > Ethernet Ports ................................................................................................... E41
E.3.4.1.1 Home > Network > Ethernet Ports > Ethernet Port # ............................................... E42
E.3.4.2 Home > Network > LAN IP................................................................................................................. E43
E.3.4.3 Home > Network > LAN ARP ............................................................................................................. E44
E.3.4.3.1 Home > Network > LAN ARP > Arp Table > Arp Entry # ............................................ E45
E.3.4.4 Home > Network > VLAN .................................................................................................................. E46
E.3.4.4.1 Home > Network > VLAN > VLAN Table > VLAN # .................................................... E47

xviii

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Table of Contents MN-CDM625

E.3.4.5 Home > Network > Routes ................................................................................................................ E48


E.3.4.5.1 Home > Network > Routes > Route Table................................................................. E49
E.3.4.6 Home > Network > Managed Switch ............................................................................................... E50
E.3.4.7 Home > Network > IGMP (Internet Group Management Protocol) ............................................E51
E.3.4.8 Home > Network > DNS (Domain Name System) ..........................................................................E52
E.3.4.9 Home > Network > DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol) ..............................................E52
E.3.4.10 Home > Network > PTP (Precision Time Protocol) .........................................................................E53
E.3.4.11 Home > Network > SNTP (Simple Network Time Protocol) ..........................................................E54
E.3.4.12 Home > Network > MAC Table ......................................................................................................... E55
E.3.5 Home > WAN Submenu ......................................................................................................................... E56
E.3.5.1 Home > WAN > QoS Submenu ......................................................................................................... E56
E.3.5.1.1 Home > WAN > QoS > Max-Pri and Min-Max Table ................................................. E57
E.3.5.1.2 Home > WAN > QoS > QoS Differentiated Services Table ........................................ E58
E.3.5.2 Home > WAN > Compression ........................................................................................................... E59
E.3.5.3 Home >WAN > Encryption ................................................................................................................ E60
E.3.6 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) Submenus (Summary Only) ................................................................E62
E.3.7 Home > Redundancy Submenu ............................................................................................................ E63
E.3.8 Home > General Information Submenu............................................................................................... E64
E.3.8.1 Home > General Information > Modem Status ..............................................................................E65
E.3.8.2 Home > General Information > Modem Information ....................................................................E66
E.3.8.3 Home > General Information > MAC Table..................................................................................... E67
E.3.8.4 Home > General Information > Block Upconverter (BUC) ............................................................E68
E.3.8.5 Home > General Information > Low Noise Block Downconverter (LNB).....................................E68
E.3.9 Home > Logs Submenu .......................................................................................................................... E69
E.3.9.1 Home > Logs > Base Modem ............................................................................................................ E70
E.3.9.1.1 Home > Logs > Base Modem > Stored Event Table .................................................. E71
E.3.9.1.2 Home > Logs > Base Modem > Stored Statistic Table............................................... E72
E.3.9.2 Home > Logs > Packet Processor ...................................................................................................... E73
E.3.9.2.1 Home > Logs > Packet Processor > Stored Event Table ............................................ E74
E.3.10 Home > Statistics Submenu ................................................................................................................... E75
E.3.10.1 Home > Statistics > Ethernet Submenu ........................................................................................... E76
E.3.10.1.1 Home > Statistics > Ethernet > Rx ........................................................................... E77
E.3.10.1.2 Home > Statistics > Ethernet > Tx ........................................................................... E78
E.3.10.1.3 Home > Statistics > Ethernet > Errors ..................................................................... E79
E.3.10.2 Home > Statistics > Router ................................................................................................................ E80
E.3.10.3 Home > Statistics > Managed Switch ............................................................................................... E81
E.3.10.4 Home > Statistics > WAN (Router Mode) ........................................................................................ E82
E.3.10.5 Home > Statistics > WAN (Managed Switch Mode).......................................................................E83
E.3.10.6 Home > Statistics > Compression ..................................................................................................... E84
E.3.10.6.1 Home > Statistics > Compression > Table View ...................................................... E85
E.3.10.7 Home > Statistics > QoS ..................................................................................................................... E86
E.3.10.7.1 Home > Statistics > QoS > Table View..................................................................... E86
E.3.10.8 Home > Statistics > PTP ..................................................................................................................... E87
E.3.10.8.1 Home > Statistics > PTP > LAN Details .................................................................... E88
E.3.10.8.2 Home > Statistics > PTP > WAN Details .................................................................. E88
E.3.10.9 Home > Statistics > CPU..................................................................................................................... E89
E.3.10.10 Home > Statistics > Clear All Counters ............................................................................................. E89
E.3.11 Home > Contact Page ............................................................................................................................. E90

xix

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Table of Contents MN-CDM625

APPENDIX F. CDM-625 ODU (TRANSCEIVER, BUC, LNB) OPERATION........................ F1

F.1 Introduction ....................................................................................................................... F1

F.2 ODU Remote Control Address Setup .................................................................................... F2

F.3 ODU Operations via the CDM-625 Front Panel ..................................................................... F3


F.3.1 CDM-625 Front Panel Operation Overview........................................................................................... F3
F.3.2 CDM-625 Front Panel Menus ODU Menu Hierarchy ........................................................................ F4
F.3.3 SELECT: (Main) Menu Overview.............................................................................................................. F5
F.3.3.1 (SELECT: CONFIGURATION) Menu Branches .................................................................................... F6
F.3.3.1.1 CONFIG: Tx Freq and CONFIG: Rx Freq Submenus ........................................... F6
F.3.3.1.2 (SELECT: CONFIGURATION) Mask Submenus ............................................................. F6
F.3.3.1.2.1 CONFIG: Mask BUC.......................................................................................... F7
F.3.3.1.2.2 CONFIG: Mask LNB .......................................................................................... F8
F.3.3.2 (SELECT: MONITOR) Live-Alarms Menu ............................................................................................ F9
F.3.3.3 (SELECT:) ODU Menu Branches ........................................................................................................ F10
F.3.3.3.1 ODU: BUC:PwrSupply+Ref (Power Supply and Reference) ....................................... F10
F.3.3.3.1.1 ODU: BUC:PwrSupply+Ref PSU-and-10MHz Parameters .............................. F10
F.3.3.3.1.2 ODU: BUC:PwrSupply+Ref LO Freq (Local Oscillator Frequency).................. F11
F.3.3.3.1.3 ODU: BUC:PwrSupply+Ref PSUmonitor ........................................................ F11
F.3.3.3.2 ODU: LNB:PwrSupply+Ref (Power Supply and Reference) ....................................... F12
F.3.3.3.2.1 ODU: LNB:PwrSupply+Ref PSU-and-10MHz .................................................. F12
F.3.3.3.2.2 ODU: LNB:PwrSupply+Ref LO-Freq (Local Oscillator Frequency) .................. F12
F.3.3.3.2.3 ODU: LNB:PwrSupply+Ref PSUmonitor......................................................... F13
F.3.3.3.3 ODU: FSK-control ...................................................................................................... F13
F.3.3.3.3.1 ODU: FSK-control CSAT ................................................................................. F15
F.3.3.3.3.1.1 ODU: FSK-control CSAT (2CSATs CSAT #X) Configuration............. F15
F.3.3.3.3.1.1.1 ODU: FSK-control CSAT (2CSATs CSAT #X) Configuration Tx ....
.............................................................................................................. F15
F.3.3.3.3.1.1.2 ODU: FSK-control CSAT (2CSATs CSAT #X) Configuration Rx ....
.............................................................................................................. F16
F.3.3.3.3.1.1.3 ODU: FSK-control CSAT (2CSATs CSAT #X) Configuration LNA .
.............................................................................................................. F16
F.3.3.3.3.1.1.4 ODU: FSK-control CSAT (2CSATs CSAT #X) Configuration Misc
.............................................................................................................. F17
F.3.3.3.3.1.2 ODU: FSK-control CSAT (2CSATs CSAT #X) Monitor ..................... F18
F.3.3.3.3.1.3 ODU: FSK-control CSAT (2CSATs CSAT #X) Alarms ....................... F18
F.3.3.3.3.1.3.1 ODU: FSK-control CSAT (2CSATs CSAT #X) Alarms Current-
Alarms .............................................................................................................. F18
F.3.3.3.3.1.3.2 ODU: FSK-control CSAT (2CSATs CSAT #X) Alarms Stored-
Alarms .............................................................................................................. F19
F.3.3.3.3.1.4 ODU: FSK-control CSAT (2CSATs CSAT #X) Info ............................ F19
F.3.3.3.3.2 ODU: FSK-control 2CSATs .............................................................................. F21
F.3.3.3.3.2.1 ODU: FSK-control 2CSATs CSAT#X ..................................................... F21
F.3.3.3.3.2.2 ODU: FSK-control 2CSATs Redundancy-Box ...................................... F21
F.3.3.3.3.3 ODU: FSK-control KST .................................................................................... F23
F.3.3.3.3.3.1 ODU: FSK-control KST Configuration ................................................. F23

xx

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Table of Contents MN-CDM625

F.3.3.3.3.3.1.1 ODU: FSK-control KST Configuration Tx................................. F23


F.3.3.3.3.3.1.2 ODU: FSK-control KST Configuration Rx ................................ F23
F.3.3.3.3.3.1.3 ODU: FSK-control KST Configuration Miscellaneous ............. F23
F.3.3.3.3.3.1.4 ODU: FSK-control KST Information ............................................. F24
F.3.3.3.3.3.1.5 ODU: FSK-control KST Information Model............................. F24
F.3.3.3.3.3.1.6 ODU: FSK-control KST Information Tx+Rx-Param .................. F24
F.3.3.3.3.3.1.7 ODU: FSK-control KST Information Misc ............................... F25
F.3.3.3.3.3.1.8 ODU: FSK-control KST Information Numbers ........................ F25
F.3.3.3.3.3.1.9 ODU: FSK-control KST Alarms ..................................................... F25
F.3.3.3.3.4 ODU: FSK-control BUC ................................................................................... F26
F.3.3.3.3.4.1 ODU: FSK-control BUC Configuration ................................................ F26
F.3.3.3.3.4.2 ODU: FSK-control BUC Status ............................................................ F26
F.3.3.3.3.4.3 ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK ............................................... F26
F.3.3.3.3.4.3.1 ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD (2LPODs
Online/Offline LPOD) ...................................................................................................... F27
F.3.3.3.3.4.3.1.1 ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD (2LPODs
Online/Offline LPOD) Cnfg ..................................................................................... F27
F.3.3.3.3.4.3.1.2 ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD (2LPODs
Online/Offline LPOD) Monitor ................................................................................ F29
F.3.3.3.3.4.3.1.3 ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD (2LPODs
Online/Offline LPOD) LPOD Alarms ................................................................... F30
F.3.3.3.3.4.3.1.4 ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD (2LPODs
Online/Offline LPOD) Statistics ............................................................................... F31
F.3.3.3.3.4.3.1.5 ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD (2LPODs
Online/Offline LPOD) Information .......................................................................... F33
F.3.3.3.3.4.3.1.6 ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD (2LPODs
Online/Offline LPOD) Redun .................................................................................. F34
F.3.3.3.3.4.3.1.7 ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK 2LPODs .............. F35

F.4 ODU Operations via the CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface ......................................... F36
F.4.1 Web Server Interface and Menu Tree .................................................................................................. F36
F.4.2 Web Page Descriptions .......................................................................................................................... F38
F.4.2.1 Configuration | BUC (Block Up Converter) Page ............................................................................ F38
F.4.2.2 Configuration | LNB (Low Noise Block Down Converter) .............................................................. F39
F.4.2.3 Status | Modem Logs | Base Modem Page .................................................................................... F40
F.4.2.4 ODU Pages........................................................................................................................................... F42
F.4.2.4.1 ODU | Enable ............................................................................................................ F43
F.4.2.4.2 ODU | Config Pages................................................................................................... F44
F.4.2.4.2.1 ODU | Config (CSAT-5060) ................................................................................. F44
F.4.2.4.2.2 ODU | Config (KST-2000A/B) ............................................................................. F47
F.4.2.4.3 ODU | Status ............................................................................................................. F49
F.4.2.4.3.1 ODU | Status (CSAT-5060) ................................................................................. F49
F.4.2.4.3.2 ODU | Status (KST-2000A/B) .............................................................................. F50
F.4.2.4.4 ODU | Utilities ........................................................................................................... F51
F.4.2.4.4.1 ODU | Utilities (CSAT-5060) ............................................................................... F51
F.4.2.4.4.2 ODU | Utilities (KST-2000A/B) ........................................................................... F53

xxi

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Table of Contents MN-CDM625

F.5 ODU Operations via the CDM-625 Telnet Command Line Interface (CLI) ............................. F54
F.5.1 ODU Operations using the Telnet CLI ................................................................................................... F55
F.5.1.1 Home (Main) Menu ........................................................................................................................... F55
F.5.1.2 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) Submenu .......................................................................................... F56
F.5.1.2.1 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 Submenu ............................................... F57
F.5.1.2.1.1 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > Up Converter Settings 1/2, 2/2 ... F58
F.5.1.2.1.2 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > Down Converter Settings 1/2, 2/2 ......
............................................................................................................................ F59
F.5.1.2.1.3 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > Unit Settings 1/2, 2/2 .................. F60
F.5.1.2.1.4 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > LNA Settings ................................ F61
F.5.1.2.1.5 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > Status .......................................... F62
F.5.1.2.1.6 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > Logs ............................................. F63
F.5.1.2.1.7 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > Redundancy ................................ F64
F.5.1.2.1.8 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > Utilities ........................................ F64

TABLES
Table 1-1. CDM-625 Optional Hardware and Accessories ........................................................................ 16
Table 1-2. CDM-625 FAST and FAST-accessible Hardware Options.......................................................... 18
Table 3-1. CDM-625 Rear Panel Cabling Connections .............................................................................. 32
Table 3-2. Data Interface Connector Pinouts........................................................................................... 34
Table 3-3. CIC-60 Module HSSI/EIA-613 Side Connector Pinouts ......................................................... 36
Table 3-4. Balanced G.703 Connector Pinouts......................................................................................... 37
Table 3-5. Auxiliary G.703 Connector Pinouts ......................................................................................... 37
Table 3-6. CA-0000163 Connector Pinouts .............................................................................................. 38
Table 3-7. CA-0000164 Connector Pinouts .............................................................................................. 39
Table 3-8. CA-0000347/CA-0020710 Connector Pinouts....................................................................... 310
Table 3-9. IDR Data/Alarms/Audio Connector Pinouts .......................................................................... 311
Table 3-10. ESC Connector Pinouts ........................................................................................................ 312
Table 3-11. Remote Control Connector Pinouts .................................................................................... 312
Table 3-12. Alarm Interface Connector Pinouts..................................................................................... 313
Table 3-13. PMSI (Pre-Mapped Symbol Interface) Connector Pinouts.................................................. 313
Table 3-14. 1:1 Control Interface Connector Pinouts ............................................................................ 314
Table 7-1. Viterbi Decoding Summary ...................................................................................................... 72
Table 7-2. Sequential Decoding Summary ................................................................................................ 73
Table 7-3. Concatenated RS Coding Summary.......................................................................................... 74
Table 7-4. 8-PSK/TCM Coding Summary ................................................................................................... 75
Table 7-5. Available TPC/ LDPC Modes ..................................................................................................... 78
Table 7-6. Comparison of all Comtech EF Data TPC/LDPC Modes (CDM-625 with TPC/LDPC Codec) ..... 79
Table 7-7. TPC/LDPC Processing Delay Comparison ............................................................................... 710
Table 7-8. TPC/LDPC Summary ............................................................................................................... 710
Table 7-9. The VersaFEC ModCod set ..................................................................................................... 711
Table 10-1. Spectral Efficiency using DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier ....................................................... 107
Table 17-1. The VersaFEC ModCod set ................................................................................................... 177
Table 17-2. VersaFEC Implementation of ACM 100 ksymbols/sec Example Case ............................... 178
Table 20-1. Modem Tx Data Rate vs. QoS Tx Data Rate (Hardware-limited) ......................................... 202

xxii

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Table of Contents MN-CDM625

Table 20-2. 802.1q to Layer 2 QoS Priority Conversion .......................................................................... 206

FIGURES
Figure 1-1. CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem .................................................................................... 11
Figure 1-2. CDM-625 Dimensional Envelope .......................................................................................... 111
Figure 1-3. CDM-625 Front Panel Features ............................................................................................ 112
Figure 1-4. CDM-625 Rear Panel View .................................................................................................... 113
Figure 1-5. Rx Carrier Level vs. Symbol Rate L-Band (950-2000 MHz) ................................................. 120
Figure 1-6. Rx Carrier Level vs. Symbol Rate IF Band (50-180 MHz) .................................................... 120
Figure 2-1. Unpacking and Inspecting the CDM-625 ................................................................................ 21
Figure 2-2. Installing the CDM-625 Into a Rack Enclosure ........................................................................ 23
Figure 2-3. Installing the Optional Rear-Mounting Support Brackets Kit ................................................. 24
Figure 3-1. CDM-625 Rear Panel View ...................................................................................................... 31
Figure 3-2. CIC-60 Interface Adapter Module (CEFD P/N PL-0000307) .................................................... 35
Figure 3-3. CA-0000163 Adapter Cable (DB-9M (2X) DB-15F) ............................................................. 38
Figure 3-4. CA-0000164 Adapter Cable (DB-9M (2X) RJ-48F) .............................................................. 39
Figure 3-5. Quad E1 Balanced/Unbalanced Adapter Cable Kits ............................................................. 310
Figure 3-6. CDM-625 Chassis Ground Interface ...................................................................................... 315
Figure 3-7. CDM-625 Standard AC Chassis (CEFD P/N PL/12587-1) ....................................................... 316
Figure 3-8. Applying AC Power to the CDM-625 ..................................................................................... 317
Figure 3-9. Replacing CDM-625 AC Fuses ............................................................................................... 317
Figure 3-10. CDM-625 Optional DC Chassis (CEFD P/N PL/12587-2) ...................................................... 318
Figure 3-11. Applying Power to the CDM-625 Optional DC Chassis ....................................................... 319
Figure 3-12. Replacing CDM-625 Optional DC Chassis Fuses.................................................................. 320
Figure 5-1. CDM-625 Front Panel Features .............................................................................................. 51
Figure 5-2. CDM-625 Principle Menu Tree (FW Ver. 2.3.1) ...................................................................... 57
Figure 5-3. Loopback Modes ................................................................................................................... 568
Figure 6-1. CDM-625 Telnet Command Line Interface (CLI) ..................................................................... 67
Figure 6-2. CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface Menu Tree (FW Ver. 2.3.1) .................................... 611
Figure 6-3. CDM-625 Satellite Modem Home page ................................................................................ 613
Figure 6-4. Home | Contact page............................................................................................................ 614
Figure 6-5. Home | Support page ........................................................................................................... 615
Figure 6-6. Admin | Access page ............................................................................................................ 616
Figure 6-7. Admin | SNMP page ............................................................................................................. 618
Figure 6-8. Admin | Firmware | Base Modem page ............................................................................... 619
Figure 6-9. Admin | Firmware | Packet Processor page......................................................................... 620
Figure 6-10. Status | Firmware Info | Reboot page................................................................................ 621
Figure 6-11. Admin | FAST page ............................................................................................................. 622
Figure 6-12. Admin | Utilities page ......................................................................................................... 623
Figure 6-13. Configuration | Modem page ............................................................................................. 624
Figure 6-14. Configuration | LAN | IP page ............................................................................................ 625
Figure 6-15. Configuration | LAN | ARP page ......................................................................................... 629
Figure 6-16. Configuration | Routing | Routes page .............................................................................. 631
Figure 6-17. Configuration | Routing | IGMP page ................................................................................ 633
Figure 6-18. Configuration | Routing | DHCP page ................................................................................ 635
Figure 6-19. Configuration | Routing | DNS page................................................................................... 636

xxiii

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Table of Contents MN-CDM625

Figure 6-20. Configuration | Managed Switch page ............................................................................... 637


Figure 6-21. Configuration | WAN | QoS Pages ..................................................................................... 640
Figure 6-22. Configuration | WAN | QoS page (DiffServ Mode) ............................................................ 644
Figure 6-23. Configuration | WAN | Compression page ........................................................................ 646
Figure 6-24. Configuration | WAN | Encryption page ............................................................................ 647
Figure 6-25. Configuration | Overhead page .......................................................................................... 649
Figure 6-26. Configuration | Utilities page ............................................................................................. 651
Figure 6-27. Configuration | D&I page (Selected Framing Mode = D&I) ................................................ 654
Figure 6-28. Configuration | BUC page ................................................................................................... 655
Figure 6-29. Configuration | LNB page ................................................................................................... 655
Figure 6-30. Configuration | ANT | PTP page ......................................................................................... 656
Figure 6-31. Configuration | ANT | SNTP page ....................................................................................... 658
Figure 6-32. Configuration | ANT | SNTP page ....................................................................................... 659
Figure 6-33. Status | Modem Status page .............................................................................................. 660
Figure 6-34. Status | Modem Logs | Base Modem page ........................................................................ 661
Figure 6-35. Status | Modem Logs | Packet Processor page .................................................................. 663
Figure 6-36. Status | Modem Info page .................................................................................................. 664
Figure 6-37. Status | Traffic Statistics | Ethernet page .......................................................................... 665
Figure 6-38. Status | Traffic Statistics | Router page.............................................................................. 666
Figure 6-39. Status | Traffic Statistics | Managed Switch page .............................................................. 667
Figure 6-40. Status | Traffic Statistics | WAN page ................................................................................ 668
Figure 6-41. Status | Traffic Statistics | Compression page ................................................................... 669
Figure 6-42. Status | Traffic Statistics | QoS page (DiffServ Mode) ....................................................... 670
Figure 6-43. Status | Traffic Statistics | PTP page................................................................................... 671
Figure 6-44. Status | Traffic Statistics | MAC Table page ....................................................................... 673
Figure 6-45. Status | Traffic Statistics | Clear Counters page ................................................................. 674
Figure 6-46. Status | Performance | Performance page ........................................................................ 675
Figure 6-47. Status | Performance | Graphs page.................................................................................. 676
Figure 6-48. ODU Page Examples (Enable, Config, Status, and Utilities) ................................................ 677
Figure 6-49. Redundancy page ............................................................................................................... 678
Figure 7-1. TPC & LDPC Modes Performance (Relative to Shannon Limit)............................................... 77
Figure 7-2. VersaFEC Codes versus Shannon Capacity ........................................................................... 712
Figure 7-3. Viterbi Decoding ................................................................................................................... 716
Figure 7-4. Viterbi with Concatenated R-S Outer Code .......................................................................... 717
Figure 7-5. 8-PSK/TCM Rate 2/3 with and without Concatenated RS Outer Code................................. 718
Figure 7-6. Rate 3/4, Rate 7/8 16-QAM with Concatenated RS Outer Code .......................................... 719
Figure 7-7. Sequential Decoding at 64 kbps ........................................................................................... 720
Figure 7-8. Sequential Decoding at 2048 kbps ....................................................................................... 721
Figure 7-9. Sequential Decoding at 512 kbps with RS 220,200 Outer Code ........................................... 722
Figure 7-10. Rate 5/16 BPSK Turbo Product Codec ................................................................................ 723
Figure 7-11. Rate 21/44 BPSK, QPSK, OQPSK Turbo Product Codec....................................................... 724
Figure 7-12. Rate 3/4 QPSK/OQPSK, 8-PSK/8-QAM and 16-QAM Turbo Product Codec ....................... 725
Figure 7-13. Rate 7/8 QPSK/OQPSK, 8-PSK/8-QAM and 16-QAM Turbo Product Codec ....................... 726
Figure 7-14. Rate 0.95 QPSK and Rate 0.95 8-PSK Turbo Product Codec ............................................... 727
Figure 7-15. Rate 1/2 BPSK, QPSK, OQPSK, LDPC Codec......................................................................... 728
Figure 7-16. Rate 2/3 QPSK, OQPSK, 8-PSK, 8-QAM LDPC Codec ........................................................... 729
Figure 7-17. Rate 3/4 QPSK, OQPSK, 8-PSK, 8-QAM, 16-QAM LDPC Codec ........................................... 730
Figure 7-18. VersaFEC Codec BPSK, Rate 0.488 ................................................................................... 731

xxiv

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Table of Contents MN-CDM625

Figure 7-19. VersaFEC Codec QPSK, Rate 0.533, 0.631, 0.706 and 0.803 ............................................ 732
Figure 7-20. VersaFEC Codec 8-QAM, Rate 0.642, 0.711, and 0.780 ................................................... 733
Figure 7-21. VersaFEC Codec 16-QAM, Rate 0.731, 0.780, 0.829 and 0.853....................................... 734
Figure 9-1. TX Clock Modes ....................................................................................................................... 93
Figure 9-2. RX Clock Modes ...................................................................................................................... 95
Figure 9-3. Supported T1 and E1 Framing Formats .................................................................................. 97
Figure 9-4. Drop and Insert Clocking......................................................................................................... 99
Figure 9-5. Single-Source Multiple Modems (Looming) ......................................................................... 910
Figure 9-6. Single-Source Multiple Modems (Daisy-chain) ..................................................................... 910
Figure 9-7. G.703 Clock Extension Mode 1 ............................................................................................. 913
Figure 9-8. G.703 Clock Extension Mode 2 ............................................................................................. 914
Figure 9-9. G.703 Clock Extension Mode 3 ............................................................................................. 915
Figure 10-1. Conceptual Block Diagram .................................................................................................. 103
Figure 10-2. Conventional FDMA Link .................................................................................................... 105
Figure 10-3. Same Link Using CDM-625 and DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier............................................ 106
Figure 10-4. Duplex Link Optimization.................................................................................................... 106
Figure 10-5. DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Signals ................................................................................. 108
Figure 10-6. Carrier-in-Carrier Signal Processing Block Diagram ............................................................ 108
Figure 16-1. CDM-625 Ethernet Architecture Design ............................................................................. 161
Figure 16-2. Improper Use of External Ethernet Switch with CDM-625 ................................................. 162
Figure 16-3. Ethernet Networking Loop Example (Simplified) ............................................................... 162
Figure 16-4. Networking Loop Example .................................................................................................. 163
Figure 16-5. Hub-to-Hub with Standard Traffic using Routers ............................................................... 164
Figure 16-6. Hub-to-Remotes with Standard Traffic using Routers or Switches .................................... 165
Figure 16-7. Point-to-Point Configuration in Router Multipoint Hub Working Mode ........................ 166
Figure 16-8. Point-to-Multipoint using Routers ...................................................................................... 167
Figure 16-9. Point-to-Multipoint using Switches .................................................................................... 168
Figure 16-10. Point-to-Multipoint (Router Multipoint Hub Mode) ........................................................ 169
Figure 16-11. Multicast Routing Diagram ............................................................................................. 1611
Figure 16-12. Configuration Example for a Multicast Routing Network............................................... 1612
Figure 16-13. Configuration Example Point-to-Point Network with PTP ........................................... 1616
Figure 16-14. PTP Master/Slave Assignment Example ......................................................................... 1617
Figure 17-1. ACM-over-Satellite Generic Example............................................................................... 174
Figure 17-2. VersaFEC Codes vs. Constrained Capacity .......................................................................... 177
Figure 17-3. CDM-625 ACM ModCod Switch Points .......................................................................... 1710
Figure 17-4. CDM-625 ACM Congestion Control ............................................................................... 1712
Figure 20-1. IEEE 802.1q VLAN priority ................................................................................................... 206
Figure A-1. EIA-530 to RS-422/449 DCE Conversion Cable (CEFD P/N CA/WR0049) ............................... A-2
Figure A-2. EIA-530 to V.35 DCE Conversion Cable .................................................................................. A-3
Figure A-3. RS-232 Remote Control Cable (CDM-625 Remote Control Port to PC 9-Pin Serial Port) ....... A-4
Figure C-1. CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface ADMIN | FAST page ............................................ C4
Figure F-1. CDM-625 Front Panel Features ............................................................................................... F3
Figure F-2.CDM-625 Front Panel ODU Operation Menu Tree (FW Ver. 2.3.1) ...................................... F4
Figure F-3. CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface Home Page ............................................................. F36
Figure F-4. CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface Menu Tree (FW Ver. 2.3.1) .................................... F37
Figure F-5. Configuration | BUC page ..................................................................................................... F38
Figure F-6. Configuration | LNB page ..................................................................................................... F39
Figure F-7. Status | Modem Logs | Base Modem page .......................................................................... F40

xxv

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Table of Contents MN-CDM625

Figure F-8. ODU | Enable page ............................................................................................................... F43


Figure F-9. ODU | Config page (CSAT-5060) ........................................................................................... F44
Figure F-10. ODU | Config page (KST-2000A/B)...................................................................................... F47
Figure F-11. ODU | Status page (CSAT-5060) ......................................................................................... F49
Figure F-12. ODU | Status page (KST-2000A/B) ...................................................................................... F50
Figure F-13. ODU | Utilities page (CSAT-5060) ....................................................................................... F51
Figure F-14. ODU | Utilities page (KST-2000A/B) ................................................................................... F53
Figure F-15. CDM-625 Telnet Command Line Interface (CLI) ................................................................. F54

xxvi

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


PREFACE
About this Manual
This manual provides installation and operation information for the Comtech EF Data CDM-625
Advanced Satellite Modem. This is a document intended for the persons responsible for the
operation and maintenance of the CDM-625.

Reporting Comments or Suggestions Concerning this Manual


Comtech EF Data welcomes comments and suggestions regarding the content and design of this
manual. Contact the Comtech EF Data Technical Publications Department:

TechnicalPublications@comtechefdata.com

Conventions and References

Patents and Trademarks


See all of Comtech EF Data's Patents and Patents Pending at http://patents.comtechefdata.com.
Comtech EF Data acknowledges that all trademarks are the property of the trademark owners.

DoubleTalk is licensed from Raytheon Applied Signal Technology.

DoubleTalk is a registered trademark of Raytheon Applied Signal Technology.

Carrier-in-Carrier is a registered trademark of Comtech EF Data.

Warnings, Cautions, and Notes

A WARNING gives information about a possible hazard that MAY CAUSE DEATH or
SERIOUS INJURY.

A CAUTION gives information about a possible hazard that MAY CAUSE INJURY or
PROPERTY DAMAGE.

xxvii

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Preface MN-CDM625

A NOTE gives important information about a task or the equipment.

A REFERENCE directs the user to additional information about a task or the


equipment.

Recommended Standard Designations


The new designation of the Electronic Industries Association (EIA) supersedes the Recommended
Standard (RS) designations. References to the old designations may be shown when depicting
actual text (e.g., RS-232) displayed on the Front Panel menus, Web Server pages, serial remote
interface, Telnet Command Line Interface (CLI), or unit rear panel. All other references in the
manual refer to EIA designations.

Metric Conversion
Metric conversion information is located on the inside back cover of this manual. This information
is provided to assist the operator in cross-referencing non-metric to metric conversions.

The user should carefully review the following information.

Safety and Compliance

Electrical Safety and Compliance


The unit complies with the EN 60950 Safety of Information Technology Equipment (Including
Electrical Business Machines) safety standard.

If the unit is operated in a vehicle or movable installation, make sure the unit is
stable. Otherwise, EN 60950 safety is not guaranteed.

Sect. 3.3 CDM-625 Ground and Power connections

Grounding
PROPER GROUNDING PROTECTION IS REQUIRED: The installation instructions
require that the integrity of the protective earth must be ensured and that the
equipment shall be connected to the protective earth connection at all times.

The CDM-625 is designed for connection to a power system that has separate

xxviii

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Preface MN-CDM625

ground, line and neutral conductors. The equipment is not designed for connection
to a power system that has no direct connection to ground. It is therefore
imperative during installation, configuration, and operation for the user to ensure
that the unit has been properly grounded using the ground stud provided on the
rear panel of the unit.

In Finland: "Laite on liitettv suojamaadoituskoskettimilla varustettuun


pistorasiaan."

In Norway: Apparatet m tilkoples jordet stikkontakt.

In Sweden: Apparaten skall anslutas till jordat uttag.

Electrical Installation
The unit is rated for a nominal operating range of 100-240 volts AC; for the appropriately
equipped DC option, nominal operating range is 43-60 volts DC. The unit has a maximum power
consumption of 300 watts.

The installation and connection to the line supply must be made in compliance to local or
national wiring codes and regulations.

The CDM-625 is shipped with a line inlet cable suitable for use in the country of operation. If it is
necessary to replace this cable, ensure the replacement has an equivalent specification.

Examples of acceptable ratings for the cable include HAR, BASEC and HOXXX-X.

Examples of acceptable connector ratings include VDE, NF-USE, UL, CSA, OVE, CEBEC, NEMKO,
DEMKO, BS1636A, BSI, SETI, IMQ, KEMA-KEUR and SEV.

Battery
THE MODEM CONTAINS A LITHIUM BATTERY. DANGER OF EXPLOSION EXISTS IF THE
BATTERY IS INCORRECTLY REPLACED. REPLACE ONLY WITH THE SAME OR EQUIVALENT
TYPE RECOMMENDED BY THE MANUFACTURER. DISPOSE OF USED BATTERIES IN
ACCORDANCE WITH LOCAL AND NATIONAL REGULATIONS.

Fuses

FOR CONTINUED OPERATOR SAFETY, ALWAYS REPLACE THE FUSES WITH THE CORRECT
TYPE AND RATING.

The CDM-625 is fitted with two fuses:

xxix

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Preface MN-CDM625

For AC operation, the unit requires two common 4 Amp/250 volts 20mm x 5mm Slow-
blow fuses that are contained within a fuse holder that is press-fit into the body of the
IEC power inlet module (on the rear panel of the unit).

For DC operation, the unit requires two different fuses that are contained within the
individual screw-in receptacles below the terminal block (on the rear panel of the unit).

These DC fuse requirements are as follows:

o Modem Operation 3 Amp/250 volts 20mm x 5mm Slow-blow fuse.

o BUC Operation 6.3 Amp/250 volts 20mm x 5mm Slow-blow fuse.

Operating Environment
DO NOT OPERATE THE UNIT IN ANY OF THESE EXTREME OPERATING
CONDITIONS:

AMBIENT TEMPERATURES LESS THAN 0C (32F) OR MORE THAN 50C


(122F). (MAXIMUM STORAGE TEMPERATURE ALLOWED IS -25C
(-13F) TO 85C (185F)).

PRECIPITATION, CONDENSATION, OR HUMID ATMOSPHERES OF MORE


THAN 95% RELATIVE HUMIDITY.

UNPRESSURIZED ALTITUDES OF MORE THAN 2000 METRES (6561.7


FEET).

EXCESSIVE DUST.

FLAMMABLE GASES.

CORROSIVE OR EXPLOSIVE ATMOSPHERES.

European Union Radio Equipment and Telecommunications Terminal


Equipment (R&TTE) Directive (1999/5/EC) and EN 301 489-1
Independent testing verifies that the unit complies with the European Union R&TTE Directive, its
reference to EN 301 489-1 (Electromagnetic compatibility and Radio spectrum Matters [ERM];
ElectroMagnetic Compatibility [EMC] standard for radio equipment and services, Part 1:
Common technical requirements), and the Declarations of Conformity for the applicable
directives, standards, and practices that follow:

European Union Electromagnetic Compatibility (EMC) Directive


(2004/108/EC)
Emissions: EN 55022 Class B Limits and Methods of Measurement of Radio
Interference Characteristics of Information Technology Equipment.

xxx

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Preface MN-CDM625

Immunity: EN 55024 Information Technology Equipment: Immunity Characteristics,


Limits, and Methods of Measurement.

EN 61000-3-2 Harmonic Currents Emission

EN 61000-3-3 Voltage Fluctuations and Flicker.

Federal Communications Commission Federal Code of Regulation FCC Part 15, Subpart
B.

TO ENSURE THAT THE UNIT COMPLIES WITH THESE STANDARDS, OBEY THESE
INSTRUCTIONS:

Use coaxial cable that is of good quality (e.g., RG58/U (50) or RG59/U (75)) for
connections to the IF Tx and Rx (transmit and receive) BNC female connectors.

Use Type 'D' connectors that have back-shells with continuous metallic shielding.

Type D cabling must have a continuous outer shield (either foil or braid, or both). The
shield must be bonded to the back-shell.

Operate the unit with its cover on at all times.

European Union Low Voltage Directive (LVD) (2006/95/EC)

Symbol Description
<HAR> Type of power cord required for use in the European Community.

CAUTION: Double-pole/Neutral Fusing


! ACHTUNG: Zweipolige bzw. Neutralleiter-Sicherung

International Symbols
Symbol Definition Symbol Definition
Alternating Current Protective Earth
Fuse Chassis Ground

For additional symbols, refer to Warnings, Cautions and Notes listed earlier in this
Preface.

xxxi

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Preface MN-CDM625

European Union RoHS Directive (2002/95/EC)


This unit satisfies (with exemptions) the requirements specified in the European Union Directive
on the Restriction of Hazardous Substances in Electrical and Electronic Equipment (EU RoHS,
Directive 2002/95/EC).

E uropean Union T elec ommunic ations T erminal E quipment Direc tive


(91/263/E E C )
In accordance with the European Union Telecommunications Terminal Equipment Directive
91/263/EEC, do not directly connect the unit to the Public Telecommunications Network.

CE Mark
Comtech EF Data declares that the unit meets the necessary requirements for the CE Mark.

Warranty Policy
Comtech EF Data products are warranted against defects in material and workmanship
for a specific period from the date of shipment, and this period varies by product. In
most cases, the warranty period is two years. During the warranty period, Comtech EF
Data will, at its option, repair or replace products that prove to be defective. Repairs are
warranted for the remainder of the original warranty or a 90 day extended warranty,
whichever is longer. Contact Comtech EF Data for the warranty period specific to the
product purchased.

For equipment under warranty, the owner is responsible for freight to Comtech EF Data
and all related customs, taxes, tariffs, insurance, etc. Comtech EF Data is responsible for
the freight charges only for return of the equipment from the factory to the owner.
Comtech EF Data will return the equipment by the same method (i.e., Air, Express,
Surface) as the equipment was sent to Comtech EF Data.

All equipment returned for warranty repair must have a valid RMA number issued prior
to return and be marked clearly on the return packaging. Comtech EF Data strongly
recommends all equipment be returned in its original packaging.

Comtech EF Data Corporations obligations under this warranty are limited to repair or
replacement of failed parts, and the return shipment to the buyer of the repaired or
replaced parts.

Limitations of Warranty
The warranty does not apply to any part of a product that has been installed, altered,
repaired, or misused in any way that, in the opinion of Comtech EF Data Corporation,

xxxii

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Preface MN-CDM625

would affect the reliability or detracts from the performance of any part of the product,
or is damaged as the result of use in a way or with equipment that had not been
previously approved by Comtech EF Data Corporation.

The warranty does not apply to any product or parts thereof where the serial number or
the serial number of any of its parts has been altered, defaced, or removed.

The warranty does not cover damage or loss incurred in transportation of the product.

The warranty does not cover replacement or repair necessitated by loss or damage from
any cause beyond the control of Comtech EF Data Corporation, such as lightning or
other natural and weather related events or wartime environments.

The warranty does not cover any labor involved in the removal and or reinstallation of
warranted equipment or parts on site, or any labor required to diagnose the necessity
for repair or replacement.

The warranty excludes any responsibility by Comtech EF Data Corporation for incidental
or consequential damages arising from the use of the equipment or products, or for any
inability to use them either separate from or in combination with any other equipment
or products.

A fixed charge established for each product will be imposed for all equipment returned
for warranty repair where Comtech EF Data Corporation cannot identify the cause of the
reported failure.

Exclusive Remedies
Comtech EF Data Corporations warranty, as stated is in lieu of all other warranties,
expressed, implied, or statutory, including those of merchantability and fitness for a
particular purpose. The buyer shall pass on to any purchaser, lessee, or other user of
Comtech EF Data Corporations products, the aforementioned warranty, and shall
indemnify and hold harmless Comtech EF Data Corporation from any claims or liability
of such purchaser, lessee, or user based upon allegations that the buyer, its agents, or
employees have made additional warranties or representations as to product
preference or use.

The remedies provided herein are the buyers sole and exclusive remedies. Comtech EF
Data shall not be liable for any direct, indirect, special, incidental, or consequential
damages, whether based on contract, tort, or any other legal theory.

xxxiii

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Preface MN-CDM625

Getting Help

Review the Warranty Policy before contacting Comtech EF Data Technical Support or
Customer Service.

Contacting Comtech EF Data


Contact Comtech EF Data for:

Technical Support Product support or training.

Customer Service Information on returning an in-warranty or out-of-warranty product for


upgrade or repair. Be prepared to provide the product model number and its serial
number.

Contact Comtech EF Data Customer & Technical Support during normal business hours (Monday
through Friday, 8 A.M. to 5 P.M Mountain Standard Time (MST)):

For: Contact:

CDM-625 Telephone +1.480.333.4357


Technical
Email cdmipsupport@comtechefdata.com
Support and
Service Fax +1.480.333.2500

Main Page http://www.comtechefdata.com


Customer and
Comtech EF Technical http://www.comtechefdata.com/support.asp
Data Web Site Support
RMA
(Return Material http://www.comtechefdata.com/rmaform.asp
Authorization)
Comtech EF Data Main Number +1.480.333.2200
2114 West 7th Street
Mailing Address
Tempe, Arizona 85281 USA

xxxiv

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Preface MN-CDM625

Returning a Product for Upgrade or Repair

Step Task

Go to the Comtech EF Data Home page (http://www.comtechefdata.com). From the


1 SUPPORT column at the bottom of the page, select the Service hyperlink, and read
the Return Material Authorization section in its entirety.
2 Request a Return Material Authorization Number:

On the Comtech EF Data Home page: From the SUPPORT column at the bottom
of the page, select the RMA Request hyperlink;

OR

On the Comtech EF Data Support page: Click [Send RMA Request];

OR

On the Comtech EF Data Service page: Select the Return Material Authorizaion
hyperlink;

Fill out the RMA form completely;

Click [Send Email].

Alternately:

Send an e-mail providing this same detailed information to Comtech EF Data


Customer Service (service@comtechefdata.com).

Contact Comtech EF Data Customer & Technical Support by phone or fax.

3 Pack the product in its original shipping carton and protective packaging.

4 Ship the product back to Comtech EF Data. Shipping charges should be prepaid.

xxxv

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Preface MN-CDM625

Notes:

xxxvi

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


Chapter 1. INTRODUCTION
1.1 Overview

Figure 1-1. CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem

The CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem (Figure 1-1) is intended for both closed network and
legacy Intelsat applications. The CDM-625 is a replacement for the CDM-600 and CDM-600L
Open Network Satellite Modems, and it includes many new or enhanced features:

It is compact 1RU high and 17.6 inches deep and consumes only 48 watts (typical).

It features front panel LED Indicators, a keypad, and a Vacuum Fluorescent Display (VFD)
for local configuration and monitoring and control (M&C). It also can be fully remote-
controlled through its serial remote control or Ethernet-based Web Server (HTTP) and
Telnet Command Line interfaces.

It provides a full range of built-in (i.e., no plug-in cards required) traffic data interface
types, including all G.703 types, Quad E1 Drop and Insert, HSSI, and ASI.

Its IF frequency range simultaneously covers 50-180 MHz and 950-2000 MHz.

It offers variable data rates, from 18 kbps to 25 Mbps, in BPSK, QPSK, Offset QPSK
(OQPSK), 8PSK, 8-QAM and 16-QAM modes. Viterbi, Sequential, concatenated Reed-
Solomon (RS), Trellis Coded Modulation (TCM), Turbo Product Coding (TPC), Low-density
Parity Check Coding (LDPC), and VersaFEC (short-block, low latency LDPC) are provided
as Forward Error Correction (FEC) options.

It is compliant with IESS-308/309/310/315 specifications, but also adds other significant


features in closed network modes.

Its demod design incorporates fast acquisition, improved composite power handling,
and an integrated adaptive equalizer.

11

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Introduction MN-CDM625

It includes VersaFEC Adaptive Coding and Modulation to increase capacity on IP links.

It can be equipped with a DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier option card that can save up to
50% transponder bandwidth.

It can be equipped with an optional IP Packet Processor card that, in addition to providing
Layer 3 functionality, incorporates a number of key features for Wide Area Network
(WAN) bandwidth optimization: very low overhead Streamline Encapsulation (SLE),
Header and Payload Compression, Advanced Quality of Service (QoS), and Advanced
Encryption Standard (AES) Encryption.

IEEE-1588v2 Precision Timing Protocol (PTP) and Jumbo Frame Support are available
options (either requires the CDM-625 Rev 2 Hardware configuration).

Carrier ID is a patent pending carrier identification (CID) technique that uses MetaCarrier
spread spectrum technology to embed a unique carrier identification sequence for the
transmitted carrier.

1.2 Functional Description


The CDM-625 has two fundamentally different types of interface - IF and data:

The IF interface provides a bidirectional link with the satellite via the uplink and
downlink equipment.

The data interface is a bidirectional path that connects with the customers equipment
(assumed to be the DTE) and the modem (assumed to be the DCE).

Transmit data is received by the terrestrial interface where line receivers convert the clock and
data signals to CMOS levels for further processing. A small FIFO follows the terrestrial interface
to facilitate the various clocking and framing options. If framing is enabled, the transmit clock
and data output from the FIFO pass through the framer, where the overhead data (IDR, IBS, D&I
or EDMAC) is added to the main data; otherwise, the clock and data are passed directly to the
Forward Error Correction encoder.

In the FEC encoder, the data is differentially encoded, scrambled, and then convolutionally or
block encoded. Following the encoder, the data is fed to the transmit digital filters, which
perform spectral shaping on the data signals. The resultant I and Q signals are then fed to the
BPSK, QPSK/OQPSK, 8PSK, 8-QAM, or 16-QAM modulator.

The carrier is generated by a frequency synthesizer, and the I and Q signals directly modulate
this carrier. For L-Band applications, the directly modulated signal comprises the main output.
For IF applications (50180 MHz), the L-Band signal is mixed down and filtered to produce the
desired output. The Rx-IF signal at L-Band is processed by a dual IF superheterodyne receiver.

12

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Introduction MN-CDM625

For IF applications (50180 MHz), the signal is first mixed up to the first IF frequency. The
second conversion is a complex mix, resulting in the signal once more being split into an in-
phase (I) and a quadrature (Q) component, producing an output at near-zero frequency.
An AGC circuit maintains the desired signal level constant over a broad range. Following this, the
I and Q signals are sampled by high-speed (flash) A/D converters. All processing beyond this
conversion is purely digital, performing the functions of Nyquist filtering, carrier recovery, and
symbol timing recovery. The resultant demodulated signal is fed, in soft decision form, to the
selected FEC decoder, which can be Viterbi, Sequential, TCM, Reed-Solomon, TPC, LDPC or
VersaFEC (if installed).

After decoding, the recovered clock and data pass to the de-framer (if IBS, IDR, D&I or EDMAC
framing is enabled), where the overhead information is removed. Following this, the data passes
to the Plesiochronous/Doppler buffer, which has a programmable size, or may be bypassed.
From here, the receive clock and data signals are routed to the terrestrial interface, and are
passed to the externally connected DTE equipment.

1.3 Features

1.3.1 Physical Description


The CDM-625 is constructed as a 1RU-high rack-mounting chassis, which can be free-standing if
desired. Handles at the front ease placement into and removal from a rack.

The CDM-625 modem chassis assembly (CEFD P/N PL/12587-1 Standard AC Chassis or CEFD P/N
PL/12587-2 Optional DC Chassis) is physically comprised of two main card assemblies:

Baseband Framing Card (CEFD P/N PL/11963-1). This first card includes all of the
interface circuits, the framer/de-framer, plesiochronous/Doppler buffer, Reed Solomon
outer codec, HDLC framer, Ethernet switch, and the main microcontroller.

Modem Card (CEFD P/N PL/12575-1). This second card is the modem itself. It performs
all signal processing functions of modulation, demodulation, and primary Forward Error
Correction.

1.3.2 Modem Compatibility


The CDM-625 is fully backwards-compatible with the Comtech EF Data CDM-500, CDM-550, and
CDM-550T modems. As an Open Network Modem, the CDM-625 is fully compatible with
modems from other manufacturers that are compliant with the IESS-308/309/310/314
specifications. Note, however, that IESS-315 (VSAT Turbo) defines closed network operation,
and this therefore requires modems from the same manufacturer at both ends of the link.

The unit is also fully backwards-compatible with the CDM-600 and CDM-600L modems (with the
exception of a lower data rate range of 18 kbps). The modem includes software emulation of
CDM-600 and CDM-600L.

13

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Introduction MN-CDM625

1.3.3 Ethernet/IP Interface Compatibility

HDLC Encapsulation
Compatible CEFD
Compatible Compatible CEFD IP Modem
CDM-625 Configuration IP Modem
CEFD IP Modem Configuration
Firmware
Standard 4-port Ethernet Data CDM-570/570L must have Layer
CDM-570/570L IP
Interface without optional IP CDM-570/570L 2 (L2) Tx and Rx Header
Firmware Versions
Packet Processor Managed with IP Module Compression disabled
1.5.4 to 1.6.X
Switch Mode* Managed Switch Mode*
Standard 4-port Ethernet Data CDD-562L/564 must have Layer
CDD-562L/564 IP
Interface without optional IP CDD-562L/564 2 (L2) Tx and Rx Header
Firmware Versions
Packet Processor Managed IP Demodulator Compression disabled
1.5.4 to 1.6.X
Switch Mode* Managed Switch Mode*

Streamline Encapsulation
Compatible Compatible CEFD IP Compatible CEFD IP
CDM-625 Configuration
CEFD IP Modem Modem Firmware Modem Configuration
CDM-570/570L IP
Optional IP Packet Processor CDM-570/570L
Firmware Version 1.7.0 or Managed Switch Mode*
Managed Switch Mode* with IP Module
later
Optional IP Packet Processor CDD-562L/564 CDD-562L/564 IP Firmware
Managed Switch Mode*
Managed Switch Mode* IP Demodulator Version 1.7.0 or later
CDM-570/570L IP
Optional IP Packet Processor CDM-570/570L
Firmware Version 1.7.0 or Router Mode
Router Mode with IP Module
later
Optional IP Packet Processor CDD-562L/564 CDD-562L/564 IP Firmware
Router Mode
Router Mode IP Demodulator Version 1.7.0 or later
*Note: Managed Switch Mode is also known as Ethernet Bridge Mode.

1.3.4 Verification
The CDM-625 includes many test modes and loopbacks for rapid verification of the correct
functioning of the unit. Of particular note is the IF loopback, which permits you to perform a
quick diagnostic test without having to disturb external cabling. During the loopback, all of the
receive configuration parameters are temporarily changed to match those of the transmit side,
and an internal RF switch connects the modulator output to the demodulator input. When
normal operation is again selected, all of the previous values are restored.

1.3.5 Updating Modem Firmware

Chapter 4. UPDATING FIRMWARE

The CDM-625 stores its firmware internally in flash memory, which simplifies the firmware
updating process without having to open the modem. Firmware downloads are available via the

14

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Introduction MN-CDM625

Internet from Comtech EF Datas Web site, via e-mail, or on CD, and can be transferred from an
external client PC once connectivity has been established with the modem.

1.3.6 Standard Data Interfaces

Chapter 3. REAR PANEL CONNECTORS AND PINOUTS

The CDM-625 includes a universal data interface that eliminates the need to exchange interface
cards for different applications. The interfaces offered, as standard, include:

RS-422 (EIA530) DCE (at rates up to 14 Mbps)

X.21 DTE and DCE (at rates up to 2.048 Mbps)

V.35 DCE (at rates up to 14 Mbps)

G.703 E1, balanced and unbalanced

G.703 T1, balanced

G.703 E2, unbalanced

G.703 T2, balanced and unbalanced

Quad E1 Drop and Insert (QDI) up to 4 balanced E1ports

Serial LVDS (at rates up to 25 Mbps)

HSSI (at rates up to 25 Mbps)

ASI

Four-port Ethernet 10/100 BaseT switch for IP bridging and routing

Dual Audio, 600 (produces a single 64 kbps data stream with either IBS or EDMAC
framing)

1.3.7 Optional Hardware and Accessories


Table 1-1 identifies the available hardware options and accessories that can be factory-installed
at the time of ordering, or user-installed in the field. Refer to the chapter section in this manual
for further information or details. Contact your Comtech EF Data sales representative during
normal business hours to purchase any of these products.

15

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Introduction MN-CDM625

Table 1-1. CDM-625 Optional Hardware and Accessories


Feature CEFD P/N Description Chapter
Combination Low-density Parity Check / TPC Codec daughter card providing
LDPC/TPC KT-0000093 7.7
data rates up to 25 Mbps and a full range of code rates/modulation
VersaFEC VersaFEC Codec daughter card providing data rates up to 16 Mbps, 12
KT-0000092 7.8
Codec combinations of modulation and code rate (ModCod)
CnC KT-0000094 DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier daughter card 10.7
KT-0000176 IP Packet Processor daughter card with Fan
IP Packet
KT-0000174 IP Packet Processor Kit for AC units (includes 175W Power Supply) 18.1.1
Processor
KT-0000175 IP Packet Processor Kit for DC units (includes 125W Power Supply).
Rack KT/6228-2 Rear Rack-Mount Kit 4 Bracket
2.2.1
Installation KT/6228-3 Rear Rack-Mount Kit 10 Bracket
PL-0000307 CiC-60 (HSSI) Interface Adapter Module 3.2.2.1.1
Quad E1 Adapter Y-Cable (for 2 E1 Ports: D-Type 9-pin Male to 2X D-Type 15-
CA-0000163 3.2.2.2.3.1
pin Female)
Data CA-0000164 Quad E1 Adapter Y-Cable (for 2 E1 Ports: D-Type-9-pin Male to 2X RJ-48) 3.2.2.2.3.2
Interface KT-0000122 Quad E1 Balanced/Unbalanced Adapter Kit, 6
3.2.2.2.3.3
KT-0020570 Quad E1 Balanced/Unbalanced Adapter Kit, 3 Ft
Adapter Cable: 25-pin D-Type Male to 37-pin D-Type Female, 8 (RTS/CTS
CA/WR12685-1 N/A
Control)
KT-0020703 AC to 24V DC Conversion Kit
KT-0000226 AC to 48V DC Conversion Kit
AC Primary Power Supply: 100-240 VAC (65W Power Supply) w/required
KT-0000283
cables
AC Primary Power Supply: 100-240 VAC (175W Power Supply) w/required
KT-0020701
cables
PS-0000075 AC 65W Power Supply
AC Power PS-0000065 AC 175W Power Supply 3.3.2
CA/17725 AC Power Cord, Standard (IEC-60320 Type C13) USA
CA/90025-5FT AC Power Jumper Cord, Standard (IEC-60320 Type C13)
KT/11633-1 AC Power Cord Retainer Kit (for any AC Cord)
CA/17850 AC Power Cord European / French
PP-0000097 AC Power Cord Japanese
PP-0020556 AC Power Cord India
PL/12587-2 Modem Chassis DC
KT-0020683 DC to AC Conversion Kit for CDM-625 Base Modem
KT-0020680 DC to AC Conversion Kit for CDM-625 with IP Packet Processor
KT-0000282 DC Primary Power Supply: -48 VDC, w/required cables
PS-0000066 DC 48V 125W Power Supply
DC Power PS-0020545 DC 24V 120W Power Supply 3.3.3
CA-0000455 DC Pigtail Adapter
KT/9640-3 BUC Power Supply: 24 VDC 90W (50 C) (100-240 VAC Input)
KT-0000029 BUC Power Supply: 48 VDC 150W (50 C) (100-240 VAC Input)
KT-0000185 BUC Power Supply: 24 VDC 90W (50 C) (-48 VDC Input)
KT-0000186 BUC Power Supply: 48 VDC 150W (50 C) (-48 VDC Input)

16

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Introduction MN-CDM625

1.3.8 Fully Accessible System Topology (FAST)

Appendix C. FAST Activation Procedure

The CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem incorporates a number of optional features. In order
to permit a lower initial cost, you may purchase the unit enabled with only the desired features.

If you wish to upgrade the functionality of a unit at a later date, Comtech EF Data provides Fully
Accessible System Topology (FAST), which permits the purchase and activation of options
through special authorization codes. You may purchase these unique, register-specific Fast
Access Codes from Comtech EF Data during normal business hours, and then load these codes
into the unit using either the front panel keypad or the CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface.
Contact a Comtech EF Data sales representative during normal business hours, or via e-mail to
sales@comtechefdata.com, to order the desired options.

FAST System Theory: FAST facilitates on-location upgrade of the operating feature set without
removing a unit from the setup. FAST technology allows you to order a unit precisely tailored for
the initial application. When your service requirements change, you can upgrade the topology of
the unit to meet these requirements within minutes. This accelerated upgrade can be
accomplished because of FASTs extensive use of the programmable logic devices incorporated
into Comtech EF Data products.

FAST Implementation: Comtech EF Datas FAST system is factory-implemented in the modem.


All FAST options are available through the basic platform unit at the time of order FAST allows
immediate activation of available options, after confirmation by Comtech EF Data, through the
CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface.

FAST Accessible Options: Hardware options can be ordered and installed either at the factory or
in the field (see Table 1-1 for hardware option details). Depending on the current hardware
configuration of the unit, you can select options that can be easily activated on-site. The FAST
Access Code that is purchased from Comtech EF Data enables configuration of the available
hardware.

Table 1-2 shows the FAST and FAST-accessible hardware options available for the CDM-625. The
base CDM-625 unit is equipped with Viterbi and Reed-Solomon codecs. It offers BPSK, QPSK, and
OQPSK modulation types, and data rates up to 5.0 Mbps, with all interface types. While it is
limited to Closed Network operation, it also includes EDMAC and AUPC.

17

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Introduction MN-CDM625

Table 1-2. CDM-625 FAST and FAST-accessible Hardware Options


Option Description and Comments Installation Method
IF band 50-180 MHz BASE UNIT
950-2000 MHz (L-Band) FAST
Forward Error Correction Viterbi, Sequential and concatenated Reed-Solomon BASE UNIT
LDPC/TPC Codec daughter card HARDWARE
VersaFEC Codec daughter card HARDWARE
Data Rate (base function) Data rate 18 kbps to 5.0 Mbps BASE UNIT
Data rate 18 kbps to 10.0 Mbps FAST
Data rate 18 kbps to 15.0 Mbps FAST
Data rate 18 kbps to 20.0 Mbps FAST
Data rate 18 kbps to 25.0 Mbps FAST
Data Rate (LDPC/TPC function) Data rate 18 kbps to 5.0 Mbps BASE UNIT
Data rate 18 kbps to 10.0 Mbps FAST
Data rate 18 kbps to 15.0 Mbps FAST
Data rate 18 kbps to 20.0 Mbps FAST
Data rate 18 kbps to 25.0 Mbps FAST
Modulation BPSK, QPSK, OQPSK BASE UNIT
8PSK and 8-QAM FAST
16-QAM FAST
Open Network All IDR/IBS Open Network features FAST
Drop and Insert T1/E1 D&I (single port) FAST
Quad E1 Drop and Insert FAST
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier daughter card HARDWARE
Data rate 18 kbps to 512 kbps FAST
Data rate 18 kbps to 1 Mbps FAST
Data rate 18 kbps to 2.5 Mbps FAST
Data rate 18 kbps to 5.0 Mbps FAST
Data rate 18 kbps to 10.0 Mbps FAST
Data rate 18 kbps to 15.0 Mbps FAST
Data rate 18 kbps to 20.0 Mbps FAST
Data rate 18 kbps to 25.0 Mbps FAST
VersaFEC Adaptive Coding and Symbol rate 37 ksps to 300 ksps HARDWARE / FAST
Modulation (ACM)
Symbol rate 37 ksps to 1200 ksps HARDWARE / FAST
Symbol rate 37 ksps to 4100 ksps HARDWARE / FAST

18

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Introduction MN-CDM625

Option Description and Comments Installation Method


G.703 Clock Extension G.703 Clock Extension FAST
IP Packet Card IP Packet Processor daughter card HARDWARE
Processor
Payload Data rate up to 5 Mbps or Symbol rate up to 1200 ksps (ACM) FAST
Compression
Data rate up to 10 Mbps or Symbol rate up to 4100 ksps (ACM) FAST
Data rate up to 15 Mbps or Symbol rate up to 4100 ksps (ACM) FAST
Data rate up to 20 Mbps or Symbol rate up to 4100 ksps (ACM) FAST
Data rate up to 25 Mbps or Symbol rate up to 4100 ksps (ACM) FAST
Header Data rate up to 5 Mbps or Symbol rate up to 1200 ksps (ACM) FAST
Compression
Data rate up to 10 Mbps or Symbol rate up to 4100 ksps (ACM) FAST
Data rate up to 15 Mbps or Symbol rate up to 4100 ksps (ACM) FAST
Data rate up to 20 Mbps or Symbol rate up to 4100 ksps (ACM) FAST
Data rate up to 25 Mbps or Symbol rate up to 4100 ksps (ACM) FAST
Advanced QoS Advanced QoS FAST
AES Encryption Tx Packet Encryption / Rx Packet Decryption FAST
REV 2 HARDWARE /
Advanced Network Timing (ANT) IEEE-1588v2 Precision Timing Protocol (PTP)
FAST
BUC Power Supplies 24V, 100W HARDWARE
48V, 150W @ 50 C (180W@ 35 C) HARDWARE
Main Power Supplies 100-240 VAC Nominal
HARDWARE
90-264 VAC Maximum
43-60 VDC Nominal
HARDWARE
36-60 VDC Maximum

19

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Introduction MN-CDM625

1.3.9 Supporting Hardware and Software


Redundancy Support: Comtech EF Data provides redundant operations support to the CDM-625
as follows:

For 1:1 redundancy applications, via its low-cost external CRS-170A L-Band and CRS-180
70/140 MHz IF 1:1 Redundancy Switches.

For M:N redundancy (hub) applications, via its external CRS-300 1:10 Redundancy
Switch or the CRS-500 M:N Redundancy System.

Transceiver Support: The CDM-625 is a companion product for Comtech EF Datas CSAT-5060
and KST-2000A/B RF Transceivers. The modem incorporates a Frequency Shift-keying (FSK) serial
link that can be activated on the Rx-IF port for the purpose of communicating with a transceiver,
if connected. In this manner, you may configure, monitor and control the transceiver using
either the CDM-625s front panel display and keypad or any of its remote control interfaces. The
EDMAC channel may also be used to convey M&C data to a transceiver at the distant end of a
satellite link, if it is connected to a CDM-625.

BUC Support: The CDM-625 incorporates an FSK serial link that can be activated on the Tx-IF
port for the purpose of communicating with an FSK-capable smart BUC. This link is designed to
be compatible with the Global VSAT Forum/ND SatCom specification. In this manner, you may
configure, monitor and control the BUC using either the CDM-625s front panel display and
keypad or any of its remote control interfaces.

Additionally, Comtech EF Data provides for an "Advanced FSK" for use with its LPOD BUCs, re-
using the existing FSK channel to pass additional "proprietary" commands to expand front panel
user control. The EDMAC channel can be used to convey M&C interface to a BUC at the distant
end of a satellite link, if it is connected to a CDM-625.

110

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Introduction MN-CDM625

1.3.10 Physical Features

1.3.10.1 Dimensional Envelope


All dimensions are in inches. Dimensions shown in parentheses are in metric units (mm).

Figure 1-2. CDM-625 Dimensional Envelope

111

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Introduction MN-CDM625

1.3.10.2 Front Panel

Chapter 5. FRONT PAN EL OPERATION

Feature Description Function Chapter


1 LED Indicators The LEDs indicate, in a summary fashion, the status of the modem. 5.1.1
The keypad comprises six individual keyswitches. The keys have a
positive click action that provides tactile feedback. Enter data via
2 Keypad 5.1.2
the k eypad. D ata, pr ompts, and m essages ar e di splayed on t he
VFD.
The V FD i s an ac tive di splay s howing t wo l ines of 40 characters
Vacuum
each. It produces a blue light with adjustable brightness. Nested
3 Fluorescent 5.1.3
menus display all available options and pr ompt you to carry out a
Display (VFD)
required action.

Figure 1-3. CDM-625 Front Panel Features

112

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Introduction MN-CDM625

1.3.10.3 Rear Panel

Chapter 3. REAR PANEL CONNECTORS AND PINOUTS

Figure 1-4. CDM-625 Rear Panel View


(Top) Standard AC Chassis (CEFD P/N PL/12587-1)
(Bottom) Optional 48V DC Chassis (CEFD P/N PL/12587-2)

Figure 1-4 shows the rear panel of the modem. External cables are attached to connectors on
the rear panel of the CDM-625. They comprise:

Connector Group
Name Connector Type Function
(Chapter)
BNC female (70/140MHz band)
Rx IF Input
IF Type N female (L-Band)
(Sect. 3.2.1) BNC female (70/140MHz band)
Tx IF Output
Type N female (L-Band)
Data Interface 25-pin Type D female Serial synchronous data input/output
Balanced G.703 9-pin Type D female G.703, D&I or D&I++; Quad E1 Ports 1 & 2
Auxiliary G.703 9-pin Type D female Quad E1 Ports 3 & 4
Unbalanced Out BNC female Receive G.703 (IDO); ASI
G.703
Data Unbalanced In BNC female Transmit G.703 (DDI); ASI
Terrestrial Data
(Sect. 3.2.2) IDI BNC female Insert Data In / Sub-rate Auxiliary Tx G.703 In
Drop Data Output / Sub-rate Auxiliary Rx
DDO BNC female
G.703 Out
10/100 Ethernet (4X) RJ-45 female 10/100 BaseT management and data
IDR Data/Alarms/Audio 44-pin High Density Type D female Intelsat Open Network auxiliary signals
ESC 9-pin Type D female ESC input/output (RS232/485)
Remote Control 9-pin Type D male Serial Remote Interface (RS232/485)
Alarms 15-pin Type D male Form C Alarms (relay closures)
Utility
PMSI 9-pin Type D female Pre-Mapped Symbol Interface (CnC)
(Sect. 3.2.3
1:1 Control 9-pin Type D female Connection to External 1:1 Controller
External Reference BNC female Input/output
Ground #10-32 stud See Sect. 3.3.1 Common Chassis Ground
Ground / Power
AC Power (Standard) See Sect. 3.3.2 Chassis power
(Sect 3.3)
DC Power (Optional) See Sect. 3.3.3 Chassis power

The European EMC Directive 2004/108/EEC (EN 55022, EN 50024) requires using
properly shielded cables for DATA I/O. These cables must be double-shielded from
end-to-end, ensuring a continuous ground shield.

113

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Introduction MN-CDM625

1.4 Summary of Specifications


1.4.1 Modulator
Modulation BPSK, QPSK, OQPSK, 8PSK, 8-QAM and 16-QAM
Symbol rate range 18 ksps to 12.5 Msps
Data rate range 18 kbps - 25 Mbps. See Section 1.4.7
Operating frequency 50 - 180 MHz (BNC connector) AND 950 - 2000 MHz (Type N connector), 100 Hz resolution
Note: Firmware Ver. 1.4.1 and later increases L-Band range to 950 - 2000 MHz.
Stability 0.06 ppm (6 x 10-8) 0 to 50oC (32 to 122oF), when using internal reference
Operating modes Open Network, per Intelsat IESS-308/309/310/314 (IDR, IBS/SMS)
E1/T1 Drop and Insert
Transparent, Closed Network, IESS-315 (VSAT Turbo)
Proprietary EDMAC framed mode:
* 5% overhead EDMAC (data rates < 2.048 Mbps all modes except BPSK Turbo, Rate 21/44 QPSK Turbo)
* 1.6% overhead - EDMAC-2 (rates >2.048 Mbps and all Rate 21/44, 5/16 Turbo)
* EDMAC-3 for SNMP Proxy same as EDMAC
R-S Outer Codec
Turbo Product Codec - 2nd Generation (optional plug-in module)
LDPC Codec (optional plug-in module - includes all 2nd Generation TPC modes
VersaFEC Codec (optional plug-in module short-block, low latency and ultra-low-latency LDPC)
VersaFEC Adaptive Coding and Modulation IP interface only maximum symbol rate = 4100 ksps
Automatic Uplink Power Control (AUPC) mode
High Rate ESC, Enhanced ESC (ESC++)
Enhanced Drop & Insert (D&I++)
Quad E1 Drop & Insert (QDI) - concatenates time slots from up to four E1 G.703 streams, Framed QDI
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier mode (optional plug-in module)
FEC None: Uncoded BPSK/QPSK/OQPSK
Viterbi: k=7, per IESS-308/309
BPSK: Rate 1/2
QPSK/OQPSK: Rate 1/2, Rate 3/4 and Rate 7/8
16-QAM: Rate 3/4 and Rate 7/8 (Viterbi plus Reed-Solomon only)
Sequential:
BPSK: Rate 1/2
QPSK/OQPSK: Rate 1/2, Rate 3/4 and Rate 7/8
Reed-Solomon (Open Network):
IDR modes:
225/205 for T1
219/201 for E1 and IESS-310 mode,
194/178 for T2 and E2
IBS modes:
126/112 and 219/201 for IESS-310 mode
Reed-Solomon (Closed Network):
220,200 outer code (transparent mode)
225,205 outer code (transparent mode, EF Data compatible, V.35 scrambling)
126,112 outer code (transparent mode, IBS parameters, D&I++ mode)
219,201 outer code (transparent mode, IESS-310 parameters)
200,180 outer code (EDMAC modes)
Interleaver depth = 4 or 8 (depending on mode)
8PSK/TCM Rate 2/3 (Trellis): Per IESS-310
Turbo Product Codec, 2nd Generation (Optional plug-in card, includes LDPC modes):
Rate 5/16 (2 dimensional) and Rate 21/44 (3-dimensional) BPSK
Rate 21/44 QPSK/OQPSK (aka 1/2) - 3 dimensional
Rate 3/4 QPSK/OQPSK/8PSK/8-QAM/16-QAM - 2 dimensional
Rate 7/8 QPSK/OQPSK/8PSK/8-QAM/16-QAM - 2 dimensional
Rate 0.95 QPSK/OQPSK/8PSK/8-QAM/- 2 dimensional TPC (exact Code Rate is actually 17/18, or 0.944)
Low Density Parity Check (LDPC) Codec (Optional plug-in card):
Rate 1/2 BPSK/QPSK/OQPSK
Rate 2/3 QPSK/OQPSK/8PSK/8-QAM
Rate 3/4 QPSK/OQPSK/8PSK/8-QAM/16-QAM
VersaFEC Codec (Optional plug-in card short-block, low latency LDPC):
Rate 0.488 BPSK (also 0.493 BPSK Ultra-Low-Latency - requires Firmware 1.5.4 or higher)
Rate 0.533, 0.631, 0.706, 0.803 QPSK (0.493, 0.654, 0.734 Ultra-Low-Latency - requires Firmware 1.5.4 or higher)
Rate 0.642, 0.711, 0.780 8-QAM (also 0.576 8-QAM Extended CCM - requires Firmware 1.5.4 or higher)
Rate 0.731, 0.780, 0.829, 0.853 16-QAM (also 0.644 16-QAM Extended CCM - requires Firmware 1.5.4 or higher)

114

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Introduction MN-CDM625

Transmit filtering Firmware prior to 1.4.0: Root-Raised Cosine, alpha = 0.35 (fixed)
Firmware 1.4.0 or later: Root-Raised Cosine, alpha = 0.35 and 0.25 front panel/software selectable
See graph of output spectrum provided at the end of this section
Scrambling IDR Mode, no RS, - per ITU V.35 (Intelsat variant)
IBS mode, no RS - per IESS-309, externally frame synchronized
Transparent Closed Network mode, no RS or Turbo coding - per ITU V.35 (Intelsat variant)
EDMAC mode, no RS coding - externally frame synchronized - proprietary
Turbo Product Code/LDPC/VersaFEC modes - externally frame synchronized - proprietary
All RS modes - externally frame synchronized per IESS-308/309/310
External Reference As an input: 1, 2, 5 or 10MHz -6dBm to +10dBm (nominal 50/75 , BNC female connector)
As an output: 10MHz, 2.7 volts peak-to-peak 0.4 volts, low impedance output
(The Ext. reference phase locks Tx and Rx synthesizers, and all baseband clock generation)
Harmonics/spurious Better than -60 dBC/4 kHz (typically <-65 dBC/4kHz)
measured from 1 to 500 MHz (50-180 MHz band)
measured F0 500 MHz (950-2000 MHz band)
Transmit on/off ratio -60 dBC minimum
Output phase noise < 0.480rms double sided, 100 Hz to 1MHz (minimum of 16 dB better overall than the INTELSAT IESS-308/309 requirement)
dB/Hz Frequency Offset
-63.0 100 Hz
-73.0 1 kHz
-83.0 10 kHz
-93.0 100 kHz
Fundamental AC line spurious is -42 dBc or lower
The sum of all other single sideband spurious, from 0 to 0.75 x symbol rate, is -48 dBc or lower
Output power 950-2000 MHz band: 0 to -40 dBm, 0.1 dB steps - manual mode. See AUPC section also
50-180 MHz band: 0 to -25 dBm, 0.1 dB steps - manual mode. See AUPC section also
Power accuracy 950-2000 MHz band:
0.7dB over frequency, data rate, modulation type and temperature range 15 to 35oC
1.0 dB over frequency, data rate, modulation type and temperature range 0 to 50oC
50-180 MHz band:
0.5dB over frequency, data rate, modulation type and temperature range 15 to 35oC
0.8dB over frequency, data rate, modulation type and temperature range 0 to 50oC
Output impedance 950-2000 MHz band: 50, 19 dB minimum return loss (21 dB typical)
50-180 MHz band: 50, or 75 16 dB minimum return loss (18 dB typical)
Output connector 950-2000 MHz band: Type N female
50-180 MHz band: BNC female
Clocking options Internal, 0.06 ppm (SCT)
External, locking over a 100 ppm range (TT)
Loop timing (Rx satellite clock) - supports asymmetric operation - Rx and Tx data rates need not be identical
External Clock
G.703 Clock Extension mode internal ST clock can be slaved to an external T1 or E1 G.703 signal, and a G.703 timing
signal re-constituted at the distant end of the link, regardless of the actual link data rate
External TX Carrier Off By TTL 'low' signal or external contact closure - hardware function automatically over-rides processor
BUC Reference On center conductor of L-Band output connector; 10.0 MHz 0.06 ppm (internal reference selected)
(10 MHz): 0.0 dBm, 3 dB; programmable ON/OFF
Phase Noise Source: either Internal Modem Reference or External Reference (10 MHz)
dB/Hz Frequency Offset
-105 10 Hz
-125 100 Hz
-138 1 kHz
-148 10 kHz
-150 100 kHz
BUC Supply Voltage Standard unit has no BUC supply.
Optional BUC Supply:
24VDC, 4.17 Amps maximum, 100W
48VDC, 3.125 Amps maximum, 150W @ 50oC (180 watts @ 30oC)
Supplied through Tx IF center conductor and selectable ON/OFF via M&C control.
BUC Current Monitor Min/Max programmable current alarm thresholds.
Tx Carrier ON Delay Selectable feature power on to allow internal ovenized reference to stabilize before turning on Tx carrier. Intelligent algorithm
minimizes delay time based on internal temperature at power-up.
BUC Monitoring Power level, temperature, power class, PLL lock.
Uses ND Satcom/Global VSAT Forum specification for FSK control and monitoring.

115

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Introduction MN-CDM625

0.0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1.0 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 1.5

0 Symbol Rate, Rs

-5 Comtech EF Data
CDM-625 Transmit
-10 Power Spectral Note: Tx Alpha = 0.25 requires
Density, referred to Firmware v1.4.0 or higher

symbol rate
-15

-20

-25

-30

Intelsat
-35 IESS
Tx Alpha = 0.35
308/309
Limit
-40

CDM-625
-45 Modulator
typically < -50 dB, and
Intelsat guaranteed to be
-50 IESS < -45 dB at offsets
308/309
Spectral Tx Alpha = 0.25 > 0.75 Rs
Limit
density, dB
-55

1.4.2 Demodulator
Note: Data rate range, operating modes, descrambling, input impedance/return loss etc, as per Sect. 1.4.1 Modulator.
Input power range, 950-2000 MHz (950-1950 MHz w/Firmware prior to Ver. 1.4.1) band:
desired carrier -130 + 10log(symbol rate) to -80 + 10 log(symbol rate) dBm
50-180 MHz band:
-105 + 10 log(symbol rate) to -70 + 10 log(symbol rate) dBm
Maximum Composite 950-2000 MHz band:
Operating Level 102 10 log(symbol rate, desired carrier) dBC, +10 dBm max, with the additional requirement that within 10 MHz of the
desired carrier, composite power is +30 dBC.
50-180 MHz band:
94 10 log(symbol rate, desired carrier) dBC, +10 dBm max, with the additional requirement that
within 10 MHz of the desired carrier, composite power is +30 dBc
Absolute Maximum,
+20 dBm
No Damage
FEC Viterbi: 3 bit soft decision
Sequential: 2 bit soft decision
Trellis: Per IESS-310
Reed-Solomon(Open Network): Per IESS-308/309/310
Reed-Solomon(Closed Network): Proprietary
Turbo Product Codec: 6 bit soft decision, proprietary
LDPC: 5 bit soft decision, proprietary
VersaFEC: 6 bit soft decision, proprietary
Adaptive Equalizer 5-tap design, selectable on/off
Acquisition range Programmable in 1kHz increments, and subject to the following:
Below 64 ksymbols/sec: 1 to (Rs/2) kHz, where Rs = symbol rate in ksymbols/sec
Between 64 and 389 ksymbols/sec: 1 up to a maximum of 32kHz
Above 389 ksymbols/sec: 1 to (0.1Rs) kHz, up to a maximum of 200 kHz
Acquisition time Highly dependent on data rate, FEC rate, and demodulator acquisition range.
Examples: 120 ms average at 64 kbps, R1/2 QPSK, 10 kHz acquisition sweep range, 6dB Eb/No
2 s average at 18 kbps, R1/2 QPSK, 10 kHz, 6dB Eb/No
Note: The use of Reed-Solomon, TPC, LDPC, VersaFEC increases acquisition time, due to the additional time taken for these
decoders to declare synchronization.
Clock tracking range 100 ppm min
Clocking modes Full range of clocking options supported see plesiochronous/Doppler buffer section

116

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Introduction MN-CDM625

LNB 10 MHz Reference On center conductor of L-Band input connector, selectable ON/OFF. Level: -3dBm 3 dB.
Source: either Internal modem reference or External reference
Performance: For phase noise, refer to L-Band modulator 10 MHz. Frequency stability same as the modulator 10 MHz
reference.
LNB Voltage On center conductor of L-Band input connector, selectable ON/OFF, 13, 18 volts per DiSEq 4.2 and 24VDC at 500 mA
maximum.
LNB Current Alarm Programmable MIN and MAX current alarms.
VITERBI BER performance Rate 1/2 (B, Q, OQ) Rate 3/4 (Q, OQ) Rate 7/8 (Q, OQ)
(met in the presence of two Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No:
adjacent carriers, each 7 dB (typical value in parentheses) (typical value in parentheses) (typical value in parentheses)
higher than the desired carrier)
For:
BER=10-5 5.4 dB (4.9 dB) 6.8 dB (6.3 dB) 7.7 dB (7.2 dB)

BER=10-6 6.0 dB (5.5 dB) 7.4 dB (6.9 dB) 8.4 dB (7.9 dB)

BER=10-7 6.7 dB (6.2 dB) 8.2 dB (7.7 dB) 9.0 dB (8.6 dB)
VITERBI and RS 220,200 or Rate 1/2 (B, Q, OQ) Rate 3/4 (Q, OQ) Rate 7/8 (Q, OQ)
200,180 Outer Code BER (with Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No:
two adjacent carriers, each 7 (typical value in parentheses) (typical value in parentheses) (typical value in parentheses)
dB higher than the desired For:
carrier) BER=10-5 4.3 dB (4.0 dB) 5.6 dB (4.7 dB) 6.5 dB (6.0 dB)

BER=10-6 4.4 dB (4.1 dB) 5.8 dB (4.8 dB) 6.7 dB (6.2 dB)

BER=10-7 4.5 dB (4.2 dB) 6.0 dB (5.2 dB) 6.9 dB (6.5 dB)
8PSK/TCM CODEC Rate 2/3 8PSK/TCM Rate 2/3 8PSK/TCM
BER (with two adjacent Guaranteed Eb/No: w/concatenated RS
carriers, each 7 dB higher than (typical value in parentheses) Guaranteed Eb/No:
the desired carrier) (typical value in parentheses)
For:
BER=10-5 7.9 dB (7.2 dB) 6.3 dB (5.4 dB)

BER=10-7 9.5 dB (8.7 dB) 6.7 dB (5.8 dB)

BER=10-8 10.4 dB (9.5 dB) 6.9 dB (6.0 dB)


16-QAM VITERBI/ 16-QAM Rate 3/4 16-QAM Rate 7/8
220,200 RS BER (with two Viterbi/RS Viterbi/RS Attention:
adjacent carriers, each 7 dB Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No: For 126,112
higher than the desired carrier) (typical value in parentheses) (typical value in parentheses) Reed-Solomon
For:
BER=10-6 8.1 dB (7.5 dB) 9.5 dB (9.0 dB) Add 0.2 dB to these figures

BER=10-8 8.6 dB (8.0 dB) 10.1 dB (9.5 dB)


SEQUENTIAL at 64 kbps Rate 1/2 (B, Q, OQ) Rate 3/4 (Q, OQ) Rate 7/8 (Q, OQ)
BER performance (met in the Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No:
presence of two adjacent (typical value in parentheses) (typical value in parentheses) (typical value in parentheses)
carriers, each 7 dB higher than For:
the desired carrier) BER=10-4 4.4 dB (4.0 dB) 5.2 dB (4.7 dB) 6.2 dB (5.7 dB)

BER=10-6 5.1 dB (4.6 dB) 5.8 dB (5.4 dB) 7.0 dB (6.6 dB)

BER=10-8 5.7 dB (5.2 dB) 6.4 dB (6.0 dB) 7.9 dB (7.4 dB)
SEQUENTIAL Rate 1/2 (Q, OQ) Rate 3/4 (Q, OQ) Rate 7/8 (Q, OQ)
at 2048 kbps BER Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No:
performance (met in the (typical value in parentheses) (typical value in parentheses) (typical value in parentheses)
presence of two adjacent For:
carriers, each 7 dB higher than BER=10-4 5.0 dB (4.6 dB) 5.6 dB (5.2 dB) 6.5 dB (6.0 dB)
the desired carrier)
BER=10-6 5.8 dB (5.4 dB) 6.4 dB (6.0 dB) 7.6 dB (7.2 dB)

BER=10-8 6.7 dB (6.3 dB) 7.3 dB (6.8 dB) 8.7 dB (8.2 dB)

117

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Introduction MN-CDM625

SEQUENTIAL and RS 220,200 Rate 1/2 (B, Q, OQ) Rate 3/4 (Q, OQ) Rate 7/8 (Q, OQ)
Outer Code Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No:
at 512 kbps (typical value in parentheses) (typical value in parentheses) (typical value in parentheses)
BER performance (with two For:
adjacent carriers, each 7 dB BER=10-4 4.5 dB (4.1 dB) 5.0 dB (4.6 dB) 5.9 dB (5.5 dB)
higher than the desired carrier)
BER=10-6 4.7 dB (4.3 dB) 5.2 dB (4.8 dB) 6.1 dB (5.7 dB)

BER=10-8 4.9 dB (4.6 dB) 5.4 dB (5.0 dB) 6.3 dB (5.9 dB)
TURBO PRODUCT CODEC Rate 21/44 (B, Q, OQ)* Rate 5/16 (B)
BER Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No: * See Notes 1 and 2 (below)
Rate 21/44 B/Q/OQPSK (typical value in parentheses) (typical value in parentheses)
Rate 5/16 BPSK For:
BER (with two adjacent BER=10-6 3.1 dB (2.9 dB) 2.7 dB (2.5dB)
carriers, each 7 dB higher than
the desired carrier) BER=10-7 3.3 dB (3.1 dB) 2.9 dB (2.7dB)

BER=10-8 3.5 dB (3.3 dB) 3.1 dB (2.9dB)


TURBO PRODUCT CODEC Rate 3/4 (Q, OQ) Rate 3/4 (8PSK, 8-QAM) Rate 3/4 (16-QAM)
BER Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No:
Rate 3/4 QPSK (typical value in parentheses) (typical value in parentheses) (typical value in parentheses)
Rate 3/4 8PSK/8-QAM
Rate 3/4 16-QAM For:
BER (with two adjacent BER=10-6 3.8dB (3.4dB) 6.4 dB (6.0 dB) 7.8 dB (7.4 dB)
carriers, each 7 dB higher than
the desired carrier) BER=10-7 4.1dB (3.7dB) 6.7 dB (6.3 dB) 8.1 dB (7.7 dB)

BER=10-8 4.4dB (4.0dB) 7.1 dB (6.7 dB) 8.5 dB (8.2 dB)


TURBO PRODUCT CODEC Rate 7/8 (Q, OQ) Rate 7/8 (8PSK, 8-QAM) Rate 7/8 (16-QAM)
BER Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No:
Rate 7/8 QPSK (typical value in parentheses) (typical value in parentheses) (typical value in parentheses)
Rate 7/8 8PSK/8-QAM For:
Rate 7/8 16-QAM BER=10-5 4.3 dB (4.0 dB) 7.0 dB (6.7 dB) 8.1 dB (7.7 dB)
BER (with two adjacent
carriers, each 7 dB higher than BER=10-8 4.5 dB (4.2 dB) 7.2 dB (6.8 dB) 8.4 dB (8.1 dB)
the desired carrier)
TURBO PRODUCT CODEC Rate 0.95 (Q, OQ) Rate 0.95 (8PSK, 8-QAM)
BER Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No:
Rate 0.95 QPSK (typical value in parentheses) (typical value in parentheses)
Rate 0.95 8PSK/8-QAM For:
BER (with two adjacent BER=10-6 6.4 dB (6.0 dB) 9.6 dB (9.2 dB)
carriers, each 7 dB higher than
the desired carrier) BER=10-7 6.7 dB (6.3 dB) 10.1 dB (9.7 dB)

BER=10-8 6.9 dB (6.5 dB) 10.6 dB (10.2 dB)


LDPC CODEC BER * See Note 2 BPSK/QPSK/OQPSK* Rate 1/2 QPSK/OQPSK QPSK/OQPSK
Rate 1/2 B/Q/OQPSK LDPC Rate 2/3 LDPC Rate 3/4 LDPC
Rate 2/3 Q/OQPSK Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No:
Rate 1/2 Q/OQPSK (typical value in parentheses) (typical value in parentheses) (typical value in parentheses)
(With two adjacent carriers, For:
each 7 dB higher than the BER=10-5 2.0 dB (1.7 dB) 2.3 dB (2.0 dB) 3.0 dB (2.6 dB)
desired carrier)
BER=10-9 2.3 dB (2.0 dB) 2.7 dB (2.3 dB) 3.3 dB (3.0 dB)
LDPC CODEC BER 8PSK Rate 2/3 LDPC 8PSK Rate 3/4 LDPC
Rate 2/3 8PSK Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No:
Rate 3/4 8PSK (typical value in parentheses) (typical value in parentheses)
(With two adjacent carriers, For:
each 7 dB higher than the BER=10-5 --- 5.6 dB (5.2 dB)
desired carrier)
BER=10-9 5.7 dB (5.2 dB) 6.0 dB (5.6 dB)
Notes:
1) Rate 21/44 QPSK is shown as Rate 1/2 on the Front Panel display, etc.
2) The demod acquisition and tracking threshold for OQPSK is approx 1 dB worse than the QPSK case in this mode.

118

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Introduction MN-CDM625

LDPC CODEC BER 8-QAM Rate 2/3 LDPC 8-QAM Rate 3/4 LDPC
Rate 2/3 8-QAM Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No:
Rate 3/4 8-QAM (typical value in parentheses) (typical value in parentheses)
(With two adjacent carriers, For:
each 7 dB higher than the BER=10-5 4.6 dB (4.2 dB) 5.6 dB (5.2 dB)
desired carrier)
BER=10-9 5.0 dB (4.6 dB) 6.0 dB (5.6 dB)
LDPC CODEC BER 16-QAM Rate 3/4 LDPC
Rate 3/4 16-QAM Guaranteed Eb/No:
(With two adjacent carriers, (typical value in parentheses)
each 7 dB higher than the For:
desired carrier) BER=10-5 6.8 dB (6.2 dB)

BER=10-9 7.1 dB (6.8 dB)


VersaFEC CODEC BER Rate 0.488
BPSK Guaranteed Eb/No:
(With two adjacent carriers, (typical value in parentheses)
each 7 dB higher than the For:
desired carrier) BER=10-5 2.4 dB (2.1 dB)

BER=10-8 2.7 dB (2.4 dB)


VersaFEC CODEC BER Rate 0.533 QPSK Rate 0.631 QPSK Rate 0.706 QPSK Rate 0.803 QPSK
QPSK Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No:
(With two adjacent carriers, (typical value in (typical value in (typical value in (typical value in
each 7 dB higher than the parentheses) parentheses) parentheses) parentheses)
desired carrier) For:
BER=10-5 2.3 dB (2.0 dB) 2.8 dB (2.5 dB) 3.3 dB (3.0 dB) 3.8 dB (3.5 dB)

BER=10-8 2.5 dB (2.2 dB) 3.0 dB (2.7 dB) 3.7 dB (3.4 dB) 4.1 dB (3.8 dB)
VersaFEC CODEC BER Rate 0.642 8-QAM Rate 0.711 8-QAM Rate 0.780 8-QAM
8-QAM Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No:
(With two adjacent carriers, (typical value in (typical value in (typical value in
each 7 dB higher than the parentheses) parentheses) parentheses)
desired carrier) For:
BER=10-5 4.6 dB (4.3 dB) 5.2 dB (4.9 dB) 5.6 dB (5.3 dB)

BER=10-8 4.9 dB (4.6 dB) 5.5 dB (5.2 dB) 6.0 dB (5.7 dB)
VersaFEC CODEC BER R 0.731 16-QAM R 0.780 16-QAM R 0.829 16-QAM R 0.853 16-QAM
16-QAM Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No:
(With two adjacent carriers, (typical value in (typical value in (typical value in (typical value in
each 7 dB higher than the parentheses) parentheses) parentheses) parentheses)
desired carrier) For:
BER=10-5 6.4 dB (6.1 dB) 7.0 dB (6.7 dB) 7.5 dB (7.2 dB) 8.0 dB (7.7 dB)

BER=10-8 6.6 dB (6.3 dB) 7.3 dB (7.0 dB) 7.8 dB (7.5 dB) 8.3 dB (8.0 dB)
VersaFEC CODEC - Extended R 0.576 8-QAM R 0.644 16-QAM
CCM BER Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No:
(With two adjacent carriers, (typical value in (typical value in
each 7 dB higher than the parentheses) parentheses)
desired carrier) For:
BER=10-5 4.5 dB (4.2 dB) 6.4 dB (6.1 dB)

BER=10-8 4.9 dB (4.6 dB) 6.9 dB (6.6 dB)


Ultra-Low-Latency (ULL) R 0.493 BPSK R 0.493 QPSK R 0.654 QPSK R 0.734 QPSK
CODEC BER Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No: Guaranteed Eb/No:
(With two adjacent carriers, (typical value in (typical value in (typical value in (typical value in
each 7 dB higher than the parentheses) parentheses) parentheses) parentheses)
desired carrier) For:
BER=10-5 3.1 dB (2.8 dB) 3.1 dB (2.8 dB) 3.6 dB (3.3 dB) 4.1 dB (3.8 dB)

BER=10-8 3.7 dB (3.4 dB) 3.7 dB (3.4 dB) 4.2 dB (3.9 dB) 4.7 dB (4.4 dB)
Plesiochronous/ Selectable size of 64 to 262,144 bits, in 16-bit steps (with added limitations for G.704 frame boundaries).
Doppler Buffer Size selection is displayed in bytes and milliseconds.
Supports asymmetric operation - when buffer is clocked from Tx clock, Rx and Tx rates do not need to be identical.

119

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Introduction MN-CDM625

Monitor Functions Eb/No estimate:


2 to 10 dB with 0.3 dB accuracy
0 to 16 dB with 0.5 dB accuracy
Corrected Bit Error Rate, 1E-3 to 1E-10
Frequency offset, 32 kHz range, (or 200 kHz range, depending on band and symbol rate) 100 Hz resolution
Buffer fill state, in percent
Receive signal level:
950-2000 MHz band accuracy: 3 dB
50-180 MHz band accuracy: 2 dB

0
-10
Maximum
-20
Carrier Level in dBm

-30
-40
-50
-60
-70
Minimum
-80
-90
10 100 1000 10000 100000
Symbol Rate in ksps

Figure 1-5. Rx Carrier Level vs. Symbol Rate L-Band (950-2000 MHz)

10

0 Maximum
-10
Carrier Level in dBm

-20
-30

-40
-50 Minimum
-60
-70

-80
10 100 1000 10000 100000
Symbol Rate in ksps

Figure 1-6. Rx Carrier Level vs. Symbol Rate IF Band (50-180 MHz)

120

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Introduction MN-CDM625

1.4.3 Data Interfaces


Primary Data RS-422/EIA-530 DCE (Rates up to 14 Mbps) 25-pin D-sub (female)
(4 selectable modes) (also supports X.21 DCE & DTE up to 2.048 Mbps and 8k ESC orderwire for IDR)
V.35 DCE (Rates up to 14 Mbps)
LVDS serial (Rates up to 25 Mbps)
HSSI serial (Rates up to 25 Mbps)
G.703 (Tx In, Drop Out, 1.544 Mbps T1 (Balanced 100 ) 9-pin D-sub (female)
Insert In, Rx Out) 6.312 Mbps T2 (unbalanced 75 or balanced 110 ) or BNC (female)
2.048 Mbps E1 (unbalanced 75 or balanced 120 )
8.448 Mbps E2 (unbalanced 75 )
Note: All Drop and Insert modes are a FAST option.
ASI Uses G.703 (Tx In, Rx Out) ports BNC (female)
Auxiliary G.703 Two additional 2.048 Mbps E1 ports (balanced 120 ) 9-pin D-sub (female)
(used for Quad D&I modes) Note: All Drop and Insert modes are a FAST option.
External Reference In/Out As an input: BNC (female)
1, 2, 5 or 10MHz -6dBm to +10dBm (nominal 50/75 )
As an output:
10MHz, 2.7 volts peak-to-peak +/- 0.4 volts, low impedance output
Overhead Data RS-422 octet clocks for IDR ESC & IBS 44-pin High-density
RS-422 IDR 64 kbps ESC data & clock D-sub (male)
IDR BWA IDR BWA Inputs/4 backward alarm Form C relay outputs
Inputs/Outputs 2 audio channels, each occupying 32 kbps bandwidth as part of IDR overhead or as
a 64 kbps primary data rate option.
ADPCM Audio Interface 600 balanced 0 dBm0 nominal, -6 to +8 dB, 2 dB steps
Modem Alarms Relay outputs (Tx, Rx & unit faults) 15-pin D-sub (male)
Demodulator I & Q test outputs (constellation)
Demodulator Rx Signal Level output (0 to 2.5 volts)
External carrier off input
ESC (Overhead) Standard IBS ESC interfaces 9-pin D-sub (female)
RS-232/485 High Rate ESC data
RS-232/485 ESC++ data
Remote Control RS-232 or RS-485 modem control and monitoring 9-pin D-sub (male)
PMSI Interface Pre-mapped Symbol interface 9-pin D-sub (female)
(used by DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier function)
1:1 Control Control interface for CRS170A/CRS180 1:1 Redundancy unit 9-pin D-sub (male)
Ethernet 4 ports of 10/100 BaseT auto-sensing full/half duplex Ethernet RJ-45

121

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Introduction MN-CDM625

1.4.4 Automatic Uplink Power Control (AUPC)


Operating Mode Requires Closed Network Framed mode (EDMAC, D&I++, Enhanced D&I, or ESC++) for transport of
Eb/No information from remote modem (EDMAC can be enabled or disabled)
Target Eb/No range 0 to 14.9 dB at remote demod (default is 4.0 dB)

Max AUPC range 0 to 9 dB (default is 3 dB)


Monitor functions Remote demod Eb/No
Tx power level increase
(front panel or via remote control interface)

1.4.5 DoubleTalk Carrier- in-Carrier (CnC)


Requires the two links to share a common carrier frequency (Outbound and Inbound symbol rates do
Operating Mode
not have to be equal)
Power Spectral Density Ratio and BSPK/QPSK/8PSK/8-QAM: 7 dB to +11 dB (ratio of power spectral density, outbound interferer to
CnC Ratio desired inbound)
16-QAM: 7 dB to +7 dB (ratio of power spectral density, outbound interferer to desired inbound)
Note: With asymmetric carriers, the absolute power ratio (or CnC ratio) would be different,
depending on the ratio of the symbol rates.
Example:
Outbound interferer = 1 Msymbols/sec
Desired Inbound = 500 ksymbols/sec
Ratio of power spectral density = +7 dB
Absolute power ratio (CnC Ratio) = +7dB + (10 log Outbound/desired symbol rate) = +10 dB
Maximum Symbol Rate Ratio 3:1 (TX:RX or RX:TX)
Inbound/Outbound frequency Within the normal acquisition range of the demod, as follows:
uncertainty Below 64 ksymbols/sec: 1 to (Rs/2) kHz, where Rs = symbol rate in ksymbols/sec
Between 64 and 389 ksymbols/sec: 1up to a maximum of 32kHz
Above 389 ksymbols/sec: 1 to (0.1Rs) kHz, up to a maximum of 200 kHz
Delay range 0-330 ms
Eb/No Degradation BPSK = 0.3dB QPSK = 0.3dB OQPSK = 0.3dB
(equal Inbound/Outbound power 8PSK = 0.5dB 8-QAM = 0.4dB 16-QAM = 0.6dB
spectral density) For +10 dB power spectral density ratio (outbound interferer 10 dB higher than desired inbound) add
an additional 0.3 dB
Monitor Functions Delay, in milliseconds
Frequency offset (between outbound interferer and desired inbound). 100 Hz resolution
CnC Power Ratio, in 0.1 dB (ratio of absolute power, outbound interferer to desired inbound)
Power Spectral Density Ratio, in 0.1 dB
CnC Monitor Accuracy 0.1 dB for symmetric symbol rate

122

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Introduction MN-CDM625

1.4.6 Framing Summary


Available data rates Overhead Additional Reed- Scrambling
Framing Mode Overhead added
and format components Solomon Overhead (see Note 1)
200/220
225/205 Basic ITU
Transparent None All rates and formats None
219/201 V.35 (Intelsat)
126/112
To 2 Mbps: 5% Remote control link
EDMAC Above 2 Mbps: 1.6% All rates and formats between modems 200/180 Proprietary scrambler
(see Note 2) processor plus AUPC
Remote control link
EDMAC-2 1.6% All rates and formats between modems 200/180 Proprietary scrambler
processor plus AUPC
Remote control link
To 2 Mbps: 5%
EDMAC-3 All rates and formats between modems 200/180 Proprietary scrambler
Above 2 Mbps: 1.6%
processor plus AUPC
EIA-422 ESC
(8 kbps) T1 = 225/205
T1, E1, T2 and E2; all EIA-422 ESC E1 = 219/201 and Basic ITU V.35
IDR Fixed 96 kHz
formats (64 kbps or IESS-310 mode (Intelsat)
2 audio links) T2/E2 = 194/178
4 BW alarms
EIA-232 Earth station
126/112
1/15 of front panel data 64 to 2048 kbps only; link at 1/480th of
IBS 219/201 for IESS-310 IESS-309 scrambler
rate all formats primary data rate. One
mode
BW alarm
EIA-232 Earth station
1/15 of front panel data 126/112
Specific multiples of 64 link at 1/480th of
D&I rate 219/201 for IESS-310 IESS-309 scrambler
kbps only primary data rate
Terrestrial is T1 or E1 mode
One BW alarm
1/45 of front panel data Same as EDMAC, plus
rate Any multiple of 64 kbps, EIA-232 Earth station Basic ITU V.35
D&I++ 126/112
Terrestrial is up to n = 31 link at 1/576th of (Intelsat)
T1 or E1 primary data rate
Variable: between EIA-232 Earth station
Basic ITU V.35
ESC++ 11.76% at 64 kbps to All rates and formats link at variable rate, 126/112
(Intelsat)
1.58% above 7 Mbps plus AUPC
n x 64 kbps, up to
220/200
0.78% (129/128) of n = 128 using a max of Basic ITU V.35
QDI None 225/205
front panel data rate 4 balanced G.703 E1 (Intelsat)
219/201
D&I interfaces
n x 64 kbps, up to
Concatenation of QDI n = 128 using a max of Basic ITU V.35
Framed QDI None 200/180
and EDMAC-2 4 balanced G.703 E1 (Intelsat)
D&I interfaces

Notes:

1. Reed-Solomon is Off.

2. % for Rates 5/16 or 21/44 BPSK Turbo, Rate 1/2 QPSK/OQPSK Turbo, and all rates > 2 Mbps.

123

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Introduction MN-CDM625

1.4.7 Data Rate Ranges


UNFRAMED (NO REED SOLOMON) Lower Limit (kbps) Upper Limit (kbps)
No FEC, BPSK 18.0 12500
No FEC, O/QPSK 36.0 25000.0
VITERBI, BPSK, 1/2 18.0 6250.0
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 1/2 18.0 12500.0
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 3/4 27.0 18750.0
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 7/8 31.5 21875.0
SEQUENTIAL, BPSK, 1/2 18.0 1024.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 1/2 18.0 2048.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 3/4 27.0 2048.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 7/8 31.5 2048.0
TRELLIS, 8PSK, 2/3 36.0 25000.0
TPC, BPSK, 5/16 18.0 3906.2
TPC, BPSK, 21/44 (aka 1/2) 18.0 5965.9
TPC, O/QPSK, 21/44 (aka 1/2) 18.0 11931.8
TPC, O/QPSK, 3/4 27.0 18750.0
TPC, O/QPSK, 17/18 (aka 0.95) 34.2 23611.1
TPC, O/QPSK, 7/8 31.5 21875.0
TPC, 8PSK/8-QAM, 3/4 40.5 25000.0
TPC, 8PSK/8-QAM, 17/18 (aka 0.95) 52.0 25000.0
TPC, 8PSK/8-QAM, 7/8 48.0 25000.0
TPC, 16-QAM, 3/4 54.0 25000.0
TPC, 16-QAM, 7/8 63.0 25000.0
LDPC, BPSK, 1/2 18.0 6250.0
LDPC, O/QPSK, 1/2 18.0 12500.0
LDPC, O/QPSK, 3/4 27.0 18750.0
LDPC, O/QPSK, 2/3 24.0 16666.6
LDPC, 8PSK/8-QAM, 3/4 40.5 25000.0
LDPC, 8PSK/8-QAM, 2/3 36.0 25000.0
LDPC, 16-QAM, 3/4 54.0 25000.0

UNFRAMED (ANY REED SOLOMON) Lower Limit (kbps) Upper Limit (kbps)
VITERBI, BPSK, 1/2 18.0 5555.0
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 1/2 18.0 11111.0
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 3/4 27.0 16666.6
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 7/8 31.5 19444.0
SEQUENTIAL, BPSK, 1/2 18.0 1024.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 1/2 18.0 2048.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 3/4 29.0 2048.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 7/8 31.5 2048.0
TRELLIS, 8PSK, 2/3 36.0 22222.0
VIT 16-QAM, 3/4 54.0 22222.0
VIT 16-QAM, 7/8 63.0 22222.0

124

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Introduction MN-CDM625

EDMAC, EDMAC-2, or EDMAC-3 (NO REED SOLOMON) Lower Limit (kbps) Upper Limit (kbps)
No FEC, BPSK 18.0 12295.0
No FEC, O/QPSK 35.5 24590.1
VITERBI, BPSK, 1/2 18.0 6147.5
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 1/2 18.0 12295.0
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 3/4 26.6 18442.6
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 7/8 31.0 21516.3
SEQUENTIAL, BPSK, 1/2 18.0 1024.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 1/2 18.0 2048.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 3/4 26.6 2048.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 7/8 31.0 2048.0
TRELLIS, 8PSK, 2/3 35.5 24590.1
TPC, BPSK, 5/16 18.0 3842.2
TPC, BPSK, 21/44 (aka 1/2) 18.0 5868.1
TPC, O/QPSK, 21/44 (aka 1/2) 18.0 11736.2
TPC, O/QPSK, 3/4 26.6 18442.6
TPC, O/QPSK, 17/18 (aka 0.95) 33.5 23224.0
TPC, O/QPSK, 7/8 31.0 21516.3
TPC, 8PSK/8-QAM, 3/4 39.9 24590.1
TPC, 8PSK/8-QAM, 17/18 (aka 0.95) 50.2 24590.1
TPC, 8PSK/8-QAM, 7/8 46.5 24590.1
TPC, 16-QAM, 3/4 53.2 24590.1
TPC, 16-QAM, 7/8 62.0 24590.1
LDPC, BPSK, 1/2 18.0 6147.5
LDPC, O/QPSK, 1/2 18.0 12295.0
LDPC, O/QPSK, 3/4 26.6 18442.6
LDPC, O/QPSK, 2/3 23.7 16393.4
LDPC, 8PSK/8-QAM, 3/4 39.9 24590.1
LDPC, 8PSK/8-QAM, 2/3 35.5 24590.1
LDPC, 16-QAM, 3/4 53.2 24590.1

EDMAC, EDMAC-2, or EDMAC-3 (ANY REED SOLOMON) Lower Limit (kbps) Upper Limit (kbps)
VITERBI, BPSK, 1/2 18.0 5532.7
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 1/2 18.0 11065.5
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 3/4 24.0 16598.3
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 7/8 27.9 19364.7
SEQUENTIAL, BPSK, 1/2 18.0 1024.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 1/2 18.0 2048.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 3/4 24.0 2048.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 7/8 27.9 2048.0
TRELLIS, 8PSK, 2/3 31.9 22131.1
VIT 16-QAM, 3/4 47.9 22131.1
VIT 16-QAM, 7/8 55.8 22131.1

IBS (NO REED SOLOMON) Lower Limit (kbps) Upper Limit (kbps)
No FEC, BPSK 64.0 8448.0
No FEC, O/QPSK 64.0 8448.0

125

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Introduction MN-CDM625

VITERBI, BPSK, 1/2 64.0 5859.3


VITERBI, O/QPSK, 1/2 64.0 8448.0
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 3/4 64.0 8448.0
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 7/8 64.0 8448.0
SEQUENTIAL, BPSK, 1/2 64.0 1024.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 1/2 64.0 2048.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 3/4 64.0 2048.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 7/8 64.0 2048.0
TRELLIS, 8PSK, 2/3 64.0 8448.0
TPC, BPSK, 5/16 64.0 3662.1
TPC, BPSK, 21/44 (aka 1/2) 64.0 5593.0
TPC, O/QPSK, 21/44 (aka 1/2) 64.0 8448.0
TPC, O/QPSK, 3/4 64.0 8448.0
TPC, O/QPSK, 17/18 (aka 0.95) 64.0 8448.0
TPC, O/QPSK, 7/8 64.0 8448.0
TPC, 8PSK/8-QAM, 3/4 64.0 8448.0
TPC, 8PSK/8-QAM, 17/18 (aka 0.95) 64.0 8448.0
TPC, 8PSK/8-QAM, 7/8 64.0 8448.0
TPC, 16-QAM, 3/4 64.0 8448.0
TPC, 16-QAM, 7/8 64.0 8448.0
LDPC, BPSK, 1/2 64.0 5859.3
LDPC,O/ QPSK, 1/2 64.0 8448.0
LDPC, O/QPSK, 3/4 64.0 8448.0
LDPC, O/QPSK, 2/3 64.0 8448.0
LDPC, 8PSK/8-QAM, 3/4 64.0 8448.0
LDPC, 8PSK/8-QAM, 2/3 64.0 8448.0
LDPC, 16-QAM, 3/4 64.0 8448.0

IBS (ANY REED SOLOMON) Lower Limit (kbps) Upper Limit (kbps)
VITERBI, BPSK, 1/2 64.0 5208.0
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 1/2 64.0 8448.0
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 3/4 64.0 8448.0
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 7/8 64.0 8448.0
SEQUENTIAL, BPSK, 1/2 64.0 1024.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 1/2 64.0 2048.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 3/4 64.0 2048.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 7/8 64.0 2048.0
TRELLIS, 8PSK, 2/3 64.0 8448.0
VIT 16-QAM, 3/4 64.0 8448.0
VIT 16-QAM, 7/8 64.0 8448.0

ESC++ (NO REED SOLOMON) Lower Limit (kbps) Upper Limit (kbps)
No FEC, BPSK 64.0 12304.6
No FEC, O/QPSK 64.0 24609.3
VITERBI, BPSK, 1/2 64.0 5921.0
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 1/2 64.0 12304.6
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 3/4 64.0 18457.0

126

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Introduction MN-CDM625

VITERBI, O/QPSK, 7/8 64.0 21533.2


SEQUENTIAL, BPSK, 1/2 64.0 1024.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 1/2 64.0 2048.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 3/4 64.0 2048.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 7/8 64.0 2048.0
TRELLIS, 8PSK, 2/3 64.0 24609.3
TPC, BPSK, 5/16 64.0 3700.6
TPC, BPSK, 21/44 (aka 1/2) 64.0 5651.9
TPC, O/QPSK, 21/44 (aka 1/2) 64.0 11745.3
TPC, O/QPSK, 3/4 64.0 18457.0
TPC, O/QPSK, 17/18 (aka 0.95) 64.0 23242.1
TPC, O/QPSK, 7/8 64.0 21533.2
TPC, 8PSK/8-QAM, 3/4 64.0 24609.3
TPC, 8PSK/8-QAM 17/18 (aka 0.95) 64.0 24609.3
TPC, 8PSK/8-QAM, 7/8 64.0 24609.3
TPC, 16-QAM, 3/4 64.0 24609.3
TPC, 16-QAM, 7/8 64.0 24609.3
LDPC, BPSK, 1/2 64.0 5921.0
LDPC, O/QPSK, 1/2 64.0 12304.6
LDPC, O/QPSK, 3/4 64.0 18457.0
LDPC, O/QPSK, 2/3 64.0 16406.2
LDPC, 8PSK/8-QAM, 3/4 64.0 24609.3
LDPC, 8PSK/8-QAM,2/3 64.0 24609.3
LDPC, 16-QAM, 3/4 64.0 24609.3

ESC++ (ANY REED SOLOMON) Lower Limit (kbps) Upper Limit (kbps)
VITERBI, BPSK, 1/2 64.0 5263.1
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 1/2 64.0 10937.5
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 3/4 64.0 16406.2
VITERBI, O/QPSK, 7/8 64.0 19140.6
SEQUENTIAL, BPSK, 1/2 64.0 1024.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 1/2 64.0 2048.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 3/4 64.0 2048.0
SEQUENTIAL, O/QPSK, 7/8 64.0 2048.0
TRELLIS, 8PSK, 2/3 64.0 21875.0
VITERBI, 16-QAM, 3/4 64.0 21875.0
VITERBI, 16-QAM, 7/8 64.0 21875.0

VersaFEC (ANY MODE) Lower Limit (kbps) Upper Limit (kbps)


VersaFEC BPSK Rate 0.488 18.0 5700.0
VersaFEC QPSK Rate 0.533 20.0 10000.0
VersaFEC QPSK Rate 0.631 23.0 10000.0
VersaFEC QPSK Rate 0.706 26.0 10000.0
VersaFEC QPSK Rate 0.803 28.0 12000.0
VersaFEC 8-QAM Rate 0.576 (ECCM) 32.0 11000.0
VersaFEC 8-QAM Rate 0.642 35.0 12000.0
VersaFEC 8-QAM Rate 0.711 39.0 12000.0

127

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Introduction MN-CDM625

VersaFEC 8-QAM Rate 0.780 43.0 12000.0


VersaFEC 16-QAM Rate 0.644 (ECCM) 47.0 11000.0
VersaFEC 16-QAM Rate 0.731 53.0 12000.0
VersaFEC 16-QAM Rate 0.780 57.0 14000.0
VersaFEC 16-QAM Rate 0.829 60.0 14000.0
VersaFEC 16-QAM Rate 0.853 62.0 16000.0
ULL BPSK Rate 0.493 18.0 5700.0
ULL QPSK Rate 0.493 18.0 6000.0
ULL QPSK Rate 0.654 24.0 9000.0
ULL QPSK Rate 0.734 27.0 9000.0

VersaFEC Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM): See Specifications that follow (Sect.1.4.8)

128

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Introduction MN-CDM625

1.4.8 VersaFEC Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM)

Adaptive Coding and Modulation, using BPSK, QPSK, 8-QAM , 16-QAM and
System type
VersaFEC short-block LDPC coding - total of 12 ModCods

Symbol Rate Range 37 ksps to 4100 ksps

Interface 10/100 Base T Ethernet, with auto-negotiated Congestion Control


Automatically reported from remote modem built in function at the physical
Remote SNR reporting
layer requires no additional overhead
Max span of data rate 7:1 over range of adaptation
Switch point
Corresponds to SNR (Eb/No) that gives BER = 5 x 10-8
(decreasing SNR)
Switch point hysteresis 0.3 dB

Max fading rate Approximately 1 dB/second (higher if Target Eb/No margin > 1 dB)

Max ModCod update rate 1 update every 2 seconds (no restriction on distance between ModCods)

Minimum and Maximum ModCod (ModCod0 through ModCod11)


Remote Demod Unlock Action: Maintain current ModCod
Configurable parameters
Go to minimum ModCod
Target Eb/No margin (0 to 4.5 dB, 0.5 dB steps)

54 milliseconds max (for a system operating at 100 ksps, and assuming a WAN
System latency
buffer of 20 milliseconds, not including satellite path)

Tx and Rx ModCods
Local and Remote SNR
Monitored parameters (-3.0 dB to +22.0dB, 0.1dB resolution, +/- 0.5 dB accuracy)
Config and monitor menus displaying data rate, modulation and code rate update
dynamically with ModCod

Typical Min. Data Max. Data


Spectral efficiency,
Modulation Code Rate Eb/No, for Rate, Rate,
bps/Hz
BER = 5 x 10-8 ACM mode ACM mode

BPSK 0.488 0.49 2.4 dB 18.1 kbps 2.00 Mbps


QPSK 0.533 1.07 2.2 dB 39.6 kbps 4.38 Mbps
QPSK 0.631 1.26 2.7 dB 46.7 kbps 5.16 Mbps
QPSK 0.706 1.41 3.4 dB 52.2 kbps 5.78 Mbps
QPSK 0.803 1.61 3.8 dB 59.6 kbps 6.60 Mbps
8-QAM 0.642 1.93 4.6 dB 71.5 kbps 7.91 Mbps
8-QAM 0.711 2.13 5.2 dB 78.8 kbps 8.73 Mbps
8-QAM 0.780 2.34 5.6 dB 86.6 kbps 9.59 Mbps
16-QAM 0.731 2.93 6.3 dB 108.5 kbps 12.01 Mbps
16-QAM 0.780 3.12 7.0 dB 115.5 kbps 12.79 Mbps
16-QAM 0.829 3.32 7.5 dB 122.8 kbps 13.61 Mbps
16-QAM 0.853 3.41 8.0 dB 126.2 kbps 14.00 Mbps

129

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Introduction MN-CDM625

1.4.9 Miscellaneous
Front Panel Tactile keypad, 6 keys (Up/Down), Left/Right, Enter/Clear)
Vacuum Fluorescent Display (blue) 2 lines of 40 characters
Loopbacks Internal IF loopback, RF loopback, digital loopback, and inward/outward loopback
Fault relays Hardware fault, Rx and Tx Traffic Alarms, Open Network Backward Alarms
Type: Form C Contacts. Rating: Up to +/-50 volts, max 0.5 Amp
M&C Interface EIA-232 and EIA-485 (addressable multidrop, 2-wire or 4-wire) or Ethernet (10/100 BaseT)
M&C Software Serial comms, SNMP, Telnet, Web Server (HTTP)
Firmware update Via Ethernet port. ftp protocol
Dimensions 1RU high, 17.65 inches (448 mm) deep
Weight 10.5 lbs (4.8 kg) max (All option cards and 48V BUC supply installed)
AC consumption 48 watts (typical, TPC/LDPC Codec and CnC module installed), 68watts (maximum)
280 watts (typical TPC/LDPC Codec, CnC module and 48 volt BUC supply installed, 300 watts (max)
AC operating voltage 100 - 240 VAC Nominal - autosensing
90 264 VAC Maximum
DC consumption (option) As above (AC consumption)
DC operating voltage 43-60 VDC Nominal
36 60 VDC Maximum
Operating temperature 0 to 50C (32 to 122F)

1.4.10 Approvals
EN 61000-3-2 EN 61000-4-6
CE as follows: EN 55022 Class B
EN 61000-3-3 EN 61000-4-8
(Emissions) EN 61000-4-9
EN 61000-4-2
EN 50082-1 (Immunity) EN 61000-4-4 EN 61000-4-11
EN 60950-1 (Safety) EN 61000-4-5 EN 61000-4-13

FCC Federal Communications Commission Federal Code of Regulation FCC Part 15, Subpart B.

130

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


Chapter 2. INSTALLATION
2.1 Unpacking and Inspecting the Shipment

Figure 2-1. Unpacking and Inspecting the CDM-625


The CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem, its Installation and Operation Manual, and its power
cord were packaged and shipped in a reusable cardboard carton containing protective foam
spacing.

This equipment contains parts and assemblies sensitive to damage by Electrostatic


Discharge (ESD). Use ESD precautionary procedures when handling the equipment.

21

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Installation MN-CDM625

As shown in Figure 2-1: Once opened, inspect the shipment:

Step Task

1 Keep all shipping materials for storage or reshipment.

2 Check the packing list to ensure the shipment is complete.


Inspect the equipment for any possible damage incurred during shipment.
3
Contact the carrier and Comtech EF Data immediately and submit a damage report if
damage is evident to the shipment.
4 Review the manual carefully to become familiar with operation.
5 Proceed to Sect. 2.2 Installing and Mounting the CDM-625

2.2 Installing Into a Rack Enclosure


When mounting the CDM-625 into a rack enclosure (Figure 2-1):

PROPER GROUNDING PROTECTION IS REQUIRED. The equipment must be


connected to the protective earth connection at all times. It is therefore imperative
that the unit is properly grounded, using the ground stud provided on the unit rear
panel, during installation, configuration, and operation.

In Finland: "Laite on liitettv suojamaadoituskoskettimilla varustettuun


pistorasiaan."

In Norway: Apparatet m tilkoples jordet stikkontakt.

In Sweden: Apparaten skall anslutas till jordat uttag.

PROPER AIR VENTILATION IS REQUIRED. In a rack system where there is high


heat discharge, provide forced-air cooling with top- or bottom-mounted fans or
blowers.

o Make sure there is adequate clearance inside the enclosure, especially at


the side for air ventilation.

o Air temperature inside the rack enclosure should never exceed 50C
(122F).

For information about custom rack enclosures, contact Comtech EF Data


Customer Support during normal business hours or visit Comtech EF Datas Web
site (www.comtechefdata.com/support.asp).

22

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Installation MN-CDM625

The CDM-625 CANNOT have rack slides mounted to the sides of the chassis.
Cooling fans and exhaust vents are provided here air flow must not be
impeded. Comtech EF Data recommends that an alternate method of support is
provided within the rack, such as standard rack shelves or the optional Rear-
Mounting Support Bracket Kit. If there is any doubt, contact Comtech EF Data
Customer Support during normal business hours.

Feature Description
1 Custom Rack Enclosure
2 CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem
3 Standard Rack Shelving
Rack Enclosure Threaded Front
4
Mounting Rail (typical)
5 Unit Front Panel
6 User-supplied Screws

Figure 2-2. Installing the CDM-625 Into a Rack Enclosure


Mount the CDM-625 in its assigned position in the rack enclosure. Use, as required:

A standard rack-mounted shelf;

User-supplied screws to secure the front panel to the rack enclosure threaded front
mounting rails;

Comtech EF Datas optional KT/6228 (4) or KT/6228 (10) Rear-Mounting Support


Brackets Kit (Figure 2-3).

23

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Installation MN-CDM625

2.2.1 Installing the Optional Rear-Mounting Support Brackets Kits

Detail Description
1 Back of modem
2 Rack Enclosure Threaded Rear Mounting Rail (typical)

Kit / Quantity
Item CEFD P/N Description
KT/6228-2 KT/6228-3
1 2 2 HW/10-32SHLDR Shoulder Screw, #10
2 4 4 HW/10-32FLT Flat Washer, #10
3 2 2 HW/10-32SPLIT Lock Washer, #10
4 2 2 HW/10-32HEXNUT Hex Nut, #10
5 4 4 HW/10-32x1/2RK Bolt, #10, Rear Support Bracket
2 FP/6138-2 Bracket, Rear Support 4
6
2 FP/6138-3 Bracket, Rear Support 10

Figure 2-3. Installing the Optional Rear-Mounting Support Brackets Kit

Tools needed to install the optional KT/6228 (4) or KT/6228 (10) Rear-Mounting Support
Brackets Kit:

A medium Phillips screwdriver

A 5/32-inch SAE Allen Wrench

An adjustable Crescent wrench.

24

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Installation MN-CDM625

Follow these steps to install the optional KT/6228 (4) or KT/6228 (10) Rear-Mounting Support
Brackets Kit:

Step Task
Use the #10 flat washers, #10 split washers, and #10 hex nut to secure the #10 shoulder screws to the unit
1
chassis through the rear right and left side mounting slots as shown.
Use the #10 rack bracket bolts to install the rear support brackets onto the rack enclosure threaded rear
2
mounting rails.
Mount the unit into the rack enclosure. Ensure that the shoulders of the #10 shoulder screws properly engage
3
into the rear support bracket slots.

2.3 Configuring the CDM-625

Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION

The unit is shipped with a default 64 kbps, QPSK, Rate 1/2 configuration. There are no internal
jumpers to configure, no interface cards to install, and no other options to install. All
configurations are carried out entirely via the modems installed firmware use the front panel
keypad and display to configure the modem locally.

The auto-sensing AC power supply does not require any adjustments. Simply plug
in the supplied line cord, and turn on the rear panel switch.

2.4 Selecting the Internal IF Loop

Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION Sect. 5.2.2 SELECT: Test Menus

You may quickly verify proper operation of the modem without the need for externally
connected equipment. From the top level menu, select TEST: Mode IF (IF LOOP).The demod
should synchronize, and the Rx TRAFFIC LED should illuminate GREEN. If the unit does not pass
this test, call Comtech EF Datas Customer Support department for assistance.

2.5 Connecting the External Cables

Chapter 3. REAR PANEL CONNECTORS AND PINOUTS

Having verified correct operation via the Internal IF loop test, enter the desired configuration
and then connect all external cables. If difficulties occur, call Comtech EF Datas Customer
Support department for assistance.

25

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Installation MN-CDM625

Notes:

26

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


Chapter 3. REAR PANEL
CONNECTORS A ND PINOUTS
3.1 CDM-625 Rear Panel Overview

Figure 3-1. CDM-625 Rear Panel View


(Top) Standard AC Chassis (CEFD P/N PL/12587-1)
(Bottom) Optional 48V DC Chassis (CEFD P/N PL/12587-2)

The CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modems rear panel, shown in Figure 3-1, provides all
necessary external connections between the modem and other equipment:

Section 3.2 details the cabling connections provided on the rear panel interface,
grouped according to service function. Where applicable, the connectors pinout table is
provided.

Section 3.3 details the CDM-625 grounding and power features.

31

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Rear Panel Connectors and Pinouts MN-CDM625

3.2 CDM-625 Cable Connections


Table 3-1. CDM-625 Rear Panel Cabling Connections
Connector
Name Connector Type Function
Group (Sect)
IF BNC female (70/140MHz band)
Sect. 3.2.1 Rx IF Input
Type N female (L-Band)
BNC female (70/140MHz band)
Tx IF Output
Type N female (L-Band)
Terrestrial Data Data Interface 25-pin Type D female Serial synchronous data input/output
Sect. 3.2.2 G.703, D&I or D&I++;
Balanced G.703 9-pin Type D female
Quad E1 Ports 1 & 2
Auxiliary G.703 9-pin Type D female Quad E1 Ports 3 & 4
Unbalanced Out BNC female Receive G.703 (IDO); ASI
G.703
Data Unbalanced In BNC female Transmit G.703 (DDI);ASI
Insert Data In / Sub-rate Auxiliary Tx
IDI BNC female
G.703 In
Drop Data Output / Sub-rate Auxiliary Rx
DDO BNC female
G.703 Out
10/100 Ethernet (4X) RJ-45 female 10/100 Base-T management and data
44-pin High Density Type D
IDR Data/Alarms/Audio Intelsat Open Network auxiliary signals
female
ESC 9-pin Type D female ESC Input/output (RS232/485)
Utility Remote Control 9-pin Type D male Serial Remote Interface (RS232/485)
Sect. 3.2.3 Alarms 15-pin Type D male Form C Alarms (relay closures)
PMSI 9-pin Type D female Pre-Mapped Symbol Interface (CnC)
1:1 Control 9-pin Type D female Connection to External 1:1 Controller
External Reference BNC female Input/output
The European EMC Directive 2004/108/EEC (EN 55022, EN 50024) requires using properly
shielded cables for DATA I/O. These cables must be double-shielded from end-to-end,
ensuring a continuous ground shield.

32

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Rear Panel Connectors and Pinouts MN-CDM625

3.2.1 IF Connection Group

There may be DC voltages present on the Type N Rx and Tx IF connectors, up to a


maximum of 48 volts.

3.2.1.1 Rx IF Connectors

Connector Type Description Direction


Type N Rx IF signal, L- band
In
BNC Rx IF signal, 70/140 MHz band

3.2.1.2 Tx IF Connectors

Connector Type Description Direction


Type N Tx IF signal, L- band
Out
BNC Tx IF signal, 70/140 MHz band

33

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Rear Panel Connectors and Pinouts MN-CDM625

3.2.2 Terrestrial Data Connection Group

3.2.2.1 Data Interface (DB-25F)


The Data Interface connector is a 25-pin, Type D female interface that
conducts data input and output signals to and from the modem, and
connects to customers terrestrial equipment, breakout panel, or
protection switch.

Table 3-2. Data Interface Connector Pinouts

Pin # EIA-422 Circuit


Generic Signal Description Direction V.35 HSSI LVDS
(R-L) EIA 530 #

1 Shield Shield FG Shield Shield 101


14 Transmit Data B DTE to Modem SD B SD B SD B SD B 103
2 Transmit Data A DTE to Modem SD A SD A SD A SD A 103
15 Internal Transmit Clock A Modem to DTE ST A SCT A ST A ST A 114
3 Receive Data A Modem to DTE RD A RD A RD A RD A 104
16 Receive Data B Modem to DTE RD B RD B RD B RD B 104
4 Request to Send A * DTE to Modem RS A RTS TA A 105
17 Receive Clock A Modem to DTE RT A SCR A RT A RT A 115
5 Clear to Send A * Modem to DTE CS A CTS 106
18 (NOTE 2)
6 Data Set Ready A (NOTE 2) Modem to DTE DM A DSR
19 Request to Send B * DTE to Modem RS B - TA B 105
7 Signal Ground SG SG SG SG 102
20 (NOTE 2)
8 Receiver Ready A Modem to DTE RR A RLSD CA A RR A 109
21 (NOTE 2)
9 Receive Clock B Modem to DTE RT B SCR B RT B RT B 115
22 Data Set Ready B (NOTE 2) Modem to DTE DM B
10 Receiver Ready B Modem to DTE RR B CA B RR B 109
23 (NOTE 2)
11 Transmit Clock B DTE to Modem TT B SCTE B TT B TT B 113
24 Transmit Clock A DTE to Modem TT A SCTE A TT A TT A 113
12 Internal Transmit Clock B Modem to DTE ST B SCT B ST B ST B 114
25 (NOTE 2)
13 Clear to Send B * Modem to DTE CS B 106

Notes:

1. When t he r ear-panel LE D m arked 1:N A ctive! i s OFF, al l of t he s ignals s hown abov e ar e av ailable and f unctional. I n
addition, pi ns not s hown are not connected, and therefore no damage will oc cur i f ot her signals ar e c onnected to the
additional pins.

34

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Rear Panel Connectors and Pinouts MN-CDM625

2. When the rear-panel LED marked 1:N Active! is ON, the signals shown highlighted are no longer available. Furthermore,
pins 6, 18, 20, 21, 22, 23 and 25 are reserved for use by the 1:N system. DO NOT connect signals to any of these pins in
this mode. Certain pins have DC voltages present that may damage equipment other than a Comtech EF Data redundancy
switch.

3. For X.21 operation, use the EIA-422 pins, but ignore Receive Clock if the Modem is DTE, and ignore Transmit clocks if the
Modem is DCE.

4. For IDR operation using G.703, this primary interface becomes the 8 kbps EIA-422 overhead channel.

3.2.2.1.1 HSSI Operation via the CIC-60 Interface Adapter Module


For HSSI operation (Tx, Rx, or both), the optional CIC-60 Interface Adapter Module (Figure 3-2)
may be purchased from Comtech EF Data to adapt the Data Interface 25-pin Type D female
connection to a standard 50-pin Type HD HSSI (SCSI-II) female connection.

See Table 3-3 for the pinouts for the HSSI/EIA-613 side of the CIC-60 Adapter Module.

The modem must first be configured for the appropriate HSSI operation, via the
CDM-625 Front Panel, before using this adapter:

SELECT: Configure Mode


(Select HSSI for both Tx Mode / Interface and Rx Mode / Interface)

Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION

CIC-60 Interface Adapter Module CIC-60 Interface Adapter Module


(Modem Interface Side) (Installed, HSSI Interface Side Shown)

Figure 3-2. CIC-60 Interface Adapter Module (CEFD P/N PL-0000307)

35

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Rear Panel Connectors and Pinouts MN-CDM625

Table 3-3. CIC-60 Module HSSI/EIA-613 Side Connector Pinouts


Pin # Circuit
Signal Function HSSI Signal EIA-613 Circuit Comment
(+,-) Direction
1, 26 Signal Ground SG 102 Ground
2, 27 Receive Timing RT 115 From DCE
3, 28 DCE Available CA 107 From DCE
4, 29 Receive Data RD 104 From DCE
5, 30 Loopback circuit C LC undefined From DCE Not used
6, 31 Send Timing ST 114 From DCE
7, 32 Signal Ground SG 102 Ground
8, 33 DTE Available TA 108/2 to DCE
9, 34 Terminal Timing TT 113 to DCE
10, 35 Loopback circuit A LA 143 to DCE Not used
11, 36 Send Data SD 103 to DCE
12, 37 Loopback Circuit B LB 144 to DCE Not used
13, 38 Signal Ground SG 102 Ground
14, 39 Not used undefined Not used
15, 40 TX DVALID undefined Not used
16, 41 Reserved (to DCE) Not used
17, 42 Reserved (to DCE) Not used
18, 43 Reserved (to DCE) Not used
19, 44 Signal Ground SG 102 Ground
20 undefined Not used
45 undefined Not used
21 undefined Not used
46 Reserved (to DTE) Not used
22, 47 undefined from DCE Not used
23, 48 undefined from DCE Not used
24, 49 Test Mode TM 142 from DCE Not used
25, 50 Signal Ground SG 102 Ground

36

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Rear Panel Connectors and Pinouts MN-CDM625

3.2.2.2 G.703 Connectors

3.2.2.2.1 Balanced G.703 (DB-9F)


The Balanced G.703 connector is a 9-pin Type D female connector. It is
used for single port G.703, D&I or D&I++. When used with Quad E1
operations, this connector serves Ports 1 and 2 of the Quad E1 interface.

Table 3-4. Balanced G.703 Connector Pinouts


Pin # Signal Function Signal Function Signal Function
(R-L) Serial G.703 D&I or D&I++ Quad D&I
1 Rx out - IDO - Port 2 Rx Out -
6 Rx out + IDO + Port 2 Rx Out +
2 IDI - Port 2 Tx In -
7 IDI + Port 2 Tx In +
3 GND GND GND
8 DDO + Port 1 Rx Out +
4 DDO - Port 1 Rx Out -
9 DDI - Port 1 Tx In -
5 Tx in + DDI + Port 1 Tx In +

3.2.2.2.2 Aux G.703 (DB-9F)

The Auxiliary G.703 connector is a 9-pin Type D female connector. When


used with Quad E1 operations, this connector serves Ports 3 and 4 of the
Quad E1 interface.

Table 3-5. Auxiliary G.703 Connector Pinouts


Pin # Signal Function Signal Function Signal Function
(R-L) Serial G.703 D&I or D&I++ Quad D&I
1 Port 4 Rx out -
6 Port 4 Rx out +
2 Port 4 Tx in -
7 Port 4 Tx in +
3 GND
8 Port 3 Rx out -
4 Port 3 Rx out +
9 Port 3 Tx in -
5 Port 3 Tx in +

37

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Rear Panel Connectors and Pinouts MN-CDM625

3.2.2.2.3 Quad E1 Operation via the Balanced G.703 / Aux G.703


Connectors
Each adapter cable option provides for two of the four ports of the Quad E1
interface. If all four ports of Quad E1 are needed, the user will need to obtain a
quantity of (2X) of any adapter option.

For Quad E1 operation, optional Comtech EF Data cabling accessories may be purchased from
Comtech EF Data to adapt the Balanced G.703 or Auxiliary G.703 connectors as follows:

Figure CEFD Part No. Converts (1) 9-pin Type D Connector (DB-9F) to:
3-3 CA-0000163 (2) DB-15F connections see Table 3-6 for the connector pinout
3-4 CA-0000164 (2) RJ-48 F connections see Table 3-7 for the connector pinout
KT-0000122 or
3-5 (2) BNC 75 BNC-F connections see Table 3-8 for the connector pinout
KT-0020570

3.2.2.2.3.1 CA-0000163 Adapter Cable

Figure 3-3. CA-0000163 Adapter Cable (DB-9M (2X) DB-15F)


Table 3-6. CA-0000163 Connector Pinouts
Connector Twisted
Signal Function
P1 J1 J2 Pair
5 9 Port 1 or 3 Tx In +
X
9 1 Port 1 or 3 Tx In -
4 11 Port 1 or 3 Rx In +
X
8 3 Port 1 or 3 Rx In -
7 9 Port 2 or 4 Tx In +
X
2 1 Port 2 of 4 Tx In -
6 11 Port 2 or 4 Rx In +
X
1 3 Port 2 or 4 Rx In -
3 2 2 GND

38

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Rear Panel Connectors and Pinouts MN-CDM625

3.2.2.2.3.2 CA-0000164 Adapter Cable

Figure 3-4. CA-0000164 Adapter Cable (DB-9M (2X) RJ-48F)

Table 3-7. CA-0000164 Connector Pinouts


Connector Twisted
Signal Function
P1 J1 J2 Pair
5 1 Port 1 or 3 Tx In +
X
9 2 Port 1 or 3 Tx In -
4 4 Port 1 or 3 Rx In +
X
8 5 Port 1 or 3 Rx In -
7 1 Port 2 or 4 Tx In +
X
2 2 Port 2 of 4 Tx In -
6 4 Port 2 or 4 Rx In +
X
1 5 Port 2 or 4 Rx In -
3 3 3 GND

39

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Rear Panel Connectors and Pinouts MN-CDM625

3.2.2.2.3.3 KT-0000122/KT-0020570 Quad E1 Balanced/Unbalanced Adapter


Cable Kits

Quad E1 Balanced/Unbalanced Adapter Kits


Kit / Quantity
Part Number Description
KT-0000122 KT-0020570
Y-Cable Assembly, 6, DB-9M 2X RJ-48 Male
1 CA-0000347
(See Table 3-8)
Y-Cable Assembly, 3, DB-9M 2X RJ-48 Male
1 CA-0020710
(See Table 3-8)
Bolun Adapter, 2X RJ-48 Female 2X BNC 75
2 2 502-0532-001
Female

Figure 3-5. Quad E1 Balanced/Unbalanced Adapter Cable Kits

Table 3-8. CA-0000347/CA-0020710 Connector Pinouts


P1 PINOUT J1/ J2 TYPICAL WIRE CHART
Connector Twisted
Signal Function PIN WIRE COLOR
P1 J1 J2 Pair
5 1 Port 1 or 3 Tx In + 1 WHITE / ORANGE STRIPE
X
9 2 Port 1 or 3 Tx In - 2 ORANGE
4 4 Port 1 or 3 Rx In + 3 WHITE / GREEN STRIPE
X
8 5 Port 1 or 3 Rx In - 4 BLUE
7 1 Port 2 or 4 Tx In + 5 WHITE / BLUE STRIPE
X
2 2 Port 2 of 4 Tx In - 6 GREEN
6 4 Port 2 or 4 Rx In + 7 WHITE / BROWN STRIPE
X
1 5 Port 2 or 4 Rx In - 8 BROWN
3 3 3 GND

310

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Rear Panel Connectors and Pinouts MN-CDM625

3.2.2.2.4 Unbal G.703 / ASI Out (IDO), In (DDI)

Connector Type Description Direction


G.703 Unbalanced Rx (IDO) / ASI Out
BNC
G.703 Unbalanced Tx (DDI) / ASI In

3.2.2.2.5 G.703 IDI (Insert Data In), DDO (Drop Data Out)

Connector Type Description Direction


IDI (Insert Data Input) In
BNC
DDO (Drop Data Output) Out

3.2.2.3 Quad 10/100 Ethernet (RJ-45)

These are four standard RJ-45 female connectors, operating at 10/100 Mbps, half
and full duplex, auto-negotiating.
\

3.2.2.4 IDR Data / Alarms / Audio (HD-44F)


The IDR Data/Alarms/Audio interface is a 44-pin, high-density Type D
female connector.

Table 3-9. IDR Data/Alarms/Audio Connector Pinouts


Top Center Bottom
Pin # Description Pin # Description Pin # Description
(R-L) (R-L) (R-L)
1 BWA4 out Normally Closed 16 No Connect 31 BWA4 out Normally Open
2 BWA3 out Normally Closed 17 BWA4 out Common 32 BWA3 out Normally Open
3 BWA2 out Normally Closed 18 BWA3 out Common 33 BWA2 out Normally Open
4 BWA1 out Normally Closed 19 BWA2 out Common 34 BWA1 out Normally Open
5 No Connect 20 BWA1 out Common 35 TBD RS-422 A in
6 RS-422 Tx ESC Data A in 21 TBD RS-422 B in 36 RS-422 Tx ESC Data B in
7 RS-422 Tx Octet B out 22 RS-422 Tx Octet A out 37
8 BWA3 in 23 BWA4 in 38 BWA2 in
9 Audio Out 2- 24 BWA1 in 39 Audio Out 2+
10 Audio In 2+ 25 Audio In 2- 40 Audio Out 1-
11 Audio In 1- 26 Audio Out 1+ 41 Audio In 1+
12 RS-422 Tx ESC Clock A out 27 RS-422 Tx ESC Clock B out 42 TBD RS-422 A out
13 RS-422 Rx Octet A out 28 TBD RS-422 B out 43 RS-422 Rx Octet B out
14 RS-422 Rx ESC Clock B out 29 RS-422 Rx ESC Clock A out 44 RS-422 Rx ESC Data A out
15 Ground 30 RS-422 Rx ESC Data B out

311

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Rear Panel Connectors and Pinouts MN-CDM625

3.2.2.5 ESC (DB-9F)

The ESC (Engineering Service Channel) port is a 9-pin Type D female


connector.

Table 3-10. ESC Connector Pinouts


Pin #
Asynchronous Synchronous
(R-L)
1 Ground Ground
6 RS-485 Tx Data B in
2 RS-232 Rx Data out RS-232 Rx Data out
7 RS-485 Tx Data A in
3 RS-232 Tx Data in RS-232 Tx Data in
8 RS-485 Rx Data B out
4 RS-232 Rx Clock out
9 RS-485 Rx Data A out
5 RS-232 Tx Clock out

3.2.3 Utility Connections Group

3.2.3.1 Remote Control (DB-9M)


The Remote Control interface is a 9-pin Type D male connector. It is
intended for connection to an M&C computer or terminal device, and is user
selectable for either EIA-232 or EIA-485.

Table 3-11. Remote Control Connector Pinouts


Pin #
Description Direction
(L-R)
1 Ground
6 EIA-485 Receive Data B * In
2 EIA-232 Transmit Data Out
7 EIA-485 Receive Data A * In
3 EIA-232 Receive Data In
8 EIA-485 Transmit Data B * Out
4 Reserved Do Not Use
9 EIA-485 Transmit Data A * Out
5 Ground
*Use for EIA-485 2-wire operation

312

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Rear Panel Connectors and Pinouts MN-CDM625

3.2.3.2 Alarms (DB-15M)


Unit alarms are provided on this 15-pin Type D male connector.

Table 3-12. Alarm Interface Connector Pinouts


Pin #
Name Signal Function
(L-R)
1 GND Ground
9 EXT-OFF EXT Carrier OFF
2 AGC AGC Voltage (Rx signal level, 0 to 10 Volts)
10 N/A Spare (No connection)
3 RX-Q Rx Q Channel (Constellation Monitor)
11 RX-I RX I Channel (Constellation Monitor)
4 UNIT-COM Unit Fault
12 UNIT-NO Unit Fault (Energized, No Fault)
5 UNIT-NC Unit Fault (De-energized, No Fault)
13 TX-COM Tx Traffic
6 TX-NO Tx Traffic (Energized, No Fault)
14 TX-NC Tx Traffic (De-energized, No Fault)
7 RX-COM Rx Traffic
15 RX-NO Rx Traffic (Energized, No Fault)
8 RX-NC Rx Traffic (De-energized, No Fault)

3.2.3.3 PMSI Connector, DB-9F


The PMSI (Pre-Mapped Symbol interface) is a 9-pin Type D female
connector. The PMSI is an EIA-485 multidrop bus system, used in tandem
with Carrier-in-Carrier (CnC), where one device transmits, and all other
devices on the multidrop bus are configured to receive.

Table 3-13. PMSI (Pre-Mapped Symbol Interface) Connector Pinouts


Pin #
Description Direction
(R-L)
1 Ground
6 Spare (No connection)
2 Spare (No connection)
7 PMSI symbol clock RS485 - In/Out
3 PMSI symbol clock RS485 + In/Out
8 PMSI LSB RS485 - In/Out
4 PMSI LSB RS485 + In/Out
9 PMSI MSB RS485 - In/Out
5 PMSI MSB RS485 + In/Out

313

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Rear Panel Connectors and Pinouts MN-CDM625

3.2.3.4 1:1 Control (DB-9F)

The 1:1 Control connector is intended only for connection to a CRS-170A or CRS-180
Redundancy Switch.

The 1:1 Control connector is a 9-pin Type D female connector.

Table 3-14. 1:1 Control Interface Connector Pinouts


Pin #
Description Direction
(R-L)
1 Ground
6 Transmit Serial Data auxiliary channel Out
2 Receive Serial Data auxiliary channel In
7 Redundancy Out 1 Out
3 Redundancy In 1 In
8 Redundancy Out 2 Out
4 Redundancy In 2 In
9 Fused +12 volt Out Out
5 Ground

3.2.3.5 Ext Ref In/Out

Connector Type Description Direction


BNC External Reference In/Out

314

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Rear Panel Connectors and Pinouts MN-CDM625

3.3 CDM-625 Ground and Power Connections

3.3.1 Chassis Ground Interface


PROPER GROUNDING PROTECTION IS REQUIRED. The equipment must be connected
to the protective earth connection at all times. It is therefore imperative that the unit
is properly grounded, using the ground stud provided on the unit rear panel, during
installation, configuration, and operation.

Figure 3-6. CDM-625 Chassis Ground Interface


(T op) S tandard AC C has s is (C E F D P /N P L /12587-1)
(B ottom) Optional 48V DC C has s is (C E F D P /N P L /12587-2)

Use the #10-32 stud, located adjacent to the power interface, for connecting a
common chassis ground among equipment.

The AC power interface provides the safety ground.

315

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Rear Panel Connectors and Pinouts MN-CDM625

3.3.2 Standard 100V/240V Alternating Current (AC) Power Interface

Feature Description
1 On / Off Switch
2 Press-fit Fuse Holder
3 IEC-60320 Type C14 Three-prong Connector

AC Power Specifications
48 watts (typical with TPC/LDPC Codec and
CnC module installed), 68 watts (max)
Input Power 280 watts (typical TPC/LDPC Codec, CnC
module and 48 volt BUC supply installed),
300 watts (max)
100V to 240V AC, +6%/-10%, autosensing
Input Voltage (total absolute max. range is 90V to 264V
AC)
Connection Type IEC-60320 Type C13/C14
Line and neutral fusing
Fuse Protection (2X) 5mm x 20mm Slow-blow type fuses:
T4A ( 250V AC operation)

Figure 3-7. CDM-625 Standard AC Chassis (CEFD P/N PL/12587-1)

3.3.2.1 AC Operation CDM-625 Accessories


Contact your Comtech EF Data sales representative during normal business hours to purchase
any of these available accessories:

CEFD P/N Description


KT-0020703 AC to 24V DC Conversion Kit
KT-0000226 AC to 48V DC Conversion Kit
KT-0000283 AC Primary Power Supply: 100-240 VAC (65W Power Supply) w/required cables
KT-0020701 AC Primary Power Supply: 100-240 VAC (175W Power Supply) w/required cables
PS-0000075 AC 65W Power Supply
PS-0000065 AC 175W Power Supply
CA/17725 AC Power Cord, Standard (IEC-60320 Type C13) USA
CA/90025-5FT AC Power Jumper Cord, Standard (IEC-60320 Type C13)
KT/11633-1 AC Power Cord Retainer Kit (for any AC Cord)
CA/17850 AC Power Cord European / French
PP-0000097 AC Power Cord Japanese
PP-0020556 AC Power Cord India

316

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Rear Panel Connectors and Pinouts MN-CDM625

3.3.2.2 AC Operation Applying Power

Figure 3-8. Applying AC Power to the CDM-625

To apply AC power to the CDM-625 (Figure 3-8):

First, plug the provided AC power cord female end into the unit.

Then, plug the AC power cord male end into the user-supplied power source.

Finally, switch the unit ON.

3.3.2.3 AC Operation Replacing Fuses


For AC operation the CDM-625 uses two common 5mm x 20mm Slow-blow fuses one each for
line and neutral connections. The fuses are contained within a fuse holder that is press-fit into
the body of the IEC power module (located on the rear panel, Figure 3-9).

Figure 3-9. Replacing CDM-625 AC Fuses

To replace the fuse(s):

DISCONNECT THE POWER SUPPLY BEFORE PROCEEDING!

First, unseat the fuse holder from the IEC power module.

317

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Rear Panel Connectors and Pinouts MN-CDM625

o Use the slot to pry the holder outward from the IEC power module.

o Pull the holder straight out, and then swing the holder away from the module.

Then, remove and replace the T4A (4 Amp) fuses as needed.

FOR CONTINUED OPERATOR SAFETY, ALWAYS REPLACE THE FUSES WITH THE
CORRECT TYPE AND RATING.

Finally, reseat the fuse holder in the IEC power module.

3.3.3 Optional 48V Direct Current (DC) Power Interface

This DC input design supersedes the configuration featured on modems built prior
to May 2009.

Feature Description
1 On / Off Switch
2 Power Terminal Block
3 Screw-in Fuse Holders / Receptacles

DC Power Specifications
48 watts (typical with TPC/LDPC Codec and CnC
module installed), 68 watts (max)
Input Power
280 watts (typical TPC/LDPC Codec, CnC module
and 48 volt BUC supply installed), 300 watts (max)
43 60 VDC Nominal
Input Voltage
36 60 VDC Maximum
Connector Type Terminal Block
(2X) 5mm x 20mm Slow-blow type fuses:
Fuse Protection Modem Fuse: 3Amp/250Volts
BUC Fuse: 6.3 Amp/250 Volts

Figure 3-10. CDM-625 Optional DC Chassis (CEFD P/N PL/12587-2)

318

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Rear Panel Connectors and Pinouts MN-CDM625

3.3.3.1 Optional DC Operation CDM-625 Accessories


Contact your Comtech EF Data sales representative during normal business hours to purchase
any of these available accessories:

CEFD P/N Description


KT-0020683 DC to AC Conversion Kit for CDM-625 Base Modem
KT-0020680 DC to AC Conversion Kit for CDM-625 with IP Packet Processor
KT-0000282 DC Primary Power Supply: -48 VDC, w/required cables
PS-0000066 DC 48V 125W Power Supply
PS-0020545 DC 24V 120W Power Supply
CA-0000455 DC Pigtail Adapter
KT/9640-3 BUC Power Supply: 24 VDC 90W (50 C) (100-240 VAC Input)
KT-0000029 BUC Power Supply: 48 VDC 150W (50 C) (100-240 VAC Input)
KT-0000185 BUC Power Supply: 24 VDC 90W (50 C) (-48 VDC Input)
KT-0000186 BUC Power Supply: 48 VDC 150W (50 C) (-48 VDC Input)

3.3.3.2 Optional DC Operation Applying Power

Figure 3-11. Applying Power to the CDM-625 Optional DC Chassis

To apply DC power to the CDM-625:

First, connect the user-supplied (+) and () DC power leads to their respective terminals.
Number 18 AWG minimum wires are recommended.

Then, connect the user-supplied DC power leads to the power source.

Finally, switch the unit ON.

319

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Rear Panel Connectors and Pinouts MN-CDM625

3.3.3.3 Optional DC Operation Replacing Fuses


For DC operation the CDM-625 requires two different fuses that are contained within the
individual screw-in receptacles below the terminal block (located on the rear panel, Figure
3-12).

Figure 3-12. Replacing CDM-625 Optional DC Chassis Fuses

To replace the fuses:

DISCONNECT THE POWER SUPPLY BEFORE PROCEEDING!

First, unscrew either fuse holder from its receptacle. Then, remove and replace the modem
and/or the BUC fuse(s):

o Use T3A (3 Amp) 250V fuses for modem operation (left-hand receptacle).

o Use T6.3A (6.3 Amp) 250V fuses when a Block Upconverter (BUC) is installed (right-hand
receptacle).

FOR CONTINUED OPERATOR SAFETY, ALWAYS REPLACE THE FUSES WITH


THE CORRECT TYPE AND RATING.

Screw either fuse holder back into its receptacle.

320

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


Chapter 4. UPDATING FIRMWARE
4.1 Updating Firmware via Internet

TO ENSURE OPTIMAL PERFORMANCE, IT IS IMPORTANT TO OPERATE THE CDM-625


WITH ITS LATEST AVAILABLE FIRMWARE.

The CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem is factory-shipped with its latest version of operating
firmware. If a firmware update is needed, once Ethernet connectivity has been established with
the unit, the update can be downloaded from the Comtech EF Data Web site
(www.comtechefdata.com), or obtained through Comtech EF Data Customer Support via e-mail
or on CD by standard mail delivery.

The CDM-625 Firmware Update process is as follows:

Perform the update without opening the CDM-625 by connecting the rear panel serial
Remote Control port or 10/100 Ethernet port to a serial or 10/100 BaseT Ethernet port
of the user PC.

Download the firmware update via the Internet to the user PC.

Transfer the firmware update, via File Transfer Protocol (FTP), from the user PC to the
CDM-625.

4.2 About Firmware Files, Naming, Versions, and Archive Formats


Comtech EF Datas Web site catalogues its firmware update
files by product type (e.g., modem, converter, etc.) and
specific model/optional configuration. The hyperlinks appear
as per the example to the right. This example depicts the
F0020534*_V### base modem bulk firmware download
hyperlink (where ### indicates the firmware version
number, and * denotes the revision letter of that version).

In addition to this base modem bulk firmware archive file, downloads are available for the
CDM-625s optional IP Packet Processor Module, available with or without AES Encryption. This
module requires separate firmware update.

41

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Updating Firmware MN-CDM625

Firmware updates are available from Comtech EF Data per the following table:

Web Hyperlink EXE/ZIP Filename Contains Image File ( where * denotes revision letter)
Fw12864*.bin
F12864*_V### FW12864*
Base modem firmware up to FW Version 1.6.0
Fw-0020534*.bin
F0020534*_V### Fw-0020534*
Base modem firmware from FW Version 2.0.1 to current
FW-0000342*.bin
F0000342*_V### FW0000342*
IP Packet Processor Module option without AES Encryption.
FW-0000438*.bin
CONTACT CEFD FW0000438*
IP Packet Processor Module option with AES Encryption.

Only firmware for the CDM-625 base modem and IP Packet Processor Module
without AES Encryption is available for download from the CEFD Web site. To
obtain the firmware update for the CDM-625 IP Packet Processor Module with
AES Encryption, contact Network Product Customer Support:

Phone: 480.333.2433
E-mail: cdmipsupport@comtechefdata.com.

The firmware download files are available from Comtech EF Data in two archive file formats:
*.exe (self extracting) and *.zip (compressed). Some firewalls will not allow the downloading of
*.exe files; in this case, download the *.zip file instead. If applicable, one version prior to the
current release is also available for download.

For additional help with "zipped" file types, refer to the help files provided with the
"PKZIP for Windows", "WinZip", or "ZipCentral" file archiving programs. PKZIP for
Command-line is not supported due to file naming conventions.

To verify the correct firmware number, see Step 2 in Sect. 4.3.1 Getting Started: Preparing for
the Firmware Download.

42

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Updating Firmware MN-CDM625

4.3 Firmware Update Procedure

4.3.1 Getting Started: Preparing for the Firmware Download

Step Task
1 Connect the Windows-based user PC to the CDM-625:

Connect the appropriate modem Ethernet port either via a hub or a switch or directly with an Ethernet or
crossover cable. Make sure that a compatible web browser is running on the PC.

Connect the modem Remote Control port to a serial port on the PC. Make sure that a terminal emulator
program such as Hyper Terminal is running on the PC.

2 Identify the CDM-625 configuration in use, and its firmware number and current version:

A. For the CDM-625 Base Modem, the firmware number and running version can be obtained as follows:

From the modem front panel The firmware version is available from the VFDs top-level splash screen. To
view this screen, press the [CLEAR] key several times.

The firmware numbers are provided within the SELECT: UTIL Firmware Info Image#1 or
Image#2 menu screens. For more information, see Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION.

From HTTP via the Base Modem Web Server Interface The Bootrom, Bulk1 and Bulk2 firmware loads may
be viewed on the Admin | Firmware | Base Modem page. For more information, see Chapter 6.5. Web
Server (HTTP) Interface.

Using serial Remote Control query The firmware number, versions, and revision level can be queried as
follows:

Abbreviated: <0/SWR> or:

Detailed: <0/FRW?x (where: x = B (Boot), 1 (Image 1) or 2 (Image 2))

For more information, see Appendix D. SERIAL REMOTE CONTROL.

B. For the CDM-625 with installed IP Packet Processor, the firmware number and running version can be
obtained as follows:

From the modem front panel Select the Utilities: Firmware Packet-Processor Info Image#1 or
Image#2 menu trees. For more information, see Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION.

From HTTP via the Base Modem Web Server Interface Select the Admin | Firmware | Packet Processor
page. The Bootrom, Bulk1 and Bulk2 firmware loads may be viewed here. For more information, see Chapter 6.5
Web Server (HTTP) Interface.

Using serial Remote Control query Use the IP Packet Processors firmware revision query <0/VS1? (Image
1) or <0/VS2? (Image 2).

For more information, see Appendix D. REMOTE CONTROL.

43

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Updating Firmware MN-CDM625

Step Task
3 Create a temporary folder (subdirectory) on the user PC for the firmware archive file download.

Drive letter c: is used in these examples. Any valid, writable drive letter can be used.

Typical for all tasks: Type the command without quotes, and then press Enter to execute.

A temporary folder may be created on a Windows-based PC using differing methods:

A. Use the Windows Desktop to create and rename the temporary folder.

Right-click anywhere on the desktop to open the popup submenu, and then select New > Folder to create the
temporary folder. The New Folder will be created on the desktop.

Right-click on the New Folder and then select Rename from the popup submenu. Rename this folder to
"temp" or some other convenient, unused name.

B. Use Windows Command-line to create the temporary folder.

First, click [Start] on the Windows taskbar, and then click the Run... icon (or, depending on Windows OS
versions prior to Windows 95, click the MS-Command-line Prompt icon from the Main Menu).

Next, open a Command-line window

o For Windows 95 or Windows 98, type command.

o For any Windows OS versions later than Windows 98, type cmd or command.

o Alternately, from [Start], select All Programs > Accessories > Command Prompt.

Finally, from the Command-line prompt (c:\>), type mkdir temp or md temp (mkdir and md stand for
make directory), and then click [OK].

C. Use the Run and Browse windows to create and rename the temporary folder.

Select [Start] on the Windows taskbar, and then click the Run... icon. The Run window will open.

Click [Browse] in the Run window. The Browse window will open.

Click the Create New Folder icon in the Browse window. The New Folder will be created.

Right-click the New Folder folder name, and then rename this folder to temp or some other convenient,
unused name.

There should now be a "temp" folder created and available for placement of the firmware archive file
download.

44

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Updating Firmware MN-CDM625

4.3.2 Downloading and Extracting the Firmware Update

Step Task
1 Download the correct firmware archive file to the user PC temporary folder.

A. Go online to www.comtechefdata.com.

B. On the Main page under Support Information or the Support tab, select the Software Downloads hyperlink.

C. On the Software Downloads page click Download Flash and Software Update Files.

D. On the Flash & Software Update Files page select the (Select a Product Line) Modems hyperlink.

E. On the Modems product page select the CDM-625 product hyperlink.

F. Select the appropriate firmware EXE or ZIP download hyperlink (i.e. the CDM-625 Base Modem, or the CDM-
625 with IP Packet Processor without AES Encryption; otherwise, contact CEFD Network Product Customer
Support to obtain the firmware download for the IP Packet Processor with AES Encryption).

Refer to the table in Sect. 4.2 About Firmware Numbers, File Versions, and Formats in this chapter for the
naming and availability of the firmware download hyperlinks, archive files, and downloaded image files.

G. Download the archive file to the temporary folder.

Once the EXE or ZIP hyperlink is selected, the File Download window opens and prompts selection of
[Open] or [Save]:

Click [Open] to turn over file extraction to the user-supplied utility program. Be sure to extract the
firmware files to the temp folder created earlier.

Click [Save] to open the Save As window. Be sure to select and [Save] the *.exe or *.zip archive file to
the temp folder created earlier.

Otherwise, click [Cancel] to quit and exit the file download process.

2 Extract the firmware files from the downloaded *.exe or *.zip archive file with the user-supplied utility program (if not
already done with File Download > [Open]).

A. For the Base Modem update, a minimum of two files should be extracted:

Fw12864*.bin or Fw-0020534*.bin The base modem bulk image file (where * is the revision letter).

CDM625_ReleaseNotes_v###.pdf (or a variation of this filename, where ### is the firmware version).

B. For the IP Packet Processor update, a minimum of two files should be extracted:

Without AES FW-0000342*.bin (where * is the revision letter) or

With AES FW000438x.bin (where * is the revision letter).

CDM625_ #.#.#_ReleaseNotes.pdf (or a variation of this filename, where #.#.# is the firmware
version).

45

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Updating Firmware MN-CDM625

Step Task
3 Confirm availability of the firmware files in the temporary folder. There are a number of ways the user may view the
contents of the temporary folder on a Windows-based PC:

A. From the Windows Desktop:

Double-left-click the temp folder saved to the Windows Desktop.

Use Windows Explorer to locate, and then double-left-click the temp folder.

Use the Browse window ([Start] > ...Run > [Browse]) to locate, and then double-click the c:\temp
folder.

B. Using Command-line:

Type cd c:\temp at the prompt to change to the temporary directory created earlier using Command-
line.

Type dir to list the files extracted to the temporary directory from the downloaded archive file.

The firmware files have been successfully downloaded to the user PC and are now available for FTP
upload to the CDM-625.

46

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Updating Firmware MN-CDM625

4.3.3 Executing the Ethernet FTP Upload Procedure


Important note about firmware updates: When updating the CDM-625 firmware to
the current (e.g., Fw-0020534X Version 2.3.1) release from FW/12864AC Version 1.5.3 or
lower, the firmware update MUST be FTPd three times (3X) in order to program it
correctly into both images.

After each FTP, the active image MUST be switched, and the modem MUST be rebooted
from the other image.

Step Task
1 Verify that the Base Modem firmware update has been downloaded to the user PC and is available in the temporary
folder, and ensure that the user PC is properly connected to the CDM-625.
2 Confirm that there is proper connection and communication between the user PC and the modem.
First, determine the IP Address as follows:
Using the front panel SELECT: CONFIG IP Addresses Add/Range
Using serial Remote Control query <0/IPA?
Then, use Command-line to ping the modem:
From Windows, click [Start] on the Windows toolbar, and then select the Run... option (as an alternative, use
the Command-line Prompt or Command Prompt icon in the Start menu):
o Using Win95 or Win98 Type command.
o Using WinNT, Win2K or WinXP Type cmd.
Type ping xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx at the Command-line prompt (where "xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx" is the CDM-625 IP Address). The
results should confirm whether or not the modem is connected and communicating.
3 Use Command-line to initiate the FTP session with the CDM-625.
A. Type "ftp xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx" (where "xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx" is the CDM-625 IP Address).
B. If the optional IP Packet Processor is installed and enabled, enter the User Name and Password when
prompted. Otherwise, press ENTER.
C. Type "bin" to set the binary transfer mode.
D. Type "prompt", and then type "hash" to facilitate the file upload.

4 Upload the file:


If the IP Packet Processor is not installed or is installed but disabled, type "put Fw-0020534*.bin bulk:"
(where * denotes the revision letter) to begin the file transfers the destination bulk: must be all lower
case.

If the IP Packet Processor is installed and enabled, type put Fw-0020534*.bin (i.e., as per Step 3(A)
but without typing the destination bulk:).

For either selection, it will take a few seconds to transfer the file.

47

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Updating Firmware MN-CDM625

Step Task
5 Observe the file upload process:

A. The PC should report that the file transfer has occurred, and the CDM-625 front panel will display:

Programming bulk flash (Block ID)


Please wait

B. The process sequences through several blocks this will take several minutes. When it has finished, the
CDM-625 front panel will display:

Bulk FTP done. Press CLEAR.

C. Type bye to terminate the FTP session, and then close the Command-line window.

D. Verify that the new firmware version has uploaded using any of the methods described in Step 2 in Sect.
4.3.1.

E. If you are running a CDM-625 Base Modem without the optional IP Packet Processor, you may now
reboot the system to activate the new firmware. However, if you are running a CDM-625 equipped
with the optional IP Packet Processor installed, do NOT reboot at this time proceed to Step 6 to
continue the Ethernet FTP Upload Procedure.

From the Admin| Reboot web page, click [Reboot Now]. Both the web page and the CDM-625 front panel
will display Rebooting, Please wait...

The system reboot has completed once the CDM-625 front panel displays the top-level splash screen:

Comtech CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem


Ver2.3.1

You will need to log in to a new Web session at this time.

If you are a Base Modem user, the CDM-625 is now operating with its latest firmware. The firmware update
process is now complete.
6 Upgrading the IP Packet Processor:

Use Command-line to initiate the FTP session with the modem.

A. Type "ftp xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx" (where "xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx" is the CDM-625 IP Address).

B. Enter the Admin User Name and Password to complete login.

C. Type "bin" to set the binary transfer mode.

Type "prompt", and then type "hash" to facilitate the file upload.

7 Upload the firmware file from the temporary folder on the user PC:

Type put FW#######*.bin (where ####### is the designated image FW file number 0000342 or 0000438
and * is the revision letter) to begin the file upload.

It will take several minutes to transfer and write the files to flash memory.

48

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Updating Firmware MN-CDM625

Step Task
8 Observe the file upload process:

A. The PC should report that the file transfer has occurred, and the display on the modem will report:

Packet Processor upgrading Bootrom


Please wait

Followed by:

Packet Processor upgrading Image


Please wait

B. The process will complete in less than a minute. When it has finished, the modem front panel will display:

Packet Processor upgrade complete


Press CLEAR to continue.

C. Type "bye" to terminate the FTP session, and then close the Command-line window.

D. Verify that the new file has loaded into its designated Image slot by viewing the Admin | Firmware | Packet
Processor web page (as per Step 2 in Sect. 4.3.1). Press the PCs F5 key to ensure that the web page has
properly refreshed.

E. Change the desired image to boot using the Admin | Firmware | Packet Processor web page: Use the
Boot From drop-down menu to boot the system from Latest (or the Image slot that was automatically
selected for the FTP upload) then click [Submit] to save this change.

F. Use the Admin| Reboot web page to reboot the system to activate the new firmware:

Click [Reboot Now]. Both the web page and the CDM-625 front panel will display Rebooting, Please wait...
If the Top Card Application has been changed, when booting into a new image an
additional step will occur as the modem downloads to a different flash memory. This
additional upload takes approximately two minutes. The following messages will appear
on the CDM-625 front panel display:

Programming Top-App to Top Card Flash.


Please wait

Followed by:

Send packet xxx of yyy to Top Card.


Please wait

Then:

Top Card programming was successfully


completed.

49

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Updating Firmware MN-CDM625

Step Task
8 G. The system reboot has completed once the CDM-625 front panel displays the top-level splash screen:
(cont.)
Comtech CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem
PktP present Ver2.3.1

You will need to log in to a new Web session at this time.

The Ethernet FTP Upload Procedure is now complete. The CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem is now
operating with its current firmware.

410

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL
OPERATION

5.1 Introduction

See Chapter
Feature Description Function
Section...
1 LED Indicators The LEDs indicate, in a summary fashion, the status of the modem. 5.1.1
The keypad comprises six individual keyswitches. The keys have a
positive click action that provides tactile feedback. Enter data via
2 Keypad 5.1.2
the k eypad. D ata, pr ompts, and m essages ar e di splayed on t he
VFD.
The VFD i s an ac tive di splay s howing t wo l ines of 40 characters
Vacuum
each. It produces a blue light with adjustable brightness. Nested
3 Fluorescent 5.1.3
menus (Figure 5-2) display all available options and prompt you to
Display (VFD)
carry out a required action.

Figure 5-1. CDM-625 Front Panel Features

51

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.1.1 LED Indicators


In general, the Alarm relay state reflects the state of
the Front Panel LEDs. For example, if the Unit Status
LED is red, the Unit Alarm relay is active, etc. The
sole exception is the Transmit Traffic relay it does
not reflect the state of the Tx carrier; it activates
only if a Transmit Traffic Fault exists.

The function of the eight front panel LED indicators is as follows:

LED State Function

Green No Unit Faults or Traffic Faults.

UNIT STATUS Orange No Unit Faults, but a Traffic Fault exists.

Red A Unit Fault exists (Example: PSU fault).

Tx (Transmit) Green No Tx Traffic Faults.


TRAFFIC Off A Tx Traffic fault exists OR the Tx Carrier is in OFF state.

Rx (Receive) Green No Rx Traffic Faults (demod and Viterbi decoder are locked, everything is OK).
TRAFFIC Off An Rx Traffic fault exists (the demod may still be OK).

Green The Unit is Online and carrying traffic.


ONLINE The Unit is Offline (Standby) forced by externally connected 1:1 or 1:N
Off
redundancy system.
There is a Stored Event in the log, which can be viewed from the front panel, or
Orange
STORED EVENT retrieved via the remote control interface.
Off There are no Stored Events.

Orange The Unit is in Remote Mode local monitoring is possible, but no local control.
ODU control has been enabled, and there is a communications fault, or there is
REMOTE Flashing
an ODU status fault.
The Unit is in Local Mode remote monitoring is possible, but no remote
Off
control.
Framing on, EDMAC on, and unit defined as Slave local monitoring is
Orange
EDMAC MODE possible, but no local control.
Off No EDMAC, EDMAC Master, or Transparent mode is selected.

Orange A Test Mode is selected (Example: IF Loopback).


TEST MODE
Off There is no Test Mode currently selected.

52

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.1.2 Keypad
The keypad has an auto-repeat feature. If you hold
down a key for more than one second, the key action
repeats, automatically, at the rate of 15 keystrokes per
second. This is particularly useful when editing numeric
field with many digits, such as frequency or data rate.

The function of the keypad is as follows:

Key Description
Use t his k ey to di splay t he ne sted m enu f or a s elected function, or t o ex ecute ( save) a
ENTER
configuration change.
Use t his ke y t o back out of a s election or t o c ancel a c onfiguration c hange t hat has not been
CLEAR
executed using ENTER. Press CLEAR to return to the previous menu screen.
Use these keys to navigate between available selections, or to move the cursor position, on any
(Left, Right) menu screen.
Use these keys primarily to change the alphanumeric selection ( i.e., numbers for configuration

data, l etters f or t ext s trings) at t he c urrent c ursor pos ition, o r to s croll t hrough pr e-defined
(Up, Down)
parameter settings that may be provided at the current cursor position.

53

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.1.3 Vacuum Fluorescent Display (VFD)


The CDM-625 features a Vacuum
Fluorescent Display (VFD). The VFD is
an active display showing two lines of
40 characters each. It produces a blue
light with adjustable brightness. Compared to a Liquid Crystal Display (LCD), the VCD provides
superior viewing characteristics and does not suffer problems of viewing angle or contrast.

On most menu screens, you will observe a flashing solid block cursor, which blinks at a once-per-
second rate. This indicates the currently selected menu item, digit, or field. Where this solid
block cursor would obscure the item being edited (e.g., a numeric field) the cursor automatically
changes to an underline cursor.

5.1.3.1 Screen Saver


If the operating unit is left displaying
the same screen for weeks at a time,
the VFD could become burnt with this
image. To prevent such burn-in, a
screen saver feature activates after one hour. The screen saver messages loop from right to left
across the screen. The top line of the display shows the user-editable Circuit ID; the bottom line
shows the current status of the modem followed by the message Press any key as shown
here. Press any key to restore the previous screen.

5.1.3.2 Opening Screen


The front panel displays provide the visual means to fully control and monitor operation of the
CDM-625. The first screen to display, after turning the power on, is the read-only opening
screen:

Comtech CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem


Ver2.1.0

This screen identifies the modem model, its installed firmware version, and information about
installed hardware options. From any other nested menu, press CLEAR repeatedly to access this
screen.

5.1.3.2.1 Feature Availability/Operation Indicators via the Opening Screen

Comtech CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem


TPC,CnC,VFEC,PktP present Ver2.1.0

TPC/LDPC Codec If installed, the display also indicates TPC.

54

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

Sect. 7.6 Turbo Product Codec (Hardware Option)


Sect. 7.7 TPC and Low Density Parity Check (LDPC) coding

DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Module If installed and enabled, the presence of CnC is


indicated with the appearance of the flashing CnC icon on the following front panel SELECT:
menus: CONFIG CnC; Test; Info; and Monitor.

Chapter 10. DOUBLETALK CARRIER-IN-CARRIER OPTION

VersaFEC Card If installed, the display also indicates VFEC.

Sect. 7.8 VersaFEC (Short-block LDPC)

IP Packet Processor Card If installed, the display also indicates PktP.

Chapter 18. IP PACKET PROCESSOR OPTION

CDM-600/600L Emulation Indication The CDM-625 serves as a drop-in replacement


product for CDM-600 and CDM-600L modems. An emulation mode is provided to
accomplish this design intent, and is configurable via either the front panel (SELECT:
UtilityEm) or by remote control (remote command EMU=).
When emulating a CDM-600 or CDM-600L modem, the CDM-625 opening screen displays
the mode of operation, as per this example:

Comtech CDM-625 emulating a CDM-600


TPC,CnC,VFEC,PktP present Ver2.2.6

Note that, while emulating a CDM-600 or CDM-600L modem, the I/O responses (including
that of remote query EID?) replicate those of the emulated modem; further, the firmware
version number displayed on the opening screen, and the response from the SWR? remote
query reflects that of the emulated modems firmware version number.

Warm-up Delay Mode counter When selecting the warm-up delay mode, the modem
turns the carrier off during the warm-up time and the countdown message High-
Stability Ref Warming up : ### sec displays on the bottom line of the screen
as follows:

Comtech CDM-625 emulating a CDM-600


High-Stability Ref warming up: 009 sec

55

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2 SELECT: (Main) Menu

SELECT: Configuration Test Monitor


Info Store/Ld Utility ODU FAST ()

Figure 5-2 shows the hierarchal structure of the CDM-625 principle menu tree from the SELECT:
menu on down.

Press ENTER or CLEAR to immediately access the SELECT: menu screen from the opening screen.
From any nested menu, press CLEAR repeatedly until this screen reappears.

The table that follows identifies each menu branch available from the SELECT: menu and its
content section in this chapter. Functionality of each menu sub branch is further explained in
the subsequent chapter sections.

Menu Branch Sect. Function

Configuration 5.2.1 Use to fully configure the modem.

Use t o c onfigure t he m odem i nto one of several T est m odes, and t o


Test 5.2.2
configure/monitor the BER Tester.
Monitor Use to monitor the current status of the modem and to view the log of stored
5.2.3
events for the modem.

(Information) Use to view information on t he modem without having to access


Info 5.2.4
the Configuration screens.
Store/Ld 5.2.5 (Store/Load) Use to store and retrieve up to 10 different modem configurations.
Use t o per form m iscellaneous functions e.g., s etting t he Real-Time C lock,
Utility 5.2.6
adjusting the VFD brightness, etc.
(Outdoor Unit) Depending on 70/140 MHz or L-Band operation: Use to monitor
and c ontrol a standalone or r edundant Comtech EF D ata R F T ransceiver
(CSAT-5060 or KST-2000A/B) or LPOD BUC if connected.
ODU 5.2.7
See Appendix F. C DM-625 O DU ( TRANSCEIVER, BUC, L NB) OPERATION
for full details.
(Fully Accessible System Topology) Use to configure available options e.g.,
FAST 5.2.8 extended dat a r ates, i nterfaces, et c. C ontact Comtech EF D ata C ustomer
Support for details.

The actual choices displayed in the submenus may vary according to which
FAST options have been activated and enabled. Where a FAST option affects a
menu, this is shown in the descriptive text.

From the top SELECT: menu, use the arrow keys to select from the choices shown, and then
press ENTER to continue.

56

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

Figure 5-2. CDM-625 Principle Menu Tree (FW Ver. 2.3.1)

57

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.1 SELECT: Configuration Menus

CONFIG: All Mode Tx Rx Clocks D&I/ACM


CnC EDMAC Misc Mask Remote IP ()

Use the arrow keys to select from the submenu choices shown, and then press ENTER. The
submenus available from the Configuration menu are as follows:

Submenu Sect. Function

This submenu is hi ghly r ecommended f or new us ers, as i t leads you through the
All 5.2.1.1
complete modem configuration process on a step-by-step basis.

Mode 5.2.1.2 Used to select Frame Type and Data Format for Tx and Rx.

(Transmit) Used to define, on a parameter-by-parameter basis, the Tx configuration of


Tx 5.2.1.3 the unit. These menu submenu branches would be us ed if you wished to change, for
example, just the Tx Frequency.
(Receive) Used to define, on a p arameter-by-parameter basis, the Rx configuration of
Rx 5.2.1.4 the unit. These menu submenu branches would be us ed if you wished to change, for
example, just the Rx data rate.

Clocks 5.2.1.5 Used to select Tx-Clocking, Rx-Buffer/Clock, or External Reference.

Used to select (Quad) Drop & Insert options (NOT SELECTABLE/VISIBLE IN IP-ACM
D&I 5.2.1.6
MODE).
(VersaFEC Adaptive Coding and Modulation) Used to c onfigure ACM operating
ACM 5.2.1.7
parameters. (SELECTABLE/VISIBLE IN PLACE OF D&I IN IP-ACM MODE ONLY).
(DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier) Used t o s elect D oubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier ( CnC)
CnC 5.2.1.8
options.

EDMAC 5.2.1.9 Used to select EDMAC options.

Misc 5.2.1.10 (Miscellaneous) Used to select, view, or change various other parameters.

Mask 5.2.1.11 Used to activate or MASK an alarm condition.

(Remote Control) Used to define whether the unit is being controlled locally, remotely,
Remote 5.2.1.12 or via IP, and to configure the serial Remote Control parameters: baud rate, I/O format,
address.
Used t o c onfigure v arious I P par ameters, i ncluding I P addr ess, gat eway, M AC
IP 5.2.1.13
addresses, VLAN, and QoS.

Only one method of remote access may control the modem at a time. The modem
may be monitored over the remote control bus at any time (i.e., queries only), and
the front panel may be viewed.

To make configuration parameter changes from the front panel, Local Mode is
required. Via serial remote, Remote Mode is required. Via IP, Ethernet Mode is
required.

58

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.1.1 CONFIG: All

All = Stop
(Stop, Start)

Use this menu to configure the unit on a step-by-step basis. Every available configuration menu
displays in succession. Use the arrow keys to select Stop or Start, and then press ENTER to
execute. Then:

Use the arrow keys to select, and the arrow keys to edit, parameters as
needed.

Press ENTER to continue through all the configurations.

Press CLEAR to discontinue.

Configuration Notes:

59

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.1.2 CONFIG: Mode


MODE is a key parameter when configuring the modem. To simplify the menu
choices, you must first determine the INTERFACE and FRAMING type for both
Transmit and Receive. Once these have been selected, you are presented only with
menu choices that are applicable to those particular modes. For example:

If selecting a G.703 interface, the data rate menu is restricted to only the
appropriate G.703 rates.

If selecting an IDR framing mode, the data rate choices are limited to only
those rates specified by IESS-308.

Mode: Tx=RS422:NONE Rx=RS422:None


(422,V35,G703s,Audio,LVDS,HSSI,IP,ASI)

The screen shown here depicts an Interface Type menu screen. You may select Interface Type
and Framing for both Tx and Rx from this menu. Use the arrow keys to select the
parameter to edit. The bottom line indicates the available options for the active parameter. Not
all options are always available they depend on other settings or on the modems activated
FAST options.

The first parameter is the Interface Type. The options are:

IP-ACM LVDS RS422


G.703s: HSSI V.35
o G.703B (Balanced) IP Audio
o G.703U (Unbalanced) ASI

Interface Notes:
1. The IP-ACM mode choice restricts the available framing types to NONE or EDMACs.

Chapter 17. ADAPTIVE CODING AND MODULATION (ACM)

2. The list of available Interface Types includes Audio when a unit ships with the Two
Channel Audio Drop Hardware Option installed. The Audio mode choice permits you
to carry 2 x 32 kbps ADPCM audio as the primary data. This mode restricts the
available framing types to IBS or EDMAC (see the selection table and the
explanations on the next page).

Use the arrow keys to scroll through the available options, and then press ENTER.

If the cursor is on the second parameter the Framing Type the display appears as shown:

Mode:Tx=RS422:NONE Rx=RS422:None
(None IBS IDR D&Is EDMACs ESC++)

510

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

Use the arrow keys to scroll through the available options, and then press ENTER. The
available Framing Types are as follows:

Framing Type Comments

None ---

IBS (FAST option) ---

IDR (FAST option) ---

D&Is (Drop & Insert)


(FAST option) which includes:
o D&I The D&I (Drop and I nsert) multiplexer works in conjunction with the G.703
(FAST option) interfaces to enable the modem to transmit or receive fractional parts of a
T1 or E1 data stream.

o D&I++ D&I++ is anot her C omtech pr oprietary f raming it is a c losed-network


(FAST option) frame structure, similar to D&I, but which permits AUPC and EDMAC. See
Chapter 9 . C LOCK M ODES a nd D ROP & I NSERT ( D&I) for f urther
information.

o QDI (Quad Drop & Insert) QDI is another variation of D&I that allows up to four E1 terrestrial ports to
(FAST option) be used.

o Framed QDI Framed QDI is a concatenation of QDI and EDMAC framing.


(FAST option)
o D&I Enhanced Available when in E1-CCS; may enable ESC, and then AUPC.
EDMACs which include:
o EDMAC EDMAC is C omtech E F Datas pr oprietary f raming. I t is ba ckwards
compatible with the CDM-500, CDM-550, CDM-550T, CDM-600 and CDM-
600L. T he f raming per mits bi -directional pas sing of M &C and A UPC
(Automatic Uplink Power Control) data between local and distant-end units.
o EDMAC-2 EDMAC-2 is a reduced overhead version of EDMAC, and is not completely
(as in the CDM-570) backwards-compatible with the modems listed above, but is in some modes
(e.g., in T urbo BPSK modes and at rates above 2.048 Mbps). F or further
information, see Chapter 11. EDMAC CHANNEL.

o EDMAC-3 EDMAC-3 uses t he s ame ov erhead as E DMAC f raming, but t he E DMAC


channel operated at 1/3 the rate of original EDMAC. Most of the overhead
is dedi cated t o c arrying t he r emote m odems c omplete s tatus i nformation
(including AUPC) to the near-end modem very quickly. T ailored to SNMP
proxy appl ications. F or f urther i nformation, s ee Chapter 11. E DMAC
CHANNEL.
ESC++ ESC++ is anot her C omtech pr oprietary f raming it is a c losed-network
frame s tructure, w hich per mits A UPC, E DMAC and ESC. F or f urther
information, see Chapter 12. ESC++.

511

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.1.3 CONFIG: Tx

Tx-IF Freq Power FEC Mod Data Scrambler


(Data 00192.000kbps, 00131.657ksps) ()

On the top line Use the arrow keys to select Tx-IF, Freq, Power, FEC, Mod, Data (Symb
when in IP-ACM mode), or Scrambler, and then press ENTER.

On the bottom line Read-only Data/Symbol rate information is provided.


When Sub-Mux is ON, Composite Rate information replaces the Data Rate
information on the bottom line of this display.

5.2.1.3.1 CONFIG: Tx Tx-IF

Tx: Carrier=On (Off,On,RTI) POCO=Off


SpectrumInvert=Off Tx=.35(.35,.25)()

Use the arrow keys to select Carrier, POCO (Power-On Carrier-Off), SpectrumInvert, or Tx
(for Tx Alpha Filter Rolloff Factor), and then use the arrow keys to edit the option setting
(the available choices may be shown in parentheses). Press ENTER when done.

For the Carrier, use the arrow keys to select Off, On, RTI-01s, RTI-02s, RTI-04s, RTI-07s,
or RTI-10s, and then press ENTER when done.

USE THE RTI FEATURE WITH EXTREME CARE! RTI (RECEIVE/TRANSMIT INHIBIT),
when selected, prevents transmission of the Tx carrier until the demodulator is
locked. To avoid shutdown of the Tx Carrier when the demodulator loses lock for
a very short duration, before the transmit carrier is inhibited the demodulator
must be unlocked continuously for the selected time period (1, 2, 4, 7, or 10
seconds).

Enabling RTI does not affect the Internal IF Loopback feature. However, be
aware that, if an External IF Loopback is attempted (i.e., connecting an external
cable from the Tx IF output to the Rx IF input), this will not work! (The Tx carrier
cannot turn on until the demod is locked the demod cannot lock because the
Tx output is off. The net result is that the demod will not lock and the Tx carrier
will not turn on.)

When POCO (Power-On Carrier-Off) is enabled (selected as ON), this feature overrides the
Tx setting to OFF in the event of a power-cycle of the modem. Use with caution.

SPECTRUM INVERT should normally be in the OFF position. For all FEC types
except BPSK, when Spectrum Invert is in the ON position the transmit spectrum is
inverted (which is the same as reversing the direction of phase rotation in the

512

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

modulator). In BPSK, the time-order of bits out of the FEC encoder is reversed to
make the modem compatible with certain other manufacturer modems.

For the Tx (Tx Alpha Filter Rolloff Factor) selection, you may select 0.25 instead of the
default value of 0.35.

5.2.1.3.2 CONFIG: Tx Freq (Frequency)

Tx-IF Frequency: 0050.0000 MHz


()

To edit the Tx-IF Frequency, use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit, and then use the
arrow keys to change that digit. The available ranges are 50-180 MHz, and 950-2000 MHz
(L-Band) (FAST option). The resolution is 100Hz. Press ENTER when done.

When you use the ODU menus to configure a BUC LO-frequency, this menu displays a second
line of information:

Tx-IF Frequency: 1750.0000 MHz


(LO:12500 MHz Sat:14250.0000 MHz) ()

As you edit the IF frequency, the Satellite frequency updates accordingly.

Satellite frequency = LO IF frequency, where the sign is determined


by the LO mix parameter:

High-sided mix [] (includes a spectral inversion);


Low-sided mix [+].

5.2.1.3.3 CONFIG: Tx Power

Output Power: Mode= Manual (Manual,AUPC)


Level= 20.0 dBm ()

Use the arrow keys to select the Output Power Mode (top line) or to edit the Output Power
Level (bottom line) and then press ENTER.

On the top line Use the arrow keys to select the Output Power Mode as MANUAL or
AUPC (see next section for conditional selection).

On the bottom line To edit the Output Power Level, use the arrow keys to first select a
digit of the Tx Output Power Level, and then use the arrow keys to change that digit. For Tx
frequencies of 50-180 MHz, the permitted level range is 0 to 25dBm. For 950-2000 MHz
(L-Band), the range is 0 to 45dBm. Press ENTER when done.

513

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.1.3.3.1 CONFIG: Tx Power Mode AUPC

Chapter 8. AUTOMATIC UPLINK POWER CONTROL (AUPC)

The AUPC Output Power Mode Is selectable only when the T0x framing is EDMAC, D&I++, ESC++
or D&I. Otherwise, if you attempt to select the Output Power Mode as AUPC, you are blocked
from selecting AUPC and a message displays on the bottom line:

Output Power: Mode= AUPC (Manual,AUPC)


! AUPC needs supporting framing mode !

Otherwise, with an appropriate framing type selected, the bottom line appears as shown:

Output Power: Mode= AUPC (Manual,AUPC)


Target-EbNo-Range Alarm-Action ()

Use the arrow keys to select Target-EbNo-Range or Alarm-Action and then press ENTER.

CONFIG: Tx Power Mode AUPC Target-EbNo-Range

Minimum EbNo of Remote Modem = 5.0dB


Max Permitted Power Increase = 9dB ()

On the top line To edit the Target Eb/No of the remote modem, use the arrow keys to
select a digit to edit, and then use the arrow keys to change that digit. The default value is
3.0 dB. The upper limit is 14.9 dB.

On the bottom line To edit the maximum permitted increase in power level when in AUPC
Mode, use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit, and then use the arrow keys to
change that digit. Press ENTER when done. The default value is 1 dB. The upper limit is 9 dB,
except when CnC Mode is ON the upper limit value is instead 3 dB.

Press ENTER when done.

CONFIG: Tx Power Mode AUPC Alarm-Action

Max Tx Pwr Action= None (None, Tx-Alm)


Rem Demod Unlock Act= Nom-Pwr (Nom,Max)

On the top line To determine the action that occurs if the AUPC causes the maximum output
power level to be reached, use the arrow keys to select None or Tx Alarm.

On the bottom line To determine the action that occurs if the remote demod is unlocked, use
the arrow keys to select Nom-Pwr or Max-Pwr. Note the following:

514

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

Selection Function

Nom-Pwr (Nominal Power) The output level reverts to the nominal power level set under Manual.

Max-Pwr (Maximum Power) The output level changes to the maximum permitted.

Press ENTER when done.

CONFIG: Tx Power Mode CnC-APC Mode

Chapter 10. Double Talk Carrier-in-Carrier Option

Selecting CnC Automatic Power Control (CnC-APC) mode displays the following menu:

Output Power Mode = CnC-Auto-Power-Control


Level=-25.0dBm MaxPwrIncrease=2.5dB ()

On the bottom line To edit the power output level and the maximum permitted increase in
power level when in APC Mode, use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit, and then use
the arrow keys to change that digit. Press ENTER when done.

Note that, when APC is in an active state, the power level values display in the bottom left as
AUTO.

5.2.1.3.4 CONFIG: Tx FEC

Enc=Vit (Vit,Seq,TCM,TPC,LDPC,VFEC,ULL)
Reed-Solomon=On (Off, On) ()

Use the arrow keys to select Encoder or Reed-Solomon / Diff Encoder, and then press
ENTER.

On the top line Use the arrow keys to select an available Encoder option (shown in
parentheses), and then press ENTER. The choices are:
None (i.e., uncoded) Vit (Viterbi)

TCM (Trellis Coded Modulation)


Seq (Sequential)
8-PSK Rate 2/3 only (FAST option)
TPC (Turbo) LDPC (Low Density Parity
(Hardware option) Check) (Hardware option)
VFEC ULL (Ultra-Low Latency)
(VersaFEC Hardware option) (VersaFEC Hardware option)

515

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

1. When selecting None for the Encoder setting, the bottom line of the display changes
from Reed-Solomon to Diff Encoder (Differential Encoding).

2. The TPC (Turbo) and LDPC encoding selections display only when the optional
TPC/LDPC Codec is installed.

3. The VFEC and ULL encoding selections display only when the optional VersaFEC Codec
is installed.

On the bottom line When Reed-Solomon is selectable, use the arrow keys to select On or
Off. Press ENTER when done.

CONFIG: Tx FEC Reed-Solomon On

Reed-Solomon Encoding =Standard(126/112)


(Standard(126/110),IESS-310(219/201)) ()

Use the arrow keys to select one of the listed parameters, and then press ENTER. Possible
selections, depending on the Framing mode, are as follows:
IESS-310, open or closed network 219/201

IBS or D&I 126/112

EDMAC or EDMAC2, closed network 200/180

IDR, open network 225/205, 219/201 or 194/178

ESC++ or D&I++, closed network 126/112

Unframed closed network:

Comtech standard 220/200

Legacy EF Data 225/205, with V.35 scrambling


Otherwise, when Diff Encoder is selectable on the bottom line, use the arrow keys to select
On or Off, and then press ENTER:

CONFIG: Tx FEC Diff Encoder On

Enc=None(Vit,Seq,TCM,TPC,LDPC,VFEC,ULL)
Diff Encoder=On (Off,On) ()

If selecting Differential Encoding=OFF, there is no way for the modem to resolve


the phase ambiguities associated with PSK modulations. For BPSK there is a 1 in 2
chance that the polarity of the data will be correct. In QPSK there is a 1 in 4 chance
the data will be correct.

516

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.1.3.5 CONFIG: Tx Mod (Modulation)

Mod=QPSK (B,Q,OQ,8PSK,16Q,8QAM)
FEC Rate=1/2 (1/2,3/4,7/8) ()

Use the arrow keys to select the Modulation type (top line) or the FEC rate (bottom line),
and then use the arrow keys to change that parameter selection. The Encoder type dictates
the Modulation Type and FEC rate choices:

Encoder Type Modulation Type FEC Rate Choice


BPSK Fixed at 1/1
No Encoder
QPSK, OQPSK Fixed at 1/1
BPSK Fixed at Rate 1/2
TCM 8-PSK (FAST option) Fixed at Rate 2/3
Non-Turbo Encoder
QPSK, OQPSK 1/2, 3/4, 7/8
16-QAM (Vit+RS only) 3/4, 7/8
BPSK 5/16, 21/44
TPC QPSK, OQPSK 1/2 (aka 21/44), 3/4, 7/8, 0.95
(with TPC/LDPC Codec installed) 8-PSK (FAST option) 3/4, 7/8, 0.95
16-QAM (FAST option) 3/4, 7/8
BPSK Fixed at 1/2
LDPC QPSK, OQPSK 1/2, 2/3, 3/4
(with TPC/LDPC Codec installed) 8-PSK, 8-QAM (FAST) 2/3, 3/4
16-QAM (FAST option) Fixed at 3/4
BPSK Fixed at 0.488
VFEC QPSK 0.533, 0.631, 0.706, 0.803
(with VersaFEC Codec installed) 8-QAM (FAST option) 0.576, 0.642, 0.711, 0.780
16-QAM (FAST option) 0.644, 0.731, 0.780, 0.829, 0.853
ULL BPSK Fixed at 0.493
(with VersaFEC Codec installed) QPSK 0.493, 0.654, 0.734

If selecting TPC from the FEC menu with TPC/LDPC Codec installed, the options appear as
shown:

Mod=QPSK (B,Q OQ,8PSK,16Q,8QAM)


FEC Rate=1/2 (1/2,3/4,7/8,0.95) ()

If selecting VFEC from the FEC menu with VersaFEC Codec installed, the options appear as
shown:

Mod=BPSK (B,Q,8QAM,16QAM) ()
FEC Rate=0.488 (Fixed)

If selecting ULL from the FEC menu with VersaFEC Codec installed, the options appear as shown:

517

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

Mod=BPSK (B,Q) ()
FEC Rate=0.493 (Fixed)

5.2.1.3.6 CONFIG: Tx Data

Tx Data Rate Tx Sub-Mux


()

Use the arrow keys to select Tx Data Rate or Tx Sub-Mux, and then press ENTER.

If Tx Sub-Mux is ON, this menu provides read-only IP Info Rate information on the bottom line:

Tx Data Rate Tx Sub-Mux


(IP Info Rate: 01200.340 kbps) ()

CONFIG: Tx Tx Data Tx Data Rate

Tx Data Rate = 01544.000 kbps


Data Invert=Off Clock Invert=Off ()

Use the top line to edit the Tx Data Rate. The bottom line permits selection of the Data Inversion
or the Clock Inversion features (added for compatibility with certain older equipment).

On the top line To edit the Tx Data Rate, use the arrow keys to select the digit to edit,
and then use the arrow keys to change that digit. Press ENTER. when done.

The maximum limits for the Tx Data Rate are 18kbps to 25Mbps. The actual minimum and
maximum data rates are dependent on Framing mode, Interface type, Modulation type and FEC
Code Rate. If you change any of the higher-priority parameters causing the data rate to
become invalid the Data Rate adjusts automatically. The installed FAST option(s) also dictate
the upper range of data rate.

When configuring for D&I or IDR framing or for G.703 interface type, the arrow keys scroll
through only the available data rates. If you edit the data rate to 1920 kbps while in D&I
framing, a message appears to indicate that E1 Fixed Channel Mode is implemented.

When using G.703, three auxiliary rates (512, 1024 and 2048 kbps) are also available, indicated
by the word AUX appearing to the right of the decimal place (for example, 00512.AUX
kbps).

AUX G.703 Data Rate Connectors Reference: Sect. 3.3.2.5 G.703 IDI (Insert Data In),
DDO (Drop Data Out) Connectors in Chapter 3. REAR PANEL CONNECTOR PINOUTS

518

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

Note that in QDI (Quad D&I) mode, these data rates are read-only! The data rate is the sum of
the tributary rates for all ports. You must edit them via the QDI menu.

On the bottom line To set the Data Invert or Clock Invert operation, for either, use the
arrow keys to select On or Off. Press ENTER when done.

CONFIG: Tx Tx Data Tx Sub-Mux

Tx Sub-Mux = Off (Off, On)


Ratio = 1/9 (IP/Synchronous) ()

Use the arrow keys to select the desired ratio, and then press ENTER. There are a total of
34 ratio options available:
1/59 1/39 1/19 1/9 1/8 1/7 1/6 1/5 1/4

2/7 1/3 2/5 3/7 1/2 3/5 2/3 3/4 4/5

1/1 5/4 4/3 3/2 5/3 2/1 7/3 5/2 3/1

7/2 4/1 5/1 6/1 7/1 8/1 9/1

5.2.1.3.7 CONFIG: Tx Symb (IP-ACM Mode Only)

Chapter 17. ADAPTIVE CODING AND MODULATION (ACM)

VersaFEC ACM requires the correct hardware module (PL-0000264) to be installed in


the CDM-625; Version 1.4.0 (or higher) firmware; and the appropriate FAST code for
the maximum operating symbol rate.

TxSymbolRate = 01000.000 ksps (ACM Mode)


Data Invert=Off Clock Invert=Off ()

Take care to note that the use of IP-ACM is a fundamental departure from the way you would
typically configure the modem. When IP-ACM mode is active, the CONFIG: Tx menu changes the
Data option to Symb.

Use the arrow keys to select TxSymbolRate, Data Invert, or Clock Invert, and then press
ENTER.

On the top line To edit the Tx Symbol Rate, use the arrow keys to first select the digit to
edit, and then use the arrow keys to change that digit. Press ENTER when done.

On the bottom line To edit the Data Invert or Clock Invert: For either, use the arrow keys
to select On or Off, and then press ENTER.

519

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.1.3.8 CONFIG: Tx Scrambler

Tx Scrambler = IESS (Normal,IESS,Off)


IESS-315 V.35 Scrambler ()

Use the arrow keys to select Normal, IESS, or Off, and then press ENTER.

The modem automatically selects the actual scrambler used for Normal, depending on the exact
operating mode:

If framing = IBS/D&I, the IESS-309 scrambler is used.

If Reed-Solomon is on but IBS/D&I is off, its frame synchronous scrambler is used per
IESS-310, App. H. An exception to this is legacy EF Data Reed-Solomon, which uses a
proprietary modified V.35 scrambler instead.

If framing = EDMAC/2/3 and Reed-Solomon is off, its frame synchronous scrambler is


used.

If configured for TPC (Turbo) encoding and all of the above settings are off, the TPC
frame scrambler is used except for 8-QAM.

For CDM-570 compatibility, TPC with 8-QAM uses the V.35 scrambler.

ITU V.35 scrambler (Intelsat variant) is the default scrambler when all of the above
settings are off.

When selecting IESS, the default ITU V.35 scrambler specified in IESS-315 takes priority over all
normal scramblers and is used instead. Therefore, for many operating modes, the two
scrambler choices are redundant.

When using TPC and Carrier-in-Carrier simultaneously, the IESS-315 (V.35) scrambler is the only
permitted choice.

520

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.1.4 CONFIG: Rx

RxIF Freq FEC Demod Data Descram Eq EbNo


(Data 02048.000kbps,02184.533ksps) ()

On the top line Use the arrow keys to select RxIF, Freq, FEC, Demod, Data (Symb when in
IP-ACM Mode), Descram, Eq, or EbNo, and then press ENTER.

On the bottom line Read-only Data/Symbol rate information is provided.

When Sub-Mux is ON, the Data Rate information on the bottom line of this display
is replaced by Composite Rate information.

5.2.1.4.1 CONFIG: Rx Rx-IF

Acquisition Sweep Range = +/- 032 kHz


Spectrum Invert=Off (Off,On) ()

Use the arrow keys to select Acquisition Sweep Range or Spectrum Invert (available
options are shown in parentheses).

The Acquisition Sweep Range value determines the amount of frequency uncertainty the
demodulator will sweep over in order to find and lock to an incoming carrier. When operating at
low bit rates, large values of sweep range (compared to the data rate) cause excessively long
acquisition times. For example, when selecting 32 kHz with a data rate of 2.4 kbps, BPSK will
result in an average acquisition time of around 3 minutes.

Use the arrow keys to edit the setting in 10 kHz increments, and then press ENTER. The Rx
symbol rate determines the Sweep Range limits:

Rx Symbol Rate Sweep Range Limit


1 to symbol rate / 2 (ksps) 18 - 64 kbps
1 to 32 kHz 64 - 389 ksps
1 to (10% of symbol rate) 389 - 2000 ksps
1 to 200 kHz >2000ksps

Use the arrow keys to set Spectrum Invert as Off or On, and then press ENTER.

SPECTRUM INVERT should normally be in the OFF position. When in the ON


position, the Rx spectrum is inverted (which is the same as reversing the direction
of phase rotation in the demodulator). When in BPSK mode, note that the
demodulator will automatically synchronize to either the normal time-ordering of
bits FEC codeword pairs, or the inverted ordering used by certain other
manufacturers.

521

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.1.4.2 CONFIG: Rx Freq (Frequency)

Rx-IF Frequency: 0050.0000 MHz


()

To edit the Rx Frequency, use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit, and then use the
arrow keys to change that digit. The available frequency ranges are 50-180 MHz, and 950-2000
MHz (L-Band) (FAST option). Press ENTER when done.

When you use the ODU menus to configure a LNB LO-frequency, this screen displays a second
line of information (this example uses low-sided mix):

Rx-IF Frequency: 1200.0000 MHz


(LO:12500 MHz Sat:13700.0000 MHz) ()

The Satellite frequency updates accordingly as the IF frequency is edited.

Satellite frequency = LO IF frequency, where the sign is determined


by the LO mix parameter:
High-sided mix [] (includes a spectral inversion);
Low-sided mix [+].

5.2.1.4.3 CONFIG: Rx FEC

Dec=Vit (Vit,Seq,TCM,TPC,LDPC,VFEC,ULL)
Reed-Solomon=Off (Off,On) ()

Use the arrow keys to select Decoder or Reed-Solomon / Diff Encoder, and then press
ENTER.

On the top line Use the arrow keys to select an available Decoder option (shown in
parentheses), and then press ENTER. The choices are:
None (i.e., uncoded) Vit (Viterbi)

TCM (Trellis Coded Modulation)


Seq (Sequential)
8-PSK Rate 2/3 only (FAST option)
TPC (Turbo) LDPC (Low Density Parity
(Hardware option) Check) (Hardware option)
VFEC ULL (Ultra-Low Latency)
(VersaFEC Hardware option) (VersaFEC Hardware option)

1. If selecting None for the Encoder setting, the bottom line of the screen
changes from Reed-Solomon to Diff Encoder (Differential Encoding).

2. The TPC (Turbo) and LDPC encoding selections display only when the optional

522

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

TPC/LDPC Codec is installed.

3. The VFEC and ULL encoding selections display only when the optional
VersaFEC Codec is installed.

On the bottom line When Reed-Solomon is selectable, use the arrow keys to select On or
Off, and then press ENTER.

CONFIG: Rx FEC Reed-Solomon On

Reed-Solomon Decoding =IESS-310(219/201)


(Standard(126/110),IESS-310(219/201)) ()

Use the arrow keys to select an available parameter, and then press ENTER. Depending on
the Framing mode, possible selections are as follows:
IESS-310, open or closed network 219/201
IBS or D&I 126/112
EDMAC or EDMAC2, closed network 200/180
IDR, open network 225/205, 219/201 or 194/178
ESC++ or D&I++, closed network 126/112
Unframed closed network:
Comtech standard 220/200
Legacy EF Data 225/205, with V.35 scrambling

Otherwise, when Diff Encoder is selectable, use the arrow keys to select On or Off, and
then press ENTER.

CONFIG: Rx FEC Diff Encoder On


When selecting Differential Decoding as OFF, there is no way for the modem to
resolve the phase ambiguities associated with PSK modulations. For BPSK there is a 1
in 2 chance that the polarity of the data will be correct. In QPSK there is a 1 in 4
chance that the data will be correct.

Enc=None (None,Vit,Seq,TCM,TPC,LDPC,VFEC)
Diff Encoder=On (Off,On) ()

523

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.1.4.4 CONFIG: Rx Demod (Demodulation)

Demod=QPSK (B,Q,OQ,8PSK,16QAM)
FEC Rate=1/2 (1/2,3/4,7/8) ()

Use the arrow keys to select Demod (top line) or FEC Rate (bottom line), and then press
ENTER. Then, for either, use the arrow keys to select the setting. The Decoder type dictates
the FEC Rate choices:

Decoder Type Modulation Type FEC Rate Choice

BPSK Fixed at 1/1


No Encoder
QPSK, OQPSK Fixed at 1/1
BPSK Fixed at Rate 1/2
TCM 8-PSK (FAST option) Fixed at Rate 2/3
Non-Turbo Encoder
QPSK, OQPSK 1/2, 3/4, 7/8
16-QAM (Vit+RS only) 3/4, 7/8
BPSK 5/16, 21/44
TPC QPSK, OQPSK 1/2, 3/4, 7/8, 0.95
(with TPC/LDPC Codec installed) 8-PSK (FAST option) 3/4, 7/8, 0.95
16-QAM (FAST option) 3/4, 7/8
BPSK Fixed at 1/2
LDPC QPSK, OQPSK 1/2, , 7/8
(with TPC/LDPC Codec installed) 8-PSK, 8-QAM (FAST) 2/3, 3/4
16-QAM (FAST option) Fixed at 3/4
BPSK Fixed at 0.488
VFEC QPSK 0.533, 0.631, 0.706, 0.803
(with VersaFEC Codec installed) 8-QAM (FAST option) 0.576, 0.642, 0.711, 0.780
16-QAM (FAST option) 0.644, 0.731, 0.780, 0.829, 0.853
ULL (Ultra-Low Latency) BPSK Fixed at 0.493
(with VersaFEC Codec installed) QPSK 0.493, 0.654, 0.734

If selecting TPC from the FEC menu with TPC/LDPC Codec installed, the options appear as
shown:

Demod=QPSK (B,Q OQ,8PSK,16Q,8QAM)


FEC Rate=1/2 (1/2,3/4,7/8) ()

If selecting VFEC from the FEC menu with VersaFEC Codec installed, the options appear as
shown:

Demod=BPSK (B,Q,8QAM,16QAM) ()
FEC Rate=0.488 (Fixed)

524

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

If selecting ULL from the FEC menu with VersaFEC Codec installed, the options appear as shown:

Demod=BPSK (B,Q) ()
FEC Rate=0.493 (Fixed)

5.2.1.4.5 CONFIG: Rx Data

Rx Data Rate Rx Sub-Mux


()

Use the arrow keys to select Rx Data Rate or Rx Sub-Mux, and then press ENTER.

If Rx Sub-Mux is ON, this menu provides read-only IP Info Rate information on the bottom line,
as shown:

Rx Data Rate Rx Sub-Mux


(IP Info Rate: 01200.340 kbps) ()

CONFIG: Rx Data Rx Data Rate

Rx Data Rate = 01544.000 kbps


Data Invert=Off Clock Invert=Off ()

Use the top line to edit the Rx Data Rate. The bottom line permits selection of the Data
Inversion or the Clock Inversion features (added for compatibility with certain older equipment).

On the top line To edit the Rx Data Rate, use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit, and
then use the arrow keys to change that digit. Press ENTER when done.

The maximum limits for the Rx Data Rate are 18kbps to 25Mbps. The actual minimum and
maximum data rates are dependent on Framing mode, Interface type, Modulation type and FEC
Code Rate. If you change any of the higher-priority parameters causing the data rate to
become invalid the Data Rate adjusts automatically. The installed FAST option(s) also dictate
the upper range of data rate.

When configuring for D&I or IDR framing or for G.703 interface type, the arrow keys scroll
through only the available data rates. If you edit the data rate to 1920 kbps while in D&I
framing, a message appears to indicate that E1 Fixed Channel Mode is implemented.

When G.703 is used, three auxiliary rates 512, 1024, and 2048 kbps are available as indicated
by the word AUX appearing to the right of the decimal place (for example, 00512.AUX
kbps).

525

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

AUX G.703 Data Rate Connectors Reference: Sect. 3.3.2.5 G.703 IDI (Insert Data In),
DDO (Drop Data Out) Connectors in Chapter 3. REAR PANEL CONNECTORS AND
PINOUTS.

Note that, in QDI (Quad D&I) mode, these data rates are read-only! The data rate is the sum of
the tributary rates for all ports, and you must the data rate via the QDI menu.

On the bottom line To edit the Data Invert or Clock Invert operation: For either, use the
arrow keys to select On or Off, and then press ENTER.

CONFIG: Rx Rx Data Rx Sub-Mux

Rx Sub-Mux = Off (Off, On)


Ratio = 1/9 (IP/Synchronous) ()

Use the arrow keys to select the desired ratio, and then press ENTER. There are a total of
34 ratio options available:

1/59 1/39 1/19 1/9 1/8 1/7 1/6 1/5 1/4


2/7 1/3 2/5 3/7 1/2 3/5 2/3 3/4 4/5
1/1 5/4 4/3 3/2 5/3 2/1 7/3 5/2 3/1
7/2 4/1 5/1 6/1 7/1 8/1 9/1

5.2.1.4.6 CONFIG: Rx Symb (IP-ACM Mode Only)

Chapter 17. ADAPTIVE CODING AND MODULATION (ACM)

VersaFEC ACM requires the correct hardware module (PL-0000264) to be installed


in the CDM-625, Version 1.4.0 (or higher) firmware, and the appropriate FAST code
for the maximum operating symbol rate.

RxSymbolRate = 01000.000 ksps (ACM Mode)


Data Invert=Off Clock Invert=Off ()

Note that the use of IP-ACM is a fundamental departure from the way you would typically
configure the modem. When IP-ACM mode is active, the CONFIG: Rx menu changes the Data
option to Symb.

On the top line To edit the Rx Symbol Rate, use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit,
and then use the arrow keys to change that digit. Press ENTER when done. Note that
asymmetric operation is supported transmit and receive symbol rates do not have to be equal.

On the bottom line To set the Data Invert or Clock Invert operation: For either, use the
arrow keys to select On or Off, and then press ENTER.

526

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.1.4.7 CONFIG: Rx Descram (Descrambler)

Rx Descrambler = IESS (Normal,IESS,Off)


IESS-315 V.35 Scrambler ()

Use the arrow keys to select Normal, IESS, or Off, and then press ENTER.

The modem automatically selects the actual scrambler used for Normal, depending on the exact
operating mode:

If framing = IBS/D&I, the IESS-309 scrambler is used.

If Reed-Solomon is on but IBS/D&I is off, its frame synchronous scrambler is used per
IESS-310, App. H. An exception to this is legacy EF Data Reed-Solomon, which uses a
proprietary modified V.35 scrambler instead.

If framing = EDMAC/2/3 and Reed-Solomon is off, its frame synchronous scrambler is


used.

If configured for TPC (Turbo) encoding and all of the above settings are off, the TPC
frame scrambler is used except for 8-QAM. For CDM-570 compatibility, TPC with 8-QAM
uses the V.35 scrambler.

ITU V.35 scrambler (Intelsat variant) is the default scrambler when all of the above
settings are off.

When selecting IESS, the default ITU V.35 scrambler specified in IESS-315 takes priority over all
normal scramblers and is used instead. Therefore, for many operating modes, the two
scrambler choices are redundant.

When using TPC and Carrier-in-Carrier simultaneously, the IESS-315 (V.35) scrambler is the only
permitted choice.

5.2.1.4.8 CONFIG: Rx Eq (Equalizer)

Rx Equalizer:
Disabled (Enable,Disable) ()

Use the arrow keys to select Enable or Disable, and then press ENTER. The integrated 5-tap
adaptive equalizer can compensate for:

Amplitude slope and variation over the symbol bandwidth.

Non-linear group delay variation over the symbol bandwidth.

527

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

It is particularly useful at higher symbol rates (up to 12.5 Msymbols/second) in situations with
long cable runs between equipment (downconverter and modem, for example).

The Eb/No estimate is performed after the adaptive equalizer block, which provides an easy way
to determine if the equalizer is providing any benefit. If the equalizer is first turned off, the
Eb/No may be viewed on the monitor screen. The equalizer is then turned on, and the Eb/No
viewed on the monitor screen to determine any improvement.

5.2.1.4.9 CONFIG: Rx EbNo

Receive EbNo Alarm Point = 02.0 dB


()

To edit the EbNo Alarm Point, use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit, and then use the
arrow keys to change that digit. The permitted range is from 00.1 to 16.0 dB. Press ENTER
when done.

If the Rx Eb/No falls below this value and the fault is NOT masked, a receive traffic
fault will be generated.

528

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.1.5 CONFIG: Clocks

Clocking: TxClock RxBuffer/Clock


Clock-Ext Freq-Ref Int-Ref-Adjust ()

Use the arrow keys to select TxClock, RxBuffer/Clock, Clock-Ext, Freq-Ref, or Int-Ref-
Adjust, and then press ENTER.

5.2.1.5.1 CONFIG: Clocks Tx Clock

Transmit Clock = Internal(SCT)


(Int(SCT),TxTerr(TT),RxLoop, ETTSTRxS) ()

Use the arrow keys to select from the choices shown in parentheses, and then press
ENTER. Note the following:

Selection Function
Internal (SCT) This is the required setting when the Tx interface type is Audio. Indicates that the unit
will supply a clock to the DTE, which is derived from its internal high-stability source.
Tx-Terrestrial (TT) This is the required setting when the modems interface type is G.703. Indicates that
the unit expects to receive a clock from the DTE, to which the unit can phase-lock its
internal circuits. If no clock is detected the modem will substitute its internal clock and
generate an alarm.
Rx-Loop-timed Allows the modems internal clock to be phas e locked to the Rx buffer clock source.
This output clock is Send Timing. Choosing Rx-Loop does not automatically select Rx-
Sat as t he buf fer c lock s ource. This al lows f or i ncreased f lexibility f or m odem c lock
selection. While you typically should select Rx-Sat, other choices are also available.

Example: You have an av ailable hi gh s tability 10 M Hz c lock s ource, but t he end


equipment only accepts a clock at the information data rate. Selecting Tx Clock = Rx-
Loop and Rx Buffer Clock = EXT-REF provides receive timing and send timing to the
end equipment that is sourced from the 10 MHz reference.
Ext-TT (ST = Rx Sat) Only valid if: RS422, V.35, HSSI or LVDS, Tx and Rx data rates are equal, no RS, and
no framing.

This m ode is a vailable to per mit a par ticular v ariation of Loop T iming. In t his m ode,
transmit timing is taken from the TT pins, but ST is active and gives out a copy of the
Rx Satellite Clock.

Sect. 9.1.1 CLOCK MODES AND DROP & INSERT (D&I).

529

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.1.5.2 CONFIG: Clocks Rx Buffer/Clock

Clk=Rx-Sat (Rx-Sat,TxTerr,Int(SCT),Ins)
Buffer-Size = 00016bytes(00002ms) Center

Use the arrow keys to set the Rx Clock (top line) or the Buffer-Size (bottom line).

On the top line To set the Rx Clock, use the arrow keys to select Rx-Sat, Tx-Terr, Int (SCT),
or Ins, and then press ENTER. Note the following:

Selection Function
Sets the Receive buffer clock source to the satellite clock (the receive buffer is bypassed).
Rx-Sat
Note: This will fix the buffer size to minimum.
Tx-Terr In this timing mode, data is clocked out of the receive buffer using the external transmit clock.
Int(SCT) Data is clocked out of the buffer using the same reference that drives the modem Internal(SCT).
Available only if Rx framing is D&I and Rx interface is G.703. Sets the buffer clock to the Insert
Ins(ert)
stream.

On the bottom line To set the Buffer-Size, use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit, and
then use the arrow keys to change that digit. Press ENTER when done.

Buffer Size indicates the size in bytes (and size in milliseconds) of the Plesiochronous /
Doppler Buffer. The minimum buffer size and step size are usually the same, and are
dictated by the following rules:

If Framing is D&I or D&I++: Otherwise:


If D&I Type is: Step size (bytes) If data rate is: Step size (bytes)
E1 D&I @ 1920kbps 1024 1544 kbps (T1) 1158
T1-D4 24 x n or 3ms 2048 kbps (E1) 1024
T1-ESF 48 x n or 6ms 6312 kbps (T2) 1578
E1 32 x n or 4ms 8448 kbps (E2) 528
Otherwise 2, with minimum size of 16 bytes

CONFIG: Clocks Rx Buffer/Clock Center


Selecting Center displays the following screen:

Press ENTER to Center the Buffer


otherwise, press CLEAR

Press ENTER or CLEAR as instructed.

530

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.1.5.3 CONFIG: Clocks Clk-Ext (G.703 Clock Extension)

Sect. 9.1.1 CLOCK MODES AND DROP & INSERT (D&I).

G.703 Clock Extension:


Mode Interface ()

Use the arrow keys to select Mode or Interface, and then press ENTER.

CONFIG: Clocks Clk-Ext Mode

G.703 Clock Extension Mode: RxEnable


(None, TxLock, RxEnable) ()

Use the arrow keys to select None, TxLock, or RxEnable, and then press ENTER. Note the
following:

Selection Function
None All G.703 Clock extension modes are disabled.
The CDM-625 (operating in a non-G.703 mode) locks its transmit clock timing to an externally
TxLock
presented G.703 reference signal.
The CDM-625 (operating in a non-G.703 mode) synthesizes a G.703 timing reference from the
RxEnable
Rx satellite signal, regardless of its actual data rate.

CONFIG: Clocks Clk-Ext Interface

G.703 Clock Extension:


Interface: T1 (T1, E1-B, E1-U) ()

When selecting TxLock as the mode, the transmit timing of the CDM-625 locks to the timing
presented of the interface type selected here.

When selecting RxEnable as the mode, the CDM-625 generates a timing signal of the interface
type selected here.

The two interface types do not need to be the same for a particular link. For
example, if it is required to generate an E1 reference signal at the remote site, but
at the local end only a T1 reference signal is available, this is supported.

531

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.1.5.4 CONFIG: Clocks Freq-Ref

Frequency Reference: Internal


(Internal(with O/P),1,2,5,10MHz) ()

Use the arrow keys to select one of the two internal reference modes Internal and
Internal (with Output) and then press ENTER.

Internal (with Output) mode uses the internal reference as an output on the rear panel Ext Ref
In/Out BNC connector. This mode is useful if a user wishes to use a single frequency reference
for both the modem and another piece of equipment in the system. When selecting this mode,
an amber LED adjacent to the connector illuminates to alert you that the connector, normally
used as input, now has an output signal present.

5.2.1.5.5 CONFIG: Clocks Int-Ref-Adjust

Internal Hi-Stability 10MHz Reference


Fine Adjust: +048 (+/-999) ()

Very fine adjustment of the Internal 10MHz Reference is possible when selecting the Internal 10
MHz Reference. The adjustment value is retained in EEPROM memory, and is therefore not lost
when the NVram memory is cleared.

Use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit, and then use the arrow keys to change that
digit. Press ENTER when done.

Changes made to the adjust value are executed immediately upon entry, not after
pressing the ENTER key.

532

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.1.6 CONFIG: D&I (Drop & Insert)

Chapter 9. CLOCK MODES AND DROP & INSERT (D&I).

1. Drop & Insert operation is a FAST option.

2. D&I (Drop & Insert) is not available when IP-ACM mode is selected.

If D&I has not been selected, this menu displays as shown:

Drp-Type= N/A Chan/TS Loop=Y (Y/N)


Ins-Type= N/A Chan/TS ()

If you configure the modem for Quad Drop and Insert (QDI), then a different menu displays
see Sect. 5.2.1.6.4.

For one-port D&I, the menu displays as shown:

Drp-Type= T1-D4 Chan/TS Loop=Y (Y/N)


Ins-Type= T1-D4 Chan/TS ()

On the top line Use the arrow keys to select the Drp-Type (Drop-Type); its Chan/TS
(Channel Timeslot); or the Loop.

On the bottom line Select the Ins-Type (Insert-Type) or its Chan/TS (Channel Timeslot).

For any of these selections, press ENTER to continue on to that selections submenu branch, and
then use the arrow keys to individually edit those parameters.

5.2.1.6.1 CONFIG: D&I Loop


Selecting Loop ties Drop Data Out (DDO) to Insert Data Input (IDI) without having to externally
connect cables to these ports. Use the arrow keys to select Y(es) or N(o) for the Loop
feature.

5.2.1.6.2 CONFIG: D&I Drp-Type or Ins-Type


The Drop-Types and Insert-Types are:
T1- D4 T1 ESF E1 CCS E1 CAS
Use the arrow keys to select the desired Drop-Type and Insert-Type. To edit the Channel
Timeslots (Chan/TS) for either Drop or Insert, press ENTER to display the screens featured in the
next sections.

533

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.1.6.3 CONFIG: D&I (Drop or Insert) Chan/TS (Channel Timeslots)

Drp-Ch: 1 2 3 4
TS: 01 02 03 04

Ins-Ch: 1 2 3 4 5
TS: 01 02 03 04 na

For the Drop-Type or Insert-Type Channel Timeslots, use the arrow keys to select the
Channel to edit, and then use the arrow keys to edit that timeslots value. Press ENTER
when done.

The number of available Channels depends on the data rate:

If the data rate is 1920 kbps and the framing is D&I, then only the E1 formats are
available and the Chan/TS menus are disabled. This is the Fixed Channel Mode where
all timeslots are allocated in order. D&I++ does not have Fixed Channel Mode.

If the framing is D&I and Drop/Insert Type is E1-CAS, Timeslot 16 is used solely for CAS
signaling and therefore may not be allocated for traffic data.

5.2.1.6.4 CONFIG: Quad D&I (QDI)

Quad D&I (QDI):


Drop Insert ()

Use the arrow keys to select Drop or Insert, and then press ENTER.

CONFIG: Quad D&I (QDI) Drop or Insert

QDI Port[ch]: Drop: 01536 kbps


1[09] 2[15] 3[00] 4[00] ()

QDI Port[ch]: Insert: 01536 kbps


1[09] 2[15] 3[00] 4[00] ()

The Drop or Insert submenus show information for all four ports of the Drop or Insert sides, and
the cumulative Tx or Rx data rates.

Typical for either submenu:

Each port may be allocated between 0 and 32 channels, accumulating to no less than one
channel and no more than 32 channels.

534

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

Use the arrow keys to select the port to edit, and then use the arrow keys to edit the
number of channels for that port. The cumulative data rate calculates and displays as you edit
the number of channels.

After pressing ENTER, a submenu appears based on the port that the cursor had been on (where
#X is the tributary port number):

QDI Drp-Ch: 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 >


Port#X TS: 01 02 03 04 11 12 13 14

QDI Ins-Ch: 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 >


Port#X TS: 01 02 03 04 11 12 13 14

Each display can only show up to eight channels. A > character displays at the top right-hand
side of either screen to indicate that there are more channels to view beyond Channel 8 (as
shown in the preceding examples). Use the arrow key to scroll further to more channels.

Use the arrow keys to select a timeslot, and then use the arrow keys to edit that
timeslot value. Press ENTER when done.

535

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.1.7 CONFIG: ACM (Adaptive Coding and Modulation) (IP-ACM Mode


Only)

Chapter 17. ADAPTIVE CODING AND MODULATION (ACM)

ACM Config: Min/Max-ModCod Unlock-Action


Target-EbNo-Margin ()

Use the arrow keys to select Min/Max-ModCod, Unlock-Action, or Target-EbNo-Margin,


and then press ENTER.

5.2.1.7.1 CONFIG: ACM Min/Max-ModCod

Min Modcod: 00 (B 0.488 0.488 bps/Hz)


Max Modcod: 00 (B 0.488 0.488 bps/Hz)

Use the arrow keys to select the Min(imum) or Max(imum) ModCod range setting. Then,
use the arrow keys to define the range of ModCods (00 through 11) over which the system
will operate. Press ENTER when done.

ModCod 00 is BPSK Rate 0.488 (0.49 bps/Hz), while ModCod 11 is 16-QAM Rate 0.853
(3.41bps/Hz).

If you wishes to constrain the system to run at a fixed ModCod, set the Min and
Max ModCod values to be equal.

The value of Max ModCod may be limited by other FAST codes installed. For
example, suppose the 4100 ksps FAST option is installed, and the symbol rate set
to 4100 ksps, the theoretical maximum data rate would be 14 Mbps at ModCod 11.
However, if CnC is being used, with a 10 Mbps FAST limit the ACM Max ModCod
will be limited to ModCod 7, or 9.6 Mbps.

5.2.1.7.2 CONFIG: ACM Unlock-Action

When distant-end demod loses lock:


Go to min Tx ModCod (Maintain,Min) ()

Use this submenu to establish the desired action when the remote demod loses lock. This is
important, as the ACM system depends on the feedback of the SNR metric from the remote
demod to determine the optimum ModCod. Use the arrow keys to select Go to min Tx
ModCod (recommended) or Maintain Tx ModCod, and then press ENTER.

536

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.1.7.3 CONFIG: ACM Target-EbNo-Margin

Target Eb/No Margin = 1.0 dB (0.0 4.5)


()

Use the arrow keys to select a margin value from 0.0 to 4.5 dB, in 0.5 dB increments. Press
ENTER when done.

The ACM system is designed to switch based on thresholds that correspond to a


BER of 5 x 10-8 for each ModCod. However, in order to prevent oscillation around
two ModCods at this exact value, 0.3 dB of hysteresis has been added.

5.2.1.8 CONFIG: CnC

CnC operation requires installation of the DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier module. In


addition to installing the CnC module, you needs to purchase one of several
available FAST options to provide capability to a maximum of 25Mbps.
1. Chapter 10. DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier OPTION
2. For more information about purchasing FAST options:
Sect. 5.2.8 SELECT: FAST menus
Sect. 1.3.10 Fully Accessible System Topology (FAST)
Appendix C. FAST ACTIVATION PROCEDURE

Carrier in Carrier: Mode Freq-Offset


Search-Delay PMSI-control ()

Use the arrow keys to select Mode, Freq-Offset, Search-Delay, or PMSI-control, and then
press ENTER.

5.2.1.8.1 CONFIG: CnC Mode


See Sect. 10.6 Carrier-in-Carrier Automatic Power Control (CnC-APC) in Chapter 10.
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier OPTION for complete details about, and setup of, the
CnC-APC feature.

CnC Mode: APC,Side A,C-band (Off, On, APC)


Activate? N(Y,N) APC is not active ()

On the top line Use the arrow keys to select the appropriate CnC operating mode.
Available selections are:
Off On (normal) APC,Side A,C-band
APC,Side A,X-band APC,Side A,Ku-band APC,Side A,Ka-band

537

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

APC,Side B,C-band APC,Side B,X-band APC,Side B,Ku-band


APC,Side B,Ka-band

With no CnC module (card) installed, CnC Mode is Off, this menu is inaccessible, and the
CONFIG: CnC Mode screen appears as shown:

CnC Mode: Off (Off, On, APC)


Card not installed ()

5.2.1.8.2 CONFIG: CnC CONFIG: CnC Freq-Offset

CnC Frequency Offset: (range 1-032)


+/-015 kHz ()

Use this menu to enter the maximum expected frequency offset between the outbound
interferer and the desired inbound. It normally corresponds to the demod acquisition range.

Use the arrow keys to edit the CnC Frequency Offset value, and then press ENTER. The
upper limit of Frequency Offset is determined by the Rx symbol rate:

Below 64 ksymbols/sec: 1 to (Rs/2) kHz, where:

Rs=symbol rate in ksymbols/sec

Between 64 and 389 ksymbols/sec: 1 up to a maximum of 32kHz

Above 389 ksymbols/sec: 1 to (0.1Rs) kHz, up to a maximum of 200 kHz

This range is pre-calculated and displayed in parentheses for reference.

5.2.1.8.3 CONFIG: CnC Search-Delay

CnC Search Delay: (range 0-330ms)


Min: 010 ms Max: 290 ms ()

To reduce the time taken for the CnC algorithm to converge, you may apply restrictions to the
range of delay used by the search. During initial link testing, it should be set to 240 ms (min) and
300 ms (max). Once CnC has found the exact delay, the value can be further reduced but care
should be taken to allow sufficient range to accommodate changes in path delay due to
Doppler.
If CnC is being bench-tested with two units in a back-to-back configuration, the
minimum delay should be set to 0 ms, and the maximum to 20 ms. This takes into
account the lack of satellite delay.

538

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

To edit the Min or Max delay, use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit, and then use the
arrow keys to change that digit. Press ENTER when done.

5.2.1.8.4 CONFIG: CnC PMSI-Control

CnC PMSI Mode: Idle


(Idle, Redundancy, Talk, Listen) ()

The Pre-Mapped Symbol Interface (PMSI) is an RS-485 multi-drop bus system where one device
transmits and all other devices on the multi-drop bus are configured to receive. Its function, as
associated with DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier, permits the modulator in a selected unit to
provide a direct copy of its output (the outbound interferer) to one or many other modems. The
other modem(s) may then choose to take the PMSI signal and use it for its own CnC reference.
This applies to 1:1 and 1:N systems, and to certain other configurations.

In order to use this mode of operation, you must connect the appropriate cable to the PMSI
connector on the rear panel of each modem:

For 1:N multi-drop applications Use Comtech EF Data cable P/N CA-0000275;

For 1:1 applications Use Comtech EF Data cable P/N CA-0000276.

Contact Comtech EF Data Customer Service for further details about either cable.

Use the arrow keys to select the desired PMSI control configuration, and then press ENTER.
Note the following:

Selection Function
Idle Select when CnC is not used.
Redundancy Select when CnC is used in a 1:1 or 1:N redundancy applications.
Select w hen C nC i s us ed i n o ther c onfigurations, or f or m anual t esting ( the m odem w ill
Talk
transmit a copy of its baseband modulated signal on the PMSI port).
Select when CnC is used in other configurations, or for manual testing (the modem will receive
Listen the P MSI s ignal, and l ock its m odulator t o t his, per mitting t he C nC m odule t o us e t he ot her
modems reference outbound interferer).

539

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.1.9 CONFIG: EDMAC

Chapter 11. EDMAC CHANNEL

EDMAC Mode= Idle (Idle,Master,Slave)


()

Embedded Distant-end Monitor And Control (EDMAC) is a Comtech-proprietary framing that


permits communication access to the distant-end modem. In order to edit the EDMAC mode,
the framing must be set for EDMAC, EDMAC-2, EDMAC-3, or D&I++.

EDMAC Mode= Master (Idle,Master,Slave)


EDMAC Address= 0020 ()

Use the arrow keys to select the mode as Idle, Master, or Slave, and then press ENTER.

If the mode is Master or Slave, the bottom line shows an address. To edit the address, use the
arrow keys to select a digit to edit, and then use the arrow keys to change that digit.
Press ENTER when done. Note the following:

An EDMAC Master is a modem that is local to the M&C computer, and which passes
messages, via the overhead, to a distant-end modem. The Master address always ends
in 0.

An EDMAC Slave is a modem that is not local to the M&C computer. It is at the distant-
end of a satellite link. The Slave EDMAC address always ends in 1. When configured as
a Slave, reconfiguration is expected to be via the EDMAC link, and is therefore not
permitted via the front panel or via serial remote control.

540

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.1.10 CONFIG: Misc

Misc: G.703-LineCode IDR-ESC HSSI RTS


Audio-Vol HiRateESC WarmUp Stats MEO ()

Use the arrow keys to select G.703-LineCode, IDR-ESC, HSSI, RTS, Audio-Vol, HiRateESC,
WarmUp, Stats, or MEO and then press ENTER.

5.2.1.10.1 CONFIG: Misc G.703-LineCode (Ternary Code)

Parameters are editable only when the Data Interface Type is G.703.

Tx G.703/DDO Code= AMI (AMI,B8ZS)


Rx G.703/IDI Code= AMI (AMI,B8ZS) ()

The choices displayed here depend on the selected G.703 interface type. Use the arrow
keys to select either the G.703 Tx or Rx Ternary Code, and then use the arrow keys to select
the desired code. Press ENTER when done. The available choices are as follows:

Selection For:

HDB3 E1, E2 or sub-rate operation

B8ZS T1 and Unbalanced T2 operation

B6ZS Balanced T2 operation

AMI

5.2.1.10.2 CONFIG: Misc IDR-ESC

Parameters are editable only when the Framing Mode is IDR.

IDR-ESC-Type Tx:64k Data (64kData,Audio)


Rx:64k Data ()

Use this menu to determine if the 64 kbps channel in the IDR Engineering Service Channel (ESC)
overhead, normally reserved for the two 32 kbps ADPCM audio channels, should instead carry
user data. The rear panel Overhead connector provides the appropriate EIA-422 interface for
this option.

541

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

Use the arrow keys to select the parameter to edit, and then use the arrow keys to
select its setting. Press ENTER when done.

5.2.1.10.3 CONFIG: Misc HSSI

This control setting is applicable only when the Data Interface Type is HSSI.

HSSI handshake control: (2 options)


TA-> CA loop ()

Use the arrow keys to select HSSI handshake control as TA -> CA loop, RR cntl CA, or TA
cntl Tx, and then press ENTER.

5.2.1.10.4 CONFIG: Misc RTS

This control setting is effective only when the Data Interface is set for RS-422 or
V.35.

RTS/CTS operation: (3 options)


Loop, RTS controls Tx-out ()

Use the arrow keys to set the RTS/CTS control, and then press ENTER. The available choices
are as follows:

Selection Function
RTS and CTS are looped so that CTS echoes the state of RTS, but RTS does
RTS/CTS Loop, No Action
not control the ON/OFF state of the carrier.
RTS and C TS ar e l ooped s o t hat C TS ec hoes t he s tate of R TS, and R TS
Loop, RTS controls Tx out controls the ON/OFF state of the carrier (i.e., the modem will not bring up its TX
carrier until RTS is asserted).

RxEnable RTS is ignored and CTS is asserted unconditionally.

5.2.1.10.5 CONFIG: Misc Audio-Vol (ADPCM Audio Volumes)

ADPCM Tx1 = +0 dB Tx2 = -2 dB


Volumes: Rx1 = +2 dB Rx2 = -4 dB ()

Use this menu to adjust the gain (or volume) of the audio ESC circuits for both Transmit (Tx) and
Receive (Rx). Use the arrow keys to select the volume to edit, and then use the arrow

542

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

keys to change the value. The permitted range of the volumes is 6 dB to +8 dB, in 2 dB steps.
Press ENTER when done.

5.2.1.10.6 CONFIG: Misc HiRateESC

High-Rate-ESC=Off (Off,On) RS-232


2400 baud DataParityStop=8N1 ()

The ESC (Engineering Service Channel) is determined by the framing type (IBS, D&I, or ESC++)
selected under CONFIG: Mode. The High Rate IBS (Engineering Service Channel) requires the
Open Network FAST option. Both Tx and Rx Framing must be configured as IBS or D&I for this
feature to be enabled. When enabled, the lower of the Tx or Rx primary data rate limits the
maximum baud rate, in accordance with the following table:

Data Rate Max ESC Baud Rate


64 kbps 2400
128 kbps 4800
256 kbps 9600
384 kbps 14400
512 kbps 19200
768 kbps 28800
1024 kbps 38400

Chapter 14. OPEN NETWORK OPERATIONS

ESC++ is available as standard. Both Tx and Rx framing must be set to ESC++. When enabled, the
lower of the Tx or Rx primary data rate limits the maximum baud rate, in accordance with the
following table:

Data Rate Max ESC++ Baud Rate


64 kbps 4800
128 kbps 9600
192 kbps 14400
256 kbps 19200
384 kbps 28800
512 kbps 38400

Chapter 12. ESC++

Use the arrow keys to select the parameter to edit, and then use the arrow keys to
select its setting. The available choices are as follows:

543

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

High-Rate-Esc operation as On or Off.

RS-232 or RS-485.

Baud rate (range depends on other configuration parameters, previously noted).

Character format (number of data bits, parity, number of stop bits): 8N1 (8-None-1), 7E2
(7-Even-2) or 7O2 (7-Odd-2).

Press ENTER when done.

5.2.1.10.7 CONFIG: Misc Warm-Up

High-Stab Reference Warm-Up Delay:


Enabled (None,Enable) ()

The High-Stability Reference Module contains an oven for its crystal. During the short time it
takes for the oven and crystal to come up to temperature, frequency accuracy is not
guaranteed.

Use this menu to select a Warm-up Delay that executes upon power-up. This delay is calculated
by the modem and is based on temperature and the amount of time the unit was turned off.
This is much more important at L-Band (950-2000 MHz) than at 50-180 MHz, where the 10 MHz
reference may also be used for RF conversion equipment.

Once this feature is enabled and the modem is powered up, a Warm-Up Delay Countdown is
activated during which time the Tx is suppressed. This countdown displays in decremented
fashion as shown in this example:

Comtech CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem


High-Stability Ref warming up: 045 sec

Press the CLEAR key to bypass this warm-up period as needed.

5.2.1.10.8 CONFIG: Misc Stats (Statistics)

Link Statistics Logging Interval:


10 minutes (00 to 90) ()

The Logging Interval is the period over which performance statistics are to be measured. Use the
arrow keys either to set this interval as 00 to disable the feature (i.e., no logging), or to
select a logging interval, in 10-minute increments, from 10 through 90 minutes. Press ENTER
when done.

544

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

To view compiled Statistic logs, access the SELECT: Monitor Statistics menu (see Sect.
5.2.2.8 for detailed information about viewing compiled Statistics data).

5.2.1.10.9 CONFIG: Misc MEO

MEO is non-functional when the optional CnC card is installed.

CDM-625 modems are configurable for continuous pairing as Primary and non-Primary Modems
in an Antenna Handover System when the MEO (Medium Earth Orbit) feature is enabled.
Ethernet data traffic is transmitted and received via the Primary and Non-Primary CDM-625s
four 10/100 Ethernet ports. The Antenna Handover signal received from the user-provided IF/RF
switch determines which modem is the ONLINE or OFFLINE unit:

The ONLINE unit transmits traffic only to the WAN side while, at the same time, the
OFFLINE units Tx is muted.

Both the ONLINE and OFFLINE units receive the satellite traffic, but only the ONLINE unit
forwards traffic to the LAN side while the OFFLINE unit drops the packets.

Any time a unit switches from the OFFLINE to ONLINE state, the traffic destined for the
WAN is buffered, preconfigured in milliseconds (base modem Antenna Handover
delay).

With MEO disabled, the CONFIG: Misc MEO screen appears as follows:

MEO: Feature

Press ENTER to access the MEO feature activation screen:

MEO Feature: Disabled (Enabled, Disabled)


Use the arrow keys to select the MEO feature as Disabled or Enabled, and then press
ENTER. Once the MEO feature is enabled, you are returned back to the MEO screen, only now
the Antenna Handover function is visible and available for selection:

MEO: Feature Antenna Handover


()

Use the arrow keys to select Feature or Antenna Handover, and then press ENTER.

545

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.1.10.9.1 CONFIG: Misc MEO Antenna Handover

Antenna Handover: Enabled DPD = 00


Mode = Manual ()

Use the arrow keys to navigate to the proper line:

First, on the top line Use the arrow keys to select the Antenna Handover operational
control, and to set the DPD (Digital Pre-Distortion) limit.

To set the Antenna Handover operation, use the arrow keys to select operation as
Enabled or Disabled.

To set a value for the DPD limit for this unit, use the arrow keys to select a DPD
value from -13 to (+)13.

Next, on the bottom line Use the arrow keys to set the Antenna Handover switching
mode as Manual or Auto.

Press ENTER when done.

5.2.1.11 CONFIG: Mask


The Mask submenus allow you to selectively mask (ignore) or make active various alarms and
traffic conditions that are monitored by the modem.

Alarm Masks: AIS Buffer Ref RxIF TxClk


TxSat RxSat Terr ROp BUC LNB CEX ()

Use the arrow keys to select AIS, Buffer, Ref, RxIF, TxClk, TxSat, RxSat, Terr, ROp, BUC, LNB
and CEX, and then press ENTER.

5.2.1.11.1 CONFIG: Mask AIS

AIS: Tx-Terr-AIS = Masked (Active,Mask)


Rx-Sat-AIS = Active ()

Use the arrow keys to select Tx-Terr-AIS or Rx-Sat-AIS, and then use the arrow keys to
select either as Active or Masked. Press ENTER when done. Note the following:

Selecting Tx-Terr-AIS as Active generates a fault whenever the modulator senses that
the all ones condition is present in the terrestrial data.

546

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

Selecting Rx-Sat-AIS as Active generates a fault whenever the demodulator senses that
the all ones condition is present in the receive data.

Typical for either, selecting AIS as Masked generates no alarms.

5.2.1.11.2 CONFIG: Mask Buffer or Ref

Buffer Slip Alarm = Active (Active,Mask)


Reference Alarms = Active ()

Use the arrow keys to select Buffer Slip Alarm or Reference Alarms, and then typical for
either use the arrow keys to select as Active or Masked. Press ENTER when done. Note the
following:

Selecting the Buffer Slip Alarm as Active generates a Buffer Slip fault in the Rx faults
whenever the receive circuitry senses that the buffer is either underflowing or
overflowing.

5.2.1.11.3 CONFIG: Mask RxIF

RxIF Alarms: AGC=Active (Active,Mask)


EbNo=Masked ()

Use the arrow keys to select AGC or EbNo and then, typical for either, use the arrow
keys to select the alarms as Active or Masked. Press ENTER when done. Note the following:

Selecting the AGC Rx IF Alarm as Active generates an AGC fault whenever the receive
signal level exceeds 20 dBm (for the desired carrier).

Selecting the EbNo Rx IF Alarm as Active generates an Eb/No fault whenever the
demodulator sees the receive Eb/No fall below the pre-determined value.

Typical for either, selecting the alarm as Masked, generates no alarms.

5.2.1.11.4 CONFIG: Mask TxClk

Tx Clock Alarm: = Masked (Active,Masked)


(Valid in G.703 & Ext clock modes) ()

Use the arrow keys to select the Tx Clock Alarm as Active or Masked, and then press
ENTER. Note the following:

547

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

Selecting the Tx Clock Alarm as Active generates a Tx Traffic alarm if a G.703 interface is
active and the input is lost or removed, or if selecting another interface type where the
Tx Clock mode is External and the clock is lost or removed.

Selecting the Tx Clock Alarm as Masked generates no alarm.

5.2.1.11.5 CONFIG: Mask TxSat (Satellite Tx Alarms)

Process Alarms from (Off,H/W,S/W)


BWA1=Off BWA2=Off BWA3=S/W BWA4=H/W

To determine how the Tx IDR backward alarm inputs are to be used, the alarm may be disabled
(Off); otherwise, an activated alarm may respond to a hardware input at P5A (H/W) or be
software controlled by a receive fault on the modem (S/W).

Use the arrow keys to select which Backward Alarm is to be configured BWA1, BWA2,
BWA3, or BWA4 and then use the arrow keys to set that alarm as Off, H/W, or S/W.
Press ENTER when done.

5.2.1.11.6 CONFIG: Mask RxSat (Satellite Rx Alarms)

Process Alarms received from Satellite


BWA1=N BWA2=N BWA3=N BWA4=N (Yes,No)

Use the arrow keys to select which Rx IDR backward alarms are to be monitored BWA1,
BWA2, BWA3, or BWA4 and then use the arrow keys to select Yes (to monitor) or No (to
mask). Press ENTER when done.

5.2.1.11.7 CONFIG: Mask Terr

These alarms are applicable only to D&I operation.

Terr-Alm: Tx= Active (Active,Mask)


Rx= Off (Off,Enabled)()

Use the arrow keys to select Terr-Alm Tx or Rx and then, typical for either, use the
arrow keys to set that alarm as Active or Masked. Press ENTER when done.

548

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.1.11.8 CONFIG: Mask ROp (RAN Optimization) (FUTURE)

RAN Optimization Rx Alarm = Active


(Active,Masked) ()

Although selectable/viewable, this mask is reserved for the RAN Optimization option card which,
at present, is not supported. It will be supported in a future release.

5.2.1.11.9 CONFIG: Mask BUC

Appendix F. CDM-625 ODU (TRANSCEIVER, BUC, LNB) OPERATION

BUC alarm = Active (Active,Mask)


Attach to Tx alarm = No (Yes,No)()

When using L-Band, a Block Up Converter (BUC) may be included in the system. A smart BUC
may be monitored and/or controlled via the modem via FSK (Frequency-Shift Keying control).
For a modem in a 1:1 redundancy setup, you must customize the fault indications for the
physical setup.

5.2.1.11.10 CONFIG: Mask LNB

Appendix F. CDM-625 ODU (TRANSCEIVER, BUC, LNB) OPERATION

LNB alarm = Active (Active,Mask)


Attach to Rx alarm = No (Yes,No)()

When using L-Band, a Low-Noise Block Down Converter (LNB) may be included in the system. It
cannot be monitored and/or controlled by the modem, except for the power supply values. For a
modem in a 1:1 redundancy setup, you must customize the fault indications for the physical setup.

5.2.1.11.11 CONFIG: Mask CEX (G.703 Clock Extension mask)

G.703 Clock Extension = Active


(Active, Masked) ()

Use the arrow keys to select Active or Masked, and then press ENTER.

Selecting Active generates a CEX alarm if the G.703 Clock Extension mode is set to TxLock and
the input is lost or removed from the G.703 interface.

549

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.1.12 CONFIG: Remote (Remote Control)

Remote Control=Local
(Local,Serial remote,Ethernet) ()

Use the arrow keys to select Local, Serial remote, or Ethernet, and then press ENTER.

If selecting Local, then reconfiguration via Serial Remote or Ethernet is not permitted although
remote monitoring is still possible. If Local or Serial Remote selected, a typical submenu is
displayed proceed to the next section.

5.2.1.12.1 CONFIG: Remote Local or Serial remote settings

Interface= RS-485-4W (232,485-2,485-4)


Address= 0001 9600 baud ()

If selecting either Local or Serial remote control, use the arrow keys to select Interface,
Address, or Baudrate; then, use the arrow keys to edit the Interface type, Baudrate, and
each digit of the Address. Note the following:

Character format is not selectable and is fixed at 8-N-1.


For RS-485 (aka EIA-485) The permitted address range is from 0001 to 9999. Address
0000 is reserved for universal addressing.

For RS-232 (aka EIA-232): The Address is fixed at 0000.

5.2.1.13 CONFIG: IP

IP Config: Addresses SNMP Setup


ANT AccessList PktP-Enable ()

Use the arrow keys to select Addresses, SNMP, Setup, ANT, AccessList, or displayed only
when the optional IP Packet Processor card is installed PktP-Enable, and then press ENTER.

5.2.1.13.1 CONFIG: IP Addresses

IP Addresses: MAC Gateway


Addr/Range ()

Use the arrow keys to select MAC, Gateway, or Addr/Range, and then press ENTER.

550

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

CONFIG: IP Addresses MAC

Ethernet MAC Address:


00-06-B0-00-01-06 (read-only)

This read-only screen displays the unit MAC address. Press ENTER or CLEAR to return to the
previous menu.

CONFIG: IP Addresses Gateway

Ethernet IP Gateway:
192.168.001.002 ()

To edit the IP Gateway Address for the Ethernet M&C port for this unit, use the arrow keys
to select a digit to edit, and then use the arrow keys to change that digit. Press ENTER
when done.

CONFIG: IP Addresses Address/Range

Ethernet IP Address/Range:
192.168.001.002/24 ()

To configure the IP Address for the Ethernet M&C port for this unit, use the arrow keys to
select a digit to edit, and then the arrow keys to change that digit. Press ENTER when done.

5.2.1.13.2 CONFIG: IP SNMP

SNMP:
Communities Traps ()

Use the arrow keys to select Communities or Traps, and then press ENTER.

CONFIG: IP SNMP Communities

SNMP Communities:
Read Write ()

Use the arrow keys to select Read or Write, and then press ENTER.

CONFIG: IP SNMP Communities Read

SNMP Read Community:


Public (20 chars) ()

551

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

To edit the SNMP Read Community string, use the arrow keys to select a character to edit,
and then use the arrow keys to edit that character.

Only the first 20 characters on the bottom line are available.

All printable ASCII characters are available with the exception of the backslash (ASCII code 92)
and ~ (ASCII code 126).

Press ENTER after composing the SNMP Read Community String. All trailing spaces are removed
from the string upon entry.

CONFIG: IP SNMP Communities Write

SNMP Write Community:


Private (20 chars) ()

To edit the SNMP Write Community string, use the arrow keys to select a character to edit,
and then use the arrow keys to edit that character.

Only the first 20 characters on the bottom line are available.

All printable ASCII characters are available with the exception of the backslash (ASCII code 92)
and ~ (ASCII code 126).

Press ENTER after composing the SNMP Write Community String. All trailing spaces are removed
from the string upon entry.

CONFIG: IP SNMP Traps

Traps: Community Version


IP-Addr#1 IP-Addr#2 ()

Use the arrow keys to select Community, Versions, IP-Addr#1 or IP-Addr#2, and then press
ENTER.

CONFIG: IP SNMP Traps Community

SNMP Traps Community:


Comtech (20 chars) ()

To edit the SNMP Traps Community string, use the arrow keys to select a character to edit,
and then use the arrow keys to edit that character.

Only the first 20 characters on the bottom line are available.

552

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

All printable ASCII characters are available with the exception of the backslash (ASCII code 92)
and ~ (ASCII code 126).

Press ENTER after composing the SNMP Traps Community String. All trailing spaces are removed
from the string upon entry.

CONFIG: IP SNMP Traps Version

SNMP Traps Version:


SNMP-ver1 (ver1,ver2) ()

Use the arrow keys to select SNMP-ver1 or SNMP-ver2, and then press ENTER.

CONFIG: IP SNMP Traps Address

Trap IP addr #1:


000.000.000.000 ()

To edit the SNMP Trap Destinations IP Address, use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit,
and then use the arrow keys to change that digit.

To disable SNMP Traps, set both Trap IP Addresses as 000.000.000.000.

5.2.1.13.3 CONFIG: IP Setup

IP Setup: Mode WAN PerPortCnfg DDMgmtPt


MAC-Learning VLAN QoS Stats FrmSize ()

Use the arrow keys to select Mode, WAN, PerPortCnfg, DDMgmtPt, MAC-Learning, VLAN,
QoS, Stats, or displayed only on modems with Hardware Version 2.X or higher FrmSize, and
then press ENTER.

If the optional IP Packet Processor card is installed and enabled, then both the PTP
and VLAN options are selectable but non-functional.

CONFIG: IP IP Setup Mode

Working Mode: Router Point to Point


(ManagedSwitch,R-PtoP, R-MPHub,R-MPRm)()

Use the arrow keys to select ManagedSwitch, R-PtoP (Router Point-to-Point), R-MPHub
(Router Multipoint-to-Hub), or R-MPRm (Router Multipoint-to-Remote), and then press ENTER.

553

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

If the optional IP Packet Processor card is either not installed or installed but
disabled, the mode is Fixed at Managed Switch Mode.

CONFIG: IP IP Setup WAN

WAN: Buffer Length = 240ms


Avg Buffer Fill State = 00% ()

On the top line Use the arrow keys to edit the WAN Buffer Length, and then press ENTER.
The value is configurable from 20ms to 780ms in 20ms increments. Packets are dropped when
the buffer is exceeded.

On the bottom line (read-only) The percentage of the Average WAN Buffer Fill State displays
across a 4-second duration.

If the optional IP Packet Processor card is installed and enabled, this menu is non-
functional and displays as follows:

WAN: Buffer Length = N/A due to PktP


Avg Buffer Fill State = xx% ()

CONFIG: IP IP Setup PerPortCnfg

Per-Port-Config:
Port1 Port2 Port3 Port4 ()

Use the arrow keys to select Port1, Port1, Port1 or Port4, and then press ENTER.

CONFIG: IP IP Setup PerPortCnfg Port#

Port#: Pause=Off NegoSpeed:LinkDwn


Speed=Auto (Auto,100F/H,10F/H) ()

Where # denotes the selected Port.

On the top line Pause Frame Flow Control is set on a per port basis; use the arrow keys to
set this control as On or Off (default is Off). To turn Pause on for the selected (active) port, you
must meet the following conditions:

1. Tx Data Rate, or IP Info Rate (if Sub-Mux is on), or a data rate calculated based on
ModCod0 from the Symbol Rate in ACM, must be at least 128 kbps.

554

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

-and-

2. WAN Buffer Length must be large enough, so that Data Rate in kbps x buffer
length / 4096 24.

The actual negotiated speed (NegoSpeed:) is provided here as a read-only status display.

On the bottom line Use the arrow keys to edit the desired speed setting. Note the
following:

Selection Function
Sets the port speed as Auto Negotiated. This allows the ports to negotiate speed and half/duplex
Auto
operation.
100Full Forces the Port to 100/Full.

100Half Forces the Port to 100/Half.

10Full Forces the Port to 10/Full.

10Half Forces the port to 10/Half.

CONFIG: IP IP Setup DDMgmtPt (Dedicated Management Port)

Dedicated Management Port: Port1


(Disabled,Port1,Port2,Port3,Port4) ()

Dedicated Management Port mode is not available when the optional IP Packet
Processor card is installed and enabled. Should you attempt to execute this
command under such a configuration, the screen is non-functional, and appears as
follows:

Dedicated Management Port: Disabled


(Fixed @ Disabled with PktP Present) ()

Use Dedicated Management Port mode in redundancy applications. When a redundant


CDM-625 is Offline (Standby), all four of the offline modems Ethernet ports are disabled unless
you configure one of the four ports as the Dedicated Management Port.

Use the arrow keys to set the Dedicated Management Port as Disabled, or select one of
the Ethernet ports (Port1, Port2, Port3 or Port4). Press ENTER when done.

555

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

CONFIG: IP IP Setup MAC-Learning

Unit power must be cycled whenever MAC Learning mode is enabled or disabled.

MAC learning:
Off (Off, On) ()

MAC Learning is an Ethernet switch function that allows the LAN (user) side of the Ethernet
ports to learn the MAC addresses of the equipment connected to those ports. Learning applies
only to the LAN (user) side of the Ethernet ports. There is no learning on the WAN (modem) side
of the ports.

If On (enabled), the interface is in LAN-to-WAN learning mode, and the connections are learned
based on source MAC addresses and ingress ports. Once the connections are learned, the switch
will not send any more packets destined to local node over WAN.

If Off (disabled), the interface passes all packets from the LAN to the WAN.

Use the arrow keys to select On (to enable) or Off (to disable) MAC learning. Press ENTER,
and then cycle the unit power.

CONFIG: IP IP Setup VLAN


If the optional IP Packet Processor card is installed and enabled, then the CONFIG:
IP Setup VLAN menu and its available submenus and operations described
hereafter, while selectable, are not functional.

VLAN: Disabled (Dis,Ena) Mgmt-VLAN=0001


PortMode VLAN-Table ()

VLAN Operation Use the arrow keys to first select this operation parameter, and then use
the arrow keys to set VLAN Operation as Disabled or Enabled.

Mgmt-VLAN To configure a Management Ports VLAN ID, use the arrow keys to select a
digit to edit, and then use the arrow keys to change that digit. The value range is from 1 to
4095.

Hold down the arrow keys to quickly scroll between 1 and 4095.

PortMode or VLAN-Table From the VLAN submenu, use the arrow keys to select either
parameter, and then press ENTER.

556

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

CONFIG: IP IP Setup VLAN PortMode

Port Mode:
Port1 Port2 Port3 Port4 ()

Use the arrow keys to select Port1, Port2, Port3 or Port4, and then press ENTER.

CONFIG: IP IP Setup VLAN PortMode Port#

Port #: Port Mode= Trunk


PVID=N/A ()

Where # denotes the selected Port, use the arrow keys to select the operation parameter.
Then, use the arrow keys to select Access or Trunk.

When Port Mode is selected as Trunk, VLAN ID (PVID) is not applicable. On the bottom line of
the display, the selected ports PVID will display as PVID=N/A.

Otherwise, when Port Mode set to Access, configure the VLAN IDs (PVIDs). To edit the PVID, first
use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit, and then use the arrow keys to change that
digit. Enter a PVID in the range from 0001 to 4095. The default is 0001.

Hold down the arrow keys to quickly scroll between 0001 and 4095.

CONFIG: IP IP Setup VLAN VLAN-Table

VLAN Table:
View/Edit/Delete Add-Entry ()

The VLAN table supports up to 32 entries. Use the arrow keys to select View/Edit/Delete
or Add-Entry, and then press ENTER.

CONFIG: IP IP Setup VLAN VLAN-Table View / Edit / Delete

VLAN ID:0001 P1:Filtered P2:Untagged


P3:Tagged P4:Untagged ACT=None(N,E,D)

To view, edit, or delete existing VLAN IDs, first use the arrow keys to select the desired
parameter:

VLAN ID Selects the tabulated VLAN ID. After selecting VLAND ID, use the arrow
keys to scroll through the available VLAN IDs.

557

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

ACT Choose an action to undertake for the selected VLAN ID NONE (default), Edit, or
Del (Delete).

P1 (Port1) through P4 (Port4) With ACT=Edit active, you may update the selected
ports behavior attributes, as assigned under the selected VLAN ID.

You have the following options:

View, without changing, the behavior attributes assigned to each port under the
selected VLAN ID: ACT=NONE (default).

Edit the behavior attributes assigned to each port under the selected VLAN ID. Once the
VLAN ID targeted for editing is selected, use the arrow keys to select the ACT
parameter, and then use the arrow keys to select ACT=Edit.

Next, to change the behavior attribute of a specific port as needed, use the arrow keys to
select P1, P2, P3, or P4. Then, use the arrow keys to designate the attribute for that port as
Tagged or Filtered for a Trunk port, or Untagged or Filtered for an Access port.

The Untagged option is available only when Port Mode has been set to Access
for the selected port.

You may not designate the behavior attributes for all four ports as Filtered is
this is done, and you presses ENTER to save this configuration change, an error
message will display as follows:

ERROR: Entry with FILTERED on all ports


is not allowed.

Once the port attributes have been changed (with ACT=Edit active), press ENTER to save those
changes. ENTER must be pressed to save the change. CLEAR will discard the change.

You must take into consideration, when editing VLAN table entries, the following rules:

All Untagged/Tagged packets arriving at the LAN port are tagged (four byte VLAN
frame is added) with the configured VLAN ID.

If the port is in Port Mode, any packet arriving from the WAN that matches this PVID
will have the VLAN tag removed and passed out the Ethernet.

If the port is in Port Mode and the packet does not match the PVID, the VLAN table
must be checked to determine if the packet should pass. Packets leaving a port in Port
Mode are always untagged.

If the port behavior Port Mode attribute is set to Trunk, then the VLAN table is
referenced to determine if the packet should pass. In this mode, packets will either be
filtered (dropped) or passed as is with the VLAN header intact.

558

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

Delete the selected VLAN ID. After targeting a VLAN ID for deletion, use the arrow
keys to select the ACT parameter, and then use the arrow keys to select ACT=Del.
Press ENTER to execute deletion of the selected VLAN ID.

You must take into consideration that, when deleting VLAN IDs, an entry
associated with an enabled PVID cannot be deleted.

CONFIG: IP IP Setup VLAN VLAN-Table Add-Entry

VLAN ID:???? P1:Tagged P2:Tagged


P3:Tagged P4:Untagged ADD ()

To add new entries to the VLAN table:

First, use the arrow keys to select the ???? character string following the VLAN ID:
parameter.

Then, use the arrow keys to replace the string with a new VLAN ID.

Hold down the arrow keys to quickly scroll between 1 and 4095.

Next, use the arrow keys to select the port (P1/Port1 through P4/Port4), and then
use the arrow keys to set the behavior attribute for that port as Tagged, Filtered,
or Untagged.

The port attribute assignment restrictions explained previously apply.

Once you assign the VLAN ID and the port behavior attributes, press ENTER to create
the new entry. You are then returned to the previous menu.

Note the following:

If you attempt to add an entry that is named identically to an existing VLAN ID, an error
message displays as follows:

ERROR: vid already exists in table

If you attempt to add a new entry, and the VLAN table has already reached the 32
maximum allowable entries, an error message displays as follows:

Can not add new entry!


VLAN table is FULL!

559

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

You must follow these rules when creating or adding a VLAN table entry:

The VLAN ID (0001-4095) must be unique it cannot be a duplicate of any previously


assigned VLAN ID, including PVIDs in the VLAN ID table.

If a port is not in Trunk Mode (PortMode = Trunk), the behavior attribute for each port
may be set as Tagged or Filtered.

For any VLAN ID (Trunk Mode) created, at a minimum, one port must be
defined as Tagged.

You must follow these rules when assigning PVIDs:

The PVID (0001-4095) must be unique it cannot be a duplicate of any previously


assigned VLAN ID, including PVID. The only exception to this rule is that the default
value 0001 may be assigned as the PVID for all ports.

If a port is in Access Mode (Port Mode = Access), the behavior attribute for each port
may be set as Untagged or Filtered.

PVIDs are automatically entered into the VLAN ID Table when changed.

When a new PVID entry is added to the VLAN ID Table, the other ports will default to
Filtered.

When a PVID is changed, the entry in the VLAN ID Table for that port will change to
Filtered. If the rest of the ports are also Filtered, then delete that entry. If any other port
has been marked Tagged, leave the entry in the table.

THE FOLLOWING EXAMPLES OF THE VLAN PORT CONFIGURATION AND ID TABLES ARE
PROVIDED FOR USER REFERENCE:

VLAN Port Configuration


Port Port Mode Native VLAN ID
1 Trunk N/A
2 Trunk N/A
3 Trunk N/A
4 Access 3400

VLAN ID Table
VLAN ID Port 1 Port 2 Port 3 Port 4
344 Tagged Filtered Tagged Filter
454 Filtered Tagged Tagged Untagged (Access mode)
3400 Filter Tagged Filter Untagged (Access mode)

560

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

CONFIG: IP IP Setup QoS (Quality of Service)

Chapter 20. QUALITY OF SERVICE (QoS)

QoS functionality is dependent on whether the optional IP Packet Processor card is either a) not
installed or installed but disabled, or b) installed and enabled.

QoS Mode: L2 QoS L3 QoS


()

Use the arrow keys to select the basic QoS setup as L2 QoS or L3 QoS:

Select L2 QoS (Layer 2) when the optional IP Packet Processor card is either not
installed or installed but disabled.

Select L3 QoS (Layer 3) when the optional IP Packet Processor card is installed and
enabled. L3 QoS is required to support IP Packet Processor Managed Switch Mode.

Press ENTER to continue.

CONFIG: IP IP Setup QoS L2 QoS

L2 QoS=Off (Off,VLAN,PT,VLAN&Port)
()

Use the arrow keys to set the L2 QoS operational priority, and press ENTER when done. The
choices are as follows:

Selection Function
Off QoS disabled.
(VLAN Priority o nly) QoS traffic prioritization is applied based o n the priority bits in the LAN
VLAN
ingress packets VLAN tag.
PT (Port Priority only) QoS traffic prioritization is applied based on LAN ingress traffic port.
(VLAN and Port Priority) In this mode, if the LAN ingress packet contains a V LAN tag, it will
VLAN&Port
then apply the VLAN Priority scheme; otherwise it applies the port-based priority scheme.

When selecting Port (only) or VLAN&Port, the display updates to include Port Priority on the
bottom line:

L2 QoS=Port only (Off,VLAN,PT,VLAN&Port)


Port Priority: P1:1 P2:2 P3:1 P4:1 ()

To define Port Priority, use the arrow keys to select the port (P1, P2, P3, or P4), and then
use the arrow keys to designate a priority from 1 to 4 (with Priority 4 being the highest).

561

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

CONFIG: IP IP Setup QoS L3 QoS


When the optional IP Packet Processor card is either not installed or installed but disabled, and
L3 QoS is selected, this menu is disabled and appears as follows:

L3 QoS=Off
(Fixed at Off) ()

Otherwise, when the optional IP Packet Processor card is installed and enabled, the L3 QoS
menu appears as follows:

L3 QoS=Off
(Off,Max/Prio,MinMax,DiffServ) ()

To set the L3 QoS operational priority, use the arrow keys, and press ENTER when done.
The choices are as follows:

Selection Function

Off QoS disabled.


(Maximum priority only) Provides multi-level traffic prioritization with the ability to limit
Max/Prio
maximum traffic per priority class.
(Minimum/Maximum priority) Provides a Committed Information Rate (CIR) to each
MinMax user-defined class of traffic with the ability to allow a higher burstable rate depending
on availability.
(DiffServ priority only) Industry-standard method of providing QoS, enabling
DiffServ
seamless co-existence in networks that implement DiffServ.

CONFIG: IP IP Setup Stats

IPstats: Port x In Out ()


Unicasts: 00000003 00000023 Clr:N

This screen provides IP traffic statistics for both the In (Ingress) and Out (Egress) directions. Use
the arrow keys to navigate to the proper line, in this order:

First, on the top line Use the arrow keys to select the bottom-line IPstats type as WAN,
Ports 1 through 4, HDLC FPGA, or Management. (In and Out are column labels for the
bottom line parameters and are not selectable.)

Next, on the bottom line Use the arrow keys to view the desired statistical parameter.
The following statistics are available:

562

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

IP Stats Type Available Statistics


(Use to select) (Use to navigate to the bottom line, and then to display a desired statistic)
WAN HDLC Frames In / Out

Tx Dropped

Rx CRC Error
Port 1 *Indicates In only
Unicasts 511 Octets
Port 2 **Indicates Out only
Port 3 Broadcasts 1023 Octets
Port 4
Pause Max Octets
HDLC FPGA
Management Multicasts Jabber*

FCS Error Oversize*

Align Error* Discards

Good Octets Filtered*

Bad Octets* Collisions**

Undersize Multiple**

Fragments* Single**

64 Octets Deferred**

127 Octets Late**

255 Octets Excessive**

To clear the IP Statistics accumulators, use the arrow keys to move the cursor to Clr:N;
then, use the arrow keys to select Clr:Y. Press ENTER when done.

CONFIG: IP IP Setup FrmSize

This feature is supported only on modems with Hardware Version 2.X or higher.

2048 Ethernet Frame Size:


Enabled (Dis/Ena) ()

Use the arrow keys to set 2048-byte Ethernet packet sizes as Enabled or Disabled, and then
press ENTER.

563

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.1.13.4 CONFIG: IP ANT (Advanced Network Timing)

IP Protocols: SNTP PTP


()

Use the arrow keys to select SNTP or PTP, and then press ENTER.

5.2.1.13.4.1 CONFIG: IP ANT SNTP (Simple Network Time Protocol)

SNTP: Disabled (Disabled, Enabled)


Servers: Primary Backup ()

Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) is used to synchronize computer clocks throughout a
computer network when the ultimate performance of the full NTP implementation as per
RFC-1305 (Requests for Comment No. 1305: Network Time Protocol, Version 3, Specification,
Implementation and Analysis) is not needed or justified.

On the top line Use the arrow keys to select SNTP as Enabled or Disabled. If Enabled,
SNTP contacts the time server to update the Real-Time Clock (RTC) every 24 hours. If Disabled,
no such notifications take place.

On the bottom line Use the arrow keys to first navigate to the bottom line, and then
select the Primary or Backup Server submenu. Pressing ENTER to continue:

[#######] Time Server: 192.168.001.010


Last Update: Never ()

(Where [######] Time Server denotes Primary Time Server or Backup Time Server):

On the top line To edit the selected Time Servers IP Address, use the arrow keys to select
a digit to edit, and then use the arrow keys to change that digit.

On the bottom line this read-only field displays the time and date that the selected server was
last updated. The time is shown in military format (HH:MM:SS); the date is shown in DAY-
MONTH-YEAR format in accordance with European convention. This line specifies Never if no
update information exists.

564

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.1.13.4.2 CONFIG: IP ANT PTP (Precision Time Protocol)

Sect. 16.7.2 Precision Time Protocol (PTP) (Chapter 16. ETHERNET NETWORK
MANAGEMENT)

1. If the optional IP Packet Processor card is installed and enabled, then the
CONFIG: IPANTPTP menu and its available submenus and operations
described hereafter, while selectable, are not functional.

2. All network devices between the Grandmaster and Slave devices must support
PTP for sub-microsecond accuracy.

PTP Feature = Enabled


PTP Grandmaster = LAN ()

Precision Time Protocol (PTP) is a FAST-activated feature used to synchronize computer clocks
throughout a computer network. On LANs, PTP achieves clock accuracy in the sub-microsecond
range much more accurate than what is attainable by NTP (Network Time Protocol) and it is
also used in network applications where GPS is either unaffordable or inaccessible.

If Enabled, PTP is used to establish independent Wireless Receiver/Transmitter (WRT) protocol


segments one for LAN and the other for WAN. If Disabled, by default the availability of the PTP
protocol is dependent on the near-end (e.g., the RNC/BSC) and distant-end (e.g., the BTS) IEEE
1588v2 (PTP) capable network devices in the network.

On the top line Use the arrow keys to select PTP as Enabled or Disabled. Then, use the
arrow keys to first navigate to the bottom line. Use the arrow keys to select the PTP
Grandmaster as follows:

Selection Function

LAN The LAN port receives messages from the PTP master.

WAN The WAN port receives messages from the PTP master.

Press ENTER when done.

5.2.1.13.5 CONFIG: IP AccessList

Use this menu to restore SNMP/HTTP access if your own IP Address is inadvertently
excluded from the Host Access List while configuring the list through either the
SNMP or Web Server (HTTP) interface.

The Host Access List allows a user to define which remote clients can connect when the Access
List is enabled. Each entry allows a user to specify an IP address and a subnet mask to define a
unique class of machines that are allowed access.

565

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

After defining and enabling an access list via SNMP or the CDM-625 Web Server interface
Admin | Access page, functionality of this menu appears as follows:

Host Access List is Enabled


Disable the List: No (N,Y) ()

Use the arrow keys to select N (No) to maintain the active Host Access List, or Y to disable
the list. Press ENTER when done. Once disabled, the following message appears whenever this
menu is selected:

Host Access List is Disabled


Use HTTP or SNMP to configure the list.

5.2.1.13.6 CONFIG: IP PktP-Enable

This menu is visible/selectable only when the optional IP Packet Processor card is
installed.

Packet Processor: Enabled (Ena, Dis) ()


(Modem will auto-reboot after change!)

Use the arrow keys to select the card as Ena(bled) or Dis(abled), and then press ENTER. The
modem will automatically reboot after this configuration change. Note the following:

The default mode is Ena(bled).

When the IP Packet Processor is disabled, the card and its accompanying functionality is
completely bypassed and the modem reverts to its base modem Layer 2 switch
functionality.

566

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.2 SELECT: Test Menus

TEST: Mode BERT ()


CnC-APC-Monitor Uncorrected-BER

Use the arrow keys to select Mode, BERT, CnC-APC-Monitor, or Uncorrected-BER, and
then press ENTER.

5.2.2.1 SELECT: TEST Mode

Modem Test Mode = Normal ()


(NORM,Tx-CW,Tx-1/0,IF,RF,DIG,I/O)

Select Normal Operation or a Test Mode from the parameters shown in the parentheses. Use
the arrow keys, and then press ENTER, to select one of the following modes:

Selection Function

(Normal) This c lears any t est modes or l oopbacks, and pl aces t he uni t bac k i nto an
NORM
operational state.
(Transmit C W) Use t his test m ode to f orce t he m odulator t o t ransmit a pur e c arrier
Tx-CW
(unmodulated).
(Transmit an al ternating 1, 0,1,0 p attern) Use t his test mode t o c heck t he carrier
suppression of the Modulator This mode forces the modulator to transmit a carrier modulated
Tx-Alt-1/0
with an al ternating 1,0,1,0 pat tern, at the currently selected symbol rate; t his causes two
(Tx-1/0)
discrete s pectral l ines t o appe ar, s paced at half t he s ymbol r ate, about t he c arrier
frequency.
(IF Loopback) Use this test mode to invoke an i nternal IF loop. This is a par ticularly useful
feature, as it permits you to perform a quick diagnostic test without having to disturb external
IF-LOOP (IF) cabling. Furthermore, all of the receive configuration parameters are temporarily changed to
match t hose of t he t ransmit s ide. All pr evious values ar e restored onc e Normal is agai n
selected.
(RF Loopback) Use this test mode to perform a satellite loopback. It is almost identical to the
IF loop mode, except that all receive configuration parameters (except Rx Spectrum Invert)
RF-LOOP (RF)
are temporarily changed to match those of the transmit side; however, no internal connection
is made. All previous values are restored once Normal is again selected.
(Digital Loopback) Use this test mode to invoke a di gital loopback, which loops data at the
Dig-Loop output of the Reed-Solomon encoder on t he transmit side and back into the Reed-Solomon
(DIG) decoder on t he receive side. This tests the entire interface, transmit baseband circuits, FEC
encoder, FEC decoder, and buffer.
(Inward/Outward Loopback) Use this test mode to invoke two distinct loopbacks. The first is
the i nward l oop, w hich t akes dat a bei ng r eceived f rom t he s atellite di rection and pas ses i t
I/O-Loop (IF)
directly to the modulator. Simultaneously, the outward loop is invoked, whereby data being
fed to the transmit data interface is routed directly back out of the receive data interface.

567

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

Figure 5-3 illustrates the IF, Digital, and I/O Loopback Test modes.

Figure 5-3. Loopback Modes

568

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.2.2 SELECT: TEST BERT

BERT: Config Monitor


()

Use the arrow keys to select Config or Monitor, and then press ENTER.

5.2.2.2.1 SELECT: TEST BERT Config

BERT Tx:Off Pattern=2047 ErrIns=Off


Cnfg Rx:Off Pattern=2047 ()

Use the arrow keys to select a BERT configuration parameter, and then use the arrow
keys to select a parameter setting. The configuration options are as follows:

Option Selection
Tx/Rx Options Off or On

ErrIns Options Off or 10E-3

Pattern Options Space, Mark, 1:1, 1:2, 63, 511, 2047, 2047R, MIL188, 215-1, 220-1, 223-1

5.2.2.2.2 SELECT: TEST BERT Monitor

BERT Monitor: Errs=0000000 Sync: OK


BER=0.0E-07 Restart

Press ENTER to restart the BERT Monitor.

5.2.2.3 SELECT: TEST CnC-APC-Monitor

CNC-APC: BER=N/A Reset FER=N/A Reset


()

The test results provided on this screen are as follows:

Test Description
BER Bit Error Rate
FER Frame Error Rate

To restart either Test, use the arrow keys to select (BER) Reset or (FER) Reset, and then
press ENTER.

569

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

Note that, when CnC-APC is disabled, this menu is inaccessible and displays the following
message:

CnC-APC is disabled.
()

5.2.2.4 SELECT: TEST Uncorrected-BER

Uncorrected BER < 5.0E-6

In order for a valid test run, you must first configure the modem with Viterbi, VersaFEC CCM, or
ULL (Ultra Low Latency) FEC. If the modem is not configured with the required FEC, this screen
displays N/A in the place of a proper test value on the top line, and a configuration advisory
follows on the bottom line:

Uncorrected BER=N/A
Requires Viterbi, VersaFEC CCM or ULL()

Sect. 5.2.1.3.4 CONFIG: Tx FEC


Sect. 5.2.1.4.3 CONFIG: Rx FEC

Additionally, if the demodulator is in unlocked state, this menu is inaccessible and displays the
following message:

Demodulator is unlocked

570

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.3 SELECT: Monitor Menus

Monitor: Live-Alarms Stored-Events ACM


Statistics Rx-Params AUPC CnC IP ()

Use the arrow keys to select Live-Alarms, Stored-Events, ACM, Statistics, Rx-Params,
AUPC, CnC, or IP, and then press ENTER.

5.2.3.1 Monitor: Live-Alarms

Live Unit=None Net=None


Alarms Rx=Demod Lock Tx=No Clock ()

Live BUC=None
Alarms LNB=None ()

Six alarm types are available between two screens, as shown in the preceding examples. Use the
arrow keys to navigate between these read-only pages. The highest priority alarm
currently active for each of the alarm types is as follows:

Alarm Type Description


Unit Power supplies (+5V, +12V, -5V, +18V, -12V) are always monitored by
PSU an onboard supervisory IC.

Tx and Rx Synth The PLLs in the IF sections are monitored for an unlocked condition.
Calibration dat a s tored i n E EPROM i s c hecked at pow er-up t o v erify
Power Cal that the factory calibration has not been corrupted.

FPGA Downloads are verified to have been loaded successfully.


Hi-Stab Freq Ref No PLL Lock This will suppress the Tx carrier.
Module
Tx Clock activity from the Tx terrestrial source is checked if expected. The
(Transmit) No Clock modem f alls bac k t o t he i nternal S CT c lock t o dr ive t he m odulator if
clock activity is absent.
Alarm oc curs w hen t he t errestrial c lock s ource di ffers f rom t he
FIFO Slip programmed data rate, or may indicate a hardware failure.
Alarm Indication Signal (all 1s) is monitored at the Tx terrestrial input if
Tx AIS present.
A Tx alarm occurs if the power increase limit has been reached when
AUPC Level AUPC is enabled.
Hi-Stab Freq Ref Reference not present; unit falls back to its internal 10MHz.
Activity Fault
BUC summary alarm May occur only if ABA is enabled.

G.703 Loss of Signal May only occur in Clock Extension Mode.

571

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

Alarm Type Description


Rx Indicates either the demodulator or the following FEC decoder cannot
Demod Lock lock to the incoming signal.
(Receive)
AGC Alarm Indicates if the demod signal level is out of range.
Indicates t hat t he de -framing u nit ( EDMAC, I BS or I DR) or R eed-
Frame Sync Solomon outer decoder cannot synchronize to the data being sent to it
by the demod and/or FEC decoder.
Occurs w hen Doppler or Plesiochronous ef fects c ause t he Rx data
Buffer Slip buffer to empty or fill completely, which results in a reset to 50%.
Alarm I ndication S ignal ( all 1 s) is m onitored i f present at t he R x
Rx AIS satellite input.
Occurs when the monitored level drops below what was programmed
EbNo Alarm via menus: Config, Rx, EbNo Alarm point.
Indicates that the desired buffer reference is not present, causing the
Buffer Clock buffer to fall back on Rx satellite timing to clock its output.
Net (Unit Loss of Tx frame occurs in Drop & Insert operation, when the incoming
Network) Loss TxFrm T1 or E1 frame cannot be found by the modem.

BER >10E-3 This error rate monitor is enabled for IBS and IDR framing.
Loss of T x m ultiframe oc curs i n E 1-CAS D &I oper ation, w hen t he
Loss TxMul multiframe marker for CAS signaling data cannot be found.
An A IS condition i n t he s ignaling pos itions of an i ncoming E 1-CAS
Tx Sig AIS frame is monitored.
Indicates t he pr esence of t he Tx t errestrial r emote al arm on t he
Tx Terr RM incoming T1 or E1 frame.
Indicates t he pr esence of t he I BS satellite r emote al arm ( backward
IBS Rx Rem alarm) on the incoming IBS frame from the transmit side of the link.
Multi-destination backward al arms ar e t he c orresponding s atellite
IDR Rx BW1-4 alarms used by the IDR frame structure.
Backward alarms 1-4 indicate that the hardware inputs available on the
IDR Tx BW1-4 back panel of the modem have t riggered, resulting in the generation,
by the modems IDR framer, of a corresponding Tx backward alarm.

BUC
Appendix F. CDM-625 ODU (TRANSCEIVER, BUC, LNC) OPERATIONS
LNB

5.2.3.2 Monitor: Stored Events

Stored Events: Clear-All: No (No,Yes)


#199 FT- Frame Sync 25/10/07 16:25:24

An example of a Stored Events screen is shown here. Use the arrow keys to select the #
character on the bottom line, and then use the arrow keys to scroll up and down through
the event log entries. Press ENTER or CLEAR to return to the previous menu.

572

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

The event log can store up to 255 events. When a fault condition occurs, it is time- and date-
stamped and put into the log. Similarly, when the fault condition clears, this is also recorded.

The date is shown in DAY-MONTH-YEAR format in accordance with European convention.

Use the arrow keys to select Clear-All, and then use the arrow keys to select Yes or
No. Press ENTER when done.

Upon selecting Clear-All=Yes, the event log clears and the modem returns you to the previous
menu. However, if there already are faults present on the unit at this time, they are re- stamped
and new log entries are generated.

5.2.3.3 Monitor: ACM

TxModCod=01 QPSK .533 RemoteSNR=04.2dB


RxModCod=02 QPSK .631 LocalSNR=03.5dB

This read-only screen provides the active IP-ACM mode information as follows:

Selection Function

TxModCod Displays the Tx ModCod (00 through 11).

RemoteSNR Displays the SNR reported by the remote modem.

RxModCod Displays the Rx ModCod (00 through 11).

LocalSNR Displays the SNR of the local unit.

If you attempt to access this display when the modem is not in IP-ACM mode, the following
message appears:

ACM Parameter is not available.

5.2.3.4 Monitor: Statistics

Stats 114: 16.0,16.0,9.0,9.0,16.5,16.5


07/04/10 14:48:06 Clear-All: No (N/Y)

This display shows the statistics data that has been measured and recorded. (To enable statistics
logging, see Sect. 5.2.1.10.8.) Use the arrow keys to scroll backwards or forwards through
the statistics log entries. The top line displays the statistics log entry number (the statistics log
can store up to 255 log entries), followed by that log entrys statistical content. The bottom line
indicates the time and date of the entry shown in DAY-MONTH-YEAR format.

573

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

For statistics logging, you define a measurement interval (see CONFIG: Stats); then, during this
interval, Eb/No, Transmit Power Level Increase (TPLI), and Receive Signal Level (RSL) are
observed at a rate of once every second.

Per the example, at the end of the defined measurement interval period, the modem calculates
statistics data in the order that follows (from left to right on the top line):

(16.0,16.0) First, the Eb/No is calculated: The minimum Eb/No value observed in the
interval is provided first, and then the average Eb/No value observed follows. If the
measured values are 16.0 dB, then 16.0 is displayed.

(9.0,9.0) Next, the TPLI is calculated: The maximum TPLI observed in the interval is
provided first, and then the average TPLI value observed follows.

(16.5,16.5) Finally, the RSL is calculated: The minimum value observed in the interval is
provided first, and then the average RSL value observed follows (note that both values
are negative).

If the demod has lost lock during the measurement interval, the
minimum Eb/No will show LOSS rather than indicate a value
however, the average value (while the demod was locked) will still be
calculated and shown.

If, on the other hand, the demodulator has been unlocked for the entire
measurement interval, the average Eb/No will also show Loss (i.e., the
display will show Loss,Loss).

In addition, If AUPC is not enabled, the values of maximum and average


TPLI will both show 0.0'.
Example 1:
08.0,13.5,2.5,1.8,30.0,25.1 means:
(08.0) Minimum Eb/No observed in the measurement interval = 8.0 dB
(13.5) Average Eb/No observed in the measurement interval = 13.5 dB
(2.5) Maximum TPLI observed in the measurement interval = 2.5 dB
(1.8) Average TPLI observed in the measurement interval = 1.8 dB
(30.0) Minimum RSL is observed in the measurement interval = -30.0 dB
(25.1) Average RSL is observed in the measurement interval = -25.1 dB

Example 2:
Loss,04.5,0.0,0.0,29.0,29.0 means:
(Loss) There was a loss of demod lock during the measurement interval
(04.5) Average Eb/No observed in the measurement interval = 4.5 dB
(0.0) Maximum TPLI observed in the measurement interval = 0 dB
(0.0) A verage T PLI obs erved in t he m easurement i nterval = 0 dB (which indicates no
AUPC activity, or that AUPC is disabled.)
(29.0) Minimum RSL is observed in the measurement interval = -29.0 dB
(29.0) Average RSL is observed in the measurement interval = -29.0 dB

574

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

Press ENTER or CLEAR when done viewing to return to the previous menu, or use the arrow
keys to select the Clear-All option. Then, at the prompt, use the arrow keys to select Yes or
No and press ENTER to implement.

5.2.3.5 Monitor: Rx Parameters

Rx-Parameters: EbNo=11.4dB F=+011.7kHz


BER=0.0E-9 Buffer=51% RxLevel=-43.5dBm

If the demodulator is locked, then this screen shows the following:

Item Description
This s hows the v alue of Eb/No calculated by t he dem odulator. The v alue r eferred t o her e i s t he
Eb/No
energy per information bit (Ebi), divided by the noise spectral density (No).
F The frequency offset of the received carrier, in kHz, with a displayed resolution of 100 Hz.

BER This is an estimate of the corrected BER.


(Buffer fill state) This shows the fill state (in percent), of the receive Buffer. After a reset, it will read
Buffer
50. A value <50% indicates that the buffer is emptying, and >50% indicates that it is filling.
A dBm reading indicating the signal level of the desired receive carrier with a displayed resolution of
Rx-Level
0.5 dB

5.2.3.6 Monitor: AUPC-Parameters

AUPC-Params: Remote EbNo= 6.8 dB


Transmit Power Increase= 1.2 dB

The top line displays the value of Remote Eb/No of the demodulator at the distant end of the
satellite link. The Remote Eb/No displays Unlock if the remote Demod is unlocked.

The bottom line shows how much the AUPC system has increased the output power. If AUPC is
not enabled, then the value of Tx Power Increase displays as 0.0 dB.

5.2.3.7 Monitor: CnC-Parameters

CnC-Params:PwrRatio=-04.1dB PSDR=+01.9dB
Freq-offset=-123.4kHz Delay=123.4ms

When enabled and locked, the screen displays the CnC performance data. This read-only display
updates once every second.

575

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.3.8 Monitor: IP Statistics

IPstats: Port x In Out ()


Unicasts: 00000003 00000023 Clr:N

This screen is identical to and displays the same performance information as the screen shown
in Sect. 5.2.1.13.3 CONFIG: IP Setup Stats.

5.2.4 SELECT: Info (Information) Menus

Info: All ID Mode Tx Rx Clocks EDMAC


Drop Insert Remote Alarm-Mask Misc

The read-only INFO screens display the modems current configuration information without
risking inadvertent changes.

Use the arrow keys to select All, ID, Mode, Tx, Rx, Clocks, EDMAC, Drop, Insert, Remote,
Alarm-Mask, or Misc, and then press ENTER.

After viewing any Info screen except All: Press ENTER or CLEAR to return to the previous menu.

5.2.4.1 Info: All

All = Start
(Stop, Start) ()

Use this menu to scroll through and review configuration settings on a sequential basis. The
configuration displays are read-only no editing is possible.

To view the configurations Use the arrow keys to select between Stop and Start. Press
ENTER to continue through all the displays.

To discontinue viewing Press CLEAR, use the arrow keys to select Stop, and then press
ENTER.

5.2.4.2 Info: ID

Modem Circuit ID:


----A TEST MESSAGE TO SHOW CIRCUIT ID---

This screen displays the 40-character, user-defined Circuit ID string that was created using the
Utility Circuit-ID menu. The Circuit ID also appears in the title bar of compatible web browsers
for easy unit identification.

576

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.4.3 Info: Mode

Info: Mode: Tx= G.703B:D&I (B8ZS)


Rx= G.703B:IBS (B8ZS)

An example of a Mode Info screen is shown here.

5.2.4.4 Info: Tx

Tx:On 0070.0000MHz PWR=-20.0 TSI=N


Vit+RS:220/200 00064.000 QPSK 7/8 Scrm

An example of the Tx Info screen is shown here. It displays the following information:

Item Configuration Setting


Tx Carrier On, Off, or RTI.
Tx Frequency xxxx.xxxx MHz.
Top line
Power Power Level (dBm).
TSI TSI = Tx Spectral Inversion, I=Inverted (on), N=Not inverted (off).
FEC type: Viterbi, TCM, Vit+RS, TCM+RS, TPC, LDPC, VFEC, or
Encoder None:DE-xxx (DE is the Differential Encoder setting, shown as DE-Off or DE-
On).

Bottom Data Rate xxxxx.xxx kbps (an asterisk * indicates that the data sense is inverted).
line Modulation BPSK, QPSK, OQPSK, 8-PSK, 8-QAM, 16-QAM.
FEC Rate 1/2, 2/3, 3/4, 7/8, 0.95, 5/16, 21/44 or 1/1.
Scrambler Scrm, None, or IESS (Turbo Only).

5.2.4.5 Info: Rx

Rx:0070.0000MHz 02.0dB +-30 RSI=N


Vit+RS:126/112 01544.000 QPSK 1/2 Scrm

An example of the Rx Info screen is shown here. It displays the following information:

Item Configuration Setting


Rx Frequency xxxx.xxxx MHz.
Eb/No 12.3 dB (Alarm Point).
Top line
Sweep Range Up to 32 kHz.
RSI RSI = Rx Spectral Inversion, I=Inverted (on), N=Not inverted (off).

577

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

Item Configuration Setting


FEC type: Viterbi, TCM, Vit+RS, TCM+RS, TPC, LDPC, VFEC, or
Decoder
None:DE-xxx (DE is the Differential Encoder setting, shown as DE-Off or DE-On).
Data Rate xxxxx.xxx kbps (an asterisk * indicates that the data sense is inverted).
Bottom
line Modulation BPSK, QPSK, OQPSK, 8-PSK, 8-QAM, 16-QAM.
FEC Rate 1/2, 2/3, 3/4, 7/8, 0.95, 5/16, 21/44 or 1/1.
Descrambler Scrm, None, or IESS (Turbo Only).

5.2.4.6 Info: Clocks

Clocks:Tx=Int(SCT) CEX=RxEnable E1-unbal


Rx=Int(SCT) Buffer=00016bytes REF=Int10

An example of a Clocks Info screen is shown here. It displays information for Tx Clock, G.703
Clock Extension, Rx Clock, Reference, and Buffer.

5.2.4.7 Info: EDMAC

EDMAC Function= On
EDMAC Mode= Master EDMAC Addr= 0020

An example of an EDMAC Info screen is shown here. This screen indicates whether or not
EDMAC is enabled and, when EDMAC is enabled, it provides the EDMAC Mode and Address.

5.2.4.8 Info: Drop

Drop Type= CH:1


E1-CCS TS:01

An example of an Info Drop screen is shown here. This screen shows the Drop Type and channel
allocations.

When in QDI (Quad Drop & Insert) Mode, this screen displays the same
information as the CONFIG: D&I Drop menu.

578

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.4.9 Info: Insert

Insert Type= CH:1


E1-CCS TS:01

An example of an Insert Info screen is shown here. This screen shows the Insert Type and
channel allocations. Press ENTER or CLEAR to return to the previous menu.

When in QDI (Quad Drop & Insert) Mode, this screen displays the same
information as the CONFIG: D&I Drop menu.

5.2.4.10 Info: Remote

Remote-Control= Local Address= 0000


Interface= RS-232 9600 baud 8N1

An example of a Remote Info screen is shown here. This screen shows if the unit is in Local,
Remote or Ethernet (IP) mode. It also displays the electrical interface type selected, the units
address, and the active baud rate.

5.2.4.11 Info: Alarms Mask

Alarms Masked: TxAIS Terr REF TxClk BUC


Buf-Slip AGC RxAIS Sat EbNo LNB CEX

A sample Alarms Mask Info screen is shown here. Note that, while all available masks are
displayed here, this screen will show only the alarm(s) that are currently masked. For any alarm
that is not masked, a blank space assumes that items designated screen position.

5.2.4.12 Info: Misc

Miscellaneous: Normal
1:1 Switch=Not connected Online

The Miscellaneous Info screen provides the following information:

Display Item Configuration Setting


Top line Operational Mode Test Mode or Normal.
1:1 Switch Link Status Connected or Not Connected.
Bottom line
Redundancy Status Offline or Online.

579

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.5 SELECT: Store/Ld (Store/Load) Menus

Configuration #2: Load Store ()


AVAILABLE

You can store up to 10 modem configurations into an assigned slot 0 through 9. If a


configuration slot is available for storage, the bottom line notes the status of that slot as
AVAILABLE. Otherwise, if the slot contains an existing configuration, the bottom line specifies its
storage time in military format (HH:MM:SS); the date is shown in DAY-MONTH-YEAR format in
accordance with European convention.

To load (recall) a configuration setting:

First, use the arrow keys to move the cursor to the configuration slot number
(Configuration #X) and then use the arrow keys to select a slot number from 0
to 9.

Next, use the arrow keys to select Load, and press ENTER when done. Modem
operation then updates as per the configuration settings stored in this slot.

To store (save) a configuration setting:

First, make any desired configuration changes to the modem.

Next, use the arrow keys to move the cursor to the configuration slot number
(Configuration #X) and then use the arrow keys to select a slot number from 0
to 9.

Finally, use the arrow keys to select Store, and press ENTER when done.

Once a modem configuration is stored into the designated slot, the time and date are recorded,
and this information appears on the bottom line.

Store Override When storing into a configuration slot that previously had information saved
into the working memory, you are required to confirm the request, as the existing information
will be overwritten:

Configuration #2. Override? No (Y,N) ()


14:06:37 26/10/12

Use the arrow keys to select the Override choice (Y or N), and then press ENTER.

580

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.6 SELECT: Utility Menus

Utilities: Set-RTC Display-Bright CarrID


LED Redundancy Circuit-ID Firmware Em

Use the arrow keys to select Set-RTC, Display-Bright, CarrID, LED, Redundancy, Circuit-ID,
Firmware, or Em, and then press ENTER.

5.2.6.1 Utilities: Set-RTC

Edit Real-Time Clock:


Time: 12:01:02 Date:26/10/06 ()

To edit the time and date settings of the Real-Time Clock, use the arrow keys to select a
digit to edit, and then use the arrow keys to change that digit. Press ENTER when done.

The date is shown in DAY-MONTH-YEAR format in accordance with European convention.

5.2.6.2 Utilities: Display-Bright

Edit Display Brightness:


100% ()

To edit the brightness of the VFD (Vacuum Fluorescent Display), use the arrow keys to
select a suitable brightness level. The selectable values are 25%, 50%, 75% or 100%. Press
ENTER when done.

5.2.6.3 Utilities: CarrID

Chapter 19. CARRIER ID (METACARRIER)

Carrier ID: Disabled (Disabled, Enabled)


()

Use the arrow keys to select the Carrier ID (MetaCarrier) function as Enabled or Disabled,
and then press ENTER.

WHEN ENABLING CARRIER ID OPERATION, BE SURE TO CREATE A 24-CHARACTER


(MAX) CARRIER ID CUSTOM MESSAGE USING THE UTILITIES: CIRCUIT ID MENU (SEE
SECT. 5.2.6.6 Utilities: Circuit ID).

581

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.6.4 Utilities: LED

Front Panel LED Test: Enabled


(Enable,Disable) ()

Use the arrow keys to select Enable or Disable, and then press ENTER to continue. When
enabled, a test of all of the LEDs on the front panel is executed. Normal operations resume upon
completion of the test.

5.2.6.5 Utilities: Redundancy

Redundancy:
Traffic-IP-Addr/Range 1:1 1:N

Use the arrow keys to select Traffic-IP-Addr/Range, 1:1, or 1:N, and then press ENTER.

5.2.6.5.1 Utilities: Redundancy Traffic-IP-Addr/Range

Traffic IP address/Range
192.168.001.001/24 ()

To edit the Traffic IP Address and range, when the modem is part of a 1:1 or 1:N redundancy
application: First, use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit, and then use the arrow
keys to change that digit. Press ENTER when done.

5.2.6.5.2 Utilities: Redundancy 1:1

Press ENTER key to force Unit into


Standby (1:1 only)

For use when the modem is part of a 1:1 redundancy application (e.g., via a CRS-170A L-Band or
CRS-180 70/140 MHz 1:1 Redundancy Switch) and this unit is currently Online, press ENTER to
cause the unit to switch to Standby (i.e., go Offline).

5.2.6.5.3 Utilities: Redundancy 1:N

1:N Mode: (use with CAUTION!)


Disabled (Enable, Disable) ()

For use when the unit is part of a 1:N redundant application (e.g., via a CRS-300 1:10
Redundancy Switch). Use the arrow keys to select 1:N Mode operation as Enable or
Disable, and then press ENTER.

582

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

When the unit is connected to a 1:N switch, a red LED located on the rear panel
labeled 1:N Active! indicates that caution is required, as there may be DC voltages
and other control signals present on certain pins on the 25-pin Data Interface
connector.

5.2.6.6 Utilities: Circuit-ID

Edit this Modems Circuit ID: ()


----------------------------------------

To compose a Circuit ID string On the bottom line, first use the arrow keys to select the
alphanumeric character space to edit, and then use the arrow keys to edit that character.

You may use the following characters to compose a Circuit ID string of up to 40 characters in
length or a MetaCarrier Custom Message of 24 characters or less:

[Space] ( ) * + - , . / 0-9 and A-Z.

Press ENTER once you finish composing the Circuit ID string. As created here, in addition to the
front panel VFD, the Circuit ID also appears in the title bar of compatible web browsers for easy
unit identification.

Proper composition of the Circuit ID string is dependent on whether the Carrier ID


(MetaCarrier) feature operation is enabled or disabled (see Sect. 5.2.6.3 Utilities:
CarrID):

1. With Carrier ID enabled, the first 24 characters of the 40-character Circuit ID


are intended for and sent as the MetaCarrier Custom Message. While you
must limit your MetaCarrier Custom Message to 24 characters or less, the full
40 characters of the Circuit ID will display on the front panel screen saver (see
Sect. 5.1.3.1 Screen Saver).

2. With Carrier ID disabled, the Circuit ID full 40 character length is available for
creation of the unit identification label that displays on the front panel VFD
screen saver and the Web browser title care.

583

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.6.7 Utilities: Firmware

THESE MENUS ARE FOR DIAGNOSTIC PURPOSES. ONLY CHANGE AN IMAGE IF


INSTRUCTED TO DO SO BY A COMTECH EF DATA CUSTOMER SUPPORT TECHNICIAN.

Firmware Images:
Base-Modem Packet-Processor ()

Use the arrow keys to select Base-Modem or Packet-Processor, and then press ENTER.

5.2.6.7.1 Utilities: Firmware Base-Modem

Firmware Information:
Boot-ROM Image#1* Image#2 Select ()

Use these submenus to view information about the CDM-625 Base Modem internal firmware.
This screen identifies the firmware image that is loaded on startup or reboot of the Base Modem
with an asterisk (*). Use the arrow keys to select Boot-Rom, Image#1, Image#2, or Select,
and then press ENTER.

5.2.6.7.1.1 Utilities: Firmware Base-Modem Boot-ROM, Image#X

Bootrom: DD/MM/YY
FW/12865X #.#.#

The example shown here is for the Bootrom firmware opening screen. Typical for the Image#1
or Image#2 screens, you may use the arrow keys to scroll through information for all the
constituent firmware blocks that make up the bulk.

This read-only information is provided for: firmware type; its number (where X is the revision
letter); its build date (in day/month/year format); and its version number (e.g., 2.1.0). Press
ENTER or CLEAR to return to the previous menu.

5.2.6.7.1.2 Utilities: Firmware Base-Modem Select

Current Active Image is #1


Next Reboot, will use Image: #1 ()

The modem can store two complete firmware images. Use this menu to select which image is
loaded the next time the unit reboots. The top line shows the current active image while, on the
bottom line, you may use the arrow keys to select the other image. Press ENTER when

584

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

done a message will then prompt you to reboot the unit in order for the newly-selected image
to be loaded upon startup.

5.2.6.7.2 Utilities: Firmware Packet-Processor

Packet Processor Firmware Information:


Boot-ROM Image#1* Image#2 Select ()

This screen identifies the optional CDM-625 IP Packet Processor internal firmware image that is
loaded on startup or reboot of the Base Modem with an asterisk (*).

Use the arrow keys to select Boot-Rom, Image#1, Image#2, or Select, and then press
ENTER.

5.2.6.7.2.1 Utilities: Firmware Packet-Processor Boot-ROM,


Image#X

Bootrom: DD/MM/YY HH:MM:SS


FW-0000346X #.#.#

The example shown here is for the IP Packet Processor Bootrom firmware opening screen.
Typical for the Bootrom, Image#1 or Image#2 screens, read-only information is provided for:
firmware type; its number (where X is the revision letter); its build date- and time-stamps (in
day/month/year and hours/minutes/seconds formats); and its version number (e.g., 1.3.3).
Press ENTER or CLEAR to return to the previous menu.

5.2.6.7.2.2 Utilities: Firmware Packet-Processor Select

Current Active Image is #1


Next Reboot, will use Image: #2 ()

The modem can store two complete firmware images, and you can select which image loads the
next time the unit reboots. The top line shows the current active image while, on the bottom
line, you may use the arrow keys to select the other image. Press ENTER when done a
message will then prompt you to reboot the unit in order for the newly-selected image to load
upon startup.

585

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

5.2.6.8 Utilities: Em (CDM-600/600L Emulation)


The CDM-625 serves as a drop-in replacement product for CDM-600 and CDM-600L modems.
An emulation mode is provided to accomplish this design intent, and is configurable via either
this menu or by remote control (remote command EMU=).

When emulating a CDM-600 or CDM-600L modem, the CDM-625 opening screen displays the
mode of operation, as per this example:

Comtech CDM-625 emulating a CDM-600


TPC, CnC installed Ver 2.2.6

Note that, while emulating a CDM-600 or CDM-600L modem, the I/O responses (including that
of remote query EID?) replicate those of the emulated modem; further, the firmware version
number displayed on the opening screen, and the response from the SWR? remote query
reflects that of the emulated modems firmware version number.

There are some features that the CDM-625 does not support, and as a result are not possible
while in CDM-600 or CDM-600L Emulation Modes:

Sequential FEC coding;

RS-232 synchronous data interface;

External ref of 20 MHz;

BUC leveling;

Operation below 18 ksps or 18 kbps.

Other parameters have become dont care:

Impedance;

External Clock.

5.2.7 SELECT: ODU Menus (Summary Only)

See Appendix F. CDM-625 ODU (TRANSCEIVER, BUC, LNB) OPERATION for complete
details about this product-specific menu branch.

ODU: BUC:PwrSupply+Ref
LNB:PwrSupply+Ref FSK-control ()

586

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

Depending on 70/140 MHz or L-Band operation: Use to monitor and control a standalone or
redundant Comtech EF Data RF Transceiver (CSAT-5060 or KST-2000A/B) or LPOD BUC if
connected.

5.2.8 SELECT: FAST Menus


The d isplay example a s s hown h ere d epicts a unit s hipped w ith th e T wo-
channel A udio D rop h ardware o ption i nstalled. I f th is h ardware i s not
included, Audio does not appear on the bottom line.

FAST: Options Demo-Mode CnC


Baseboard S/N 123456789 HW Rev1.X Audio

FAST (Fully Accessible System Topology) allows you to enable new options in the modem. Use
the arrow keys to select Options, Demo-Mode, or CnC, and then press ENTER.

5.2.8.1 FAST: Options

FAST options: View Options


Set Registers ()

You can access the FAST options via three separate internal EEPROM registers. Each register
requires its own FAST access code. Use the arrow keys to select View Options or Set
Registers (to continue via the correct register menu), and then press ENTER.

5.2.8.1.1 FAST: Options View Options

FAST: View options: 01 ()


Base 5 Mbps data rate installed

Use the arrow keys to scroll through the available options. The modem identifies each
selected FAST option as installed or not installed.

You must contact a Comtech EF Data sales representative, during normal business hours or via
e-mail to sales@comtechefdata.com, to purchase the FAST Access Code for the desired option.

Available options include:

Data Rate

Data Rate when configured for TPC/LDPC

Data Rate when configured for CnC (DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier)

Data Rate when configured for VersaFEC

587

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

Data Rate when configured for Header Compression

Data Rate when configured for Payload Compression

Symbol Rate when configured for IP-ACM

Open Network Framing

Modulation:

8PSK/8-QAM

16-QAM

Drop & Insert:

1-port D&I

4-port (Quad) D&

L-Band

IP-ACM (Adaptive Coding Modulation)

25 Mbps Header Compression

25 Mbps Payload Compression

G.703 Clock Extension

Advanced QoS (Quality of Service)

AES Encryption

Fractional CnC (DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier)

Advanced Network Timing (PTP Precision Timing Protocol)

5.2.8.1.2 FAST: Options Set Registers

Appendix C. FAST ACTIVATION PROCEDURE

FAST: Set register#: Enter code below


88888888888888888888 then [ENTER] ()

Where # is the appropriate register #1, #2, or #3: FAST: Options Set Registers is used to
enable new options in the modem on a per-register basis. It is important to use the appropriate
FAST access code for the appropriate register.

Contact a Comtech EF Data sales representative, during normal business hours or via e-mail to
sales@comtechefdata.com, to order the desired options (see Sect. 5.2.7.1.1) be prepared to
provide the Modem Serial Number. The Comtech EF Data Customer Support representative will

588

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

verify the order and provide an invoice and instructions, including a register-specific 20-digit
FAST Access Code.

Enter the FAST Access Code that you have obtained from Comtech EF Data carefully using the
front panel keypad or, alternately, the CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface:

From the CDM-625 front panel First, use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit,
and then use the arrow keys to change that digit. Compose the code carefully, and
then press ENTER only when you are ready to execute the upgrade.

For Firmware Ver. 1.5.1 or earlier, enter the FAST access code for option
register(s) #1, #2 and/or #3 as required. For Firmware Ver. 1.5.2 and later,
all three FAST access codes must be entered in sequence in order for the
purchased option upgrades to be properly activated.

The modem responds with Configured Successfully upon completion of the


FAST upgrade; the modem then resets to its newly incorporated default configuration.
However, if you enter an invalid code, the modem rejects the entry and the unit
prompts you to re-enter the code as follows:

Failed to configure. Re-enter code.


88888888888888888888 then [ENTER] ()

Repeat the FAST access code entry procedure. Should the code entry error persist,
contact Comtech EF Data Customer Support for further assistance.

From the CDM-625 Web Server Interface See Sect. 6.5.4.2.5 Admin | FAST.

5.2.8.2 FAST: Demo-Mode

FAST Options Demo Mode: Off (Off,On) ()


1209600 seconds remaining.

FAST Options Demo Mode allows access to ALL CDM-625 FAST options for 2592000 seconds (30
calendar days). On the top line, use the arrow keys to select Demo Mode as Off or On, and
then press ENTER. The bottom line displays the time remaining the time format is in seconds.
Note the following:

The time count decrements only when Demo Mode is turned On. Demo Mode may be
turned on and off an unlimited number of times until the full 30 calendar days have
expired. Upon expiration of the Demo period, the following message displays:

FAST Options Demo Mode: Expired ()


0000000 seconds remaining.

589

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

Once the timer decrements to 0000000, FAST Options Demo Mode may no longer be
enabled. Your modem will still function with the purchased FAST enabled features.

If the Demo Mode timer reaches 0000000 while the modem is running a
FAST feature that is not a purchased FAST feature, the modem will fall into
an invalid state, turn off its carrier, and revert all settings to factory default
settings.

5.2.8.3 FAST: CnC

FractionalCnC:1-YearCounter=00000000 sec
90-DayCounter= 0000000 sec

Fractional CnC is common in 1:1 or 1:N redundancy systems where the primary modem has a
full CnC license, and the backup modem(s) has a Fractional CnC license. A Fractional CnC licenses
allows 90 full calendar days of CnC usage in one calendar year. This lowers the cost of the
modem but does not allow for constant, round-the-clock operation.

When Fractional CnC Mode is ordered, the number of seconds remaining for both the 1-year
(top line) and 90-day (bottom line) activation timers are displayed here.

When the counters expire, the following message is displayed:

Fractional CnC is not installed.

As per the previous screen examples, if Fractional CnC is not installed in the CDM-625, the
modem displays a message that no CnC license is installed and provides time remaining and
time remaining refill timers; or that a Full CnC license is installed and the screen displays no
timers. Note the following:

1-YearCounter This is the calendar year counter, in seconds, that resets the 90-
DayCounter to 90 full days of CnC usage when it reaches 00000000. This counter continually
decrements and accounts for time even when the modem is powered Off. Once this timer
fully decrements, the 1-YearCounter resets to 31536000 once again and immediately begins
to decrement.

The 1-Year Counter cannot be reset or refilled in the field. Once the timer has
run out, your only options are to:

1) Upgrade the modem to a full license.

2) Wait until 1-YearCounter reaches 00000000.

Using Fractional CnC is not a normative mode of operation. To best inform you
that your modem is running Fractional CnC (i.e., the 1-YearCounter counter

590

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

is actively decrementing), your modem does the following:

o The front panel RED Unit Status LED will blink on and off.

o The modem generates an Event in the Event Log every 12 hours that
indicates Fractional CnC is running.

o When connected to a 1:1 redundant switch, the modem generates a


phantom fault every 12 hours, allowing the Full License CnC modem to
return online if its fault has cleared.

90-DayCounter This is the amount of time, in seconds, that that the modem can be run in
CnC mode. This counter decrements under the following conditions:

o The modem has a Fractional CnC license

o The modem is powered on

o The modems TX is On

o The modem is in standalone mode or in 1:1 redundancy configuration and is Online

o The modem is NOT in Demo Mode. If the timer reaches 00:00:00:00, the modem
will turn its TX Off and the circuit will be down.

591

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Front Panel Operation MN-CDM625

Notes:

592

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


Chapter 6. ETHERNET-BASED
REMOTE PRODUCT
MANAGEMENT
6.1 Introduction
The CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem base unit is equipped with four RJ-45 10/100 BaseT
Ethernet connectors, subject to the following conditions:

When Dedicated Management is disabled, you may use any port for Ethernet-based
remote product management (monitor and control) purposes.

When Dedicated Management is enabled, you may use only that specific port for remote
monitor and control (M&C) purposes.

6.2 Ethernet Management Interface Protocols


The user PC facilitates access to Ethernet-based remote M&C of the CDM-625 through three
separately-operated protocols:

Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) This requires a user-supplied Network


Management System (NMS) and a user-supplied Management Information Base (MIB) File
Browser.

Telnet Interface This requires use of a user-supplied terminal emulation program such as
HyperTerminal (for use with the remote control protocol) or PuTTY (for use with the Telnet
Command Line Interface), installed on the user PC.

CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface This requires a compatible user-supplied web
browser such as Internet Explorer, installed on the user PC.

61

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.3 SNMP Interface


The Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) is an Internet-standard protocol for managing
devices on IP networks. An SNMP-managed network consists of three key components:

The managed device This includes the CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem.

The SNMP Agent The software that runs on the CDM-625. The CDM-625 SNMP Agent
supports both SNMPv1 and SNMPv2c.

The user-supplied Network Management System (NMS) The software that runs on
the manager.

6.3.1 Management Information Base (MIB) Files


MIB files are used for SNMP remote management of a unique device. A MIB file consists of a
tree of nodes called Object Identifiers (OIDs). Each OID provides remote management of a
particular function. These MIB files should be compiled in a user-supplied MIB Browser or SNMP
Network Monitoring System server.

The following MIB files are associated with the CDM-625:

MIB File/Name
Description
(where * is revision letter)
FW10874-2*.mib ComtechEFData MIB file gives the root tree for ALL Comtech EF Data products
ComtechEFData Root MIB file and consists of only the following OID:
Name:comtechEFData
Type:MODULE-IDENTITY
OID:1.3.6.1.4.1.6247
Full path:
iso(1).org(3).dod(6).internet(1).private(4).enterprises(1).comtechEFData(6247)
Module: ComtechEFData
FW-0000083*.mib
MIB file consists of all of the OIDs for management of the modem functions
CDM-625 MIB file
FW-0000084*.mib
Trap MIB file is provided for SNMPv1 traps common for modem.
CDM-625 Traps MIB file
FW-0000345*.mib MIB file consists of all of the OIDs for management of the optional IP Packet
IP Packet Processor MIB file Processor functions.
FW10874-8*.mib
MIB file consists of all of the OIDs for management of the CSAT-5060 Transceiver
CSAT-5060 Transceiver MIB
connected to the CDM-625 modem through FSK.
file
FW10874-9*.mib
MIB file consists of all the OIDs for management of the KST-2000A/B Transceiver
KST-2000A/B Transceiver connected to the CDM-625 modem through FSK.
MIB file
MIB file consists of a subset of the CDM-625 MIB with all OIDs used manage to a
FW-0000165*.mib
distant-end CDM-625. SNMP "gets" and "sets" are sent to the local CDM-625 and
DistantEnd CDM-625 MIB file
EDMAC3 is used to communicate efficiently with the distant end modem.

62

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.3.2 SNMP Community Strings

In SNMP v1/v2c, the SNMP Community String is sent unencrypted in the SNMP
packets. Caution must be taken by the network administrator to ensure that SNMP
packets travel only over a secure and private network if security is a concern.
The CDM-625 uses Community Strings as a password scheme that provides authentication
before gaining access to the modem agents MIBs. They are used to authenticate users and
determine access privileges to the SNMP agent.

Type the SNMP Community String into the user-supplied MIB Browser or Network Node
Management software.

The user defines three Community Strings for SNMP access:

Read Community default = public

Write Community default = private

Trap Community default = comtech

For proper SNMP operation, the CDM-625 MIB files must be used with the
associated version of the CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem M&C. Refer to the
CDM-625 FW Release Notes for information on the required FW/SW compatibility.

6.3.3 SNMP Traps


The CDM-625 supports both SNMPv1 traps and SNMPv2 notifications. The modem has the
ability to send out SNMP traps when certain events occur and clear in the modem, including unit
faults, Tx faults, Rx faults, and ODU faults.

For the trap to work, the modem must be in Ethernet remote mode, and it must
have the Trap IP Address properly configured.

You only need to compile the Traps file if you intend to use SNMPv1 traps. You may configure
which style of traps the modem sends by using the CDM625SNMPTrapVersion OID.

The CDM-625 supports the following MIB2 v1 traps / v2 notifications:

MIB2 SNMPv1 trap: Authentication Failure 5


MIB2 SNMPv2 notifications: Authentication Failure 1.3.6.1.6.3.1.1.5.5

63

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

The CDM-625 supports the following Alarms and Faults SNMPv1 traps / SNMPv2 notifications:

Alarms and Faults SNMPv1 traps


cdm625UnitAlarmV1 6247641
cdm625TxTrafficAlarmV1 6247642
cdm625RxTrafficAlarmV1 6247643
cdm625OpenNetworkAlarmV1 6247644
cdm625BUCAlarmV1 6247645
cdm625LNBAlarmV1 6247646
cdm625RedundancyStateTrapV1 6247647

Alarms and Faults SNMPv2 notifications:


cdm625UnitAlarm 1.3.6.1.4.1.6247.34.2.0.1
cdm625TxTrafficAlarm 1.3.6.1.4.1.6247.34.2.0.2
cdm625RxTrafficAlarm 1.3.6.1.4.1.6247.34.2.0.3
cdm625OpenNetworkAlarm 1.3.6.1.4.1.6247.34.2.0.4
cdm625BUCAlarm 1.3.6.1.4.1.6247.34.2.0.5
cdm625LNBAlarm 1.3.6.1.4.1.6247.34.2.0.6
cdm625RedundancyStateTrap 1.3.6.1.4.1.6247.34.2.0.7

64

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.4 Telnet Interface


Comtech EF Data provides a Telnet interface for the purpose of equipment monitor and control
(M&C) using either the standard remote control protocol or, when the optional IP Packet
Processor is installed and enabled, the Telnet Command Line Interface (CLI).

6.4.1 Using the Telnet Interface for Remote Control Operation

Appendix D. REMOTE CONTROL

The Telnet interface requires login at the Administrator and Read/Write User Access Levels. An
example of the login process is shown here:

Once logged into the Telnet interface as the Administrator, the standard Remote Control
interface defined in Appendix D. REMOTE CONTROL is accessible, as shown here:

6.4.1.1 Using HyperTerminal for Telnet Remote Control Operation


There is a disadvantage when using Windows Command-line as a Telnet client with the standard
Remote Control protocol. Since Command-line cannot translate a \r (i.e., carriage return or
CR) to a \r\n (i.e., CR+line feed LF) for the messages coming from Telnet Server, any multi-

65

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

line Target-to-Controller response (e.g., the response to the FRW? query) will be displayed as
one line, with the latter lines overwriting the previous lines.

In order to view the full response messages, use of the HyperTerminal terminal emulation
program configured as a Telnet client is permissible.

Configure HyperTerminal as follows:

1. Be sure to properly define the Connect To Telnet connection properties (File


Properties), as shown below at the near right:

A) Enter the CDM-625s


Management IP Address as
the Host Address (e.g.,
192.168.1.1).

B) Enter TCP Port 23 as the Port


number.

C) Set Connect using to TCP/IP


(Winsock) instead of COM1 or
COM2.

2. For ASCII Setup (File Properties Settings ASCII Setup), as shown above at the far
right:

A) Check the "Send line ends with line feeds" option in the ASCII Sending section.

B) Check the "Append line feeds to incoming line ends" option in the ASCII Receiving
section.

Examples of login and remote command/query execution, when using HyperTerminal as the
interface, appear as follows:

66

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.4.2 Using the Telnet Interface for Telnet Command Line Interface (CLI)
Operation

Appendix E. TELNET COMMAND LINE INTERFACE (CLI) OPERATION

Figure 6-1. CDM-625 Telnet Command Line Interface (CLI)


(Left) TeraTerm CLI Example
(Right) PuTTY CLI Example

1. The CDM-625 Telnet Command Line Interface (CLI) is accessible only when the
optional IP Packet Processor is installed and enabled.

2. The CDM-625 Telnet CLI uses Telnet TCP Port 107. Be sure to specify this port
when configuring your terminal emulator for CLI operation.

3. The HyperTerminal terminal emulator, while compatible for use with remote
control operations, is not supported or recommended for CDM-625 Telnet CLI
operation. Instead, for best results Comtech EF Data recommends PuTTY or
Tera Term or as the preferred terminal emulators (Figure 6-1).

67

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5 Web Server (HTTP) Interface


A user-supplied Web browser allows the full monitor and control (M&C) of the CDM-625 from
its Web Server Interface. The CDM-625s embedded web application is designed for, and works
best with, Microsofts Internet Explorer Version 9.0 or higher. Comtech EF Data does not
recommend setting your browser to IE7 Compatibility Mode.

6.5.1 User Login


Type the CDM-625s IP Address (shown here as http://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx) into the Address area of
the user PC Web browser:

The Login window will appear, similar to the


example shown here, opens. Enter the
assigned User name and Password. The Web
Server Interface default user names and
passwords are as follows:

Admin comtech/comtech
Read/Write opcenter/1234
Read Only monitor/1234

HTTP Login User Access Levels are further defined as follows:

HTTP Login User Access Level


Admin User Read/Write User Read Only User
No Access to Admin or IP Packet Processor- No Access to Admin or IP Packet Processor-
Full Access to all related web pages. related web pages.
web pages.
Full Access for all other web pages View Only Access for all other web pages.

Type the User Name and Password, and then


click [OK].

Once the valid User Name and Password is


accepted, you will see the CDM-625 Web
Server Interface splash page, as per the
following example (note that the Base
Modem and optional IP Packet Processor
Firmware Versions listed here are subject to
change):

To properly access the CDM-625 Web Server Interface, you must first configure remote control
access for the unit to Ethernet mode. If you attempt to log in to the Web Server Interface and

68

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

remote control for the CDM-625 has not been set to Ethernet mode, access is blocked and the
following error message displays in the browser window:

Click [Enable Ethernet Mode] to switch over from your current mode to Ethernet Mode.

Alternately, From the CDM-625 front panel, use the arrow keys to navigate to, and the
arrow keys to edit, the remote control configuration menu (press ENTER when done):

SELECT: Configuration Remote Remote Control=Ethernet

6.5.2 Web Server Interface Operational Features

6.5.2.1 Navigation
The CDM-625 Web Server Interface features navigation tabs
located at the top of each page. After you click a navigation
tab, you may click an available primary page tab. In turn, any
nested tabs appear for further selection.

This manual uses a naming format for all pages to indicate the depth of navigation needed to
view the subject page: Top Level Tab | Primary Page Tab | Nested Tab.

For example: Admin | Firmware | Base Modem is interpreted to mean first click the top-
level Admin navigation tab; then, click the Firmware primary page tab; finally, click the nested
Base Modem tab.

6.5.2.2 Page Sections


Each page features one or more sections. The title at the
upper-left corner of each page or page section describes its
operational features. Each section can feature editable
fields, action buttons, and read-only displays for a specific
function.

This manual explains the purpose and operation for each Web page on a per-page, per-section
basis.

6.5.2.3 Action Buttons


Action buttons are important in the Web Server Interface.

69

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

Click an action button to do one of these tasks:

Refresh the page with current data.

Reset changed parameters to remove unsaved changes.

Submit (permanently save) changes.

If you edit a field, make sure to click the action button before you leave the page.
If you go to another page without first clicking the action button, your changes are
not saved.

6.5.2.4 Drop-down Lists


A drop-down list lets you choose from a list of selections.
Left-click the drop-down button to open the list. Then, left-
click on an item to select that choice.

6.5.2.5 Text or Data Entry


Text boxes let you type data into a field. An action button may
be associated with a single text box, or a group of text boxes.

For any text box, left-click anywhere inside the box, type the
desired information into that field, and be sure to press
[ENTER] when done.

Click the related action button to save the data.

If you edit any field, make sure to click the action button before you leave the
page. If you go to another page without first clicking the action button, your
changes are not saved.

610

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.3 Web Server Interface Menu Tree


The CDM-625 Web Server Interface pages in this diagram that are marked with an
asterisk (*) are selectable/operational only when the optional FAST feature is
activated, or when the optional IP Packet Processor card is installed and enabled
and you have logged in with Admin access privileges. See Sect. 6.5.3.1 for detailed
information about this conditional access.

Pages marked with double asterisks (**) are operable only when the specified
auxiliary products, such as BUCs or LNBs, are installed.

The menu tree diagram (Figure 6-2) lists the features available through the CDM-625 Web Server
(HTTP) Interface. This interface features six navigation tabs (shown in blue). Primary page tabs
(green) and nested page tabs (yellow) provide access to individual Web pages. Click any
navigation tab to continue.

Figure 6-2. CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface Menu Tree (FW Ver. 2.3.1)

611

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.3.1 Conditional Access to IP Packet Processor Pages

Carefully review the information in this section.

A significant number of pages in the CDM-625 Web Server Interface address operation of the
CDM-625 when equipped with the optional IP Packet Processor card. These pages are accessible
only when the optional IP Packet Processor card is installed and enabled.

As specified in Sect. 6.5.1, access to these pages is further restricted to Admin (administrative)
users only. If a user with Read/Write or Read Only user access privileges attempts to select
any IP Packet Processor-specific page, access to that page is prohibited and either of the
following error messages may display in the browser window:

-or-

Once logged in, if the Admin user attempts to access any IP Packet Processor-specific page when
the optional IP Packet Processor card is not installed, the following message displays:

Click [Back to previous page] to resume use of the interface.

If the Admin user attempts to access these pages when the optional IP Packet Processor card is
installed but card operation is Disabled, the following message displays:

Click [Back to previous page] to continue any other available operations, or go to the Packet
Processor drop-down list (in the Network Configuration section of the Configuration | LAN | IP
page) to select its operation as Enabled (the modem will automatically reboot).

612

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

The CDM-625 Web Server Interface menu tree diagram (Figure 6-2) indicates those primary and
nested IP Packet Processor pages having conditional access and operation with an asterisk (*).
Further, each interface page subsection (under Sect. 6.5.4 Web Server Page Descriptions)
governed by such restrictions contains an advisory note similar to this example:

These pages are accessible only to Admin users and when the optional IP Packet
Processor card is installed and enabled. See Sect. 6.5.3.1 for complete details
about using these conditional access pages.

6.5.4 Web Server Page Descriptions


Access to and availability of certain CDM-625 Web Server Interface pages are
dependent upon the options purchased for operation (e.g., the IP Packet Processor
card) as well as the detected presence of auxiliary equipment (e.g., Block Up
Converters, Low Noise Block Down Converters, Redundancy Switches, etc.), as
installed and configured for use with the CDM-625. Any such operational
restrictions are noted in the subsections that follow through the remainder of this
chapter.

6.5.4.1 Home Pages


Click the Home, Contact, or Support tab to continue.

6.5.4.1.1 Home | Home


Use this page to identify the product and its current operating firmware version. Click the Home
navigation tab and/or the nested page tab to return to this page from anywhere in the Web
Server Interface.

Figure 6-3. CDM-625 Satellite Modem Home page

613

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.1.2 Home | Contact


Use this page to see the contact information (phone, fax, or Web/e-mail hyperlinks) for
Comtech EF Data Sales or Customer Support.

Figure 6-4. Home | Contact page

614

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.1.3 Home | Support

For this page to operate correctly, the modems administrator is required to


specify the SMTP server, domain name, and destination on the Admin | Access
page (see Sect. 6.5.4.2.1).

This page uses SMTP (Simple Mail Transport Protocol) to compose and send e-mail messages
about the modem to Comtech EF Data Modem Support (cdmipsupport@comtechefdata.com).

Figure 6-5. Home | Support page

Contact Information
Use this section to provide your contact information to Comtech EF Data when you submit a
Problem Report.

Problem Report
Use this section to compose a message of up to 256 characters maximum to Comtech EF Data.
Be sure to provide your Contact Information, and then click [Submit Email] to send the
message.

615

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.2 Admin Pages


Use these pages to set up user access, manage the firmware load preferences, and activate FAST
features.

The Admin pages are available only to users who have logged in using the
Administrator Name and Password.

Click the Access, SNMP, Firmware, Reboot, FAST, or Utilities tab to continue.

6.5.4.2.1 Admin | Access

Figure 6-6. Admin | Access page

System Account Access Information


Read Only, Read/Write, Admin Names and Passwords The factory defaults for these user
names and passwords are as follows:

Description Factory Default User Name / Password Typical Parameters

Read Only monitor / 1234


Name and Password fields can be any
Read/Write opcenter / 1234 alphanumeric combination with a
maximum length of 10 characters.
Admin comtech / comtech

SMTP Server Specify the mail server IP Address from where e-mail may be sent.

SMTP Domain Name / Destination The Administrator can assign the SMTP Domain Name
and Destination. This is required if the e-mail feature of the Home | Support page (Sect.
6.5.4.1.3) is to be used.

616

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

o SMTP Domain Name Specify the domain of the e-mail server (usually found to the
right of the @ symbol in an e-mail address).

o SMTP Domain Destination Specify the e-mail recipient name (usually found to the left
of the @ symbol in an e-mail address).

Host Access List


IP (#) / Mask The Host Access List allows a user to define which remote clients can connect
when the Access List is Enabled. Each entry allows a user to specify an IP Address and a
subnet mask to define a unique class of machines that are allowed access.

For example, if a user wanted to grant access to a PC with an IP Address of 10.10.10.1 and
any PC on a subnet of 192.168.10.XXX, and then the Access List would be defined as:

IP 1 / Mask 10.10.10.1/32
IP 2 / Mask 192.168.10.0/24

The check box before the IP (#) / Mask must be checked in order for that list
entry to take effect.

Access List The Access List allows a user to grant access via HTTP and SNMP to a defined
list of client machines.

Use the drop-down to select Enable or Disable. If Disable is selected, then any client
machine will be able to connect via HTTP and SNMP.

Click [Submit Admin] to save these settings.

617

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.2.2 Admin | SNMP

Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION


Sect. 6.3 SNMP INTERFACE

The Administrator must use this page to set and return administration information for the
CDM-625 SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol) feature.

Figure 6-7. Admin | SNMP page

SNMP
Simple Network Management Use the drop-down list to select as Disabled or Enabled.

Enable Authentication Trap Use the drop-down list to select as Disable or Enable.

Assign up to two SNMP Trap IP Addresses.

Trap Version Use the drop-down list to select SNMPv1 or SNMPv2.

SNMP Read/Write/Trap Community Strings, SNMP Contact/Name/Location Create or


edit these alphanumeric text strings as follows:
Setting Factory Default Typical Parameters

SNMP Read Community String public


The Read, Write, and Trap Community Strings
SNMP Write Community String private can be any alphanumeric combination with a
maximum length of 4 to 15 characters.
SNMP Trap Community String comtech
SNMP Contact N/A
The SNMP Contact, Name, and Location strings
SNMP Name N/A can be any alphanumeric combination with a
maximum length of 0 to 20 characters.
SNMP Location N/A

Click [Submit Admin] to save these settings.

618

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.2.3 Admin | Firmware Pages

Chapter 4. UPDATING FIRMWARE

Click the Base Modem tab, or when the optional IP Packet Processor card is installed, the Packet
Processor tab to continue.

6.5.4.2.3.1 Admin | Firmware | Base Modem


Use this page to view the scrollable, read-only status windows that provide information about
the basic units two loaded and operational firmware images.

Figure 6-8. Admin | Firmware | Base Modem page

Boot
This window identifies the firmware number, version, and release date that is loaded upon
power-up/boot up of the unit.

Image 1 / Image 2
These scrollable windows identify the Firmware numbers, versions, and release dates that
comprise the aggregate image load.

619

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

Currently Running (read-only)


The current running image is identified here.

Next Reboot, will use


Use the drop-down list to select Image 1 or Image 2 as the image to use upon next reboot, and
then click [Submit] to save this selection.

6.5.4.2.3.2 Admin | Firmware | Packet Processor


This nested page is accessible only to Admin users and when the optional IP Packet
Processor card is installed and enabled. See Sect. 6.5.3.1 for complete details about
using conditional access pages.

Use this page to view the status window for the optional IP Packet Processors currently loaded
firmware, and to set the firmware load preference for the IP Packet Processor upon power-
up/reboot of the unit.

Figure 6-9. Admin | Firmware | Packet Processor page

Firmware
(Read-only) The IP Packet Processors Bootrom, Image 1, Image 2, and current Running
image are identified here.

Boot From Use the drop-down list to boot the IP Packet Processor from Latest, Image 1, or
Image 2, and then click [Submit] to save this selection.

620

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.2.4 Admin | Reboot


Use this page to perform a soft reboot of the CDM-625 using the current, active firmware Image
as selected on the Admin | Firmware | Base Modem page (Sect. 6.5.4.2.3.1) and/or the
Admin | Firmware | Packet Processor page (Sect. 6.5.4.2.3.2).

Figure 6-10. Status | Firmware Info | Reboot page

Click [Reboot Now] to perform the soft reboot of the CDM-625. The page updates to indicate
the reboot in progress as follows:

Depending on the number of installed hardware and firmware options, it may take up to one
minute for soft reboot to execute. Once the CDM-625 splash screen appears on the front
panel VFD, you must log in to begin a new Web Server Interface session:

1. Click [OK] on the Rebooting page to complete the reboot process.

2. Upon reboot, you will need to refresh your browser window. Once the Login
window appears, type in your User name and Password.

3. Click [OK] in the Login window; the browser window will refresh to show the Web
Server Interface splash (Home) page.

4. Select any navigation tab to resume your session.

621

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.2.5 Admin | FAST


Sect. 1.3.8 Fully Accessible System Topology (FAST)
Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION
Appendix C. FAST ACTIVATION PROCEDURE

The CDM-625 has a number of optional features that may be activated after the units purchase.
Fully Accessible System Topology (FAST) Access Codes are register-specific authorization codes
that may be purchased from Comtech EF Data, and then activated in the unit using this page.
Contact a Comtech EF Data sales representative during normal business hours, or via e-mail to
sales@comtechefdata.com, to order the desired options and obtain your unique FAST Access
Codes.

Figure 6-11. Admin | FAST page

FAST code
When you obtain a FAST access code from Comtech EF Data, it will be for a specific option
register. Carefully enter each register-specific 20-character FAST access code in sequence, and
then click [Submit FAST code] when done. A message will display at the top of this section that
states whether or not the codes are accepted or if the upgrade is successful.

622

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

Demo Time Remaining:


FAST Options Demo-Mode allows access to ALL CDM-625 FAST options* for 2592000 seconds
(30 calendar days). This section displays the remaining time in days, hours, and minutes.

* The AES Feature is available only when the CDM-625 is equipped with the
optional IP Packet Processor with AES software.

Use the drop-down list to set Demo-Mode as Enabled or Disabled, and then click [Submit] to
execute the selection.

Equipment ID
This read-only section displays the operational status for a number of FAST-enabled features.

Installed Options
This scrollable, read-only list box displays the installed and presently operational FAST-enabled
features.

Options Not Installed


This scrollable, read-only list box displays the uninstalled FAST-enabled features that are
available for purchase and activation from Comtech EF Data.

6.5.4.2.6 Admin | Utilities


Use this page to ping a device on the network for diagnostic purposes.

Figure 6-12. Admin | Utilities page

Ping
IP Address Enter the IP Address for the network device in the format XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX.

Number of Pings (1-20) Specify the number of ping attempts to be executed, from a
minimum of 1 up to a maximum of 20 attempts.

Click [Ping] to execute the function. The scrollable window displays the result of the
command.

623

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.3 Configuration Pages


Use the Configuration pages to configure all operating parameters for the CDM-625, including
its ODUs (Outdoor Units) when connected. Click the Modem, LAN, Routing, WAN, Overhead,
Utilities, D&I, BUC, or LNB tab to continue.

6.5.4.3.1 Configuration | Modem

Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION

Use the Configuration | Modem page to configure these modem operating parameters:
Tx / Rx Interfaces and Framing* Carrier-in-Carrier (CnC) Parameters
Tx / Rx Operating Parameters ACM Parameters

*The Tx / Rx Interface Types and Framing Modes have higher priority than other
parameters, and should be configured before setting other parameters.

Figure 6-13. Configuration | Modem page


Click [Submit] to save these settings.

624

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.3.2 Configuration | LAN Pages


Click the IP tab, or when the optional IP Packet Processor card is installed and enabled the
ARP tab to continue.

6.5.4.3.2.1 Configuration | LAN | IP

Figure 6-14. Configuration | LAN | IP page

Network Configuration
Ping Reply Use the drop-down list to select Ping Reply as Disabled or Enabled. When
Enabled, the modem responds to ICMP ping requests.

MAC Address This parameter is read-only and cannot be changed.

WAN Buffer Length Enter a value between 20ms and 400ms, in 20ms increments.

625

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

L2 QoS (Layer 2 QoS) Use the drop-down list to select this feature as Off, VLAN only, Port
only, or VLAN & Port.
L
L2 QoS can be enabled only when the optional IP Packet Processor is disabled.

Dedicated Management Port This feature is available in Managed Switch Mode, but it is
unavailable when VLAN Mode is Enabled or when the optional IP Packet Processor is
enabled.

Use the drop-down list to select Port 1, Port 2, Port 3, or Port 4 as the Dedicated
Management Port. If Port 1 (2,3,4) - Local Only is selected, management is restricted to LAN
only. Note that, when the optional IP Packet Processor is Enabled, the drop-down list
displays Disabled as the sole listed option. When VLAN is Enabled, the drop-down list
displays all options as described previously, but the selections are non-functioning.

2048 Ethernet Frame Size This feature is supported only on modems with Hardware
Revision 2.X or higher.

Use the drop-down list to select this feature as Disabled or Enabled.

IP Gateway (applicable only in Managed Switch Mode), and Traffic/Mgmt IP Address (and
subnet mask) Configure the modems IP Addresses using these fields.

MAC Learning (applicable only in Managed Switch Mode) Use the drop-down list to select
MAC Learning as On or Off.

L3 QoS (Layer 3 QoS) This feature is operational only when the optional IP Packet
Processor card is installed and enabled.

Use the drop-down list to select the L3 (Advanced) QoS as Off, Max/Priority, Min Max, or
DiffServ.

Working Mode Use the drop-down list to select the Working Mode as follows:

o Managed Switch Primarily intended for operation in a point-to-point topology,


Managed Switch Mode is Comtechs IP modem intelligent networking solution. It allows
a link to be set up with minimal configuration (no specific routes need to be configured).

When the optional IP Packet Processor is either not installed or is installed but disabled,
Managed Switch Mode provides support for Layer 2 QoS, and Dedicated Management
Port or VLAN.

When the optional IP Packet Processor is installed and enabled, advanced features are
available, such as Layer 3 (Advanced) QoS, Header and Payload Compression, Streamline
Encapsulation (SLE), and Encryption. Most are supported only under Admin user
access.

626

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

Sect. 6.5.4.3.4 Configuration | Managed Switch

o Router Point-to-Point Functions as a point-to-point router in Point-to-Point


configurations.

o Router Multipoint Hub Functions as the Hub side router in a Point-to-Multipoint


network. Allows Satellite-to-Satellite packets to pass.

o Router Multipoint Remote Functions as a Remote Router in a Point-to-Multipoint


network. Packets from the WAN are not allowed to be sent to the WAN.

Packet Processor This feature is operational only when the optional IP Packet Processor
card is installed. Use the drop-down list to select the IP Packet Processor card as Enabled or
Disabled.

When you change the optional IP Packet Processor card operation (i.e.,
Enabled or Disabled), after you click the [Submit] tab the modem is forced to
reboot and you will see the following message:

Note that, before clicking [OK] to proceed with reboot of the modem, you may
first need to clear the PCs ARP table.

Click [Submit] to save these settings.

Per Port Configuration


Set the parameters on a per-port basis (Port 1 through Port 4). Note the following:
Column Description
Speed Use the drop-down list to select the speed for each selected port: Auto, 100 Full, 100 Half,
10 Full, or 10 Half.
Pause Flow Control Use the drop-down list to select Pause Flow Control for the port as Off or On.
Port Mode Use the drop-down list to select Port Mode for the port as Access or Trunk.
PVID When Port Mode is Access, a PVI D ( Native VLAN ID) may be as signed to the selected
port us ing a v alue r ange of 0001 -4095. ( See not e about P VIDs ( Native V LAN IDs) v s.
Management VLAN IDs.)
Priority Use t he dr op-down l ist t o s et t he oper ational pr iority of t he s elected por t, i n t he or der of
preference (from 1 to 4).
Actual Negotiated This i s t he s tatus of t he c urrent oper ating ac tual s peed and d uplex. I f t he port i s not
Port Speed connected, and then Link Down is displayed.

Click [Submit Port Cnfg] to save these settings.

627

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

VLAN Mode

VLAN Mode is supported in Managed Switch Mode, with or without the optional IP
Packet Processor enabled.
VLAN Mode Use the drop-down list to select the mode as Disabled or Enabled.

Management VLAN ID A Management VLAN ID may be assigned to the selected port using
a value range from 0001 to 4095.

When configuring Access and Management VLAN IDs:

The Access VLAN ID (PVID) is used to tag arriving packets that have no
VLAN tag. Likewise, when packets arrive from the WAN with the same
VLAN tag as the Access VLAN ID, and then the VLAN header is removed
and passed to the LAN interface.

The Management VLAN ID is used to specify a dedicated management


VLAN used to access and control the modems.

Click [Submit] to save these settings.

VLAN Table
VLAN Entry / Action Set the table entry action as None, Edit, Delete, or Add:

o None No actions will be taken on the VLAN priority rule for the selected VLAN ID.

o Edit Click to modify an existing VLAN priority rule in the VLAN table. The VLAN rule will
be updated in the VLAN Table once the user clicks [Submit].

o Delete Click to flag a VLAN priority rule for removal from the VLAN Table. The VLAN
rule will be deleted from the VLAN Table once the user clicks [Submit].

o Add Click to add a VLAN priority rule. The entry will be added to the VLAN Table for
processing once the user clicks [Submit].

VLAN ID This parameter is read-only and reflect the ID value assigned in the Per Port
Configuration section of this page (i.e., any ID has a value range of 0001-4095).

Port 1 through Port 4 Use the drop-down list to select the port as Untagged, Tagged, or
Filtered.

Action Use the drop-down list to select the action for this active ID as None, Edit, Delete,
or Add.

Click [Submit] to save these settings.

628

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

VLAN Table This read-only table provides the user with the status for VLAN entry on a per-
ID (0001-4095) and per-Port (1-4) basis, where U=Untagged, T=Tagged, and F=Filtered.

6.5.4.3.2.2 Configuration | LAN | ARP


This nested page is accessible only to Admin users and when the optional IP Packet
Processor card is installed and enabled. See Sect. 6.5.3.1 for complete details about
using conditional access pages.

ARP (Address Resolution Protocol) is a technique by which the Web Server Interface in Router
Mode on a given network answers the ARP queries for a network address that is not on this
network, but is reachable via the IP Packet Processor Interface.

Use this page to configure the modems ARP parameters.

Figure 6-15. Configuration | LAN | ARP page

ARP Table (Edit)


This section displays all current Static and Dynamic ARP entries, and allows to user to directly
edit the current Static ARP entries, when more than one ARP entry exists. Note the following:
Column Description
Index This is the internal table index that is automatically assigned and cannot be edited.
IP IP Address, in the format XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX.
MAC MAC Address, in the format YY:YY:YY:YY:YY:YY.
Type Type is identifiable as Static or Dynamic (cannot be edited).

Click [Submit Changes] to save these settings.

629

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

Add Static ARP


This section allows you to directly add a static ARP entry. Note that the index will automatically
increment to the next available number.

Click [Add Entry] to save these settings.

Delete Static ARP


Enter Entry Index to Delete, and then click [Delete Entry] once all changes have been made in
this section.

Flush Dynamic ARPs


Click [Flush ARP Table] to delete all dynamically learned ARP entries.

630

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.3.3 Configuration | Routing Pages


The nested Routes, IGMP, and DHCP pages are accessible only to Admin users and
when the optional IP Packet Processor card is installed and enabled. See Sect.
6.5.3.1 for complete details about using conditional access pages.

Click the Routes, IGMP, DHCP, or DNS tab to continue.

6.5.4.3.3.1 Configuration | Routing | Routes


Use this page to enter static routes into the IP Packet Processor to route IP traffic over the
satellite or to another device on the local LAN.

Figure 6-16. Configuration | Routing | Routes page

Route Table (Edit)


This section displays and allows you to edit all current Route Table entries. Note the following:
Column Description
Index This is the internal table index that is automatically assigned and cannot be edited.
Desc. This label helps to maintain the network. Enter a l abel string in this text box. The assigned
name must be unique and cannot contain any whitespace.
Dest.IP/Mask Enter a Destination IP Address/Mask in the form XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX/YY.
Interf. Use the drop-down list to select the Interface as toWAN or toLAN.

631

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

Column Description
Next HOP IP Enter t he des ired N ext H op I P Address f or toLAN routes. N ote t hat no N ext H op ent ry i s
needed for toWAN routes.
Header Comp. When the optional Header Compression FAST feature is available, use the drop-down list to
Disable or Enable operations.
Payload Comp. When the optional Payload Compression FAST feature is available, use the drop-down list to
Disable or Enable operations.
Encryption When t he opt ional AES Encryption F AST f eature i s av ailable, use t he dr op-down lis t t o
Disable or Enable operations.
With AES Encryption disabled, all routed traffic is transmitted in the
clear regardless of the Encryption Key specified in the Route Table.

Encryption With enc ryption enabled, u se t he dr op-down l ist t o s elect Key 1 through Key 8 (assigned
Key using the Configuration | WAN | Encryption page, Sect. 6.5.4.3.5.3) or Random Key.
You must program all eight encryption and decryption keys before
selecting Random Key otherwise, the modem will select any of the eight
allotted keys, even if a key is currently clear (set to all zeroes).

Click [Submit Changes] to save these settings.

Add New Route


This section allows you to directly add a route entry using text boxes and drop-down lists as
described previously for the Route Table (Edit) section.

Click [Add Entry] to save these settings. Note that, when a new route is added, the index
automatically increments to the next available number.

Delete Route
Enter Route Index to Delete, and then click [Delete Entry] once all changes have been made in
this section. The specified route entry will then be deleted from the route table.

632

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.3.3.2 Configuration | Routing | IGMP


This page permits use of Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) with configured multicast
routes.

IGMP, when enabled, responds to IGMP queries for the configured multicast routes on the
transmit side and generates IGMP queries on the receive side. If there are no active IGMP
receivers on the LAN, it will stop forwarding the multicast traffic (received from the satellite) to
the LAN.

Figure 6-17. Configuration | Routing | IGMP page

IGMP Multicast Router


Version Use the drop-down list to select IGMPv1, IGMPv2, or IGMPv3.

Last Member Query Interval This is the maximum response time inserted into group-
specific queries that are set in response to Leave Group messages, and is also amount of
time between group-specific query messages. This value may be tuned to modify the "leave
latency" of the network; a reduced value results in reduced time to detect the loss of the
last member of a group.

Enter a value, in seconds, from 1 to 25 (default = 1 second).

633

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

Query Interval This is the interval between general queries sent by the modem. By varying
the query interval, a modem administrator may tune the number of IGMP messages on the
subnet; note that larger numbers cause the IGMP queries to be sent less often.

Enter a value, in seconds, from 1 to 18000 (default = 125 seconds)

Query Response Interval This is the maximum response time inserted into the periodic
general queries. By varying the Query Response Interval, a modem administrator may tune
the burstiness of IGMP messages on the subnet; note that larger values make the traffic
less bursty as host responses are spread out over a large interval.

Enter a value, in seconds, from 1 to 25 (default = 10 seconds).

The number of seconds assigned to the Query Response Interval must be less
than the Query Interval.

Click [Submit] to save these settings.

IGMP Joined Groups


This read-only table lists the IGMP Groups that are active on the modem. This allows you to
determine which services are being used and the minimum time before a service will be
terminated.

Click [Refresh] to update this section with its latest available statistics.

Multicast Routes
This read-only table lists the Multicast Routes that are active on the modem.

Click [Refresh] to update this section with its latest available statistics.

634

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.3.3.3 Configuration | Routing | DHCP


Use this page to set up the DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol) Relay feature.

DHCP allows a device to be configured automatically eliminating the need for intervention by a
network administrator and provides a server located at the hub for keeping track of devices
that are connected to the network. This prevents two devices from accidentally being
configured with the same IP Address.

The CDM-625 DHCP Relay feature allows you to deploy a single DHCP server at the hub that
manages all of the devices throughout your remote networks. When a device on the CDM-625's
network issues a DHCP request, it is relayed to the DHCP server as specified by the "DHCP Server
IP Address". The DHCP response is then sent directly to the requesting device.

Figure 6-18. Configuration | Routing | DHCP page

DHCP Relay
Relay Feature Use the drop-down list to Disable or Enable the DHCP Relay Feature.

DHCP Server IP Address Specify the IP Address to be used for the DHCP server at the hub
in the form XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX.

Click [Submit] to save these settings.

635

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.3.3.4 Configuration | Routing | DNS


Use this page to manage DNS (Domain Name System) caching. DNS caching provides an efficient
way for DNS to keep the Internet synchronized as the IP addresses of some servers change and
as new servers come online.

Figure 6-19. Configuration | Routing | DNS page

DNS Caching
Use the drop-down list to set DNS as Enabled or Disabled. Click [Submit] to save.

DNS Cache Flush


Click [Flush] to clear the DNS Cache of all data.

636

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.3.4 Configuration | Managed Switch


The features on this nested page are accessible only to Admin users and when the
optional IP Packet Processor card is installed and enabled. See Sect. 6.5.3.1 for
complete details about using conditional access pages.

For configuration of Managed Switch Mode features that do not require the
presence or enabling of the optional IP Packet Processor (i.e., L2 QoS, Dedicated
Management Port, VLAN Mode), see Sect. 6.5.4.3.2.1 Configuration | LAN | IP.

Managed Switch Mode is primarily intended for operation in a point-to-point topology. It


supports VLAN as well as advanced features such as QoS, Header Compression, Payload
Compression, and Encryption/Decryption.

Figure 6-20. Configuration | Managed Switch page

Managed Switch Configuration


Header Compression When this optional feature is available, use the drop-down list select
Header Compression as Disable, L2 Enabled, or L2/L3 Enabled.

Click [Save] to save this setting.

Payload Compression When this optional feature is available, use the drop-down list to
Disable or Enable Payload Compression.

Click [Save] to save these settings.

Encryption When this optional feature is available , use the drop-down list to Disable or
Enable Encryption.

Encryption Key When this optional feature is available and encryption has been Enabled,
the Encryption keys are used to encrypt traffic being sent over the satellite interface:

637

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

o Select Key 1 through Key 8 to use the key specified in the Encryption/Decryption
Configuration Page (Sect. 6.5.4.3.5.3) to encrypt WAN traffic.

o Select Disable to force the IP Module to not encrypt any WAN traffic.

o Select Random to cause the IP Module to randomly use any of the eight Tx Keys to
encrypt the traffic destined for the satellite link.

Click [Save] to save these settings.

638

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.3.5 Configuration | WAN Pages


The nested QoS, Compression, and Encryption pages are accessible only to Admin
users and when the optional IP Packet Processor card is installed and enabled. See
Sect. 6.5.3.1 for complete details about using conditional access pages.

Click the QoS, Compression, or Encryption tab to continue.

6.5.4.3.5.1 Configuration | WAN | QoS Pages


The Configuration | WAN | QoS page is viewable only when QoS is enabled for operation.

With QoS disabled, if the nested QoS tab is selected, in place of a populated page the following
message appears:

With QoS enabled, the appearance of this page depends on the active mode of operation. The
active mode is labeled in the upper left-hand page corners, below the nested QoS tab:

Max/Priority Mode or Min/Max Mode (see Figure 6-21)

DiffServ Mode (see Figure 6-22)

The label for each page is appended with the following message:

Note that IP is a hyperlink providing direct navigation to this configuration page.

Segmentation and Reassembly (SAR)


This section is identical for the Max/Priority, Min/Max, and DiffServ pages.

Packet Segmentation and Reassembly (SAR) is an adaptive process; it will trigger only if the
packet latency exceeds the threshold value (default to 25 msec). SAR is needed, when running
small-speed (<700 kbps) links, to keep latency and jitter within specifications (25 msec
latency/10 msec jitter) when the lower priority queue contains large packets.

Use the drop-down list to select SAR as Disable or Enable, and then click [Submit].

639

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.3.5.1.1 Configuration | WAN | QoS Pages Max/Priority, Min/Max


Modes

Figure 6-21. Configuration | WAN | QoS Pages


(Top) QoS Control Mode = Max/Priority
(Bottom) QoS Control Mode = Min/Max (Banner, Menu Bar not shown)

640

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

QoS Rules Table


For the Max/Priority page:

For the Min/Max page:

This section displays all existing QoS Rules Table entries. From left to right:
Column Description
Index This is the internal table index that is automatically assigned and cannot be edited.
Protocol Specifies the protocol for the specific rule.
VLAN Range Specifies the minimum-to-maximum range of VLAN IDs (applicable only in Managed Switch
Mode)
TOS Specifies the Type Of Service
Src IP/Mask Identifies the Source IP Address/Mask in the form XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX/YY.
Dst IP/Mask Identifies the Destination IP Address/Mask in the form XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX/YY.
Min Src Port Specifies the Minimum Source Port.
Max Src Port Specifies the Maximum Source Port.
Min Dst Port Specifies the Minimum Destination Port.
Max Dst Port Specifies the Maximum Destination Port.
Min BW (Kbps) (Min/Max page only) Specifies the minimum bandwidth value.
Max BW (Kbps) Specifies the maximum bandwidth value.
Priority (Max/Priority page only) Specifies the priority established for the specific rule.
WRED Specifies the WRED (Weighted Random Early Detection) setting for the specific rule as
Disable or Enable.
Filter All Specifies the flow filter setting for the specific rule as Disable or Enable.

Add New QoS Rule


This section allows you to directly add a new rule entry. Note that the index will automatically
increment to the next available number.

For the Max/Priority page:

641

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

For the Min/Max page:

From left to right:


Column Description
Protocol Use the drop-down list to select the Protocol as UDP, TCP, ICMP, RTP, VOICE, VIDEO,
RTPS, FTP, HTTP, TELNET, SMTP, SNMP, All-IP, Non-IP, or All.
VLAN Range Enter the minimum-to-maximum range of VLAN IDs from 0-4094 (applicable only in
Managed Switch Mode).
TOS Enter the Type of Service.
Src IP/Mask Enter a Source IP Address/Mask in the form XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX/YY.
Dst IP/Mask Enter a Destination IP Address/Mask in the form XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX/YY.

Min/Max Src Port Selection of Source/Destination Ports should only be done if you are aware of the
port us age of t he de sired pr otocol or a pplication. There ar e w ell-known por ts f or
various protocols, but often only the command messaging is transacted on t hese ports
Min/Max Dst Port and the data is transferred through a negotiated port.
Min BW (Kbps) (Min/Max page only) Assign a value to a flow to restrict the Minimum Bandwidth that
any particular flow will utilize; otherwise, the default of no bandwidth restriction can be
selected.
Max BW (Kbps) Assign a value to a flow to restrict the Maximum Bandwidth that any particular flow will
utilize; otherwise, the default of no bandwidth restriction can be selected.
Priority (Max/Priority page only) Use the drop-down list to assign a Priority Level from 1 to 8
for each flow:

The IP Module classifies each packet that is to be forwarded over the satellite; the
packet then has a Priority assigned according to the defined QoS Rules;

Any latency critical traffic such as VoIP/RTP should always be assigned Priority 1;

Priority 1 pac kets are forwarded immediately; Priority 2 packets are forwarded as
soon as there are no Priority 1 packets in the Queue; and so on;

Any packet that does not meet a QoS Rule is assigned to the Default Rule and i s
assigned a Priority of 9.
WRED Use the drop-down list to set WRED (Weighted Random Early Detection) as Disable or
Enable.
Filter All Use the drop-down list to set Filter All to Disable or Enable. QoS allows specific flows to
be designated as filtered so the IP Packet Processor card will discard traffic that you do
not want to forward over a satellite link.

For either page, click [Add Rule] to execute the addition of the new rule to the QoS Rules Table.

642

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

Delete Rule
This section is identical for both the Max/Priority and Min/Max pages.

Enter Rule Index to Delete, and then click [Delete Rule] to execute deletion of the specified rule
from the QoS Rules Table.

Delete All (Max/Pri, Min/Max) QoS Rules Use With Caution


For the Max/Priority page:

For the Min/Max page:

For either page, use the drop-down list to select Yes, and then click [Submit] to execute the
deletion of all rules from the QoS Rules Table.

643

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.3.5.1.2 Configuration | WAN | QoS Pages DiffServ Mode


QoS can be set to DiffServ Mode to make it fully compliant to the Differentiated Services QoS
RFC (Request For Comments) standards.

Figure 6-22. Configuration | WAN | QoS page (DiffServ Mode)

Differentiated Services
From left to right, note the following:
Column Description
Priority IP traffic is prioritized based upon the DSCP (DiffServ Code Points) Class Selector
Precedence.
Per-Hop Behavior (PHB) Traffic class that determines how packets will be forwarded.
Codepoint (DSCP) Codepoint value in Type of Service (ToS) byte in IP header.

The user has the option of configuring each queue to one of the following attributes (the
acceptable ranges are shown in brackets):

644

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

Column Description
Service Rate [ -0.000 / (Tx Data Rate)] The minimum bandwidth will be s erved first among the
Assured F orwarding (ASFD) c lasses in case of band width availability once Class
Selector 7 through Class Selected 1 have been serviced.
Drop Preferences ASFD Class 4 through 1 Code Points (b100xx0, b011xx0, b010xx0, and b001xx0)
carry the drop precedence value (xx). In case of network congestion, a W eighted
Random E arly D etection ( WRED) c ongestion av oidance al gorithm i s i mposed on
these queues to drop the packets randomly rather than tail drop.

Low Drop Precedence (% full) [0100] In case of congestion, the WRED


is appl ied af ter t he queue dept h ex ceeds t he c onfigured per centage v alue
assigned for the Drop Precedence value b001.

Med. Drop Precedence (% full) [099] In case of congestion, the WRED


is appl ied af ter t he queue dept h ex ceeds t he c onfigured per centage v alue
assigned for the Drop Precedence value b010.

High Drop Precedence (% full)) [099] In case of congestion, the WRED


is appl ied af ter t he queue dept h ex ceeds t he c onfigured per centage v alue
assigned for the Drop Precedence value b011.

Click [Submit] to save these settings.

645

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.3.5.2 Configuration | WAN | Compression


Use this page to configure the optional Payload and Header Compression, when this FAST
feature is enabled.

Figure 6-23. Configuration | WAN | Compression page

Compression Availability
This section provides a hyperlink to the Configuration | Managed Switch page (see Sect.
6.5.4.3.4). Use this Managed Switch link to enable Header and Payload Compression.

Header Compression
Header Comp. RTP Refresh Rate Enter a time for the Real Time Protocol refresh rate, from
1 to 600 seconds.

Header Comp. UDP Refresh Rate Enter a time for the User Datagram Protocol refresh
rate, from 1 to 600 seconds.

Header comp. Default Refresh Rate Enter a time for the Default Protocol refresh rate,
from 1 to 600 seconds.

Click [Submit] to save these settings.

Payload Compression
Payload Comp. Refresh Rate Enter for the Payload Compression refresh rate, in number of
packets, from 1 to 255.

646

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.3.5.3 Configuration | WAN | Encryption


This page allows configuration of the optional AES Encryption, when this FAST feature is
enabled. When AES Encryption is active and enabled on a WAN route, the IP Packet Processor
will encrypt all outgoing traffic on the WAN, and decrypt any encrypted traffic it receives.

Figure 6-24. Configuration | WAN | Encryption page

Encryption Status Section


This section displays the active state of the AES Encryption option:

Per the example shown in Figure 6-24, when the AES Encryption FAST feature is enabled,
this section displays the message Encryption is available. All functionality of this page is
operable you can encrypt a specific route.

647

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

Route encryption is set using the Configuration | Routing | Routes page (see Sect.
6.5.4.3.3.1) when the modem is in a router mode, or the Configuration | Managed Switch
page (see Sect. 6.5.4.3.4) when the modem is in Managed Switch Mode.

When the AES Encryption FAST feature has not been purchased and is therefore disabled,
the Encryption section of this page appears as follows:

While the AES Encryption FAST feature itself is disabled, the this page may still be used to
program the Encryption and Decryption keys in anticipation of future use.

FAST features may be purchased from Comtech EF Data Sales Representatives


during normal business hours. See Sect. 5.2.8 SELECT: FAST Menus or Appendix C.
FAST ACTIVATION PROCEDURE in this manual for addtional information about
activating FAST features.

For situations where, for example, export restrictions prohibit the availability of the AES
Encryption option, the CDM-625 runs an FPGA chipset that does not allow encryption
operations. The Configuration | WAN | Encryption page is therefore disabled: The page, when
accessed, notes the operational restriction by hiding the Encryption Key and Decryption Key
programming sections and displaying the following message in the Encryption section:

Encryption Unencrypted Rx Traffic


Use the drop-down list to select Allow (default) or Drop. Note the following:

Under the default Allow setting, the local modem allows receipt of unencrypted (plain text)
packets from the remote modem over the WAN, even when encryption is enabled.

Under the Drop setting, the modem drops all unencrypted traffic received over the WAN
interface when encryption is enabled. The remote modem may therefore transmit only
encrypted data.

Encryption / Decryption Keys


A typical encryption or decryption key consists of a string of 32 characters, using any
combination of the numbers 0 through 9 and the letters a through f / A through F.

To program a key, enter the desired 32-character string in the appropriate key row, and then
click [Set]. Any previously programmed key may be overwritten in this manner.

Alternately, click [Clear] to reset a previously programmed entry to all zeroes, and then re-enter
the new key string as instructed here.

648

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

Up to eight keys may be programmed for each function; once set, a specified Encryption Key
may then be selected for active use via the Configuration | Routing | Routes page (Sect.
6.5.4.3.3.1).

The user must program all eight encryption and decryption keys before selecting
Random Key operation on the Configuration | Routing | Routes page. Otherwise,
the modem will select any of the eight allotted keys, even if a key is currently clear
(set to all zeroes).

6.5.4.3.6 Configuration | Overhead

This page appearance is dependent on whether Carrier-in-Carrier Automatic Power


Control (CnC-APC) Mode is selected.

Figure 6-25. Configuration | Overhead page


(Top) Page when CnC-APC mode is not selected
(Bottom) Page with CnC-APC mode selected (Banner, Menu Bar not shown)

649

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION

Use this page to configure the following overhead interfaces:

ESC including Tx / Rx IDR Esc Type, Audio Volume, High Rate ESC

IDR Backward Alarms for Tx 1-4 and Rx 1-4

AUPC (when Carrier-in-Carrier Automatic Power Control is disabled/de-activated)

CnC-APC (when Carrier-in-Carrier Automatic Power Control is enabled/activated)


See Sect. 10.6 Carrier-in-Carrier Automatic Power Control (CnC-APC) in
Chapter 10. DOUBLETALK CARRIER-IN-CARRIER OPTION for complete details
about, and setup of, the CnC-APC feature.
EDMAC Framing Mode and Slave Address

Click [Submit] to save these settings.

650

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.3.7 Configuration | Utilities


Use this page to configure a number of the CDM-625s utility functions.

Figure 6-26. Configuration | Utilities page

Redundancy
If the unit is part of a 1:1 redundant pair of modems, and this unit is currently online, click
[Force 1:1 Switch] to cause the unit to switch to standby.

Re-Center Buffer
Click [Re-Center Buffer] to force the re-centering of the Plesiochronous/Doppler buffer.

Unit
Use the drop-down lists provided in this section to configure Test Mode, Stats Sample Interval,
Front Panel Lockout, RTS/CTS Control, and HSSI Handshake Control.

Click [Submit Unit Utilities] to save these settings.

651

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

Clocks
Use the drop-down lists provided in this section to configure Tx / Rx Clock Sources, Rx Buffer
Size, External Clock, External Frequency Reference, and G.703 Clock Extended Mode /
Interface.

Click [Submit Clocks] to save these settings.

Circuit and Carrier ID


It is IMPORTANT to understand that Carrier ID and Circuit ID, while named similarly,
are two distinct features of the CDM-625. Read your documentation carefully.

With Carrier ID enabled, the first 24 characters of the 40-character Circuit ID are
intended for and sent as the MetaCarrier Custom Message. While you must limit
your MetaCarrier Custom Message to 24 characters or less, the full 40 characters of
the Circuit ID will display on the front panel screen saver (see Sect. 5.1.3.1 Screen
Saver).

Chapter 19. CARRIER ID (MetaCarrier)

Circuit ID Enter a Circuit ID string of


up to 40 characters, or a MetaCarrier
Custom Message of 24 characters or
less.

You may use the following characters to compose either string:

[Space] ( ) * + - , . / 0-9 and A-Z.

The Circuit ID / MetaCarrier Custom Message, as created here, also appears in the title bar
of compatible web browsers for easy unit identification.

Carrier ID Use the drop-down list to


set Carrier ID operation as Disabled or
Enabled.

Click [Submit] to save these settings.

Date and Time


Enter a date using DD/MM/YY format
(where DD = day [01 to 31], MM = month [01 to 12], and YY = year [00 to 99]).

Enter a time using HH:MM:SS format


(where HH = hour [00 to 23], MM = minutes [00 to 59], and SS = seconds [00 to 59]).

Click [Enter Date/Time] once you set the desired date and time.

652

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

BERT Config
Use the drop-down lists provided in this section to configure Bit Error Rate Test for Tx or Rx as
On or Off; configure the pattern for Tx or Rx; and set Error Insertion as either Off or 10E-3.

Click [Submit BERT] once you select the desired BERT settings.

BERT Monitor
This read-only section displays the ongoing BERT. Click [Restart] to restart the BERT Monitor, or
[Update] to refresh a test already in progress.

Save / Load (Save takes precedence over Load)

The Save/Load feature stores and retrieves the CDM-625 Base Modem settings
only. It does not include the optional IP Packet Processor settings.

As a safeguard, to prevent any inadvertent action the Save Location and Load Location drop-
down lists default selections are Dont Save and Dont Load, respectively. Otherwise:

Save Location / Load Location Use the drop-down lists to save or load up to 10 different
modem configurations 0 through 9. An empty location is noted on its menu line as
Available.

Click [Submit Save/Load] to save these settings.

653

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.3.8 Configuration | D&I (Drop and Insert)

For D&I configuration information: Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION


For D&I functionality overview: Chapter 9. CLOCK MODES AND DROP AND
INSERT (D&I).

Figure 6-27. Configuration | D&I page (Selected Framing Mode = D&I)


The appearance of this page is dependent on the framing mode selected on the Configuration |
Modem page (Sect. 6.5.4.3.1). If the selected framing mode is D&I++, the section heading and
the available parameters adjust accordingly:

If the selected framing mode is Quad Drop & Insert, the section heading and the available
parameters adjust accordingly:

Click [Submit] to save these settings.

654

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.3.9 Configuration | BUC (Block Up Converter)

Appendix F. CDM-625 ODU (TRANSCEIVER, BUC, LNB) OPERATION

After configuring the CDM-625 for L-Band operation, and when a Block Up Converter (BUC) is
installed, you may use this page to configure its operating parameters and to view the BUC
operational status.

Figure 6-28. Configuration | BUC page

6.5.4.3.10 Configuration | LNB (Low Noise Block Down Converter)

Appendix F. CDM-625 ODU (TRANSCEIVER, BUC, LNB) OPERATION

After configuring the CDM-625 for L-Band operation, and when a Low Noise Block Down
Converter (LNB) is installed, you may use this page to configure its operating parameters and to
view the LNB operational status.

Figure 6-29. Configuration | LNB page

655

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.3.11 Configuration | ANT (Advanced Network Timing) Pages

Sect. 16.7 Advanced Network Timing (ANT) (Chapter 16. ETHERNET NETWORK
CONFIGURATION)

The ANT feature provides IP-based protocols to synchronize the modem's internal time-of-day
clock to an external device such as a time server, Base Station Controller (BSC), or Radio
Network Controller (RNC).

Select the PTP or SNTP tab to continue.

6.5.4.3.11.1 Configuration | ANT | PTP (Precision Time Protocol)

Sect. 16.7.2 Precision Time Protocol (PTP) (Chapter 16. ETHERNET NETWORK
MANAGEMENT)

If the optional IP Packet Processor card is installed and enabled, then the
Configuration | ANT | PTP menu, while selectable, are not functional.

All network devices between the Grandmaster and Slave devices must support PTP
for sub-microsecond accuracy.

Precision Time Protocol (PTP) is a FAST-activated feature used to synchronize computer clocks
throughout a computer network. On LANs, PTP achieves clock accuracy in the sub-microsecond
range much more accurate than what is attainable by NTP (Network Time Protocol) and it is
also used in network applications where GPS is either unaffordable or inaccessible.

Figure 6-30. Configuration | ANT | PTP page

PTP
Feature Use the drop-down list to set PTP operation as Enabled or Disabled.

656

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

If Enabled, PTP is used to establish independent Wireless Receiver/Transmitter (WRT)


protocol segments one for LAN and the other for WAN. If Disabled, by default the
availability of the PTP protocol is dependent on the near-end (e.g., the RNC/BSC) and
distant-end (e.g., the BTS) IEEE 1588v2 (PTP) capable network devices in the network.

Grandmaster Use the drop-down list to assign to which side (either the LAN port or the
WAN port) the PTP Grandmaster is connected. Note the following:

Selection Function

LAN The LAN port receives messages from the PTP master.

WAN The WAN port receives messages from the PTP master.

Click [Submit] to save these settings.

Status
Click [Refresh] to update this section with its most recently accumulated statistics.

These status parameters are read-only and cannot be changed. Note the following:
Row Title Description
PTP Engine Specifies whether or not PTP is actively attempting to synchronize time.
Top Displays the time that has been synchronized with the master device and is being
PTP Time
propagated to the slave devices.
Displays whether or not the Ethernet link is detected. The PTP Port is always
PTP Port
Ethernet Port 2 on the modem.
Bottom
Displays the presumed time for the modem. While the PTP time depends on the
RTV Time
Grandmaster device, the RTC Time changes only when set by the user.

657

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.3.11.2 Configuration | ANT | SNTP (Simple Network Timing Protocol)

Sect. 16.7.1 Simple Network Timing Protocol (SNTP) (Chapter 16. ETHERNET
NETWORK MANAGEMENT)

Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) is used to synchronize computer clocks throughout a
computer network when the ultimate performance of the full NTP implementation as per
RFC-1305 (Requests for Comment No. 1305: Network Time Protocol, Version 3, Specification,
Implementation and Analysis) is not needed or justified.

F
i
g
u
r
e

6
-
3
1
.
Configuration | ANT | SNTP page

SNTP
Primary / Backup Ethernet Time Server Enter the desired Time Servers IP Address in the
form XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX.

Last Update This read-only field displays the time and date that the selected server was
last updated. The time in shown military format (HH:MM:SS); the date is shown in DAY-
MONTH-YEAR format in accordance with European convention. This line specifies Never if
no update information exists.

Feature Use the drop-down list to select SNTP as Disabled or Enabled.

Click [Submit] to save these settings.

Date and Time


Enter a time using HH:MM:SS format
(where HH = hour [00 to 23], MM = minutes [00 to 59], and SS = seconds [00 to 59]).

Enter a date using DD/MM/YY format


(where DD = day [01 to 31], MM = month [01 to 12], and YY = year [00 to 99]).

Click [Enter Date/Time] once you set the desired date and time.

658

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.3.12 Configuration | MEO (Mid-Earth Orbit)

MEO is non-functional when the optional CnC card is installed.

Figure 6-32. Configuration | ANT | SNTP page


CDM-625 modems are configurable for continuous pairing as Primary and non-Primary Modems
in an Antenna Handover System when the MEO (Medium Earth Orbit) feature is enabled.
Ethernet data traffic is transmitted and received via the Primary and Non-Primary CDM-625s
four 10/100 Ethernet ports. The Antenna Handover signal received from the user-provided IF/RF
switch determines which modem is the ONLINE or OFFLINE unit:

The ONLINE unit transmits traffic only to the WAN side while, at the same time, the
OFFLINE units Tx is muted.

Both the ONLINE and OFFLINE units receive the satellite traffic, but only the ONLINE unit
forwards traffic to the LAN side while the OFFLINE unit drops the packets.

Any time a unit switches from the OFFLINE to ONLINE state, the traffic destined for the
WAN is buffered, preconfigured in milliseconds (base modem Antenna Handover
delay).

MEO
Use the drop-down list to select the MEO Feature operation as Disabled or Enabled, and then
click [Submit] to save this setting.

Antenna Handover
Feature Use the drop-down list to select the Antenna Handover Feature operation as
Disabled or Enabled.

Mode Use the drop-down list to select the enabled Antenna Handover Feature switching
operation as Manual or Automatic.

Differential Path Delay Enter a DPD limit value from -30 to +30.

659

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

Click [Submit] to save these settings.

6.5.4.4 Status Pages


The Status pages provide you with status, event logging, and operational statistics windows.
Click the Modem Status, Modem Logs, Modem Info, Traffic Statistics, or when the optional IP
Packet Processor card is installed and enabled the Performance tab to continue.

6.5.4.4.1 Status | Modem Status


Use this page to view read-only status window pertaining to:
Alarms Rx Parameters AUPC

CnC (Carrier-in-Carrier) ACM General Status

Fractional CnC Counters

Figure 6-33. Status | Modem Status page

660

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.4.2 Status | Modem Logs

Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION

Click the Base Modem tab, or when the optional IP Packet Processor card is installed and
enabled the Packet Processor tab to continue.

6.5.4.4.2.1 Status | Modem Logs | Base Modem


Use this page to control how the fault, statistics, and alarm masking parameters are processed
by the unit.

Figure 6-34. Status | Modem Logs | Base Modem page

Events Log
Read Next Five Events Click to buffer the next group of five stored events into the
scrollable events window.

Clear Events Log Click to wipe clean the stored events log.

661

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

Initialize Events Pointer Click to reset the logs internal pointer.

Unread Events Displays the total number of unread stored events in the scrollable events
window. As stored event groups are displayed, this number decrements accordingly.

Click [Submit] to save these settings.

Statistics Log
Read Next Five Statistics Click to buffer the next group of five stored events into the
scrollable statistics window.

Clear Statistics Log Click to wipe clean the stored statistics log.

Initialize Statistics Pointer Click to reset the logs internal pointer.

Unread Statistics Displays the total number of unread stored statistics in the scrollable
statistics window. As stored statistics are displayed, this number decrements accordingly.

Click [Submit] to save these settings.

Alarm Mask
Use the option buttons provided to define a designated alarm as Masked or Active, and then
click [Submit Alarm Mask] to save these changes.

662

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.4.2.2 Status | Modem Logs | Packet Processor


This nested page is accessible only to Admin users and when the optional IP Packet
Processor card is installed and enabled. See Sect. 6.5.3.1 for complete details about
using conditional access pages.

This page provides you with a scrollable window showing the optional IP Packet Processors
cumulative events, plus control over what information is displayed for IP Packet Processor
operations.

Figure 6-35. Status | Modem Logs | Packet Processor page

Event Logging
The Event Log can display a maximum of 256 events. Each event is assigned a sequential Index
number; its type, the date and time of occurrence, and a description of the event follows.

Logging On/Off Select event logging as On or Off.

Logging Level Use the drop-down list to select the type of information displayed in the log:
Errors Only, Errors and Warnings, or All Information.

Click [Submit] once the desired settings have been entered in this section.

Clear Event Log


Scroll through the Event Log as needed, and then click [Clear Log] to wipe the log clean. The
table will reset to a single event description Event log cleared.

663

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.4.3 Status | Modem Info


Use this page to view read-only information about the currently configured modem:
General Information
Equipment ID
Scrollable windows listing Installed Options and available Options Not Installed

Figure 6-36. Status | Modem Info page

664

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.4.4 Status | Traffic Statistics Pages


Click the Ethernet, WAN, or Clear Counters tab and, when the optional IP Packet Processor
card is installed and enabled the Router, Managed Switch, WAN, Compression, QoS, PTP,
MAC Table, or Clear Counters tab to continue.

6.5.4.4.4.1 Status | Traffic Statistics | Ethernet


Use this page to view Ethernet Ingress/Egress Statistics on a Per Port basis.

Figure 6-37. Status | Traffic Statistics | Ethernet page


Click [Clear Statistics] to clear all Ethernet statistics from the buffer.

Click [Refresh] to update the page with the latest available statistics.

665

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.4.4.2 Status | Traffic Statistics | Router


This nested page is accessible only to Admin users and when the optional IP Packet
Processor card is installed and enabled. See Sect. 6.5.3.1 for complete details about
using conditional access pages.

Use this page to view cumulative router traffic information.

Figure 6-38. Status | Traffic Statistics | Router page

Clear Statistics
Click [Clear] to clear all router statistics from the buffer.

Click [Refresh] to update the page with the latest available statistics.

666

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.4.4.3 Status | Traffic Statistics | Managed Switch


This n ested p age i s accessible o nly to A dmin u sers a nd w hen th e optional I P
Packet Processor ca rd is installed and enabled. See Sect. 6.5.3.1 for complete
details about using conditional access pages.

Use this page to view cumulative Managed Switch traffic information.

Figure 6-39. Status | Traffic Statistics | Managed Switch page

Clear Statistics
Click [Clear] to clear all Managed Switch statistics from the buffer.

Click [Refresh] to update the page with the latest available statistics.

667

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.4.4.4 Status | Traffic Statistics | WAN


This p age a ppearance is d ependent o n w hether th e o ptional I P Packet
Processor c ard i s not installed / installed but disabled or if it is installed and
enabled. See S ect. 6.5.3.1 for complete details about using conditional a ccess
pages.

Use this page to view cumulative WAN traffic information.

Figure 6-40. Status | Traffic Statistics | WAN page


(Top) Page when optional IP Packet Processor is either not installed or installed but disabled
(Bottom) Page when optional IP Packet Processor is installed and enabled

668

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

For either page version, note the following:

Clear Statistics / WAN Statistics


Click [Clear] or [Clear Statistics] to clear all WAN statistics from the buffer.

Click [Refresh] to update the page with the latest available statistics.

6.5.4.4.4.5 Status | Traffic Statistics | Compression


This n ested p age i s accessible o nly to A dmin u sers a nd w hen th e optional I P
Packet Processor ca rd is installed and enabled. See Sect. 6.5.3.1 for complete
details about using conditional access pages.

Use this page to view cumulative Header Compression and Payload Compression statistics.

Figure 6-41. Status | Traffic Statistics | Compression page

Clear Compression Counters


Click [Clear] to clear all compression statistics from the buffer.

Click [Refresh] to update the page with the latest available statistics.

669

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.4.4.6 Status | Traffic Statistics | QoS


This nested page is accessible only to Admin users and when the optional IP Packet
Processor card is installed and enabled. See Sect. 6.5.3.1 for complete details about
using conditional access pages.

Use this page to view cumulative Quality of Service information.

Figure 6-42. Status | Traffic Statistics | QoS page (DiffServ Mode)

Clear QoS Counters


Click [Clear] to clear all QoS statistics from the buffer.

Click [Refresh] to update the page with the latest available statistics.

670

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.4.4.7 Status | Traffic Statistics | PTP

Sect. 16.7.2 Precision Time Protocol (PTP) (Chapter 16. ETHERNET NETWORK
MANAGEMENT)

Use this page to obtain data intended to troubleshoot PTP operational issues.

Figure 6-43. Status | Traffic Statistics | PTP page

PTP Status
Click [Refresh] to update this section with its most recently accumulated statistics.

These status parameters are read-only and cannot be changed. Note the following:
Row Title Description
PTP Engine Specifies whether or not PTP is actively attempting to synchronize time.
Top Displays the time that has been synchronized with the master device and is being
PTP Time
propagated to the slave devices.
Displays whether or not the Ethernet link is detected. The PTP Port is always
PTP Port
Ethernet Port 2 on the modem.
Bottom
Displays the presumed time for the modem. While the PTP time depends on the
RTV Time
Grandmaster device, the RTC Time changes only when set by the user.

671

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

PTP Statistics
Click [Refresh] to update the page with the latest available statistics.

Click [Clear] to clear all PTP statistics from the buffer.

This statistics table breaks down the number of PTP packets sent or received on the WAN and
LAN ports as follows:
Row Description (LAN/WAN Rx/Tx Columns)
Event Port Number of packets (PTP or other) received on the PTP UDP event-message port.
General Port Number of packets (PTP or other) received on the PTP UDP general-message port.
Announce Number of PTP announce messages received from another PTP device.
Sync Number of synchronization messages received from a master PTP device.
Followup Number of follow-up messages received from a 2-step-clock master PTP device.
Delay Req Number of Delay Request messages received from a slave device.
Delay Resp Number of Delay Response messages sent to a slave device.
Mgmt Number of PTP management messages received by the modem.
Signal Number of PTP signaling messages received by the modem.
Total number of PTP packets discarded by the modem.
Discarded
Note: Some discarded messages are normal. For example, if the modem receives
a PTP message while it is configuring its PTP port, it will discard that message.
2. PTP Master Devices send Announce, Sync, Followup, and Delay Response
messages, while PTP Slave Devices send Delay Request messages.

3. PTP is a UDP multicast protocol. When negotiating with devices over the
LAN interface, the modem uses UDP Port 319 for events, and UDP Port 320
for general packets. On the WAN interface, the modem uses UDP Port 59319
for events, and UDP Port 59320 for general packets.

672

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.4.4.8 Status | Traffic Statistics | MAC Table


Use this page to view and refresh the MAC Addresses that the modem has discovered on one or
more of its Ethernet switch ports.

Figure 6-44. Status | Traffic Statistics | MAC Table page

MAC Table
Click [Refresh] to update the page with the latest discovered MAC Addresses.

From left to right, note the following:


Column Description
MAC The MAC Address of the device on LAN/WAN
DBNum Database number (always zero)
CPU Port connected to the modems M&C Management Port
P4 User Traffic Port #4
P3 User Traffic Port #3
P2 User Traffic Port #2
P1 User Traffic Port #1
WAN Packets going into WAN (when the IP Packet Processor is installed and enabled)
Type Identifies the MAC address as Static or Dynamic

673

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.4.4.9 Status | Traffic Statistics | Clear Counters


Use this page to clear and reset the counters for all Traffic Statistics pages (Ethernet, and when
applicable, Router, Managed Switch, WAN, Compression, and QoS).

Figure 6-45. Status | Traffic Statistics | Clear Counters page

Clear All Counters


Click [Clear] to globally clear and reset the Traffic Statistics counters.

674

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.4.5 Status | Performance Pages


These pages are available only when the optional IP Packet Processor card is
installed and enabled. See Sect. 6.5.3.1 for complete details about using these
conditional access pages.

Click the Performance or Graphs tab to continue.

6.5.4.4.5.1 Status | Performance | Performance


Use this page to view a tabulated snapshot of the CDM-625 performance statistics.

Figure 6-46. Status | Performance | Performance page

CPU Usage

Component % CPU Description


The percentage of CPU time used by the packet-processing components of
Kernel
the module.
Applications The percentage of CPU time used by the management interfaces.
Total Cumulative percentage of Kernel and Applications components.

At present, CPU Usage (%) is the only viewable parameter; more functionality will
be selectable in future firmware releases.

675

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.4.5.2 Status | Performance | Graphs

Figure 6-47. Status | Performance | Graphs page


Use this page to view a graphical representation of the CDM-625 performance. The displayed
graphs automatically update in real time.

Typical for both line graph types, the X-axis denotes elapsed time; the Y-axis denotes
performance, in percent. Either graph scrolls from right to left as viewing time increments.

Click [Add Big] to display a line graph with an extended scale Y-axis.

Click [Add Small] to display a line graph with a compressed scale Y-axis.

For either line graph, use the component check box, located to the right of each graph, to select
that graphs viewable parameter. The line graph will update to incorporate performance
tracking for that item.

At present, CPU Usage (%) is the only selectable parameter; more functionality
will be available in future firmware releases.

Each new graph is added to the bottom of the scrollable page. Any combination of graph types
may be displayed on this page. Click [Remove] to delete the bottom-most graph from the page.

676

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.5 ODU (Outdoor Unit) Pages (Summary Only)


1. After enabling ODU Comms and configuring the CDM-625 for 70/140 MHz
operation, you may use the ODU (Outdoor Unit) pages to control and monitor
the CSAT-5060 or KST-2000A/B Outdoor Unit that is connected via FSK to the
CDM-625.

2. The Comtech EF Data LPOD Amplifier / Block Up Converter is not supported by


the CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface at this time.

See Appendix F. CDM-625 ODU (TRANSCEIVER, BUC, LNB) Operation for complete
details on using the Web Server Interface for ODU operations.

Figure 6-48. ODU Page Examples (Enable, Config, Status, and Utilities)

677

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

6.5.4.6 Redundancy page


Take note of the following redundant switch information, as it pertains to IP
Packet Processor Redundancy:

1:1 Redundancy is supported using either a CRS-170A L-Band 1:1


Redundancy Switch or a CRS-180 70/140 MHz 1:1 Redundancy Switch, and
a user-provided, off-the-shelf Ethernet switch.

1:N Redundancy is supported using a CRS-300 1:10 Redundancy Switch or a


CRS-500 M:N Redundancy System in 1:N mode based on the following
criteria:

Redundancy Device Packet Processor Terrestrial Interface Mode


CRS-300 Disabled Any Any
EIA-422/530, V.35,
Disabled Any
CRS-500 Sync EIA-232
Enabled Ethernet L3 or Bridge

Packet Processor Redundancy is supported in both 1:1 and 1:N redundant


configurations using the CRS-500 M:N Redundancy System.

Refer to the pertinent switch Installation and Operation Manuals for detailed
information on using the CDM-625 in a redundancy configuration.

Figure 6-49. Redundancy page

Redundancy Config
Redundancy Traffic IP Address Enter the IP Address and subnet mask in the form
XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX/YY.

678

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

The Redundancy Traffic IP Address and subnet mask is different from the
Traffic/Management IP Address and subnet mask that is defined on the
Configuration | LAN | IP page (Sect. 6.5.4.3.2.1).

1: N Mode (use with CAUTION!) Use the drop-down list to set 1:N Redundancy mode as
Disabled or Enabled.

Packet Processor Redundancy When the optional IP Packet Processor card is installed and
enabled in a 1:1 redundancy configuration (i.e., both the traffic and backup modems are
equipped with the optional IP Packet Processor and are connected to a CRS-170A L-Band or
CRS-180 70/140 MHz 1:1 Redundancy Switch), there is no need to use the drop-down list
here, as Packet Processor Redundancy is enabled automatically.

If it is desired to operate either modem outside of the redundant setup as a standalone unit, use
the drop-down list to select Packet Processor Redundancy for that specific modem as Disabled.

Click [Submit] to save these settings.

Force 1:1 switch (Only applies to Online modem)


When redundant modems are used and the selected unit is currently the Online unit, click
[Force 1:1 Switch] to force a switchover so the unit will then be in Offline (standby) mode. The
command is only valid for the Online unit in a 1:1 pair.

Redundancy Monitor
Monitoring of the redundancy setup both the status of the active modem (i.e., Online or
Offline) and the detected presence of a redundancy switch is provided in this read-only
section. Click [Refresh] to manually update this page section.

679

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet-based Remote Product Management MN-CDM625

Notes:

680

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


Chapter 7. FORWARD ERROR
CORRECTION OPTIONS
7.1 Introduction
As standard, the CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem is equipped with four Forward Error
Correction encoders/decoders Viterbi, Sequential, concatenated Reed-Solomon and Trellis
(which is available with the 8-PSK FAST option). The constraint lengths and encoding
polynomials are not only Open Network compatible, but are also Closed Network compatible
with the vast majority of existing modems from other manufacturers. Comtech EF Data has
performed compatibility testing to ensure inter-operability.

Turbo Product Coding (TPC) and Low-Density Parity Check (LDPC) coding represent a very
significant development in the area of FEC. An option card, field upgradeable, combines LDPC
and TPC together on one module.

While the performance of LDPC is exceptional in terms of coding gain, its higher latency is
considered disadvantageous in some applications. For this reason, Comtech EF Data and
Comtech AHA have jointly developed a completely new family of short-block LDPC codes, which
we have called VersaFEC. (The name VersaFEC is a trademark registered to Comtech AHA.) It is
ideal for lower data rates that demand the shortest possible latency, and is available as a field
upgradeable option card.

VersaFEC represents the best Forward Error Correction technology currently available, and is
offered with a sufficient range of code rates and modulation types that link performance can be
optimized under almost any conditions.

7.2 Viterbi
The combination of convolutional coding and Viterbi decoding has become an almost universal
standard for satellite communications. The CDM-625 complies with the Intelsat IESS 308/309
standards for Viterbi decoding with a constraint length of seven. This is a de facto standard,
even in a closed network environment, which means almost-guaranteed interoperability with
other manufacturers equipment. It provides very useful levels of coding gain, and its short
decoding delay and error-burst characteristics make it particularly suitable for low data rate
coded voice applications. It has a short constraint length, fixed at 7, for all code rates. (The

71

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

constraint length is defined as the number of output symbols from the encoder that are affected
by a single input bit.)

By choosing various coding rates (Rate 1/2, 3/4 or 7/8) the user can trade off coding gain for
bandwidth expansion. Rate 1/2 coding gives the best improvement in error rate, but doubles
the transmitted data rate, and hence doubles the occupied bandwidth of the signal. Rate 7/8
coding, at the other extreme, provides the most modest improvement in performance, but only
expands the transmitted bandwidth by 14%.

A major advantage of the Viterbi decoding method is that the performance is independent of
data rate, and does not display a pronounced threshold effect (i.e., does not fail rapidly below a
certain value of Eb/No). Note that, in BPSK mode, the CDM-625 only permits a coding rate of
1/2. Because the method of convolutional coding used with Viterbi, the encoder does not
preserve the original data intact, and is called non-systematic.

Table 7-1. Viterbi Decoding Summary


FOR AGAINST
Good BER performance very useful coding gain.
Almost universally used, with de facto standards for
constraint length and coding polynomials.
Shortest decoding delay (~100 bits) of any FEC
scheme good for coded voice, VOIP, etc. Higher coding gain possible with other methods.
Short constraint length produce small error bursts
good for coded voice.
No pronounced threshold effect fails gracefully.
Coding gain independent of data rate.

7.3 Sequential
Although the method of convolutional coding and Sequential decoding appears to be very similar
to the Viterbi method, there are some fundamental differences. To begin with, the convolutional
encoder is said to be systematic it does not alter the input data, and the FEC overhead bits are
simply appended to the data. Furthermore, the constraint length k is much longer (Rate 1/2, k=36.
Rate 3/4, k= 63. Rate 7/8, k=87). This means that, when the decoding process fails (i.e., when its
capacity to correct errors is exceeded), it produces a burst of errors which is in multiples of half
the constraint length. An error distribution is produced which is markedly different to that of a
Viterbi decoder; this gives rise to a pronounced threshold effect.

A Sequential decoder does not fail gracefully a reduction in Eb/No of just a few tenths of a dB
can make the difference between acceptable BER and a complete loss of synchronization. The
decoding algorithm itself, called the Fano algorithm, uses significantly more path memory 4 kbps
in this case than the equivalent Viterbi decoder, giving rise to increased latency. Furthermore, a
fixed computational clock is used to process input symbols and to search backwards and forwards
in time to determine the correct decoding path.

72

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

At lower data rates there are sufficient number of computational cycles per input symbol to
permit the decoding process to perform optimally. However, as the data rate increases, there are
fewer cycles available, leading to a reduction in coding gain. This is clearly illustrated in the
performance curves that follow. For data rates above ~1 Mbps, Viterbi should be considered the
better alternative; the practical upper limit in this implementation is 2.048 Mbps.
Table 7-2. Sequential Decoding Summary
FOR AGAINST
Pronounced t hreshold ef fect does not f ail gr ace-fully i n
poor Eb/No conditions.
Higher coding gain (1-2 dB) at lower data rates, Higher processing delay than Viterbi (~4 k bits) not good
compared to Viterbi. for low-rate coded voice.
Upper data rate limit 2.048Mbps
Coding gain varies with data rate favors lower data rates.

7.4 Reed-Solomon Outer Codec


The concatenation of an outer Reed-Solomon (R-S) Codec with Viterbi decoder first became popular
when it was introduced by Intelsat in the early 1990s. It permits significant improvements in error
performance without significant bandwidth expansion. The coding overhead added by the R-S outer
Codec is typically around 10%, which translates to a 0.4 dB power penalty for a given link.

Reed-Solomon codes are block codes as opposed to Viterbi, which is convolutional; in order to
be processed correctly, the data must be framed and de-framed. Additionally, R-S codes are
limited in how well they can correct errors that occur in bursts. This, unfortunately, is the nature
of the uncorrected errors from Viterbi decoders, which produce clusters of errors that are
multiples of half the constraint length. For this reason, the data must be interleaved following R-
S encoding, and is then de-interleaved prior to decoding. This ensures that a single burst of
errors leaving the Viterbi or Sequential decoder is spread out over a number of interleaving
frames, so errors entering the R-S decoder do not exceed its capacity to correct those errors. In
the case of the CDM-625, different R-S code rates are used according to the mode of operation:
Closed Network Modes and Open Network Modes.

7.4.1 Closed Network Modes


A 220,200 code is used in transparent closed network modes, and a 200,180 code is used in
framed (EDMAC) modes. (220,200 means that data is put into blocks of 220 bytes, of which 200
bytes are data, and 20 bytes are FEC overhead.) These two codes were chosen because they fit
well into Comtech EF Datas clock generation scheme, and they have almost identical coding
gain. There is also a 225, 205 code available that it compatible with legacy EF Data modems.
When Viterbi decoding is used as the primary FEC, an interleaver depth of 4 is used. The
increase in coding gain is at the expense of delay. The interleaving/de-interleaving delay and the
delay through the decoder itself can be as high as 25 kbits. At very low data rates, this equates
to several seconds, making it highly unsuitable for voice applications. Additionally, the de-
interleaver frame synchronization method can add significantly to the time taken for the
demodulator to declare acquisition.

73

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

7.4.2 Open Network Modes


Code Rate Mode
219, 201 Standard IESS-308 E1, and IESS-310 mode
225, 205 Standard IESS-308 T1
194, 178 Standard IESS-308 T2/E2
126, 112 Standard IESS-309 modes

A characteristic of concatenated R-S coding is the very pronounced threshold effect. For any
given modem design, there will be a threshold value of Eb/No below which the demodulator
cannot stay synchronized. This may be due to the carrier-recovery circuits, or the
synchronization threshold of the primary FEC device, or both. In the CDM-625, and Rate 1/2
operation, this threshold is around 4 dB Eb/No. Below this value, operation is not possible, but
above this value, the error performance of the concatenated R-S system produces exceptionally
low error rates for a very small increase in Eb/No.

Care should be taken not to operate the demodulator near its sync threshold. Small
fluctuations in Eb/No may cause total loss of the link, with the subsequent need for
the demodulator to re-acquire the signal.
Table 7-3. Concatenated RS Coding Summary
FOR AGAINST
Exceptionally good BER performance several Very pronounced threshold effect does not fail
orders of magnitude improvement in link BER gracefully in poor Eb/No conditions. Additional
under given link conditions coding overhead actually degrades sync
threshold, and reduces link fade margin.
Very small additional bandwidth expansion. Significant processing delay (~25 kbps) not
good for voice or IP applications.
Adds to demod acquisition time.

7.5 Trellis Coding (FAST Option)


In the other FEC methods described here, the processes of coding and modulation are
independent the FEC codec has no knowledge of, or interaction with the modulator. However,
there are schemes in which the coding and modulation are combined together, where the
encoder places FEC symbols in a precise manner into the signal constellation. This can yield an
overall improvement in performance, and is used in higher-order modulation schemes, such as
8-PSK, 16-PSK, 16-QAM, etc.

When convolution coding is used, the overall coded modulation approach is referred to as Trellis
Coded Modulation (TCM). Ungerboeck was an early pioneer and developed optimum mapping
and decoding schemes. However, the decoding scheme was seen as complex and expensive, and
Qualcomm Inc. developed a variation on the theme that uses a Viterbi decoder at the core,
surrounded by adjunct processing. The scheme, called pragmatic Trellis Coded Modulation, is able
to achieve performance very close to the optimum Ungerboeck method, but with far less
complexity.

74

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

As more and more high power transponders are put in to service, Intelsat recognized that the
transponders are no longer power limited, but bandwidth limited. In order to maximize
transponder capacity, 8-PSK was looked at as a method of reducing the occupied bandwidth of a
carrier, and Qualcomms pragmatic TCM, at Rate 2/3, was adopted.

A Rate 2/3 8-PSK/TCM carrier occupies only 50% of the bandwidth of a Rate 1/2 QPSK carrier.
However, the overall coding gain of the scheme is not adequate by itself, so Intelsats IESS-310
specification requires that the scheme be concatenated with an outer RS codec. When
combined, there is a threshold value of Eb/No of around 6 dB and, above approximately 7 dB,
the bit error rate is better than 1 x 10-8.

The detractions of the concatenated RS approach apply here also, along with more stringent
requirements for phase noise and group delay distortion the natural consequences of the
higher-order modulation.

The CDM-625 fully implements the IESS-310 specification at data rates up to 20 Mbps. In
accordance with the specification, the R-S outer code can be disabled. Performance curves for
both cases are shown in the following figures.
Table 7-4. 8-PSK/TCM Coding Summary
FOR AGAINST
Needs c oncatenated R S out er codec t o give ac ceptable
coding gain performance.
Exceptionally bandwidth efficient compared to
Demod acquisition threshold much higher than for QPSK.
QPSK.
8-PSK is m ore s ensitive t o phas e noi se and gr oup del ay
distortion than QPSK.

7.6 Turbo Product Codec (Hardware Option)


Turbo coding is an FEC technique developed within the last few years, which delivers significant
performance improvements compared to more traditional techniques. Two general classes of
Turbo Codes have been developed, Turbo Convolutional Codes (TCC), and Turbo Product Codes
(TPC, a block coding technique). Comtech EF Data has chosen to implement an FEC codec based
on TPC. A Turbo Product Code is a 2 or 3 dimensional array of block codes. Encoding is relatively
straightforward, but decoding is a very complex process requiring multiple iterations of
processing for maximum performance to be achieved.

Unlike the popular method of concatenating an R-S codec with a primary FEC codec, Turbo
Product Coding is an entirely stand-alone method. It does not require the complex interleaving/
de-interleaving of the R-S approach, and consequently, decoding delays are significantly
reduced. Furthermore, the traditional concatenated R-S schemes exhibit a very pronounced
threshold effect a small reduction in Eb/No can result in total loss of demod and decoder
synchronization. TPC does not suffer from this problem the demod and decoder remain
synchronized down to the point where the output error rate becomes unusable. This is
considered to be a particularly advantageous characteristic in a fading environment. Typically, in
QPSK, 8-PSK and 16-QAM TPC modes the demod and decoder can remain synchronized 2 3 dB
below the Viterbi/Reed-Solomon or TCM cases.

75

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

7.7 TPC and Low Density Parity Check (LDPC) coding

7.7.1 Introduction
In the past few years there has been an unprecedented resurgence in interest in Forward Error
Correction (FEC) technology. The start of this new interest has its origins in the work done by
Claude Berrou et al, and the 1993 landmark paper, Near Shannon Limit Error Correcting Coding
and Decoding Turbo Codes. FEC is considered an essential component in all wireless and
satellite communications in order to reduce the power and bandwidth requirements for reliable
data transmission.

Claude Shannon, considered by many to be the father of modern communications theory, first
established the concept of Channel Capacity in his 1948 paper A Mathematical Theory of
Communication. This places an absolute limit on how fast it is possible to transmit error-free
data within a channel of a given bandwidth, and with given noise conditions within that channel.
He concluded that it would only be possible to approach this limit through the use of source
encoding what is familiar today as Forward Error Correction.

Shannon postulated that if it were possible to store every possible message in the receiver,
finding the stored message that most closely matched the incoming message would yield an
optimum decoding method. However, for all but the shortest bit sequences, the memory
required for this, and the time taken to perform the comparisons, makes this approach
impractical. For all practical purposes, the memory requirement and the decoding latency
become infinite.

For many years, there were few advances in the quest to approach the Shannon Limit. The
Viterbi algorithm heralded a major step forward, followed in the early 1990s by the
concatenation of a Viterbi decoder with Reed-Solomon hard-decision block codes. It remained
clear, however, that the Shannon Limit was still an elusive target.

Berrous work on Turbo Codes showed, through the use of an ingeniously simple approach
(multiple, or iterative decoding passes) that it is possible to achieve performance close to the
Shannon Limit. Berrous early work dealt exclusively with iteratively-decoded convolutional
codes (Turbo Convolutional Coding, or TCC), but in time the iterative approach was applied to a
particular class of block codes called Product Codes hence Turbo Product Coding (TPC). TPC
exhibits inherently low decoding latency compared with TCC, and so is considered much more
desirable for 2-way, interactive satellite communications applications.

In August 1999, Comtech became the first company in the world to offer satellite modems that
incorporate TPC. Since its inception, Comtech has continued to develop and refine its
implementation of TPC in its products, and now offers a comprehensive range of code rates
(from Rate 5/16 to Rate 0.95) and modulations (from BPSK to 16-QAM). However, in the past
few years, as part of the general interest in Turbo coding, a third class of Turbo coding has
emerged: Low Density Parity Check Codes (LDPC).

LDPC is more like TPC than TCC in that it is an iteratively-decoded block code. Gallager first
suggested this in 1962 but, at the time, the implementation complexity was considered to be

76

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

too great; for decades, it remained of purely academic interest. Further interest in LDPC was
stimulated in 2003, when the Digital Video Broadcasting (DVB) committee adopted LDPC codes
(proposed by Hughes Network Systems) as the basis for the new DVB-S2 standard. Now,
however, with silicon gates being cheap, plentiful and fast, an LDPC decoder can easily be
accommodated in a large Field Programmable Gate Array (FPGA) device.

The LDPC method on its own produces an undesirable flaring in the Bit Error Rate (BER) vs.
Eb/No characteristic, and for this reason it is desirable to concatenate a short BCH code with
LDPC. This concatenation produces almost vertical BER vs. Eb/No curves, as can be seen in the
performance graphs that are presented later. In order to take full advantage of the coding gain
increase that LDPC provides, it became necessary to find an alternative to 8-PSK. Comtech EF
Data has therefore developed an 8-QAM approach that permits acquisition and tracking at much
lower values of Eb/No than 8-PSK. Comtechs implementation of 8-QAM is the subject of a U.S.
Patent, granted in 2007.

Comtech EF Data chose the CDM-600 platform as the first satellite modem in which to
implement both LDPC and 8-QAM, and the CDM-625 includes a newer technology version of the
original design.

7.7.2 LDPC versus TPC


Is LDPC better than TPC? The answer must be sometimes, but not always, and there are issues
such as latency that must be taken into consideration. Figure 7-1 graphs the performance of
various TPC and LDPC modes relative to the Shannon Limit the Channel Capacity is shown for
both QPSK and 8-PSK. Error free transmission is not possible for values of spectral efficiency
(capacity) vs. Eb/No above these limit curves. The horizontal distance to the limit provides a
metric of overall performance.

It can be seen from this graph that, for Code Rates above 3/4, Comtechs TPCs are very close
(1-1.5 dB) to the Shannon Limit. However, at 3/4 and below, LDPCs are performing 0.7-1.2 dB
better than TPCs.

Figure 7-1. TPC & LDPC Modes Performance (Relative to Shannon Limit)

77

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

It is clear that, in order to provide the best possible performance over the range of code rates
from 1/2 to 0.95, both an LDPC and a TPC codec need to be offered.

In order to meet this requirement, Comtech EF Data has developed a combination LDPC/TPC
Codec module that can be added to the CDM-625 Modem. Table 7-5 outlines the operating
modes provided by this module.
Table 7-5. Available TPC/ LDPC Modes
Lower Data Rate Limit Upper Data Rate Limit
Mode Code Rate/Modulation
(kbps) (kbps)
TPC Rate 21/44 BPSK (aka 1/2) 18.0 5965.9
Rate 5/16 BPSK 18.0 3906.2
Rate 21/44 QPSK, OQPSK (aka 1/2) 18.0 11931.8
Rate 3/4 QPSK, OQPSK 27.0 18750.0
Rate 3/4 8-PSK , 8-QAM 40.0 25000.0
Rate 3/4 16-QAM 54.0 25000.0
Rate 7/8 QPSK, OQPSK 31.5 21875.0
Rate 7/8 8-PSK , 8-QAM 48.0 25000.0
Rate 7/8 16-QAM 63.0 25000.0
Rate 0.95 QPSK, OQPSK (aka 17/18) 34.2 23611.1
Rate 0.95 8-PSK , 8-QAM (aka 17/18) 52.0 25000.0
LDPC Rate 1/2 BPSK 18.0 6250.0
Rate 1/2 QPSK, OQPSK 18.0 12500.0
Rate 2/3 QPSK, OQPSK 24.0 16666.6
Rate 2/3 8-PSK , 8-QAM 36.0 25000.0
Rate 3/4 QPSK, OQPSK 27.0 18750.0
Rate 3/4 8-PSK , 8-QAM 40.5 25000.0
Rate 3/4 16-QAM 54.0 25000.0

This LDPC/TPC codec module may be installed in any existing CDM-625 as a simple field
upgrade, or it can be pre-installed in new modems ordered from the factory. It also requires the
appropriate FAST codes for enabling operation beyond the base data rate limit of 5 Mbps.

Contact a Comtech EF Data Sales representative during normal business hours for pricing and
delivery information.

Table 7-6 compares all TPC and LDPC modes available in Comtech EF Datas CDM-625, and
shows Eb/No performance and spectral efficiency (occupied bandwidth) for each case. This
information will be of particular interest to satellite operators wishing to simultaneously balance
transponder power and bandwidth. The large number of modes offered will permit, in the
majority of cases, significant power and/or bandwidth savings when compared with existing
schemes such as concatenated Viterbi/Reed-Solomon, or the popular 8-PSK/Trellis/Reed-
Solomon (Intelsat IESS-310).

78

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

Table 7-6. Comparison of all Comtech EF Data TPC/LDPC Modes (CDM-625 with
TPC/LDPC Codec)
Eb/No at Eb/No at Spectral Occupied *
Mode BER = 10-6 BER = 10-8 Efficiency Symbol Rate Bandwidth for
(typical) (typical) (bps per Hz) 1 Mbps Carrier
QPSK Rate 1/2 Viterbi ** 5.5 dB 6.8 dB 1.00 bps/Hz 1.0 x bit rate 1190 kHz
BPSK Rate 1/2 LDPC 1.7 dB 1.9 dB 0.50 bps/Hz 2.0 x bit rate 2380 kHz
BPSK Rate 21/44 TPC 2.8 dB 3.0 dB 0.48 bps/Hz 2.1 x bit rate 2493 kHz
BPSK Rate 5/16 TPC 2.4 dB 3.0 dB 0.31 bps/Hz 3.2 x bit rate 3808 kHz
QPSK/OQPSK Rate 1/2 LDPC 1.7 dB 1.9 dB 1.00 bps/Hz 1.0 x bit rate 1190 kHz
QPSK/OQPSK Rate 21/44 TPC 2.8 dB 3.3 dB 0.96 bps/Hz 1.05 x bit rate 1246 kHz
QPSK/OQPSK Rate 2/3 LDPC 2.1 dB 2.4 dB 1.33 bps/Hz 0.75 x bit rate 892 kHz
QPSK/OQPSK Rate 3/4 LDPC 2.7 dB 2.9 dB 1.50 bps/Hz 0.67 x bit rate 793 kHz
QPSK/OQPSK Rate 3/4 TPC 3.4 dB 4.0 dB 1.50 bps/Hz 0.67 x bit rate 793 kHz
QPSK/OQSK Rate 7/8 TPC 4.2 dB 4.3 dB 1.75 bps/Hz 0.57 x bit rate 678 kHz
QPSK/OQPSK Rate 0.95 TPC 6.0 dB 6.5 dB 1.90 bps/Hz 0.53 x bit rate 626 kHz
8-PSK Rate 2/3 TCM **
5.6 dB 6.2 dB 1.82 bps/Hz 0.56 x bit rate 666 kHz
and RS (IESS-310)
8-QAM Rate 2/3 LDPC 4.3 dB 4.6 dB 2.00 bps/Hz 0.50 x bit rate 595 kHz
8-QAM Rate 3/4 LDPC 5.3 dB 5.5 dB 2.25 bps/Hz 0.44 x bit rate 529 kHz
8-PSK/8-QAM Rate 3/4 TPC 6.1 dB 6.7 dB 2.25 bps/Hz 0.44 x bit rate 529 kHz
8-PSK/8-QAM Rate 7/8 TPC 6.7 dB 6.9 dB 2.62 bps/Hz 0.38 x bit rate 453 kHz
8-PSK/8-QAM Rate 0.95 TPC 9.2 dB 10.2 dB 2.85 bps/Hz 0.35 x bit rate 377 kHz
16-QAM Rate 3/4 LDPC 6.7 dB 6.8 dB 3.00 bps/Hz 0.33 x bit rate 396 kHz
16-QAM Rate 3/4 TPC 7.4 dB 8.1 dB 3.00 bps/Hz 0.33 x bit rate 396 kHz
16-QAM Rate 7/8 TPC 7.9 dB 8.1 dB 3.50 bps/Hz 0.28 x bit rate 340 kHz
16-QAM Rate 3/4 **
7.5 dB 8.0 dB 2.73 bps/Hz 0.37 x bit rate 435 kHz
Viterbi/Reed-Solomon
16-QAM Rate 7/8 **
9.0 dB 9.5 dB 3.18 bps/Hz 0.31 x bit rate 374 kHz
Viterbi/Reed-Solomon

* The occupied bandwidth is defined at the width of the transmitted spectrum taken at the 10 dB points on t he plot of power
spectral density. This equates to 1.19 x symbol rate for the CDM-625 transmit filtering.

** Included for comparative purposes

79

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

7.7.3 End-to-End Processing Delay


In many cases, FEC methods that provide increased coding gain do so at the expense of
increased processing delay. However, with TPC, this increase in delay is very modest. Table 7-7
shows, for the CDM-625, the processing delays for the major FEC types, including the three TPC
modes.
Table 7-7. TPC/LDPC Processing Delay Comparison

FEC Mode (64 kbps data rate) End-to-end delay (ms)


Rate 1/2 9
Viterbi
Rate 1/2 + Reed Solomon 266
Rate 1/2 74
Sequential
Rate 1/2 + Reed Solomon 522
Rate 3/4 47
Rate 21/44 41
Turbo Product Coding Rate 5/16 69
Rate 7/8 245 *
Rate 0.95 69
Rate 1/2 198
Rate 2/3, O/QPSK 234
LDPC Coding
Rate 2/3, 8-PSK, 8-QAM 350
Rate 3/4, O/QPSK 248
Rate 3/4, 8-PSK, 8-QAM, 16-QAM 395

*A larger block is used for the Rate 7/8 code, which increases decoding delay.

Note that, in all cases, the delay is inversely proportional to data rate, so for 128 kbps, the delay
values would be half of those shown above. It can be seen that the concatenated Reed-Solomon
cases increase the delay significantly (due mainly to interleaving/de-interleaving), while the TPC
cases yield delays which are less than or equal to Sequential.

Table 7-8. TPC/LDPC Summary


FOR AGAINST
Exceptionally good B ER per formance significant improvement
compared with every other FEC method in use today.
Most m odes hav e n o pr onounced t hreshold ef fect fails
gracefully.
Exceptional bandwidth efficiency. Nothing!
Coding gain independent of data rate (in this implementation).
Low decoding delay for TPC.
Easy field upgrade in CDM-625.

710

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

7.8 VersaFEC (Short-block LDPC)


VersaFEC is a system of short-block LDPC codes that have been designed as a low-latency
alternative to both Comtechs existing LDPC codes, and to the system set forth in the DVB-S2
specification (EN 302307) ratified by ETSI.

Since the introduction of Comtechs LDPC, considerable research has been carried out to find
ways to reduce the block size of LDPC (and hence its latency) while preserving the coding gain
performance very close to the Shannon bound.

The set of VersaFEC codes was developed with two distinct purposes:

1) To provide an expanded choice of combinations of modulation and coding that maintain the
same coding gain performance as Comtechs existing LDPC, while significantly reducing
latency. The existing LDPC approach (and DVB-S2 short-block) uses blocks that are 16 kbits
in length. VersaFEC, on the other hand, uses block sizes that vary between 2k and 8.2 kbits,
and at the same time reduces latency still further through a novel design approach.

2) To provide combinations of modulation and coding (ModCods) that are suitable not only for
Constant Coding and Modulation (CCM) applications, but are also the basis for a patent-
pending Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM) system. The modulation types (BPSK, QPSK,
8-QAM and 16-QAM) and the code rates have been chosen to give a continuous progression
of performance in terms of both Eb/No and spectral efficiency an essential aspect of a well-
engineered ACM system. There are 12 ModCods in the VersaFEC set. For a detailed discussion
on ACM, see Chapter 17. ADAPTIVE CODING AND MODULATION (ACM).

Table 7-9. The VersaFEC ModCod set


Spectral Typical Latency at Min. Data Max. Data
Block size,
Modulation Code Rate efficiency, Eb/No, for 64 kbps, in Rate, Rate,
bits
bps/Hz BER = 5 x 10-8 milliseconds CCM mode CCM mode
BPSK 0.488 0.49 2k 2.4 dB 26 18 kbps 5.7 Mbps
QPSK 0.533 1.07 4.1k 2.2 dB 53 20 kbps 10 Mbps
QPSK 0.631 1.26 4.1k 2.7 dB 59 23 kbps 10 Mbps
QPSK 0.706 1.41 4.1k 3.4 dB 62 26 kbps 10 Mbps
QPSK 0.803 1.61 4.1k 3.8 dB 66 28 kbps 12 Mbps
8-QAM 0.642 1.93 6.1k 4.6 dB 89 35 kbps 12 Mbps
8-QAM 0.711 2.13 6.1k 5.2 dB 93 39 kbps 12 Mbps
8-QAM 0.780 2.34 6.1k 5.6 dB 97 43 kbps 12 Mbps
16-QAM 0.731 2.93 8.2k 6.3 dB 125 53 kbps 12 Mbps
16-QAM 0.780 3.12 8.2k 7.0 dB 129 57 kbps 14 Mbps
16-QAM 0.829 3.32 8.2k 7.5 dB 131 60 kbps 14 Mbps
16-QAM 0.853 3.41 8.2k 8.0 dB 132 62 kbps 16 Mbps

As a comparison, looking at LDPC Rate 2/3 8-QAM and VersaFEC Rate 0.642 8-QAM essentially
identical spectral efficiency and Eb/No performance. However, at 64 kbps, the latency has been
reduced from 350 milliseconds to 89 milliseconds a factor of 4 reduction.

711

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

The performance of the VersaFEC codes compared with the Shannon bound is shown in Figure 7-2.
This puts the performance of VersaFEC at or near the DVB-S2 performance with 16 kbit blocks.

Figure 7-2. VersaFEC Codes versus Shannon Capacity

Note that SNR is used in place of Eb/No a convention for comparing ACM ModCods. SNR is
defined as Eb/No + 10log(Spectral Efficiency).

VersaFEC requires both the correct hardware module (PL-0000264) to be installed


in the CDM-625 and Firmware Version 1.3.0 (or higher). ACM requires Firmware
Version 1.4.0 (or higher).

712

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

7.8.1 VersaFEC Extensions

VersaFEC Extensions require Firmware Version 1.5.4 (or higher)

7.8.1.1 Extended CCM Codes


In Firmware Version 1.5.4 and later, two additional rates have been added to the VersaFEC
family of codes. Note that these are CCM (Constant Coding and Modulation) only they are NOT
included in the ACM set of ModCods.

These two new codes (Rate 0.576 8-QAM and Rate 0.644 16-QAM) ) have been added to fill in
perceived gaps in the progression of spectral efficiency versus SNR. They do not, in fact, provide
any discernible improvement in Eb/No performance (compared with their nearest neighbors in
the initial VersaFEC family), but exhibit a modest SNR improvement.
Table 7-10. Extended CCM Codes
Spectral Typical Latency at Min. Data Max. Data
Modulation Code Rate efficiency, Eb/No, for 64 kbps, in Rate, Rate,
bps/Hz BER = 5 x 10-8 milliseconds CCM mode CCM mode
8-QAM 0.576 1.73 4.5 dB 87 32 kbps 11 Mbps
16-QAM 0.644 2.58 6.5 dB 121 47 kbps 11 Mbps

7.8.1.2 Ultra-Low-Latency (ULL) Codes


Four new ultra-short block LDPC codes have been added to address the needs of users with
applications requiring even lower latency than the standard VersaFEC code set. These new
codes (which are limited to BPSK and QPSK only) use significantly shorter code blocks than
standard VersaFEC, and as a result, the coding gain is slightly reduced. However, in terms of
latency, the performance is exceptional far lower than any other FEC method ever offered,
with the exception of Viterbi.
Table 7-11. ULL Codes
Spectral Typical Latency at Min. Data Max. Data
Code
Modulation efficiency, Eb/No, for 64 kbps, in Rate, Rate,
Rate
bps/Hz BER = 5 x 10-8 milliseconds CCM mode CCM mode
BPSK 0.493 0.49 3.3 dB 18 18 kbps 5.7 Mbps
QPSK 0.493 0.99 3.3 dB 19 18 kbps 6 Mbps
QPSK 0.654 1.30 3.8 dB 21 24 kbps 9 Mbps
QPSK 0.734 1.47 4.3 dB 23 27 kbps 9 Mbps

713

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

7.9 Uncoded Operation (No FEC)


Comtech EF Data strongly cautions users when using uncoded operation. If the
acquisition sweep width exceeds one quarter of the symbol rate, there is a very high
probability that the demodulator will false lock.
Example: If selecting 64 kbps QPSK, uncoded, the symbol rate will be half of this rate,
or 32 ksymbols/second. One quarter of this equals 8 kHz. Therefore, the absolute
maximum acquisition sweep range that should be considered is 8 kHz. If there is
any frequency uncertainty on the incoming carrier, this should be subtracted from
the sweep width. The problem becomes progressively better with increasing symbol
rate.

Comtech EF Data cannot be held responsible for incorrect operation if the user does
not adhere to these guidelines when using uncoded operation.

There are occasions where a user may wish to operate a satellite link with no forward error
correction of any kind. For this reason, the CDM-625 offers this uncoded mode for three
modulation types BPSK, QPSK, and OQPSK. However, the user should be aware of some of the
implications of using this approach.

PSK demodulators have two inherent undesirable features. The first, known as phase
ambiguity, is due to the fact the demodulator does not have any absolute phase reference and,
in the process of carrier recovery, the demodulator can lock up in any of K phase states where K
= 2 for BPSK, K = 4 for QPSK. Without the ability to resolve these ambiguous states, there would
be a 1-in-2 chance that the data at the output of the demodulator would be wrong in the case of
BPSK. For QPSK, the probability would be 3-in-4.

The problem is solved in the case of BPSK by differentially encoding the data prior to
transmission, then performing the inverse decoding process. This is a very simple process, but
has the disadvantage that it doubles the receive BER. For every bit error the demodulator
produces, the differential decoder produces two.

The problem for QPSK is more complex, as there are four possible lock states leading to four
ambiguities. When FEC is employed, the lock state of the FEC decoder can be used to resolve
two of the four ambiguities, and the remaining two can be resolved using serial differential
encoding/decoding. However, when no FEC is being used, an entirely different scheme must be
used. Therefore, in QPSK, a parallel differential encoding/decoding technique is used, but has
the disadvantage that it again doubles the receive BER.

OQPSK is a different situation again, where the ambiguities result not only from not having an
absolute phase reference, but also not knowing which of the two parallel paths in the demod, I
or Q, contains the half-symbol delay. Another type of differential encoding is used, but yet again
the error rate is doubled, compared to ideal.

NOTE: Whenever uncoded operation is selected, the modem offers the choice between
enabling and disabling the differential encoder/decoder appropriate for the modulation type.

714

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

The second problem inherent in PSK demodulators is that of data false locking. In order to
accomplish the task of carrier recovery, the demodulator must use a non-linear process. A
second-order non-linearity is used for BPSK, and a fourth-order non-linearity is used for QPSK.
When data at a certain symbol rate is used to modulate the carrier, the demodulator can lock at
incorrect frequencies, spaced at intervals of one-quarter of the symbol rate away from the
carrier. Fortunately, when FEC decoding is used, the decoder synchronization state can be used
to verify the correct lock point has been achieved, and to reject the false locks.

However, if uncoded operation is used, there is no way to recognize a data false lock. The
demodulator will indicate that it is correctly locked, but the data out will not be correct.

715

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

Eb/No i n dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1

Uncoded BPSK/QPSK
Viterbi
1E-2
Decoding

Typical
Performance

1E-3

1E-4

1E-5

1E-6

Specification
1E-7 limit, Rate 7/8
Coding

1E-8

Specification Specification
limit Rate 1/2 limit, Rate 3/4
Coding Coding
1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER

Figure 7-3. Viterbi Decoding

716

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1

Uncoded BPSK/QPSK Viterbi with


concatenated
1E-2 RS 220,200
Sync Outer Code
threshold,
Rate 3/4

1E-3

Sync
threshold,
Rate 7/8
1E-4

Combined sync
1E-5 threshold, demod
and Viterbi
Decoder, Rate 1/2

1E-6 Specification
Limit Rate 1/2
and 220,200
Outer Code

1E-7
Specification
Limit Rate 3/4
and 220,200
Typical performance
Outer Code

1E-8
Specification
Limit Rate 7/8
and 220,200
Outer Code
1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER

Figure 7-4. Viterbi with Concatenated R-S Outer Code

717

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1

Uncoded BPSK/QPSK
8-PSK/TCM Rate 2/3
Decoding, with and
1E-2
without 219, 201 RS
Outer Code

1E-3

1E-4 Typical
Performance

1E-5

1E-6

1E-7

1E-8

Specification limit
Rate 2/3 Coding and Specification
219, 201 RS Outer Code limit, Rate 2/3
Coding
1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER

Figure 7-5. 8-PSK/TCM Rate 2/3 with and without Concatenated RS Outer Code

718

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

Eb/No i n dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1

16-QAM Viterbi, Rate 3/4 and Rate 7/8


with 220,200 RS Outer Code
Uncoded BPSK/QPSK
1E-2

Uncoded 16-QAM

1E-3

1E-4
Specification
limit Rate 7/8
Viterbi and
220,200 RS
Outer Code
1E-5

Typical
Performance

1E-6

1E-7

1E-8

Specification limit Rate


3/4 Viterbi and 220,200
RS Outer Code
1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER
Figure 7-6. Rate 3/4, Rate 7/8 16-QAM with Concatenated RS Outer Code

719

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1

Uncoded BPSK/QPSK
Sequential Decoding
64 kbps, BPSK,
1E-2
QPSK and OQPSK
Typical
Performance

1E-3

1E-4

1E-5

1E-6

Specification limit,
Rate 7/8 Coding,
1E-7 QPSK, OQPSK

Specification limit,
1E-8 Rate 1/2 Coding,
BPSK, QPSK, OQPSK
Specification limit,
Rate 3/4 Coding,
QPSK, OQPSK
1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER

Figure 7-7. Sequential Decoding at 64 kbps

720

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1

Sequential Decoding
Uncoded BPSK/QPSK
2048 kbps,
QPSK, OQPSK
1E-2
Typical
Performance

1E-3

1E-4

1E-5

1E-6 Specification limit,


Rate 7/8 Coding
QPSK, OQPSK

1E-7

Specification limit,
Rate 3/4 Coding
1E-8 QPSK, OQPSK

Specification limit,
Rate 1/2 Coding
QPSK, OQPSK

1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER

Figure 7-8. Sequential Decoding at 2048 kbps

721

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1

Uncoded BPSK/QPSK Sequential with


concatenated RS 220,200
Outer Code, 512 kbps
1E-2
BPSK, QPSK, OQPSK
Typical
Performance

1E-3

1E-4

1E-5

1E-6 Specification Limit


Rate 3/4 and
220,200 Outer Code
QPSK, OQPSK

1E-7

1E-8 Specification Limit


Specification Limit
Rate 1/2 and
Rate 7/8 and
220,200 Outer Code
220,200 Outer Code
BPSK, QPSK, OQPSK
QPSK, OQPSK

1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER

Figure 7-9. Sequential Decoding at 512 kbps with RS 220,200 Outer Code

722

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1

Comtech Turbo Product Codec


Uncoded Rate 5/16 BPSK
BPSK/QPSK
1E-2

1E-3

Spec limit
Rate 5/16
BPSK

1E-4

1E-5

1E-6

1E-7

1E-8
Typical performance

1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER

Figure 7-10. Rate 5/16 BPSK Turbo Product Codec

723

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1

Comtech Turbo Product Codec


Uncoded Rate 21/44 BPSK/QPSK/OQPSK
BPSK/QPSK
1E-2
Notes:
* Rate 21/44 QPSK is
shown as R1/2 on the
front panel
1E-3
* The OQPSK acquisition
Spec limit
and tracking thresholds
Rate 21/44
are approx. 1 dB worse
B/Q/OQPSK
than the QPSK case
1E-4

1E-5

1E-6

1E-7

1E-8
Typical performance

1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER

Figure 7-11. Rate 21/44 BPSK, QPSK, OQPSK Turbo Product Codec

724

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1

Comtech Turbo Product Codec


Uncoded
Rate 3/4 QPSK/OQPSK,
BPSK/QPSK 8-PSK/8-QAM and 16-QAM
1E-2
Uncoded
16-QAM
Spec limit -
Spec limit Uncoded
Rate 3/4
Rate 3/4 8-PSK
QPSK/OQPSK
8-PSK/8-QAM
1E-3

1E-4

1E-5

1E-6

1E-7

Spec limit
Rate 3/4
16-QAM
1E-8

Typical performance

1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER

Figure 7-12. Rate 3/4 QPSK/OQPSK, 8-PSK/8-QAM and 16-QAM Turbo Product Codec

725

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1

Comtech Turbo Product Codec


Uncoded
Rate 7/8 QPSK/OQPSK,
BPSK/QPSK 8-PSK/8-QAM and 16-QAM
1E-2
Uncoded
Uncoded 16-QAM
Spec limit -
8-PSK
Rate 7/8
QPSK/OQPSK
1E-3

Spec limit
Rate 7/8
8-PSK
8-QAM
1E-4

1E-5

1E-6

1E-7

Spec limit
Rate 7/8
16-QAM
1E-8

Typical performance

1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER

Figure 7-13. Rate 7/8 QPSK/OQPSK, 8-PSK/8-QAM and 16-QAM Turbo Product Codec

726

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1

Comtech Turbo Product Codec


Uncoded Rate 0.95 QPSK/OQPSK
BPSK/QPSK
1E-2 and 8-PSK/8-QAM

Spec limit
Rate 0.95
QPSK/OQPSK
1E-3

Uncoded
8-PSK
1E-4

1E-5

1E-6

1E-7 Spec limit


Rate 0.95
8-PSK
8-QAM

1E-8

Typical performance

1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER

Figure 7-14. Rate 0.95 QPSK and Rate 0.95 8-PSK Turbo Product Codec

727

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1

Comtech LDPC Codec


Uncoded Rate 1/2 BPSK/QPSK/OQPSK
BPSK/QPSK
1E-2

Note:
The OQPSK demod
1E-3 acquisition and tracking
threshold is about 1 dB
Spec limit worse than the QPSK
Rate 1/2 case
B/Q/OQPSK

1E-4

1E-5

1E-6

1E-7

Typical
performance

1E-8

1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER

Figure 7-15. Rate 1/2 BPSK, QPSK, OQPSK, LDPC Codec

728

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1

Comtech LDPC
Uncoded Rate 2/3 QPSK/OQPSK
BPSK/QPSK
1E-2 and 8-PSK/8-QAM

1E-3

Spec limit Spec limit


Rate 2/3 Rate 2/3
QPSK/OQPSK 8-QAM Uncoded
8-PSK
1E-4

1E-5

1E-6

Spec limit
Rate 2/3
8-PSK
1E-7

Typical
performance

1E-8

1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER

Figure 7-16. Rate 2/3 QPSK, OQPSK, 8-PSK, 8-QAM LDPC Codec

729

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1

Comtech LDPC
Uncoded Rate 3/4 QPSK/OQPSK
BPSK/QPSK
1E-2 8-PSK/8-QAM and 16-QAM

1E-3
Spec limit
Spec limit Rate 3/4
Rate 3/4 8-PSK
QPSK/OQPSK 8-QAM Uncoded
8-PSK
1E-4

1E-5

1E-6

Spec limit
Rate 3/4
16-QAM

1E-7

Typical
performance

1E-8

1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER

Figure 7-17. Rate 3/4 QPSK, OQPSK, 8-PSK, 8-QAM, 16-QAM LDPC Codec

730

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1

Comtech VersaFEC Codec


Uncoded Rate 0.488 BPSK
BPSK/QPSK
1E-2

1E-3

Rate
0.488
BPSK

1E-4

Typical performance shown -


guaranteed performance curve
is 0.3 dB to the right
1E-5

1E-6

1E-7

1E-8

1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER

Figure 7-18. VersaFEC Codec BPSK, Rate 0.488

731

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1

Comtech VersaFEC Codec


Uncoded
Rate 0.533, 0.631, 0.706,
BPSK/QPSK and 0.803 QPSK
1E-2

Rate Rate Rate Rate


1E-3
0.533 0.631 0.706 0.803
QPSK QPSK QPSK QPSK

1E-4

Typical performance shown -


guaranteed performance curves
are 0.3 dB to the right
1E-5

1E-6

1E-7

1E-8

1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER

Figure 7-19. VersaFEC Codec QPSK, Rate 0.533, 0.631, 0.706 and 0.803

732

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1

Comtech VersaFEC Codec


Uncoded Rate 0.642, 0.711, 0.780
BPSK/QPSK
1E-2
8-QAM

Rate Rate Rate


0.642 0.711 0.780
8-QAM 8-QAM 8-QAM
1E-3

Uncoded
8-PSK
1E-4

1E-5

1E-6

1E-7

Typical performance show -


guaranteed performance curves
are 0.3 dB to the right

1E-8

1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER

Figure 7-20. VersaFEC Codec 8-QAM, Rate 0.642, 0.711, and 0.780

733

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1

Comtech VersaFEC Codec


Rate 0.731, 0.780, 0.829
Uncoded BPSK/QPSK and 0.853 16-QAM
1E-2

Uncoded 16-QAM
Rate Rate Rate Rate
0.731 0.780 0.829 0.853
16-QAM 16-QAM 16-QAM 16-QAM
1E-3

1E-4

1E-5

1E-6

1E-7

Typical Performance shown -


guaranteed performance curves
are 0.3dB to the right
1E-8

1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER

Figure 7-21. VersaFEC Codec 16-QAM, Rate 0.731, 0.780, 0.829 and 0.853

734

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1
Comtech VersaFEC
Uncoded Codec - Extended CCM
BPSK/QPSK
1E-2
0.576 8-QAM and
0.644 16-QAM

Rate Rate
0.576 0.644
1E-3 8-QAM 16-QAM

Uncoded
8-PSK
1E-4

1E-5

1E-6

1E-7

Typical performance show -


guaranteed performance
1E-8 curves are 0.3 dB to the right

1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER

Figure 7-22. VersaFEC Extended CCM 8-QAM Rate 0.576 and 16-QAM, Rate 0.644

735

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

Eb/No in dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1

Comtech Ultra-Low-Latency
Uncoded (ULL) Codec - Rate 0.493
BPSK/QPSK
1E-2
BPSK/QPSK,
0.654 and 0.734 QPSK

1E-3 Rate Rate Rate


0.493 0.654 0.734
BPSK/QPSK QPSK QPSK

1E-4

Typical performance shown -


guaranteed performance curves
are 0.3 dB to the right
1E-5

1E-6

1E-7

1E-8

1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER

Figure 7-23. ULL Codec BPSK/QPSK Rate 0.493 and QPSK, Rate 0.654 and 0.734

736

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

Eb/No i n dB
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1E-1

Differential
Encoding -
No FEC, no
1E-2 Uncoded BPSK/QPSK
scrambling

1E-3

1E-4

1E-5

1E-6

1E-7

1E-8

1E-9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
BER

Figure 7-24. Differential Encoding No FEC, No Scrambling

737

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Forward Error Correction Options MN-CDM625

Notes:

738

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


Chapter 8. AUTOMATIC UPLINK
POWER CONTROL (AUPC)
8.1 Introduction
You MUST obtain permission from the Satellite Operator to use this feature.
Improper use of this feature could result in a transmitting terminal seriously
exceeding its allocated flux density on the Operators satellite. This could produce
interference to other carriers, and could cause transponder saturation problems.

AUPC is an acronym for Automatic Uplink Power Control. This feature permits a local modem to
adjust its own output power level in order to attempt to maintain the Eb/No at the remote
modem. To accomplish this, you must use one of the following framing types:

EDMAC, EDMAC-2, or EDMAC-3

D&I++

ESC++

Framed QDI

The remote modem constantly sends back information about the demodulator Eb/No using
reserved bytes in the overhead structure. The local modem then compares this value of Eb/No
with a pre-defined target value. If the Remote Eb/No is below the target, the local modem will
increase its output power, creating a closed-loop feedback system over the satellite link. A
particularly attractive benefit of this feature is that, whenever framed operation is selected, the
remote demodulators Eb/No can be viewed from the front panel display of the local modem.
Note that both EDMAC and AUPC can be used simultaneously with either framing type.

There are several important parameters associated with this mode of operation. You must
understand how the AUPC feature works, and what the implications are for setting these
parameters.

81

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Automatic Uplink Power Control (AUPC) MN-CDM625

8.2 Setting AUPC Parameters


The important consideration is that EDMAC framing should be enabled.

1) Use the SELECT: Configuration Mode menu to first select EDMAC framing. You may
select EDMAC as IDLE, or define the unit as an EDMAC Master or Slave.

2) Verify that the remote modem also has EDMAC framing enabled.

3) Set the nominal output power of the modem: Use the SELECT: Configuration Tx
POWER menu to select MANUAL mode, and then edit the displayed Tx output power level.

4) Select AUPC as the operating mode. At this point, you are prompted to define four key
parameters: Target Eb/No, Max Range, Alarm, and Demod Unlock.

8.2.1 Target Eb/No


This is value of Eb/No that you need to keep constant at the remote modem:

The minimum value to enter is 0.0 dB. If the Eb/No falls below this value, the AUPC
control will increase the Tx output power, but will never exceed the value determined
by the parameter MAX RANGE.

The maximum value to enter is 14.9 dB. If the Eb/No exceeds this value, the AUPC
control will reduce the Tx output power, but will never drop below the nominal value
set.

The default value is 3.0 dB.

The resolution is 0.1 dB.

8.2.2 Max Range


This defines how much the modem is permitted to increase the output level, under AUPC
control:

The minimum value to enter is 0 dB.

The maximum value to enter is 9 dB.

The default value is 1 dB.

The resolution is 1 dB.

82

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Automatic Uplink Power Control (AUPC) MN-CDM625

8.2.3 Alarm
This defines modem behavior if the maximum power limit is reached while under AUPC control.
The two choices are:

NONE (no action) default setting.

Tx ALARM (generate a Tx alarm).

8.2.4 Demod Unlock


This defines the action the modem will take if the remote demodulator loses lock. The two
choices are:

NOMINAL (reduce the Tx Output Power to the nominal value) default setting.

MAXIMUM (increase the Tx Output Power to the maximum value permitted by the
parameter MAX RANGE).

If the local demod loses lock, then the modem automatically moves its output power
to the nominal value.

8.3 Compensation Rate


As with any closed-loop control system, you must choose loop parameters that ensure stability
at all times. Several features ensure that the AUPC system does overshoot, or oscillate:

First, corrections for which the output power can be made are fixed at the rate of once
every 4 seconds. This takes into account the round trip delay over the satellite link, the
time taken for a power change to be reflected in the remote demodulators value of
Eb/No, and other processing delays in the modems.

Second, if the comparison of actual and target Eb/No yields a result that requires a
change in output power, to avoid the possibility of overshoot the first correction made
will be at 80% of the calculated step. Subsequent corrections are made until the
difference is less than 0.5 dB. At this point, the output power is only changed in
increments of 0.1 dB to avoid hunting around the correct set point.

83

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Automatic Uplink Power Control (AUPC) MN-CDM625

8.4 Monitoring
Comtech F Data strongly cautions against the use of large values of permitted
power level increase under AUPC control. Users should consider using the absolute
minimum range necessary to improve rain-fade margin.

The remote demodulators value of Eb/No can be monitored at all times, either from the front
panel (SELECT: Monitor AUPC) or via the remote control interface. The resolution of the
reading is 0.2 dB. For all values greater than or equal to 16 dB, a value of 16.0 dB will be
displayed. As long as framing is enabled, the value will still be available, even though AUPC may
be disabled.

The current value of Tx power increase is also displayed. If EDMAC framing is enabled but AUPC
is disabled, this will indicate 0.0 dB. This value is also available via the remote control interface.

84

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


Chapter 9. CLOCK MODES A ND
DROP AND INSERT (D&I)
9.1 Introduction
When dealing with satellite modems, the subject of clocking can be a complex issue. This
chapter describes the various clocking options that are available with the CDM-625.

The CDM-625 provides two fundamentally different interfaces:

Synchronous clock and data interfaces (EIA-422, V.35, etc.) that permit great flexibility
concerning the source and direction of clocks. These cause the most confusion.

G.703 interfaces, in which the clock and data are combined into a single signal (and are
referred to as self-clocking). In their basic form, these are less flexible and therefore
easier to understand. However, when used with Drop and Insert operation, the subject
again becomes more complex.

9.2 Transmit Clocking


There are five transmit clocking modes in the CDM-625. EIA-422/449 signal mnemonics will be
used for illustration, but the description applies equally to V.35, HSSI, and LVDS. Figure 9-1
provides a graphic depiction of these modes.

9.2.1 Internal Clock


In this mode, the modem, assumed always to be the DCE, supplies the clock to the DTE. (The
EIA-422/449 name for this signal is Send Timing, or ST.) The DTE then clocks from this source,
and gives the modem transmit data (Send Data, or SD) that is synchronous with this clock. It is
optional whether the DTE also returns the clock (Terminal Timing, or TT) the modem can
accept it if it is present, but uses ST if it is not. At rates above 2 Mbps, Comtech EF Data highly
recommends that you return TT to ensure the correct clock/data relationship.

G.703 and ASI: The internal clock mode does not apply the clock is always recovered from the
incoming signal, and the modem locks its modulator clocks to this.

IP and Audio: This is the only available mode.

91

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Clock Modes and Drop and Insert (D&I) MN-CDM625

9.2.2 TX Terrestrial
In this mode, the modem expects to see the DTE provide the clock so that it can phase-lock its
internal circuits. In this case, the modem does not provide any signal on ST, but instead requires
a clock signal on Terminal Timing (TT) that is synchronous with the data. If no clock is present, an
alarm will be generated and the modem will substitute its internal clock.

G.703 and ASI: This is the natural clock mode.

IP and Audio: Does not apply.

9.2.3 RX Loop-Timed, RX=TX


In certain circumstances, a terminal at the distant-end of a satellite link may be required to
provide a clock to the DTE equipment that is locked to the receive satellite signal. This is similar
to Internal Clock mode in that the modem will source Send Timing (ST) to the DTE, but now the
timing is derived from the demodulator. The DTE then clocks from this source and gives the
modem transmit data (Send Data, or SD) that is synchronous with this clock. It is optional
whether the DTE also returns the clock (Terminal Timing, or TT) the modem can accept it, if it
is present, but uses ST if it is not. If the demodulator loses lock, the modems internal clock will
be substituted, so an accurate and stable clock is present on ST rather than a clock that may
jitter and wander in a random fashion.

G.703, ASI, IP and Audio: Does not apply.

9.2.4 RX Loop-Timed, RX<>TX (Asymmetric Loop Timing)


The CDM-625 incorporates circuitry that permits loop timing when the TX and RX data rates are
not the same. In this case, the clock frequency appearing at ST will be whatever the TX data rate
is programmed to, but will be phase-locked to the demodulators receive symbol clock. In all
other respects, the operation is the same as for standard loop timing.

G.703, ASI, IP and Audio: Does not apply.

9.2.5 External TT with ST = RX Satellite


This is a special case that addresses a particular need for backwards compatibility with the
SDM-300A modem. It is, in many ways, similar to the standard TX Terrestrial mode described in
Sect. 9.2.2 in that, in this mode, the signal appearing on TT is used to provide the timing
reference for the transmit side of the CDM-625. However, in this mode the ST pins on the
interface are active and provide a copy of the RX Satellite clock (i.e., the clock from the
demodulator, prior to the buffer).

This mode is subject to certain limitations:

RX and TX data rates must be identical.

92

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Clock Modes and Drop and Insert (D&I) MN-CDM625

No framing (EDMAC, etc.) may be used.

No RS coding may be used.

RS-422, V.35, HSSI, and LVDS are the only interfaces supported and used on the Type D
25-pin connector.

Figure 9-1. TX Clock Modes

93

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Clock Modes and Drop and Insert (D&I) MN-CDM625

9.3 Receive Clocking


There are three receive clocking modes in the CDM-625: Buffer Disabled (RX Satellite), Buffer
Enabled (TX=RX), and Buffer Enabled (RX< >TX). An additional setting used only for Drop and
Insert is described in further detail later in this chapter. Figure 9-2 provides a graphic depiction
of these modes.

9.3.1 Buffer Disabled (RX Satellite)


When the buffer is disabled, the receive clock (Receive Timing, or RT) is derived directly from the
demodulator, and will therefore be subject to plesiochronous and Doppler offsets. This may
acceptable in certain instances. There is still a minimum buffer in use to de-jitter the effects of
removing overhead framing.

G.703: Applicable.

9.3.2 Buffer Enabled, TX=RX (TX Terrestrial or Int (SCT) Clock)


In this instance, it is required that buffer be enabled, so that the clock and data appearing on
Receive Timing and Receive Data (RT and RD, respectively) are synchronous with the transmit
clock or the internal (SCT) clock. This is a relatively simple case, as the output clock for the buffer
is derived directly from ST, TT, or the external source.

G.703: Applicable.

9.3.3 Buffer Enabled, RX<>TX (TX Terrestrial or Int (SCT) Clock)


This is an uncommon case, where the receive data rate does not equal the transmit or external
reference. The modem will generate a phase-locked buffer output clock that uses the selected
reference, regardless of its frequency in relation to the receive data rate.

G.703: Applicable.

94

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Clock Modes and Drop and Insert (D&I) MN-CDM625

Figure 9-2. RX Clock Modes

95

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Clock Modes and Drop and Insert (D&I) MN-CDM625

9.4 X.21 Notes


The central feature of X.21 is that the DCE supplies the clock for both directions. Therefore, the
first requirement is that TX and RX data rates are the same. Because the DCE doesnt get an
input clock moving in the same direction as its input data, the several nanoseconds of delay
through long cables and the modems data transceivers can cause the clock phase to change
relative to the data. This is why X.21 is not recommended above 2048 kbps.

If Modem = DCE (normal assumption), then X.21 mode is just a matter of ignoring ST and TT
and, instead, using RT to run both directions. Using the clock settings TX Clk = Loop and RX
Buffer Clk = RX assumes that the desired timing is coming from the far-end modem. The
modems ST is forced to be a copy of RT, because the latter assumes use by the terrestrial DTE
to drive SD data into the modem.

If, instead, the local modem supplies the timing, the clock settings should be TX Clk = Int and RX
Buffer Clk = TX or Int. These settings instead force RT to be a copy of ST. In either case, it is SD
that has an uncertain phase relationship to the clock due to round-trip delays, so the modems
TX clock invert feature may be necessary to avoid clocking in SD on its transitions.

If Modem = DTE, then ST and RT are ignored, and TT from the terrestrial DCE is used. The
correct modem settings are TX Clk = TT and RX Buffer Clk = TX. These settings force RT (which
drives out the modems RD) to be a copy of TT. It is now RD that has an uncertain phase
relationship to the clock, so the modems RX clock invert may be necessary to please the
terrestrial DCE.

9.5 Drop and Insert


The Drop and Insert (D&I) multiplexer works in conjunction with the G.703 interfaces to enable
the modem to transmit or receive fractional parts of a T1 or E1 data stream.

The D&I option provides fully compliant baseband processing in accordance with Intelsat
IESS-309 for the terrestrial information rate of 2048 kbps (E1) and 1544 kbps (T1), using G.703
interfaces. The data rate sent over the satellite link is n x 64 kbps. See the Frame Formats
diagram for the permissible values of n. The modem provides the interface to transmission level
framing compliant to IESS-309 Data Type 2.

96

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Clock Modes and Drop and Insert (D&I) MN-CDM625

9.6 Frame Formats


Figure 9-3 shows the supported E1 and T1 Frame Formats. Note that, for D&I++, the smaller
overhead frame structure does not support CAS signaling, although E1 timeslot 16 may still be
one of the channels transmitted.

E1-CCS (Common Channel Signalling)


2048 kbps E1 Frame Maximum channels to drop = 30 = 1920 kbps n x 64 kbps, n = 1,2,3,4,5,6,8,10,12,15,16,20,24,30

Time 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30
Slot 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
No.
Reserved for May be reserved for Signalling. All signalling
Framing information is common to all 30 TS and no signalling is
transmitted.

E1-CAS (Channel Associated Signalling)


2048 kbps E1 Frame Maximum channels to drop = 30 = 1920 kbps n x 64 kbps, n = 1,2,4,6,8,12,16,24,30

Time 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30
Slot 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
No.
Reserved for Reserved for Signalling. All signalling is transmitted
Framing for TS's dropped in IBS overhead (500Hz per TS)
Signalling information in TS 16 is associated to
specific TS's.

T1-ESF (Extended Super Frame)


1544 kbps T1 Frame 24-Frame multi-frame structure. No IBS multi-frame signalling will be transmitted.
Maximum channels to drop = 24 = 1536 kbps n x 64 kbps, n = 1,2,3,4,5,6,8,10,12,15,16,20,24

Time 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
Slot 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
No.

T1-D4 (D4 Framing)


1544 kbps T1 Frame 12-Frame multi-frame structure. No IBS multi-frame signalling will be transmitted.
Maximum channels to drop = 24 = 1536 kbps n x 64 kbps, n = 1,2,3,4,5,6,8,10,12,15,16,20,24

Time 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
Slot 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
No.

Figure 9-3. Supported T1 and E1 Framing Formats

97

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Clock Modes and Drop and Insert (D&I) MN-CDM625

9.7 Timeslot Selection


Selection of the transmit and receive data rates may be made in certain 64 kbps increments and
may be independent of each other. The actual satellite rates for open network D&I are 16/15 of
the transmit or receive data rate to include IBS overhead per IESS-309, although this is
transparent to the user.

For E1, you can select any timeslot (TS) from 1 to 31. Selection of TS 0 is permitted (on the front
panel menus, use z to add to the list of timeslots to be dropped/inserted).

For T1, you can select any timeslot (TS) from 1 to 24. You may also select N/A to leave a
satellite channel unused.

The configuration menu allows timeslots to be selected for transmission or reception up to the
maximum dictated by the selected transmit or receive data rate, and may be selected in
arbitrary order. For example, if the data rate is set to 256 kbps, the maximum number of
timeslots that can be dropped or inserted is 4 (being 4 x 64 kbps).

Note that, for 1920 kbps data rate, the timeslots may not be manipulated. This is the fixed
channel mode where Timeslot 1 is assigned to Channel 1, and so on.

For D&I++ framing, all increments of 64 kbps are allowed up to a maximum of 31 (1984 kbps).
For this mode, the satellite rate is 46/45 of the front panel data rate (2.22%).

98

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Clock Modes and Drop and Insert (D&I) MN-CDM625

9.8 Drop and Insert (D&I) Clocking


Figure 9-4 shows the general arrangement for Drop and Insert clocking in the CDM-625. Note
that there are two inputs and two outputs shown for Drop and Insert Operation:

Drop Data In (DDI) Insert Data In (IDI)


Drop Data Out (DDO) Insert Data Out (IDO)

This arrangement permits you to choose between fully independent operation of the incoming
and outgoing E1/T1 signal, or to use the same T1/E1 signal for both Dropping and Inserting
(looped mode). If Loop has been selected under the Drop and Insert configuration menu, the
Drop Data Out (DDO) signal is automatically looped internally, to become the Insert Data In (IDI).

In this mode, timeslots are dropped from an incoming E1/T1 signal for transmission over the
satellite, and the same E1/T1 signal has timeslots re-inserted into it that will over-write data in
existing timeslots.

Figure 9-4. Drop and Insert Clocking

99

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Clock Modes and Drop and Insert (D&I) MN-CDM625

9.9 RX Buffer Clock = Insert (D&I only)


The E1 or T1 clock recovery from the IDI G.703 port serves as the RX Buffer reference. In
addition, the recovered data is the E1/T1 input to the Insert Mux. If the RX G.703 recovery
circuit detects no activity at IDI input, or cannot detect the expected frame format, Buffer Clock
= RX Satellite will be chosen as a fall-back.

If Insert is not the selected buffer clock reference, the clock and data from the IDI port is
ignored, and a new E1/T1 frame is generated. The timeslots coming from the satellite are then
re-inserted into the selected timeslots of this new blank frame, and output on the IDO port.

9.10 Single-Source Multiple Modems


Two ways to connect a single T1 or E1 stream to several modems are by looming or daisy-chaining
modems. Looming method is illustrated in Figure 9-5, while Figure 9-6 illustrates the daisy-chain
method each requires the RX Buffer Clock = Insert setting. Note the following:

Assign all timeslots to not overlap.

Assign modems to number of TX/RX channels as required.

Figure 9-5. Single-Source Multiple Modems (Looming)

MODEM MODEM MODEM

IDI

DDI DDO IDI IDO

Multiple Modem Drop & Insert Application: This application shows how the loop is extended
to one or more additional modems.
Terrestrial Trunk
DDO- IDI connection may be made internally using Loop = Y under D&I menu.

Figure 9-6. Single-Source Multiple Modems (Daisy-chain)

910

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Clock Modes and Drop and Insert (D&I) MN-CDM625

9.11 G.703 Clock Extension


There are some applications where it becomes necessary, at the distant end of a satellite link, to
provide a high-stability G.703 timing reference for timing equipment connected to the modem.
For example, in cellular backhaul applications, the BTS equipment may require such a reference
even though the satellite link itself may be operating at a data rate other than 1.544 Mbps or
2.048 Mbps. This is sometimes accomplished by adding a specialized GPS receiver at the distant
end, which then provides the G.703 synchronizing signal. However, with the G.703 clock
extension mode this may become unnecessary, as the CDM-625 operating at either end of the
link, where the local modem has access to a high-stability G.703 signal can provide an almost
perfect copy of this signal at the distant end. The presence of Doppler shift on the link is the only
factor affecting the overall accuracy. If Doppler shift were not present, the copy of the clock
would be perfect.

This is accomplished by the use of a novel frequency synthesis and phase locking scheme. This
feature of the CDM-625 permits the distant end to generate a G.703 synchronizing signal that,
depending on a sufficiently accurate local reference, has short term accuracy to within parts in
10-8, and is solely dependent on link Doppler shift.

The subsections and figures that follow illustrate three possible G.703 clock extension modes.
Details of how to set up the modems for these various operating modes are given in Chapter 5.
FRONT PANEL OPERATION.

9.11.1 Clock Extension Mode 1


Figure 9-7 shows Clock Extension Mode 1. The local modem is assumed to be operating on
INTERNAL clock. A T1 or E1 G.703 signal is applied to the rear panel connector of the modem,
where the clock is recovered.

(Note: the G.703 signal is not intended to convey data its function is only to provide a
synchronizing clock. The data is transferred using the EIA-530/V.35 serial interface.)

The internal clock reference generator locks in both frequency and phase to this recovered
clock, and a special synthesizer generates an ST clock of ANY ARBITRARY FREQUENCY over the
range 2.4 kHz to 9.98 MHz with a resolution of 1 Hz. The synthesis is exact there is no
approximation or residual error. For example, if you select 168.231 kbps as the transmit data
rate, and an E1 reference, there will be exactly 168,231 clock cycles generated for every
2,048,000 cycles of the E1 reference.

The internal ST clock is now used, as in the standard Internal Clock mode, to provide the timing
reference for the externally-connected equipment. The data is then transmitted at the desired
data rate to the distant end (or distant ends this works for broadcast applications as well).

Now, at the distant end modem (timing mode: RX Satellite), the RX signal is received,
demodulated, and the clock is recovered. A second synthesizer, very similar to the one used at
the local modem, is now used to generate an E1 or T1 timing signal. Again, it should be

911

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Clock Modes and Drop and Insert (D&I) MN-CDM625

emphasized that the synthesis is exact. The net result is that the E1 or T1 timing signal used at
the local end is reproduced at the distant end, regardless of the link data rate.

The only thing that affects the overall accuracy and stability of the copy of the clock is the
Doppler shift of the link itself. This will be very dependent on the particular satellite used, and
the accuracy of the orbital station keeping (often referred to as orbital inclination). Typically the
Doppler variations are in the order of parts in 10-8, but more importantly it should be recognized
that, over a 24 hour period, the net error would be zero due to a fundamental characteristics of
geostationary orbits.

The T1 or E1 signal, available on the rear panel of the modem on the G.703 connectors, is now
used to provide a synchronizing source for equipment connected to the modem. The form of
this is an all ones signal, which provides the maximum transition density in the AMI signal.

Note: This scheme is sufficiently flexible to permit an E1 signal to be used at the local end, and a
T1 signal to be reproduced at the distant end, or vice versa.

9.11.2 Clock Extension Mode 2


Figure 9-8 shows Clock Extension Mode 2. This is for situations where clock extension needs to
be performed, but there is no local G.703 reference. In this case, the local modem now operates
in an EXTERNAL clock mode and the accuracy of the TX Clock is determined solely by the
accuracy of the equipment connected to the modem.

At the distant end, an E1 or T1 synchronizing signal is generated regardless of the link data rate,
as in Mode 1.

9.11.3 Clock Extension Mode 3


Figure 9-9 shows Clock Extension Mode 3. This is very similar to Mode 1 but now, instead of the
EIA-530/V.35 serial interface being used, everything is based around the 10/100 Base T Ethernet
interface.

At the distant end, an E1 or T1 synchronizing signal is generated regardless of the link data rate,
as in Mode 1
.

912

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Clock Modes and Drop and Insert (D&I) MN-CDM625

CDM-625 CDM-625

Figure 9-7. G.703 Clock Extension Mode 1

913

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Clock Modes and Drop and Insert (D&I) MN-CDM625

CDM-625 CDM-625

Figure 9-8. G.703 Clock Extension Mode 2

914

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Clock Modes and Drop and Insert (D&I) MN-CDM625

CDM-625 CDM-625

Figure 9-9. G.703 Clock Extension Mode 3

915

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Clock Modes and Drop and Insert (D&I) MN-CDM625

9.12 Quad E1 Operation


Up to four complete or fractional E1 streams may be concatenated into a single Comtech
proprietary satellite frame structure using the Quad E1 feature. The Balanced G.703 and Aux
G.703 9-pin D-sub female connectors on the CDM-625 rear panel each provide access to two
ports. See Sect. 3.2.2.2 G.703 Connectors for pinout details.

Selected timeslots for each active port are dropped onto the transmit satellite frame in order
of port number and drop channel number, with the reverse insert operation on the receive
side. For each port, if n=32 is selected, then it is not assumed that the E1 into the modem
contains framing. Data may be framed or unframed, and the modem will simply transmit the
entire 2048 kbps stream on that ports portion of the satellite frame; this is why timeslot
selection is disabled for n=32. However, for any fractional value of n, the incoming E1 to that
port must have TS0 framing so that the selected timeslots to be dropped can be identified.

Beginning with Firmware Version 2.0.1, changes to Quad E1 operation allow the combining of
asynchronous E1 streams. Prior to Firmware Version 2.0.1, it was important for all ports to be
synchronous to one another in order to operate without data loss bit stuffing is now
performed on slower data streams to match them to faster ones. Satellite overhead is used to
identify extra data on each port that was sent over the link. The extra data is then removed at
the receiver, so that each ports timing is maintained. As a result, it is important that the ports
used and the number of timeslots for each port match at both ends of the link. The
recommendation for G.703 requires that the actual bit rate be within 50 ppm of 2048 kbps.

If asynchronous E1 streams are used at the transmit side of the link, it is important to keep the
receive buffer set to Rx Satellite. The Tx Terrestrial setting should only be used if all E1
streams are synchronous to one another (no bit stuffing over the satellite frame) and the
resulting E1 streams from the receiver need to be retimed to a local reference.

There is a hardware limitation for base modem boards previous to HW Rev 2.x (see front panel
under the SELECT: FAST menu): Older boards use a common receive E1 clock for ports 3 and 4,
so it is necessary that ports 3 and 4 at the transmitting modem remain synchronized to one
another.

916

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


Chapter 10. DOUBLETALK
CARRIER-IN-CARRIER OPTION
BEFORE ATTEMPTING TO COMMISSION A SATELLITE LINK USING CARRIER-IN-CARRIER,
YOU MUST ENSURE THAT THE LINK IS ROBUST ENOUGH FOR NORMAL OPERATION. ONLY
WHEN THIS HAS BEEN DONE AND ALL SYSTEM ISSUES (E.G., ANTENNA-POINTING,
CABLING, TERRESTRIAL INTERFERENCE, SATELLITE INTERFERENCE, ETC.) HAVE BEEN
RESOLVED SHOULD YOU ATTEMPT THE USE OF CARRIER-IN-CARRIER.

10.1 Introduction
Space segment costs are typically the most significant operating expense for any satellite-based
service, having a direct impact on the viability and profitability of the service. For a satellite
transponder that has finite resources in terms of bandwidth and power, the leasing costs are
determined by bandwidth and power used. Therefore, a satellite circuit should be designed for
optimal utilization to use a similar share of transponder bandwidth and power.

The traditional approach to balancing a satellite circuit once the satellite and earth station
parameters are fixed involves trade-off between modulation and coding. A lower order
modulation requires less transponder power while using more bandwidth; conversely, higher
order modulation reduces required bandwidth, albeit at a significant increase in power.

Comtech EF Data has added a new dimension to satellite communication optimization:


DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier.

10.2 What is DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier?


The CDM-625s DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier (CnC) option uses a patented signal processing
algorithm developed by Raytheon Applied Signal Technology that allows both the forward and
reverse carriers of a full duplex link to share the same segment of transponder bandwidth, using
patented Adaptive Cancellation. Raytheon Applied Signal Technology uses the term
DoubleTalk, and Comtech EF Data refers to it as DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier (CnC) 1.

1
DoubleTalk is licensed from Raytheon Applied Signal Technology.

DoubleTalk is a registered trademark of Raytheon Applied Signal Technology.

Carrier-in-Carrier is a registered trademark of Comtech EF Data.

101

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Option MN-CDM625

CnC was first introduced in Comtech EF Datas CDM-Qx Satellite Modem and, more recently, in
the CLO-10 Link Optimizer. The implementation of DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier in the CDM-625
has been further refined, and some of the limitations that existed in the CDM-Qx
implementation have been overcome.

This innovative technology provides a significant improvement in bandwidth and power


utilization, beyond what is possible with FEC and modulation alone, allowing users to achieve
unprecedented savings. When combined with advanced modulation and FEC, it allows for multi-
dimensional optimization:

Reduced operating expense (OPEX) e.g., Occupied Bandwidth & Transponder Power;

Reduced capital expenditure (CAPEX) e.g., Block Up Converter/High-Power Amplifier


(BUC/HPA) size and/or antenna size;

Increased throughput without using additional transponder resources;

Increased link availability (margin) without using additional transponder resources;

A combination of any of the above to meet different objectives.

Summary: When carriers share common bandwidth, up to 50% savings in transponder


utilization is possible.

10.3 Application Requirements


The following conditions are necessary in order to operate DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier:

Link must be full duplex.

A CDM-625 must be used at the end of the link where the cancellation needs to take
place.

The transponder is operated as Loopback. That is, each end of the link must be able to
see a copy of its own signal in the return (downlink) path from the satellite. The looped
back signal is then subtracted which leaves the signal from the distant end of the link.
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier cannot be used in spot beam systems.

The transponder needs to be bent-pipe meaning no on-board processing,


demodulation, regeneration can be employed. Demodulation/remodulation does not
preserve the linear combination of the forward and return signals and the resulting
reconstituted waveform prevents recovery of the original constituent signals.

Figure 10-1 shows a simplified conceptual block diagram of CnC processing. The two ends of the
link are denoted A and B and the uplink and downlink are shown.

102

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Option MN-CDM625

Figure 10-1. Conceptual Block Diagram


This performance is achieved through advanced signal processing algorithms that provide
superior cancellation while tracking and compensating for the following common link
impairments:

1) Time varying delay: In addition to the static delays of the electronics and the round-trip
delay associated with propagation to the satellite and back, there is a time-varying
component due to movement of the satellite. The CnC module tracks and compensates
for this variation.

2) Frequency offset and drift: Common sources are satellite Doppler shift, up and down
converter frequency uncertainties, and other drift associated with the electronics in the
CDM-625 itself. The CnC module tracks and compensates for this frequency offset and
drift.

3) Atmospheric effects: Fading and scintillation can affect amplitude, phase, and spectral
composition of the signal and the degree to which it correlates with the original signal.
The CnC module tracks and compensates for these atmospheric related impairments.

103

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Option MN-CDM625

4) Link Asymmetries: Various asymmetries in the forward and return link can produce
differences in the relative power of the two received signal components. These can be
both deterministic (static) or random (and time varying). An example of the former
would be the differences resulting from antenna size/gain variations between the two
ends of the link. An example of the latter would be transient power differences due to
different levels of atmospheric fading in the uplinks. CnC compensates for the
asymmetries, up to a certain extent.

In a number of ways, CnC carriers behave similar to conventional carriers in satellite links. They
are both exposed to adjacent carriers, cross-polarization and rain fade, and exhibit impairments
when any of these become too great. In addition, CnC operates in an environment where:

Carriers intentionally occupy the same spectral slot;

Performance depends upon desired and co-located interfering carrier.

10.3.1 Operational Recommendations


The rules for CnC operation are summarized as follows:

Both earth stations share the same footprint so each sees both carriers

CnC carriers are operated in pairs

One outbound with multiple return carriers is not allowed

Asymmetric data rates are allowed (no restrictions)

The ratio of power spectral density is normally less than 11 dB

CnC operates with modems not modulators only or demodulators only

In addition, to minimize false acquisition, observe the following:

Use of IESS-315 V.35 Scrambler is highly recommended

Keep the search delay range as narrow as possible once the modem has reported the
search delay, narrow the search delay range to the nominal reported value 5 ms for
example, if the modem reported delay is 245 ms, narrow the search range to say 240-
250 ms

Use external data source (e.g. Firebird) or internal BER tester when testing Carrier-in-
Carrier performance

To prevent self-locking in case the desired carrier is lost, it is recommended that the two
carriers have some configuration difference for example, use different settings for
Spectrum Inversion

104

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Option MN-CDM625

10.4 System Functionality and Operational Considerations


Figure 10-2 illustrates a conventional, full duplex satellite link where two carriers are placed in
non-overlapping channels. Figure 10-3 shows the same link using the CDM-625 equipped with
the DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier option. Note that only 50% of the bandwidth is being used, as
both carriers are now occupying the same bandwidth.

The transponder downlinks the composite signal containing both carriers on the same band to
the CDM-625 which then translates the signal to near baseband where it can be filtered
(decimated) and then processed as a complex envelope signal. The CDM-625 then suppresses
the version of the near end carrier on the downlink side and then passes the desired carrier to
the demodulator for normal processing.

To further illustrate, as shown in Figure 10-4, without DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier, the two
carriers in a typical full duplex satellite link are adjacent to each other. With DoubleTalk Carrier-
in-Carrier, only the composite signal is visible when observed on a spectrum analyzer. Carrier 1
and Carrier 2, shown here for reference only, are overlapping, thus sharing the same spectrum.

Figure 10-2. Conventional FDMA Link

105

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Option MN-CDM625

Figure 10-3. Same Link Using CDM-625 and DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier

Figure 10-4. Duplex Link Optimization


The CDM-625 CnC module operates on the near-zero signal before the demodulator, and is
waveform agnostic. This means that no prior knowledge of the underlying modulation, FEC, or
any other waveform specific parameter is required in order to perform the signal suppression
operation. The only caveat to this is that the waveform must be sufficiently random.

Because acquiring the delay and frequency offset of the interfering carrier is fundamentally a
correlation operation, anything deterministic in the interfering carrier (within the correlation
window of the algorithm) will potentially produce false correlation peaks and result in incorrect
delays and/or frequency. Normally, this is not a problem, since energy dispersal techniques are
utilized in the vast majority of commercial and military modems. However, it is something that

106

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Option MN-CDM625

must be kept in mind when troubleshooting a system that utilizes the DoubleTalk Carrier-in-
Carrier technique for signal suppression.

One possible way to mitigate false peaks is to narrow the correlation window. For example, if
the delay is known to be around 240ms, set the minimum search delay to 230ms and the
maximum search delay to 250ms.

As all advances in modem technologies including advanced modulation and FEC techniques
approach their theoretical limits of power and bandwidth efficiencies, DoubleTalk Carrier-in-
Carrier allows satellite users to achieve spectral efficiencies (bps/Hz) that cannot be achieved
with modulation and FEC alone. Table 10-1 illustrates how DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier, when
used with 16-QAM, approaches the bandwidth efficiency of 256-QAM (8bps/Hz).
Table 10-1. Spectral Efficiency using DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier

Modulation Spectral Efficiency (bps/Hz)


and Code Rate TraditionalSCPC Carrier-in-Carrier
BPSK 1/2 0.50 1.00
QPSK 1/2 1.00 2.00
QPSK 2/3 1.33 2.67
QPSK 3/4 1.50 3.00
QPSK 7/8 1.75 3.50
8-QAM 2/3 2.00 4.00
8-QAM 3/4 2.25 4.50
8-QAM 7/8 2.63 5.25
16-QAM 3/4 3.00 6.00
16-QAM 7/8 3.50 7.00

As shown here, DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier allows equivalent spectral efficiency using a lower
order modulation and/or FEC Code Rate; CAPEX is therefore reduced by allowing the use of a
smaller BUC/HPA and/or antenna. And, as DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier can be used to save
transponder bandwidth and/or transponder power, it can be successfully deployed in
bandwidth-limited as well as power-limited scenarios.

10.4.1 DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Cancellation Process


The state-of-the-art signal processing technology employed via DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier
continually estimates and tracks all parametric differences between the local uplink signal and
its image within the downlink. Through advanced adaptive filtering and phase locked loop
implementations, it dynamically compensates for these differences by appropriately adjusting
the delay, frequency, phase and amplitude of the sampled uplink signal, resulting in excellent
cancellation performance.

When a full duplex satellite connection is established between two sites, separate satellite
channels are allocated for each direction. If both directions transmitted on the same channel,
each side would normally find it impossible to extract the desired signal from the aggregate due

107

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Option MN-CDM625

to interference originating from its local modulator. However since this interference is produced
locally, it is possible to estimate and remove its influence prior to demodulation of the data
transmitted from the remote location.

For the DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier cancellation, it is necessary to provide each demodulator


with a copy of its local modulators output.

Referring to Figure 10-5: Modem 1 and Modem 2 transmit signals S1 and S2 respectively. The
satellite receives, translates, and retransmits the composite signal. The downlink signals S1* and
S2*, received at Modem 1 and Modem 2 differ from the transmit signals primarily in terms of
phase, frequency, and delay offsets.

Figure 10-5. DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Signals


Referring to Figure 10-6: For round trip delay estimation, a search algorithm is utilized that
correlates the received satellite signal to a stored copy of the local modulators transmitted
signal. The interference cancellation algorithm uses the composite signal and the local copy of
S1 to estimate the necessary parameters of scaling (complex gain/phase), delay offset and
frequency offset. The algorithm continuously tracks changes in these parameters as they are
generally time-varying in a satellite link.

Figure 10-6. Carrier-in-Carrier Signal Processing Block Diagram

108

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Option MN-CDM625

The resulting estimate of the unwanted interfering signal is then subtracted from the composite
signal. In practical applications, the estimate of the unwanted signal can be extremely accurate.
Unwanted interfering signal suppression of 30 dB or more has been achieved in commercial
products with minimal degradation of the demodulator performance.

10.4.2 Margin Requirements


Typical interfering signal cancellation is 28 to 35 dB (depending on the product). The residual
interfering signal appears as noise causing a slight degradation of the Eb/No. To compensate for
the residual noise, a small amount of additional link margin is required to maintain the BER.
Margin requirements depend on the product, modulation and power ratios:

For the CDM-625, the additional margin requirements are as follows:

Modulation Nominal Margin*


BPSK 0.3 dB
* Equal power and equal symbol rate for the
QPSK/OQPSK 0.3 dB interfering carrier and the desired carrier, i.e., 0 dB
8-PSK 0.5 dB PSD ratio. Measured at IF with AWGN, +10 dBc
Adjacent Carriers, 1.3 spacing.
8-QAM 0.4 dB
16-QAM 0.6 dB

10.4.3 Carrier-in-Carrier Latency


Carrier-in-Carrier has no measurable impact on circuit latency.

10.4.4 Carrier-in-Carrier and Adaptive Coding and Modulation


Carrier-in-Carrier is fully compatible with VersaFEC Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM)
mode of operation in the CDM-625.

Carrier-in-Carrier combined with VersaFEC ACM can provide 100-200% increase in average
throughput.

10.4.5 Carrier-in-Carrier Link Design


Carrier-in-Carrier link design involves finding the FEC and modulation combination that provides
optimal bandwidth utilization. Just like conventional link design, it is an iterative process that
involves trying different FEC and modulation combinations with Carrier-in-Carrier until an
optimal combination is found.

For optimal Carrier-in-Carrier performance, it is recommended that the two carriers have similar
symbol rate and power. This can be achieved by selecting appropriate ModCods as shown in
following sections.

109

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Option MN-CDM625

10.4.5.1 Symmetric Data Rate Link


Consider the following example:

Satellite & Transponder Galaxy 18 @ 123 W, 13K/13K


Earth Station 1 Phoenix, AZ 4.6 m
Earth Station 2 Phoenix, AZ 2.4 m
Data Rate 512 kbps / 512 kbps

The traditional link was based on QPSK TPC 3/4 and required 0.96 MHz of leased BW. The LST 2
summary for the traditional link is as follows:

Carrier-in-Carrier link design involved trying different Modulation & FEC Code Rates to find the
optimal combination:

8-QAM, LDPC 2/3 with Carrier-in-Carrier

QPSK, LDPC 3/4 with Carrier-in-Carrier

QPSK, LDPC 2/3 with Carrier-in-Carrier

QPSK, LDPC 1/2 with Carrier-in-Carrier

2
LST is Intelsats Lease Transmission Plan Program.

1010

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Option MN-CDM625

Link parameters and LST summary for QPSK, LDPC 2/3 with Carrier-in-Carrier is as follows:

1011

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Option MN-CDM625

The link budget summary for the different ModCod combinations is as follows:

PSD
Allocated Leased BW Savings Compared
S. No. Modulation & FEC PEB (MHz) Ratio
BW (MHz) (MHz) to Original
(dB)
1 8-QAM, LDPC 2/3 0.3584 1.1468 1.1468 -20% 2.1
2 QPSK, LDPC 3/4 0.47785 0.6734 0.6734 30% 2.1
3 QPSK, LDPC 2/3 0.53735 0.5777 0.5777 40% 2.1
4 QPSK, LDPC 1/2 0.7168 0.5184 0.7168 25% 2.1

Based on this analysis, QPSK, LDPC 2/3 with Carrier-in-Carrier provides the maximum savings of
40%. In addition to 40% reduction in Leased Bandwidth, using Carrier-in-Carrier also reduced the
required HPA Power by almost 40%:

Traditional Link CnC Link


HPA Power HPA Power Reduction
(QPSK, TPC 3/4) (QPSK, LDPC 2/3)
HPA @ 4.6 m 0.7 W 0.5 W 40%
HPA @ 2.4 m 1.5 W 1.1 W 36%

10.4.5.2 Asymmetric Data Rate Link


As occupied (or allocated) bandwidth of a Carrier-in-Carrier circuit is dictated by the larger of the
two carriers, it is strongly recommended that the smaller carrier be spread as much as possible
using a lower order modulation and/or FEC, while meeting the PSD ratio spec. Spreading the
smaller carrier using a lower order modulation has multiple benefits:

Lower order modulation is always more robust;

Lower order modulation uses less transponder power this reduces total transponder,
and increases available link margin;

Lower order modulation uses less transmit power on the ground this can significantly
reduce the BUC/SSPA size by not only reducing the transmit EIRP, but also reducing the
BUC/SSPA backoff

Consider the following example:

Satellite & Transponder IS-901 @ 342 W, 22/22 (EH/EH)


Earth Station 1 Africa 4.5 m
Earth Station 2 Africa 3.0 m
Data Rate 3000 Mbps / 1000 Mbps

While the traditional link was based on QPSK, TPC 3/4 and required 3.9 MHz of leased
bandwidth, the Carrier-in-Carrier link was based on QPSK, LDPC 3/4 and QPSK, LDPC 1/2 and
required 2.8 MHz of leased bandwidth.

1012

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Option MN-CDM625

The savings summary is as follows:

Original Link With Carrier-in-Carrier and LDPC


Item Hub to Remote to Hub to Remote to Savings
Total Total
Remote Hub Remote Hub
Data Rate (kbps) 3000 1000 3000 1000
Modulation QPSK QPSK QPSK QPSK
FEC TPC 3/4 TPC 3/4 LDPC 3/4 LDPC 1/2
Occupied BW
(MHZ) 2.8 0.9 3.7 2.8 1.4 2.8
Power Eq. BW
(MHz) 3.3 0.6 3.9 2.5 0.3 2.8
Leased BW (MHz) 3.9 2.8 27.5%
Hub HPA (W) 26.0 20.3 22%
Remote HPA (W) 10.6 6.4 40%

If this link was designed using QPSK, LDPC 3/4 in both directions, it would have required:

Occupied BW 2.8 MHz


Power Eq. BW 3.0 MHz 7.2% increase in Power Eq. BW
Leased BW 3.0 MHz 7.2% increase in Leased BW
Hub HPA 20.3 W
Remote HPA 8.3 W 30% increase in Remote power

10.4.5.3 Power Limited Links


Carrier-in-Carrier can provide substantial savings even when the original link is power limited.
Spreading the carrier by using a lower modulation and/or FEC along with latest FEC such as
VersaFEC can substantially reduce the total power, which can then be traded with bandwidth
using Carrier-in-Carrier. The concept is illustrated with the following examples:

The conventional link is using 8-PSK, TPC 3/4:

Switching to VersaFEC and using a lower order modulation e.g., QPSK,


VersaFEC 0.803 increases the total occupied bandwidth, while reducing
the total power equivalent bandwidth:

Now using DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier, the second QPSK, VersaFEC


0.803 carrier can be moved over the first carrier thereby significantly
reducing the total occupied bandwidth and total power equivalent
bandwidth when compared to the original side-by-side 8PSK, TPC 3/4
carriers:

1013

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Option MN-CDM625

To continue, consider this example:

Satellite & Transponder IS-901 @ 342 W, 22/22 (EH/EH)


Earth Station 1 Africa 9.2 m
Earth Station 2 Africa 4.5 m
Data Rate 2.048 Mbps / 2.048 Mbps

Whereas the original link used 8-PSK TPC 3/4, the Carrier-in-Carrier link used QPSK VersaFEC
0.803. The savings summary is as follows:

Original Link With Carrier-in-Carrier and VersaFEC


Item Hub to Remote to Hub to Remote to Savings
Total Total
Remote Hub Remote Hub
Data Rate (kbps) 2048 2048 2048 2048
Modulation 8-PSK 8-PSK QPSK QPSK
FEC TPC 3/4 TPC 3/4 0.803 0.803
Occupied BW
(MHZ) 1.3 1.3 2.6 1.8 1.8 1.8
Power Eq. BW
(MHz) 2.2 1.0 3.2 1.1 0.5 1.6
Leased BW (MHz) 3.2 1.8 44%
Hub HPA (W) 5.0 2.0 60%
Remote HPA (W) 11.6 4.7 60%
Note: 1 dB HPA BO for QPSK, 2 dB HPA BO for 8-PSK, 1 dB Feed Loss.

Using Carrier-in-Carrier and VersaFEC reduced the leased bandwidth by almost 44% and HPA
power by 60%.

1014

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Option MN-CDM625

10.4.6 Carrier-in-Carrier Commissioning and Deployment


Prior to commissioning a Carrier-in-Carrier link, it is critical that the link is fully tested in non
Carrier-in-Carrier mode and all system issues including external interference, antenna pointing,
cabling, SSPA backoff are resolved. Only after the link is robust, should you attempt turning on
Carrier-in-Carrier.

The following steps are recommended for Carrier-in-Carrier commissioning and deployment:
Step Task
1 Turn ON the carrier at Site A. Carrier from Site B is OFF. CnC function is OFF at both sites.
Using a spectrum analyzer, measure Co+No/No at the input to the modem at Site A.
Using a spectrum analyzer, measure Co+No/No at the input to the modem at Site B.
Measure/record Eb/No at Site B. Make sure there is sufficient margin to account for
CnC.
Measure/record Receive Signal Level (RSL) at Site B.

2 Turn OFF the carrier at Site A. Turn ON the carrier at Site B. CnC function is OFF at both sites.
Using a spectrum analyzer, measure Co+No/No at the input to the modem at Site A.
Using a spectrum analyzer, measure Co+No/No at the input to the modem at Site B.
Measure/record Eb/No at Site A. Make sure there is sufficient margin to account for
CnC.
Measure/record RSL at Site B.

3 Using Co+No/No readings calculate PSD ratio at Site A and Site B. If it is not within
specification, make necessary adjustments to bring it within specification and repeat
measurements in Step (1) and (2).
Also verify that the RSL is within spec.

4 Now without changing the transmit power levels, turn ON both the carriers (on the same
frequency) and turn CnC ON.
Measure/record Eb/No at Site A and B.
Measure/record RSL at Site A and B.
Now compare Eb/No in presence of 2 over lapping carriers with CnC with Eb/No when
only 1 carrier was ON. Eb/No variation should be within spec for that modulation, FEC
and PSD ratio.

5 The test can be repeated for different PSD ratio and Eb/No.

1015

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Option MN-CDM625

10.4.7 Validating Carrier-in-Carrier Performance


Carrier-in-Carrier performance can be easily validated by verifying that Eb/No degradation due
to Carrier-in-Carrier is within published specification for the observed Power Spectral Density
Ratio.

The following steps are recommended for validating Carrier-in-Carrier performance:


Step Task
1 Setup a conventional side-by-side link of the desired Eb/No:
Carrier-in-Carrier should be OFF.
Record the Eb/No as displayed by the Modems.
Observe the 2 carriers on a spectrum analyzer and record the PSD ratio.
Example Link:
Full duplex 512 kbps, QPSK, LDPC 2/3 circuit between 4.6 m and 2.4 m antennas
Recorded Eb/No = 2.6 dB (at both modems)
PSD Ratio = 1.2 dB (measured at larger Antenna)

2 Now relocate one of the carriers on top of the other carrier:


Enable Carrier-in-Carrier.
Record the Eb/No as displayed by the Modems.
3 Calculate change in Eb/No and verify against specification.
Example Link:
Recorded Eb/No = 2.4 dB
Change in Eb/No = 0.2 dB
Eb/No Degradation (Spec.) at 1.2 dB PSD = 0.3 dB
Modem performance is within spec

1016

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Option MN-CDM625

10.5 Operational References

10.5.1 Carrier-in-Carrier Link Budget Calculation


The following steps are required for calculating the link budget for a Carrier-in-Carrier Link:
Step Task
1 Calculate the link budget for both carriers in the duplex link, with required CnC margin:

2 Verify that the PDS ration is within spec for the CDM-625.
3 Calculate the Allocated Bandwidth (BW) and Power Equivalent Bandwidth (PEB) for the duplex
link:
BWDuplex Link = Greater of (BWCarrier 1, BWCarrier 2)

PEBDuplex Link = PEBCarrier 1 + PEBCarrier 2

Leased BWDuplex Link = Greater of (BWDuplex Link, PEBDuplex Link)

4 For an optimal link, the Leased Bandwidth and the Power Equivalent Bandwidth should be
equal / nearly equal.
5 Repeat the link budget process by selecting different Modulation and FEC, until the BW and
PEB is nearly balanced.

1017

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Option MN-CDM625

10.5.2 Estimating PSD Ratio


PSD can be estimated from a link budget using Downlink EIRP and Symbol Rate:

PSD = Downlink EIRP 10 * Log (Symbol Rate)

PSD Ratio Example:

Carrier Downlink EIRP Symbol Rate Power Spectral Density


A to B 27 dBW 500 ksps -29.99 dBW/Hz
B to A 24 dBW 375 ksps -31.74 dBW/Hz

PSD Ratio (@ A) = -29.99 (-31.74) = 1.75 dB

PSD Ratio (@ B) = -31.74 (-29.99) = -1.75 dB

10.5.2.1 Estimating PSD Ratio from LST

1018

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Option MN-CDM625

10.5.2.2 Estimating PSD Ratio from Satmaster

10.5.2.3 Estimating PSD Ratio Using Spectrum Analyzer


PSD Ratio or CnC Ratio can also be estimated using a Spectrum Analyzer capable of integrating
the signal power in a given bandwidth.

CnC Ratio (in dB) = PowerC1 (in dBm) PowerC2 (in dBm)

PSD Ratio (in dB) = (PowerC1 10 log BWC1 (in Hz)) (PowerC2 10 log BWC2 (in Hz))
= CnC Ratio 10 log (BWC1 / BWC2)

If the two carriers have same Symbol Rate / Bandwidth, then the CnC Ratio is same as the PSD
Ratio.

1019

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Option MN-CDM625

10.6 Carrier-in-Carrier Automatic Power Control (CnC-APC)

10.6.1 Introduction
A number of Comtech EF Data modems, including the CDM-625, offer Automatic Uplink Power
Control (AUPC) to mitigate the effects of rain fading and other link impairments.

It is important to note that the simple system employed in AUPC (whereby distant-end Eb/No is
monitored, and local power is increased when a degraded link is detected) has an undesirable
characteristic, which leads to some operators not permitting its use on their transponders: The
inability of classic AUPC to determine at which side of link the fade (or other impairment) has
occurred. More specifically:

If the fade is at the local side, all is well the drop in Eb/No at the distant site
corresponds exactly to the drop in power (due to excess attenuation) on the local
uplink; when uplink power is increased, the power at the transponder does not exceed
its clear-sky value.

Conversely, if the fade occurs at the distant side, the AUPC system increases power in
exactly the same way but now, there is no excess uplink attenuation and, as a result,
the clear-sky power at the satellite will be exceeded.

In a transponder with many carriers using AUPC, a fade event at the wrong side can cause
many carriers to simultaneously increase power beyond their authorized maximums, leading to
intermod problems, adjacent channel interference (ACI) issues, and in some extreme cases,
saturation of the transponder.

When considering power control in the Carrier-in-Carrier case, not only must the issue of
exceeding allocated power limits be respected, but the problem of driving CnC ratios outside
working limits during fading must also be taken into account.

10.6.2 AUPC and Carrier-in-Carrier in the CDM-625


The CDM-625 currently permits classic AUPC when Carrier-in-Carrier mode is in operation, but
this does nothing to stop the problem of exceeding power limits when the fade is on the wrong
side. To limit the impact of this, you are constrained to 3 dB of permitted power increase.
Depending on the satellite band, and the depth and rapidity of the fade, this constraint may
curtail the effectiveness of the system.

10.6.3 The CnC Automatic Power Control Algorithm


In addressing the shortcomings of classic AUPC, from its studies of the unique problems of
power control in CnC systems, Comtech EF Data has determined that there is sufficient
information available (CnC ratio, power level, Eb/No, RSL, etc.) on the local and distant sides to
control power at each end without exceeding the total composite power allocated to each

1020

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Option MN-CDM625

carrier in the CnC pair. Furthermore, the power control algorithm developed by Comtech EF
Data ensures that the CnC ratio remains within the correct working range.

As a recap, consider the following diagram:

Carrier 1

Do
k wn
lin lin
Up kt
o
Composite Carrier
T1 T2

Satellite
Target PSD
T1 T2
to
k Up
lin Carrier 2 lin Carrier 1
wn k
Do
Carrier 2

Terminal 1 Terminal 2
Satellite Link CnC Carriers

Whenever power is adjusted on Carrier 1, the power in Carrier 2 needs to be adjusted so the
composite carrier power remains constant (or does not exceed its allocated limit), while keeping
the CnC ratio within limits.

There are two distinct phases to the CnC-APC algorithm:

1) In order for the CnC-APC algorithm to work effectively, it must first analyze the CnC Ratio
and Eb/No margins on each side of the link, and based on the starting conditions, re-
distribute power between the two ends so that good protection against fades can be
achieved. This process is referred as re-balancing, and is done so that total composite power
(TCP) in the two carriers remains constant (within 0.5 dB).

In this process, both sides of the link calculate power changes, based on their ability to see
not only local parameters, including CnC Ratio, Eb/No, Receive signal level, power level and
max power increase, but those of the modem at the other end of the link. After these
calculations are performed, a comparison of the results is performed, and if they are in close
agreement, the power changes are implemented.

It may not always be possible to drive the powers to an optimum point. The calculations
take into account:

The minimum and maximum power levels possible in the modem (which is affected
by the operating band 70/140 MHz IF versus L-Band).

If the user-programmed value that determines the maximum permitted increase in


Tx power for the terminal would be exceeded. This is a very important value, and
you must know exactly how far from compression his transmit RF chain is operating.
As an example, if, under normal clear sky conditions, you determine that the backoff
from compression is -3 dB, and under no circumstances must the RF chain ever go
past -1 dB, the maximum power increase that can be permitted is 2 dB. You enter
this into the CDM-625 as a setup parameter. If this value is ignored, or incorrectly
entered, compression or saturation could occur, either during the initial re-balance,

1021

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Option MN-CDM625

or during a fade event. This parameter is referred to as TPLImax (Transmit Power


Level Increase, max).

If the power changes calculated would put the CnC Ratio out of its working range.

If the Rx signal level is above its minimum level if it is not, the CnC Ratio monitor
will not be accurate, which is essential correct calculations.

If the power change would result in the Eb/No margin on either side becoming
negative (see below).

At the end of the re-balance procedure, the modem will display the result:

Full re-balance.

Partial re-balance.

Some issue was found that prevents a re-balance.

In the case of a partial or no re-balance, the modem displays the reason for this result; you
can then adjust an operating parameter and try again.

IMPORTANT NOTES:

You should be aware that after the re-balance has been carried out, it is
very likely that the CnC Ratio will not be at 0dB, and the Eb/No margins will
not be equal. This is particularly true for cases where there is an asymmetry
in antenna size, terminal G/T, symbol rate etc. This is an inherent function
of the re-balancing algorithm, and is not a cause for concern.

You should only attempt to do a re-balance if it is known with certainty that


there are CLEAR SKY conditions at BOTH SIDES OF THE LINK.

It is not necessary for there to be a person at each end the re-balance can
be initiated from either side, with the other side unattended.

Following the re-balance, the CDM-625 stores key parameters, such as Tx Power level, that
are referred to as the Home State. In the event of a loss of communication between the two
sides, the modem will revert to Home State, which is a known safe condition that will not
cause TCP to be exceeded. Once the link conditions have improved so that communication is
re-established, CnC-APC will automatically re-activate.

2) In the second phase of the algorithm, Eb/No, CnC ratio, and RSL are continuously
monitored. For every combination of the modulation, FEC type and FEC code rate, the
modem calculates an Eb/No margin. An Eb/No margin of 0 dB is arbitrarily determined to
be the Eb/No value that produces a BER of 1 x 10-7 at the output of the decoder, plus 1 dB.
If the algorithm senses that Eb/No margin is dropping, power is increased at one or both

1022

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Option MN-CDM625

ends of the link, but in a manner that ensures that TCP is not exceeded. In the vast majority
of cases the TCP during a fade will not exceed its clear-sky value by more than +0.5 dB.

The algorithm uses a number of inputs, from both sides of the link, including a knowledge of
the satellite band in use (which you are required to know at the time of set-up). The
characteristics of rain fading changes with frequency, and there are different models for
C-Band, X-Band, Ku-Band, and Ka-Band. Not only does downlink attenuation vary as a
function rain rate, but in some cases (depending on the G/T of the terminals at each end,
and the satellite transponder itself) may be dominated by an increase in receive noise
temperature when the antenna is pointing through rain and clouds, rather than cold sky.

The depth of fade that the CnC-APC algorithm can tolerate is highly dependent on a number
of factors, including:

The CnC Ratio and Eb/No margins following a re-balance. In general, with a highly
asymmetric link, where CnC Ratio is not close to zero, the tolerance to fade depth
on one side will be less than the other.

The maximum permitted level of power increase that you have defined. If, for
example, you have programmed a TPLImax value of 2 dB (because thats the only
headroom the RF chain has) you should not expect the link to tolerate a fast 10 dB
fade at Ku-Band.

10.6.4 CnC-APC Framing


In order to provide a two-way communications link between the two ends, CnC-APC requires an
overhead channel (very much like EDMAC, or one of its variants, which is used in AUPC).

Recognizing that this overhead needs to have a minimal impact on occupied bandwidth and
Eb/No performance, the overhead has been kept as low as possible:

The overhead rate is fixed at 0.5%, causing the symbol rate of the carrier to grow by an
almost imperceptible amount (no need to re-calculate channel spacing) and causing a
loss of Eb/No performance of only 0.02dB.

This choice of overhead rate effectively gives you the functionality of the CnC-APC
channel without having to pay a penalty in power or bandwidth its essentially free.

The CnC-APC channel constantly passes a number of metrics and parameters, including CnC
Ratio, Eb/No, Receive signal level, power level and max power increase, as well as information
required for the initial set-up, including the modem operating band (L-Band or 70/140 MHz),
and the satellite band in use.

In addition to the information fields in the frame, there is a control field that permits commands
to be sent from one side or the other during initial re-balancing, and re-balancing during fade
events.

1023

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Option MN-CDM625

Note that the CnC-APC frame size (and the latency associated with it) limits the lower end of the
range of bit rates that are supported to 64 kbps. If you select the CnC-APC mode at a data rate
below 64 kbps, an error message will be generated if a re-balance operation is requested.

10.6.5 Solving the Problem of Self-Locking


Self-locking is a problem that has been previously reported to Comtech EF Data Customer
Service on CnC links that have identical data rates, FEC and modulation.

In the case where both ends of the link are up and running, the CnC canceller performs as
intended. However, if the carrier at the remote side stops transmitting a carrier, the CnC
canceller will still cancel the interferer (its own outbound Tx signal), but the cancelation is not
perfect (it may be in the order -30 dB) and hence a weak signal appears at the input to the
demodulator that, because of the correct settings of data rate, FEC and modulation, is
sometimes acquired by the demod. This can sometimes be an issue because, although the Tx
carrier from the distant side is not transmitting, no demodulator alarm is generated and hence
the local end is not alerted and data being transmitted is looped back to the receiver, and back
into the network.

The use of CnC-APC framing provides the means to eliminate the self-locking problem. Rather
than having an identical framing structure for the local and distant sides of the link, by
designating each side as Side A and Side B, each side has a different framing structure and is
therefore non-identical and incompatible. This makes it impossible for a modem in this CnC
mode to lock to itself. With this approach, there is no master-slave relationship both sides
are peers, and either side can be designated as A or B.

10.6.6 CnC-APC Response Time


After CnC-APC is activated, power may be modified at a rate that does exceed once every 1.75
seconds. This rate has been determined by taking into account the round trip satellite delay, the
time taken to accurately determine CnC Ratio and Eb/No following a power adjustment, and the
latency of the CnC-APC frame itself. The overall response time of the control system is therefore
limited by these factors, and deep fading events that exceed approximately 1 dB/second are
likely to be too fast for CnC-APC (or any other classic scheme) to respond to. Users should bear
in mind that these limitations in response time are inherent in schemes involving round-trip
delays from geostationary satellites.

10.6.7 CnC-APC Setup


To set up CnC-APC, carefully follow and understand the steps as presented here.

This procedure should be done only when there are CLEAR SKY conditions at both ends
of the link.

1) Set up the CnC link in normal mode according to the instructions earlier in this chapter, and
according to an appropriately calculated link budget.

1024

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Option MN-CDM625

The initial selection of CnC-APC normally requires that a person be present at both ends, to
coordinate the change of CnC from normal to CnC-APC mode. Alternately, if an IP
connection is available to the distant end that does not depend on the satellite link for
primary connectivity, the setup can be performed remotely.

Once the link is established, a further re-balance, activation or suspension does not require
another person to be present, or independent remote IP access.

2) Once the normal CnC link has been established, determine that the link is stable and that it
has an acceptable link margin at both ends.

3) Decide, arbitrarily, which is Side A, and which is Side B.

4) From the CDM-625 front panel, select the CONFIG CnC Mode menu:

CnC Mode: APC,Side A,C-Band (Off, On, APC)


Activate? N (Y,N) APC is not active ()

On the top line, use the arrow keys to select the appropriate CnC operating mode.
Available selections are:

Off On (normal) APC,Side A,C-Band


APC,Side A,X-Band APC,Side A,Ku-Band APC,Side A,Ka-Band
APC,Side B,C-Band APC,Side B,X-Band APC,Side B,Ku-Band
APC,Side B,Ka-Band

If it is not known which satellite band is being used, no attempt should be


made to engage CnC-APC.

Once the mode has been selected, press ENTER do not select Activate (on the bottom
line) yet.

Note the following:

If Side A is selected at both sides, or Side B is selected at both sides, both modems
will display a Frame Sync fault (under Rx faults). No further action is possible until
this error has been corrected.

If different satellite bands are selected on each side (for instance, Side A is Ku-Band,
while side B is C-Band) the modem will display an APC Band Mismatch fault (under
Rx faults). No further action is possible until this error has been corrected.

5) Based on the known RF terminal equipment in use, determine a value for the maximum
allowed power increase (TPLImax) and then set this value. From the CDM-625 front panel,
select the CONFIG Tx Power menu:

1025

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Option MN-CDM625

Output Power Mode = CnC-Auto-Power-Control


Level = -25.0dBm MaxPwrIncrease=2.5dB ()

On the bottom line, to edit the power output level and the maximum permitted increase in
power level when in APC Mode: Use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit, and then
use the arrow keys to change the value of that digit. Press ENTER when done.

Note that when APC is in an active state, the value of the power level displayed in the
bottom left will show AUTO.

6) Go back to the SELECT: CONFIG CnC MODE menu. On the bottom line, which will be
displaying Activate? N (Y,N ), use the arrow keys to select Y(Yes)and then
press ENTER.

The modem display will update, similar to the following example:

The CnC Mode: APC,Side A,C-Band (Off, On, APC)


Suspend? N (Y,N) OK-ReBalance Done ()

The message on the bottom line can be any one of the following:

Displayed Message Expanded Meaning


OK-ReBalance Done Full re-balance was achieved
OK(P)CnCRatio Lim Partial re-balance, limited by CnC ratio approaching its working limit
OK(P)-LocalPwr Min Partial re-balance, limited by local power approaching its lower limit
OK(P)-LocalPwr Max Partial re-balance, limited by local power approaching its upper limit
OK(P)-LocalPwr Lim Partial re-balance, limited by local power approaching TPLImax
OK(P)-DistPwr Min Partial re-balance, limited by distant power approaching its lower limit
OK(P)-DistPwr Max Partial re-balance, limited by distant power approaching its upper limit
OK(P)-DistPwr Lim Partial re-balance, limited by local power approaching TPLImax
OK(P)-Incomplete Partial re-balance, algorithm did not fully converge
No APC Frame Sync Communication not possible no APC frame sync
Locl EbNo too high The local Eb/No is too high (>16 dB) to determine re-balance params
Dist EbNo too high The distant Eb/No is too high (>16 dB) to determine re-balance params
DistEnd ReBal fail The distant end failed to re-balance
DistEnd NoResponse The distant end failed to respond
Fail-CalcMismatch No Re-balance - the solution calculated by each end does not match
CnC Ratio too high The CnC ratio is too high (>9 dB) for re-balancing to be attempted
LoclMargin too low There is insufficient local Eb/No margin for an APC re-balance

1026

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Option MN-CDM625

Displayed Message Expanded Meaning


DistMargin too low There is insufficient local Eb/No margin for an APC re-balance
Rx DataRate<64kbps The Rx data rate needs to be 64 kbps or higher for APC
Rx DataRate<64kbps The Tx data rate needs to be 64 kbps or higher for APC
Local RSL too low The local RSL is below the minimum for the operating symbol rate
Dist RSL too low The distant RSL is below the minimum for the operating symbol rate

If the message shown begins with OK, then after approximately 5 seconds, the display
changes as per the following example:

The CnC Mode: APC,Side A,C-Band (Off, On, APC)


Suspend? N (Y,N) APC is active ()

At this point, as indicated on the bottom line of the display, CnC-APC is active.

To suspend CnC-APC at any time: On the bottom line, which will be displaying Suspend?
N (Y,N), use the arrow keys to select Y(Yes)and then press ENTER. The CnC-APC
status message on the bottom line of the display will update accordingly, as per the
following example:

The CnC Mode: APC,Side A,C-Band (Off, On, APC)


Activate? N (Y,N) APC is not active ()

Note that, when CnC-APC is suspended, it is de-activated on both sides.

If a message other than OK is displayed after attempting to perform a re-balance, the CnC-
APC system will not activate, and you should correct the link conditions before re-
attempting to activate it.

IMPORTANT NOTE:

When CnC-APC is active, you are not permitted to change configuration


parameters that potentially affect the operation of CnC-APC (modulation type,
FEC type, code rate, framing, etc). If you attempt to change one of these
parameters either locally or remotely, the change will not be accepted. In order
to change these configuration parameters, CnC-APC needs to be suspended first.
Following the changes, you should re-activate CnC-APC. Be aware that the re-
activation will be preceded with a new re-balance operation.

1027

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Option MN-CDM625

10.6.8 CnC-APC Redundancy Support Notes


1. The initial release of the CnC-APC feature (in CDM-625 Firmware Version 2.0.2) fully
supports 1:1 redundancy. Note that, as is required with standard CnC 1:1 redundancy
operation, a PMSI cable is required to connect the two units in a 1:1 pair.

Sect. 5.2.1.8.4 CONFIG: CnC PMSI-Control (Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL


OPERATION)

2. At this time, 1:N redundancy in the CRS-300/CRS-500 is not yet supported a firmware
update for these switches will be available in the future. Please consult Comtech EF Data
Technical Support for updated information.

1028

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Option MN-CDM625

10.7 DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Specifications


Requires the two links to share a common carrier frequency (Outbound and Inbound symbol
Operating Mode
rates do not have to be equal)
Power Spectral Density Ratio BSPK/QPSK/8-PSK/8-QAM: 7 dB to +11 dB (ratio of power spectral density, outbound
and CnC Ratio interferer to desired inbound)

16-QAM: 7 dB to +7 dB (ratio of power spectral density, outbound interferer to desired


inbound)

Note: With asymmetric carriers the absolute power ratio (or CnC ratio) would be different,
depending on the ratio of the symbol rates.

Example:

Outbound interferer = 1 Msymbols/sec

Desired Inbound = 500 ksymbols/sec

Ratio of power spectral density = +7 dB

Absolute power ratio (CnC Ratio) = +7dB + (10 log Outbound/desired symbol rate) = +10 dB
Maximum Symbol Rate Ratio 3:1 (TX:RX or RX:TX)
Inbound/Outbound Within the normal acquisition range of the demod, as follows:
frequency uncertainty
Below 64 ksymbols/sec: 1 to (Rs/2) kHz, where Rs = symbol rate in ksymbols/sec

Between 64 and 389 ksymbols/sec: 1up to a maximum of 32kHz

Above 389 ksymbols/sec: 1 to (0.1Rs) kHz, up to a maximum of 200 kHz


Delay range 0-330 ms

BPSK = 0.3dB QPSK = 0.3dB OQPSK = 0.3dB


Eb/No Degradation 8-PSK = 0.5dB 8-QAM = 0.4dB 16-QAM = 0.6dB
(equal Inbound/Outbound
power spectral density) For +10 dB power spectral density ratio (outbound interferer 10 dB higher than desired
inbound) add an additional 0.3 dB
Delay, in milliseconds

Monitor Functions Frequency offset (between outbound interferer and desired inbound). 100 Hz resolution

CnC ratio, in dB (ratio of absolute power, outbound interferer to desired inbound)


CnC Monitor Accuracy 1.0 dB for symmetric symbol rate

1029

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Option MN-CDM625

10.8 Carrier-in-Carrier Summary


Comtech EF Datas DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier can provide significant savings in operational
expenses. The following should be considered when evaluating DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier:

DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier can only be used for full duplex links where the
transmitting earth station is able to receive itself.

DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier can be used in both bandwidth limited and power limited
situations.

The maximum savings is generally achieved when the original link is symmetric in data
rate.

10.9 Glossary
Bandwidth, Allocated or Occupied

Bandwidth or Allocated Bandwidth or Occupied Bandwidth is the frequency space required by a carrier on
a transponder.

For example: A Duplex 10 Mbps Circuit with 8PSK Modulation, FEC Rate 3/4 and 1.4 Spacing requires:

Allocated BW = (DR / SE) * CSF [(Data Rate / Spectral Efficiency) * Carrier Spacing Factor]

Allocated BW = 6.222 MHz = (10 / 2.25) * 1.4

For a 36 MHz transponder, 6.222 MHz corresponds to 17.3% Bandwidth Utilization.

Bandwidth, Leased (LBW)

Almost all satellite operators charge for the Leased Bandwidth (LBW). Leased Bandwidth or Leased
Resource is the greater of the Allocated Bandwidth and Power Equivalent Bandwidth.

For example: If a carrier requires 3 MHz of Allocated BW and 4.5 MHz of PEB, the Leased Bandwidth is 4.5
MHz

Bandwidth, Power Equivalent (PEB)

Power Equivalent Bandwidth (PEB) is the transponder power used by a carrier, represented as bandwidth
equivalent.

PEB Calculation Example:

Transponder EIRP = 37 dBW

Output Backoff (OBO) = 4 dB


3.3
Available EIRP = 37 4 = 33 dBW = 10 = 1995.26 Watts

1030

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Option MN-CDM625

Transponder Bandwidth = 36 MHz

Power Available / MHz = 1995.26 / 36 = 55.424 W

2.4
If a carrier uses 24 dBW, its PEB = 10 / 55.424 = 4.532 MHz

This corresponds to 12.59% of available transponder power.

CnC Ratio

Ratio of Interfering Carrier Power to Desired Carrier Power (unit in dB).

The Interfering Carrier is the Tx Carrier from local modulator; the Desired Carrier is the carrier from the
distant end received by the local demodulator.

At the station transmitting C1: CnC Ratio (in dB) = PowerC1 (in dBm) PowerC2 (in dBm)

Eb/No
Ratio of Energy per bit (Eb) to Noise density (No) (unit in dB):

Eb/No = C/No 10log(DR) [where DR is the Data Rate]

Eb/No = Es/No 10log(SE) [where SE is Spectral Efficiency]

Es/No

Ratio of Energy per symbol (Es) to Noise density (No) (unit in dB):

Es/No = C/No 10log(SR) [where SR is the Symbol Rate]

Es/No = Eb/No + 10log(SE) [where SE is Spectral Efficiency]

C/N
Ratio of Carrier Power (C) to Noise (N) (unit in dB):

Equivalent to Es/No when calculated in the Symbol Rate bandwidth.

C/No

Ratio of Carrier Power (C) to Noise Density (No) (unit in dBHz)

1031

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier Option MN-CDM625

Co+No/No

Ratio of Carrier Density (Co) + Noise (No) to Noise Density (No) (unit in dB):

C/N = C/No 10log(B) [where B is bandwidth in Hz]

Eb/No = C/No 10log(DR) [where DR is data rate in bits/sec]

= C/N + 10log(B) 10log(DR)

= C/N 10log(SE) [where SE is Spectral Efficiency]


((Co+No/No)/10)
Eb/No = 10log (10 1) 10log(SE) [where SE is Spectral Efficiency]

[Note: Spectral Efficiency is in bps / Hz]

Power Spectral Density (PSD)


Power Spectral Density (PSD) is the signal power per unit bandwidth: dBW / Hz or dBm / Hz

For example: Signal power = 20 dBm

Signal bandwidth = 5 MHz

PSD = 20 10 *log (5,000,000) = -46.99 dBm / Hz

PSD Ratio

Ratio of Power Spectral Density (PSD) of the interfering carrier to the desired carrier.

If looking at the two carriers side-by-side on a spectrum


analyzer:

Quasi Error Free (QEF)


-7
Quasi Error Free (QEF) corresponds to PER ~10

[Note: PER (packet error rate) is based upon a 188-byte MPEG frame size]

Spectral Efficiency (SE)


Ratio of the Data Rate to the Symbol Rate.

Symbol Rate & Data Rate

Symbol Rate and Data Rate are related:

DR = SR * SE [Data Rate = Symbol Rate * Spectral Efficiency]

SR = DR / SE [Symbol Rate = Data Rate / Spectral Efficiency]

1032

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


Chapter 11. EDMAC CHANNEL
11.1 Theory of Operation

11.1.1 EDMAC
EDMAC is an acronym for Embedded Distant-end Monitor And Control. This feature permits
user access to the M&C features of modems that are at the distant-end of a satellite link. This is
accomplished by adding extra information to your data, but in a manner that is otherwise
transparent.

On the transmit side:

The data is split into frames each frame containing 1008 bits (except Rate 21/44 BPSK Turbo,
or when the data rates exceed 2048 kbps, where the frame length is 2928 bits, and Rate 5/16
BPSK Turbo where the frame length is 3072 bits). 48 bits in each frame are overhead, and the
rest of these bits are user data. This increases the rate of transmission by 5% (approximately
1.5% for the Turbo BPSK cases, and for all data rates greater than 2.048 Mbps). For example, if
the user data rate is 64 kbps, the actual transmission rate will now be at 67.2 kbps. Note that
you may also select EDMAC-2 framing, which always uses a 2928 bit frame, and yields a 1.6%
overhead for all modulation types and data rates.

At the start of each frame, a 12-bit synchronization word is added. This allows the demodulator
to find and lock to the start of frame. At regular intervals throughout the frame, additional data
bytes and flag bits are added (a further 36 bits in total). It is these additional bytes that convey
the M&C data.

When framing is used, the normal V.35 scrambler is no longer used. This V.35 approach is called
self synchronizing because no external information is required in the receiver in order for the
de-scrambling process to recover the original data.

The disadvantage of this method is that it multiplies errors. On average, if one bit error is
present at the input of the descrambler, three output errors are generated. However, there is an
alternative when the data is in a framed format: in this case, a different class of scrambler may
be used one that uses the start of frame information to start the scrambling process at an
exact known state.

In the receiver, having synchronized to the frame, the de-scrambler can begin its processing at
exactly the right time. This method does not multiply errors, and therefore has a clear

111

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
EDMAC Channel MN-CDM625

advantage over V.35 scrambling. This is fortunate, as there is a penalty to be paid for adding the
framing: by adding the extra 5% to the transmitted data rate, the effective Eb/No that is seen
will degrade by a factor of 10log(1.05), or 0.21 dB (0.07dB in the case of the two BPSK Turbo
rates or EDMAC-2).

The use of an externally synchronized scrambler and descrambler almost exactly compensates
for this degradation. The net effect is that you will see effectively identical BER performance,
whether or not framing is used.

On the receive side:

When the demodulator locks to the incoming carrier, it must go through the additional step of
searching for and locking to the synchronization word. This uniquely identifies the start of
frame, and permits the extraction of the overhead bytes and flag bits at the correct position
within the frame. Additionally, the start of frame permits the de-scrambler to correctly recover
the data: your data is extracted and sent through additional processing in the normal manner.
The extracted overhead bytes are examined to determine if they contain valid M&C bytes.

11.1.2 Drop & Insert ++


A new variation of EDMAC is available with D&I++ framing. With this, each frame contains 2944
bits, with 64 overhead bits and 2880 user data bits. The portion of the overhead used for the
EDMAC link performs identically to that of the EDMAC frame, but because D&I++ uses a smaller
overhead, the two modes are not compatible with each other.

11.1.3 EDMAC-3
EDMAC-3 is another variation of EDMAC, which uses the same rate exchange as the original
EDMAC frame:

21/20 (5%) at 2048 kbps and below

61/60 (1.6%) above 2048 kbps

With EDMAC-3, however, the EDMAC channel operates at 1/3 the rate of original EDMAC
because most of the overhead is dedicated to carrying the remote modems complete status
information (including AUPC), so that it is available to the near-end modem at nearly real-time
speed. EDMAC-3 is best suited for SNMP proxy applications.

11.2 M&C Connection


Data to be transmitted to the distant-end is sent to a local unit via the remote control port. A
message for the distant-end is indistinguishable from a local message it has the same
structure and content, only the address will identify it as being for a distant-end unit.

112

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
EDMAC Channel MN-CDM625

Before the M&C data can be successfully transmitted and received, pairs of units must be split
into EDMAC Masters and EDMAC Slaves. Masters are local to the M&C Computer, and Slaves are
distant-end.

Now, a unit that has been designated an EDMAC master not only responds to its own unique
bus address, but it will also be configured to listen for the address that corresponds to its
EDMAC Slave. When a complete message packet has been received by the EDMAC Master, it will
begin to transmit this packet over the satellite channel, using the overhead bytes that become
available.

The normal protocol for the message packet is not used over the satellite path, as it
is subject to errors. For this reason, a much more robust protocol is used which
incorporates extensive error checking.

At the distant-end, the EDMAC slave, configured for the correct address, receives these bytes,
and when a complete packet has been received, it will take the action requested, and then send
the appropriate response to the EDMAC Master, using the return overhead path on the satellite
link. The EDMAC Master assembles the complete packet, and transmits the response back to the
M&C Computer.

Apart from the round-trip satellite delay, the M&C Computer does not see any difference
between local and distant-end units it sends out a packet, addressed to a particular unit, and
gets back a response. It can be seen that the EDMAC Master simply acts as forwarding service, in
a manner that is completely transparent.

This approach does not require any additional cabling; connection is made using the normal
M&C remote port. Furthermore, you do not have to worry about configuring the baud rate of
the M&C connection to match the lowest data rate modem in the system. The M&C system can
have mixed data-rate modems, from 18 kbps to 25 Mbps, and still run at speeds in excess of
19200 baud. It should be pointed out that, at 18 kbps, the effective throughput of the overhead
channel is only 56 asynchronous characters/second. For a message of 24 bytes, the time
between sending a poll request and receiving a response will be around 1 second. (Note that
when EDMAC-2 or either of the BPSK Turbo rates is in use, the overhead rate is reduced by a
factor of three, and therefore the response time will be around 3 seconds.)

113

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
EDMAC Channel MN-CDM625

11.3 Setup Summary


To access a distant-end unit:

Designate a Master/Slave pair: Master at the local-end, Slave at the distant-end.

On the local-end unit, enable framing and EDMAC, define the unit as MASTER, then
enter the bus address. This is constrained to be base 10' meaning that only addresses
such as 10, 20, 30, 40 etc, are allowed.

Choose a unique bus address for the distant-end. This should normally be set to the
base 10' address + 1. For example, if the MASTER unit is set to 30, choose 31 for the
distant-end unit.

On the distant-end unit, enable framing and EDMAC, define the unit as SLAVE, then
enter the bus address. The orange EDMAC Mode LED on the modem front panel should
be illuminated.

Set the local-end unit to RS485 remote control, and set the bus address of this local unit.
The orange Remote Mode LED on the modem front panel should be illuminated.

Once the satellite link has been established, connect the M&C Computer, and begin
communications with both the local and distant end units.

EDMAC modes are fully compatible with AUPC modes.

114

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


Chapter 12. ESC++
12.1 Introduction
ESC is an acronym for Engineering Service Channel. The ESC++ mode of operation is a closed
network frame structure that combines Automatic Uplink Power Control (AUPC) with a high
speed asynchronous order-wire channel. AUPC works identically to what is offered with EDMAC
and D&I++ framing, but is not compatible with either because ESC++ framing uses a different
overhead percentage than the other closed network framing modes.

12.2 Overhead Details


Baud rates from 1200 to 38400 bits/sec are offered using EIA-232 or EIA-485 format. Three data
formats are available: 8-N-1 (eight data bits, no parity, and one stop bit), 7-E-2 (seven data bits,
even parity, and two stop bits), and 7-O-2 (seven data bits, odd parity, and two stop bits). The
9-pin ESC port is used for this data channel (see Sect. 3.2.2.5 ESC (DB-9F) in Chapter 3. REAR
PANEL CONNECTORS AND PINOUTS for more information).

Because 38400 baud is the maximum rate available, the actual overhead percentage for ESC++
framing changes as the data rate increases, thereby saving bandwidth at high data rates. The
added overhead is as follows:

Data rate Overhead ratio (percentage)


64 kbps to < 768 kbps 19/17 (11.76%)
768 kbps to 1.5 Mbps 12/11 (9.09%)
> 1.5 Mbps to 2.5 Mbps 29/27 (7.4%)
> 2.5 Mbps to 7 Mbps 19/18 (5.56%)
> 7 Mbps 64/63 (1.58%)

Note that 64 kbps is the minimum data rate allowable with ESC++. Depending upon code rate
and modulation used, the modems maximum data rate of 25 Mbps may be used with ESC++. In
all cases, if the Reed-Solomon outer codec is used, the 126/112 ratio is employed with ESC++.
The new frame structure may be used with any FEC codec type available with the CDM-625.

121

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
ESC++ MN-CDM625

12.3 Available Baud Rates


At the lowest data rates, the 11.76% overhead may not allow all baud rates. Available rates
are as follows:

Data rate Baud rates available


64 to 127.999 kbps 1200, 2400, 4800
128 to 191.999 kbps 1200 to 9600
192 to 255.999 kbps 1200 to 14400
256 to 383.999 kbps 1200 to 19200
384 to 511.999 kbps 1200 to 28800
512 kbps and above 1200 to 38400

12.4 Configuration

Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION

Use the SELECT: Configure Mode menu to select ESC++. Then, use the SELECT: Configure
Misc HiRateESC menu select the baud rate and asynchronous character format.

12.5 Effect on Eb/No Performance


Because the increase in transmitted data rate will cause a decrease in the Eb/No performance
particularly at lower data rates where the percentage overhead is large all of the published
data concerning BER versus Eb/No needs to be modified according to the table that follows:

Data rate Overhead ratio (percentage) Eb/No degradation


64 kbps to < 768 kbps 19/17 (11.76%) 0.48 dB
768 kbps to 1.5 Mbps 12/11 (9.09%) 0.38 dB
> 1.5 Mbps to 2.5 Mbps 29/27 (7.4%) 0.31 dB
> 2.5 Mbps to 7 Mbps 19/18 (5.56%) 0.23 dB
> 7 Mbps 64/63 (1.58%) 0.07 dB

The degradation is simply 10 x log (Overhead ratio).

The Eb/No displayed by the modem (SELECT: Monitor RX-Params) takes this into account in
the value that is calculated.

122

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


Chapter 13. OFFSET QPSK
OPERATION
OQPSK is an acronym for Offset Quadrature Phase Shift Keying modulation. OQPSK is a variation
of normal QPSK that is offered in the CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem. Normal band limited
QPSK produces an RF signal envelope that necessarily goes through a point of zero amplitude
when the modulator transitions through non-adjacent phase states. This is not considered to be
a problem in most communication systems, as long as the entire signal processing chain is
linear.

However, when band limited QPSK is passed through a non-linearity (e.g., a saturated power
amplifier), there is a tendency for the carefully filtered spectrum to degrade. This phenomenon
is termed spectral regrowth, and at the extreme (hard limiting), the original unfiltered sin(x)/x
spectrum would result. In most systems, this would cause an unacceptable level of interference
to adjacent carriers, and would cause degradation of the BER performance of the corresponding
demodulator.

To overcome the problem of the envelope collapsing to a point of zero amplitude, Offset QPSK
places a delay between I and Q channels of exactly 1/2 symbol. Now, the modulator cannot
transition through zero when faced with non-adjacent phase states; the result is that there is far
less variation in the envelope of the signal, and non-linearities do not cause the same level of
degradation.

The demodulator must realign the I and Q symbol streams before the process of carrier recovery
can take place. For various reasons, this makes the process of acquisition more difficult. In the
CDM-625, the two consequences of this are as follows:

1. Demodulator acquisition may be longer than standard QPSK, especially at low symbol
rates.

2. The acquisition threshold is slightly higher than for normal QPSK. This effect is only an
issue for LDPC Rate 1/2 and TPC Rate 21/44 code rates, where the Eb/No values are
typically less than 2 dB. In this case, the acquisition and tracking threshold is
approximately 1dB higher than for QPSK.

131

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Offset QPSK Operation MN-CDM625

Notes:

132

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


Chapter 14. OPEN NETWORK
OPERATIONS
14.1 Overview
This chapter summarizes the functionality and specifications of the IBS, Drop and Insert (D&I),
and IDR Open Network framing modes.

14.2 IBS
Primary Data Rates Supported
G.703 1544, 2048, 6312 and 8448 kbps SD, RD
EIA-422, V.35, LVDS N x 64 kbps SD, RD (up to 8448 kbps)
ADPCM Audio (2 Channels) 64 kbps only, full duplex

Engineering Service Channel


Earth Station-to-Earth EIA-232 data synchronous at 1/480 of the primary data
Station Channel EIA-232 data asynchronous at 1/2000 of the primary data

High Rate Engineering Service Channel


Async configurable asynchronous character format, EIA-232 at up to
ESC Data Interface Type
1/20th of primary data rate
ESC Data Rate Example: 2400 baud at 64 kbps

Faults and Alarms


Satellite Backward Alarm 1 (per IESS-309)
Receive BWA Output Enabled onto terrestrial secondary alarm

141

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Open Network Operations MN-CDM625

14.2.1 IBS Clock/Data Recovery and De-jitter


This feature performs clock and data recovery on the G.703 format. Clock de-jitter and data
encoding/decoding is done as with the IDR configuration.

14.2.2 IBS Framing


IBS Framing multiplexes/demultiplexes the primary data in compliance with the standard IESS-
309 overhead ratio of 1/15 (4 overhead bytes per 60 data bytes) and provides the rate
exchanged transmit clock to the modulator portion of the base modem.

14.2.3 IBS Engineering Service Channel


The IBS Engineering Service Channel provides bi-directional processing of the components of the
ESC channel, including the ASYNC or SYNC EIA-232 data channel, and fault/alarm indications.

Alternately, a high-rate ESC channel at up to 1/20th of the primary data rate is available,
using Async EIA-232 format.

14.2.4 IBS Scrambling


IBS Scrambling provides the synchronous scrambling/descrambling of the satellite-framed data
specified in IESS-309. Base modem scrambling/descrambling is disabled in this mode.

142

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Open Network Operations MN-CDM625

14.3 Drop and Insert (D&I)

Primary Data Rates Supported


G.703, EIA-422, V.35 and Serial 1544 kbps SD, RD, DDO, IDI
LVDS 2048 kbps SD, RD, DDO, IDI
N x 64 kbps
Satellite Data Rates Supported N = 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 8, 10, 12, 15, 16, 20, or 24 (T1)
(all have 16/15 overhead) N = 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 8, 10, 12, 15, 16, 20, 24, or 30 (E1-CCS)
N = 1, 2, 4, 6, 8, 12, 16, 24, 30 (E1-CAS)
Terrestrial Framing Supported G.732/G.733, G.704
16/15 of data rate per IESS-308 Rev. 6 and IESS-309 Rev. 3, or
Satellite Overhead Rate
higher
1 to 24 (all T1 modes)
Timeslot Selection Range 1 to 30 (E1-CAS and E1-CCS)
Arbitrary order, non-contiguous available
Selectable size of 64 to 262,144 bits, in 16-bit steps (with added
Plesiochronous Buffer Sizes
limitations for G.704 frame boundaries)
Derived from Insert Data In (Insert Clock)
Buffer Clock Reference
External, RX (satellite) or TX (Terrestrial)

Asynchronous Engineering Service Channel


ESC Data Interface Type EIA-232, Asynchronous
ESC Data Rate 1/2000 of primary data rate
ESC Data Circuits Supported SD, RD, DSR

Synchronous Engineering Service Channel


ESC Data Interface Type EIA-232, synchronous to primary data
ESC Data Rate 1/480 of primary data rate
ESC Data Circuits Supported SD, ST, RD, RT, DSR

Faults and Alarms


Satellite Backward Alarm 1 (per IESS-309)
Receive BWA Output Enabled onto terrestrial secondary alarm

143

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Open Network Operations MN-CDM625

14.3.1 D&I Primary Data Interfaces


When configured for D&I operation, multiplexing/demultiplexing follows the IBS satellite frame
structure and ESC features, but with the following changes:

It accepts and outputs primary data through the G.703 connectors.

The data rate must be at T1 or E1 rates only. This includes additional links for Drop Data
Out and Insert Data In.

Clock recovery, dejitter, and encoding/decoding are performed as before.

14.3.2 D&I Framing


The IBS satellite framing/deframing is applied only to selected time slots of the datas G.704
terrestrial structure.

144

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Open Network Operations MN-CDM625

14.4 IDR

Primary Data Rates Supported


G.703 1544 kbps SD, RD
EIA-422 (Replaces 8K Overhead) 2048 kbps SD, RD
V.35 (Replaces 8K Overhead) 6312 kbps SD, RD
8448 kbps SD, RD

Engineering Service Channel


ESC Audio 2 duplex ADPCM channels
Audio Encoding CCITT G.721
Audio Interface Type 600 transformer-balanced 4-wire
Nominal Input : 0dBm0 (-3dBm, 600)
Audio Input Level
Adjustment range: -6 to +8 dB, 2 dB steps
Audio Output Level Adjustment range: -6 to +8 dB, 2 dB steps
Audio Filtering Internal 300 to 3400 Hz input and output
ESC Data Interface Type EIA-422
ESC Data Rate 8 kbps, also 64 kbps if ADPCM audio is not used
ESC Data Circuits Supported SD, ST, RD, RT, Octet in, Octet out
Per EIA-449, data changes on the rising clock transition, is
Data Signal Phasing
sampled on the falling clock edge
Octet Timing Octet high with every 8th bit, aligns with frame bit d8

Faults and Alarms


Backward Alarms Supported 4 input, 4 output
Backward Alarm Inputs 1 k pull up to ground, set high to activate.
Backward Alarm Outputs Form C Relay, N/O, N/C, Com

145

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Open Network Operations MN-CDM625

14.4.1 IDR Primary Data Interfaces


When configured for IDR operation, the board performs these functions:

It receives and performs clock and data recovery on incoming G.703 T1 and E1 pseudo-
ternary data.

Clock dejitter is performed per G.823 and G.824, and any data decoding (AMI, B8Z5, or
HDB3) required per G.703 is also accomplished.

It performs IDR Framing.

It multiplexes in compliance with the standard IESS-308 96 kbps ESC overhead onto the
data and provides both the data and rate-exchanged clock to the modulator portion of
the base modem.

It performs the corresponding demultiplexing of Rx satellite data received from the


demodulator portion of the modem. Resulting G.703 data is optionally encoded (AMI,
B8ZS, or HDB3) before being output.

14.4.2 IDR Engineering Service Channel


It provides for bidirectional processing of the components of the ESC channel, including
the ADPCM audio channels, 8 kbps data channel, and fault indications specified by IESS-
403 and IESS-308.

It provides the option of using the ADPCM portion of the satellite overhead for a single
64 kbps ESC data channel in addition to (and with the same format as) the 8 kbps data
channel.

When using G.703 format for the primary IDR data path, the P3B primary data interface
(25-pin) is used for the 8kbps overhead channel. If EIA-422 or V.35 is used, P3B becomes
the primary interface and the 8kbps channel is unavailable.

146

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


Chapter 15. IP SUB-MUX
15.1 Introduction
Subsystem Multiplex referred to throughout this manual as Sub-Mux is a secondary
framing structure that combines IP traffic with any currently available combination of framing
and interface type (excluding IP itself). The composite data rate to the modulator and from
the demodulator is referenced to the primary, non-IP interface rate by a specific ratio selected
by the user.

15.2 Available Ratios


The IP portion of the modem traffic can be either smaller or larger than the primary interface by
the following ratios:

Ratio IP Portion of Modem Traffic


1/59 IP traffic is one-fifty-ninth the primary
1/39 IP traffic is one-thirty-ninth the primary
1/19 IP traffic is one-nineteenth the primary
1/9 or 9 IP traffic is one-ninth the primary, or 9 times the primary
1/8 or 8 IP traffic is one-eighth the primary, or 8 times the primary
1/7 or 7 IP traffic is one-seventh the primary, or 7 times the primary
1/6 or 6 IP traffic is one-sixth the primary, or 6 times the primary
1/5 or 5 IP traffic is one-fifth the primary, or 5 times the primary
1/4 or 4 IP traffic is one-fourth the primary, or 4 times the primary
2/7 or 7/2 IP traffic is two-sevenths the primary, or 3.5 times the primary
1/3 or 3 IP traffic is one-third the primary, or 3 times the primary
2/5 or 5/2 IP traffic is two-fifths the primary, or 2.5 times the primary
3/7 or 7/3 IP traffic is three-sevenths the primary, or 2.33 times the primary
1/2 or 2 IP traffic is one-half the primary, or 2 times the primary
3/5 or 5/3 IP traffic is three-fifths the primary, or 1.66 times the primary
2/3 or 3/2 IP traffic is two-thirds the primary, or 1.5 times the primary
3/4 or 4/3 IP traffic is three-fourths the primary, or 1.33 times the primary
4/5 or 5/4 IP traffic is four-fifths the primary, or 1.25 times the primary
1/1 IP traffic equals the primary

151

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
IP Sub-Mux MN-CDM625

This gives you 34 ratios from which to choose. If framing is on, the overhead associated with the
selected frame structure is applied to the primary data only, and the IP ratios above are
fractions of the framed primary data.

IP ratios that put the composite rate above the maximum data rate of the modem cannot be
selected. For example if the primary rate is 8192.000 kbps and the maximum rate of the modem
was 25000.000 kbps, then a ratio above 2 cannot be selected. Also, if Sub-Mux is on and the
primary rate is raised so the composite rate goes above the maximum of the modem, then the
IP ratio will be lowered so that the composite rate stays below the maximum.

15.3 Data Rate vs. Composite Rate


Without Sub-Mux, the CONFIG: Tx and CONFIG: Rx front panel menu screens display the
modems transmit and receive data rates, which refer to the terrestrial rate of the primary
interface type. Additions to the primary data due to framing are not shown, but are reflected in
the displayed symbol rates.

Once Sub-Mux is enabled, the data rate display is replaced with the composite rate. This is the
sum of the primary interfaces data rate which now includes framing overhead and the IP
rate at the selected ratio. The later is displayed by itself as IP INFO Rate under the CONFIG: Tx
Tx Data Rate or CONFIG: Rx Rx Data Rate submenu. Note that Reed-Solomon overhead, if
enabled, is also included in the composite rate calculation.

(See Sect. 5.2.1.3 CONFIG: Tx or Sect. 5.2.1.4 CONFIG: Rx and their respective subsections in
Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION for detailed information).

Example: For a G.703 E1 primary interface, with a 4/5 Sub-Mux ratio selected:

Unframed
Primary data rate = 2048.000 kbps
IP info rate = 2048 x 4/5 = 1638.400 kbps
Composite rate = 2048 + 1638.4 or 2048 x 9/5 = 3686.400 kbps

Add ESC++ framing (added to El path only)


Data rate with overhead = 2048 x 29/27 = 2199.703 kbps
IP info rate = 2199.703 x 4/5 = 1759.762 kbps
Composite rate = 2199.703 + 1759.762 or 2199.703 x 9/5 = 3959.466 kbps

Add Reed-Solomon FEC (added after Sub-Mux)


Composite rate = 3959.466 x 126/112 = 4454.400 kbps

The Sub-Mux frame does contain a very small overhead required for acquisition and
identification of primary vs. IP data: As this overhead is taken from the "IP info rate" rather
than the primary data rate, actual IP throughput will be slightly reduced.

152

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


Chapter 16. ETHERNET
NETWORK CONFIGURATION
16.1 Introduction
The CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modems handling of Ethernet terrestrial traffic data differs
depending on whether the optional IP Packet Processor is either not installed or installed but
disabled; or when the optional IP Packet Processor is installed and enabled.

Chapter 18. IP PACKET PROCESSOR OPTION

This chapter explains the CDM-625s Ethernet interface and illustrates the functional differences
between the available operating modes. Additional modes of operation are also explained.

16.2 CDM-625 Ethernet Overview

16.2.1 Interface Architecture

Figure 16-1. CDM-625 Ethernet Architecture Design


Figure 16-1 shows the internal Ethernet architecture for the CDM-625. The CDM-625 features
four built-in 10/100 BaseT Ethernet Ports (port configuration and statistics are available on a
per-port basis) connected to a single internal Ethernet Layer 2 Managed Switch.

161

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet Network Configuration MN-CDM625

16.2.2 Modes of Ethernet Operation


The Ethernet interface is configurable for Managed Switch Mode when the optional IP Packet
Processor is either not installed or installed but disabled; or in Router Mode or Managed
Switch Mode when the optional IP Packet Processor is installed and enabled.

This interface design allows for multiple customer Ethernet interfaces, as well as the
convenience of daisy-chaining together of multiple CDM-625s.

Additionally, because the M&C processor is connected to the internal Ethernet Switch, M&C
traffic is available via all LAN interfaces as well as via the over-the-air WAN interface.

16.2.3 Ethernet Networking Loops


It should be noted that care must be taken to avoid Ethernet Networking Loops. Specifically,
the network operator must make sure to avoid connecting multiple ports of the CDM-625 to the
same external Ethernet switch, as shown in Figure 16-2.

Figure 16-3 shows a simplified version of this loop. As shown here, two switches have been
connected each switch has two or more separate connections. This is not how the CDM-625s
Ethernet switches are designed to be used, and this configuration will cause a network outage.

Figure 16-2. Improper Use of External Ethernet Switch with CDM-625

Figure 16-3. Ethernet Networking Loop Example (Simplified)

162

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet Network Configuration MN-CDM625

16.2.3.1 Networking Loops in Managed Switch Mode

16.2.3.1.1 Hub-to-Hub using Ethernet Switches


When connecting two or more hub-sites where there are multi-paths between each site, care
must be taken to ensure that no Ethernet Networking Loops occur. Figure 16-4 shows two hub-
sites connected with two or more modems, where all the traffic being transmitted and received
is on the same LAN/VLAN. Since there is no router in the network and all the traffic is destined
to the same network, an Ethernet Networking Loop has been created.

Figure 16-4. Networking Loop Example

163

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet Network Configuration MN-CDM625

16.2.3.1.2 Hub-to-Hub using Ethernet Routers


Figure 16-5 shows two hub-sites connected with standard Ethernet traffic, using routers instead
of switches for the Ethernet connection. The routers will block the broadcasts coming from the
remote network; therefore, the creation of a broadcast storm is prevented and there is no
possibility of having a remote MAC on the Hub networks.

Figure 16-5. Hub-to-Hub with Standard Traffic using Routers

164

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet Network Configuration MN-CDM625

16.2.3.1.3 Hub-to-Remotes using Ethernet Switches or Routers


Figure 16-6 shows a hub-to-remotes configuration using switches or routers with standard
Ethernet traffic, the routers/switches will block broadcasts coming from the hub and remote
networks; therefore, the creation of a broadcast storm is prevented and there is no possibility of
having a remote MAC on the Hub networks.

Figure 16-6. Hub-to-Remotes with Standard Traffic using Routers or Switches

165

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet Network Configuration MN-CDM625

16.2.3.2 Networking Loops in Router Mode (with IP Packet Processor)


In a network where more than one CDM-625s working mode is set to Router Multipoint Hub,
care must be taken in route table configuration to avoid Ethernet Networking Loops. Figure 16-7
shows Point-to-Multipoint configuration using the optional IP Packet Processor.

When a CDM-625s working mode is configured as Router Multipoint Hub, the modem is
allowed to egress on the WAN interface the same packet as was originally ingressed from the
WAN interface. This is necessary to allow the Point-to-Multipoint configuration.

However, configuring more than one modem as a Router Hub across the WAN Interface, then
adding default routes on either side or any other invalid routes will cause the same packet to
ping-pong between these two modems until TTL times out.

Figure 16-7. Point-to-Point Configuration in Router Multipoint Hub Working Mode

166

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet Network Configuration MN-CDM625

16.3 Ethernet Network Configurations in Managed Switch Mode

16.3.1 P oint-to-Multipoint Hub-to-R emotes , S plit-path Traffic Us ing R outers


Figure 16-8 shows hub-to-remotes configuration using routers with standard and split-path
Ethernet traffic. A Static ARP Entry is needed in the switch so that routing of the Tx side of the
modems will be on the correct port of the router. For example, the Rx side of the Ethernet
connection for Traffic Modem #N comes in the bottom port of the Router, but the Tx Ethernet
connection must be connected through the same port as Traffic Modem #1, as shown in this
figure.

Figure 16-8. Point-to-Multipoint using Routers

167

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet Network Configuration MN-CDM625

16.3.2 P oint-to-Multipoint Hub-to-R emotes , S plit-path Traffic Us ing


S witches
With switches used, the hub and remote are on the same subnet as shown in Figure 16-9,
meaning that broadcasts will be allowed to transverse the network. Learning Mode must be
disabled on the Hub Tx/Rx modem, because if a computer on the remote sends a broadcast out
to the Hub, the modem learns that MAC is local when in fact it is not.

Figure 16-9. Point-to-Multipoint using Switches

168

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet Network Configuration MN-CDM625

16.4 Ethernet Network Configurations in Router Mode (with IP Packet


Processor)

16.4.1 Point-to-Multipoint (Router Multipoint Hub) Mode


Figure 16-10 depicts a Point-to-Multipoint (Router Multipoint Hub) setup, with the optional IP
Packet Processor installed and enabled in the CDM-625 and configured for Router Mode. This
configuration features a Hub Outbound CDM-625, with a rack of Hub Demods (Rx-only
CDM-625s are connected on single LAN networks), and Remotes (each) connected to a separate
LAN network).

Figure 16-10. Point-to-Multipoint (Router Multipoint Hub Mode)

16.4.1.1 Router Multipoint Hub Configuration


To configure a Router Multipoint Hub Network:

For the Hub Outbound Modem Configuration:

o Referring to Sect. 6.5.4.3.2.1 Configuration | LAN | IP in Chapter 6. ETHERNET-


BASED PRODUCT MANAGEMENT: From the pages Network Configuration
section, use the Working Mode drop-down menu to select the mode as Router
Multipoint Hub, and then click [Submit] to accept this configuration change.

o Referring to Sect. 6.5.4.3.3.1 Configuration | Routing | Routes in Chapter 6.


ETHERNET-BASED PRODUCT MANAGEMENT: From the pages Add New Route

169

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet Network Configuration MN-CDM625

section, add a route entry for each remote subset. Make sure to select toWAN
from the Interf. drop-down menu (this defines the route as LAN WAN).

Click [Add Entry] once each route is created.

For the Hub Demod Modem Configurations:

o Referring to Sect. 6.5.4.3.2.1 Configuration | LAN | IP in Chapter 6. ETHERNET-


BASED PRODUCT MANAGEMENT: From the pages Network Configuration
section, use the Working Mode drop-down menu to select the mode as Router
Multipoint Hub, and then click [Submit] to accept this configuration change.

o Referring to Sect. 6.5.4.3.3.1 Configuration | Routing | Routes in Chapter 6.


ETHERNET-BASED PRODUCT MANAGEMENT: From the pages Add New Route
section, add a route for each remote subset. First, make sure to select toLAN
from the Interf. drop-down menu (this defines the route as WAN LAN); then,
when assigning the Next Hop IP address, make sure it is identical to the Hub
Outbound modems IP address.

Click [Add Entry] once each route is created.

For the Remote" Modem Configurations:

o Referring to Sect. 6.5.4.3.2.1 Configuration | LAN | IP in Chapter 6. ETHERNET-


BASED PRODUCT MANAGEMENT: From the Network Configuration section, use
the Working Mode drop-down menu to select the mode as Router Multipoint
Remote, and then click [Submit] to accept this configuration change.

o Referring to Sect. 6.5.4.3.3.1 Configuration | Routing | Routes in Chapter 6.


ETHERNET-BASED PRODUCT MANAGEMENT: Add a default LAN route entry
using the pages Add New Route section. First, specify the Hub Outbound
modems IP address as the gateway address, and then select toWAN from the
Interf. drop-down menu (this defines the route as LAN WAN).

Click [Add Entry] once the route is created.

1610

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet Network Configuration MN-CDM625

16.4.2 Multicast Routing Mode


Multicast Routing Mode, available when the optional IP Packet Processor is installed and
enabled, is where communications is established via one single source (referred to as the
Multicast Sender) and routed to many groups of destination nodes (referred to as Multicast
Receivers). Typical multicast applications include multimedia conferencing, online training,
news, etc. Figure 16-11 depicts the schematic for a Multicast Routing Network.

Figure 16-11. Multicast Routing Diagram

As shown, there are two key components to this configuration the LAN Downstream
Interface, and the WAN Upstream Interface. Observe the following:

LAN Downstream Interface the LAN Downstream Interface is the interface to which
multicast packets arriving at the upstream interface are forwarded if a multicast group
has at least one listener.

The CDM-625 LAN interfaces are configured as Downstream Interface and


the IGMP server is enabled by default.

WAN Upstream Interface the WAN Upstream Interface is where all multicast packets
are forwarded to the uplink interface if the multicast routing exists in the Routing table.

The CDM-625 WAN interface is configured as Upstream Interface by


default.

1611

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet Network Configuration MN-CDM625

16.4.2.1 Multicast Routing Configuration

Figure 16-12. Configuration Example for a Multicast Routing Network

To configure a Multicast Routing Network (Figure 16-12):

For Hub Outbound Modem Configuration Referring to Sect. 6.5.4.3.3.1


Configuration | Routing | Routes in Chapter 6. ETHERNET-BASED PRODUCT
MANAGEMENT: Add a multicast route (using the pages Add New Route section),
making sure to select toWAN from the Interf. drop-down menu (this defines the route
as LAN WAN). Click [Add Entry] once the route is created.

For Remote Modem Configuration Referring to Section 6.5.4.3.3.2 Configuration |


Routing | IGMP in Chapter 6. ETHERNET-BASED PRODUCT MANAGEMENT: From the
pages IGMP Multicast Router section, edit the IGMP parameters to suit the multicast
receivers capabilities (i.e., version number and query intervals).

1612

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet Network Configuration MN-CDM625

16.5 Ethernet Overhead over WAN Interface

16.5.1 Managed Switch Mode (without IP Packet Processor)


When the optional IP Packet Processor is either not installed or installed but disabled: After
Ethernet packets are sent from the internal switch to the modem WAN interface, the link
overhead per packet is as follows:

1 Byte (HDLC Start Flag) + 2 Bytes HDLC Control + 14 Bytes


Ethernet Header + Ethernet Payload + 2 Bytes HDLC CRC

Additionally, on average, an additional 3% of overhead is added to account for HDLC bit stuffing.

16.5.2 Router Mode or Managed Switch Mode (with IP Packet Processor)


When the optional IP Packet Processor is installed and enabled: The CDM-625 uses Comtech EF
Datas patented Streamline Encapsulation (SLE) Framing instead of HDLC Framing.

Note that in SLE Framing, no bit stuffing overhead is involved; hence, WAN overhead is
deterministic. After Ethernet packets are sent from the internal switch to the IP Packet
Processor interface, per packet overhead on the WAN Interface is as follows:

1 Byte SLE start Flags + Control Byte(s)+ Ethernet Payload


(IP + UDP + payload; IP + TCP + payload; etc.) + 2 bytes
CRC

For Control Byte(s)note the following:

If payload compression or header compression or both are enabled, Control


Byte(s)= 2 bytes;

If Segmentation and Reassembly (SAR) is enabled, Control Byte(s)= 2 bytes;

Otherwise, Control Byte(s)= 1 byte.

1613

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet Network Configuration MN-CDM625

16.6 Ethernet Redundancy


Once you have determined the best configuration for near-to-far end Ethernet networks, you
may add the appropriate redundancy switches to one or both ends of the link(s):

1:1 Redundancy is supported using either a CRS-170A L-Band 1:1 Redundancy Switch or
a CRS-180 70/140 MHz 1:1 Redundancy Switch, and a user-provided, off-the-shelf
Ethernet switch.

1:N Redundancy is supported using a CRS-300 1:10 Redundancy Switch or a CRS-500


M:N Redundancy System in 1:N mode (in a wired-thru or wired-around configuration),
and is supported in Single-Port Ethernet Bridge (Managed Switch) and Router Modes
(the optional IP Packet Processor is required for Router Mode).

Packet Processor Redundancy is supported in both 1:1 and 1:N redundant


configurations using the CRS-500 M:N Redundancy System.

Refer to the pertinent switch Installation and Operation Manuals for detailed information on
using the CDM-625 in a redundancy configuration.

1614

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet Network Configuration MN-CDM625

16.7 Advanced Network Timing

16.7.1 Overview
The Advanced Network Timing (ANT) feature provides IP-based protocols to synchronize the
modem's internal time-of-day clock to an external device such as a time server, Base Station
Controller (BSC), or Radio Network Controller (RNC).

16.7.2 SNTP (Simple Network Time Protocol)


The Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP), defined in RFC-1361, provides millisecond-
resolution time synchronization with a time server. When the modem synchronizes its time, it also
synchronizes the time of all connected EDMAC devices, such as slave LPODs or CSATs. When all
devices are synchronized, administrators can better correlate logged events between devices.

SNTP is a UDP protocol that works on port 123. If the modem is not updating its time, verify that
there are no network devices between the modem and time server that might block UDP packets
on that port.

16.7.3 PTP (Precision Time Protocol)


1. At p resent, P TP i s n ot supported i n m odems i n w hich th e o ptional I P
Packet Processor is installed and enabled.

2. For better PTP clock accuracy, ingress and egress port sync interval shall
be at least 2 seconds.

The Precision Time Protocol is used to synchronize clocks throughout a computer network.
Based on the IEEE 1588v2 (2008) standard, PTP achieves clock accuracy in the nanosecond range
much more accurate than what is attainable by NTP (Network Time Protocol) and it is also
used in network applications where GPS is either unaffordable or inaccessible.

Comtech EF Datas implementation of PTP in the CDM-625 operates over IP, without the
presence of the optional IP Packet Processor. To achieve high accuracy time and frequency
synchronization, PTP relies on hardware time stamping at the ingress and egress ports of the
network; therefore, all devices in the network must support PTP.

Figure 16-13 shows a typical network configuration. Here, the RNC/BSC (Radio Network
Controller/Base Station Controller) at the near-end side of the network and the BTS (Base
Transceiver Station) on the distant-end side of the network are the IEEE 1588v2-capable devices.
In this topology the RNC/BSC serves as the Grandmaster the root timing reference that
transmits synchronization information to the clocks residing on its network segment or slave
to the Grandmaster.

1615

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet Network Configuration MN-CDM625

Figure 16-13. Configuration Example Point-to-Point Network with PTP


Without PTP implementation and support in the modem, it is very difficult to achieve PTP end-
to-end (RNC BTS) time synchronization in nanosecond range due to the presence in the
network of variable delay components such as QoS (Quality of Service) buffer, Rx/Tx FIFOs,
Satellite Doppler, etc.

The CDM-625 bridges PTP from LAN to WAN and vice versa, and uses 2-step synchronization
(i.e., it sends both Sync and Follow-up messages when acting as a master). When negotiating
with devices over the LAN interface, the modem uses UDP multicast PTP messages on UDP Port
319 for events, and UDP Port 320 for general packets. On the WAN interface, the modem uses
UDP Port 59319 for events, and UDP Port 59320 for general packets.

Some devices use the Announce message to negotiate which is the PTP master, a process known
as the Best Master Clock (BMC) algorithm. This algorithm allows PTP devices to vote on which
device has the best clock resolution. The CDM-625 will become a PTP master if there is no
Grandmaster device or the Grandmaster is not reachable.

You must configure the modem for the Grandmaster location:

When the modem can reach the Grandmaster device only through its LAN interface, set
Grandmaster to LAN.

When Grandmaster is LAN, then the modem knows it must become a slave to the
Grandmaster on the LAN interface, and will set its PTP Clock Priority1 value to 255 (the
lowest).

1616

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet Network Configuration MN-CDM625

When the modem must synchronize with the Grandmaster over the WAN interface, set
Grandmaster to WAN.

When Grandmaster is WAN, the modem will set its PTP Clock Priority1 value to 1 (the highest)
to force slave devices that use the BMC algorithm to accept the modem as the PTP master.

Symbol Designation Function

M Master The Master device maintains the clocks.

S Slave The Slave device synchronizes its clock to the Master devices clock.

The r oot t iming r eference t hat transmits s ynchronization i nformation t o t he c locks


Grandmaster
residing on its network segment.

Figure 16-14. PTP Master/Slave Assignment Example

As shown in Figure 16-14:

The first segment is between the RNC/BSC and the CDM-625 A (near-end modem) LAN
port. In this segment, the RNC/BSC is the master, and the near-end modem LAN port is
the slave.

Using the CDM-625 A front panel or its Web Server Interface, set the PTP Grandmaster
on this near-end modem as LAN.

The second segment is from the CDM-625 A (near-end modem) WAN port to the
CDM-625 B (distant-end modem) WAN port, in which the near-end modem WAN port
is the master and the distant-end modem WAN port is the slave.

Using the CDM-625 B front panel or its Web Server Interface, set the PTP Grandmaster
on this distant-end modem as WAN.

1617

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Ethernet Network Configuration MN-CDM625

Accordingly, the third segment between the CDM-625 B (distant-end modem) LAN
port and the BTS defines the distant-end modems LAN port as the master and the BTS
as the slave.

As configured here, each modem has established independent Wireless Receiver/Transmitter


(WRT) protocol segments one for LAN and other one for WAN. This defines the boundary clock
time distribution configuration, where the slave to one interface provides a master clock to the
other interfaces.

1618

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


Chapter 17. ADAPTIVE CODING
AND MODULATION (ACM)

17.1 Introduction
The VersaFEC Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM) feature is a patents-pending technology,
wholly owned and developed by Comtech EF Data and CEFD sister division Comtech AHA Corp. It
serves as a very significant operational enhancement for the CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem:

ACM turns fade margin into increased link capacity gains of 100% or more are
possible, compared to traditional Constant Coding and Modulation (CCM). This is
accomplished by automatically adapting the modulation type and FEC code rate to give
highest possible throughput.

ACM maximizes throughput regardless of link conditions (noise or other impairments,


clear sky, rain fade, etc). Initial setup is easy, and then requires no further user
intervention.

With a CCM system, severe rain fading can cause the total loss of the link, and zero
throughput. ACM keeps the link up (with lower throughput) and can yield much higher
system availability.

ACM in the CDM-625 is used in conjunction with VersaFEC and is currently for IP traffic
only.

The VersaFEC ACM feature requires Firmware Version 1.4.0 or later, the VersaFEC plug-in module,
and the appropriate FAST codes.

171

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM) MN-CDM625

17.2 Background
ACM is not a new concept. It has been used for some time in wireless communications, including
terrestrial microwave applications and, more recently, over satellite links. Its primary function is to
optimize throughput in a wireless data link, by adapting the modulation order used and the
Forward Error Correction code rate both of which directly affect spectral efficiency (expressed in
bits per second per Hertz) according to the noise conditions (or other impairments) on the link.
Implicit in this concept is that the symbol rate (and power) of the wireless communication system
must remain constant. This ensures that the bandwidth allocated for a particular link is never
exceeded.

Given that the symbol rate does not change, if modulation and coding are changed, the data
rate must therefore be modified. This is expressed in the simple equation:

Symbol rate = bit rate / (modulation order * code rate)

For example, for Rate 3/4 QPSK (where modulation order = 2):

Symbol rate = bit rate * 0.666

Re-arranging: Bit rate = symbol rate * modulation order * code rate

So, in changing to a higher modulation order or code rate, the bit rate is increased, and in
changing to a lower modulation order or code rate, the bit rate is reduced.

However, there are a number of important factors to be considered, namely:

The digital communications system must be able to tolerate a change in bit rate.
Synchronous serial interfaces (such as G.703 E1, which operated at a fixed data rate of
2.048 Mbps) are totally unsuitable in a scheme where data rate is changing. The only
practical application for this scheme is a packet-based scheme that will tolerate a
change in data rate, and which has mechanisms within its protocols to recognize when
increased or reduced bandwidth is available. The best example of this is Ethernet, and
this discussion is limited to schemes that employ it.

The bit rate cannot be changed arbitrarily. The link noise conditions, described in terms
of Eb/No or SNR, must be able to support reliable communications for the given
modulation order and code rate. This is a key point, as in fact, the link SNR is the input
that drives the adaptation.

172

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM) MN-CDM625

17.3 Requirements for ACM


A generic example of ACM-over-Satellite is shown in Figure 17-1. There are a number of
essential requirements for enabling this scheme:

a) A modulator and FEC encoder that can instantaneously, when commanded, change
either modulation type (order) or FEC encoder rate, or both. This needs to be
accomplished without the corruption of data anywhere in the path. Block FEC codes are
considered to be the most practical in achieving the required synchronization. Recently,
a specific nomenclature has emerged to describe a combination of a modulation type
and code rate namely, ModCod (also referred to as Mod/Code). The modulator is
required to send the value of ModCod at the start of each code block to signal the
demodulator/decoder how to configure for the correct modulation type and FEC code
rate.

b) A receiver that is capable of demodulating and decoding the signal transmitted by a)


without any a priori knowledge of when a change has taken place, but based purely on
the value of ModCod seen at the start of each FEC block. Again, this needs to be
accomplished without the corruption of data anywhere in the path.

c) The receiver in b) needs to derive an estimate of the link quality (in terms of Eb/No, SNR,
etc) and then communicate this estimate, via a return channel, to the modulator in a).

d) The modulator in a) needs to able to process the link quality metric from the
demodulator in b), and then, based upon a pre-determined algorithm, adapt the data
rate and change the ModCod sent to the receiver at the distant end. Thus, the data rate
on the link can be maximized, given the current link noise conditions.

173

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM) MN-CDM625

Figure 17-1. ACM-over-Satellite Generic Example

174

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM) MN-CDM625

17.4 An Existing Satellite ACM Scheme


The best-known scheme for ACM-over-Satellite is covered in the DVB-S2 specification (EN 302307)
ratified by ETSI in March 2005. While primarily for digital video broadcast, the DVB-S2
specification also encompasses two-way interactive services.

A summary of the main transmission aspects follows:

Four modulation types are defined: QPSK, 8PSK, 16APSK and 32APSK.

The primary FEC type is low-density parity check coding (LDPC), concatenated with a
short BCH code.

The 8PSK, 16APSK, and 32APSK modulation types use interleaving.

There are ten code rates defined: 1/4, 1/3, 2/5, 1/2, 3/5, 2/3, 3/4, 4/5, 5/6, 8/9 and
9/10, which depend on the modulation type and other system requirements.

A single FEC block may be 64800 bits (normal, referred to as 64k blocks) or 16200 bits
(short, referred to as 16k blocks)

Adaptive coding and modulation is defined for optimizing satellite transponder capacity.

Hughes Network Systems (Germantown, MD) have commercially deployed DVB-S2 with ACM
over satellite.

17.5 Disadvantages of DVB-S2


While the scheme defined by DVB-S2 is undoubtedly very effective for many broadcast and
higher data rate applications, it is definitely not a one size fits all solution. Some of the
disadvantages are as follows:

Excessive latency. The so-called short blocks are too long for low latency IP applications
at low data rates. This is exacerbated by the addition of interleaving.

Overly complex in its implementation. The design of DVB-S2 dictated that all FEC blocks
should be constant in bits. This means that for each ModCod, there are a varying
number of symbols. This then makes the task of synchronization a much more
demanding task. Also, because of the limitations of tracking the higher-order
modulations in a very low SNR environment, so-called pilot symbols were added in
order to aid tracking.

Concatenated BCH code added to mitigate the problem of error rate flaring and
flooring. This is no longer necessary. Since the introduction of the original LDPC/BCH
scheme, an enormous amount of research has been done on the design of LDPC codes.

175

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM) MN-CDM625

Most importantly, however, LDPC codes can now be designed that yield almost
equivalent coding gain, but with considerably shorter block lengths.

In an ACM mode, no overhead channel was defined by DVB-S2 for the purpose of
reporting SNR metrics to the originating end. It has been left to individual equipment
manufacturers to decide their own method. This illustrates that all ACM systems,
DVB-S2 or not, are proprietary. In addition, it implies that additional bandwidth needs to
be consumed for the SNR reporting, and this is not accounted for in the code rate.

17.6 VersaFEC ACM


VersaFEC (a registered trademark of Comtech AHA), in concert with a novel ACM approach,
addresses all of the shortcomings of DVB-S2 outlined above. There are patents pending for both
VersaFEC and the ACM scheme.

VersaFEC covers a family of 12 short-block LDPC ModCods, specifically designed for low latency
and ACM applications. However, the VersaFEC codes are equally well suited to Constant Coding
and Modulation (CCM) applications.

The requirements for an ACM system that approaches the minimum possible latency are:

The shortest possible LDPC codes that give performance at or very close to DVB-S2, in
order to minimize latency, and which do not use interleaving.

Encoder design that further reduces latency to the minimum possible.

A constant number of symbols per block, to reduce the demodulator and decoder
complexity, and significantly, also reduces latency in the ACM case.

The elimination of the need for pilot symbols for carrier tracking at low SNR by
substitution of other modulation techniques. This further reduces the complexity of the
demodulator.

Reduction in the number of ModCods that further reduces complexity.

The inclusion, at the physical layer, of an overhead channel to permit the reporting of
SNR metrics back to the originating end. Note that this does not have to be enabled or
disabled it is part of the fundamental frame structure of VersaFEC ACM, and has been
take into account in the code rate.

The family of VersaFEC short-block LDPC codes is presented in Table 17-1. The modulation types
include BPSK, QPSK, 8-QAM, and 16-QAM. It will be seen from the table that in order to
maintain a constant number of symbols per block, the block size in bits (data + parity) must
necessarily change, depending on both the modulation type (which affects the number of bits
per symbol) and the code rate. For VersaFEC, the block size varies between 2k and 8.2k bits. At
worst, therefore, the VersaFEC codes are 50% shorter than the short DVB-S2 codes.

176

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM) MN-CDM625

Table 17-1. The VersaFEC ModCod set


Spectral Typical Latency at Min. Max.
Code Block
Modulation efficiency, Eb/No, for 64 kbps, in Data Rate, Data Rate,
Rate size, bits
bps/Hz BER = 5 x 10-8 milliseconds CCM mode CCM mode
BPSK 0.488 0.49 2k 2.4 dB 26 18 kbps 5.7 Mbps
QPSK 0.533 1.07 4.1k 2.2 dB 53 20 kbps 10 Mbps
QPSK 0.631 1.26 4.1k 2.7 dB 59 23 kbps 10 Mbps
QPSK 0.706 1.41 4.1k 3.4 dB 62 26 kbps 10 Mbps
QPSK 0.803 1.61 4.1k 3.8 dB 66 28 kbps 12 Mbps
8-QAM 0.642 1.93 6.1k 4.6 dB 89 35 kbps 12 Mbps
8-QAM 0.711 2.13 6.1k 5.2 dB 93 39 kbps 12 Mbps
8-QAM 0.780 2.34 6.1k 5.6 dB 97 43 kbps 12 Mbps
16-QAM 0.731 2.93 8.2k 6.3 dB 125 53 kbps 12 Mbps
16-QAM 0.780 3.12 8.2k 7.0 dB 129 57 kbps 14 Mbps
16-QAM 0.829 3.32 8.2k 7.5 dB 131 60 kbps 14 Mbps
16-QAM 0.853 3.41 8.2k 8.0 dB 132 62 kbps 16 Mbps

The VersaFEC codes compared with the Shannon bound are shown below in Figure 17-2. It can be
seen that the performance of VersaFEC at or near the DVB-S2 performance with 16 kbit blocks.

Note that SNR is used in place of Eb/No, a convention for comparing ACM ModCods. SNR is
defined as Eb/No + 10log (Spectral Efficiency).

Figure 17-2. VersaFEC Codes vs. Constrained Capacity

177

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM) MN-CDM625

17.7 VersaFEC ACM Latency


In an ACM system that has a number of ModCods, each having a different latency, what defines
the overall system latency? The answer is simple the latency of the worst-case ModCod. (This
may not seem obvious to some, and it is beyond the scope of this chapter to provide a rigorous
defense of this statement. It is, however, a correct statement despite certain believers in non-
causal systems and encoders that possess the magical quality of negative latency)

Examining the data in Table 17-2, latency for each ModCod is shown for the example of
VersaFEC ACM at a fixed 100 ksymbols/second rate. Of particular note is that even though the
ModCods span a 7:1 variation in throughput, the latency is only varying between 25 and 34
milliseconds. A careful analysis will show that this is a consequence of using a constant number
of symbols per block. In the example shown the worst-case latency for this ACM scheme is 34
milliseconds, + WAN Buffer delay (which is configurable, with a minimum value of 20ms).
Table 17-2. VersaFEC Implementation of ACM 100 ksymbols/sec Example Case
Minimum Latency,
Spectral efficiency,
ModCod Modulation Code Rate Bit rate (throughput) In milliseconds,
bps/Hz
for each ModCod
0 BPSK 0.488 0.49 49 kbps 34 + WAN BUFFER
1 QPSK 0.533 1.07 107 kbps 32 + WAN BUFFER
2 QPSK 0.631 1.26 126 kbps 30 + WAN BUFFER
3 QPSK 0.706 1.41 141 kbps 28 + WAN BUFFER
4 QPSK 0.803 1.61 161 kbps 26 + WAN BUFFER
5 8-QAM 0.642 1.93 193 kbps 30 + WAN BUFFER
6 8-QAM 0.711 2.13 213 kbps 28 + WAN BUFFER
7 8-QAM 0.780 2.34 234 kbps 27 + WAN BUFFER
8 16-QAM 0.731 2.93 293 kbps 27 + WAN BUFFER
9 16-QAM 0.780 3.12 312 kbps 26 + WAN BUFFER
10 16-QAM 0.829 3.32 332 kbps 25 + WAN BUFFER
11 16-QAM 0.853 3.41 341 kbps 25 + WAN BUFFER
OVERALL SYSTEM LATENCY = Worst-case ModCod (ModCod0)
Latency = 34 milliseconds + WAN Buffer delay

By way of comparison, consider the same 100 ksymbols/second rate, but this time using DVB-S2. It
becomes clear that there is an unintended penalty (besides demodulator complexity) to having a
constant number of bits per block. Each time the ModCod is lowered and the throughput is
reduced, the latency grows accordingly due to the block size being related to data rate, not symbol
rate.

Remembering that, for the ACM case, the system latency is equal to the latency of the worst-case
ModCod, DVB-S2 shows a severe penalty. For 16k short blocks, this calculates to be 329
milliseconds (+ WAN Buffer delay) versus 34 milliseconds (+ WAN Buffer delay) for VersaFEC ACM.
For 64k block DVB-S2, the core latency is 4 times higher. Assuming a WAN Buffer of 20
milliseconds:

Latency for 64k block DVB-S2 ACM at 100 ksps = 1336 milliseconds

178

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM) MN-CDM625

Latency for 16k block DVB-S2 ACM at 100 ksps = 349 milliseconds

Latency for VersaFEC ACM at 100 ksps = 54 milliseconds

For the example shown, the latency for a 16k block DVB-S2 ACM scheme is
approximately 7 times higher than VersaFEC ACM.

The latency for a 64k block DVB-S2 ACM scheme is approximately 25 times
higher than VersaFEC ACM.

17.8 Configuring VersaFEC ACM in the CDM-625

VersaFEC ACM requires the correct hardware module (PL-0000264) to be installed


in the CDM-625, Version 1.4.0 (or higher) firmware, and the appropriate FAST code
for the maximum operating symbol rate.
Configuration is very straightforward from the CDM-625 front panel. For a detailed overview of
modem operations via the front panel, refer to Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION.

Follow these steps to configure the CDM-625 for VersaFEC ACM operation:
Step Task Front Panel VFD Mnemonic
1 (SELECT) CONFIG: MODE Mode:Tx=IP-ACM:None Rx=IP-ACM:None
Set the Tx and Rx modes as IP-ACM. (422,V35,G703s,Audio,LVDS,HSSI,IP,ASI)

2 (SELECT) CONFIG: TX SYMB Tx-IF Freq Power FEC Mod Symb Scrambler
Enter the desired transmit symbol rate. Note that (Data 00192.000kbps, 00131.657ksps)()
this is a fundamental departure from the way in
which the modem is typically configured.
TxSymbolRate = 01000.000 ksps (ACM Mode)
Data Invert=Off Clock Invert=Off ()

3 (SELECT) CONFIG: TX POWER Output Power: Mode= Manual (Fixed)


Enter the desired transmit output level. Level= 20.0 dBm ()

The Transmit symbol rate is limited by the FAST code installed.


There are three options:

37 ksps to 300 ksps 37 ksps to 1200 ksps 37 ksps to 4100 ksps


4 (SELECT) CONFIG: RX SYMB RxIF Freq FEC Demod Symb Descram Eq EbNo
Enter the desired receive symbol rate. (Data 02048.000kbps,02184.533ksps)()

Note that asymmetric operation is supported -


transmit and receive symbol rates do not have to be RxSymbolRate = 01000.000 ksps (ACM Mode)
equal. Data Invert=Off Clock Invert=Off ()

5 (SELECT) CONFIG: ACM CONFIG: All Mode Tx Rx Clocks ACM


Configure the desired ACM operating parameters, CnC EDMAC Misc Mask Remote IP ()
by selecting the ACM submenu from the CONFIG:
menu branch.
ACM Config: Min/Max-ModCod Unlock-Action
Proceeding from the CONFIG: ACM submenu: Target-EbNo-Margin ()

179

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM) MN-CDM625

Step Task Front Panel VFD Mnemonic


i. Min/Max-ModCod: Define t he r ange o f Min Modcod: 00 (B 0.488 0.488 bps/Hz)
ModCods ov er which t he s ystem w ill op erate. Max Modcod: 00 (B 0.488 0.488 bps/Hz)
ModCod0 is BPSK Rate 0.488 (0.49 bps/Hz), while
ModCod11 is 16-QAM Rate 0.853 (3.41 bps/Hz).

If you wish to constrain the system to run at a fixed ModCod, set the Min and Max ModCod
values to be equal.

The value of Max ModCod may be limited by other FAST codes installed. For example, suppose
the 4100 ksps FAST option is installed, and the symbol rate set to 4100 ksps, the theoretical
maximum data rate would be 14 Mbps at ModCod 11. However, is CnC is being used, with a 10
Mbps FAST limit, the ACM Max ModCod will be limited to ModCod 7, or 9.6 Mbps.

ii. Unlock-Action: Choose the d esired action When distant-end demod loses lock:
when t he remote demod l oses l ock. T his i s Go to min Tx ModCod (Maintain,Min) ()
important, as t he ACM s ystem depends o n t he
feedback of t he S NR me tric f rom the r emote
demod t o d etermine t he op timum M odCod. T he
choices are:

Go to min Tx ModCod (recommended)


or Maintain Tx ModCod

5 iii. Target Eb/No margin: This i s a V ERY


(cont) important parameter. The ACM system is designed Target Eb/No Margin = 1.0 dB (0.0 4.5)
to switch based on thresholds that correspond to a ()
BER of 5 x 10 -8 for each Mo dCod. However, i n
order to prevent oscillation around two ModCods at
this e xact v alue, 0 .3 dB o f hy steresis has been
added. T he s witch points a nd t he h ysteresis a re
shown in Figure 17-3:

Figure 17-3. CDM-625 ACM ModCod Switch Points

1710

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM) MN-CDM625

The graph shows the switch points with the Target Eb/No margin set to 0dB. However, the
switch points can be moved (increased) by configuring the Target Eb/No margin parameter,
which can vary from 0 to 4.5 dB, in 0.5dB steps. In a fading environment it is highly
recommended to add sufficient margin to maintain an adequate link quality (and to maintain
demod lock) during the interval between the Eb/No degrading and the ACM controller
responding by lowering the ModCod. See Sect. 17.11 Notes and Recommendations.

To continue with the configuration:


Step Task Front Panel Mnemonic
6 (S E L E C T ) C ONF IG : IP S witc h-s et-up Ethernet Switch: Mode WAN PerPortCnfg
WAN MAC-Learning VLAN Qos Stats ()
Enter the desired s ize o f t he W AN B uffer. T he
minimum size is 20 mi lliseconds, and is referred to
the data rate corresponding to ModCod0. In order
to achieve minimum system latency, do not make
this value unnecessarily large.

17.9 Monitoring ACM performance


The CDM-625 provides several ways to determine the current state of the ACM system.

Use the front panel menu to select MONITOR: ACM. The current Tx and Rx ModCod, along with
the Local and Remote SNR, are displayed here. The SNR displays values between 3.0 dB and
+22.0 dB, with a resolution of 0.1 dB. If either the local or remote demod is unlocked, the SNR
will show No Sync. Of course, under MONITOR: Rx PARAMETERS, the Eb/No continues to be
displayed corrected for modulation type and code rate, in case you do not wish to deal with SNR
values.

If you wish to see the exact detail of the ModCod (data rate, modulation, code rate), then these
parameters can be seen under INFO: TX or INFO: Rx. Furthermore, if you are in a CONFIG: TX or
CONFIG: RX screen, both the symbol rate and data rate are displayed. All of these screens
update dynamically, so if a ModCod changes, the parameters are refreshed.

This information is also available through the Remote Control (serial interface), as well as the
Web Server, SNMP and Telnet interfaces.

If you wish to use the Constellation over Ethernet application that comes with the released
code, it is also informative to see the demodulator changing type on the fly. With no noise, and
a modem in a loop on itself, you may wish to experiment with Min and Max ModCod values to
drive the adaptation.

Alternately, if you have access to an Oscilloscope in X-Y mode, the Alarms connector provides
analog voltages to monitor the constellation. This has the advantage that it will show a change
in modulation type instantaneously, unlike the Constellation over Ethernet application, which
only updates once per second.

1711

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM) MN-CDM625

If you wish to verify that link performance is meeting the required level, the internal BERT tester
is an excellent tool. When using the IP interface it is not an easy matter to verify BER
performance, but the internal BERT will not only do this, but is also tolerant of the change in bit
rate that accompanies a change in ModCod. The BERT can be used to confirm that there are no
sync losses or bursts of bit errors when a ModCod changes.

17.10 ACM Congestion Control


When the ACM controller switches from a lower to a higher ModCod the bandwidth of the
Ethernet link is instantaneously increased. This is not a problem, and the link will adapt to push
more packets/second through the link.

Conversely, when the ACM controller switches from a higher to a lower ModCod the bandwidth
of the Ethernet link is instantaneously reduced. Unless the FIFO in the WAN encapsulator is
configured to be very large, the FIFO will tend to overflow, and packets will be lost before the
network recognizes that there is congestion, and reduces the rate at which packets are sent.

In order to mitigate packet loss when bandwidth is reduced, the CDM-625 ACM system
incorporates a method for congestion control. This is illustrated in Figure 17-4:

Figure 17-4. CDM-625 ACM Congestion Control


The WAN FIFO (the size of which is configurable in the IP Switch setup) produces two control
signals that enable and disable the sending of Ethernet Pause Frames. A Pause Frame is an
Ethernet frame designed to implement flow control at the MAC layer. A switch supporting
802.3x can send a Pause Frame (with Pause time set to 0xFFFF) to force the link partner to stop
sending data. Devices use the Auto-Negotiation protocol to discover the Pause Frame
capabilities of the device at the other end of the link.

In the diagram it can be seen that when the WAN FIFO reaches a fill state of 87%, it signals the
Ethernet Switch to send Pause frames back to the LAN to inhibit the sending of further data. The
Pause Frames continue to be sent until the FIFO fill state has reduced to 75%. At this point,
normal operation in resumed by sending a Pause Frame with Pause time set to 0x0000.

1712

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM) MN-CDM625

This mechanism has been shown to be very effective at mitigating packet loss when the ACM
controller reduces bandwidth.

17.11 Notes and Recommendations

VersaFEC ACM is for point-to-point applications. It is required that both directions on the link
run in IP-ACM mode, although the symbol rates do not need to be equal. If you wish to
constrain one direction to run in CCM, simply set the Min and Max ModCod to be equal.

ACM constitutes a closed-loop control system (similar in concept to AUPC) and it should be
remembered that like all control systems, the speed at which the system can react is governed
by a number of factors, including the time taken to estimate SNR to the required accuracy,
and the transport delay over the satellite. Realistically, it can cope with fading and other link
impairments that do not exceed 1dB/second (more if Target Eb/No margin is increased).

The ACM controller algorithm that resides in the CDM-625 modem does not have to switch
through ModCods sequentially it can change, if needed, directly from ModCod0 to
ModCod11 (or vice versa). When the demod first locks at ModCod0 the ACM controller will
examine the SNR from the remote end and switch directly to the ModCod that maximizes
throughput.

While ACM can do remarkable things, the fundamentals still apply. Dont expect the demod to
run at a 16-QAM ModCod if the SNR instantaneously drops to 0dB the demod will lose lock
and the system will recover by switching to ModCod0 (if so configured). We highly
recommend setting the Minimum ModCod to 0 (the ModCod of last resort) and set the
Unlock Action to Go to minimum ModCod. This will give the most robust link performance.

When running in ACM mode the demodulator is performing blind acquisition meaning that it
has no a priori knowledge of the modulation type or code rate. For this reason the
demodulator acquisition time will be slower than in CCM mode. However, the acquisition time
is typically under 1 second for all symbol rates and noise conditions.

Running the ACM link with the Target Eb/No Margin set to 0dB will give the best utilization
of link power, but in conditions of fast fading may cause demod unlock events, or highly
degraded BER just prior to the switch to a lower ModCod. In order to mitigate this, we
recommend a Target Eb/No Margin of at least 1dB more if the fading events are
particularly severe and/or frequent.

The value of Max ModCod may be limited by other FAST codes installed in the CDM-625. For
example, suppose the 4100 ksps FAST option is installed, and the symbol rate set to 4100
ksps, the theoretical maximum data rate would be 14 Mbps at ModCod 11. However, if CnC
is being used with a 10 Mbps FAST limit, then ACM Max ModCod will be limited to ModCod
7, or 9.6 Mbps. Therefore, if it is not possible to set the Maximum ModCod to the desired
value for a given symbol rate, you should check to determine what other FAST codes may be
limiting it.

1713

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM) MN-CDM625

The BER versus Eb/No performance of the ModCods is identical to the VersaFEC CCM modes
described in the FEC Options Chapter.

SNR is the preferred metric for driving the adaptation this is the value displayed on the
monitor screens. If you want to convert this to Eb/No then remember that the relationship is
simply Eb/No = SNR - 10log (Spectral Efficiency).

To achieve minimum latency, set the WAN buffer to the smallest practical value. The default
setting is 20ms, and we recommend keeping it at this level.

At this time Comtech EF Data has chosen to disable AUPC while ACM is active. This may
change in the future, but for now, ACM should be considered to be a constant power,
constant symbol rate scheme.

All IP features that are available in the CDM-625 (VLAN, QoS, etc) are available when in IP-
ACM mode. The Sub-Mux feature, however, is not available.

VersaFEC ACM is 100% compatible with Carrier-in-Carrier.

If required, VersaFEC ACM may be used in conjunction with any of the EDMAC modes, either
for serial remote control of the remote modem, or for SNMP proxy. It should be emphasized,
however, that unlike AUPC, a framing mode is not required for SNR reporting.

ACM maximizes throughput not only when Eb/No varies due to atmospheric conditions, but
will also mitigate the effects of other impairments, such as antenna pointing error, excessive
phase noise and certain types of interference. However, rapidly fluctuating impairments (~
less than 1 second) such as scintillation at low antenna look-angles at C-band will generally not
be improved by ACM.

VersaFEC ACM modes are not compatible with VersaFEC CCM modes, due to differences in
frame preambles.

The CDM-625 was purposely architected to provide the platform for VersaFEC ACM, and has
required new approaches to the signal processing employed in both modulator and
demodulator. It is the intention of Comtech EF Data to include VersaFEC ACM in future
modem platforms.

1714

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM) MN-CDM625

17.12 VersaFEC ACM Summary of Specifications


Adaptive Coding and Modulation, using BPSK, QPSK, 8-QAM , 16-QAM and
System type
VersaFEC short-block LDPC coding - total of 12 ModCods
Symbol Rate Range 37 ksps to 4100 ksps

Interface 10/100 Base T Ethernet, with auto-negotiated Congestion Control


Automatically reported from remote modem built in function at the physical
Remote SNR reporting
layer requires no additional overhead
Max span of data rate 7:1 over range of adaptation

Switch point (decreasing SNR) Corresponds to SNR (Eb/No) that gives BER = 5 x 10-8

Switch point hysteresis 0.3 dB

Max fading rate Approximately 1 dB/second (higher if Target Eb/No margin > 1 dB)

Max ModCod update rate 1 update every 2 seconds (no restriction on distance between ModCods)
Minimum and Maximum ModCod (ModCod0 through ModCod11)
Remote Demod Unlock Action: Maintain current ModCod
Configurable parameters
Go to minimum ModCod
Target Eb/No margin (0 to 4.5 dB, 0.5 dB steps)
54 milliseconds max (for a system operating at 100 ksps, and assuming a WAN
System latency
buffer of 20 milliseconds, not including satellite path)
Tx and Rx ModCods
Local and Remote SNR
Monitored parameters (-3.0 dB to +22.0dB, 0.1dB resolution, +/- 0.5 dB accuracy)
Config and monitor menus displaying data rate, modulation and code rate update
dynamically with ModCod
Typical
Spectral Efficiency, Min. Data Rate, Max. Data Rate,
Modulation Code Rate Eb/No, for
bps/Hz ACM mode ACM mode
BER = 5 x 10-8
BPSK 0.488 0.49 2.4 dB 18.1 kbps 2.00 Mbps

QPSK 0.533 1.07 2.2 dB 39.6 kbps 4.38 Mbps

QPSK 0.631 1.26 2.7 dB 46.7 kbps 5.16 Mbps

QPSK 0.706 1.41 3.4 dB 52.2 kbps 5.78 Mbps

QPSK 0.803 1.61 3.8 dB 59.6 kbps 6.60 Mbps

8-QAM 0.642 1.93 4.6 dB 71.5 kbps 7.91 Mbps

8-QAM 0.711 2.13 5.2 dB 78.8 kbps 8.73 Mbps

8-QAM 0.780 2.34 5.6 dB 86.6 kbps 9.59 Mbps

16-QAM 0.731 2.93 6.3 dB 108.5 kbps 12.01 Mbps

16-QAM 0.780 3.12 7.0 dB 115.5 kbps 12.79 Mbps

16-QAM 0.829 3.32 7.5 dB 122.8 kbps 13.61 Mbps

16-QAM 0.853 3.41 8.0 dB 126.2 kbps 14.00 Mbps

1715

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM) MN-CDM625

Notes:

1716

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


Chapter 18. IP PACKET
PROCESSOR OPTION
18.1 Introduction
The IP Packet Processor is an optional feature for the CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem. In
addition to providing Layer 3 functionality, it incorporates a number of key features for Wide
Area Network (WAN) bandwidth optimization, including very low overhead Streamline
Encapsulation (SLE), Header Compression, Payload compression, Advanced Quality of Service
(QoS), and Advanced Encryption Standard (AES) Encryption.

The IP Packet Processor enables efficient IP networking and transport over satellite, in either
Router Mode or Managed Switch Mode, by adding routing capability with very low overhead
encapsulation, header compression, payload compression, and Quality of Service (QoS). The
Advanced QoS combined with header and payload compression ensures the highest quality of
service with minimal jitter and latency for real-time traffic, priority treatment of mission critical
applications and maximum bandwidth efficiency.

18.1.1 IP Packet Processor Operational Requirements


The IP Packet Processor is available as a factory-installed option or, depending on
its originally shipped configuration, as a field-upgradeable option. Use of the IP
Packet Processor with the CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem requires the
following:

CDM-625 Power Requirements for the IP Packet Processor Board (CEFD P/N
PL-0000481): When ordering the IP Packet Processor as a factory installed option,
the modem power supply that is specified at the time of order must either be 175
watts for AC units, or 125 watts for DC units.

Existing field units that meet either power supply configuration requirement are
user-upgradable in the field using CEFD Kit KT-0000176 refer to Section 18.5 in
this chapter for the field upgrade procedure using this kit.

However, existing field units that do not meet these power supply configuration
requirements i.e., units that are configured with 65W AC or 65W DC power
supplies must be returned either to Comtech EF Data or sent to a Comtech EF

181

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
IP Packet Processor Option MN-CDM625

Data Authorized Service Center for upgrade using CEFD Kit KT-0000174 (for 65W
AC units) or CEFD Kit KT-0000175 (for 65W DC units).

CDM-625 Firmware Version 1.5.0 or later, which supports the IP Packet Processor
operational features. Factory-shipped units (i.e., units shipped with the IP Packet
Processor option) already have this firmware version pre-installed. However,
existing field units that do not run this firmware version (at a minimum) may
upgrade the firmware loads via the Flash Upgrade procedure explained in Chapter
4. UPDATING FIRMWARE.

18.1.2 Interoperability Compatibility/Limitations


CDM-625 CDM-625 Interoperability: A CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem that is
equipped with the IP Packet Processor is not interoperable for IP/Ethernet Traffic with a
CDM-625 that is not equipped with the IP Packet Processor.

CDM-625 CDM-570/L-IP or CDD-564/L Interoperability: A CDM-625 Advanced Satellite


Modem is interoperable with the CDM-570/L Satellite Modem w/Optional IP Module
(CDM-570/L-IP) and/or the CDD-564/L Demodulator with IP Module using Streamline
Encapsulation and compatible modulation, Forward Error Correction (FEC), symbol rate, etc.
However, the CDM-625 IP Packet Processors Payload Compression feature is not
interoperable with CDM-570/L-IP and/or CDD-564/L payload compression.

182

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
IP Packet Processor Option MN-CDM625

18.2 IP Packet Processor Features

18.2.1 Streamline Encapsulation (SLE)


The IP Packet Processor includes Comtech EF Datas patent-pending, very low overhead
Streamline Encapsulation (SLE). SLE can reduce the encapsulation overhead by as much as 65%
compared to industry-standard HDLC.

18.2.2 Modes of Operation

Chapter 16. ETHERNET NETWORK CONFIGURATION

A CDM-625 equipped with the IP Packet Processor can operate in four modes to support Point-
to-Point and Point-to-Multipoint network topologies:

Router Point-to-Point Router Hub


Router Remote Managed Switch

18.2.3 Subsystem Multiplex (Sub-Mux)

Chapter 15. IP SUB-MUX

Sub-Mux is a secondary framing structure that combines IP traffic with any currently available
combination of framing and interface type (excluding IP itself). A specific, user-selected ratio
references the composite data rate to the modulator and from the demodulator to the primary,
non-IP interface rate.

Sub-Mux capability can be used with the IP Packet Processor to multiplex a primary serial
synchronous or G.703 traffic stream with IP.

18.2.4 Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM)

Chapter 17. ADAPTIVE CODING AND MODULATION (ACM)

Comtech EF Datas VersaFEC Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM) feature, a patents-
pending technology wholly owned and developed by Comtech EF Data and CEFD sister division
Comtech AHA Corp., can be used with the IP Packet Processor to maximize throughput.

ACM converts available link margin into additional throughput, thereby maximizing throughput
under all conditions, including rain fade, inclined orbit satellite operation, antenna mispointing,
interference and other impairments.

183

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
IP Packet Processor Option MN-CDM625

18.2.5 FAST Options

Sect. 5.2.8 SELECT: FAST Menus (Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION)


Appendix C. FAST ACTIVATION PROCEDURE

If there is a need to upgrade the CDM-625 IP Packet Processors functionality, Comtech EF Data
provides Fully Accessible System Topology (FAST), a technology that permits the purchase and
installation of options through special authorization codes. These unique Fast Access Codes may
be purchased from Comtech EF Data during normal business hours, and then loaded into the
unit using the front panel keypad.

Contact Comtech EF Data to acquire the following available FAST options:

Header Compression:
o Up to 5 Mbps (CCM) / 1200 ksps (ACM) o Up to 10 Mbps (CCM) / 4100 ksps (ACM)
o Up to 15 Mbps (CCM) / 4100 ksps (ACM) o Up to 20 Mbps (CCM) / 4100 ksps (ACM)
o Up to 25 Mbps (CCM) / 4100 ksps (ACM)

Payload Compression:
o Up to 5 Mbps (CCM) / 1200 ksps (ACM) o Up to 10 Mbps (CCM) / 4100 ksps (ACM)
o Up to 15 Mbps (CCM) / 4100 ksps (ACM) o Up to 20 Mbps (CCM) / 4100 ksps (ACM)
o Up to 25 Mbps (CCM) / 4100 ksps (ACM)

Quality of Service

AES Encryption

18.2.5.1 Header Compression


The IP Packet Processor incorporates industry-leading header compression for IP traffic. Header
compression can reduce the 40-byte IP/UDP/RTP header to as little as 1 byte; for TCP/IP, the
40-byte header is reduced to as little as 3 bytes.

For applications such as Voice-over-IP (VoIP), header compression can provide bandwidth
savings exceeding 60%. For example, the 8 kbps G.729 voice codec requires 24 kbps of IP
bandwidth once encapsulated into an IP/UDP/RTP datagram. With header compression, the
same voice call needs about 8.5 kbps a saving of almost 65%.

In addition, bandwidth requirements for typical Web/HTTP traffic can be reduced by 10% or
more with TCP/IP header compression.

184

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
IP Packet Processor Option MN-CDM625

18.2.5.2 Payload Compression


The IP Packet Processor features industry-leading payload compression for IP traffic.
Implemented in the hardware for maximum throughput and efficiency, payload compression
can reduce the required satellite bandwidth by as much as 4050%.

18.2.5.3 Advanced Quality of Service (QoS)


The IP Packet Processor incorporates multi-level QoS to ensure the highest quality of service
with minimal jitter and latency for real-time traffic, priority treatment of mission critical
applications and maximum bandwidth efficiency.

The supported modes of QoS are:

DiffServ Industry-standard method of providing QoS, enabling seamless co-existence


in networks that implement DiffServ

Max/Priority Provides multi-level traffic prioritization with the ability to limit


maximum traffic per priority class

Min/Max Provides a Committed Information Rate (CIR) to each user-defined class of


traffic with the ability to allow a higher burstable rate depending on availability

When using rule-based QoS, you can configure up to 32 different rules based on:

Source IP address and subnet mask Destination IP address and subnet mask
Source Port Destination Port
Protocols (well known) Priority

18.2.5.4 Advanced Encryption Standard (AES) Encryption


Chapter 6. ETHERNET-BASED REMOTE PRODUCT MANAGEMENT:

Sect. 6.5.4.3.3.1 Configuration | Routing | Routes


Sect. 6.5.4.3.4 Configuration | Managed Switch
Sect. 6.5.4.3.5.3 Configuration | WAN | Encryption

When the AES Encryption option is active and enabled on a WAN route, the IP Packet Processor
will encrypt all outgoing traffic on the WAN, and decrypt any encrypted traffic it receives.

185

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
IP Packet Processor Option MN-CDM625

18.3 CDM-625 Operation with IP Packet Processor


Functionality and selection of the IP Packet Processors features and modes of operation, as
specified in the previous section, is seamless via the CDM-625s operational interfaces.
Equipment monitor and control (M&C) is possible via the methods outlined in this section.

18.3.1 Front Panel Operation

Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION

Using the keypad on the front panel, you may access a variety of nested
menus to configure the options available whenever the CDM-625 is
equipped with the IP Packet Processor.

18.3.2 Ethernet-based Remote Product Management


The CDM-625 10/100 BaseT Ethernet Management Interface supports three management
protocols for remote monitor and control (M&C) of the modem:

Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) This requires a user-supplied Network


Management System (NMS) and a user-supplied Management Information Base (MIB) File
Browser.

Telnet Interface This requires use of a user-supplied terminal emulation program such as
HyperTerminal (for use with the remote control protocol) or PuTTY (for use with the Telnet
Command Line Interface), installed on the user PC.

CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface This requires a compatible user-supplied web
browser such as Internet Explorer.

18.3.2.1 SNMP Interface

Sect. 6.3 SNMP Interface (Chapter 6. ETHERNET-BASED REMOTE PRODUCT


MANAGEMENT)
The Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) is an Internet-standard protocol for managing
devices on IP networks. An SNMP-managed network consists of three key components:

The managed device This includes the CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem.

The SNMP Agent The software that runs on the CDM-625. The CDM-625 SNMP Agent
supports both SNMPv1 and SNMPv2c.

186

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
IP Packet Processor Option MN-CDM625

The user-supplied Network Management System (NMS) The software that runs on
the manager.

18.3.2.2 Telnet Interface


Sect. 6.4 Telnet Interface (Chapter 6. ETHERNET-BASED REMOTE PRODUCT
MANAGEMENT)
Appendix D. REMOTE CONTROL
Appendix E. TELNET COMMAND LINE INTERFACE (CLI) OPERATION

Comtech EF Data provides a Telnet interface for the purpose of equipment monitor and control
(M&C) using either the standard remote control protocol or, when the optional IP Packet
Processor is installed and enabled, the Telnet Command Line Interface (CLI).

18.3.2.3 Web Server (HTTP) Interface

Sect. 6.5 Web Server (HTTP) Interface (Chapter 6. ETHERNET-BASED REMOTE


PRODUCT MANAGEMENT)

The embedded Web Server (HTTP) application provides an easy to use interface designed for
optimal performance when using Microsofts Internet Explorer Version 9.0 or higher. The
interface features enhanced functionality when the CDM-625 is equipped with the IP Packet
Processor.

187

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
IP Packet Processor Option MN-CDM625

18.4 List of Supported Internet RFCs (Requests for Comment)

RFC No. Description

768 User Datagram Protocol

791 Internet Protocol

793 Transmission Control Protocol

826 Ethernet Address Resolution Protocol

894 A Standard for the Transmission of IP Datagrams over Ethernet Networks

919 Broadcasting Internet Datagrams

922 Broadcasting Internet Datagrams in the Presence of Subnets

950 Internet Standard Subnetting Procedure

951 Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP)

959 File Transfer Protocol

1071 Computing the Internet Checksum

1112 Host Extensions for IP Multicasting

1350 The TFTP Protocol

1700 Assigned Numbers

2236 Internet Group Management Protocol, Volume 2

2474 Definition of the Differentiated Services Field (DS Field) in the IPv4 and IPv6 Headers

2475 An Architecture for Differentiated Services

2597 Assured Forwarding PHB

2598 An Expedited Forwarding PHB

2933 Internet Group Management Protocol MIB

3376 Internet Group Management Protocol, Volume 3

4293 Management Information Base for the Internet Protocol (IP)

188

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
IP Packet Processor Option MN-CDM625

18.5 IP Packet Processor Field Upgrade Procedure

18.5.1 Overview
This section describes the procedure required to field upgrade any user CDM-625-Advanced Satellite Modem having a 175W AC or 125W
DC Power Supply with the optional IP Packet Processor card. See Sections 18.1.1 and 18.1.2 in this chapter for a detailed description of
the requirements and limitations of using the IP Packet Processor with the CDM-625.

18.5.2 Requirements for Field Upgrade


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem with 175W AC or 125W DC Power Supply, and Firmware Version 1.5.0 or later

Medium Phillips screwdriver

Needle-nose pliers

CEFD P/N KT-0000176 IP Packet Processor with Fan Upgrade Kit, containing:

CEFD Part Number QTY Description


PL-0000449 1 Fan Assembly, 40 x 40 x 10
FN/FGDC12V01 1 Fan Guard
HW/4-40X3/4PH 4 Screw, S.S., 4-40 x 3/4 LG, Pan Head Phillips
HW/440HXNUTLOC 4 Locking Hex Nut, S.S., 4-40
PL-0000481 1 CDM-625 IP Packet Processor Card
HW/SEM440X1/4PH 2 Screw, S.S., 4-40 x 1/4 LG, Pan Head Phillips

189

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
IP Packet Processor Option MN-CDM625

18.5.3 Field Upgrade Procedure

Step Task
1 Turn off the CDM-625 and disconnect the modems power
cord from its power source.

Next, use the screwdriver to remove the top cover mounting


hardware. Remove the cover from the CDM-625 chassis.

IMPORTANT: Be s ure t o r etain the top cover mounting


hardware for cover re-installation once you have installed
the IP Packet Processor Card and its cooling fan.

1810

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
IP Packet Processor Option MN-CDM625

Step Task
2 The illustration a t r ight i dentifies t he u pgrade l ocations
within the chassis for:

Installation of the fan into the chassis;

Plug-in of both the fan power cable and IP Packet


Processor Card into the modems framing board;

Assembly of the IP Packet Processor Card onto


the chassis-mounted card bosses.

3 Unplug t he f ront p anel r ibbon c able f rom i ts c onnector o n


the modems framing board, and then move the cable out of
the way of the upgrade location.

1811

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
IP Packet Processor Option MN-CDM625

Step Task
4 Use the screwdriver and pliers, as needed, to install the fan
(CEFD P /N P L-0000449) and f an gu ard ( CEFD P /N
FN/FGDC12V01) securely i nto t he c hassis with t he
provided m ounting h ardware ( 4X 4 -40 x 3/4 pan h ead
screws and 4X 4 -40 l ocking hex nu ts) a t the d esignated
location.

IMPORTANT: Refer to the arrow icons imprinted on the fan


housing when installing the fan, to ensure that:

The ai r flow i s d irected i nto t he c hassis d uring


operation and

The f an p ower cable i s r outed t owards t he power


connector on the modems framing board.

5 Use ne edle-nose pl iers a s needed to plug t he f an p ower


cable receptacle into the mating connector on the modems
framing board.

IMPORTANT: Note the orientation of the fans power cable


receptacle and wiring to the mating connector and its pins
on the modems framing board.

1812

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
IP Packet Processor Option MN-CDM625

Step Task
6 Prepare t he I P P acket P rocessor C ard f or i nstallation b y
aligning i ts r eceptacle w ith t he m ating c onnector o n t he
modems framing board.

Plug t he c ard f irmly i nto t he connector take c are no t t o


damage a ny t op-mounted c omponents. S imilarly, be su re
not t o d amage t he b ottom of t he card o n t he chassis
mounting bosses while plugging the card receptacle into its
mating connector.

Installation i s c omplete once t he c able c onnector i s f ully


engaged w ithin its mating receptacle, a nd the mounting
holes at the front of the card are aligned with the mounting
boss threaded holes.

7 Use the screwdriver to secure the IP Packet Processor card


to the chassis with its provided mounting hardware (2X 4-
40 x 1/4 pan head screws).

1813

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
IP Packet Processor Option MN-CDM625

Step Task
8 Plug the f ront p anel r ibbon c able back i nto its mating
connector on the modems framing board.

9 Use the screwdriver t o reinstall t he t op cover o nto the


CDM-625 chassis with its existing mounting hardware.

Plug the modems power cord back into its power source.

The CDM-625 IP Packet Processor upgrade is now complete and you may turn on and resume use of the modem.

1814

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


Chapter 19. CARRIER ID
(MetaCarrier )

19.1 Introduction
CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modems running Firmware Version 2.2.1 or later incorporate a
patent-pending carrier identification (CID) technique that uses MetaCarrier spread spectrum
technology to embed a unique carrier identification sequence for the transmitted carrier.

The CDM-625 with MetaCarrier provides a subset of the functionality of the Comtech EF Data
MCED-100 MetaCarrier Embedding Device. It is used in tandem with the Comtech EF Data
MCDD-100 MetaCarrier Detection Device to provide a complete MetaCarrier embedding and
decoding solution.

19.2 About MetaCarrier


The MetaCarrier concept employs a low-speed data sequence containing information about the
transmission carrier that is spread using Direct Sequence Spread Spectrum (DSSS), and then
combined with the transmission desired carrier to produce a composite carrier with an
embedded CID. The power level and bandwidth of the MetaCarrier is sufficiently low that it is
completely hidden below the desired carrier, and has minimal effect on system Eb/No
(approximately 0.1 dB).

The MetaCarrier operates independent of the modulation and forward error correction rate of
the transmitted carrier. In configurations where the carrier is encrypted or uses cryptographic
technologies, the CID contained in the MetaCarrier is not affected.

Traditionally, the method for identifying an interfering carrier involves using a geo-location
system that, in turn, uses the phase offset from an adjacent satellite to triangulate the
approximate location on the surface of the earth where the interference is being generated.
While such tried-and-true geo-locating methods have proven beneficial to satellite operators
and service providers, they are nevertheless imprecise. For example, in densely populated areas,
a helicopter equipped with a feed horn and spectrum analyzer must be used to find the exact
location of the transmission source; the time and costs associated with such methods are
significant.

191

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Carrier ID (MetaCarrier) MN-CDM625

By contrast, Comtech EF Datas CID products provide the operator with the interference
sources identification information within seconds. Once the offending carrier is identified, the
uplinking station may be contacted and the request made to shut down or otherwise remove
the identified transmission from service.

The MCED-100s combined carrier (transmission carrier + embedded MetaCarrier) creates a


composite carrier that results in scalable identification system that requires minimal power
(typically less than 0.1 dB) from the transmission carrier.

19.3 Functional Description


In a typical network, there can be many CDM-625s with MetaCarrier, and one (or more) MCDD-
100s to verify the presence of the MetaCarrier on each carrier. In an interference situation, the
MCDD-100 may be used to decode the MetaCarrier of an interfering carrier that may not be part
of ones own transmission network, as long as the interfering carrier has an embedded
MetaCarrier.

The CDM-625 creates a composite carrier by first sizing the appropriate MetaCarrier, and then
by adding the spread spectrum CID (with power spectral density approximately 22 dB below the
transmission carriers spectral power density) to the transmission carrier.

The size of the MetaCarrier is determined based purely on symbol rate and is totally
independent of modulation and coding, resulting in three (3) discrete sizes of MetaCarrier being
combined with the transmission carrier. The available MetaCarrier sizes are as follows:

Original Carrier Embedded MetaCarrier


256 ksps 224 kchips per sec *
128 ksps to < 256 ksps 112 kchips per sec
64 ksps to < 128 ksps 56 kchips per sec
32 ksps to < 64 ksps 28 kchips per sec
< 32 ksps 14 kchips per sec
*kchips per sec refers to the direct sequence spread spectrum chipping rate

As shown here, the MetaCarrier is sized to be no more than 87.5% of the bandwidth of the
transmission carrier. In all configurations of the combined carrier, the MetaCarrier raises the
transmission power less than 0.1 dB above the original carrier.

The CID message is composed of the following information:

CDM-625 MAC Address Transmit carrier center frequency


Transmit carrier symbol rate Custom message

Note that other fields supported in the MCED-100 are not included.

192

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Carrier ID (MetaCarrier) MN-CDM625

The entire CID message is broken into 18 packets containing 122 bits (formatting, FEC and user
information) for a total message length of 2,196 bits for the transmission of the MetaCarrier.
Each packet of the MetaCarrier message carries 32 bits of CID information data. However, the
MAC address is sent at a higher rate (more often), so that upon reception of a frame that is
comprised of three (3) packets, the MAC address may be obtained.

The data rate of messages being carried in the MetaCarrier is shown before spreading is applied
and the associated time to send a complete CID message (including the framing and FEC). The
time for a complete message is only valid once the MCDD-100 has achieved lock to the
MetaCarrier that may cause the stated times to be longer:

Therefore, the time for the CDM-625 with MetaCarrier to insert a complete CID ID sequence is
as follows. Note that the time for unique ID may be shorter than shown, since upon achieving
lock to the MetaCarrier, the unique ID is made available immediately since MetaCarrier lock
requires the reception of three full packets to declare lock.

Embedded Time for Complete


CID Data Rate Time for Unique ID
MetaCarrier rate Message
224 kcps 56 bps 41 seconds 6.9 seconds
112 kcps 28 bps 82 seconds 13.8 seconds
56 kcps 14 bps 164 seconds 27.6 seconds
28 kcps 7 bps 328 seconds 55.2 seconds
14 kcps 3.5 bps 656 seconds 110.4 seconds

19.4 Configuring the CDM-625 for Carrier ID Operation


Carrier ID operation requires that you first enable Carrier ID feature operation, and then create
a MetaCarrier Custom Message. All other parameters (center frequency, symbol rate, and the
CDM-625s MAC address) are set automatically. The CDM-625 provides several means for
configuring Carrier ID operation:

Local Control via the CDM-625 Front Panel keypad and VFD.

Remote Control with a user-supplied PC via the

o CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface using a compatible Web browser.

o Serial-based or Telnet-based Remote Control Interface using a terminal


emulation program or Windows Command-line.

o Ethernet-based Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) using a Network


Management System (NMS) and Management Information Base (MIB) File
Browser.

193

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Carrier ID (MetaCarrier) MN-CDM625

USE OF THE SERIAL-BASED REMOTE CONTROL INTERFACE, THE TELNET-BASED


REMOTE CONTROL INTERFACE, AND THE ETHERNET-BASED SNMP INTERFACE ARE
RECOMMENDED ONLY FOR ADVANCED USERS. COMTECH EF DATA STRONGLY
ENCOURAGES USE OF THE CDM-625 FRONT PANEL OR WEB SERVER (HTTP)
INTERFACE FOR MONITOR AND CONTROL (M&C) OF THE CDM-625.

19.4.1 Enabling Carrier ID Operation

19.4.1.1 Enabling Operation via the CDM-625 Front Panel and VFD

Sect. 5.2.6.3 Utilities: CarrID (Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION)

From the front panel main (SELECT:) menu, use the arrow keys to select the Utility menu
branch, and then press ENTER. Then, from the Utilities: screen, use the arrow keys to
select the CarrID submenu. Press ENTER to continue (the solid block indicates the cursor
position upon navigation to that display item):

SELECT: Configuration Test Monitor


Info Store/Ld Utility ODU FAST ()

Utilities: Set-RTC Display-Bright CarrID


LED Redundancy Circuit-ID Firmware Em

Carrier ID: Disabled (Disabled, Enabled)


()

Use the arrow keys to select Carrier ID (MetaCarrier) operation as Enabled, and then press
ENTER.

19.4.1.2 Enabling Operation via the CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface

Sect. 6.5.4.3.7 Configuration | Utilities (Chapter 6. ETHERNET-BASED REMOTE


PRODUCT MANAGEMENT)

Log in to the CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP)


Interface. Click the Configuration, and then
the Utilities navigation tabs. In the Circuit and
Carrier ID section of the Configuration |
Utilities page, use the drop-down list to
select Carrier ID operation as Enabled, and
then click [Submit] to execute the selection.

194

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Carrier ID (MetaCarrier) MN-CDM625

19.4.2 Creating the MetaCarrier Custom Message

It is IMPORTANT to understand that Carrier ID and Circuit ID, while named similarly,
are two distinct features of the CDM-625. Read your documentation carefully.

19.4.2.1 Creating the Message via the CDM-625 Front Panel and VFD

Sect. 5.2.6.6 Utilities: Circuit-ID (Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION)

From the front panel main (SELECT:) menu, use the arrow keys to select the Utility menu
branch, and then press ENTER. Then, from the Utilities: screen, use the arrow keys to
select the Circuit-ID submenu. Press ENTER to continue (the solid block indicates the cursor
position upon navigation to that display item):

SELECT: Configuration Test Monitor


Info Store/Ld Utility ODU FAST ()

Utilities: Set-RTC Display-Bright CarrID


LED Redundancy Circuit-ID Firmware Em

Edit this Modems Circuit ID: ()


----------------------------------------

To compose a MetaCarrier Custom Message On the bottom line, first use the arrow keys
to select the alphanumeric character space to edit, and then use the arrow keys to edit that
character.

You may use the following characters to compose a MetaCarrier Custom Message of 24
characters or less:

[Space] ( ) * + - , . / 0-9 and A-Z.

Press ENTER once you finish composing the MetaCarrier Custom Message string.

With Carrier ID enabled, the first 24 characters of the 40-character Circuit ID are
intended for and sent as the MetaCarrier Custom Message. While you must limit
your MetaCarrier Custom Message to 24 characters or less, the full 40 characters of
the Circuit ID will display on the front panel screen saver (see Sect. 5.1.3.1 Screen
Saver).

195

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Carrier ID (MetaCarrier) MN-CDM625

19.4.2.2 Creating the Message via the CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP)
Interface

Sect. 6.5.4.3.7 Configuration | Utilities (Chapter 6. ETHERNET-BASED REMOTE


PRODUCT MANAGEMENT)

After logging in to the CDM-625 Web


Server (HTTP) Interface, click the
Configuration and Utilities navigation
tabs. Then, in the Circuit and Carrier ID
section of the Configuration | Utilities page, enter the 24-characters-or-less MetaCarrier
Custom Message into the Circuit ID text box. Follow the naming requirements specified in the
previous section, and then click [Submit] once you finish composing the MetaCarrier Custom
Message string.

196

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


Chapter 20. QUALITY OF
SERVICE (QOS)

20.1 Overview
Quality of Service (QoS) enables a network to use WAN bandwidth more efficiently by managing
delay, jitter (delay variation), throughput, and packet loss.

The CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem incorporates two Per Hop Behavior (PHP) QoS
methods Layer 2 QoS and Layer 3 QoS:

Layer 2 QoS is available on the CDM-625 by default when the optional IP Packet
Processor card is either not installed, or is installed but disabled. Layer 2 QoS is based
on OSI model Layer 2 header parameters such as IEEE 802.1q VLAN priority field, and is
also based on the CDM-625s physical Ethernet port.

Layer 3 QoS requires the optional IP Packet Processor card to be installed and enabled,
and the Advanced QoS FAST option must be purchased and activated. Layer 3 QoS is
based on OSI model Layer 3 to Layer 7 protocol header parameters.

20.1.1 QoS Terminology


Latency Latency is the amount of delay that is measured, in milliseconds, from the
Ethernet interface of the near-end modem to the Ethernet interface of the far-end
modem.

Jitter Jitter is the amount of variation that is measured, in milliseconds, between two
consequent frames at the receiving end.

201

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Quality of Service (QoS) MN-CDM625

20.2 Layer 2 QoS

See Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION for complete information about using
this interface.

Layer 2 QoS is implemented on System on Chip (SoC) hardware having a total queue memory of
1 Mbits (128 Kilobytes). This limits traffic burst size to no more than 128 Kilobytes. The Layer 2
QoS system has four queues and four priorities; each queue is assigned to each priority with a
total of 128 KB for all four queues.

A Layer 2 QoS system uses the strict priority-scheduling algorithm the higher the priority
number, the higher the priority. For example, a Priority 4 queue schedules and drains before a
Priority 3 queue; similarly, Priority 3 packets will schedule and drain before Priority 2 packets;
Priority 2 packets schedule and drain before Priority 1 packets. Priority 1 queue packets,
therefore, will schedule and drain only if QoS bandwidth is available after serving the three
higher-priority packet queues. High priority queues may starve low priority queues.

Three modes of Layer 2 QoS are available: Port-based, VLAN-based, or Port- and VLAN-based.

20.2.1 Modem Tx Data Rate vs. QoS Tx Data Rate


Modem Tx data rate can be set in 1 Kbps step size (resolution). In an idle situation, QoS Tx
bandwidth shall be the same as the modems Tx bandwidth. However, due to hardware
limitations the Layer 2 QoS Tx bandwidth can be set near to the modems data rate. Table 20-1
lists the step sizes for both CDM-625 hardware versions.

Note that the Layer 2 QoS scheduling algorithm runs on the basis of QoS Tx data rate; however,
the modem can send only the modem Tx data rate. In the event of difference between QoS data
rate and modem Tx data rate, after QoS scheduling the modem further clips the input data rate
to the modem Tx data rate without considering the scheduling priorities.

Table 20-1. Modem Tx Data Rate vs. QoS Tx Data Rate (Hardware-limited)
QoS Tx Data Rate
Modem Tx Data Rate
HW Ver. 2.1 or newer HW Ver. Rev 1.1 or older
Less than 128 Kbps 64 Kbps steps Limited to 128 Kbps
128 Kbps to 256 Kbps 64 Kbps steps Limited to 256 Kbps
256 Kbps to 512 Kbps 64 Kbps steps Limited 512 Kbps
512 Kbps to 1 Mbps 64 Kbps steps Limited to 1 Mps
1 Mbps to 2 Mbps 1 Mbps steps Limited to 2 Mbps
2 Mbps to 4 Mbps 1 Mbps Steps Limited to 4 Mbps
4 Mbps to 8 Mbps 1 Mbps steps Limited to 8 Mbps
8 Mbps to 25 Mbps 1 Mbps steps Limited to 100 Mbps

202

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Quality of Service (QoS) MN-CDM625

QoS Example 1
QUESTION: If the modem Tx data rate is set to 180 Kbps, then what is the QoS Tx data rate?

ANSWER A For HW version 2.1 or newer:


The QoS Tx data rate can be set from 64 Kbps to 1 Mbps, in 64 Kbps steps. If the 180 Kbps
modem Tx data rate is not in 64 Kbps step size, then the QoS Tx data rate will be the next 64
Kbps, which is 196 Kbps.

ANSWER B For HW version 1.1 or older:


If the Modem Tx Data rate of 180 Kbps is greater than 128 Kbps but less than 256 Kbps, then the
modem Tx data rate will be set to 256 Kbps.

20.2.2 Flow Control


In Layer 2 QoS mode, the CDM-625 supports Ethernet-based pause frame control (IEEE 802.3).
Flow control can be enabled or disabled independently in any of the LAN ports. Flow Control
requires WAN Buffer Length to be large enough so that

Data Rate in kbps x buffer length / 4096 24.

20.2.3 Port-based Layer 2 QoS


When selecting Port-based Layer 2 QoS, each ports priority is configurable to a QoS queue
priority of 1 (lowest) to 4 (highest). In this mode, irrespective of traffic type, all traffic ingress on
a particular port is treated with the priority assigned to that port.

In the event any port is overdriven with ingress traffic, if there is insufficient queue memory to
store the packet, then the packet will be dropped and drop stats will be incremented against
that port.

QoS Example 2
Port-based Layer 2 QoS mode is selected.

Port Layer 2 QoS Priorities are set as follows:

o Port 1 priority is set to 1;

o Port 2 priority is set to 2;

o Port 3 priority is set to 3;

o Port 4 priority is set to 4.

The modem data rate is set to 1 Mbps.

The ingress traffic on each port is set to 250 Kbps.

203

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Quality of Service (QoS) MN-CDM625

QUESTION: What is the total output data rate and what is individual ports output data rate?

ANSWER A For HW Ver. Rev 2.1 and newer:

Based on Table 20-1 for a modem Tx bandwidth of 1 Mbps, the QoS output bandwidth is set
to 1 Mbps.

Total Input data rate is 4X 250 Kbps = 1 Mbps

The output Data rate = 1 Mbps

Each ports data rate = 250 Kbps

ANSWER B For HW Ver. Rev 1.1 and older:

Based on Table 20-1 for a modem Tx bandwidth of 1 Mbps, the QoS output bandwidth is set
to 1 Mbps.

Total Input data rate is 4X 250 Kbps = 1 Mbps

The output Data rate = 1 Mbps

Each ports data rate = 250 Kbps

QoS Example 3
Port-based Layer 2 QoS mode is selected.

Port Layer 2 QoS Priorities are set as follows:

o Port 1 priority is set to 1;

o Port 2 priority is set to 2;

o Port 3 priority is set to 3;

o Port 4 priority is set to 4.

The modem data rate is set to 2500 Kbps.

The ingress traffic on Ports 1 and 2 are set to 2 Mbps.

The ingress traffic on Port 3 is set to 800 Kbps.

The ingress traffic on Port 4 is set to 500 Kbps.

204

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Quality of Service (QoS) MN-CDM625

QUESTION: What is the total output data rate and what are the individual port output data
rates?

ANSWER A For HW Ver. Rev 2.1 and newer:

Based on Table 20-1 for a modem Tx bandwidth of 2.5 Mbps, the QoS output bandwidth is
set to 3 Mbps.

Since the modem Tx bandwidth and QoS output data rates are not the same, after Layer 2
QoS prioritization the modem will further limit the output data rate to the Tx bandwidth of
the mode. The individual port data rates will henceforth be trimmed (normalized) to the
data rate of the modem Tx bandwidth without considering the priorities.

Remaining Data
L2 QoS Input QoS Output
Port Rate* (After Serving Output Data Rate
Priority Data Rate Data Rate
the Priority Queue)
4 4 500 Kbps 500 Kbps 2500 Kbps 500 x (2.5/3) = 417 Kbps
3 3 800 Kbps 800 Kbps 1700 Kbps 800 x (2.5/3) = 667 Kbps
2 2 2 Mbps 1700 Kbps 0 Kbps 1700 x (2.5 /3) = 1416 Kbps
1 1 2 Mbps 0 Kbps 0 Kbps 0 Kbps
Total 5.3 Mbps 3 Mbps 0 Kbps 2.5 Mbps

*After Priority 4, even though the actual modem TX data rate is 2500 kbps, the QoS
leftover data rate is still 2500 kbps since QoS bandwidth is 3000 kbps.

ANSWER B For HW Ver. Rev 1.1 and older:

Based on Table 20-1 for a modem Tx bandwidth of 2.5 Mbps, the QoS output bandwidth is
set to 4 Mbps.

Since the modem Tx bandwidth and QoS output data rates are not the same, after Layer 2
QoS prioritization the modem will further limit the output data rate to the Tx bandwidth of
the modem. The individual port data rates will henceforth be trimmed (normalized) to the
data rate of the modem Tx bandwidth without considering the priorities.

Remaining Data Rate


L2 QoS Input QoS Output
Port (After Serving the Output Data Rate
Priority Data Rate Data Rate
Priority Queue)
4 4 500 Kbps 500 Kbps 3500 Kbps 500 x (2.5/4)= 312.5 Kbps
3 3 800 Kbps 800 Kbps 2700 Kbps 800 x (2.5/4) = 500 Kbps
700 x (2.5 /4) = 1250
2 2 2 Mbps 2000 Kbps 700 Kbps
Kbps
700 x (2.5/4) = 432.5
1 1 2 Mbps 700 Kbps 0 Kbps
Kbps
Total 5.3 Mbps 4 Mbps 0 Kbps 2.5 Mbps

205

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Quality of Service (QoS) MN-CDM625

20.2.4 VLAN-based Layer 2 QoS


When selecting VLAN-based Layer 2 QoS, the priority field is extracted from the 802.1q VLAN tag
as shown in Figure 20-1. The VLAN tag priority field is 3 bits, so the 802.1q protocol supports
eight priorities, from 0 to 7. However, because Layer 2 QoS has only four priorities as mentioned
previously, as shown in Table 20-2 these eight VLAN priorities are automatically mapped to four
internal priories.

Dest MAC SRC MAC FCS


VLAN Tag Data
6 bytes 6 bytes 4 bytes

Type(0x8100) Priority CFI VLANid


2 bytes 3bits 1 bit 12 bits

Figure 20-1. IEEE 802.1q VLAN priority


Table 20-2. 802.1q to Layer 2 QoS Priority Conversion
802.1q VLAN Priority Field Layer 2 QoS Priority
7 (b111)
Priority 4
6 (b110)
5 (b101)
Priority 3
4 (b100)
3 (b011)
Priority 2
2 (b010)
1 (b001)
Priority 1
0 (b000)

Even though it is not necessary to configure multiple ports with VLANs, the VLAN QoS will not
look in the port information when classifying the packets into queue.

Similar to the Port-based scheduler, VLAN-based QoS also observes strict priority-based
scheduling. Should overdriving of VLAN priority traffic occur, the packet will be dropped and
drop stats will be incremented against that port.

In case VLAN Q-in-Q (double VLAN tag), the L2 VLAN QoS considers first VLAN tag
priority field only for traffic prioritization.

206

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Quality of Service (QoS) MN-CDM625

QoS Example 4
1. VLAN-based Layer 2 QoS mode is selected.

2. The modem data rate is set to 1 Mbps.

3. Four streams of VLAN ingress traffic is sent to the modem with VLAN Priorities set to 7, 5, 3,
and 1, respectively.

4. The data rate for each stream is set to 500 Kbps.

QUESTION: What is the total output data rate and what are the individual port output data
rates?

ANSWER A For HW Ver. Rev 2.1 and newer:

Based on Table 20-1 for a modem Tx bandwidth of 1 Mbps, the QoS output bandwidth is set
to 1 Mbps.

Total Input data rate is 4X 500 Kbps = 2 Mbps

Based on Table 20-2, the VLAN Priorities 7, 5, 3, and 1 are mapped, respectively, to L2 QoS
Priorities 4, 3, 2, and 1.

Since the modem Tx bandwidth and QoS output data rates are the same, there is no need
for normalization.

The data rate for each port is as follows:

VLAN L2 QoS QoS Output Data Remaining Data Rate (After Output Data
Input Data Rate
Priority Priority Rate Serving the Priority Queue) Rate
7 4 500 Kbps 500 Kbps 500 Kbps 500 Kbps
5 3 500 Kbps 500 Kbps 0 Kbps 500 Kbps
3 2 500 Kbps 0 Kbps 0 Kbps 0 Kbps
1 1 500 Kbps 0 Kbps 0 Kbps 0 Kbps
Total 2 Mbps 1 Mbps 0 Kbps 1 Mbps

ANSWER B For HW Ver. Rev 1.1 and older:

Based on Table 20-1 for a modem Tx bandwidth of 1 Mbps, the QoS output bandwidth is set
to 1 Mbps.

Total Input data rate is 4X 500 Kbps = 2 Mbps.

Based on Table 20-2, the VLAN Priorities 7, 5, 3, and 1 are mapped, respectively, to L2 QoS
Priorities 4, 3, 2, and 1.

207

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Quality of Service (QoS) MN-CDM625

Since the modem Tx bandwidth and QoS output data rates are the same, there is no need
for normalization.

The data rate for each port is as follows:


VLAN L2 QoS QoS Output Data Remaining Data Rate (After Output Data
Input Data Rate
Priority Priority Rate Serving the Priority Queue) Rate
7 4 500 Kbps 500 Kbps 500 Kbps 500 Kbps
5 3 500 Kbps 500 Kbps 0 Kbps 500 Kbps
3 2 500 Kbps 0 Kbps 0 Kbps 0 Kbps
1 1 500 Kbps 0 Kbps 0 Kbps 0 Kbps
Total 2 Mbps 2 Mbps 0 Kbps 1 Mbps

QoS Example 5
1. Port- and VLAN-based Layer 2 QoS mode is selected.

2. Port Layer 2 QoS Priorities are set as follows:

Port 1 priority is set to 1;

Port 3 priority is set to 3;

Ports 2 and 4 priorities are set to trunk mode (native disabled).

3. The modem data rate is set to 4000 Kbps.

4. The ingress traffic on Port 1 is set to 2 Mbps.

5. The ingress traffic on Port 3 is set to 1600 Kbps.

6. The ingress traffic on Port 2 is set to 2000 Kbps with a VLAN Priority of 1.

7. The ingress traffic on Port 4 is set to 800 Kbps with a VLAN Priority of 7.

QUESTION: What is the total output data rate and what are the individual port output data
rates?

ANSWER A For HW Ver. Rev 2.1 and newer:

Based on Table 20-1 for a modem Tx bandwidth of 4 Mbps, the QoS output bandwidth is set
to 4 Mbps.

Since the modem Tx bandwidth and QoS output data rates are the same, there is no need
for normalization.

Based on Table 20-2, the VLAN Priorities 7 and 1 are mapped, respectively, to L2 QoS
Priorities 4 and 1.

208

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Quality of Service (QoS) MN-CDM625

The data rate for each port is as follows:

QoS Output Data Rate


VLAN L2 QoS Remaining Data Rate (After
Port Input Data Rate = Modem Output Data
Priority Priority Serving the Priority Queue)
Rate
4 7 (b111) 4 800 Kbps 800 Kbps 3200 Kbps
3 N/A 3 1600 Kbps 1600 Kbps 1600 Kbps
2 1 (b001) 1 2 Mbps 800Kbps 800Kbps
1 N/A 1 2 Mbps 800 Kbps 800 Kbps
Total 5.3 Mbps 4 Mbps 0 Mbps

ANSWER B For HW Ver. Rev 1.1 and older:

Based on Table 20-1 for a modem Tx bandwidth of 4 Mbps, the QoS output bandwidth is set
to 4 Mbps.

Since the modem Tx bandwidth and QoS output data rates are the same, there is no need
for normalization.

Based on Table 20-2, the VLAN Priorities 7 and 1 are mapped, respectively, to L2 QoS
Priorities 4 and 1.

The data rate for each port is as follows:

QoS Output Data Rate


VLAN L2 QoS Remaining Data Rate (After
Port Input Data Rate = Modem Output Data
Priority Priority Serving the Priority Queue)
Rate
4 7 (b111) 4 800 Kbps 800 Kbps 3200 Kbps
3 N/A 3 1600 Kbps 1600 Kbps 1600 Kbps
2 1 (b001) 1 2 Mbps 800Kbps 800Kbps
1 N/A 1 2 Mbps 800 Kbps 800 Kbps
Total 5.3 Mbps 4 Mbps 0 Mbps

1. Layer 2 QoS can be enabled only when the optional Packet Processor is
not enabled.

2. Layer 2 QoS is implemented on System on Chip (SoC) hardware with a


total queue memory of 1 Mbits (128 Kbytes). Layer 2 QoS therefore
cannot accept traffic bursts requiring more than 128 Kbytes of storage.

209

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Quality of Service (QoS) MN-CDM625

20.3 Layer 3 QoS


Layer 3 QoS scheduling operates on modem Tx bandwidth with 1-byte resolution, so there is
further trimming or clipping data rate after the QoS scheduler.

Layer 3 QoS is implemented with at least one 1-second burst at maximum data rate. So Layer 3
QoS can process much larger bursts than Layer 2 QoS.

Excluding the default queue, the Layer 3 QoS system has up to 32 QoS with 8 configurable
priorities rules. The Layer 3 QoS system creates a separate queue for each rule to store the
incoming stream of packets. (In this chapter, QoS rules and QoS queues are interchangeable).

Layer 3 QoS systems use a strict priority QoS scheduling algorithm. Layer 3 QoS priority numbers
are inverse to Layer 2 QoS system numbers the lower the priority number, the higher the
priority. For example, a Priority 1 queue schedules and drains before a Priority 2 queue;
similarly, Priority 2 packets will schedule and drain before Priority 3 packets, etc.

Layer 3 QoS systems incorporates WRED (Weighted Random Early Detection) based congestion
avoidance algorithm in addition to tail drop.

Three modes of Layer 3 QoS are available: MAX-Pri (Max-Priority), MIN-MAX (Minimum-
Maximum), and DiffServ (Differentiated Services).

20.3.1 Layer 3 QoS Max-Pri Mode


In Max-Pri mode, up to 32 QoS rules can be configurable using source IP subnet, destination IP
subnet, source port range, destination port range, and protocol. For each created rule, you can
also set the QoS treatments such as priority, limiting the maximum bandwidth, WRED enable or
disable, and filter enable or disable.

When WRED is enabled for a specific queue, QoS randomly drops packets after reaching 50% of
the QoS queue.

When the FILTER option is enabled for a rule, Layer 3 QoS provides the ability to filter the packet
completely.

2010

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Quality of Service (QoS) MN-CDM625

QoS Example 6
1. Max-Pri Layer 3 QoS mode is selected.

2. Modem Tx bandwidth is set to 2048 Kbps (E1 rate).

3. The Max-Pri QoS rules are configured as follows:

Dest Max Min Max


VLAN Src IP/ Min Src Max
Index Protocol TOS IP/ Src Dst Dst Priority Filter WRED
Range mask Port BW
mask Port Port Port

1 UDP 0-4094 255 ***/* ***/* 0 65535 0 65535 644 1 N N

2 TCP 0-4094 255 ***/* ***/* 0 65535 0 65535 99999 2 N N

3 HTTP 0-4094 255 ***/* ***/* 0 65535 0 65535 99999 3 N N

4 Def 0-4094 255 ****/* ***/* 0 65535 0 65535 99999 9 N N

4. The input data streams are as follows:

Steam Data
Stream Protocol VLAN Range TOS Src IP Dest IP Src Port Dest Port
Rate

1 UDP 0-4094 255 ***/* ***/* *** *** 1024

2 TCP 0-4094 255 ***/* ***/* *** *** 1024

3 HTTP 0-4094 255 ***/* ***/* *** *** 1024

4 IP 0-4094 255 ***/* ***/* *** *** 64

QUESTION: What are the total output data rates and the individual stream data rates?

ANSWER: The individual stream data rates are as follows:

QoS Layer 3 QoS Remain Data Rate (After Serving


Input Data Rate QoS Output Data Rate
Rule Priority the Priority Queue)
644 Kbps
1 1 1024 Kbps 1404 Kbps
due to max clipping
2 2 1024 Kbps 1024 Kbps 380 Kbps
3 3 1024 Kbps 380Kbps 0 Kbps
4 9 64 Kbps 0 0 Kbps
Total 3136 Kbps 2048 Kbps 0 Kbps

2011

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Quality of Service (QoS) MN-CDM625

20.3.2 Layer 3 QoS Min-Max Mode


In Min-Max mode, up to 32 QoS rules can be configurable using source IP subnet, destination IP
subnet, source port range, destination port range, and protocol. For each created rule, you can
also set the QoS treatment, such as guaranteed minimum bandwidth, maximum clipping
bandwidth, WRED enable or disable, and filter rule.

When WRED is enabled for a specific queue, QoS randomly drops packets after reaching 50% of
the QoS queue.

When the FILTER option is enabled for a rule, Layer 3 QoS provides the ability to filter the packet
completely.

QoS Example 7
1. Min-Max Layer 3 QoS mode is selected.

2. Modem Tx bandwidth is set to 20 Mbps.

3. The Min-Max QoS rules are configured as follows:

Dest Min Max Min Max


VLAN Src IP/ Min Max
Index Protocol TOS IP/ Src Src Dst Dst Priority Filter WRED
Range mask BW BW
mask Port Port Port Port

1 UDP 0-4094 255 ***/* ***/* 0 65535 0 65535 2500 4000 1 N N

2 TCP 0-4094 255 ***/* ***/* 0 65535 0 65535 2500 99999 2 N N

3 HTTP 0-4094 255 ***/* ***/* 0 65535 0 65535 0 99999 3 N N

4 Def 0-4094 255 ****/* ***/* 0 65535 0 65535 0 9999 9 N N

4. The input data streams are as follows:

Steam Data
Stream Protocol VLAN Range TOS Src IP Dest IP Src Port Dest Port
Rate

1 UDP 0-4094 255 ***/* ***/* *** *** 10000 Kbps

2 TCP 0-4094 255 ***/* ***/* *** *** 5000 Kbps

3 HTTP 0-4094 255 ***/* ***/* *** *** 7000 Kbps

4 DEF 0-4094 255 ***/* ***/* *** *** 10000 Kbps

QUESTION: What are the total output data rates and the individual stream data rates?

ANSWER:

In Min-Max QoS mode, other than the default rule, which is configured as Priority 9, all QoS
rules are configured as Priority 8.

2012

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Quality of Service (QoS) MN-CDM625

In this mode, the minimum bandwidth for all rules the excluding the default rule will be
served first in round robin fashion.
In this example, the total minimum BW for Rules 1 and 2 is 5000 Kbps. Since the total
bandwidth is 20 Mbps, it has enough bandwidth to serve.

After serving the minimum bandwidth, the leftover bandwidth is 15 Mbps (20,000 Kbps
5000 Kbps).

Leftover bandwidth will be served among all rules in round robin fashion until it hits
maximum bandwidth limitations.

Each rules bandwidth is 15/3 = 5000 Kbps.

Since Rule 1 maximum clipping was set to 4000 Kbps, and minimum bandwidth has already
taken 2500 bytes, it will use 1500 Kbps more before reaching the maximum clipping. The
leftover 3500 Kbps (5000-1500=3500) is again given to the main pool.

Rule 2 does not have enough traffic coming in, so it will use only 2500 kbps (5000-2500);
the remaining bandwidth (5000-2500=2500) is again given to the main pool.

Rule 3s input stream is 7000 bytes; it will take its share of the 5000 allocation. Still, it needs
7000-5000=2000).

After serving the fair share, the total leftover bandwidth is 6000 kbps (3500+2500=6000).

Since Rule 3 needs the bandwidth, the leftover bandwidth is applied to that rule.

After serving Rule 3, the leftover bandwidth 4000 Kbps will be applied to the default queue.

The default rule will see the data rate of 4000 Kbps.

The individual rules data rates are as follows:

QoS Rule Layer 3 QoS Priority Input Data Rate QoS Output Data Rate
1 1 10000 Kbps 4000 Kbps
2 2 5000 Kbps 5000 Kbps
3 3 7000 Kbps 7000 Kbps
4 9 10000 Kbps 4000 Kbps
Total 32000 Kbps 20000 Kbps

2013

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Quality of Service (QoS) MN-CDM625

20.3.3 Layer 3 QoS DiffServ Mode


Layer 3 DiffServ QoS is fully compliance to RFC standards. When the Layer 3 QoS mode is set to
DiffServ, the system automatically configures the rules with DSCP code points, priority values,
and WRED. You can only configure the service rate and drop precedence levels for Assured
Forwarding (ASFD) classes.

20.3.3.1 Layer 3 QoS Congestion Avoidance


The Layer 3 QoS system supports Weighted Random Early Detection (WRED) based congestion
avoidance. WRED can be enable or disabled on any queue. When WRED is disabled, upon
overdriving the queue the packets will be tail dropped.

QoS Example 8
1. DiffServ Layer 3 QoS mode is selected.

2. The modem Tx bandwidth is set to 10 Mbps.

3. The data rate of the modem drops down from 10 Mbps to 8.7 Mbps due to EbNo.

4. The input data streams to the modem are the same as those of QoS Example 7.

QUESTION: What is the total output data rate and what are the individual port output data
rates?

ANSWER:

The Layer 3 QoS system first drains Priority 1 traffic. Since the management data stream is
only 200 Kbps, after serving Priority 1 traffic, QoS still has 9.8 Mbps (10.0-0.2=9.8).

QoS next drains Priority 2s 800 Kbps traffic. After the end of the Priority 2 traffic, QoS still
has 9 Mbps traffic available (9.8-0.8=9).
Similarly, QoS walks through all priorities until it hits the ASFD classes:

o The beginning of ASFD Classes QoS leftover bandwidth is 2 Mbps.

o All ASFD classes have the same Priority of 7, with different service rates.

o ASFD service rate is a Committed Information Rate (CIR), except serviced if bandwidth
available after serving all high priority queues. In this case, 2 Mbps bandwidth is
available, serving all service rates first. The total of all ASFD service rates are 1.6 Mbps,
which is less than the 2 Mbps leftover bandwidth.

o After serving the service rates, the leftover bandwidth is 400 Kbps. This 400 Kbps will be
distributed to all ASFD classes equally in round robin fashion until either there is no
more bandwidth, or the input streams have no data.

2014

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Quality of Service (QoS) MN-CDM625

The resulting individual data rates are as follows:

Stream Priority PHB / DSCP Code Service Rate Drop Precedence Data Rate
Management 1 CS7 / b111000 200 Kbps 9.8 Mbps 200 Kbps
Networking
2 CS6 / b110000 800 Kbps 9.0 Mbps 800 Kbps
Control
Voice 3 EXFD / b101110 1 Mbps 8.0 Mbps 1Mbps
Video 3 CS5 / b101000 4 Mbps 4.0 Mbps 4 Mbps
Data-1 4 CS4 / b100000 550 Kbps 3450 Kbps 550 Kbps
Data-2 5 CS3 / b011000 1450 2000 Kbps 1450 Kbps
Data-3 7 ASFD4 / b100010 1 Mbps NA 100 + 100 Kbps
Data-4 7 ASFD3 / b011010 1 Mbps NA 400 + 100 Kbps
Data-5 7 ASFD2 / b010010 1 Mbps NA 500 + 100 Kbps
Data-6 7 ASFD1 / b001010 1 Mbps NA 800 + 100 Kbps
Data-7 8 BE / bXXXXXX 2 Mbps NA 0 Kbps
Total 14 Mbps 0 Kbps 10 Mbps

20.3.3.2 Layer 3 QoS List of Supported RFCs (Requests for Comment)

RFC No. Description


2474 Definition of the Differentiated Services Field (DS Field) in the IPv4 and IPv6 Headers
Nichols, K., Blake, S., Baker, F. and D. Black, December 1998
2475 An Architecture for Differentiated Services
Blake, S., Black, D., Carlson, M., Davies, E., Wang, Z. and Weiss, W., December 1998
2597 Assured Forwarding PHB
Heinanen, J., Baker, F., Weiss, W. and J. Wrocklawski, June 1999
2598 An Expedited Forwarding PHB
Jacobson, V., Nichols, K. and K. Poduri, June 1999

2015

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Quality of Service (QoS) MN-CDM625

20.4 QoS with ACM (Adaptive Coding and Modulation)


When ACM is enabled, the modem is configured with symbol rate. However, while the QoS
system recognizes data rate, both Layer 2 QoS and Layer 3 QoS operate on data rate. Therefore,
while the symbol rate will be constant in ACM mode, the data rate will not be constant. As a
result, the modems data rate can vary "on-the-fly based on the EbNo. The data rate can be
more or less than when QoS was first configured, or when the modems first boots.

20.4.1 Maximum Clipping


Due to ACM, when in QoS Max-Pri mode and the data rates available bandwidth exceeds the
maximum clipping rate, the QoS system limits the output rate of that rule to configured
maximum clipping rate.

When the available data rate is less than the maximum clipping rate, the QoS system has
nothing to clip, since it has not exceeded the defined maximum bandwidth rate.

20.4.2 Minimum Data Rate


Due to ACM, when the data rates available bandwidth exceeds the minimum data rate (per QoS
Min-Max and DiffServ modes ASFD classes), the QoS system operates as normal; since the
minimum has been met, the available bandwidth is shared among all other same priorities in
round robin fashion.

When the available data rate is less than the minimum data rate, then the QoS system shares
equally among all same priority queues in a round robin fashion until either minimum
bandwidth is met, or no more data is available to drain.

QoS Example 9
1. DiffServ Layer 3 QoS mode is selected.

2. ACM is enabled.

3. The data rate of the modem drops down from 10 Mbps to 8.7 Mbps due to EbNo.

4. Input data streams are the same as with QoS Example 7 (see Sect. 20.3.2).

QUESTION: What will be the total data rate and what will be the individual data rates?

ANSWER:

After serving all high priority queues, only 500 Kbps is left for ASFD classes.

This leftover bandwidth is less than the total minimum bandwidth; it must therefore share
the residual 500 Kbps among all four ASFD classes equally - i.e., 500/4=175 Kbps per class.

2016

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Quality of Service (QoS) MN-CDM625

Since ASFD 4 has the service rate 100 Kbps, the excess 75 Kbps will be given the other
queues where the service rate not met.

In this case the 75 Kbps again will share equally among ASFD3, ASFD2, and ASFD1 since
these service rates were not met.

The resulting individual data rate is as follows:

Leftover BW (After
Stream Priority PHB / DSCP Code Input Data rate QoS output Data rate
Serving the Queue)
Management 1 CS7 / b111000 200 Kbps 9.8 Mbps 200 Kbps
Networking
2 CS6 / b110000 800 Kbps 9.0 Mbps 800 Kbps
Control
Voice 3 EXFD / b101110 1 Mbps 8.0 Mbps 1Mbps

Video 3 CS5 / b101000 4 Mbps 4.0 Mbps 4 Mbps

Data-1 4 CS4 / b100000 550 Kbps 3450 Kbps 550 Kbps

Data-2 5 CS3 / b011000 1450 2000 Kbps 1450 Kbps

Data-3 7 ASFD4 / b100010 1 Mbps NA 100 Kbps

Data-4 7 ASFD3 / b011010 1 Mbps NA 175 + 25 Kbps

Data-5 7 ASFD2 / b010010 1 Mbps NA 175 + 25 Kbps

Data-6 7 ASFD1 / b001010 1 Mbps NA 175 + 25 Kbps

Data-7 8 BE / bXXXXXX 2 Mbps NA 0 Kbps

Total 14 Mbps 0 Kbps 8.7 Mbps

2017

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Quality of Service (QoS) MN-CDM625

Notes:

2018

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


Appendix A. CABLE DRAWINGS
A.1 Overview
The EIA-530 standard pinout, provided on the CDM-625, is becoming more popular in many applications. However, there are still many
occasions especially for existing EIA-422/449 and V.35 users when a conversion is required. For these situations:

Figure A-1 depicts the cable required for EIA-530 -to- EIA-422/449 DCE conversion.

Figure A-2 depicts the cable required for EIA-530 -to- V.35 DCE conversion.

Figure A-3 depicts a standard EIA-232 cable for connection between the CDM-625 Rear Panel Remote Control port and any
serial port on the user PC.

All dimensions, where specified in the illustrations featured in this appendix, are in inches.

A-1

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix A MN-CDM625

A.1.1 EIA-530 to RS-422/449 DCE Conversion Cable


Use the EIA-530 to RS-422/449 DCE Conversion Cable (Figure A-1) for connections between the CDM-625 and the user data.

Figure A-1. EIA-530 to RS-422/449 DCE Conversion Cable (CEFD P/N CA/WR0049)

A-2

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix A MN-CDM625

A.1.2 EIA-530 to V.35 DCE Conversion Cable


Use the EIA-530 to V.35 DCE Conversion Cable (Figure A-2) for connections between the CDM-625 and the user data.

Figure A-2. EIA-530 to V.35 DCE Conversion Cable

A-3

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix A MN-CDM625

A.1.3 RS-232 Remote Control Cable


The RS-232 Remote Control Cable (Figure A-3) is required for firmware updates in the absence of an Ethernet-based connection. It is
also used for serial-based M&C of the CDM-625. Connect this cable from the CDM-625 Rear Panel Remote Control port to any user PC
serial port.

Figure A-3. RS-232 Remote Control Cable (CDM-625 Remote Control Port to PC 9-Pin Serial Port)

A-4

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


Appendix B. Eb/No
MEASUREMENT
Although the CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem calculates and displays the value of receive
Eb/N0 on the front panel of the unit, it is sometimes useful to measure the value using a
spectrum analyzer, if one is available.

The idea is to accurately measure the value of (Co+No)/No, (Carrier density + Noise density/Noise
density). This is accomplished by tuning the center frequency of the Spectrum analyzer to the
signal of interest, and measuring the difference between the peak spectral density of the signal
(the flat part of the spectrum shown) and the noise density.

To make this measurement:

Use a vertical scale of 1 or 2 dB/division.

Set the Resolution Bandwidth of the Spectrum Analyzer to < 20 % of the symbol rate.

Use video filtering and/or video averaging to reduce the variance in the displayed trace
to a low enough level that the difference can be measured to within 0.2dB.

Place a marker on the flat part of the signal of interest, then use the MARKER DELTA
function to put a second marker on the noise to the side of the carrier. This value is
(Co+No)/No, in dB.

Use this value of (Co+No)/No in the table on the following page to determine the Eb/No.
You will need to know the operating mode to read from the appropriate column.

If the (Co+No)/No value measured does not correspond to an exact table entry,
interpolate using the two nearest values.

Note that the accuracy of this method degrades significantly at low values of (Co+No)/No
(approximately less than 6 dB).

B1

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix B MN-CDM625

Example: In the above diagram, the (Co+No)/No measured is 4.6 dB. If Rate 1/2 QPSK is used,
this corresponds to an Eb/N0 of approximately 2.6 dB. The exact relationship used to derive the
table values is as follows:

Eb/N0=10log10(10(Co+No/No)/10)-1)-10log10(FEC Code Rate)-10log10(bits/symbol)


Where:
Eb/N0 and (Co+No)/ No are expressed in dB;
bits/symbol = 1 for BPSK;
bits/symbol = 2 for QPSK;
bits/symbol = 3 for 8-PSK/8-QAM;
bits/symbol = 4 for 16-QAM;
FEC Code Rate for uncoded = 1.

Note: Pay close attention to the sign of the middle term.

See Chapter 12. ESC++ for details of how the Eb/No performance degrades when
ESC++ is used, particularly at lower data rates, where the percentage overhead is
high.

B2

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


Eb/No Eb/No Eb/No Eb/No Eb/No Eb/No Eb/No Eb/No Eb/No Eb/No Eb/No Eb/No Eb/No Eb/No Eb/No
(Co+No)
Uncoded Rate 1/2 Rate 21/44 Rate 5/16 Uncoded Rate 1/2 Rate 3/4 Rate 7/8 Rate 0.95 Rate 2/3 Rate 3/4 Rate 7/8 Rate 0.95 Rate 3/4 Rate 7/8
/No
BPSK BPSK BPSK BPSK QPSK QPSK QPSK QPSK QPSK 8-PSK 8-PSK 8-PSK 8-PSK 16-QAM 16-QAM
Appendix B

1.4 - - - 0.8 - - - - - - - - - - -
1.6 - - - 1.5 - - - - - - - - - - -
1.8 - - - 2.1 - - - - - - - - - - -
2.0 - 0.7 0.9 2.7 - - - - - - - - - - -
2.2 - 1.2 1.4 3.2 - - - - - - - - - -
2.4 - 1.7 1.9 3.7 - - - - - - - - - - -
2.6 - 2.1 2.3 4.2 - - - - - - - - - - -
2.8 - 2.6 2.8 4.6 - - - - - - - - - - -
3.0 0.0 3.0 3.2 5.0 - - - - - - - - - - -
CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem

3.5 0.9 3.9 4.1 5.9 - 0.9 - - - - - - - - -

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


4.0 1.8 4.8 5.0 6.8 - 1.8 - - - - - - - - -
4.5 2.6 5.6 5.8 7.6 - 2.6 0.8 - - - - - - - -
5.0 3.3 6.3 6.5 8.4 - 3.3 1.5 0.9 - - - - - - -
5.5 4.1 7.1 7.3 9.1 1.1 4.1 2.3 1.7 1.3 - - - - - -
6.0 4.7 7.7 7.9 9.8 1.7 4.7 2.9 2.3 1.9 - - - - - -
6.5 5.4 8.4 8.6 10.4 2.4 5.4 3.6 3.0 2.6 - - - - - -
7.0 6.0 9.0 9.2 11.1 3.0 6.0 4.2 3.6 3.2 - - - - - -
7.5 6.6 9.6 9.8 11.7 3.6 6.6 4.8 4.2 3.8 - - - - - -
8.0 7.3 10.3 10.5 12.3 4.3 7.3 5.5 4.9 4.5 - - - - - -
8.5 7.8 10.8 11.0 12.9 4.8 7.8 6.0 5.4 5.0 4.8 - - - - -

B3
9.0 8.4 11.4 11.6 13.4 5.4 8.4 6.6 6.0 5.6 5.4 4.9 - - - -
9.5 9.0 12.0 12.2 14.0 6.0 9.0 7.2 6.6 6.2 6.0 5.5 4.8 4.5 - -
10.0 9.5 12.5 12.7 14.6 6.5 9.5 7.7 7.1 6.7 6.5 6.0 5.3 5.0 - -
10.5 10.1 13.1 13.3 15.1 7.1 10.1 8.3 7.7 7.3 7.1 6.6 5.9 5.6 5.3 -
11.0 10.6 13.6 13.8 15.7 7.6 10.6 8.8 8.2 7.8 7.6 7.1 6.4 6.1 5.8 5.2
11.5 11.2 14.2 14.4 16.2 8.2 11.2 9.4 8.8 8.4 8.2 7.7 7.0 6.7 6.4 5.8
12.0 11.7 14.7 14.9 16.7 8.7 11.7 9.9 9.3 8.9 8.7 8.2 7.5 7.2 6.9 6.3
12.5 12.2 15.2 15.4 17.3 9.2 12.2 10.4 9.8 9.4 9.2 8.7 8.0 7.7 7.4 6.8
13.0 12.8 15.8 16.0 17.8 9.8 12.8 11.0 10.4 10.0 9.8 9.3 8.6 8.3 8.0 7.4
13.5 13.3 16.3 16.5 18.3 10.3 13.3 11.5 10.9 10.5 10.3 9.8 9.1 8.8 8.5 7.9
14.0 13.8 16.8 17.0 18.8 10.8 13.8 12.0 11.4 11.0 10.8 10.3 9.6 9.3 9.0 8.4
14.5 14.3 17.3 17.5 19.4 11.3 14.3 12.5 11.9 11.5 11.3 10.8 10.1 9.8 9.5 8.9
15.0 14.9 17.9 18.1 19.9 11.9 14.9 13.1 12.5 12.1 11.9 11.4 10.7 10.4 10.1 9.5
15.5 15.4 18.4 18.6 20.4 12.4 15.4 13.6 13.0 12.6 12.4 11.9 11.2 10.9 10.6 10.0
16.0 15.9 18.9 19.1 20.9 12.9 15.9 14.1 13.5 13.1 12.9 12.4 11.7 11.4 11.1 10.5
16.5 16.4 19.4 19.6 21.4 13.4 16.4 14.6 14.0 13.6 13.4 12.9 12.2 11.9 11.6 11.0
17.0 16.9 19.9 20.1 21.9 13.9 16.9 15.1 14.5 14.1 13.9 13.4 12.7 12.4 12.1 11.5
17.5 17.4 20.4 20.6 22.4 14.4 17.4 15.6 15.0 14.6 14.4 13.9 13.2 12.9 12.6 12.0
18.0 17.9 20.9 21.1 23.0 14.9 17.9 16.1 15.5 15.1 14.9 14.4 13.7 13.4 13.1 12.5
18.5 18.4 21.4 21.6 23.5 15.4 18.4 16.6 16.0 15.6 15.4 14.9 14.2 13.9 13.6 13.0
19.0 18.9 21.9 22.1 24.0 15.9 18.9 17.1 16.5 16.1 15.9 15.4 14.7 14.4 14.1 13.5
19.5 19.5 22.5 22.7 24.5 16.5 19.5 17.7 17.1 16.7 16.5 16.0 15.3 15.0 14.7 14.1
20.0 20.0 23.0 23.2 25.0 17.0 20.0 18.2 17.6 17.2 17.0 16.5 15.8 15.5 15.2 14.6
Notes: IBS Framing: add 0.2 dB EDMAC Framing: rates below 2048 kbps add 0.2 dB, otherwise 0 Reed-Solomon: add an additional 0.4 dB to the values shown
MN-CDM625
Revision 13
CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix B MN-CDM625

Notes:

B4

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


Appendix C. FAST ACTIVATION
PROCEDURE
C.1 FAST System Overview
The CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem incorporates a number of optional features. In order
to permit a lower initial cost, you may purchase the unit enabled with only the desired features.

If you wish to upgrade the functionality of a unit at a later date, Comtech EF Data provides Fully
Accessible System Topology (FAST), which permits the purchase and activation of options
through special authorization codes. You may purchase these unique, register-specific Fast
Access Codes from Comtech EF Data during normal business hours, and then load these codes
into the unit using either the front panel keypad or the CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface.
Contact a Comtech EF Data sales representative during normal business hours, or via e-mail to
sales@comtechefdata.com, to order the desired options.
See Table 1-2 in Chapter 1. INTRODUCTION or Sect. 5.2.8.1.1 in Chapter 5. FRONT
PANEL OPERATION for listings of the available FAST and FAST-accessible hardware
options.
FAST System Theory: FAST facilitates on-location upgrade of the operating feature set without
removing a unit from the setup. FAST technology allows you to order a unit precisely tailored for
the initial application. When your service requirements change, you can upgrade the topology of
the unit to meet these requirements within minutes. This accelerated upgrade can be
accomplished because of FASTs extensive use of the programmable logic devices incorporated
into Comtech EF Data products.

FAST Implementation: Comtech EF Datas FAST system is factory-implemented in the modem.


All FAST options are available through the basic platform unit at the time of order FAST allows
immediate activation of available options, after confirmation by Comtech EF Data, through the
CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface.

FAST Accessible Options: Hardware options can be ordered and installed either at the factory or
in the field. Depending on the current hardware configuration of the unit, you can select options
that can be easily activated on-site. The FAST Access Code that is purchased from Comtech EF
Data enables configuration of the available hardware. The base CDM-625 unit is equipped with
Viterbi and Reed-Solomon codecs. It offers BPSK, QPSK, and OQPSK modulation types, and data
rates up to 5.0 Mbps, with all interface types. While it is limited to Closed Network operation, it
also includes EDMAC and AUPC.

C1

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix C MN-CDM625

C.2 FAST Activation Procedure

C.2.1 FAST Activation via the CDM-625 Front Panel

See Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION for c omplete i nformation a bout


using this interface.

Step Task
1 Before contacting Comtech EF Data to order FAST feature upgrades, obtain and r ecord the modems
motherboard serial number:

a) From the front panel main menu, SELECT: FAST, and then press [ENTER].

b) The modems 9-digit Baseboard S/N is displayed on the bottom line, to the left.

c) Record Serial Number: ______________________________________


2 View the currently installed features. Proceed as follows:

a) From the front panel main menu, SELECT: FAST, then press [ENTER].

b) From the SELECT: FAST OPTIONS menu, select View Options, then press [ENTER].

c) Use the up and down arrow keys ) ( to scroll through the list of available FAST options.
Options ar e i dentified as Installed or Not In stalled. A ny t hat are Not In stalled may be
purchased as a FAST upgrade.
3 Contact a Comtech EF Data sales representative during normal business hours to order features:

Provide the unit Serial Number to the representative.

Identify and purchase the desired FAST option(s).

Obtain the invoice, the register-specific 20-digit FAST Access Code(s), and the FAST option
activation instructions.
When a F AST ac cess c ode i s obt ained f rom C omtech E F D ata, it will be for a
specific option register. The FAST options are linked to three option registers:

Register 1 is for Data Rate options.

Register 2 is for L-Band, Modulation type and Framing options.

Register 3 is the Fractional CnC option.


4 Enter the FAST access code(s):

a) Press [CLEAR] to return to the SELECT: FAST Options Set Registers menu.

b) Use the arrow keys ( ) to carefully enter each register-specific 20-character FAST
access code.

c) Press [ENTER].

C2

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix C MN-CDM625

Step Task
For Firmware Ver. 1.5.1 or earlier, enter the FAST access code for option
register(s) #1, #2 and/or #3 as required. For Firmware Ver. 1.5.2 and
later, all three FAST access codes must be entered in sequence in order
for the purchased option upgrades to be properly activated.
The m odem r esponds with Configured Successfully i f th e FAST upgrade is accepted; the m odem
then resets to its newly-incorporated default configuration.

However, if an invalid code is entered, the following message displays:

Failed to configure. Re-enter code.


88888888888888888888 then [ENTER]()

Repeat the FAST access code entry procedure. Should the code entry error persist, contact Comtech
EF Data Customer Support for further assistance.

C3

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix C MN-CDM625

C.2.2 FAST Activation via the CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface

See Chapter 6. ETHERNET-BASED REMOTE PRODUCT MANAGEMENT for


complete information about using this interface.

Figure C-1. CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface ADMIN | FAST page
Use the CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface Admin | FAST page (Figure C-1) for complete
management of FAST Features. This page provides scrollable list boxes that display the
availability and activation status for all FAST options. FAST code entry/option activation control
is also provided.

Step Task
1 Before contacting Comtech EF Data to order FAST feature upgrades, use the front panel SELECT: FAST
menu, as explained in Sect. C.2.1 Step 1, to obtain and record the modems motherboard serial number.

Record Serial Number: ______________________________________

2 Use the Admin | FAST page to view the currently installed features. Any options that appear in the
scrollable Options Not Installed list box may be purchased as a FAST upgrade.

C4

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix C MN-CDM625

Step Task
3 Contact a Comtech EF Data sales representative during normal business hours to order features:

Provide the unit Serial Number to the representative.

Identify and purchase the desired FAST option(s).

Obtain the invoice, the register-specific 20-digit FAST Access Code(s), and t he FAST option
activation instructions.

When a F AST ac cess c ode i s obt ained f rom C omtech E F D ata, it will be for a
specific option register. The FAST options are linked to three option registers:

Register 1 is for Data Rate options.

Register 2 is for L-Band, Modulation type and Framing options.

Register 3 is the Fractional CnC option.


4 Enter the FAST access code(s):

a) In the Admin | FAST page FAST code section, carefully enter each register-specific 20-
character FAST access code in sequence.

b) Click [Submit FAST code].

With Firmware Ver. 2.1.0 and later, all three FAST access codes must be entered in
sequence in order for the purchased option upgrades to be properly activated.

The message Configured S uccessfully appears at the t op of t he FAST code section if th e FAST
upgrade is accepted; the modem then resets to its newly-incorporated default configuration.

However, if an invalid code is entered, either of the following messages may appear instead:

Repeat the FAST access code entry procedure. Should the code entry error persist, contact Comtech EF
Data Customer Support for further assistance.

C5

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix C MN-CDM625

Notes:

C6

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


Appendix D. REMOTE CONTROL
D.1 Introduction
The CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem serial remote product management interface is an electrical interface that is either an EIA-485
multi-drop bus (for the control of multiple devices) or an EIA-232 connection (for the control of a single device). The interface transmits
data in asynchronous serial form, using ASCII characters. This data consists of control and status information, transmitted in packets of
variable length in accordance with the structure and protocol explained later in this appendix.

D.2 EIA-485
For applications where multiple devices are to be monitored and controlled, a full-duplex (or 4-wire plus ground) EIA-485 is preferred.
Half-duplex (2-wire plus ground) EIA-485 is possible, but is not preferred. In full-duplex EIA-485 communication, there are two separate,
isolated, independent, differential-mode twisted pairs, each handling serial data in different directions.

It is assumed that a 'Controller' device (a PC or dumb terminal) transmits data in a broadcast mode via one of the pairs. Multiple 'Target'
devices are connected to this pair, and all simultaneously receive data from the Controller. The Controller is the only device with a line-
driver connected to this pair the Target devices have only line-receivers connected.

In the other direction, on the other pair each Target has a tri-state line driver connected, and the Controller has a line-receiver
connected. All the line drivers are held in high-impedance mode until one (and only one) Target transmits back to the Controller. Each
Target has a unique address, and each time the Controller transmits, the address of the intended recipient Target is included in a framed
'packet' of data. All of the Targets receive the packet, but only one (the intended) will reply. The Target enables its output line driver and
transmits its return data packet back to the Controller in the other direction, on the physically separate pair.

D1

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

EIA-485 (full duplex) summary:

Two differential pairs one pair for Controller-to-Target, one pair for Target-to-Controller.

Controller-to-Target pair has one line driver (Controller), and all Targets have line-receivers.

Target-to-Controller pair has one line receiver (Controller), and all Targets have Tri-State drivers.

D.3 EIA-232
This is a much simpler configuration in which the Controller device is connected directly to the Target via a two-wire-plus-ground
connection. Controller-to-Target data is carried, via EIA-232 electrical levels on one conductor, and Target-to-Controller data is carried in
the other direction on the other conductor.

D.4 Basic Protocol


Whether in EIA-232 or EIA-485 mode, all data is transmitted as asynchronous serial characters, suitable for transmission and reception
by a Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter (UART). The asynchronous character format is 8-N-1 (8 data bits, no parity, 1 stop bit).
The baud rate may vary from 1200 to 38400 baud.

All data is transmitted in framed packets. The Controller is in charge of the process of monitor and control, and is the only device that is
permitted to initiate, at will, the transmission of data. Targets are only permitted to transmit when they have been specifically instructed
to do so by the Controller.

All bytes within a packet are printable ASCII characters, less than ASCII code 127. In this context, the Carriage Return and Line Feed
characters are considered printable.

All messages from Controller-to-Target require a response, with one exception: This will be either to return data that has been
requested by the Controller, or to acknowledge reception of an instruction to change the configuration of the Target. The exception to
this is when the Controller broadcasts a message (such as Set Time/Date) using Address 0, when the Target is set to EIA-485 mode.

D2

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

D.4.1 Packet Structure


The exchange of information is transmitted, Controller-to-Target and Target-to-Controller, in packets. Each packet contains a finite
number of bytes consisting of printable ASCII characters, excluding ASCII code 127 (DELETE).

In this context, the Carriage Return and Line Feed characters are considered printable. With one exception, all messages from Controller-
to-Target require a response this will be either to return data that has been requested by the Controller, or to acknowledge reception of an
instruction to change the configuration of the Target.

Controller-to-Target
Start of Packet Target Address Address Delimiter Instruction Code Code Qualifier Optional Arguments End of Packet
< / = or ? Carriage Return
ASCII code 60 ASCII code 47 ASCII codes 61 or 63 ASCII code 13
(1 character) (4 characters) (1 character) (3 characters) (1 character) (n characters) (1 character)

Example: <0135/TFQ=70.2345{CR}
Target-to-Controller
Start of Packet Target Address Address Delimiter Instruction Code Code Qualifier Optional Arguments End of Packet
> / =, ?, !, or * Carriage Return, Line
ASCII code 62 ASCII code 47 ASCII codes Feed
61, 63, 33, or 42 ASCII codes 13,10
(1 character) (4 characters) (1 character) (3 characters) (1 character) (From 0 to n characters) (2 characters)

Example: >0654/RSW=32{CR}{LF}

D.4.1.1 Start of Packet


Controller-to-Target: This is the character < (ASCII code 60).

Target-to-Controller: This is the character > (ASCII code 62).

The < and > characters indicate the start of packet. They may not appear anywhere else within the body of the message.

D3

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

D.4.1.2 Target Address


Up to 9999 devices can be uniquely addressed. In EIA-232 applications this value is set to 0. In EIA-485 applications, the permissible
range of values is 1 to 9999. It is programmed into a Target unit using the front panel keypad.
The Controller sends a packet with the address of a Target the destination of the packet. When the Target responds,
the address used is the same address, to indicate to the Controller the source of the packet. The Controller does not
have its own address.

D.4.1.3 Address Delimiter


This is the forward slash character '/' (ASCII code 47).

D.4.1.4 Instruction Code


This is a three-character alphabetic sequence, which identifies the subject of the message. Wherever possible, the instruction codes have
been chosen to have some significance e.g., TFQ for transmit frequency, RMD for receive modulation type, etc. This aids in the readability
of the message, should it be displayed in its raw ASCII form. Only upper case alphabetic characters may be used (A-Z, ASCII codes 65 - 90).

D.4.1.5 Instruction Code Qualifier


This is a single character, which further qualifies the preceding instruction code. Code Qualifiers obey the following rules:

1. From Controller-to-Target, the only permitted values are:

Symbol Definition
= The = code is used as the Assignment Operator (AO) and is used to indicate that the parameter defined by the preceding byte should
(ASCII code 61) be set to the value of the argument (s) which follow it.
Example: In a message from Controller-to-Target, TFQ=0950.0000 would mean set the transmit frequency to 950 MHz.
? The ? c ode i s us ed as t he Query O perator ( QO) and i s us ed to i ndicate t hat t he Target should r eturn t he c urrent value of t he
(ASCII code 63) parameters defined by the preceding byte.
Example: In a message from Controller-to-Target, TFQ? Would mean return the current value of the transmit frequency.

D4

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

2. From Target-to-Controller, the only permitted values are:

Symbol Definition
= The = code is used in two ways:
(ASCII code 61) a. If the Controller has sent a query code to a Target.
(Example: TFQ? (meaning whats the Transmit frequency?), the Target would respond with TFQ=xxxx.xxxx, where xxxx.xxxx
represents the frequency in question.
b. If the Controller sends an instruction to set a parameter to a particular value, then, providing the value sent is valid, the Target will
acknowledge the message by replying with TFQ= (with no message arguments).

? If th e Controller sends an instruction t o s et a par ameter t o a p articular v alue, t hen, i f the v alue s ent i s not valid, t he Target will
(ASCII code 63) acknowledge the message by replying (for example) with TFQ? (with no message arguments). This indicates that there was an error in
the message sent by the Controller.
! If the Controller sends an instruction code which the Target does not recognize, the Target will acknowledge the message by echoing
(ASCII code 33) the invalid instruction, followed by the ! character.
Example: XYZ!
* If the Controller sends an instruction to set a parameter to a particular value, then, if the value sent is valid BUT the modulator will not
(ASCII code 42) permit that particular parameter to be c hanged at this time, the Target will acknowledge the message by replying, for example, with
TFQ* (with message arguments).
# If the Controller sends a correctly formatted command BUT the modem is in local mode, it will not allow reconfiguration and will
(ASCI code 35) respond with TFQ#
~ If a m essage was sent via a l ocal modem to a di stant end device or ODU, the message was transmitted transparently through the
(ASCI code 126) local modem. In the event of the distant-end device not responding, the local modem would generate a response.
Example: 0001/RET~ (indicating that it had finished waiting for a response and was now ready for further comms).
^ If the Controller sends a correctly formatted command BUT the modem is in Ethernet Remote mode, it will not allow reconfiguration,
(ASCI code 94) and will respond with TFQ^.

D5

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

D.4.1.6 Optional Message Arguments


Arguments are not required for all messages. Arguments are ASCII codes for the characters 0 to 9 (ASCII codes 48 to 57), period (ASCII code
46) and comma (ASCII code 44).

D.4.1.7 End Of Packet


Controller-to-Target: This is the Carriage Return character (ASCII code 13).

Target-to-Controller: This is the two-character sequence Carriage Return, Line Feed (ASCII codes 13 and 10). Both indicate
the valid termination of a packet.

D6

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

D.5 Remote Commands and Queries

D.5.1 Table Indexes


Notes:

1. Index Columns Where Column C = Command, and Column Q = Query, columns marked X designate the instruction code as
Command only, Query only, or Command or Query. Where CODE = XXX, this indicates a priority command.

2. In the tables that follow, the following codes are used in the Response to Command column (per Sect. D.5.5):
= Message ok # Message ok, but unit is not in Remote mode.
? Received ok, but invalid arguments were found. ~ Time out of a pass-through message, either to via EDMAC or to a local ODU
^ Message ok, but unit is in Ethernet mode.

Sect. D.5.2 Tx Parameters


CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE
APP X X D-16 TBA X X D-17 TFQ X X D-13 TMX X X D-13 TTF X D-18
AUP X X D-15 TCI X X D-17 TFT X X D-11 TPL X X D-14 TVL X X D-17
DTS X X D-17 TCK X X D-16 TIR X D-18 TRS X X D-14 TXA X X D-15
DTY X X D-17 TCR X X D-12 TIT X X D-10 TSC X X D-14 TXO X X D-15
TDI X X D-14 TLO X X D-18 TSI X X D-14
PLI X D-16 TDR X X D-13 TMD X X D-11 TSR X X D-13
TET X X D-18 TMI X D-18 TTA X X D-17
REB X D-16 TFM X X D-10 TMR X X D-13 TTC X X D-17

Sect. D.5.3 Rx Parameters


CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE
EBA X X D-24 RCI X X D-24 RFM X X D-19 RMR X X D-22 RTC X X D-25
ITS X X D-25 RCK X X D-24 RFQ X X D-22 RMX X X D-22 RTE X X D-24
ITY X X D-24 RCR X X D-21 RFT X X D-20 RRS X X D-23 RTF X D-25
RDI X X5 D-23 RIR X D-26 RSI X X D-23 RVL X X D-24
RDR X X D-22 RIT X X D-19 RSL X D-46
RBA X X D-25 RDS X X D-23 RLO X X D-25 RSN X D-52
RBS X X D-24 REE X X D-26 RMD X X D-20 RSR X X D-22
RCB X D-25 RET X X D-25 RMI X D-26 RSW X X D-23

D7

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Sect. D.5.4 Unit Parameters


CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE
ABA X X D-30 CAI X X D-38 EFR X X D-29 LRS X X D-27 RNS X D-32
ACM X X D-38 CAS X D-33 EMU X X D-27 MAC X D-34 RTS X X D-35
ADJ X X D-29 CCF X X D-36 ESA X X D-28 MEO X X D-39 SCP X X D-29
AHD X X D-39 CEX X X D-36 ESC X X D-28 MRC X X D-27 SSI X X D-31
AHM X X D-39 CID X X D-27 FPL X X D-27 MSK X X D-30
AHO X X D-39 CNM X X D-35 FRB X X D-38 NUE X D-31 TBP X X D-37
ALA X X D-30 CPM X X D-36 FSW X D-33 NUS X D-32 TIM X X D-28
BKE X X D-38 CSD X X D-36 HHC X X D-35 ODU X X D-33 TPB X X D-40
BRE X D-38 CST X D-41 IEP X D-32 OFN X X D-34 TPE X X D-39
BRM X D-38 CTD X X D-30 IMG X X D-27 OTO X X D-28 TPS X X D-40
BRR X D-38 DAY X X D-27 IPA X X D-34 PCO X X D-35 TST X X D-30
BRX X X D-37 DMM X X D-39 IPG X X D-34 RBP X X D-37
BTX X X D-37 DMT X D-39 IPT X X D-34 RNE X D--31
CAE X D-31 EFM X X D-28 ISP X D-33 RNN X D-33 WRM X X D-29

Sect. D.5.5 Bulk Configuration Strings


CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE
BSQ X D-46 CLD X D-45 DIC X X D-44 MGC X X D-41 QDI X X D-45
CST X D-45 DNI X X D-44 OGC X X D-43

Sect. D.5.6 Modem Information


CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE
EID X D-48 FCF X D-47 HRV X D-47 SNO X D-47 SW2 X D-47
FCC X D-47 FRW X D-47 SWR X D-47

Sect. D.5.7 Modem Performance Information


CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE
ABE X D-54 APS X D-55 EBN X D-50 RBE X D-56 SNR X D-56
ABR X D-54 BER X D-50 RED X D-50
AFE X D-54 BFS X D-50 FLT X D-51 RFO X D-50
AFR X D-54 CDM X D-53 RSL X D-50 TMP X D-50
AHS X X D-56 CFM X D-53 OUS X D-51 RSN X D-56
APC X D-54 CPR X D-53
APL X X D-55 CRM X D-53 PSD X D-54

D8

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Sect. D.5.8 BUC Parameters (L-Band Device)


CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE
BAD X X D-57 BDC X D-57 BOE X X D-57 BPS X X D-57
BCH X X D-57 BDV X D-57 BOL X D-57 BSV X D-58
BCL X X D-57 BFR X X D-57 BPA X D-58 BUT X D-58
BPC X D-58

Sect. D.5.9 LNB Parameters (L-Band Device)


CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE
LNC X D-59 LNL X X D-59 LPS X X D-59
LNH X X D-59 LNR X X D-59 LVO X D-59

Sect. D.5.10 Ethernet Parameters


CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE CODE C Q PAGE
ACL X X D-64 NPS X D-60 QOS X X D-62 SVD X D-62 VS0 X D-64
AFI X D-63 SVE X D-63 VS1 X D-64
PPE X X D-62 SEC X X D-60 SVM X X D-61 VS2 X D-64
DMP X X D-63 PRD X X D-64 SML X X D-61 SVT X X D-61
PTM X X D-64 SMV X X D-61 WBF X D-60
EFS X X D-63 PTP X X D-64 SPC X X D-62 WBL X X D-60
EGC X X D-61 SVA X X D-61 WMD X X D-63

D9

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

D.5.2 Tx Parameters
Priority System: TIT (Highest priority) , TFM, TFT, TMD, TCR, TDR, and TSR (Lowest Priority), indicated by shading. Any change to a higher
priority parameter can override any of the parameters of lower priority.

Exception Select DROP, D&I++, QDI or Framed QDI mode using TFM (Transmit Framing type), which is highest priority.

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Tx Interface TIT= 1 byte, value Command or Query. TIT= TIT? TIT=x
Type of 0 thru 9, or Tx Interface Type, where: TIT?
A 0=RS422 TIT* (see Description of
1=V.35 TIT# Arguments)
2= reserved do not use.
3=Balanced G.703
4=Unbalanced G.703
5=Audio (Data rate fixed at 64 kbps) (IBS/EDMAC only)
6=LVDS
7=HSSI
8=IP
9=ASI
A=IP-ACM (Unframed, EDMACs only)
Example: TIT=1 (selects V.35)
Tx Framing TFM= 1 byte, value Command or Query. TFM= TFM? TFM=x
Mode of 0 thru 9, A Tx Framing mode, where: TFM?
0=Unframed TFM* (see Description of
1=IBS TFM# Arguments)
2=IDR
3=D&I - DROP (requires D&I FAST option)
4=EDMAC
5=D&I++ (requires D&I FAST option)
6=ESC++
7=EDMAC-2
8=Quad Drop & Insert (requires QDI FAST option)
(G.703 Balanced, E1-CCS only)
9=Framed QDI (requires QDI FAST option)
(G.703 Balanced, E1-CCS only)
A=EDMAC-3
Example: TFM=0 (selects Unframed mode)

D10

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Tx FEC Type TFT= 1 byte, value Command or Query. TFT= TFT? TFT=x
of 0 thru 9, A, Tx FEC coding type, where: TFT?
B 0=None (uncoded) with differential encoding ON TFT* (see Description of
1=Viterbi TFT# Arguments)
2=Viterbi + Reed-Solomon
3=Sequential
4=Sequential + Reed-Solomon
5=TCM (Trellis Code Modulation)
(Forces Rate 2/3)
6=TCM + Reed-Solomon (Forces Rate 2/3)
7=TPC (aka Turbo) (requires TPC/LDPC Codec)
8=None (uncoded) with differential encoding OFF
9=LDPC (Requires TPC/LDPC Codec)
A=VersaFEC CCM or ACM (fixed in IP-ACM)
B=VersaFEC ULL
Example: TFT=1 (selects Viterbi coding)
Tx TMD= 1 byte, value Command or Query (Query only in IP-ACM). TMD= TMD? TMD=x
Modulation of 0 thru 5 Tx Modulation type in the form x, where: TMD?
Type 0=BPSK TMD* (see Description of
1=QPSK TMD# Arguments)
2=OQPSK
3=8-PSK
4=16-QAM (Turbo or Viterbi + RS only)
5=8-QAM (TPC/LDPC only) (Need Codec & FAST option)
6=Reserved
7=Reserved
8=Reserved
Depending on FEC type, not all of these selections will be valid.
Example: TMD=2 (selects OQPSK)

D11

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Tx FEC Code TCR= 1 byte, value Command or Query (Query only in IP-ACM). TCR= TCR? TCR=x
Rate of 0 thru 7, A Tx FEC Code Rate in the form x, where: TCR?
to U 0=Rate 1/2 TCR* (see Description of
1=Rate 3/4 TCR# Arguments)
2=Rate 7/8
3=Rate 2/3 (8-PSK TCM or LDPC only)
4=Rate 1/1 (Uncoded or No FEC)
5=Rate 21/44 (Turbo Only)
6=Rate 5/16 (Turbo Only)
7=Rate 0.95 (Turbo Only) (aka 17/18)
8=Reserved
9=Reserved
A=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 0 BPSK 0.488
B=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 1 QPSK 0.533
C=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 2 QPSK 0.631
D=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 3 QPSK 0.706
E=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 4 QPSK 0.803
F=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 5 8-QAM 0.642
G=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 6 8-QAM 0.711
H=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 7 8-QAM 0.780
I=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 8 16-QAM 0.731
J=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 9 16-QAM 0.780
K=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 10 16-QAM 0.829
L=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 11 16-QAM 0.853
M=Reserved
N=Reserved
O=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 14 8-QAM 0.576
P=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 15 16-QAM 0.644
Q=Reserved
R=VersaFEC CCM ULL ModCod 17 BPSK 0.493
S=VersaFEC CCM ULL ModCod 18 QPSK 0.493
T=VersaFEC CCM ULL ModCod 19 QPSK 0.654
U=VersaFEC CCM ULL ModCod 20 QPSK 0.734
Depending on FEC type, not all of these selections will be valid.
Example: TCR=1 (selects Rate 3/4)

D12

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Tx Data Rate TDR= 9 bytes Command or Query (Query only in IP-ACM). TDR= TDR? TDR=xxxxx.xxx
Tx Data rate, in kbps, between 18 kbps and 25 Mbps Resolution=1 bps TDR?
Example: TDR=02047.999 (selects 2047.999 kbps) TDR* (see Description of
Additional auxiliary G.703 sub-rates are available, selected using: TDR# Arguments)
00512.AUX
01024.AUX
02048.AUX
The connectors used for the Aux rates are IDI/DDO.
These Aux rates are not available with Drop & Insert or IDR.
Read-only if Framing Mode is Quad Drop & Insert (TFM=8). Data rate is set by assigning the number of
channels on each port.
Read-only if Modulation Type is a Reserved type
Tx TSR= 9 bytes, Query only (Command or Query in IP-ACM). TSR? TSR? TSR=ddddd.ddd
Symbol Rate numeric Allows remote access to the Tx symbol rate, in the form ddddd.ddd TSR=
Note: Symbol Rate ranges in IP-ACM = 37 ksym/sec to 4100 ksym/sec TSR* (see Description of
TSR# Arguments)
Tx Frequency TFQ= 9 bytes Command or Query. TFQ= TFQ? TFQ=xxxx.xxxx
Frequency ranges: TFQ?
50 MHz to 180 MHz, and TFQ*
950 MHz to 1950 MHz (L-Band FAST option) TFQ#
Exception Resolution=100Hz. Exception
600 Emulation Note: The CDM-625 supports 70,140 MHz bands and L-Band. 600 Emulation:
8 bytes Example: TFQ=0950.9872 TFQ=xxx.xxxx
Tx Sub-Mux TMX= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. TMX? TMX? TMX=x
on/off Tx Sub-Mux in the form x, where: TMX=
0=Off TMX* (see Description of
1=On TMX# Arguments)
Tx Sub-Mux TMR= 2 bytes, Command or Query. TMR? TMR? TMR=xx
Ratio numeric Tx Sub-Mux Ratio (IP/Synchronous Interface) in the form xx, where TMR=
00=1/9 08=2/5 16=5/4 24=7/2 TMR* (see Description of
01=1/8 09=3/7 17=4/3 25=4/1 TMR# Arguments)
02=1/7 10=1/2 18=3/2 26=5/1
03=1/6 11=3/5 19=5/3 27=6/1
04=1/5 12=2/3 20=2/1 28=7/1
05=1/4 13=3/4 21=7/3 29=8/1
06=2/7 14=4/5 22=5/2 30=9/1
07=1/3 15=1/1 23=3/1 31=1/59 32=1/39 33=1/19
Example: TMR=01 (Selects ratio 1/8)

D13

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Tx TDI= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. TDI= TDI? TDI=x
Data Invert Invert Transmit Data TDI?
Exception 0=Normal TDI* (see Description of
600/L 1=Inverted TDI# Exception Arguments)
Emulation: Example: TDI = 1 (selects TX Data Invert) 600/L Emulation:
ITD= Exception In 600/L Emulation Mode, instruction is ITD. ITD?
Tx TRS= 1 byte, value Command or Query. TRS= TRS? TRS=x
Reed- of 0 thru 3 Tx RS encoding TRS?
Solomon 0=Normal (based on the Open Network framing selected) TRS* (see Description of
Encoding 1=IESS-310 mode, valid with QDI, unframed, IBS, D&I, IDR. TRS# Arguments)
2=EF Data legacy standard (225,205) unframed, QDI only
3=IBS (126,112) unframed only
Example: TRS=0 (This is a dont care if no RS is selected under FEC Type)
Available all framing modes, except EDMAC.
Tx Spectrum TSI= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. TSI= TSI? TSI=x
Invert Tx Spectrum Invert selection, where: TSI?
0=Normal TSI* (see Description of
1=Tx Spectrum Inverted TSI# Arguments)
Example:TSI=0 (selects normal)
Tx Scrambler TSC= 1 byte, 0, 1 or Command or Query. TSC= TSC? TSC=x
2 Tx Scrambler state, where: TSC?
0=Off TSC* (see Description of
1=Normal TSC# Arguments)
2=IESS-315
Note: When CnC mode is ON, Tx Scrambler state is fixed as IESS-315.
Example: TSC=1 (Scrambler On)
Tx Power TPL= 4 bytes Command or Query. TPL= TPL? TPL=xx.x
Level Tx Output power level between 0 and -40 dBm (minus sign assumed) for 950 to 1950MHz range. TPL?
Tx Output power level between 0 and -25 dBm (minus sign assumed) for 50 to 180MHz range. TPL* (see Description of
Example: TPL=13.4 TPL# Arguments)
In AUPC mode, command is not valid. Response will be TPL*.
When APC is active, query returns TPL=99.9; when command is not valid, response will be TPL*.
When the external 20 dB attenuator is activated (via AUP), the permitted power level range shifted down by
20dB.
Example: 65 and -20 dBm.
600 Emulation:
Level range: 0 to -20 dBm (minus sign assumed).
600L Emulation:
Level range: 0 to -45 dBm (minus sign assumed).

D14

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Tx Carrier TXO= 1 byte, value Command or Query. TXO= TXO? TXO=x
State of 0 thru 9 Tx Carrier State in the form x, where: TXO?
0=OFF due to front panel or remote control command TXO* (see Description of
1=ON TXO# Arguments)
2=RTI (receive/transmit inhibit), timeout = 10 seconds
3=OFF due to ext H/W Tx Carrier- Off control *
4=OFF due to BUC or High-Stability Ref warm-up *
5= Carrier controlled by STDMA Controller *
6=RTI (receive/transmit inhibit), timeout = 1 second
7=RTI (receive/transmit inhibit), timeout = 2 seconds
8=RTI (receive/transmit inhibit), timeout = 4 seconds
9=RTI (receive/transmit inhibit), timeout = 7 seconds
Note: arguments indicated with a * are status-only. They are not valid as a command, and are not
indicated in MGC? response.
Example: TXO=1 (Tx Carrier ON)
Tx Alpha TXA= 1 byte, value of Command or Query. TXA= TXA? TXA=x
0 or 1 Tx Filter Rolloff Factor in the form x, where: TXA? (see Description of
x = 0 (0.35) or 1 (0.25) TXA# Arguments)
Example: TXA=0 (Tx filter rolloff factor is 0.35)
Power Level AUP= 1 byte, 0, 1, 2 Command or Query. AUP= AUP? AUP=x
Mode or 3 Power level mode in the form x, where: AUP?
(was AUPC 0=MANUAL mode (AUPC disabled). AUP* (see Description of
Enable) Normal power mode AUP# Arguments)
1=AUPC enabled.
2=MANUAL-LOW.
Low power mode (-65 to -20dBm) - external attenuator activated.
3=AUPC-LOW.
AUPC enabled and external attenuator activated
Example: AUP=1
Notes:
1. EDMAC or D&I++, E1 D&I w/ccs or ESC++ framing must be selected for the AUPC feature to be
available.
2. External 20dB Attenuator is a hardware option.

D15

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
AUPC APP= 6 bytes Command or Query. APP= APP? APP=abc.cd
Parameters Defines AUPC operating parameters in the form abc.cd: APP?
a=Defines action on max. power condition, where: APP* (see Description of
(0=do nothing, 1=generate Tx alarm) APP# Arguments)
b=Defines action on remote demod unlock, where:
(0=go to nominal power, 1=go to max power)
c.c=Target Eb/No value, for remote demod from 0.0 to 14.9 dB, where:
numbers above 9.9 use hex representation for the first character, i.e. 14.9 is coded as E.9.
d =Max increase in Tx Power permitted, from 0.0 to 9.0 dB
Example: APP=015.67 (Sets no alarm, max power, 5.6 dB Target and 7 dB power increase.)

In IP-ACM mode:
a=Defines action on max. power condition, where:
(0=do nothing, 1=generate Tx alarm when max power is reached, 2=generate Tx alarm when mimimum
ModCod is reached)
b=Defines action on remote demod unlock, where:
(0=go to nominal power, 1=go to max power, 2=hold)
c.c = Max increase in Tx Power permitted, from 0.0 to 9.9 dB OR when CnC mode is on, from 0.0 to 3.0 dB
d = Mode (0=Normal, 1=+/- Track), read-only
Remote N/A 4 bytes Query only. N/A REB? REB=xx.x
Eb/No Returns the value of Eb/No of the remote demod in the form xx.x, where:
xx.x=02.0 to 16.0 (see Description of
Responds 99.9 = remote demod unlocked. Arguments)
Responds xx.x if EDMAC is disabled.
Example: REB=12.4
Note: For values > 16.0 dB, the reply will be 16.0
Tx Power N/A 3 bytes Query only. N/A PLI? PLI=x.x
Level Returns the increase in Tx power level, in dB (from the nominal setting) due to the action of AUPC.
Increase Responds x.x if AUPC is disabled. (see Description of
Example: PLI=2.3 Arguments)
Tx Clock TCK= 1 byte, value Command or Query. TCK= TCK? TCK=x
Source of 0 thru 3 Tx Clock Source, where: TCK?
0=Internal TCK* (see Description of
1=Tx Terrestrial TCK# Arguments)
2=Rx Loop-Timed
3=Ext TT (ST=RxSat)
Example: TCK=0 (selects Internal)

D16

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Tx Clock TCI= 1 byte, value 0 Command or Query. TCI= TCI? TCI=x
Invert or 1 Invert Transmit Data Clock in the form x, where: TCI?
0=Normal TCI* (see Description of
1=Inverted TCI# Arguments)
Tx Audio TVL= 4 bytes Command or Query. (Audio/IDR parameter) TVL= TVL? TVL=aabb
Volume Tx Audio Volume control in the form aabb, where: TVL?
Control aa=Tx 1 volume control in dB, valid values are -6, -4, -2, +0, +2, +4, +6, +8; TVL* (see Description of
bb=Tx 2 volume control in dB, valid values are -6, -4, -2, +0, +2, +4, +6, +8; TVL# Arguments)
Example: TVL= -2+4 (sets Tx 1 to 2 dB and Tx 2 to +4 dB)
Transmit TTA= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. (DROP parameter) TTA= TTA? TTA=x
Terrestrial Transmit terrestrial Alarm Mask conditions in the form x, where: TTA?
Alarm Mask 0=Alarm is active (unmasked). TTA* (see Description of
1=Alarm is masked. TTA# Arguments)
Example: TTA=1 (masks an alarm).
Drop Type DTY= 1 byte, value Command or Query. (DROP/D&I++/QDI parameter) DTY= DTY? DTY=x
of 0 thru 3 Drop Type in the form x, where: DTY?
0=T1D4 DTY* (see Description of
1=T1ESF DTY# Arguments)
2=E1CCS
3=E1CAS
Tx Drop DTS= 3 bytes Command or Query. (Drop parameter) DTS= DTS? DTS=yyyyyyyyyyyyy
Timeslot (Note different format between command and query.) DTS? yyyyyyyyyyy
Command format: DTS=xxy, where: DTS* indicating all 24 Drop
xx = Channel 01 through 24 DTS# timeslots values
y = timeslot: 0-9, A=10, B=11, C=12, D=13,V=31 associated with the
24 Tx Satellite
channels.
Tx Ternary TTC= 1 byte, value Command or Query. (G.703 parameter) TTC= TTC? TTC=x
Code of 0 thru 3 Tx Ternary Code in the form x, where: TTC?
0=AMI TTC* (see Description of
1=B8ZS TTC# Arguments)
2=B6ZS
3=HDB3
Example: TTC=1 (selects B8ZS)
Transmit TBA= 4 bytes, each Command or Query. (IDR parameter) TBA= TBA? TBA=xxxx
Backward a value of 0 Transmit Backward Alarm enable in the form xxxx, where: TBA?
Alarms thru 2 0=Disable TBA* Position indicates
Enable 1=Enable Internal (S/W) TBA# backward alarm
2=Enable External (H/W) numbers: 1234
Example: TBA=0120

D17

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Transmit TET= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. (IDR parameter) TET= TET? TET=x
ESC Type IDR ESC Type in the form x, where: TET?
0=64k data channel TET* (see Description of
1=2 Audio channels TET# Arguments)
TX LO TLO= 6 bytes Command or Query. TLO= TLO? TLO=xxxxxs
Frequency Tx LO frequency information in the form xxxxxs, where: TLO?
xxxxx is the LO frequency, 3000 through 65000 MHz or 00000 (OFF) TLO* (see Description of
s is the sign for the MIX TLO# Arguments)
Terminal Frequency = LO TFQ (see below)
Example: TLO=12000+ (BUC LO is 12GHz, low-side mix)
Tx Satellite N/A 10 bytes Query only. N/A TTF? TTF=xxxxx.xxxx
(Terminal) Terminal (aka satellite) Tx Frequency, which is the frequency transmitted to the satellite.
Frequency Resolution=100 Hz (see Description of
Returns 00000.0000 if LO is zero Arguments)
Example: TTF=11650.2249
Tx N/A 9 bytes, Query only. TIR? TIR? TIR=ddddd.ddd
Information numeric This command allows remote access to the Aggregate Tx Information rate in the form: ddddd.ddd TIR=
Rate TIR* (see Description of
TIR# Arguments)
Tx Sub-Mux N/A 9 bytes, Query only. TMI? TMI? TMI=ddddd.ddd
IP numeric This command allows remote access to the IP portion of the Tx Information rate in the form: ddddd.ddd TMI=
Information TMI* (see Description of
Rate TMI# Arguments)

D18

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

D.5.3 Rx Parameters
Priority System: RIT (Highest priority) , RFM, RFT, RMD, RCR, RDR, and RSR (Lowest Priority), indicated by shading. Any change to a higher
priority parameter can override any of the parameters of lower priority.

Exception Select DROP, D&I++ or QDI mode using RFM (Transmit Framing type), which is highest priority.

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Rx Interface RIT= 1 byte, value Command or Query. RIT= RIT? RIT=x
Type of 0 thru 9, or Rx Interface Type in the form x, where: RIT?
A 0=RS422 RIT* (see Description of
1=V.35 RIT# Arguments)
2= reserved do not use.
3=Balanced G.703
4=Unbalanced G.703
5=Audio (only at 64 kbps) (IBS/EDMAC only) (FAST option)
6=LVDS
7=HSSI
8=IP
9=ASI
A=IP-ACM
Example: RIT=1 (selects V.35)
Rx Framing RFM= 1 byte, value Command or Query. RFM= RFM? RFM=x
Mode of 0 thru 9, A Rx Framing mode in the form x, where: RFM?
0=Unframed RFM* (see Description of
1=IBS (requires Open Network FAST option) RFM# Arguments)
2=IDR (requires Open Network FAST option)
3=D&I (requires D&I FAST option)
4=EDMAC
5=D&I++ (requires D&I FAST option)
6=ESC++
7=EDMAC-2
8=Quad Drop & Insert (requires QDI FAST option)
9=Framed QDI (requires QDI FAST option)
(G.703 Balanced, E1-CCS only)
A=EDMAC-3
Example: RFM=0 (selects Unframed mode)

D19

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Rx FEC Type RFT= 1 byte, value Command or Query. RFT= RFT? RFT=x
of 0 thru 9, A, Rx FEC Type in the form x, where: RFT?
B 0=None (uncoded) with differential encoding ON RFT* (see Description of
1=Viterbi RFT# Arguments)
2=Viterbi + Reed-Solomon
3= Sequential
4= Sequential + Reed-Solomon
5=TCM (Trellis Code Modulation)
6=TCM + Reed-Solomon
7=TPC (aka Turbo) (Requires Codec, FAST)
8=None (uncoded) with differential encoding OFF
9=LDPC (Requires Codec, FAST)
A=VersaFEC CCM or ACM (Fixed in IP-ACM)
B=VersaFEC ULL
Example: RFT=1 (selects Viterbi only)
Rx Demod RMD= 1 byte, value Command or Query (Query only in IP-ACM). RMD= RMD? RMD=x
Type of 0 to 5 Rx Demodulation in the form x, where: RMD?
0=BPSK RMD* (see Description of
1=QPSK RMD# Arguments)
2=OQPSK
3=8-PSK (FAST option)
4=16-QAM (Turbo or Viterbi + RS only)(FAST option)
5=8-QAM (TPC/LDPC only) (Needs Codec + FAST option)
6=Reserved
7=Reserved
8=Reserved
Depending on FEC type, not all of these selections will be valid.
All other codes are invalid.
Example: RMD=2 (selects OQPSK)

D20

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Rx FEC Code RCR= 1 byte, value Command or Query (Query only in IP-ACM). RCR= RCR? RCR=x
Rate of 0 to 7, A to Rx FEC Code Rate in the form x, where: RCR?
U 0=Rate 1/2 RCR* (see Description of
1=Rate 3/4 RCR# Arguments)
2=Rate 7/8
3=Rate 2/3 (8-PSK TCM or LDPC only)
4=Rate 1/1 (Uncoded or No FEC)
5=Rate 21/44 (Turbo Only)
6=Rate 5/16 (Turbo Only)
7=Rate 0.95 (Turbo Only) (aka 17/18)
8=Reserved
9=Reserved
A=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 0 BPSK 0.488
B=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 1 QPSK 0.533
C=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 2 QPSK 0.631
D=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 3 QPSK 0.706
E=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 4 QPSK 0.803
F=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 5 8-QAM 0.642
G=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 6 8-QAM 0.711
H=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 7 8-QAM 0.780
I=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 8 16-QAM 0.731
J=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 9 16-QAM 0.780
K=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 10 16-QAM 0.829
L=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 11 16-QAM 0.853
M=Reserved
N=Reserved
O=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 14 8-QAM 0.576
P=VersaFEC CCM ModCod 15 16-QAM 0.644
Q=Reserved
R=VersaFEC CCM ULL ModCod 17 BPSK 0.493
S=VersaFEC CCM ULL ModCod 18 QPSK 0.493
T=VersaFEC CCM ULL ModCod 19 QPSK 0.654
U=VersaFEC CCM ULL ModCod 20 QPSK 0.734
Depending on FEC type, not all of these selections will be valid.
Example: RCR=1 (selects Rate 3/4)

D21

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Rx Data Rate RDR= 9 bytes Command or Query (Query only in IP-ACM). RDR= RDR? RDR=xxxxx.xxx
Rx Data Rate, in kbps, between 18 kbps to 25 Mbps. RDR?
Resolution=1 bps RDR* (see Description of
Example: RDR=02047.999. RDR# Arguments)
Additional auxiliary G.703 sub-rates are available, selected using:
00512.AUX
01024.AUX
02048.AUX
If set for QDI (Quad D&I), RDR is query only.
The connectors used for the Aux rates are IDI/DDO.
These Aux rates are not available with D&I or IDR.
Rx Symbol RSR= 9 bytes, Query only (Command or Query in IP-ACM). RSR= RSR? RSR=ddddd.ddd
Rate numeric Allows remote access to the Rx Symbol Rate in the form ddddd.ddd RSR? (see Description of
Note: Symbol Rate ranges in IP-ACM = 37 ksym/sec to 4100 ksym/sec RSR* Arguments)
RSR#
Rx RFQ= 9 bytes Command or Query. RFQ= RFQ? RFQ=xxxx.xxxx
Frequency Frequency ranges: RFQ? (see Description of
50 MHz to 180 MHz, and RFQ* Arguments)
950 MHz to 1950 MHz (L-Band FAST option) RFQ#
Exception 950 MHz to 2150 MHz (Top card hardware Revision 2) Exception
600 Emulation: Resolution=100Hz. 600 Emulation:
8 bytes Note: The CDM-625 supports 70,140 MHz bands and L-Band. RFQ=xxx.xxxx
Example: RFQ=0950.9872
Rx Sub-Mux RMX= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. RMX? RMX? RMX=x
on/off Rx Sub-Mux in the form x, where: RMX=
0=Off RMX* (see Description of
1=On RMX# Arguments)
Rx Sub-Mux RMR= 2 bytes, Command or Query. RMR? RMR? RMR=xx
Ratio numeric Rx Sub-Mux Ratio (IP/Synchronous Interface) in the form xx, where: RMR=
00=1/9 08=2/5 16=5/4 24=7/2 RMR* (see Description of
01=1/8 09=3/7 17=4/3 25=4/1 RMR# Arguments)
02=1/7 10=1/2 18=3/2 26=5/1
03=1/6 11=3/5 19=5/3 27=6/1
04=1/5 12=2/3 20=2/1 28=7/1
05=1/4 13=3/4 21=7/3 29=8/1
06=2/7 14=4/5 22=5/2 30=9/1
07=1/3 15=1/1 23=3/1 31=1/59 32=1/39 33=1/19
Example: RMR=01 (Selects ratio 1/8)

D22

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Rx Data RDI= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. RDI= RDI? RDI=x
Invert Exception Invert Receive Data in the form x, where: RDI?
600/L 0=Normal RDI* Exception (see Description of
Emulation: 1=Inverted RDI# 600/L Emulation: Arguments)
IRD= Example: RDI=1 (selects Inverted RX Data) IRD?
Rx Reed- RRS= 1 byte, value Command or Query. RRS= RRS? RRS=x
Solomon of 0 thru 3 Rx RS decoding in the form x, where: RRS?
Decoding 0=Normal (based on the Open Network framing selected) RRS* (see Description of
1=IESS-310 mode, valid with QDI, unframed, IBS, D&I, IDR. RRS# Arguments)
2=EF Data legacy standard (225,205) unframed, QDI only
3=IBS (126,112) unframed only
Note: Available in all framing modes, except EDMAC.
(This is a dont care if no R-S is selected in FEC type)
Example: RRS=0 (selects Normal)
Rx Spectrum RSI= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. RSI= RSI? RSI=x
Invert Rx Spectrum Invert in the form x, where: RSI?
0=Normal RSI* (see Description of
1=Rx Spectrum Invert RSI# Arguments)
Example: RSI=0 (selects Normal)
Rx RDS= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. RDS= RDS? RDS=x
Descrambler Rx Descrambler state in the form x, where: RDS?
0=Off RDS* (see Description of
1=Normal RDS# Arguments)
2=IESS-315
Example: RDS=1 (Scrambler On)
Rx Demod RSW= 3 bytes Command or Query. RSW= RSW? RSW=xxx
Acquisition Rx acquisition sweep range of demodulator, in kHz. Available range depends on the symbol rate: RSW?
Sweep Width 18ksps to 64ksps: 1 to the symbol rate (ksps)/2 RSW* (see Description of
Exception 64ksps to 389ksps: 1 to 32 kHz RSW# Arguments)
600L 389ksps to 2000ksps: 1 to 10% of sym rate
Emulation: >2000ksps: 1 to 200 kHz
2 bytes
Example: RSW=009 (selects 9 kHz)

D23

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Rx Clock RCK= 1 byte, value Command or Query. RCK= RCK? RCK=x
Source of 0 thru 3 Rx Clock Source in the form x, where: RCK?
0=Rx Satellite RCK* (see Description of
1=Tx-Terrestrial RCK# Arguments)
2=Internal(SCT)
3=INSERT (command valid only when Rx framing is Insert or D&I++ and interface is G.703 or set for
D&I loop)
Example: RCK=1 (selects Tx-Terrestrial)
Rx Clock RCI= 1 byte, value 0 Command or Query. RCI= RCI? RCI=x
Invert or 1 Invert Receive Clock, in the form x, where: RCI?
0=Normal RCI* (see Description of
1=Inverted RCI# Arguments)
Eb/No Alarm EBA= 4 bytes Command or Query. EBA= EBA? EBA=xx.x
Point Eb/No alarm point in dB, with a range between 0.1 and 16 dB, in the form xx.x, where: EBA?
Resolution=0.1 dB EBA* (see Description of
Example: EBA=12.3 EBA# Arguments)
Rx Buffer RBS= 5 bytes Command or Query. RBS= RBS? RBS=xxxxx
Size Rx Buffer Size, 16 to 32768 bytes, in 2-byte steps, unless other limitations apply. RBS?
(See Sect. 5.3.1.5.2) RBS* (see Description of
Example: RBS=08192 (selects 8192 bytes) RBS# Arguments)
Rx Audio RVL= 4 bytes Command or Query. (Audio/IDR parameters) RVL= RVL? RVL=aabb
Volume Rx Audio Volume control, in the form aabb, where: RVL?
Control aa=Rx 1 volume control in dB, valid values are -6, -4, -2, +0, +2, +4, +6, +8; RVL* (see Description of
bb=Rx 2 volume control in dB, valid values are -6, -4, -2, +0, +2, +4, +6, +8. RVL# Arguments)
Example: RVL= -2+4 (sets Rx 1 to -2 dB and Rx 2 to +4 dB)
Receive RTE= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. (INSERT mode parameter) RTE= RTE? RTE=x
Terrestrial Receive Terrestrial Alarm Enable conditions in the form x, where: RTE?
Alarm Enable 0=Disables the alarm RTE* (see Description of
1=Enables the alarm. RTE# Arguments)
Example: RTE=0 (disables the alarm).
Insert Type ITY= 1 byte, value Command or Query. (INSERT/D&I++/QDI parameter) ITY= ITY? ITY=x
of 0 thru 3 Insert Type, in the form x where: ITY?
0=T1D4 ITY* (see Description of
1=T1ESF ITY# Arguments)
2=E1CCS
3=E1CAS

D24

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Rx Ternary RTC= 1 byte, value Command or Query. (G.703 parameter) RTC= RTC? RTC=x
Code of 0 thru 3 Rx Ternary Code in the form x, where: RTC?
0=AMI RTC* (see Description of
1=B8ZS RTC# Arguments)
2=B6ZS
3=HDB3
Example: RTC=1 (selects B8ZS)
Receive RBA= 4 bytes, each Command or Query. (IDR parameter) RBA= RBA? RBA=xxxx
Backward a value of 0 or Enable Receive backward alarm enable in the form xxxx, where: RBA?
Alarms 1 0=Disable RBA* (see Description of
Enable 1=External trigger Enable RBA# Arguments)
Example: RBA=0101
Receive ESC RET= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. (IDR parameter) RET= RET? RET=x
Type Sets or queries IDR ESC Type in the form x, where: RET?
0=64k data channel RET* (see Description of
1=2 Audio channels RET# Arguments)
Insert ITS= 3 bytes Command or Query. (D&I/D&I++ only) ITS= ITS? ITS=yyyyyyyyyyyyy
Timeslot (Note different format between command and query.) ITS? yyyyyyyyyyy
Insert Timeslot in the form xxy, where: ITS* indicating all 24 Insert
xx = Channel 01 through 24 ITS# timeslots values
y = timeslot: 0-9, A=10, B=11, C=12, D=13,V=31 associated with the 24
Rx Satellite channels.
ReCenter RCB= None Command only. RCB= N/A N/A
Buffer Forces the software to recenter the receive Plesiochronous/Doppler buffer. RCB?
Note: This command takes no arguments. RCB*
Example: RCB= RCB#
RX LO RLO= 6 bytes Command or Query. RLO= RLO? RLO=xxxxxs
Frequency LNB Rx LO frequency information in the form xxxxxs, where: RLO?
xxxxx is the LO frequency: 03000 through 65000 MHz, or 00000=Off RLO* (see Description of
s is the sign for the MIX (Note: negative mix induces a spectral inversion) RLO# Arguments)
Note: For additional information refer to Chapter 5 for LO, MIX, and Spectrum Settings.
Terminal Frequency = RX LO modem RFQ (see below)
Rx Terminal N/A 10 bytes Query only. N/A RTF? RTF=xxxxx.xxxx
Frequency Rx Terminal Frequency, which is the frequency (MHz) being received from the satellite.
Note: For additional information refer to Chapter 5 for LO, MIX, and Spectrum Settings. (see Description of
Resolution=100 Hz Arguments)
Returns 00000.0000 if LNB LO is zero
Example: RTF=11650.2249 (MHz)

D25

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Receive REE= 1 byte Command or Query. REE= REE? REE=x
Equalizer Rx Equalizer in the form x, where: REE?
Enable 0=disabled REE* (see Description of
1=enabled REE# Arguments)
The default is 0.
Rx Info Rate N/A 9 bytes, Query only. RIR? RIR? RIR=ddddd.ddd
numeric Allows remote access to the Aggregate Rx Information rate in the form ddddd.ddd RIR=
RIR* (see Description of
RIR# Arguments)
Rx Sub-Mux N/A 9 bytes, Query only. RMI? RMI? RMI=ddddd.ddd
IP Info Rate numeric Allows remote access to the IP portion of the Rx Information rate in the form ddddd.ddd RMI=
RMI* (see Description of
RMI# Arguments)

D26

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

D.5.4 Unit Parameters


Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Local/ LRS= 1 byte, 0 to 3 Command or Query. LRS LRS? LRS=x
Remote Used set the users Local/Remote status in the form x, where: LRS? (see Description of
Status 0=Local LRS* Arguments)
1=Serial Remote (RS-232/RS-485) LRS#
2=reserved
3=Ethernet Remote
Example: LRS=1 (selects Serial Remote)
Modem EMU= 1 byte, value Command or Query. EMU= EMU? EMU=x
Emulation 0,1 or 2 The CDM-625 is designed to be a drop-in replacement for the CDM-600 or CDM-600L modems. In order EMU? (see Description of
for c omplete modem E mulation, al l par ameters, i ncluding t he E ID (equipment I D) mus t be t hat of t he EMU* Arguments)
modem it is emulating. This parameter permits the CDM-625 modem to be configured that way. EMU#
The format for the argument is x, where x is:
0= full capability CDM-625 modem (default)
1= to emulate the CDM-600 modem
2= to emulate the CDM-600L modem
Front Panel FPL= 1 byte, numeric Command or Query. FPL= FPL? FPL=x
Lockout Control the state of front-panel lockout in the form x, where: FPL? (see Description of
0= no lockout FPL* Arguments)
1= front panel lockout active. FPL#
Disable the lockout by either FPL=0, or by setting into local mode using LRS=0.
Software IMG= 1 byte, value of Command or Query. IMG= IMG? IMG=x
Image 1 or 2 Active software image in the form x, where: IMG? (see Description of
1=Bulk Image #1 currently active IMG* Arguments)
2=Bulk Image #2 currently active IMG#
Circuit ID CID= 40 bytes Command or Query. CID= CID? CID=x
String Sets or queries the user-defined Circuit ID string, which is a fixed length of 40 characters. CID? (see Description of
Valid characters include: CID* Arguments)
Space ( ) * + , . / 0 9 and A thru Z CID#
RTC Date DAY= 6 bytes Command or Query. DAY= DAY? DAY=ddmmyy
A date in the form ddmmyy (European format), where DAY? (see Description of
dd = day of the month (01 to 31) DAY* Arguments)
mm = month (01 to 12) DAY#
yy = year (00 to 99)
Example: DAY=240457 (April 24, 2057)

D27

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
RTC Time TIM= 6 bytes Command or Query. TIM= TIM? TIM=hhmmss
A time in the form hhmmss, indicating the time from midnight, where: TIM? (see Description of
hh = hours (00 to 23) TIM* Arguments)
mm = minutes (00 to 59) TIM#
ss = seconds (00 to 59)
Example: TIM=231259 (23 hours:12 minutes:59 seconds)
EDMAC EFM= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. EFM= EFM? EFM=x
Framing EDMAC mode in the form x, where: EFM? (see Description of
Mode 0=EDMAC OFF (Idle Mode) EFM* Arguments)
1=EDMAC ON (Master Mode) EFM#
2=EDMAC ON (Slave Mode, Query Only)
Example: EFM=1 (EDMAC Enabled as Master)
EDMAC ESA= 4 bytes Command or Query. ESA= ESA? ESA=xxxx
Slave EDMAC Slave Address Range - sets the range of addresses of distant-end units (modems or transceivers) ESA? (see Description of
Address that this unit, as the Master, will forward messages for. Only values which are integer multiples of ten are ESA* Arguments)
Range permitted. (0010, 0020, 0030, 0040 etc.) ESA#
Example: ESA=0090
This command is only valid for an EDMAC master. When used as a Query, it may be sent to an EDMAC
slave, which will respond with the appropriate address.
One Time OTO= 1 byte, value Command or Query. OTO= OTO? OTO=x
EDMAC Slave of 0 or 1 One Time Overwrite to EDMAC Slave modem in the form x, where: OTO?
Overwrite 0=Off OTO* (see Description of
1=On OTO# Arguments)
Examples:
OTO=1 causes EDMAC Slave modem to be able to accept ONE remote control command locally after
OTO=1 command.
OTO=0 turns off One Time Overwrite, only EDMAC command from EDMAC Master modem will be
accepted by Slave modem.
Engineering ESC= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. (IBS and ESC++ feature) ESC= ESC? ESC=x
Service ESC in the form x, where: ESC? (see Description of
Channel 0 = Disable the high-rate ESC ESC* Arguments)
1 = Enable the high-rate ESC ESC#
IBS ESC may only be enabled when:
1. Both Tx and Rx framing modes are set to IBS.
2. Data rate is not 1544 kbps (as spare overhead bits are not available in this mode).
3. IBS high-rate ESC FAST option is enabled.

D28

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
ESC SCP= 3 bytes, Command or Query. (IBS and ESC++ feature) SCP= SCP? SCP=xyz
Parameters numeric Allows control of the ESC baud rate and character format in the form xyz, where: SCP? (see Description of
x is the index for baud rate: SCP* Arguments)
0=1200 baud SCP#
1=2400 baud
2=4800 baud
3=9600 baud
4=19200 baud
5=38400 baud
6=14400 baud
7=28800 baud
y is the character format (data bits, parity, stop bits):
0=8N1 char format
1=7E2 char format
2=7O2 char format
z is the interface type:
0=RS-232
Exception 1=RS-485 Exception
600/L The baud rate may be l imited by the data rate. The ESC baud rate breakpoints (determined by data rate) 600/L Emulation:
Emulation: are shown in Chapter 5 and Chapter 12. A response of SCP* will indicate if the data rate will not allow a SCP=xy
SCP=xy selected baud rate to operate.
External EFR= 1 byte, value of Command or Query. EFR= EFR? EFR=x
Frequency 0 thru 6 External Frequency Reference in the form x, where: EFR? (see Description of
Reference 0=Internal 10MHz (default) EFR* Arguments)
1=External 1 MHz EFR#
2=External 2 MHz Exception
3=External 5 MHz 600L Emulation:
4=External 10 MHz MRC=
Exception 5=spare MRC? Exception Exception
600L Emulation: 6=Internal 10MHz plus output. MRC* 600L Emulation: 600L Emulation:
MRC= This means that the Reference is available on the Ext Ref rear connector (small rear-panel LED MRC# MRC=? MRC=x
indicates when ON)
Adjustment ADJ= 4 bytes, Command or Query. ADJ= ADJ? ADJ=sddd
for Internal numeric Provides fine adjustment of the Internal 10MHz Reference on the High-Stability Frequency Reference ADJ? (see Description of
10MHz High- module in the form sddd, where: ADJ* Arguments)
stability s= sign (+ or ) ADJ#
Reference ddd= value, 0-999.
Warm-up WRM= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. (Hi-Stab Ref parameter) WRM= WRM? WRM=x
Delay Hi-stab Ref warm-up delay parameter in the form x, where: WRM? (see Description of
0= Delay off (instant on) WRM* Arguments)
1= Warm-up Delay on WRM#

D29

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Countdown of CTD= 3 bytes, Command or Query. (Hi-Stab Ref parameter) CTD= CTD? CTD=xxx
Warm-up numeric Hi-stab Ref countdown parameter in the form xxx, where: CTD? (see Description of
Delay xxx = countdown of the number of seconds remaining of the Warm-up time. CTD* Arguments)
remaining As a command, the only permitted format is CTD=000, which abandons the delay. CTD#
Unit Test TST= 1 byte, value of Command or Query. TST= TST? TST=x
Mode 0 thru 6 Unit Test Mode, where: TST? (see Description of
0=Normal Mode (no test) TST* Arguments)
1=Tx CW TST#
2=Tx Alternating 1,0 Pattern
3=IF Loopback
4=RF Loopback
5=Digital Loopback
6=I/O Loopback
Example: TST=3 (IF Loopback)
Unit Alarm MSK= 13 bytes Command or Query. MSK= MSK? MSK=abcdefghjklxx
Mask Alarm mask conditions in form abcdefghjklxx, where: MSK? (see Description of
a=Tx AIS MSK* Arguments)
b=Rx AIS MSK#
c=bufferslip Alarm
d=spare
e=Rx AGC Alarm
f=Eb/No Alarm
g=BUC Alarm
h=LNB Alarm
j=G.703 Loss of Signal alarm
k=Reference alarm
l=Tx Clock Alarm
xx (spare)
Exception Value of each mask:
600L 0 = unmasked
Emulation: 1 = masked
6 bytes Example: MSK=0101100000000
Attach ABA= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. ABA= ABA? ABA=x
summary BUC 0= Tx FLT status unaffected by BUC fault ABA? (see Description of
fault to Tx FLT 1= Attach a summary BUC fault to Tx FLT status ABA* Arguments)
status ABA#
Attach ALA= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. ALA= ALA? ALA=x
summary LNB 0= Rx FLT status unaffected by LNB fault ALA? (see Description of
fault to Rx FLT 1= Attach a summary LNB fault to Rx FLT status ALA* Arguments)
status ALA#

D30

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Number of N/A 3 bytes Query only. N/A NUE? NUE=xxx
Unread Unit returns the Number of stored Events, which remain Unread, (over remote control) in the form xxx (0-255). (see Description of
stored Events Example: NUE=126 Arguments)
Retrieve next N/A 80 bytes Query only. N/A RNE? RNE=[CR]ABCddm
5 unread Unit returns the oldest 5 Stored Events which have not yet been read over the remote control in the reply myyhhmmss[CR]A
Stored format BCddmmyyhhmms
Events [CR]sub-body[CR]sub-body[CR]sub-body[CR]sub-body[CR]sub-body, where: s[CR]ABCddmmyyh
sub-body=ABCddmmyyhhmmss, where: hmmss[CR]ABCdd
A is the fault/clear indicator: mmyyhhmmss[CR]
F=Fault ABCddmmyyhhmm
C=Clear ss
I=Info
B is the fault type where: (see Description of
1=Unit Arguments)
2=Rx Traffic
3=Tx Traffic
4=Info (Power on/off, or log cleared)
5=Open Network
6=BUC
7=LNB
C is Fault Code number, as in FLT? or Info Code, which may be:
0=Power Off
1=Power On
2=Log Cleared
3=Global Config Change
4=Redundancy Config Change
5=Fractional CnC License is expiring.
6=Time Limited CnC License is expiring.
7=Fractional CnC is in use.
ddmmyy = date stamp.
hhmmss = time stamp.
If there are less than 5 events to be retrieved, the remaining positions are padded with zeros. If there are no
new events, the response is RNE*.
Clear All CAE= None Command only. CAE= N/A N/A
Stored Forces the software to clear the software events log. CAE?
Events Note: This command takes no arguments CAE*
Example: CAE= CAE#

D31

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Initialize IEP= None Command only. IEP= N/A N/A
Stored Resets internal pointer to allow RNE? queries to start at the beginning of the stored events log. IEP#
Events
Pointer
Statistics SSI= 1 byte, Command or Query. SSI= SSI? SSI=x
Sample numerical Used to set the sample interval for the Statistics Logging Function in the form x, where: SSI? (see Description of
Interval x= 0 to 9 in 10 minute steps. SSI* Arguments)
Note: Setting this parameter to 0 disables the statistics logging function. SSI#
Example: SSI=3 means 30 minutes
Number of N/A 3 bytes Query only. N/A NUS? NUS=xxx
Unread Unit returns the number of stored Statistics, which remain Unread (over remote control) in the form xxx, (see Description of
stored where: Arguments)
Statistics x = 0-255
Example: NUS=187
Retrieve next N/A 135 bytes Query only. N/A RNS? RNS=[CR]AA.ABB.
5 unread Unit returns the oldest 5 Stored Statistics, which have not yet been read over the remote control in the reply BC.CD.Dddmmyyhh
Stored format [CR]sub-body[CR]sub-body[CR]sub-body[CR]sub-body[CR]sub-body, where sub-body= mmss[CR]AA.ABB.
Statistics AA.ABB.BC.CD.Dddmmyyhhmmss: BC.CD.Dddmmyyhh
AA.A=Minimum Eb/No during sample period. mmss[CR]AA.ABB.
BB.B=Average Eb/No during sample period. BC.CD.Dddmmyyhh
C.C=Max. Tx Power Level Increase during sample period. mmss[CR]AA.ABB.
D.D=Average Tx Power Level Increase during sample period. BC.CD.Dddmmyyhh
ddmmyy = date stamp. mmss[CR]AA.ABB.
hhmmss = time stamp. BC.CD.Dddmmyyhh
If there are no new events, the unit replies with RNS*. If there are less than 5 statistics to be retrieved, the mmss
remaining positions are padded with zeros. (see Description of
Arguments)

D32

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Retrieve N/A 180 bytes Query only. N/A RNN? RNN=[CR]AA.ABB.
next 5 Unit returns the oldest 5 Stored Statistics (including newly added Minimum and Average Receive Signal level), BC.CD.DEE.E,FF.F
unread New which have not yet been read over the remote control in the reply form [CR]sub-body[CR]sub-body[CR] ddmmyyhhmmss[C
Stored sub-body[CR]sub-body[CR]sub-body, where sub-body = AA.ABB.BC.CD.DEE.E,FF.Fddmmyyhhmmss: R]AA.ABB.BC.CD.D
Statistics AA.A=Minimum Eb/No during sample period. EE.E,FF.Fddmmyyh
BB.B=Average Eb/No during sample period. hmmss[CR]AA.ABB.
C.C=Max. Tx Power Level Increase during sample period. BC.CD.DEE.E,FF.F
D.D=Average Tx Power Level Increase during sample period. ddmmyyhhmmss[C
EE.E=Negative value of Minimum Receive Signal Level in dB during sample period. R]AA.ABB.BC.CD.D
FF.F=Negative value of Average Receive Signal Level in dB during sample period. EE.E,FF.Fddmmyyh
ddmmyy = date stamp. hmmss[CR]AA.ABB.
hhmmss = time stamp. BC.CD.DEE.E,FF.F
If there are no new events, the unit replies with RNN*. If there are less than 5 statistics to be retrieved, the ddmmyyhhmmss
remaining positions are padded with zeros. (see Description of
Note: RNN includes all information provided in RNS, plus Rx Signal level. Do not mix use of RNS and Arguments)
RNN.
Clear All CAS= None Command only. CAS= N/A N/A
Stored Forces the software to clear the software statistics log. CAS?
Statistics Example: CAS= CAS*
Note: This command takes no arguments. CAS#
Initialize ISP= None Command only. ISP= N/A N/A
Statistics Resets internal pointer to allow RNS? queries to start at the beginning of the statistics log. ISP#
Pointer
Force 1:1 FSW= None Command only. FSW= N/A N/A
Switch Forces unit to toggle Unit Fail relay to fail state for approx 500ms. If unit is part of a 1:1 pair and is currently FSW*
the Online unit, this will force a switchover, so unit will then be in Standby mode. The command is always
executed by the unit, regardless of whether it is standalone, in a 1:1 pair, or part of a 1:N system.
Note: This command takes no arguments.
Outdoor Unit ODU= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. ODU= ODU? ODU=x
Comms Enables or disables communications, via the FSK link, with a Comtech EF Data transceiver (ODU) in the ODU? (see Description of
enable form x, where: ODU* Arguments)
0=Disabled ODU#
1=Enabled
Example: ODU=0 (selects Disabled)

D33

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
1:N (One For OFN= 1 byte, 0 or 1 Command or Query. OFN= OFN? OFN=x
N) control Enables or disables the 1:N control. This affects a control line on the 25-pin rear panel connector. This must OFN? (see Description of
be enabled when the modem is attached to a CRS-300 1:N Controller or a CRS-500 1:N Switch in the form OFN* Arguments)
x, where: OFN#
0=Disabled
1=Enabled
Example: OFN=0 (selects Disabled)
IP Address IPA= 18 bytes Command or Query. IPA= IPA? IPA=
numerical Used to set the IP Address and network prefix for the 10/100 Base T Ethernet management port, in the form IPA? aaa.bbb.ccc.ddd.yy
aaa.bbb.ccc.ddd.yy, where permitted ranges are: IPA* (see Description of
aaa = 0-223 IPA# Arguments)
bbb = 0-255
ccc = 0-255
ddd = 001-255
yy=08-30
Example: IPA=010.006.030.001.24
IP Gateway IPG= 15 bytes Command or Query. IPG= IPG? IPG=
numerical Used to set the IP Gateway Address for the Ethernet management port, in the form aaa.bbb.ccc.ddd, where IPG? aaa.bbb.ccc.ddd
permitted ranges are: IPG* (see Description of
aaa = 0-223 IPG# Arguments)
bbb = 0-255
ccc = 0-255
ddd = 001-255
Example: IPG=010.006.030.001
Traffic IP IPT= 18 bytes Command or Query. IPT= IPT? IPT=
Address numerical In a 1:1 system, each modem has its own unique IP address that would be used by an external M&C IPT? aaa.bbb.ccc.ddd.yy
application to address each modem. The IP traffic uses a different address, and whichever modem is IPT* (see Description of
online, uses this address for the IP traffic in the form aaa.bbb.ccc.ddd.yy where permitted ranges are: IPT# Arguments)
aaa = 0-223
bbb = 0-255
ccc = 0-255
ddd = 001-255.
yy is the Subnet Mask Length (range: 08 to 30)
Example: IPT=010.006.030.002.24
MAC Address N/A 12 bytes, Query only. N/A MAC? MAC=aabbccddeeff
alpha- Used to query the unique MAC Address for the modem. (see Description of
numerical Example: MAC=0006B00001C2 Arguments)

D34

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Request to RTS= 1 byte, value of Command or Query. RTS= RTS? RTS=x
Send 0, 1, 2 Defines how RTS/CTS will operate at the main data interface in the form x, where: RTS? (see Description of
0=RTS/CTS Loop, No Action. RTS and CTS are looped, so that CTS echoes the state of RTS, but RTS RTS* Arguments)
does not control the ON/OFF state of carrier. RTS#
1=Loop, RTS Controls TX O/P. RTS and CTS are looped, so that CTS echoes the state of RTS and
RTS controls the ON/OFF state of carrier (in order words, the modem will not bring up its TX carrier
until RTS is asserted.
2=Ignore RTS, Assert CTS.
Example: RTS=0 (RTS/CTS Loop, No Action)
HSSI HHC= 1 byte, value of Command or Query. (HSSI parameter) HHC= HHC? HHC=x
Handshake 0,1 Defines TA/CA control of the HSSI interface in the form x, where: HHC? (see Description of
Control 0 = TA to CA loop (default) HHC* Arguments)
1 = RR control CA, TA control Tx output. HHC#
Example: HHC=0 (TA to CA loop)
POCO PCO= 1 byte, value of Command or Query. PCO= PCO? PCO=x
feature 0,1 Use with caution. PCO? (see Description of
(Power-On If enabled, when a modem is power cycled, it will power up with the Tx carrier setting OFF. PCO* Arguments)
Carrier-Off) 0=POCO disabled (normal operation) PCO#
1=POCO enabled care!
Example: PCO=0 (disabled normal operation)
DoubleTalk CNM= 1 byte, value of Command or Query. CNM= CNM? CNM=x
Carrier-in- 0 to 9 CnC enable in the form x, where: CNM? (see Description of
Carrier (CnC) 0=Off CNM* Arguments)
Mode 1=On (normal) CNM#
2=APC, C-Band, Side A
3=APC, X-Band, Side A
4=APC, Ku-Band, Side A
5=APC, Ka-Band, Side A
6=APC, C-Band, Side B
7=APC, X-Band, Side B
8=APC, Ku-Band, Side B
9=APC, Ka-Band, Side B
Notes:
1. CnC may be enabled only if:
The optional plug-in hardware CnC card has been installed AND a CnC FAST option is unlocked.
The range of permitted data rates is controlled by a FAST feature code. (Read EID to decode the
installed options for the modem)
2. If CnC-APC is active (APS=22), key transmission/reception (Modulation, FEC type, Code Rate,
Framing, Data Rate, Interface) cannot be modified until CnC-APC is suspended. (Use APC
command to suspend or activate.)

D35

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
DoubleTalk CPM= 1 byte, value of Command or Query. (CnC parameter) CPM= CPM? CPM=x
Carrier-in- 0 to 3 CnC PMSI (Pre-Mapped-Symbol Interface) mode in the form x, where: CPM? (see Description of
Carrier (CnC) 0=Idle CPM* Arguments)
PMSI Mode 1=Redundancy (1:1 or 1:N) CPM#
2=Talk
3=Listen
CnC CCF= 3 bytes Command or Query. (CnC parameter) CCF= CCF? CCF=xxx
Frequency The maximum value that may be entered, in the form xxx, as the CnC Sweep frequency range depends on CCF? (see Description of
Range/offset the Rx symbol rate as follows: CCF* Arguments)
18ksps to 64ksps: 1 to the symbol rate (ksps)/2 CCF#
64ksps to 389ksps: 1 to 32 kHz
389ksps to 2000ksps: 1 to 10% of sym rate
>2000ksps: 1 to 200 kHz
Example: CCF=030
CnC CSD= 6 bytes Command or Query. (CnC parameter) CSD= CSD? CSD=xxxyyy
Min/Max CnC min/max delay value in milliseconds, in the form xxxyyy, where: CSD? (see Description of
Search Delay xxx=minimum delay CSD* Arguments)
yyy=maximum delay CSD#
Maximum allowable value is 330ms
Example: CSD=010325
G.703 Clock CEX= 2 bytes Command or Query. (FAST option) CEX= CEX? CEX=ab
Extension G.703 Clock Extension in the form ab, where: CEX? (see Description of
a = G.703 Clock Extension Mode CEX* Arguments)
0 = None CEX#
1 = TxLock
2 = RxEnable
b = G.703 Clock Extension Interface
0 = T1
1 = E1Bal
2 = E1Unbal
Example: CEX=12 (Sets Tx Lock to E1 Unbalanced)
Notes:
1. Not all CEX modes are valid all the time.
2. For argument a:
If Data Interface (ITF) is G.703, only 0=None is allowed.
If Tx clock (TCK) is not Internal, 1=TxLock is not allowed.

D36

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Tx BERT BTX= 1 byte, value of Command or Query. BTX= BTX? BTX=x
State 0 or 1 Tx BERT State in the form x, where: BTX? (see Description of
0 = Off BTX# Arguments)
1 = On
Example: BTX=1 (Tx BERT On)
Rx BERT BRX= 1 byte, value of Command or Query. BRX= BRX? BRX=x
State 0 or 1 Rx BERT State in the form x, where: BRX? (see Description of
0 = Off BRX# Arguments)
1 = On
Example: BRX=1 (Rx BERT On)
Tx BERT TBP= 1 byte Command or Query. TBP= TBP? TBP=x
Pattern Tx BERT Pattern, in the form x, where: TBP? (see Description of
0=space TBP# Arguments)
1=mark
2=1:1
3=1:2
4=63
5=511
6=2047 (default)
7=2047R (or 2047 Alternate)
8=Mil-188
9=2^15-1
A=2^20-1
B=2^23-1
Example: TBP=6 (Tx BERT Pattern is 2047)
Rx BERT RBP= 1 byte Command or Query. RBP= RBP? RBP=x
Pattern Rx BERT Pattern, in the form x, where: RBP? (see Description of
0=space RBP# Arguments)
1=mark
2=1:1
3=1:2
4=63
5=511
6=2047 (default)
7=2047R (or 2047 Alternate)
8=Mil-188
9=2^15-1
A=2^20-1
B=2^23-1
Example: RBP=6 (Rx BERT Pattern is 2047)

D37

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
BERT 10E-3 BKE= 1 byte, value of Command or Query. BKE= BKE? BKE=x
Error Insert 0 or 1 Inserts 10E-3 BER in the form x, where: BKE? (see Description of
x = 0 (Off) or 1 (On) BKE# Arguments)
Example: BKE=1
BERT Restart BRM= None Command only. BRM= N/A N/A
Monitor Example: BRM=
Note: This command takes no arguments.
BERT Result N/A 7 bytes, Query only. N/A BRE? BRE=xxxxxxx
in bit errors numeric BERT monitor results in bit errors. If bit errors exceed 9999999, then BRE=9999999.
BERT Result N/A 6 bytes Query only N/A BRR? BRR=a.bEcx
in average Returns the value of the average BER in the form a.b x 10-c. First 3 bytes are the value. Byte 5 is the
BER exponent. Last byte is the indicator of Sync Loss. A * in last byte means there was a loss of pattern
synchronization since last restart, but now is synchronized. A _ (space) in last byte means pattern
synchronization is achieved.
Returns 999999 if theres no sync in BERT monitor.
Example 1: BRR=2.8E7 (BER is 2.8 x 10-7, and in sync)
Example 2: BRR=3.4E5* (BER is 3.4 x 10-5, and there was a Sync Loss)
ACM ACM= 4 bytes Command or Query. ACM= ACM? ACM=mMAT
parameters Defines ACM operating parameters in the form mMAT, where: ACM? (see Description of
m=Minimum ModCod, range is 0 to 9, and A (for ModCod=10) or B (for ModeCod=11) ACM# Arguments)
M=Maximum ModCod, range is 0 to 9, and A (for ModCod=10) or B (for ModeCod=11)
A= Defines action on remote demod unlock (0=go to minimum Tx ModCod, 1=maintain Tx ModCod)
T=Target Eb/No Margin, from 0 to 9 that is two times of the Eb/No in dB (from 0.0dB to 4.5dB).
Example: ACM=0B12
(Sets min ModCod=0, max ModCod=11, maintain Tx ModCod when remote demod unlocks,
sets Target Eb/No at 1.0dB.)
Forced FRB= None Command only. FRB= N/A N/A
Reboot Force a hard reset of the unit in 5 seconds. FRB?
FRB*
FRB#
Carrier ID CAI= 1 byte, value Command or Query. CAI= CAI? CAI =x
of 0 thru 1 Carrier ID Enable/Disable in the form x, where: CAI? (see Description of
0 = Disabled CAI * Arguments)
1 = Enabled CAI #

D38

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Demo Time N/A 6 bytes Query only. N/A DMT? DMT=ddhhmm
Remaining Demo time remaining in the form ddhhmm, (see Description of
dd = days (00 to 30) Arguments)
hh = hours (00 to 23)
mm = minutes (00 to 59)
Example: DMT=032312 (3 days 23 hours 12 minutes)
Demo Mode DMM= 1 byte, value Command or Query. DMM= DMM? DMM=x
of 0 thru 2 Demo Mode Enable/Disable in the form x, where: DMM? (see Description of
0 = Disabled DMM* Arguments)
1 = Enabled DMM#
2 = Expired
Medium- MEO= 1 byte Command or Query. MEO= MEO? MEO=x
Earth Orbit Medium Earth Orbit Enable/Disable in the form x, where: (see Description
0 = Disabled of Arguments)
1 = Enabled
Antenna AHO= 1 byte Command or Query. AHO= AHO? AHO=x
Handover Antenna Handover Enable/Disable in the form x, where: (see Description of
0 = Disabled Arguments)
1 = Enabled
Antenna AHM= 1 byte Command or Query. AHM= AHM? AHM=x
Handover Antenna Handover Mode in the form x, where: (see Description of
Mode 0 = Manual Arguments)
1 = Auto
Antenna AHD= 3 bytes Command or Query. AHD= AHD? AHD=xx
Handover Differential Path Delayin the form +xx (-13 to +13) (see Description of
Differential Arguments)
Path Delay Example: AHD=+12 (Lead 12)
AHD=-03 (Lag 3)
Time Protocol TPE= 1 byte Command or Query. TPE= TPE? TPE=x
Enable Used to disable or enable the Time Protocol, where: TPE? (see Description of
0 = Time Protocol disabled Arguments)
1 = Time Protocol enabled

Example: TPE=1 (Time protocol enabled)

D39

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Primary TPS= 15 bytes Command or Query. TPS= TPS? TPS=
Ethernet Used to set the Primary Ethernet Time Server IP address for the Unit. Tx Ethernet management port, in the TPS? xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx
Time Server format: (see Description of
xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx, where: Arguments)
xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx is the Time server IP address

Example: TPS = 192.168.001.005


Backup TPB= 15 bytes Command or Query. TPB= TPB? TPB=
Ethernet Used to set the Backup Ethernet Time Server IP address for the Unit. Tx Ethernet management port, in the TPB? xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx
Time Server format: (see Description of
xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx, where: Arguments)
xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx is the Time server IP address

Example: TPB = 192.168.001.005

D40

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

D.5.5 Bulk Configuration Strings


Note: In order to completely get/set the configuration of the modem, the following commands must be queried/set:
MGC
OGC (L-Band Only)
Drop and Insert (specified in MGC):
o DNI (Open Network DNI);
o DIC (Closed Network DNI++);
o QDI (Quad DNI), one for each active port up to a maximum of four.

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Global MGC= 224 bytes, Command or Query. MGC= MGC? MGC=FFFF.FFFFD
Configuration numerical Global Configuration of CDM625, in the form shown in the Response to Query column (to right) where: MGC? MGC?n (where DDDD.DDDGYRMV
entries, fixed * FFFF.FFFF=Tx Frequency same as TFQ MGC* n = 0 to 9. SPP.PBaaa.aaCXIK
values and DDDDD.DDD=TX Data Rate same as TDR MGC# Returns the NZffff.ffffddddd.dddg
delimiters G=Tx FEC Type same as TFT MGC portion of yrmvswwwcll.lbbbbb
Y=Tx Reed-Solomon Type same as TRS 1 of 10 stored iknzOEEEETeeeee
R=Tx FEC Rate same as TCR configurations) eeeeeeeeWALQUH
M=Tx Modulation Type same as TMD HHHhhhhJJJJjjjjabc
V=Tx Spectrum Inversion same as TSI defxxxxxxxxxxrrrrr.rr
S=Tx Scrambler State same as TSC
PP.P Tx Power Level same as TPL
rsssss.ssshgkpmnn
B=AUPC Enable same as AUP nttuuu.uuu.uuu.uuu.
aaa.aa=AUPC Parameter Setup same as APP uuvvv.vvv.vvv.vvvx
C=Tx Clock Source same as TCK GHIJKwAAABBBC
X=Tx Carrier State same as TXO CCeexEFGGGH
I=Tx Interface Type same as TIT
K=Tx Ternary Code same as TTC
N=Tx Framing Mode same as TFM
* Z=Tx Clock Invert same as TCI
* ffff.ffff=Rx Frequency same as RFQ
ddddd.ddd=Rx Data Rate same as RDR
g=Rx FEC Type same as RFT
y=Rx Reed-Solomon Type same as RRS
r=Rx FEC Rate same as RCR
m=Rx Modulation Type same as RMD
v=Rx Spectrum Inversion same as RSI
s=Rx Scrambler State same as RDS
* www=Rx Sweep Width same as RSW
c=Rx Clock Source same as RCK
ll.l=Eb/No Alarm Point same as EBA
bbbbb=Rx Buffer Size same as RBS
i=Rx Interface Type same as RIT
k=Rx Ternary Code same as RTC

D41

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Global n=Rx Framing Mode same as RFM
Configuration * z=Rx Clock Invert same as RCI
(cont.) * O=EDMAC mode same as EFM
* EEEE=EDMAC Address same as ESA
T=Unit Test Mode same as TST
* eeeeeeeeeeeee=Unit Alarm Mask same as MSK
W=Hi-Stab Reference choice same as EFR
A=Statistics Sampling Interval same as SSI
L=Rx Terrestrial Alarm Enable same as RTE
Q=Tx Terrestrial Alarm Enable same as TTA
U=ODU Common Enable same as ODU
HHHH=Tx Backward Alarm same as TBA
hhhh=Rx Backward Alarm same as RBA
JJJJ=Tx Audio Volume same as TVL
jjjj= Rx Audio Volume same as RVL
a=Drop Type same as DTY
b=Insert Type same as ITY
c=Tx ESC Type same as TET
d=Rx ESC Type same as RET
e=Tx Data Invert same as TDI
f=Rx Data Invert same as RDI
* A=Tx Sub-Mux on/off same as TMX
* B=Rx Sub-Mux on/off same as RMX
* CC=Tx Sub-Mux Ratio same as TMR
* DD=RX Sub-Mux Ratio same as RMR
* mMAT same as ACM
* rrrrr.rrr=TX Symbol Rate same as TSR
* sssss.sss=RX Symbol Rate same as RSR
* h=HSSI handshake control same as HHC
* g=RTS/CTS setting same as RTS
k=Rx Equalizer Enable same as REE
p=Power-On/Carrier-Off Enable same as PCO
m=ESC enable same as ESC
nnn=ESC parameters same as SCP
tt=G.703 Clock Extension same as CEX
* uuu.uuu.uuu.uuu.uu=IP address same as IPA
* vvv.vvv.vvv.vvv=IP gateway address same as IPG
*w same as TXA
* G=Tx BERT State same as BTX
* H=Tx BERT Pattern same as TBP
* I=BERT 10E-3 Error Insert same as BKE
* J=Rx BERT State same as BRX
* K=Rx BERT Pattern same as RBP
* w=CnC mode same as CNM
* AAA=CnC frequency offset same as CCF
BBBCCC=CnC search delays same as CSD
D=CnC PMSI mode same as CPM

D42

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Global ee=Compressed Ethernet port speed see **
Configuration E=Attach summary BUC alarm to Tx same as ABA
(cont.) F=Attach summary LNB alarm to Rx same as ALA
GGG=WAN buffer length same as WBL
H=Dedicated Management Port same as DMP

Note: Much of the 625 MGC format has been kept similar to the 600/L MGC format.
* indicates differences.
** E thernet po rt s peed i s c ompressed f rom 4 by tes i n S EC c ommand t o 2 by tes i n MG C. F irst by te
represents speed settings for Port 1 and Port 2, second byte represents speed settings for Port 3 and Port
4. In each byte, character A through Y is used to represent 25 possible combinations of two port speed.
A=00, B=01, C=02, D=03, E=04, F=10, G=11, H=12, I=13, J=14, K=20, L=21, M= 22, N=23, O=24, P=30,
Q=31, R=32, S=33, T=34, U=40, V=41, W=42, X=43, Y=44.
Example: BN is converted to 0123, that means Port 1 is AutoNeg, Port 2 is 100Full, Port 3 is 100Half, Port
4 is 10Full.
OGC Outdoor OGC= 50 Bytes Command or Query. OGC= OGC? OGC=aabxdexxxxxg
Unit Global ODU Global Configuration of CDM-625, in the form shown in the Response to Query column (to the right), where: OGC? OGC?n (where n ggghhhhxxxxixklllnn
Copy aa=BUC Address same as BAD OGC* = 0 to 9. Returns nFFFFFSfffffsxxxxxx
b=BUC Tx Output Enable same as BOE OGC# the OGC portion
* x (spare) of 1 of 10 stored (Returns current
d=BUC Power Supply same as BPS configurations) OGC Configuration)
e=BUC 10MHz Reference State same as BFR
xxxxx (spares)
gggg=BUC Current - Low Limit same as BCL
hhhh=BUC Current - High Limit same as BCH
* xxxx (spares)
* i=LNB Power Supply same as LPS
* x (spare)
k=LNB 10MHz Reference same as LNR
lll=LNB Low Alarm Limit same as LNL
nnn=LNB High Alarm Limit same as LNH
FFFFFS=TX LO Frequency same as TLO
fffffs=RX LO Frequency same as RLO
xxxxxx (spares)
Notes:
1. Much of the 625 O GC f ormat has been k ept s imilar t o t he C DM-600L OGC f ormat ( * i ndicates t he
differences). In 600L Emulation Mode, OGC follows the CDM-600Ls OGC format.
2. Any unavailable parameters will be filled with xs.

D43

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Drop & Insert DNI= 51 bytes Command or Query. (D&I only) DNI= DNI? DNI=dddddddddddd
25 bytes of Drop information: DNI? DNI?n ddddddddddddtiiiiiiiiiii
d= 24 channels (bytes) defining Timeslot locations DNI* (where n = 0 to 9. iiiiiiiiiiiiiTL
t= Drop type: DNI# Returns the DNI (see Description of
0=T1-D4, 1=T1-ESF, 2=E1-CCS, 3=E1-CAS, as DTY portion of 1 of 10 Arguments)
25 bytes of Insert information: stored
i= 24 channels (bytes) defining Timeslot location configurations) (Returns current D&I
T= Insert type: Configuration)
0=T1-D4, 1=T1-ESF, 2=E1-CCS, 3=E1-CAS) as ITY
Each Timeslot definition:
0= Unused
1-9 for timeslots 19, A=10, B=11, C=12, D=13V=31.
z=timeslot zero
L= D&I Internal Loop
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
Example: DNI=123456789ABC0000000000003123456789ABC00000000000031
Drop channels 112 using timeslots 112, and unused channels 1324. Same for Insert. E1-CAS, D&I types,
Internal Loop ON.
If framing is D&I and data rate is 1920 kbps and DNI Type is E1-CCS or E1-CAS, then channels cannot be
programmed (i.e. FIXED CHANNEL MODE).The DNI? response will display all x in the time-slot positions.
Drop & Insert DIC= 67 bytes Command or Query. (D&I++ only) DIC= DIC? DIC=dddddddddddd
Configuration (Not available in 600/L Emulation mode) DIC? dddddddddddddddd
(31 channels) 31 channels of Drop Timeslot information: xx= spares DIC* dddxxsssssssssssss
31 channels of Insert Timeslot information: xx= spares DIC# ssssssssssssssssss
Each Timeslot definition: xxL
0= Unused (see Description of
1-9 for timeslots 19, Arguments)
A=10,
B=11, DIC?n Returns current DIC
C=12, Configuration,
D=13, etc ..V=31, where:
z=timeslot zero n = 0 to 9.
L= D&I Internal Loop Returns the DIC
0 = OFF, 1 = ON portion of 1 of 10
Example: stored
DIC=123456789ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVxx123456789ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVxx0 configurations
Drop channels 132 using timeslots 131 and timeslot zero. Same for Insert. E1-CCS, Internal Loop Off.

D44

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Quad Drop & QDI= 73 bytes Command or Query. QDI= QDI?p QDI=pccddddddddd
Insert Quad Drop & Insert Commands (E1 CCS Only) QDI? QDI?pn dddddddddddddddd
QDI=pccddddddddddddddddddddddddddddddddCCssssssssssssssssssssssssssssssssrrrr, where: QDI* (where n = 0 to 9 dddddddCCssssssss
p = Port number 1 thru 4 QDI# returns the QDI ssssssssssssssssss
cc = Number of Drop Channels, 0-32. portion of 1 of 10 ssssssrrrr
Used to decide Port ps TX Tributary Rate if Interface Type is Quad Drop & Insert (TFM=8). stored
d = 32 bytes defining Timeslot locations (or channels) configurations for (Returns current
CC = Number of Insert Channels, 0-32. a single port p) Quad D&I
Used to decide Port ps RX Tributary Rate if Interface Type is Quad Drop & Insert (RFM=8). configuration of a
s = 32 bytes defining Timeslot locations (or channels) single port p)
Timeslot definition:
0 = Unused
1-9 for timeslots 19,
A=10, B=11, C=12, D=13V=31
z=timeslot zero
r = reserved (set to value 0)
Example 1:
131123456789ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUV031123456789ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUV00000
Port 1s Drop channels 131 using timeslots 131. Same for Insert
Example 2:
30412340000000000000000000000000000204123400000000000000000000000000002000000
Port 3s Drop channels 14 using timeslots 14. Same for Insert.
Note: This command is a bit forgiving in the sense that the modem accepts the command even though the
interface type is other than Quad Drop & Insert. This is intentional for use with the CRS-300 switch for 1:N
redundancy.
Configuration CST= 1 byte, value Command only. CST= N/A N/A
Save of 0 thru 9 Causes the modem to store the current modem configuration in Configuration Memory location in the form CST?
x, where x=0 to 9. CST*
Example: CST=4 (stores the current configuration in location 4) CST#
Configuration CLD= 1 byte, value Command only. CLD= N/A N/A
Load of 0 thru 9 Causes the modem to retrieve a previously stored modem configuration from Configuration Memory location in the CLD?
form x, where x=0 to 9 CLD*
Example: CLD=4 (loads modem configuration from location 4 to be the active configuration) CLD#

D45

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Bulk Status N/A 29 bytes Query only. N/A BSQ? BSQ=abcccc,ddddd,
Query Response has the form abcccc,ddddd,eeffffffggggghhh, where: eeffffffggggghhh
a = LRS? response
b = RED? response (see Description of
cccc = EBN? response Arguments)
ddddd = BER? response
eeeee = BFS? Response
Exception * ffffff = RFO? response
600 or 600L ggggg = RSL? response
Emulation: hhh = TMP? response
28 chars, as This command is intended to reduce the need for excessively frequent queries to a modem, and will be useful
RFO is for a unit in a redundancy system, where the redundancy system has monitoring of its own occurring. The latter
different 6 parameters are only updated once per second.

D46

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

D.5.6 Modem Information


Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Hardware N/A 4 bytes Query only. N/A HRV? HRV=xx.y
Revision Unit returns hardware revision level of both main circuit cards, in the form xx.y, where: (see Description of
xx indicates the main (bottom) card; Arguments)
y indicates the top (modem) card.
Software N/A 5 bytes Query only. N/A SWR? SWR=x.x.x
Revision Unit returns the value of the internal software revision installed in the unit, in the form of x.x.x (see description
Example: SWR=2.0.2 of arguments)
Firmware N/A 256 bytes Query only. N/A FRW?B FRW=xxxxxx
Information Unit returns firmware information. FRW?1 (see Description of
B requests boot code information FRW?2 Arguments)
Example: FRW=Boot: FW/12865-1-,1.1.1,04/01/07
Otherwise, FRW returns firmware information for Image 1 or 2:
Example: FRW=1
FW/12864-,1.1.1,04/01/07
FW/12866-,1.1.1,04/01/07
FW/12867-,1.1.1,04/01/07
FW/12868-,1.1.1,04/01/07
FW/12875-,1.1.1,04/01/07
FW/12874-,1.1.1,04/01/07
Serial Number N/A 9 bytes Query only. N/A SNO? SNO=xxxxxxxxx
Indicates the modem 9-digit serial number. (see Description of
Example: SNO=176500143 Arguments)
Fractional CnC N/A 7 bytes Query Only. N/A FCC? FCC=xxxxxxx
90-day Returns the number of seconds that Fractional CnC license has been used in 1 year period since the last (see Description of
Counter time the CnC counter was reset to 0. Arguments)
Example: FCC=0000455 (indicating 455 seconds)
Modem N/A 8 bytes Query Only. N/A FCF? FCF=xxxxxxxx
Operational Returns the number of seconds that the unit has been powered on since last reset of the counter. (see Description of
Full Year The counter resets to 0 when it reaches 31536000 seconds (seconds in 365 days). Arguments)
Counter Example: FCF=00001342 (indicating 1342 seconds)
Software N/A 38 bytes Query only. N/A SW2? SW2=x
Revision 2 Unit returns the value of the internal software revision installed in the unit, (see Description
Example: SW2=Boot:2.1.1 Bulk1*:2.1.2 Bulk2 :2.1.1 of Arguments)
The current active image is indicated with an asterisk.

D47

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Equipment ID N/A 33 bytes Query only. N/A EID? EID=AAAABCDEFGHsJ
Unit returns the equipment ID and installed options in the form AAAABCDEFGHsJKLMNPQRSTUVWXYssssss, where: KLMNPQRSTUVWXYZa
AAAA=0625 , the modem model number ssss
Installed hardware: (see Description of
B=Slot 1: TPC/LDPC codec Arguments)
0 = not present, 1=present
C=Slot 2: DoubleTalk Carrier-in-Carrier board (CnC)
0 = not present, 1=present
D=Slot 3: VersaFEC board
0 = not present, 1=present,
E=Slot 4: Network Processor card
0 = not present, 1=present
F=Slot 5: RAN Optimization card
0 = not present, 1=present
G=External 20dB attenuator
0 = not present, 1=present
H=Audio chips
0=not present, 1=present
s=spares (0)
Software FAST options:
J=Frequency option
0=70/140MHz, 1= 70/140MHz & L-Band
K=Modulation option
0=Standard: BPSK, QPSK, OQPSK.
1=Option 0 plus 8-PSK and 8-QAM
2=Option 0 plus 16-QAM
3=Option 1 and option 2
L=Data Rate option
M=TPC/LDPC data rate option
For L and M, the value is decoded:
0=Base, up to 5Mbps
1=up to 10Mbps
2=up to 15 Mbps
3=up to 20Mbps
4=up to 25Mbps
N=CnC data rate option, where
0=No CnC FAST installed
1=up to 512kbps
2=up to 1.1Mbps
3=up to 2.5 Mbps
P=VersaFEC CCM data rate option, where
0=Base, up to 1.1Mbps
1=up to 2.5Mbps
2=up to 5 Mbps
3=up to 16Mbps

D48

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Equipment ID Q=IP-ACM symbol rate option, where
(cont) 0=None
1=up to 300ksym/sec
2=up to 1200ksym/sec
3=up to 4100ksym/sec
R=Framing option
0=Standard: (Unframed, EDMAC, EDMAC2)
1 = Option 0 plus Open Network (IBS with hi-rate ESC, IDR, Audio)
S=D&I option
0=None
1=D&I,D&I++ for single port E1/T1
2=Option 1 plus Quad D&I (4 ports)
T= G.703 Clock Extension
0=Not installed, 1=installed on
U=Time based CnC option
0=Not installed
1=Fractional CnC installed
2=Time Limited CnC installed
3=Option 1 and Option 2
V=Header Compression
0=None
1=up to 5Mbps / 1200ksps (ACM)
2=up to 10Mbps / 4100ksps (ACM)
3=up to 15Mbps / 4100ksps (ACM)
4=up to 20Mbps / 4100ksps (ACM)
5=up to 25Mbps / 4100ksps (ACM)
W=Payload Compression
0=None
1=up to 5Mbps / 1200ksps (ACM)
2=up to 10Mbps / 4100ksps (ACM)
3=up to 15Mbps / 4100ksps (ACM)
4=up to 20Mbps / 4100ksps (ACM)
5=up to 25Mbps / 4100ksps (ACM)
X=Advanced QoS
0=Not installed, 1=Installed
Y=AES Encryption
0=Not installed
1=Installed
Z= Advanced Network Timing
0=Not installed
1=Installed
a= Carrier ID
0=Not installed
1=Installed
ssss = spares (0)
600/L Emulation: See CDM-600/600L manual
Example: EID=062510000000134473412113233000000 indicates all software options, TPC/LDPC card installed.
Note: To achieve LDPC or TPC to 25 Mbps, the modem will require:
Hardware option B, slot 1, a TPC/LDPC Codec;
Software options: L: data rate FAST option to 25 Mbps AND M:TPC/LDPC data rate FAST option to 25 Mbps.

D49

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

D.5.7 Modem Performance Information


Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Rx Signal N/A 5 bytes Query Only. N/A RSL? RSL=xxxxx
Level Unit returns the value of the Rx signal level, in dBm, between 20 and 90 dBm. (See Description of
If >-20dBm, returns RSL=GT-20 (GT = greater than) Arguments)
If <-90 dBm, returns RSL=LT-90 (LT = less than)
If in the range of 20 to 90dBm,
returns RSL=-xx.y (resolution 0.5dB)
Example: RSL=-45.5 (indicating 45.5 dBm)
Rx Frequency N/A 6 bytes Query only. N/A RFO? RFO=sxxx.x
Offset Unit returns the value of the measured frequency offset of the carrier being demodulated. (See Description of
Exception Values range from 0 to 200 kHz, 100 Hz resolution. Arguments)
600L Returns 999999 if the demodulator is unlocked.
Emulation: The maximum Rx Frequency Offset corresponds to the Receive Sweep Width (RSW)
5 bytes Example: RFO=+002.3 (selects + 2.3 kHz)
Buffer Fill N/A 2 bytes Query only. N/A BFS? BFS=xx
State Unit returns the value of the buffer fill state, between 1 and 99%. Returns 00 if demodulator is unlocked. (See Description of
Example: BFS=33 (selects 33%) Arguments)
Rx BER N/A 5 bytes Query only. N/A BER? BER=xxxxx
Units returns the value of the estimated corrected BER in the form a.bx10-3, where: (See Description of
First three bytes are the value. Arguments)
Last two bytes are the exponent.
Returns 99999 if the demodulator is unlocked or BER data is unavailable.
Example: BER=4.8E3 (selects BER=4.8 x 10-3)
Rx Eb/No N/A 4 bytes Query only. N/A EBN? EBN=xxxx
Unit returns the value of Eb/No, between 0 to 16 dB. Format xx.x, resolution 0.1 dB. (see Description of
Returns 99.9 if demod is unlocked. Arguments)
Returns +016 for values greater than 16.0 dB.
Example: EBN=12.3 (selects Eb/No = 12.3 dB)
Redundancy N/A 1 byte, 0 or 1 Query only. N/A RED? RED=x
State Unit returns the redundancy state of the unit in the form x, where: (See Description of
0=Offline Arguments)
1=Online
Example: RED=1 (selects Online)
Temperature N/A 3 bytes Query only. N/A TMP? TMP=xxx
Unit returns the value of the internal temperature sensor (degrees C) in the form xxx, where: (see Description of
Example: TMP=+26 Arguments)

D50

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Offline Unit N/A 8 bytes Query only. (1:1 set-up) N/A OUS? OUS=xxxxxx
Status This query is sent to the online modem of a 1:1 pair. It provides access to the fault status information (FLT?) (see Description of
of the offline modem. This is the only way to interrogate the status of an offline modem at the distant-end of Arguments)
a link. The response format may be:
No_1for1 = Indicates that no 1:1 system has been detected. Presence of a 1kHz signal from the
CRS-150 is used to indicate a 1:1 set-up;
No_Comms = Indicates that a 1kHz signal has been detected, but that there is no (or not yet) a response
for the modem;
abcdef = The FLT? response information from the offline 600L unit; or
abcdefghxx = The FLT? response information from the offline 625 unit.
Faults and N/A 10 bytes Query only. N/A FLT? FLT=abcdefghxx
Status Unit returns the current highest-priority fault and status codes for the Unit (hardware), TX Traffic, RX Traffic, and ODUs: (see Description of
a = Unit status: Arguments)
0 = No faults
1 = Power supply fault, +5 volts
2 = Power supply fault , +12 volts Exception
3 = Power supply fault, 5 volts 600L Emulation
4 = Power supply fault, +3.3 volts format:
5 = Power supply fault, 12 volts FLT=abcdef
6 = Power supply fault, +2.5 volts
7 = Top Card comms
8 = Tx synthesizer lock
9 = Rx synthesizer
A = Top card load fail
B = TPC/LDPC FPGA load fail
C = HDLC FPGA load fail
D = CnC FPGA load fail
E = VersaFEC FPGA load fail
F = Calibration data missing
Exception 600L: F = Rx synthesizer2
G = Reference unlocked (Note: Tx off)
H = TXDCM fail
I = Over Temperature Alarm
J = Packet Processor mailbox fault
K = Fractional CnC use only
b = Tx Traffic status:
0 = Tx traffic OK
1 = No clock from terrestrial interface
2 = Tx FIFO slip
3 = AIS detected on incoming data
4 = AUPC upper limit reached
5 = (Hi-Stab) No External Ref found (no activity)
6 = BUC summary alarm (if ABA enabled)
7 = G.703 Loss of Signal (only valid in Clock Extend Mode)
Exceptions 600L:6 = BUC current
7 = BUC voltage

D51

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Faults and 8 = BUC no comms/bad checksum
Status (cont.) 9 = BUC PLL
A = BUC temperature
8 = CnC-APC home state
c = Rx Traffic status:
0 = Rx Traffic OK
1 = Demodulator unlocked
2 = AGC Alarm - signal out of range
3 = Demux Lock (Frame SYNC)
4 = Spare
5 = Buffer Slip
6 = AIS detected on incoming data
7 = Eb/No alarm
8 = Buffer Clock activity
9 = LNB summary alarm (if ALA enabled)
A = QDI Deframer Unlocked
Exception 600L: 9 = LNB current
A = LNB voltage
B,C,D,E,F = Spare
G = CnC-APC band mismatch
d = Open Network:
0 = No Faults
1 = Loss of Tx frame
2 = BER Alarm
3 = Loss of Tx multiframe
4 = Tx signaling AIS
5 = Tx Remote alarm
6 = IBS satellite alarm
7 = IDR Rx BWA1
8 = IDR Rx BWA2
9 = IDR Rx BWA3
A = IDR Rx BWA4
B = IDR Tx BWA1
C = IDR Tx BWA2
D = IDR Tx BWA3
E = IDR Tx BWA4
e = Change in modem fault status since last poll
0 = unchanged
1 = changed
f = Change in modem configuration since last poll
0 = unchanged
1 = changed
g= BUC status/faults:
0 = OK, masked, or not present
1 = BUC current
2 = BUC voltage
3 = spare

D52

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Faults and 4 = BUC no comms/bad checksum
Status (cont.) 5 = BUC PLL
6 = BUC temperature
h= LNB status/faults:
0 = OK, masked, or not present
1 = LNB current
2 = LNB voltage
xx = spares
CnC N/A 4 bytes Query only. N/A CRM? CRM=xxxx
Ratio Monitor When CnC is enabled and the modem is locked, ratio (in dB) is monitored between the interferer and the (see Description of
desired power. Arguments)
Example 1: CRM=+02 (interferer > desired) (format = sdd)
Example 2: CRM=LT11 (less than 11 dB)
Example 3: CRM=GT11 (greater than +11 dB)
Example 4: CRM=99.9 (not locked or CnC not enabled)
Example 5: CRM=AUTO (in CnC-APC mode)
CnC N/A 6 bytes Query only. N/A CDM? CDM=xxxxxx
Delay Monitor When CnC is enabled and the modem is locked, delay (in microseconds) of the interferer is monitored. (see Description of
Example 1: CDM=229500 (229.5 ms) Arguments)
Example 2: CDM=999999 (not locked or CnC not enabled)
CnC N/A 6 bytes Query only. N/A CFM? CFM=xxxx.x
Freq Offset When CnC is enabled, an estimated frequency offset (in kHz) is calculated between the interferer and the (see Description of
Monitor desired power. Arguments)
Example 1: CFM=+001.0 (1 kHz)
Example 2: CFM=9999.9 (not locked or CnC not enabled)
CnC Power N/A 6 bytes Query only. N/A CPR? CPR=xxxxxx
Ratio Monitor When CnC is enabled and the modem is locked, ratio (in dB) between the interferer and the desired power (see Description of
is monitored.. The precision is 0.1dB. Arguments)
Example 1: CPR=+02.8 (interferer > desired) (format = sdd.d)
Example 2: CPR=LT11.0 (less than 11.0 dB)
Example 3: CPR=GT19.0 (greater than +19.0 dB)
Example 4: CPR=9999.9 (not locked or CnC not enabled)
Example 5: CPR=AUTO (in CnC-APC mode)

D53

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
CnC PSDR N/A 5 bytes Query only. N/A PSD? PSD=xxxxx
When CnC is enabled and the modem is locked, ratio (in dB) between the interferer and the desired power (see Description of
is monitored. The precision is 0.1dB. Arguments)
Example 1: PSD=+02.8 (interferer > desired) (format = sdd.d)
Example 2: PSD=999.9 (not locked or CnC not enabled)
Example 3: PSD=AUTO (in CnC-APC mode)
CnC-APC Bit N/A 4 bytes Query only. N/A ABE? ABE=xxxx
Error Rate Unit returns the value of CnC-APC BER in the form ax10-3, where:
First byte is the value, last two bytes are the exponent.
Returns 9999 if modem is not in CnC-APC mode or there is an APC frame sync error.
BER is measured in frame UW.
Example: ABE=8E-5
CnC-APC BER ABR= None Command only. ABR= N/A N/A
Reset Restart CnC-APC BER measurement.
Note: This command takes no arguments.
CnC-APC N/A 4 bytes Query only. N/A AFE? AFE=xxxx
Frame Error Unit returns the value of CnC-APC FER in the form ax10-3, where:
Rate First byte is the value, last two bytes aret he exponent.
Returns 9999 if modem is not in CnC-APC mode or there is an APC frame sync error.
Example: Example: AFE=8E-2
CnC-APC FER AFR= None Command only. AFR= N/A N/A
Reset Restart CnC-APC FER measurement.
Note: This command takes no arguments.
CnC-APC APC= 1 byte, 0 thru 2 Command only. APC= N/A N/A
Activate/Suspe Used to activate or suspend APC operation, in format APC=x, where:
nd 0 = no action
1 = Activate APC
2 = Suspend APC

D54

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
CnC-APC N/A 2 bytes Query only. N/A APS? APS=xx
state Unit returns the state of APC operation. Return value is in form xx, where:
00 = APC is not active
01 = No Solution
02 = OK - ReBalance Done
03 = OK(Partial) - CnC Ratio approaches limit
04 = OK(Partial) - Local power approaches miminum value (-25 dBm for IF band)
05 = OK(Partial) - Local power approaches minimum value (-40 dBm for L-Band)
06 = OK(Partial) - Local power approaches maximum value (0 dBm)
07 = OK(Partial) - Local power approaches limit set by max power level increase
08 = OK(Partial) - Distant power approaches miminum value (-25 dBm for IF band)
09 = OK(Partial) - Distant power approaches minimum value (-40 dBm for L-Band)
10 = OK(Partial) - Distant power approaches maximum value (0 dBm)
11 = OK(Partial) - Distant power approaches limit set by max power level increase
12 = OK(Partial) - Incomplete
13 = No APC Frame Sync
14 = CnC Ratio Problem
15 = Local EbNo too high
16 = Distant EbNo too high
17 = Distant End ReBalance failed
18 = Distant End NoResponse
19 = Fail-Calculate Mismatch
20 = CnC Ratio too high
21 = Please run again
22 = APC is active
23 = Local margin too low
24 = Distant margin too low
25 = Rx Data Rate<64kbps
26 = Tx Data Rate<64kbps
27 = Local RSL too low
28 = Distant RSL too low
CnC-APC Max APL= 3 bytes Command or Query. APL= APL? APL=xx.x
Power Level CnC-APC maximum power level increase in the form x.x, range from 0.0 to 9.9 dB, limited by Tx power APL? (see Description of
Increase level. APL* Arguments)
Example: APL=3.9 (APC max power level increase is 3.9 dB.) APL#

D55

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
CnC-APC AHS= 12 bytes Command or Query. AHS= AHS? AHS=a,bbb,cc,ddd
Home State Command is only for Offline unit in Redundancy system, sent by 1:N switch or Online unit in 1:1 system. AHS? (see Description of
Returns CnC-APC home state parameters in the form a,bbb,cc,ddd, where: AHS* Arguments)
a = APC state. (1 = APC is active, 0 = APC is not active) AHS#
bbb = APC home state Tx power, in 0.1dB. (minus sign assumed)
cc = APC home state max power level increase, in 0.1 dB.
ddd = APC Tx power threshold, in 0.1 dB. (minus sign assumed)
Example: AHS=1,100,60,085 (APC is active, home state power is -10.0 dB, home state max power level
increase is 6.0 dB, power threshold is -8.5 dB)
ACM Remote N/A 4 bytes Query only. N/A RSN? RSN=xx.x
Signal Noise Returns the value of SNR of the remote demod in the form xx.x, where: (see Description of
Ratio 99.9 = Demod is unlocked. Arguments)
xx.x = Not in IP-ACM.
Example: RSN=12.4
ACM Local N/A 4 bytes Query only. N/A SNR? SNR=xx.x
Signal Noise Unit returns the value of Local Signal Noise Ratio in the form xx.x, where: (see Description of
Ratio 99.9 = demod is unlocked. Arguments)
xx.x = Not in IP-ACM, Resolution 0.1 dB.
Example: SNR=12.3 (selects SNR=12.3 dB)
Uncorrected N/A 7 or 8 bytes Query only. N/A RBE? RBE=xxxxxxxx
BER Units returns the value of the uncorrected BER. (See Description of
LT = less than Arguments)
GT = greater than
Returns 9999999 if the demodulator is unlocked or uncorrected BER data is unavailable.
Example: BER=4.3E-02 BER=GT1.0E-1

D56

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

D.5.8 BUC Parameters (L-Band Device)


Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
BUC BPS= 1 byte, value Command or Query. BPS= BPS? BPS=x
Power Supply Exception of 0 or 1 BUC Power Supply control in the form x. where: BPS? Exception (see Description of
enable 600L Emulation: 0 = Disable the BUC DC Power Supply BPS* 600L Emulation: Arguments)
ODP= 1 = Enable the BUC DC Power Supply BPS# ODP?
BUC BFR= 1 byte Command or Query. BFR= BFR? BFR=x
10 MHz Exception In the form x, where: BFR? Exception (see Description of
Reference 600L Emulation: 0 = OFF BFR* 600L Emulation: Arguments)
ODR= 1 = ON BFR# ODR?
BUC BCL= 4 bytes Command or Query. BCL= BCL? BCL=xxxx
Current Exception BUC Current Low Limit, in the form xxxx, where xxxx is a value between 0 and 4000mA, in 100mA BCL? Exception (see Description of
Low Limit 600L Emulation: increments. BCL* 600L Emulation: Arguments)
ODL= BCL# ODL?
BUC BCH= 4 bytes Command or Query. BCH= BCH? BCH=xxxx
Current Exception BUC Current High Limit, in the form xxxx, where xxxx is a value between 0 and 4000mA, in 100mA BCH? Exception (see Description of
High Limit 600L Emulation: increments. BCH* 600L Emulation: Arguments)
ODH= BCH# ODH?
BUC BAD= 1 byte, value Command or Query. BAD= BAD? BAD=xx
Address Exception of 1 to 15 BUC Address, in the form xx, where xx is a value between 1 and 15. BAD? Exception (see Description of
600L Emulation: Note: This command is only valid when the FSK is enabled. BAD* 600L Emulation: Arguments)
OAD= BAD# OAD?
BUC BOE= 1 byte, value Command or Query. BOE= BOE? BOE=x
Output Power Exception of 0 or 1 BUC Tx Carrier Output Power Enable in the form x, where: BOE? Exception (see Description of
Enable 600L Emulation: 0 = OFF BOE* 600L Emulation: Arguments)
OOP= 1 = ON BOE# OOP?
Note: This command is only valid when the FSK is enabled.
BUC N/A 4 bytes Query only. N/A BDC? BDC=xxxx
DC BUC DC current, in the form xxxx, where xxxx is a value between 0 and 9999, units mA. Exception (see Description of
Current If not available, response is 0000. 600L Emulation: Arguments)
ODC?
BUC N/A 4 bytes Query only. N/A BDV? BDV=xx.x
Voltage BUC Voltage, in the form xx.x, where xx.x is a value between 0 and 64.0, units in volts. Exception (see Description of
600L Emulation: Arguments)
ODV?
BUC N/A 4 bytes Query only. N/A BOL? BOL=xx.x
Output Power BUC Output Power Level, in the form xx.x, where xx.x is the value in dBm. Exception (see Description of
Level Returns xxxx when FSK is not enabled. 600L Emulation: Arguments)
Example: BOL=37.4 OOL?

D57

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
BUC N/A 4 bytes Query only. N/A BUT? BUT=sxxx
Temperature BUCTemperature, in the form sxxx, where: Exception (see Description of
s = sign 600L Emulation: Arguments)
xxx = number ODT?
Note: This query is only valid when the FSK and BUC power are turned On.
BUC N/A 1 byte, value Query only. N/A BPA? BPA=x
Phase Lock of 0 or 1 BUC phase lock loop in the form x, where: (see Description of
Loop 0 = Locked Exception Arguments)
1 = Unlocked 600L Emulation:
Note: This query is only valid when the FSK is enabled. OLL?
BUC Software N/A 2 bytes Query only. N/A BSV? BSV=xx
Version BUC software version in the form xx, where xx is between 0 and 15. Exception (see Description of
Note: This query is only valid when the FSK and BUC power are turned On. 600L Emulation: Arguments)
OSV?
BUC N/A 2 bytes Query only. N/A BPC? BPC=xx
Power Class BUC Power Class in the form xx, where xx indicates the Power Class in watts. Exception (see Description of
Example: BPC=25 600L Emulation: Arguments)
Note: This query is only valid when the FSK is enabled. OPC?

D58

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

D.5.9 LNB Parameters (L-Band Device)


Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
LNB LPS= 1 byte Command or Query. LPS= LPS? LPS=x
DC Power LNB DC Power Supply Control, in the form x, where: LPS? (see Description of
Control 0 = OFF LPS* Arguments)
Exception 1 = 13V LNB Voltage LPS# Exception
600L Emulation: 2 = 18V LNB Voltage 600L Emulation:
LNB & LNV 3 = 24V LNB Voltage LNB & LNV
LNB LNR= 1 byte, value Command or Query. LNR= LNR? LNR=x
Reference of 0 or 1 LNB Reference Enable, in the form x, where: LNR? (see Description of
Enable 0 = Disable LNB Reference LNR* Arguments)
1 = Enable LNB Reference LNR#
LNB LNL= 3 bytes Command or Query. LNL= LNL? LNL=xxx
Low Current Low Current Limit in the form xxx, where xxx is a value between 0 and 500 mA. LNL? (see Description of
Limit LNL* Arguments)
LNL#
LNB LNH= 3 bytes Command or Query. LNH= LNH? LNH=xxx
High Current High Current Limit in the form xxx, where xxx is a value between 0 and 500 mA. LNH? (see Description of
Limit LNH* Arguments)
LNH#
LNB N/A 4 bytes Query only. N/A LNC? LNC=xxxx
Current LNB Current in the form xxxx, where the value is in mA. (see Description of
Arguments)
LNB N/A 4 bytes Query only. N/A LVO? LVO=xxxx
Voltage LNB Voltage in the form xxxx, where the value is in volts. (see Description of
Arguments)

D59

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

D.5.10 Ethernet Parameters


Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Ethernet SEC= 31 bytes Command or Query. SEC= SEC? SEC=1abbbbc;2ab
Control In the form 1abbbbc;2abbbbc;3abbbbc;4abbbbc, where: SEC? bbbc;3abbbbc;4abb
1, 2, 3, 4 is port number. SEC* bbc
a = reserved, default to 1. SEC# (see Description of
bbbb = reserved, default to 0001. Arguments)
c = port speed:
0 = Auto
1 = 100 Full
2 = 100 Half
3 = 10 Full
4 = 10 Half.

Actual N/A None Query only. N/A NPS? NPS=abcd


Negotiated In the form abcd, where: (see Description of
Port Speed a = port 1 negotiated port speed. Arguments)
b = port 2 negotiated port speed.
c = port 3 negotiated port speed.
d = port 4 negotiated port speed.
a, b, c, d have the following values:
0 = Link down
1 = 100 Full
2 = 100 Half
3 = 10 Full
4 = 10 Half

WAN Buffer WBL= 3 bytes Command or Query. WBL= WBL? WBL=xxx


Length WBL? (see Description of
WAN Buffer Length, 20 to 780 milliseconds, in 20 milliseconds steps. WBL* Arguments)
Example: WBL=100 WBL#

Average WAN N/A 2 bytes Query only. N/A WBF? WBF=xx


Buffer Fill (see Description
State Returns the value of Average WAN buffer fill state, between 0 and 99%. of Arguments)
Example: WBF=33 (selects 33%)

D60

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Ethernet EGC= Up to 347 Command or Query. EGC= EGC? EGC=1abccccdxxx;2
Global bytes Global Configuration of CDM625 Ethernet, in the form shown in the Response to Query column, where: EGC? EGC?n (where n abccccdxxx;3abcccc
Configuration 1abccccdxxx;2abccccdxxx;3abccccdxxx;4abccccdxxx=Switch Ports configuration same as SPC EGC* = 0 to 9. Returns dxxx;4abccccdxxxD
D=VLAN Mode Enable same as SVM EGC# the EGC portion EFFGHIJKKKKLLLL
E=Switch MAC Learning same as SML of 1 of 10 stored .
FF=QoS Priority same as QOS configurations) (see Description of
G= Ethernet 2048 Frame Size same as EFS Arguments)
H= Precision Time Protocol Feature same as PTP
I= Precision Time Protocol Mode same as PTM
J= Carrier ID same as CAI
KKKK=Management VLAN ID same as SMV
LLLL.=VLAN Table same as SVT
VLAN Mode SVM= 1 byte, value Command or Query. SVM= SVM? SVM=x
Enable 0 or 1 VLAN Mode Enable, in the form x, where: SVM? (see Description of
0 = VLAN is Disabled SVM* Arguments)
1 = VLAN is Enabled SVM#
Switch MAC SML= 1byte, value Command or Query. SML= SML? SML=x
Learning 0 or 1 Switch MAC learning in the form x, where: SML? (see Description of
0 = Off SML* Arguments)
1 =On SML#
VLAN Table SVT= Up to 287 Command or Query. SVT= SVT? SVT=aaaabcde,aaa
byes Sets/Returns all the entries in the VLAN table in the form aaaabcde,aaaabcde,aaaabcde,, where: SVT? abcde,aaaabcde
aaaa = VLAN ID. Value range is 1-4095, must not be duplicate of any PVID. SVT* (see Description of
b = property of port 1: 0=Tagged, 1=Filtered, 2=Untagged SVT# Arguments)
c = property of port 2: 0=Tagged, 1=Filtered, 2=Untagged
d = property of port 3: 0=Tagged, 1=Filtered, 2=Untagged
e = property of port 4: 0=Tagged, 1=Filtered, 2=Untagged
Add entry to SVA= 8 bytes Command only. SVA= N/A SVA=aaaabcde
VLAN table Adds entry to VLAN table in the form aaaabcde, where: SVA? (see Description of
aaaa = New VLAN ID. Value range is 1-4095, must not be duplicate of any PVID or VLAN ID existing in SVA* Arguments)
VLAN table. SVA#
b = property of port 1. 0=Tagged, 1=Filtered, 2=Untagged
c = property of port 2. 0=Tagged, 1=Filtered, 2=Untagged
d = property of port 3. 0=Tagged, 1=Filtered, 2=Untagged
e = property of port 4. 0=Tagged, 1=Filtered, 2=Untagged
Management SMV= 4 bytes Command or Query. SMV= SMV? SMV=aaaa
VLAN ID Management Ports VLAN ID in the form aaaa, where: SMV? (see Description of
aaaa = the ID number in the range 0001-4095. SMV* Arguments)
SMV#

D61

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Delete entry in SVD= 4 bytes Command only. SVD= N/A SVD=aaaa
VLAN table Deletes VLAN table entry in the form aaaa, where: SVD? (see Description of
aaaa = the VLAN ID number in the range 0001-4095. SVD* Arguments)
SVD#
Packet PPE= 1 byte, value Command or Query. PPE= PPE? PPE=x
Processor 0 or 1 Packet Processor Card Enable, in the form PPE=x, where: PPE? (see Description of
Card Enable 0 = Packet Processor Card is Disabled PPE* Arguments)
1 = Packet Processor Card is Enabled PPE#
Note: Change of this configuration results in modem auto-reboot only when IP Packet Processor option card
is installed and enabled. Otherwise, when the IP Packet Processor option card is not installed, this selection
is stored but is otherwise non-functional.
QoS Mode QOS= 2 bytes Command or Query. QOS= QOS? QOS=ab
Qo (Quality of Service) Mode, in the form QOS=ab where: QOS? (see Description of
a = Layer 2 QoS; QOS* Arguments)
0 = Off, Layer 2 QoS is disabled QOS#
1 = VLAN Priority only
2 = Port Priority only
3 = VLAN and Port Priority
b =Layer 3 QoS;
0 = Off, Layer 3 QoS is disabled
1 = Advanced QoS Max / Priority (requires Advanced QoS FAST Option)*
2 = Advanced QoS Min Max (requires Advanced QoS FAST Option)*
3 = Advanced QoS DiffServ (requires Advanced QoS FAST Option)*
*Note: Layer 3 QoS settings 1 through 3 apply to modem only with IP Packet Processor option card installed
and enabled.
Switch Ports SPC= 47 bytes Command or Query. SPC= SPC? SPC=1abccccdxxx,2
Configuration Sets/Returns Ethernet switch ports priority and PVID in the form SPC? abccccdxxx,3abcccc
1abccccdxxx;2abccccdxxx;3abccccdxxx;4abccccdxxx, where: SPC* dxxx,4abccccdxxx
1, 2. 3. 4 = Port number. SPC# (see Description of
a = Port priority; Arguments)
Value is 1, 2, 3 or 4 (the higher the number, the higher the priority).
b = Port Native Mode;
0 = Native Mode Disabled, 1 = Native Mode Enabled.
cccc = Port VLAN ID in the range of 0000-4095;
Value 0000 is only valid when port Native Mode is disabled.
d = Pause flow control;
0 = Off, 1 = On
xxx = Eeserved.

D62

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Edit entry in SVE= 8 bytes Command only. SVE= N/A SVE=aaaabcde
VLAN table Edit VLAN table entry in the form aaaabcde, where: SVE? (see Description of
aaaa = existing VLAN ID. Value range is 1-4095. SVE* Arguments)
b = property of port 1; SVE#
0=Tagged, 1=Filtered, 2=Untagged
c = property of port 2;
0=Tagged, 1=Filtered, 2=Untagged
d = property of port 3;
0=Tagged, 1=Filtered, 2=Untagged
e = property of port 4;
0=Tagged, 1=Filtered, 2=Untagged
Packet WMD= 1 byte, value Command or Query. WMD= WMD? WMD=x
Processor 0 thru 3 Packet Processor Working Mode in the form x, where: WMD? (see Description of
Working Mode 0 = Managed Switch WMD* Arguments)
1 = Router Point to Point* WMD#
2 = Router Multipoint Hub*
3 = Router Multipoint Remote*
*Note: Settings 1 through 3 apply to modem only with IP Packet Processor option card installed and enabled.
Dedicated DMP= 1 byte, value Command or Query. DMP= DMP? DMP=x
Management 0 thru 8 Dedicated Ethernet Management port in Redundancy system in the form x, where: DMP? (see Description of
Port 0 = Disabled (Any Ethernet port can do management, default value) DMP* Arguments)
1 = Port 1 DMP#
2 = Port 2
3 = Port 3
4 = Port 4
5 = Port 1 Local only*
6 = Port 2 Local only*
7 = Port 3 Local only*
8 = Port 4 Local only*
Notes:
1. VLAN must be Disabled to be able to select a port as Dedicated Management Port.
2. * Only LAN devices can access M&C of modem. NO remote modem access.
Ethernet 2048 EFS= 1 byte, value Command or Query. EFS= EFS? EFS=x
Frame Size 0 or 1 2048 byte Ethernet Frame Size Enable/Disable in the form x, where: EFS? (see Description of
0 = 2048 Ethernet Frame Size is Disabled EFS* Arguments)
1 = 2048 Ethernet Frame Size is Enabled (supported by modem with baseboard hardware Rev2 and EFS#
above)

D63

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix D MN-CDM625

Command Query
Parameter Number of Response to Response to
(Instruction Description of Arguments (Instruction &
Type Arguments Command Query
& Qualifier) Qualifier)
Host Access ACL= 1 byte, value Command or Query. ACL= ACL? ACL=x
List 0 or 1 IP Host Access List Enable/Disable in the form x, where: ACL? (see Description of
Enable/Disable 0 = Host Access List is Disabled ACL* Arguments)
1 = Host Access List is Enabled ACL#
Packet PRD= 1 byte, value Command or Query. PRD= PRD? PRD=x
Processor 0 or 1 Valid only when Packet Processor is installed and Enabled. PRD? (see Description of
Redundancy Packet Processor Redundancy Enable/Disable, where: PRD* Arguments)
0 = Disable Packet Processor Redundancy PRD#
1 = Enable Packet Processor Redundancy
Precision Time PTP= 1 byte, value Command or Query. PTP= PTP? PTP=x
Protocol 0 or 1 Precision Time Protocol Feature Enable/Disable in the form x, where: PTP? (see Description of
0 = PTP is Disabled PTP* Arguments)
1 = PTP Enabled PTP#
Precision Time PTM= 1 byte, value Command or Query. PTM= PTM? PTM=x
Protocol 0 or 1 Precision Time Protocol Grandmaster selection in the form x, where: PTM? (see Description of
Grandmaster 0 = Grandmaster reachable over LAN. PTM* Arguments)
1 = Grandmaster reachable over WAN. PTM#
Packet N/A None Query only. N/A VS0? VS0=x
Processor Valid only when Packet Processor is installed and Enabled. x is variable length of
Bootrom FW Returns Packet Processor Bootrom firmware version. text
Version
Packet N/A None Query only. N/A VS1? VS1=x
Processor Valid only when Packet Processor is installed and Enabled. x is variable length of
Image1 FW Returns Packet Processor Image 1 firmware version. text
Version
Packet N/A None Query only. N/A VS2? VS2=x
Processor Valid only when Packet Processor is installed and Enabled. x is variable length of
Image2 FW Returns Packet Processor Image 2 firmware version. text
Version
Packet N/A None Query only. N/A AFI? AFI=x
Processor Valid only when Packet Processor is installed and Enabled. x is variable length of
Running FW Returns Packet Processor Running firmware image. text
Image

D64

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


Appendix E. TELNET COMMAND
LINE INTERFACE (CLI)
OPERATION

E.1 Overview
The Telnet Command Line Interface (referred to hereafter as the Telnet CLI or the CLI) is an
Ethernet-based user menu system for the CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem equipped with
an installed and enabled optional IP Packet Processor card. The CLI facilitates configuration,
monitoring and control of the unit using a user-supplied terminal emulator (e.g., PuTTY or Tera
Term).

E.1.1 Interface Access


Any changes made to the modem that are not saved to permanent storage during
the active session will be lost if the modem is reset or loses power. This applies to
all of the base modem and optional Packet Processor parameters. The parameters
can be saved by pressing [F8] on any Telnet CLI configuration page.
For connection via a Terminal Emulator: The user PC must have network connectivity to a
Traffic Ethernet Port of the IP Module. This connectivity can be via a local LAN, a remote LAN, or
via a satellite link from another IP modem.

E1

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.1.2 Terminal Emulator Considerations


1. For best results, Comtech EF Data recommends PuTTY or TeraTerm as the
preferred terminal emulators.

2. Use of the HyperTerminal terminal emulator is not supported or recommended.

3. The numeric keypads ENTER key may not work on some terminal emulators.

E.1.2.1 Using the PuTTY Terminal Emulator


First, you must define your Telnet session connection:

For Connection type, select Telnet;

For Host Name (or IP Address), enter the interface IP Address (e.g., 192.168.1.11);

For Port, enter 107;

Click [Open] to proceed.

E2

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

Next, log in to the Telnet CLI using a valid Username and Password:

The Telnet CLI Home menu should now be accessible:

1. In order to use the Telnet CLI to make configuration changes to the CDM-625,
Remote Access Mode should always be set to [Ethernet].

2. PuTTY in Linux may require the following setting to render correctly:

Settings > Window > Translation > Override with UTF-8 if locale says so [UNCHECK]

E3

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.1.2.2 Using the Tera Term Terminal Emulator


First, you must define your Telnet session connection:

Select TCP/IP;

For Host, enter the interface IP Address (e.g., 192.168.1.11);

For Service, select Telnet;

For TCP port #, enter 107;

Click [OK] to proceed.

E4

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

Next, before you log in, Tera Term requires the following settings on the Setup > Terminal page:

For New-Line[Receive], use the drop-down list to select CR;

For New-Line[Transmit], use the drop-down list to select CR+LF.

Finally, log in to the Telnet CLI using a valid Username and Password:

E5

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

The Telnet CLI Home menu should now be accessible:

In order to use the Telnet CLI to make configuration changes to the CDM-625,
Remote Access Mode should always be set to [Ethernet].

E6

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.2 Using the Telnet Command Line Interface (CLI)

In order to use the Telnet CLI to make configuration changes to the CDM-625,
Remote Access Mode should always be set to [Ethernet].

E.2.1 Telnet CLI Menu System Parallel Functionality


The Telnet CLI allows monitoring, configuration, and control of the CDM-625 Satellite Modem in
a manner similar to functionality provided via its front panel menus and the CDM-625 Web
Server Interface. See those chapters for more in-depth explanations of operation.
Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION
Chapter 6. ETHERNET-BASED REMOTE PRODUCT MANAGEMENT
Certain configuration menu selections (e.g., Carrier-in-Carrier) are functional only
when that FAST feature has been purchased and enabled for operation. This chapter
documents the CLI as if all available options are installed your configuration may
or may not provide the level of functionality as described in this chapter.

E.2.2 CLI Menus Common Navigation and Operation Features


1. The CLI organizes operation under a hierarchy of Configuration and Information functions. You
may select a configuration submenu or information page (e.g., Administration, Statistics, etc.)
from this top-level menu, either by typing in the bracketed hot key that preceeds the submenu
name, or by using the arrow keys and pressing ENTER. Each submenu provides nested
dialog windows requiring further action.

2. The bottom of each screen shows the possible actions to take.

Home (Main) Menu page:

Submenu or nested pages (e.g., Administration, Statisdtics, etc.):

Dialog windows:

Table pages:

E7

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

Note the following:

Selection Description
Press [ENTER] to accept any updates or changes made on this page this does not
[ENTER]Select
save the selection to configuration memory, additional action is required.
[ESC] Back Press [ESC] to exit the current menu and return to the parent submenu.
Press [F5] to discard any changes made on the page and restore all values from the
[F5] Refresh
modem
[F8] Save Press [F8] to save the currently defined settings to configuration memory
[F9] Add Press [F9] to add a new index to a table (e.g., VLAN Table, Sect. E.3.4.4.1)
[F10] Exit Press [F10] to end the CLI session and close the terminal emulator window
Press [F11] to delete an ex isting i ndex f rom a t able ( e.g., VLAN T able, S ect.
[F11] Delete
E.3.4.4.1)

3. Any menu selection that requires user input


typically features an input dialog window.
Once a menu option is selected, its dialog
window opens and you must use the
arrow keys to select a functional choice:

Other dialog windows require entry of an


descriptive alphanumeric string or an
operational numeric value. This example of
the Home > Administration > SNMP: [A]
Contact dialog window shows Remote A
Site as the Current Value and prompts you
to enter an alphanumeric New Value:

Type the new parameter, and then press [ENTER] to accept the entry. The dialog window closes
and the CLI returns you to the active configuration page.

4. Each dialog windows provides cues to


ensure proper configuration of the unit. If
you enter an invalid parameter, the CLI
rejects the entry and displays an error
message at the bottom of the window, as
shown in this example:

Here, the CLI rejects the attempted entry of 6 and displays the message Number is out of
range. Re-enter a new value (in this example, a value within the acceptable ranges of 0 and
8-32) and then press [ENTER] to continue. Otherwise, press [ESC] to quit the dialog window
and return to the configuration page. You may then proceed with further configuration
updates.

E8

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

5. Any menu item that has been


changed since the previous save
gets appended with an asterisk [*],
as Cnc Mode shows in this
example:

You must press [F8] to save any changes to the modem memory. If you press [ESC]
after changes have been made but not saved on a page, the Unsaved Changes
window opens to force further action:

Use the arrow keys to select an action:

Selection Action
[Save] Save any changes made to the page to memory
[Discard] Exit the page without saving and return to the parent submenu
[Go Back] Return to the active configuration window to review or make further changes

6. For any page where the content


exceeds the defined window
height, a scroll bar appears on the
right hand side of the page:

Use the arrow keys within the window to scroll through the page contents.

This appendix documents the entire Telnet Command Line Interface. Some
features may not be available with your modem as equipped. Your CLI window
appearances may differ based on your terminal emulators configured window
settings.

E9

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3 Command Line Interface Pages

E.3.1 Home (Main) Menu

The Home Menu serves as the CLIs primary navigation page. All selections made on this page
take you to the submenus listed in this table. Press a hot key to access a submenu from this top-
level navigation page.

Hot
Description Function Sect.
Key
A Administration Access administrative configuration submenu E.3.2
B Modem Access modem configuration submenu E.3.3
C Network Access network configuration submenu E.3.4
D WAN Access WAN configuration submenu E.3.5
Access ODU comms, CSAT-5060 configuration submenus (summary E.3.6
E Outdoor Unit (ODU)
only)
F Redundancy Access 1:1 or 1:N redundancy configuration submenu E.3.7
Enter alphanumeric Circuit ID; view read-only CDM-625 operations E.3.8
G General Information
information screens
Access Base Modem and Packet Processor stored events and E.3.9
H Logs
statistics logs, alarms control submenus
I Statistics Access CDM-625 operational statistics submenus E.3.10
J Contact View read-only Customer Support contact information screen E.3.11
K Remote Mode Open the Remote Access Mode setting E.3.1.1

See the listed appendix section for further information. Once you have confirmed that the
Telnet CLIs Remote Access Mode is set to [Ethernet], press a hot key to access a configuration
submenu.

E10

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.1.1 Home > Remote Access Mode


In order to proceed with the operations described through the remaining chapter, you must be
sure to set Remote Access Mode to [Ethernet] in order for configuration changes to be saved
into memory.

First, from the Home menu, press [K] to open the Remote Access Mode dialog window:

Then, use the arrow keys to select the Remote Mode as Ethernet, and press [ENTER] to
accept the selection. Finally, press [F8] to save to memory. Note the following:

Remote Access Mode Selection Function


Configuration using Front Panel only
Local
Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION

Configuration using Serial Port


Serial Sect. 5.2.1.12 CONFIG: REMOTE (Remote Control)
Appendix D. REMOTE CONTROL

EDMAC mode cannot be set here the CLI displays EDMAC


Slave when the modem is in EDMAC Slave Mode
EDMAC Slave
Chapter 11. EDMAC CHANNEL

Configuration using SNMP / Telnet CLI / Web Server Interface


Ethernet Chapter 6,. ETHERNET-BASED REMOTE PRODUCT
MANAGEMET

E11

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.2 Home > Administration Submenu

Open the Administration submenu from the Home menu. This submenu contains the following
options:

Hot
Configuration Page Function Sect.
Key
A Host Access List Configure Host Access List(s) E.3.2.1
B SNMP Configure SNMP parameters and traps E.3.2.2
C Firmware (Base Modem) View Base Modem firmware information or select image load
View Packet Processor firmware information or select image E.3.2.3
D Firmware (Packet Processor)
load
E Reboot Reboot the CDM-625 E.3.2.4
Set the FAST Feature Demo Mode or view currently installed
F FAST Codes E.3.2.5
FAST options
G Save Modem Configuration Save up to 10 modem configurations to memory
E.3.2.6
H Load Modem Configuration Recall 1 of 10 modem configurations from memory
Discard any configuration changes and restore all settings
I Restore Factory Defaults E.3.2.7
as shipped

Press a hot key to access a configuration page. See the specified appendix section for further
configuration information. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Home menu.

E12

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.2.1 Home > Administration > Host Access List

Open the scrollable Host Access List page from the Administration submenu. This page contains
the following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Function / Option Entry
Key
A Access List Enforcement Use arrow keys to select Enabled or Disabled
B Access IP 1 Access IP List Entry Enable
E Access IP 2 Access IP List Entry Enable Typical for each entry Use arrow keys to set each list as
Enabled or Disabled
H Access IP 3 Access IP List Entry Enable
K Access IP 4 Access IP List Entry Enable
C Access IP 1 Access IP Address Typical for each entry Enter each IP Address in the form
F Access IP 2 Access IP Address XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX

I Access IP 3 Access IP Address Be sure to include your systems IP Address in


L Access IP 4 Access IP Address this list

D Access IP 1 Access Network Prefix Typical for each entry Enter a value as follows:
Range 1 Enter a value of 0
G Access IP 2 Access Network Prefix Range 2 Enter a value from 8 to 32
J Access IP 3 Access Network Prefix If you enter an invalid value, the CLI displays
M Access IP 4 Access Network Prefix error message Number is out of range

Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Administration
submenu.

E13

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.2.2 Home > Administration > SNMP

Open the SNMP page from the Administration submenu. This page contains the following
options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Contact
B Name Typical for each entry Enter the desired designations
C Location
D Enable Authentication Traps Use the arrow keys to select Enabled or Disabled
E SNMP Trap Destination IP Address 1 Typical for either entry Enter either IP Address in the form
F SNMP Trap Destination IP Address 2 XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX

G SNMP Trap Version Use the arrow keys to select SNMP V1 or SNMP V2
Enter the desired Trap Community name the default name is
H SNMP Trap Community
comtech

Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Administration
submenu.

E14

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.2.3 Home > Administration > Firmware (Base Modem) or (Packet


Processor)

Open the Base Modem and Packet Processor Firmware pages from the Administration submenu.
Use these pages to view the current firmware information, or to select the alternate firmware
image to be loaded at startup or reboot. Both pages contain the following option:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Boot From Use the arrow keys to set load as Image1 or Image2

Press the hot key to open the dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the
Administration submenu.

You must reboot the unit in order for the new firmware image load selection to take
effect.

E15

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.2.4 Home > Administration > Reboot

Open the Reboot page from the Administration submenu. Use this page to perform a soft reboot
of the CDM-625. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Administration submenu.

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Force Reboot Use the arrow keys to select No (default) or Yes to reboot

You must restart your Telnet CLI session upon reboot of the CDM-625.

E16

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.2.5 Home > Administration > FAST


Sect. 5.2.8 SELECT: FAST Menus in Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION
Appendix A. FAST ACTIVATION PROCEDURE

Open the FAST Options page from the Administration submenu. Use this page to review your
units available and installed FAST features.

E17

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Demo Mode Use the arrow keys to set Demo Mode as Disabled
(default) or Enabled
1. If Enabled, the CDM-625 begins operation in
FAST Demo Mode FAST Options Demo
Mode allows access to ALL CDM-625 FAST
options for 30 calendar days

2. You must reboot the modem after enabling or


disabling Demo Mode
Sect. 5.2.8.2. FAST: Demo Mode (Chapter 5.
FRONT PANEL OPERATION)

Press [A] to open the Demo Mode dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the
Administration submenu.

E18

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.2.6 Home > Administration > Save Modem Configuration / Load


Modem Configuration

Open the Save Modem Configuration and Load Modem Configuration pages from the
Administration submenu. Use these pages to save and load up to 10 modem configurations.

Press [A] to open the Save to Slot or Load from Slot dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to
return to the Administration submenu.

Each modem configuration is stored in an assigned slot 0 through 9. If a configuration slot is


available for storage, either page notes the status of that slot as Available. Otherwise, if the slot
contains an existing configuration, that slots storage time is specified in military format
(HH:MM:SS); the date is shown in DAY-MONTH-YEAR format in accordance with European
convention.

To store (save) a configuration setting:

First, make any desired configuration changes to the modem.

E19

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

Next, open the Save Modem


Configuration window (Home
> [A] Administration > [G]
Save Modem Configuration).
Note the Configuration slots
listed in the window, and
then press [A] Save to Slot.
The nested dialog window
opens:

Then, enter 0 through 9, and then press [ENTER] to accept the selection.

Finally, press [F8] to save (store) the configuration. Wait while the configuration is
stored into memory.

Once a modem configuration is stored into the designated slot, the time and date are recorded,
and this information appears on the configuration slot line.

To load (recall) a configuration setting:

First, open the Load Modem


Configuration window (Home
> [A] Administration > [H]
Load Modem Configuration).
Note the saved configuration
slots listed in the window,
and then press [A] Load from
Slot. The nested dialog
window opens:

Then, enter 0 through 9, and press [ENTER] to accept the selection.

Finally, press [F8] to load (recall) the configuration. Wait while the configuration is
loaded from memory.

E20

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.2.7 Home > Administration > Restore Factory Defaults

Open the Restore Factory Default page from the Administration submenu. Use this page to
restore the CDM-625 settings to the original settings as shipped from the factory.

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Restore Factory Defaults Use the arrow keys to set as Cancel (default) or Restore

Press [A] to open the Restore Factory Defaults dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return
to the Administration submenu.

By selecting Restore, the unit proceeds with restoration of factory defaults. Wait while the unit
reboots.

You must restart your Telnet CLI session upon reboot of the CDM-625.

E21

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.3 Home > Modem Submenu

Open the Modem submenu from the Home menu. This submenu contains the following options:

Hot
Configuration Page Function Sect.
Key
A Interface Configure the Tx and Rx Framing Modes E.3.3.1
B Modem TX Configure the units Tx parameters E.3.3.2
C Modem RX Configure the units Rx parameters E.3.3.3
D Carrier-in-Carrier (CnC) Configure CnC FAST Option E.3.3.4
Adaptive Coding and
E Configure ACM FAST Option E.3.3.5
Modulation (ACM)
F Drop and Insert (D&I) Configure D&I parameters E.3.3.6
G Block Upconverter (BUC) Configure BUC parameters and view operating statistics E.3.3.7
Low-Noise Block
H Configure LNB parameters and view operating statistics E.3.3.8
Downconverter (LNB)
I MEO (Medium Earth Orbit) Configure MEO and Antenna Handover parameters E.3.3.9
J Utilities Configure and monitor a variety of unit operational settings E.3.3.10
K Overhead Configure ESC, IDR Backward Alarms, AUPC, and EDMAC E.3.3.11

Press a hot key to access a configuration page. See the specified appendix section for further
configuration options. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Home menu.

E22

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.3.1 Home > Modem > Interface

Open the Interface page from the Modem submenu. This page contains the following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
Typical for either entry Use the arrow keys to select:
A Tx Interface Type
RS-422 V.35 G.703 Balanced
G.703 Unbalanced Audio LVDS
C Rx Interface Type HSSI IP ASI
IP ACM
Typical for either entry Use the arrow keys to select:
B Tx Framing Mode
Unframed IBS IDR
DNI EDMAC DNI ++
D Rx Framing Mode ESC ++ EDMAC2 ODI
Frm QDI EDMAC3

Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Modem
submenu.

E23

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.3.2 Home > Modem > Modem TX

Open the Modem TX page from the Modem submenu. This page contains the following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Tx FEC Type Use the arrow keys to select:
None Diff Enc On Viterbi Viterbi Reed-Solomon
Sequential Sequential Reed-Solomon TCM
TCM Reed-Solomon TPC None Diff Enc Off
LDPC VersaFEC ULL
Use the arrow keys to select:
B Tx Mod Type BPSK QPSK OQPSK
8PSK 16QAM 8QAM
Use the arrow keys to select:
Rate 1/2 Rate 3/4 Rate 7/8
Rate 2/3 Rate 1/1 Rate 21/44
Rate 5/16 Rate 0.95 VersaFEC BPSK 0.488
VersaFEC QPSK 0.533 VersaFEC QPSK 0.631 VersaFEC QPSK 0.706
C Tx FEC Code Rate VersaFEC QPSK 0.803 VersaFEC 8QAM 0.642 VersaFEC 8QAM 0.711
VersaFEC 8QAM 0.780 VersaFEC 16QAM 0.731 VersaFEC 16QAM 0.780
VersaFEC 16QAM 0.829 VersaFEC 16QAM 0.853 VersaFEC 8QAM 0.576
VersaFEC ULL BPSK VersaFEC ULL QPSK
VersaFEC 16QAM 0.644
0.493 0.493
VersaFEC ULL QPSK 0.654 VersaFEC ULL QPSK 0.734
D Tx Data Rate Enter a value from 18.000 to 25000.000 Kbps
E Tx Symbol Rate Enter a value from 18.000 to 25000.000 Ksps

E24

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
Enter a value as follows:
F Tx Frequency Range 1 From 50.0000 to 180.0000 MHz
Range 2 From 950.0000 to 2000.0000 MHz
G Tx Spectrum Invert Use the arrow keys to select Normal or Inverted
H Tx Scrambler Use the arrow keys to select Off, Normal, or IESS315
Enter a value as follows:
I Tx Power Level Range 1 From -99.9 to 99.9 dBm
Range 2 From-40.00 to 0.0 dBm
Tx Reed-Solomon
J Use the arrow keys to select Normal, IESS410, EF Data, or IBS
Encoding
K Tx Data Invert
Typical for either entry Use the arrow keys to select Normal or Inverted
L Tx Data Clock Invert
M Tx Ternary Code Use the arrow keys to select AMI, B8zs, B6zs, or Hdb3
Use the arrow keys to select:
Off On RTI, 10 s timeout
N Tx Carrier State
Off External Off BUC delay RTI, 1 s timeout
RTI, 2 s timeout RTI, 4 s timeout RTI, 7 s timeout
O POCO Use the arrow keys to select Disabled or Enabled
P Tx Submux Use the arrow keys to select Off or On
Use the arrow keys to select an IP/Synchronous setting:
1/9 1/8 1/7 1/6 1/5 1/4
2/7 1/3 2/5 3/7 1/2 3/5
Q Tx Submux Ratio 2/3 3/4 4/5 1/1 5/4 4/3
3/2 5/3 2/1 7/3 5/2 3/1
7/2 4/1 5/1 6/1 7/1 8/1
9/1 1/59 1/39 1/19
R Tx Filter Rolloff Factor Use the arrow keys to select Factor 0.35 or Factor 0.25

Valid code rates depend on the selected FEC and Mod types for example, you
cannot select VersaFEC 16QAM 0.644 if your FEC is TCM

Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Modem
submenu.

E25

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.3.3 Home > Modem > Modem RX

Open the Modem RX page from the Modem submenu. This page contains the following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Rx FEC Type Use the arrow keys to select
None Diff Enc On Viterbi Viterbi Reed-Solomon
Sequential Sequential Reed-Solomon TCM
TCM Reed-Solomon TPC None Diff Enc Off
LDPC VersaFEC ULL

Use the arrow keys to select:


B Rx Mod Type BPSK QPSK OQPSK
8PSK 16QAM 8QAM
Use the arrow keys to select:
Rate 1/2 Rate 3/4 Rate 7/8
Rate 2/3 Rate 1/1 Rate 21/44
Rate 5/16 Rate 0.95 VersaFEC BPSK 0.488
VersaFEC QPSK 0.533 VersaFEC QPSK 0.631 VersaFEC QPSK 0.706
C Rx FEC Code Rate VersaFEC QPSK 0.803 VersaFEC 8QAM 0.642 VersaFEC 8QAM 0.711
VersaFEC 8QAM 0.780 VersaFEC 16QAM 0.731 VersaFEC 16QAM 0.780
VersaFEC 16QAM 0.829 VersaFEC 16QAM 0.853 VersaFEC 8QAM 0.576
VersaFEC ULL BPSK VersaFEC ULL QPSK
VersaFEC 16QAM 0.644
0.493 0.493
VersaFEC ULL QPSK 0.654 VersaFEC ULL QPSK 0.734

E26

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
Enter a value from 18.000 to 25000.000 Kbps
D Rx Data Rate
Data Rate applies only when not in ACM Mode

Enter a value from 18.000 to 25000.000 Ksps


E Rx Symbol Rate
Symbol Rate applies when in ACM Mode

Enter an Rx Frequency as follows:


F Rx Frequency Range 1 From 50.0000 to 180.0000 MHz
Range 2 From 950.0000 to 2000.0000 MHz
G Rx Spectrum Invert Use the arrow keys to select Normal or Inverted
H Rx Descrambler Use the arrow keys to select Off, Normal, or IESS315
I Rx Acq Sweep Range Enter a value from 1 to 200 kHz
Rx Reed-Solomon
J Use the arrow keys to select Normal, IESS410, EF Data, or IBS
Decoding
K Rx Data Invert
Typical for either entry Use the arrow keys to select Normal or Inverted
L Rx Data Clock Invert
M Rx Ternary Code Use the arrow keys to select AMI, B8zs, B6zs, or Hdb3
N Rx EbNo Alarm Point Enter a value from 0.1 to 16.0 dB
O Rx Equalizer Enable Use the arrow keys to select Disabled or Enabled
P Rx Submux Use the arrow keys to select Off or On
Use the arrow keys to select the IP/Synchronous setting:
1/9 1/8 1/7 1/6 1/5 1/4
2/7 1/3 2/5 3/7 1/2 3/5
Q Rx Submux Ratio 2/3 3/4 4/5 1/1 5/4 4/3
3/2 5/3 2/1 7/3 5/2 3/1
7/2 4/1 5/1 6/1 7/1 8/1
9/1 1/59 1/39 1/19

Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Modem
submenu.

E27

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.3.4 Home > Modem > Carrier-in-Carrier (CnC)

Chapter 10. DOUBLETALK CARRIER-IN-CARRIER (CNC) OPTION

Open the Carrier-in-Carrier (CnC) page from the Modem submenu. This page contains the
following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
Use the arrow keys to select:
Off On Normal APC CBand Side A
A CnC Mode APC XBand Side A APC KuBand Side A APC KaBand Side A
APC CBand Side B APC XBand Side B APC KuBand Side B
APC KaBand Side B
B CnC Search Min Delay Enter a minimum value from 0 to 330 ms
C CnC Search Max Delay Enter a maximum value from 0 to 330 ms
D CnC Frequency Offset Enter a value from 1 to 200 KHz
E CnC PMSI Mode Use the arrow keys to select Idle, Redundancy, Talk, or Listen

Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Modem
submenu.

E28

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.3.5 Home > Modem > Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM)

Chapter 17. ADAPTIVE CODING AND MODULATION (ACM) OPTION

Open the ACM page from the Modem submenu. Use this page as a quick reference guide for the
Minimum and Maximum Tx ModCod settings. This submenu contains the following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A ACM Min Tx Mod Cod Enter a minimum value from 0 to 11
B ACM Max Tx Mod Cod Enter a maximum value from 0 to 11
Use the arrow keys to select Go To Min Tx Modcod or
C ACM Action on Remote Demod Unlock
Maintain Tx Modcod
D ACM Target Eb No Margin Enter a value from 0.0 to 4.5 dB

Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Modem
submenu.

E29

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.3.6 Home > Modem > Drop and Insert (D&I)

Chapter 9. CLOCK MODES AND DROP AND INSERT (D&I)

Open the Drop and Insert (D&I) page from the Modem page. This page contains the following
options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Drop Type Typical for either entry Use the arrow keys to select T1D4, T1
B Insert Type ESF, E1 CCS, or E1CAS
C Tx Terrestrial Alarm Mask Use the arrow keys to select Alarm Active or Alarm Masked
D Rx Terrestrial Alarm Enable Use the arrow keys to select Disable or Enable
E D&I Table
F D&I++ Table See Sect. E.3.3.6.1 for details
G D&I Quad Table

Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Modem
submenu.

E30

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.3.6.1 Home > Modem > Drop and Insert (D&I) > D&I Tables
From the Drop and Insert (D&I) page, press E (D&I Table), F (D&I++ Table ) or G D&I Quad Table
to continue.

Typical for any table, enter a new value, and then press [ENTER] to accept the change or [ESC]
to return to the D&I page.

Hot Key [E] D&I Table

The D&I Table dialog window shows the current value for the table. To edit the table value,
press A, and then enter a new value*. Press [ENTER] to accept the change or [ESC] to return
to the D&I dialog window.

* For correct syntax, see the DNI Command/Query Description of Arguments


column, SECT. D.5.5 Bulk Configuration Strings, page D-44 in APPENDIX D.
REMOTE CONTROL

Hot Key [F] D&I++ Table

E31

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

The D&I++ Table dialog window shows the current value for the table. To edit the table
value, press A, and then enter a new value*. Press [ENTER] to accept the change or [ESC] to
return to the D&I dialog window.

* For correct syntax, see the DIC Command/Query Description of Arguments


column, SECT. D.5.5 Bulk Configuration Strings, page D-44 in APPENDIX D.
REMOTE CONTROL

Hot Key [G] D&I Quad Table

The D&I Quad Table dialog window shows the current value for each table. To edit a table
value*, press A (Quad Drop And Insert Port 1), B (Quad Drop And Insert Port 2), C (Quad
Drop And Insert Port 3), or D (Quad Drop And Insert Port 4).

* For correct syntax, see the QDI Command/Query Description of Arguments,


SECT. D.5.5 Bulk Configuration Strings, page D-45 in APPENDIX D. REMOTE
CONTROL

E32

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.3.7 Home > Administration > Block Upconverter (BUC)

Open the Block Upconverter (BUC) page from the Modem submenu. This page features a read-
only status section for the installed device and contains the following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A BUC DC Power Use the arrow keys to select Disable or Enable
B BUC 10 MHz Reference
Typical for either entry Use the arrow keys to select Off or On
C BUC RF Output
D BUC Low Current Limit Enter a low limit value from 0 to 4000 mA
E BUC High Current Limit Enter a high limit value from 0 to 4000 mA
Enter a value as follows:
F BUC LO Frequency Range 1 From 0 to 0 MHz
Range 2 From 3000 to 65000 MHz
G BUC LO Mix Use the arrow keys to select Low Side Mix or High Side Mix
H BUC Address Enter a value from 1 to 15

Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Modem
submenu.

E33

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.3.8 Home > Modem > (Low-Noise Block Downconverter) LNB

Open the (Low-Noise Block Downconverter) LNB page from the Modem submenu. This page
provides a read-only status section for the installed device and contains the following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A LNB DC Power Use the arrow keys to select Off, On 13V, On 18V, or On 24V
B LNB 10 MHz Reference Use the arrow keys to select Disable or Enable
C LNB Low Current Limit Enter a low limit value from 0 to 500 mA
D LNB High Current Limit Enter a high limit value from 0 to 500 mA
Enter a value as follows:
E LNB LO Frequency Range 1 From 0 to 0 MHz
Range 2 From 3000 to 65000 MHz
F LNB LO Mix Use the arrow keys to select Low Side Mix or High Side Mix

Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Modem
submenu.

E34

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.3.9 Home > Modem > MEO (Medium-Earth Orbit)

MEO is non-functional when the optional Carrier-in-Carrier (CnC) card is installed.

CDM625 modems are configurable for continuous pairing as Primary and nonPrimary Modems
in an Antenna Handover System when the MEO (Medium Earth Orbit) feature is enabled. Open
the MEO page from the Modem submenu. This page contains the following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A MEO Enable Typical for either entry Use the arrow keys to select Disabled
B Antenna Handover Enable or Enabled
C Antenna Handover Mode Use the arrow keys to select Manual or Auto
D Antenna Handover DPD Enter a Differential Path Delay value from -30 to 30
E Antenna Handover Port Enter a value from 1001 to 65535

Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Modem
submenu.

E35

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.3.10 Home > Modem > Utilities

Open the scrollable Utilities page from the Modem submenu. This page contains the following
options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Unit Test Mode Use the arrow keys to select
Normal Tx CW Tx Alt10 Pattern
IF Loopback RF Loopback Digital Loopback
I/O Loopback

E36

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
B Statistics Sample Interval Use the arrow keys to select Disabled, or 10 minutes to 90 minutes
Use the arrow keys to select Loop No Action, Loop RTS Controls
C Request To Send
Tx Output, or Ignore RTS Assert CTS
Use the arrow keys to select TA To CA Loop or RR Control CA TA
D HSSI Handshake Control
Control TxS
E Circuit ID Enter a Circuit ID value as needed
F Carrier ID Use the arrow keys to select Disable or Enable
G RTC Time Enter a value in the form HH:MM:SS
H RTC Date Enter a value in the form DD:MM:YY
Use the arrow keys to select Internal, Tx Terrestrial, Rx Loop
I Tx Clock Source
Timed, or Rx Sat
Use the arrow keys to select Rx Satellite, Tx Terrestrial, Internal
J Rx Clock Source
SCT, or Insert
K Rx Buffer Size Enter a value from 16 to 32768
Use the arrow keys to select:
L Modem Reference Clock Internal External 1 MHz External 2 MHz
External 5 MHz External 10 MHz Internal Plus Output
M G703 Clock Extend Mode Use the arrow keys to select None, Tx Lock, or Rx Enable
N G703 Clock Extend Intf Use the arrow keys to select T1, E1 Balanced, or E1 Unbalanced
O Warm Up Delay Use the arrow keys to select Disable or Enable
P Warm Up Countdown Enter a value from 0 to 999 seconds
Q BERT Restart Monitor Use the arrow keys to select No or Yes
R BERT Tx State Use the arrow keys to select Off or On
Typical for either entry Use the arrow keys to select:
S BERT Tx Pattern BERT Pattern Space BERT Pattern Mark BERT Pattern 11
BERT Pattern 12 BERT Pattern 63 BERT Pattern 511
BERT Pattern 2047 BERT Pattern 2047 R BERT Pattern MIL188
U BERT Rx Pattern
BERT Pattern 2^15 BERT Pattern 2^20 BERT Pattern 2^23
T BERT Rx State
V BERT 10^-3 Error Insert Typical for each entry Use the arrow keys to select Off or On
W Recenter Buffer

Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Modem
submenu.

E37

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.3.11 Home > Modem > Overhead

Open the scrollable Overhead page from the Modem submenu. This page contains the following
options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A IDR Tx ESC Type Typical for either entry Use the arrow keys to select 64k Data
B IDR Rx ESC Type Channel or 2 Audio Channels
C Tx Audio Volume Port 1 Typical for each entry Use the arrow keys to select:
D Tx Audio Volume Port 2 Negative6 Negative4 Negative2 Zero
E Rx Audio Volume Port 1 Positive2 Positive4 Positive6 Positive8
F Rx Audio Volume Port 2
G High Rate ESC Use the arrow keys to select Disabled or Enabled

See Sect. 5.2.1.10.6 CONFIG: Misc HiRateESC in


H High Rate ESC Parameters
Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION for details

E38

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
I Tx Backward Alarm Enable Port1
J Tx Backward Alarm Enable Port2
K Tx Backward Alarm Enable Port3
L Tx Backward Alarm Enable Port4
Typical for each entry Use the arrow keys to select Off or On
M Rx Backward Alarm Enable Port1
N Rx Backward Alarm Enable Port2
O Rx Backward Alarm Enable Port3
P Tx Backward Alarm Enable Port4
Q AUPC Enable Use the arrow keys to select Disable or Enable
R AUPC Remote Demod Target Eb No Enter a value from 0.0 to 14.9 dB
S AUPC Tx Power Max Increase Enter a value from 0 to 9 dB
Use the arrow keys to select No Action, Generate Tx Alarm
T AUPC Action On Max Power
Max Power, or Generate Tx Alarm Minimum ModCod
AUPC Action On Remote Demod Use the arrow keys to select Go To Nominal Power, Go To
U
Unlock Max Power, or Hold
V EDMAC Mode Use the arrow keys to select Off, Master, or Slave
W EDMAC Address Enter a value from 0 to 9999

Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Modem
submenu.

E39

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.4 Home > Network Submenu

Open the Network submenu from the Home menu. This submenu contains the following
options:

Hot
Configuration Page Function Sect.
Key
A Ethernet Ports Configure Ethernet Ports 1 through 4 E.3.4.1
Configure Ethernet Framing, IP addresses, QoS, Working
B LAN IP E.3.4.2
Mode, Packet Processor parameters
C LAN ARP Configure LAN ARP operation and table entries E.3.4.3
D VLAN Configure VLAN operation and table entries E.3.4.4
Enter static routes into the IP Packet Processor to route IP
E Routes E.3.4.5
traffic over the satellite or to another device on the local LAN
Configure Header and Payload Compression and Encryption
F Managed Switch E.3.4.6
operations
Configure use of IGMP (Internet Group Management Protocol)
G IGMP E.3.4.7
with configured multicast routes
Configure use of DNS (Domain Name System) caching
H DNS E.3.4.8
function
Configure use of DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration
I DHCP E.3.4.9
Protocol) Relay function
Configure use and review status of PTP (Precision Time
J PTP E.3.4.10
Protocol) feature
Configure use of SNTP (Simple Network Time Protocol)
K SNTP E.3.4.11
feature, set RTC (Real Time Clock) time and date
View the MAC Addresses that the modem has discovered on
L MAC Table E.3.4.12
one or more of its Ethernet switch ports

Press a hot key to access a configuration page. See the specified appendix section for further
configuration options. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Home menu.

E40

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.4.1 Home > Network > Ethernet Ports

Open the scrollable Ethernet Ports page from the Network submenu. This page lists the current
configuration settings for Ethernet Ports 1 through 4.

Use the arrow keys to select <Ethernet Port 1>, <Ethernet Port 2>, <Ethernet Port 3>, or
<Ethernet Port 4>, and then press [ENTER] to continue.

E41

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.4.1.1 Home > Network > Ethernet Ports > Ethernet Port #

Open the nested Ethernet Port 1 through Ethernet Port 4 pages from the scrollable Home >
Network> Ethernet Ports page. Each page contains the following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
Use the arrow keys to select:
A Ethernet Ports Speed Auto Full 100 Mbps Half 100 Mbps
Full 10 Mbps Half 10 Mbps
B Ethernet Ports Pause Flow Control Use the arrow keys to select Off or On
C Ethernet Port Mode Use the arrow keys to select Trunk or Access
D Ethernet PVID Enter a value from 1 to 4095
E Ethernet Port Priority Enter a priority value from 1 to 4

Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Ethernet Ports
page.

E42

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.4.2 Home > Network > LAN IP

Open the LAN IP page from the Network submenu. This page contains the following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A 2048-byte Ethernet Frames Use the arrow keys to select Disabled or Enabled
B Default Gateway Typical for either entry Enter an IP address in the form
C IP Address XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX

D IP Network Prefix Enter a value from 8 to 30


E Switch MAC Learning Use the arrow keys to select Off or On
Use the arrow keys to select Off, VLAN Prio Only, Port Prio
F L2 QoS
Only, or VLAN and Port Prio
Use the arrow keys to select Off, Advanced QoS Max
G L3 QoS
Priority, Advanced QoS Min Max, or Advanced QoS DiffServ
Use the arrow keys to select Managed Switch, Router
H Working Mode Point-to-Point, Router Multipoint Hub, or Router Multipoint
Remote
I Packet Processor Enable Use the arrow keys to select Disabled or Enabled

Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Network
submenu.

E43

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.4.3 Home > Network > LAN ARP

Open the LAN ARP page from the Network submenu. This page contains the following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A ARP Table Use the arrow keys to select a table see Sect. E.3.4.3.1.
B Flush Dynamic ARP Entries Use the arrow keys to select Cancel or Flush

Press a hot key to view the ARP Table or open the dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to
return to the Network submenu.

E44

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.4.3.1 Home > Network > LAN ARP > Arp Table > Arp Entry #

Open the ARP Table from the nested ARP submenu. Use the arrow keys to scroll through
the available entries. You may also select a header (e.g., <ARP Entry 1>) and press [ENTER] to
view, in a standalone window, a specific ARP Entry page as shown in this example:

This window displays the ARP Type for the specific ARP Entry #. It contains the following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A ARP IP Address Enter an IP Address in the form XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX
Enter a MAC Address in the form of this example:
B ARP MAC Address
90:e2:ba:2b:a6:bb

Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] twice to return to the Network
submenu.

E45

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.4.4 Home > Network > VLAN

Open the VLAN submenu from the Network submenu. This submenu contains the following
options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A VLAN Table Use the arrow keys to select a table see Sect. E.3.4.4.1
B VLAN Mode Enable Use the arrow keys to select Disabled or Enabled
C Ethernet Management PVID Enter a value from 1 to 4095

Press a hot key to open the VLAN Table or a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to
the Network submenu.

E46

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.4.4.1 Home > Network > VLAN > VLAN Table > VLAN #

Open the VLAN Table from the nested VLAN submenu. Use the arrow keys to scroll through
the available entries. You may also select a header (e.g., <VLAN 1>) and press [ENTER] to view,
in a standalone window, a specific VLAN page as shown in this example:

Each available VLAN # page contains the following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A VLAN Entry VID Enter a value from 1 to 4095
B VLAN Entry Port1 Property
C VLAN Entry Port2 Property Typical for each entry Use the arrow keys to select Tagged,
D VLAN Entry Port3 Property Filtered, or Untagged

E VLAN Entry Port4 Property

Typical for any accessed VLAN table, press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press
[ESC] twice to return to the Network submenu.

E47

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.4.5 Home > Network > Routes

Open the Routes page from the Network submenu. This page contains the following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Route Table Use the arrow keys to select an index see Sect. E.3.4.5.1
B Delete All Route Entries Use the arrow keys to select No or Yes

Press a hot key to open the Route Table or the dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return
to the Network submenu.

E48

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.4.5.1 Home > Network > Routes > Route Table

Open the Route Table from the nested Routes submenu. Use the arrow keys to scroll
through the available entries. You may also select a header (e.g., <Index 1>) and press [ENTER]
to view, in a standalone window, a specific Route Index page as shown in this example:

Each available Index # page contains the following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Route Description Enter a description here
B Route Destination Address/Mask Enter an IP Address/Range in the form XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX/XX
C Route Interface Use the arrow keys to select LAN or WAN
D Route LAN Next Hop Address Enter an IP Address in the form XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX
E Route Header Compression
Typical for each entry Use the arrow keys to select Disable
F Route Payload Compression
or Enable
G Route Encryption
Use the arrow keys to select Key 1 through Key 8, or
H Route Encryption Key
Random

Typical for any accessed Index # page, press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press
[ESC] twice to return to the Network submenu.

E49

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.4.6 Home > Network > Managed Switch

Open the Managed Switch page from the Network submenu. This page contains the following
options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
Use the arrow keys to select Disable, Layer 2 Only, or Layer
A Header Compression
2 And 3
B Payload Compression Typical for either entry Use the arrow keys to select Disable
C Encryption Feature or Enable
Use the arrow keys to select Key 1 through Key 8, or
D Encryption Key Select
Random

Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Network
submenu.

E50

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.4.7 Home > Network > IGMP (Internet Group Management Protocol)

Open the IGMP page from the Network submenu. This page contains the following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
Lists the IGMP Groups that are active on the modem. If none
A IGMP Joined Groups
exist, this window displays the message <No IGMP Groups>
Lists the Multicast Routes that are active on the modem. If none
B Multicast Traffic exist, this window displays the message <No IGMP Multicast
Entries>
C IGMP Version Use arrow keys to select IGMPv1, IGMPv2, or IGMPv3
D IGMP Last Member Query Interval Enter a value from 1 to 25 seconds
E IGMP Query Interval Enter a value from 1 to 18000 seconds
F IGMP Query Response Interval Enter a value from 1 to 25 seconds

Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Network
submenu.

E51

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.4.8 Home > Network > DNS (Domain Name System)

Open the DNS Caching page from the Network submenu. This page contains the following
options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A DNS Caching Feature Use the arrow keys to select Disable or Enable
B DNS Caching Flush Use the arrow keys to select Cancel or Flush

Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Network
submenu.

E.3.4.9 Home > Network > DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol)

Open the DHCP Relay page from the Network submenu. This page contains the following
options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A DHCP Relay Feature Use the arrow keys to select Disable or Enable
B DHCP Relay IP Address Enter an IP Address in the form XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX

Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Network
submenu.

E52

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.4.10 Home > Network > PTP (Precision Time Protocol)

Open the PTP (Precision Time Protocol) page from the Network submenu. This page contains the
following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A PTP Feature Use the arrow keys to select Disable or Enable
B PTP Grandmaster Use the arrow keys to select LAN or WAN

Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Network
submenu.

E53

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.4.11 Home > Network > SNTP (Simple Network Time Protocol)

Open the Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) page from the Network submenu. This page
contains the following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A SNTP Enable Use the arrow keys to select Disabled or Enabled
B SNTP Primary Server Typical for either entry Enter an IP Address in the form
C SNTP Backup Server XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX
[R/O] SNTP Primary Last Update These read-only entries display the date/timestamp of the last
updates otherwise, if no updates have occurred, entries will
[R/O] SNTP Backup Last Update read Never
D RTC Time Enter a time in the form HH:MM:SS
E RTC Date Enter a date in the form DD:MM:YY

Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Network
submenu.

E54

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.4.12 Home > Network > MAC Table

Open the MAC Table page from the Network submenu. Use this page to review status
information on the recognized MAC Addresses.

Use the arrow keys to scroll through the available indices. You may also press [ENTER] to
select, and then view in a standalone window, a specific Index entry. Otherwise, press [ESC] to
return to the Network submenu.

E55

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.5 Home > WAN Submenu

Open the WAN submenu from the Home menu. This submenu contains the following options:

Hot
Configuration Page Function Sect.
Key
A QoS Configure Quality of Service operation E.3.5.1
B Compression Configure Router Mode compression refresh rates E.3.5.2
Configure Managed Switch Mode Encryption and define
C Encryption E.3.5.3
Encryption Keys 1 through 8

Press a hot key to access a configuration page. See the specified appendix section for further
configuration options. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Home menu.

E.3.5.1 Home > WAN > QoS Submenu

Open the QoS (Quality of Service) submenu from the WAN submenu. This submenu contains the
following options:

Hot
Page / Dialog Window Description / Option Entry
Key
A QoS Max-Pri and Min-Max Table See Sect. E.3.5.1.1
B QoS Differentiated Services Table See Sect. E.3.5.1.2
C QoS SAR Feature Use the arrow keys to select Disable or Enable
D QoS Rules Delete All Use the arrow keys to select No or Yes

Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Network
submenu.

E56

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.5.1.1 Home > WAN > QoS > Max-Pri and Min-Max Table

Open the scrollable QoS Table (Max-Pri and Min-Max Table) from the QoS submenu.

Use the arrow keys to scroll through the available entries. You may also select a header
(e.g., <Index 1>) and press [ENTER] to view, in a standalone window, a specific set of statistics as
shown in this example:

Press [ESC] to return to the QoS submenu.

E57

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.5.1.2 Home > WAN > QoS > QoS Differentiated Services Table

Open the nested QoS Differentiated Services page from the QoS submenu. This page contains
the following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A AF4 Service Rate
D AF3 Service Rate
Typical for each entry Enter a value from 0 to 100000000 Kbps
G AF2 Service Rate
J AF1 Service Rate
B AF4 Medium Drop Precedence Level
E AF3 Medium Drop Precedence Level
Typical for each entry Enter a value from 20 to 90%
H AF2 Medium Drop Precedence Level
K AF1 Medium Drop Precedence Level
C AF4 High Drop Precedence Level
F AF3 High Drop Precedence Level
Typical for each entry Enter a value from 10 to 80%
I AF2 High Drop Precedence Level
L AF1 High Drop Precedence Level

Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the QoS submenu.

E58

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.5.2 Home > WAN > Compression

Open the Compression page from the WAN submenu. This page contains the following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Header Comp RTP Refresh Rate
B Header Comp UTD Refresh Rate Typical for each entry Enter a value from 1 to 600
C Header Comp Default Refresh Rate
D Payload Comp Refresh Rate Enter a value from 1 to 255

Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the WAN submenu.

E59

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.5.3 Home >WAN > Encryption

Open the Encryption page from the WAN submenu. This page contains the following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Allow Unencrypted Rx Use the arrow keys to select Drop or Allow

B Encryption Feature Use the arrow keys to select Disable or Enable

C Encryption Key Select Use the arrow keys to select Key1 through Key8, or Random
D Encryption Key 1
E Encryption Key 2
Typical for each key entry Enter a 32-character encryption code
F Encryption Key 3
G Encryption Key 4

E60

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
H Encryption Key 5
I Encryption Key 6
Typical for each key entry Enter a 32-character encryption code
J Encryption Key 7
K Encryption Key 8
L Decryption Key 1
M Decryption Key 2 Typical for each key entry Enter a 32-character decryption code
N Decryption Key 3

Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the WAN submenu.

E61

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.6 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) Submenus (Summary Only)


1. After configuring the CDM-625 for 70/140 MHz operation, and then enabling
ODU Comms, you may use the Telnet CLI ODU (Outdoor Unit) submenus
and pages to control and monitor a CSAT-5060 Outdoor Unit that is
connected via FSK to the CDM-625.

2. Comtech EF Data KST-2000A/B Transceivers and LPOD Outdoor Amplifiers /


Block Up Converters (BUCs) are not supported by the Telnet CLI at this time.

See Appendix F. CDM-625 ODU (TRANSCEIVER, BUC, LNB) OPERATION for


complete details about using this product-specific menu branch.

E62

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.7 Home > Redundancy Submenu

Open the Redundancy submenu from the Home menu. This submenu additionally displays the
status of the redundant modem setup. The redundant modem operation options are as follows:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Traffic IP Address Enter an IP address in the form XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX
B Traffic IP Network Prefix Enter a value from 8 to 30
C Redundancy 1-for-N Mode Typical for either entry Use the arrow keys to select
D Packet Processor Redundancy Disabled or Enabled

E Force Redundant Switch Use the arrow keys to select No Switch or Force Switch

Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Home
submenu.

E63

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.8 Home > General Information Submenu

Open the General Information submenu from the Home menu. This submenu contains the
following options:

Hot
Information Page Sect.
Key
A Modem Status E.3.8.1
B Modem Information E.3.8.2
C MAC Table E.3.8.3
D Block Upconverter (BUC) E.3.8.4
E Low Noise Block Downconverter (LNB) E.3.8.5

Press a hot key to access a read-only (except where noted) information page. See the specified
appendix section for further information. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Home menu.

E64

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.8.1 Home > General Information > Modem Status

Press [ESC] to return to the General Information submenu.

E65

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.8.2 Home > General Information > Modem Information

Open the Modem Information page from the General Information submenu. This page contains
the following option:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Circuit ID Enter an identifying label for the modem

Press the hot key to open the dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the General
Information submenu.

E66

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.8.3 Home > General Information > MAC Table

Press [ESC] to return to the General Information submenu.

E67

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.8.4 Home > General Information > Block Upconverter (BUC)

Press [ESC] to return to the General Information submenu.

E.3.8.5 Home > General Information > Low Noise Block Downconverter
(LNB)

Press [ESC] to return to the General Information submenu.

E68

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.9 Home > Logs Submenu

Open the Logs submenu from the Home menu. This submenu contains the following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Sect.
Key
A Base Modem E.3.9.1
B Packet Processor E.3.9.2

Press a hot key to access a submenu. See the specified appendix section for further information.
Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Home menu.

E69

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.9.1 Home > Logs > Base Modem

Open the Base Modem page from the Logs submenu. This page contains the following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Stored Event Table See Sect. E.3.9.1.1
B Stored Statistic Table See Sect. E.3.9.1.2
C Clear All Stored Events Typical for either entry Use the arrow keys to select
D Clear All Stored Statistics Cancel or Clear

E Alarm Mask Tx AIS


F Alarm Mask Rx AIS
G Alarm Mask Buffer Slip
H Alarm Mask Rx AGC
I Alarm Mask Eb No Typical for each entry Use the arrow keys to select Active
J Alarm Mask BUC or Masked

K Alarm Mask LNB


L Alarm Mask G703 Loss of Signal
M Alarm Mask Reference
N Alarm Mask Tx Clock
Press a hot key to open a dialog window. See the specified appendix section for further
information. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Home menu.

E70

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.9.1.1 Home > Logs > Base Modem > Stored Event Table

Open the scrollable Stored Event Table from the Base Modem page. Use the arrow keys to
scroll through the available entries. A date, time, and description is provided for each event.
Events are numbered in the order logged, from the time the event logging buffer was last
cleared.

Press [ESC] to return to the Base Modem page. Or, you may press [ENTER] to select, and then
view in a standalone window, a specific stored event as shown in this example:

E71

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.9.1.2 Home > Logs > Base Modem > Stored Statistic Table

Open the scrollable Stored Statistic Table from the Base Modem page. Use the arrow keys
to scroll through the available entries. A date, time, and description is provided for each
statistic. Statistics are numbered in the order logged, from the time the statistics logging buffer
was last cleared.

Press [ESC] to return to the Base Modem page. Or, you may press [ENTER] to select and view in
a standalone window, a specific stored statistic as shown in this example:

E72

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.9.2 Home > Logs > Packet Processor

Open the Packet Processor page from the Logs submenu. This page contains the following
options:

Hot
Page / Dialog Window Description / Option Entry
Key
A Stored Event Table See Sect. E.3.9.2.1
B Logging Use the arrow keys to select Enable or Disable
Use the arrow keys to select Errors Only, Errors And
C Logging Level
Warnings, or All Information
D Clear Event Log Use the arrow keys to select Cancel or Clear

Press a hot key to open a dialog window. See the specified appendix section for further
information. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Logs submenu.

E73

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.9.2.1 Home > Logs > Packet Processor > Stored Event Table

Open the scrollable Stored Event Table from the Packet Processor page. Use the arrow keys
to scroll through the available entries. You may also select a header (e.g., <Event 1>) and press
[ENTER] to select, and then view in a standalone window, a specific stored event as shown in
this example:

A date, time, and description is provided for each event. Events are numbered in the order
logged, from the time the event logging buffer was last cleared.

Press [ESC] to return to the Base Modem page.

E74

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.10 Home > Statistics Submenu


The Telnet CLI Statistics submenu provides access to a number of read-only informational pages.
Most page submenus provide a dialog window that affords you the option to reset (clear) the
counters for that specific page.

Open the Statistics submenu from the Home menu:

Hot
Page Description Sect.
Key
Access pages to review Ethernet Ports 1 through 4 Rx, Tx,
A Ethernet E.3.10.1
and Error Statistics
B Router Review received, routed, transmitted, and errored packets E.3.10.2
Review Managed Switch LAN/WAN/Management received,
C Managed Switch E.3.10.3
transmitted, and errored packets statistics
Review Router Mode WAN/Interface/Satellite received,
D WAN (Router Mode) E.3.10.4
transmitted, and errored packets and counters statistics
Review Managed Switch Mode WAN/Interface/Satellite
E WAN (Managed Switch Mode) received, transmitted, and errored packets and counters E.3.10.5
statistics
F Compression Review payload and header compression statistics E.3.10.6
G QoS Review Quality of Service statistics E.3.10.7
H PTP Access pages to review LAN/WAN/PTP Engine statistics E.3.10.8
I CPU Review CPU total, kernel and apps usage statistics E.3.10.9
J Reset Counters Clear and reset all counters E.3.10.10

Press a hot key to access a nested statistics page submenu. See the specified appendix section
for further information. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Home menu.

E75

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.10.1 Home > Statistics > Ethernet Submenu

Open the nested Ethernet submenu from the Statistics submenu:

Hot
Page / Dialog Window Description / Option Entry
Key
A Rx Statistics See Sect. E.3.10.1.1
B Tx Statistics See Sect. E.3.10.1.2
C Error Statistics See Sect. E.3.10.1.2
D Clear IP Statistics Use the arrow keys to select Cancel or Clear

Press a hot key to open a statistics page or dialog window. See the specified appendix section
for further information. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the nested Ethernet submenu.

E76

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.10.1.1 Home > Statistics > Ethernet > Rx

Open the scrollable Rx statistics page from the nested Ethernet submenu. Use the arrow
keys to scroll through the available entries. You may also select a header (e.g., <Port 1>) and
press [ENTER] to view, in a standalone window, a specific set of statistics as shown in this
example:

Press [ESC] to return to the nested Ethernet submenu.

E77

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.10.1.2 Home > Statistics > Ethernet > Tx

Open the scrollable Tx statistics page from the nested Ethernet submenu. Use the arrow
keys to scroll through the available entries. You may also select a header (e.g., <Port 1>) and
press [ENTER] to view, in a standalone window, a specific set of statistics as shown in this
example:

Press [ESC] to return to the nested Ethernet submenu.

E78

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.10.1.3 Home > Statistics > Ethernet > Errors

Open the scrollable Error statistics page from the nested Ethernet submenu. Use the arrow
keys to scroll through the available entries. You may also select a header (e.g., <Port 1>) and
press [ENTER] to view, in a standalone window, a specific set of statistics as shown in this
example:

Press [ESC] to return to the nested Ethernet submenu.

E79

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.10.2 Home > Statistics > Router

Open the Router statistics page from the Statistics submenu:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Router Clear Stats Use the arrow keys to select Cancel or Clear

Press the hot key to open the dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Statistics
submenu.

E80

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.10.3 Home > Statistics > Managed Switch

Open the Managed Switch statistics page from the Statistics submenu:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Router Clear Stats Use the arrow keys to select Cancel or Clear

Press the hot key to open the dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Statistics
submenu.

E81

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.10.4 Home > Statistics > WAN (Router Mode)

Open the scrollable WAN (Router Mode) statistics page from the Statistics submenu. Otherwise,
press [ESC] to return to the Statistics submenu.

E82

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.10.5 Home > Statistics > WAN (Managed Switch Mode)

Open the scrollable WAN (Managed Switch Mode) statistics page from the Statistics submenu:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Clear Stats Use the arrow keys to select Cancel or Clear

Press the hot key to open the dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Statistics
submenu.

E83

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.10.6 Home > Statistics > Compression

Open the Compression statistics page from the Statistics submenu:

Hot
Page / Dialog Window Option Entry / Description
Key
A Compression Clear Counters Use the arrow keys to select Cancel or Clear
B View Statistics Table See Sect. E.3.10.6.1

Press a hot key to open the dialog window or view the statistics table. Otherwise, press [ESC] to
return to the Statistics submenu.

E84

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.10.6.1 Home > Statistics > Compression > Table View

Open the scrollable Compression statistics table from the nested Compression submenu.

Use the arrow keys to scroll through the available entries. You may also select a header
(e.g., <Route Index 1>) and press [ENTER] to view, in a standalone window, a specific set of
statistics as shown in this example:

Press [ESC] to return to the Compression page.

E85

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.10.7 Home > Statistics > QoS

Open the QoS statistics page from the Statistics submenu:

Hot
Page / Dialog Window Option Entry / Description
Key
A QoS Clear Counters Use the arrow keys to select Cancel or Clear
B View Statistics Table See Sect. E.3.10.7.1

Press a hot key to open the dialog window or view the table. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to
the Statistics submenu.

E.3.10.7.1 Home > Statistics > QoS > Table View

Open the scrollable QoS statistics table from the nested QoS submenu.

Use the arrow keys to scroll through the available entries. You may also select a header
(e.g., <QoS Index 1>) and press [ENTER] to view, in a standalone window, a specific set of
statistics as shown in this example:

Press [ESC] to return to the Compression page.

E86

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.10.8 Home > Statistics > PTP

Open the PTP statistics page from the Statistics submenu:

Hot
Page Description
Key
A LAN Details See Sect. E.3.10.8.1
B WAN Details See Sect. E.3.10.8.2

Press a hot key to view a statistics page. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Statistics
submenu.

E87

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.10.8.1 Home > Statistics > PTP > LAN Details

Open the LAN Details statistics page from the PTP page. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the
PTP page.

E.3.10.8.2 Home > Statistics > PTP > WAN Details

Open the WAN Details statistics page from the PTP page. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the
PTP page.

E88

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.10.9 Home > Statistics > CPU

Open the CPU statistics page from the Statistics submenu. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to
the Statistics submenu.

E.3.10.10 Home > Statistics > Clear All Counters

Open the Clear All Counters page from the Statistics submenu:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Clear All Counters Use the arrow keys to select Cancel or Clear

Press the hot key to open the dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Statistics
submenu.

E89

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix E MN-CDM625

E.3.11 Home > Contact Page

Open the read-only Contact information page from the Home menu. Use this page to retrieve
Comtech EF Data contact information. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the Home menu.

E90

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


Appendix F. CDM-625 ODU
(TRANSCEIVER, BUC, LNB)
OPERATION

F.1 Introduction
The CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem permits configuration, monitoring, and control of
Comtech EF Data ODUs (Outdoor Units) either in standalone or 1:1 redundant configuration.

The following ODUs are compatible under 70/140 MHz operation:

CSAT-5060 series (5 to 25, 50 & 100 Watts) C-Band Transceivers

KST-2000A (LNA) Ku-Band Satellite Transceiver

KST-2000B (LNB) Ku-Band Satellite Transceiver

Under L-Band operation, ODU refers to use of a Comtech EF Data LPOD Outdoor Amplifier /
Block Up Converter (BUC), or an LNB (Low-Noise Block Down Converter).

For either 70/140 MHz or L-Band operation, you can fully monitor and control ODU operations
in the following ways:

By using the CDM-625 front panel keypad and VFD. The Front Panel ODU menu branch
allows you to configure power supplies, a 10 MHz reference, and low/high current alarm
thresholds for the BUC and LNB.

LO (Local Oscillator) menus allow you to set up the upconversion and downconversion
settings for the BUC and LNB so that you can view the satellite frequencies as well as the
modem IF input/output frequencies.

By using ODU remote commands through Serial-based Remote Product Management


with the CSAT-5060 or KST-2000A/B Transceiver, or the LPOD.

By using the SNMP Interface with the CSAT-5060 or KST-2000A/B Transceiver MIB.

F1

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

By using the CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface (excluding the LPOD).

By using the CDM-625 Telnet Command Line Interface for CSAT-5060 Transceiver
operation (excluding the KST-2000A/B Transceiver or the LPOD).

F.2 ODU Remote Control Address Setup


The ODU, as connected to a CDM-625 through FSK (Frequency Shift Keying), can be remotely
monitored and controlled through the use of ODU commands and queries issued via serial
remote control or with the Telnet Command Line Interface (CLI).

The address of the ODU is set up as follows:

For Local-End ODUs:

o Use the Modems RC Address + 1 for a Standalone Unit or the Online Unit in a 1:1
Redundancy System;

o Use the Modems RC Address + 2 for the Offline Unit in a 1:1 Redundancy System.

For Distant-End ODUs in an EDMAC setup:

Chapter 11. EDMAC CHANNEL


Appendix D. REMOTE CONTROL

o Use the EDMAC Slave Address (ESA) Range +4 for Standalone Unit or the Online Unit
in a 1:1 Redundancy System;

o Use the EDMAC Slave Address (ESA) Range +5 for the Offline Unit in a 1:1
Redundancy System.

F2

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.3 ODU Operations via the CDM-625 Front Panel


1. The ODU menu branch is accessible from the CDM-625 front panel menu only
when the CDM-625 detects the presence of an installed ODU.

2. This appendix deals strictly with ODU operations. Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL
OPERATION provides detailed information for any CDM-625 menu operations
or selections not otherwise specified here.

F.3.1 CDM-625 Front Panel Operation Overview

See Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION for an in-depth explanation o f th e


function and operation of the CDM-625 front panel.

See
Feature Description Function Chapter
Section...
1 LED Indicators The LEDs indicate, in a summary fashion, the status of the modem. 5.1.1
The k eypad c omprises s ix i ndividual k eyswitches. T he k eys ha ve a
2 Keypad positive click action that provides tactile feedback. Enter data via the 5.1.2
keypad. Data, prompts, and messages are displayed on the VFD.
The V FD is an ac tive di splay s howing t wo l ines of 40 c haracters
Vacuum
each. I t pr oduces a bl ue l ight with adj ustable br ightness. N ested
3 Fluorescent 5.1.3
menus display al l av ailable opt ions and pr ompt you to c arry ou t a
Display (VFD)
required action.

Figure F-1. CDM-625 Front Panel Features


Use the CDM-625 front panel keypad and Vacuum Fluorescent Display (Figure F-1) to configure,
monitor, and control ODU operation. Nested menus display all available options and prompt you
to carry out any required action(s) (Figure F-2).

F3

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.3.2 CDM-625 Front Panel Menus ODU Menu Hierarchy


Figure F-2 identifies the CDM-625 front panel menu hierarchies allocated to the configuration,
monitor, and control of a Comtech EF Data ODU. More specifically, menu branches that
incorporate ODU operations are shown in bold; menu content that is dedicated to ODU
operations is additionally italicized.

Figure F-2.CDM-625 Front Panel ODU Operation Menu Tree (FW Ver. 2.3.1)

F4

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.3.3 SELECT: (Main) Menu Overview

SELECT: Configuration Test Monitor


Info Store/Ld Utility ODU FAST ()

Press ENTER or CLEAR to immediately access the SELECT: menu screen from the opening screen.
From any nested menu, press CLEAR repeatedly until this screen reappears.

The table that follows identifies each menu branch available from the SELECT: menu and its
content section in Chapter 5. FRONT PANEL OPERATION. ODU M&C is available for selection as
noted:
Menu Branch Chapter 5 Sect. Function

Configuration 5.2.1 Use to fully configure the modem and the ODU alarm masks.

The Tx, Rx, and Mask submenus incorporate ODU functionality. For
detailed information see the following sections in this appendix:

F.3.3.1.1 CONFIG: Tx Freq and CONFIG: Rx Freq


F.3.3.1.2.1 CONFIG: Mask BUC
F.3.3.1.2.2 CONFIG: MaskLNB

Test 5.2.2 Use to configure the modem into one of several Test modes, and
configures/monitors the BER Tester.

Monitor 5.2.3 Use to monitor the current status of the modem and ODUs and view
the log of stored events for the modem.

For detailed information, see to Sect. F.3.3.2 (SELECT: MONITOR)


Live-Alarm Menus in this appendix.

Info 5.2.4 (Information) Use to view information on the modem without having to
access the Configuration screens.

Store/Ld 5.2.5 (Store/Load) Use to store and retrieve up to 10 different modem


configurations.

Utility 5.2.6 Use to perform miscellaneous functions e.g., setting the Real-Time Clock,
adjusting the VFD brightness, etc.

ODU 5.2.7 (Summary) (Outdoor Unit) For detailed information, see Sect. F.3.3.3 (SELECT:
ODU) Menu Branches in this appendix.

FAST 5.2.8 (Fully Accessible System Topology) Use to configure available options
e.g., extended data rates, interfaces, etc. Contact a Comtech EF Data sales
representative for details.

From the top SELECT: menu, use the arrow keys to select Configuration or ODU, and then
press ENTER.

F5

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.3.3.1 (SELECT: CONFIGURATION) Menu Branches

CONFIG: All Mode Tx Rx Clocks D&I/ACM


CnC EDMAC Misc Mask Remote IP ()

Use the arrow keys to select Tx, Rx, or Mask, and then press ENTER.

F.3.3.1.1 CONFIG: Tx Freq and CONFIG: Rx Freq Submenus

Tx-IF Frequency: 1750.0000 MHz


(LO:12500 MHz Sat:14250.0000 MHz) ()

Rx-IF Frequency: 1200.0000 MHz


(LO:12500 MHz Sat:13700.0000 MHz) ()

When you use the ODU menus to configure a BUC or LNB LO-frequency, the CONFIG: TxFreq
and CONFIG: RxFreq menu screens provide supplemental information on the bottom line. As
you edit the IF frequency, the Satellite frequency updates accordingly.

Satellite frequency = LO IF frequency, where the sign is determined


by the LO mix setting:

High-sided mix [] (includes a spectral inversion);

Low-sided mix [+].

To edit the Tx-IF or Rx Frequency, use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit, and then use
the arrow keys to change that digit. The available ranges are 50-180 MHz, and 950-2000
MHz (L-Band) (FAST option). The resolution is 100Hz. Press ENTER when done.

F.3.3.1.2 (SELECT: CONFIGURATION) Mask Submenus


The Mask submenus allow you to selectively mask (ignore) or make active various alarms and
traffic conditions that are monitored by the modem.

Alarm Masks: AIS Buffer Ref RxIF TxClk


TxSat RxSat Terr ROp BUC LNB CEX ()

Use the arrow keys to select BUC or LNB, and then press ENTER.

F6

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.3.3.1.2.1 CONFIG: Mask BUC

BUC alarm = Active (Active,Mask)


Attach to Tx alarm = No (Yes,No)()

When using L-Band, a Block Up Converter (BUC) may be included in the system. A smart BUC
may be monitored and/or controlled via the modem via FSK (Frequency-Shift Keying control).

For a modem in a 1:1 redundancy setup, the fault indications must be customized for
the physical setup:

1. Two modems, two LNBs in parallel If a fault occurs on the active


modem/BUC pair and switchover is desired, the BUC mask should be configured
as Attach to Tx alarm = Yes.

2. The more common redundancy setup is Two modems in parallel, one BUC If a
fault occurs on the active modem, switchover is desired. But, if a fault occurs on
the BUC yet a switchover of modems does not fix the problem, then switchover
should not occur and the BUC mask should be configured as Attach to Tx alarm
= No.

If the system has no redundancy and was attached to an external audio alarm,
Attach to Tx alarm = Yes would indicate that a BUC fault has occurred, as the
fault would be included in the FORM C alarms.

First, use the arrow keys to select BUC Alarm or Attach to Tx alarm. Then:

For BUC Alarm, use the arrow keys to select Active or Masked.

For Attach to Tx alarm, use the arrow keys to select Yes or No.

Press ENTER when done.

F7

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.3.3.1.2.2 CONFIG: Mask LNB

LNB alarm = Active (Active,Mask)


Attach to Rx alarm = No (Yes,No)()

When using L-Band, a Low-Noise Block Down Converter (LNB) may be included in the system. It
cannot be monitored and/or controlled by the modem, except for the power supply values.

For a modem in a 1:1 redundancy setup, the fault indications must be customized for
the physical setup:

1. Two modems, two LNBs in parallel If a fault occurs on the active modem/LNB
pair and switchover is desired, the LNB mask should be configured as Attach to
Rx alarm = Yes.

2. The more common redundancy setup is Two modems in parallel, one LNB If a
fault occurs on the active modem, switchover is desired. But, if a fault occurs on
the LNB, a switchover of modems might or might not fix the problem. If
switchover should take place, the LNB mask should configured as Attach to Rx
alarm = Yes.

If the system has no redundancy and was attached to an external audio alarm,
Attach to Rx alarm = Yes would indicate that a LNB fault has occurred, as the
fault would be included in the FORM C alarms.

First, use the arrow keys to select LNB Alarm or Attach to Rx alarm. Then:

For LNB Alarm, use the arrow keys to select Active or Masked.

For Attach to Rx alarm, use the arrow keys to select Yes or No.

Press ENTER when done.

F8

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.3.3.2 (SELECT: MONITOR) Live-Alarms Menu

Live Unit=None Net=None


Alarms Rx=Demod Lock Tx=No Clock ()

Live BUC=None
Alarms LNB=None ()

Six alarm types are provided across two screens. The last two alarm types (on the second
screen) pertain to ODU operation as shown in the preceding examples.

Use the arrow keys to navigate between these read-only pages. The highest priority alarms
currently active for each of the ODU alarm types are as follows:

ALARM TYPE
BUC BUC current

BUC voltage

BUC checksum or bad comms

BUC PLL

BUC temperature
LNB LNB current

LNB voltage

F9

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.3.3.3 (SELECT:) ODU Menu Branches

ODU: BUC:PwrSupply+Ref
LNB:PwrSupply+Ref FSK-control ()

Use the arrow keys to select BUC:PwrSupply+Ref, LNB:PwrSupply+Ref, or FSK-control, and


then press ENTER:
ODU Menu Branch Sect. Nested Menu Function

BUC:PwrSupply+Ref F.3.3.3.1 Provides menus to enter a T x LO frequency, and t o control a 10 MHz


reference and for Power supply control and alarm limits.
LNB:PwrSupply+Ref F.3.3.3.2 Provides menus to enter an Rx LO frequency, and to control a 10MHz
reference and for Power supply control and alarm limits.
FSK-control F.3.3.3.3 (Frequency S hift K eying c ontrol) P rovides m enus t o m onitor and
control CSAT-5060 O R KST-2000A/B or B UC settings, and LPOD
settings v ia Advanced F SK. T he appear ance of , and t he f unctional
selections av ailable f rom t his ne sted m enu ar e dependent on t he T x
frequency employed 70/140 versus L-Band.

F.3.3.3.1 ODU: BUC:PwrSupply+Ref (Power Supply and Reference)

BUC control/monitor (non-FSK):


PSU-and-10MHz LO-freq PSUmonitor ()

The modem provides DC power and a 10MHz reference that may be used by a BUC. Use the
arrow keys to select PSU-and-10MHz, LO-Freq, or PSUmonitor, and then press ENTER.

F.3.3.3.1.1 ODU: BUC:PwrSupply+Ref PSU-and-10MHz Parameters

BUC supply=N/I 10MHz-ref:Off (Off,On)


Alarm limits, from 0.0 to 2.0 amps ()

Use the arrow keys to select BUC Supply, 10MHz-ref, or Alarm Limits, and then use the
arrow keys to select a setting:

Selection Setting

BUC supply Indicates installation state, e.g., N/I =- Not Installed.

Set the 10MHz Reference as Off or On.


10MHz-ref
A BUC will not transmit without a 10MHz reference.

Use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit, and then use the arrow keys to
Alarm Limits
change that digit. Valid range, in Amps, is 0.0 to 4.0.
Press ENTER when done.

F10

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.3.3.3.1.2 ODU: BUC:PwrSupply+Ref LO Freq (Local Oscillator


Frequency)

BUC-LO Frequency= 00000 MHz


Mix= High [-] (Hi,Lo) ()

Use the arrow keys to select BUC-LO (Local Oscillator) Frequency for the upconversion, or
Mix to set the polarity for the upconversion mix in the BUC.

On the top line To set the BUC-LO Frequency, use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit,
and then use the arrow keys to change that digit. The valid LO range is 3000 to 65000 MHz.
Entering a non-zero value for BUC LO causes the Tx-IF frequency menu to show LO and Satellite
frequencies (satellite frequency = LO frequency modem frequency).

Press ENTER when done.

On the bottom line To set the Mix polarity, use the arrow keys to set polarity as Hi (to
indicate a high side, inverting mix) or Lo (to indicate a low side, non-inverting mix).

Press ENTER when done.

F.3.3.3.1.3 ODU: BUC:PwrSupply+Ref PSUmonitor

BUC Power Supply:


0000mA, 00.0V

Use this read-only display to view the power supply current and voltage information. Press
ENTER or CLEAR to return to the previous menu.

F11

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.3.3.3.2 ODU: LNB:PwrSupply+Ref (Power Supply and Reference)

LNB control/monitor:
PSU-and-10MHz LO-freq PSUmonitor ()

The modem can supply DC power to an LNB connected to the Type N rear panel Rx connector.
It can also supply a 10 MHz reference for a phase-locked LNB. Use the arrow keys to select
PSU-and-10MHz, LO-freq, or PSUmonitor, and then press ENTER.

F.3.3.3.2.1 ODU: LNB:PwrSupply+Ref PSU-and-10MHz

LNB: Voltage=Off 10MHz:Off (Off,On)


Alarm limits, from 000 to 500 mA ()

Use the arrow keys to select Voltage, 10MHz, or Alarm Limits. Then, use the arrow
keys to edit that setting:
Selection Setting

Voltage Select Off, 13V, 18V, or 24V

10MHz Set the 10MHz Reference as Off or On.


Use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit, and then use the arrow keys to
Alarm Limits
change that digit. Valid range, in mA, is 000 to 500.
Press ENTER when done.

F.3.3.3.2.2 ODU: LNB:PwrSupply+Ref LO-Freq (Local Oscillator


Frequency)

LNB-LO: Frequency= 00000 MHz


Mix= High [-] (Hi,Lo) ()

Use the arrow keys to select the LNB-LO (Local Oscillator) Frequency for the
downconversion, or Mix to set the polarity for the downconversion mix in the LNB.

On the top line To set the LNB-LO Frequency, use the arrow keys to select a digit to edit,
and then use the arrow keys to change that digit. The valid LO range is 3000 to 65000 MHz.
Entering a non-zero value for LNB LO causes the Rx-IF frequency menu to show LO and Satellite
frequencies (satellite frequency = LO frequency modem frequency).

Press ENTER when done.

On the bottom line To set the Mix polarity, use the arrow keys to set polarity as Hi (to
indicate a high side, inverting mix) or Lo (to indicate a low side, non-inverting mix).

Press ENTER when done.

F12

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.3.3.3.2.3 ODU: LNB:PwrSupply+Ref PSUmonitor

LNB Power Supply [Off]:


0000mA, 00.0V

This read-only display shows the LNB power supply information. Press ENTER or CLEAR to return
to the previous menu.

F.3.3.3.3 ODU: FSK-control


Comtech EF Data ODUs (CSAT, KST, or LPOD), when connected to a CDM-625 through Frequency
Shift Keying (FSK), can be remotely monitored and controlled by using the CDM-625 front panel,
Web Server interface, or by using remote commands and queries through Serial or Telnet
Remote Product Management. In order to facilitate remote M&C, the ODU address is set up as
follows:

For Local-End ODUs:

o Use the Modems RC Address + 1 for a Standalone Unit or the Online Unit in a 1:1
Redundancy System;

o Use the Modems RC Address + 2 for the Offline Unit in a 1:1 Redundancy System.

For Distant-End ODUs in an EDMAC setup:

Chapter 11. EDMAC CHANNEL


Appendix D. REMOTE CONTROL

o Use the EDMAC Slave Address (ESA) Range +4 for Standalone Unit or the Online Unit
in a 1:1 Redundancy System;

o Use the EDMAC Slave Address (ESA) Range +5 for the Offline Unit in a 1:1
Redundancy System.

The appearance of the ODU: FSK-control screen adjusts automatically to the mode of operation:
70/140 MHz or L-Band.

When the Tx frequency is 70/140 MHz Communication with a Comtech EF Data CSAT or KST
transceiver is achieved using a low-speed, half-duplex FSK link over the Rx IF port, with a carrier
frequency around 2.7 MHz.

With FSK communication disabled, the ODU: FSK-control screen appears as shown here:

ODU Control: FSK=Off (Off,On)


ODU Type: C/KST (C/KST, 2CSATS) ()

F13

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

To enable FSK, on the top line use the arrow keys to select FSK, and then use the
arrow keys to set control as On.

Press ENTER when done.

Once FSK is enabled, the modem attempts to communicate with the installed transceiver(s).
Once communications are established, the bottom line of the ODU: FSK-control screen updates
to show the attached and therefore controllable via FSK transceiver(s), as per the following
examples:

ODU Control: FSK=Off (Off,On)


ODU Type: CSAT (C/KST, 2CSATS) ()

ODU Control: FSK=Off (Off,On)


ODU Type: KST (C/KST, 2CSATS) ()

At this time, use the arrow keys to navigate to the bottom line, and then use the
arrow keys to select (where appropriate), CSAT, 2CSATs, or KST.

Press ENTER when done.

Sect. F.3.3.3.3.1 ODU: FSK-control CSAT


Sect. F.3.3.3.3.2 ODU: FSK-control 2CSATs (Redundant configuration)
Sect. F.3.3.3.3.3 ODU: FSK-control KST

When the Tx frequency is L-Band Communication with a smart BUC is achieved using a low-
speed, half-duplex FSK link over the Tx IF port, with a carrier frequency around 650 kHz.

With FSK communication disabled, the ODU: FSK-control screen appears as shown here:

ODU Control: FSK=Off (Off,On)


ODU Type: None (due to Tx freq) ()

Use the arrow keys to select FSK control, and then use the arrow keys to set control as
On, and then press ENTER. Once FSK is On, the ODU type is fixed as BUC and the screen
appears as shown here:

ODU Control: FSK=On (Off,On)


ODU Type: BUC (due to Tx freq) ()

Sect. F.3.3.3.3.4 ODU: FSK-control BUC

F14

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.3.3.3.3.1 ODU: FSK-control CSAT

The CSAT menus that follow assume that you have already selected, and the
system has identified, a (standalone) CSAT connected via the rear panel Rx IF port.

When the following menu selections are made:

ODU: FSK-control CSAT


ODU: FSK-control 2CSATs CSAT#1
ODU: FSK-control 2CSATs CSAT#2
You are directed to a common submenu branch:

CSAT-5060/050 V1.02
Configuration Monitor Alarms Info()

For clarity, this common submenu branch and its nested menus are defined in this
section. (CSAT#X denotes CSAT#1 or CSAT#2.)

Use the arrow keys to select Configuration, Monitor, Alarms, or Info, and then press
ENTER.

F.3.3.3.3.1.1 ODU: FSK-control CSAT (2CSATs CSAT #X)


Configuration

Configuration settings:
Tx Rx LNA Misc ()

Use the arrow keys to select Tx, Rx, LNA, or Misc, and then press ENTER.

F.3.3.3.3.1.1.1 ODU: FSK-control CSAT (2CSATs CSAT #X)


Configuration Tx

Tx: Fq=6247.0 MHz Att=23.00 dB Amp=On


Mute=Unmuted Slope: xxx, Cal ()

Use the arrow keys to select the setting to edit, and then use the arrow keys to edit
that setting:
Selection Setting

Fq (Tx Frequency) 3625-4200 MHz, in steps of 1.0 or 2.5 MHz

At (Tx Attenuation ) 0 to 25 dB, in increments of .25dB

Amp (Amplifier setting ) Off or On

F15

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

Selection Setting

Mute (Mute setting) Muted (i.e., Tx off) or Unmuted (i.e., Tx on)

Slope Manual (0.0 to 1.0, in increments of 0.1) or Calibrated

Press ENTER to save, or CLEAR to cancel and return to the previous menu.

F.3.3.3.3.1.1.2 ODU: FSK-control CSAT (2CSATs CSAT #X)


Configuration Rx

Rx: Fq=6427.0 MHz Att=23.00 dB


Mute=Unmuted Slope:x.x, Cal()

Use the arrow keys to select the setting to edit, and then use the arrow keys to edit
that setting:
Selection Setting

Fq (Rx Frequency) 3625-4200 MHz, in steps of 1.0 or 2.5 MHz.

Att (Rx Attenuation) 0 to 25 dB, in increments of .25dB.

Mute (Mute setting) Muted (i.e., Tx off) or Unmuted (i.e., Tx on).

Slope Manual (0.0 to 1.0, in increments of 0.1) or Calibrated.

Press ENTER when done.

F.3.3.3.3.1.1.3 ODU: FSK-control CSAT (2CSATs CSAT #X)


Configuration LNA

LNA: State=On Calibrate-LNA-Current=N


Current-Window=50% Fault-Logic=Summary

Use the arrow keys to select the setting to edit, and then use the arrow keys to edit
that setting:
Selection Setting

(LNA State) Off or On. This controls whether or not the CSAT provides LNA
State
Power via the Receive RF Cable.
Select YES and press ENTER to calibrate the LNA current for use with the
Calibrate-LNA-Current
Current-Window function. (Default is NO.)
A value from 20% to 50% defines the allowable LNA Current change before
Current-Window:
declaring a fault. Select 99% to disable the Current Window function.

F16

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

Selection Setting

Summary or No-Summary. This controls whether or not an LNA Current-


Window fault activates the Summary Fault Relay, and further permits you to
Fault-Logic:
select whether or not to switch the Online/Offline CSAT in the event of an LNA
Current-Window fault.

Press ENTER when done.

F.3.3.3.3.1.1.4 ODU: FSK-control CSAT (2CSATs CSAT #X)


Configuration Misc

Misc: Cold-Start=Disabled AFR=Enable


Xref=No Ref-Adj=087 Sync-Clk=Y ()

Use the arrow keys to select the setting to edit, and then use the arrow keys to edit
that setting:
Selection Setting

Cold-Start If enabled, when the CSAT is powered on, the IF and RF outputs remain muted for 15
minutes.
AFR (Auto Fault Recovery) This defines how a CSAT reacts to momentary fault conditions:
Off: CSAT mutes when faulted and remain muted.
On: CSAT mutes when faulted, but unmute after the fault goes away.
Xref (External R eference) The C SAT aut omatically locks t o an e xternal 5 or 10 MHz
reference independent of the state of this selection. This selection determines whether
or not the Summary Fault Relay ac tivates i f t he CSAT loses lock w ith the ex ternal
reference.
Ref-Adj Select a value for the Internal 10MHz Reference setting from 000 to 255.
NOTE: The Internal Reference is set in the factory to be very accurate with the default
setting of 087. This setting is provided to compensate for the long-term frequency drift
of the oscillator.
Sync-Clk (Default is NO.) Selecting YES and pr essing ENTER causes t he C SAT RTC ( Real-
Time Clock) to be synchronized to the Modem RTC.

Press ENTER when done.

F17

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.3.3.3.3.1.2 ODU: FSK-control CSAT (2CSATs CSAT #X) Monitor

Monitor:
Tx Rx Misc Power-Supplies ()

To view these read-only displays, use the arrow keys to select Tx, Rx, Misc, or Power-
Supplies, and then press ENTER.

Press ENTER or CLEAR after viewing any Monitor screen to return to the previous menu.

ODU: FSK-control CSAT (2CSATs CSAT #X) Monitor Tx

Tx: SynTune = 09.6 VDC Power = <24 dBm


IFLO = 11.1 VDC Temp = 26 C

ODU: FSK-control CSAT (2CSATs CSAT #X) Monitor Rx

Rx: SynTuneE = 01.4 VDC


IFLO = 11.2 VDC Temp = 26 C

ODU: FSK-control CSAT (2CSATs CSAT #X) Monitor Misc

Misc: Ref-Tune = 03.0 VDC


LNA = 00.05 mA Fan = 550 mA

ODU: FSK-control CSAT (2CSATs CSAT #X) Monitor Power-


Supplies

24V=24.1 VDC 12V=12.5VDC +5V=+5.4VDC


20V=21.2 VDC 10V=10.2VDC -5V=-5.3VDC

F.3.3.3.3.1.3 ODU: FSK-control CSAT (2CSATs CSAT #X) Alarms

Alarms:
Current-Alarms Stored-Alarms ()

Use the arrow keys to select Current-Alarms or Stored-Alarms, and then press ENTER.

F.3.3.3.3.1.3.1 ODU: FSK-control CSAT (2CSATs CSAT #X) Alarms


Current-Alarms

Current Status: Tx = OK Rx = OK
Power-Supply = OK Misc = OK

F18

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

This screen is read-only. Press ENTER or CLEAR to return to the previous menu.

F.3.3.3.3.1.3.2 ODU: FSK-control CSAT (2CSATs CSAT #X) Alarms


Stored-Alarms
As stored events are compiled, the screen shows:

Reading Stored Faults..... Please Wait

Once the events are compiled, the Stored Alarms screen appears as shown here:

Stored Alarms: Clear-All: No (No,Yes)


IF #84: 10/14/04 12:52:08 Power On

Use the arrow keys to select between the log entries and the Clear-All option.

To view a log entry: With the cursor on the entry number, use the arrow keys to view
through the entries. Up to 99 entries are stored. Each entry provides the following information:

Item Comments

Entry type IF = Information


FT = Fault
OK = Fault cleared
Entry number 00 through 99

Date European Day-Month-Year (DD-MM-YY) format

Time Hour:Minute:Second (HH:MM:SS) format

Description of information / fault Example: Power On

To clear the Stored Alarms Log, use the arrow keys to select Clear-All, and then use the
arrow keys to select Yes. Press ENTER to clear the log.

F.3.3.3.3.1.4 ODU: FSK-control CSAT (2CSATs CSAT #X) Info

Info:
Model Tx Rx Misc LNA ()

These read-only screens provide the ODUs current configuration information without risking
inadvertent changes.

Use the arrow keys to select Model, Tx, Rx, Misc, or LNA, and then press ENTER.

F19

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

After viewing any CSAT/CSAT#X Info screen, press ENTER or CLEAR to return to the previous
menu.

ODU: FSK-control CSAT (2CSATs CSAT #X) Info Model

Model: CSAT-5060/025 V2.19


S/N: 010300346

Use this screen to view the CSAT model number, its operating firmware, and the unit serial
number.

ODU: FSK-control CSAT (2CSATs CSAT #X) Info Tx

Info: Tx:Off 6427.0MHz 23.00dB


Amp:Off Unmuted Slope:0.3

Use this screen to view the Tx state, Frequency, Tx Attenuation, Amplifier state, Tx Mute state
and Tx Slope adjustment (value or CAL).

ODU: FSK-control CSAT (2CSATs CSAT #X) Info Rx

Info: Rx:ON 3400.0MHz 18.00dB


Ref:087 Unmuted Slope:0.2

Use this screen to view the Rx state, Rx Frequency, Rx Attenuation, Rx Reference, Rx Mute state
and Rx Slope adjustment (value or CAL).

ODU: FSK-control CSAT (2CSATs CSAT #X) Info Misc

Info: Cold-Start:Off
Auto-Fault-Recovery:Summary (EC)

Use this screen to view the Cold Start and Auto Fault Recovery settings.

ODU: FSK-control CSAT (2CSATs CSAT #X) Info LNA

Info: LNA:Off Fault-Logic:Summary


Window:48% (EC)

Use this screen to view the Low Noise Amplifier operational settings.

F20

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.3.3.3.3.2 ODU: FSK-control 2CSATs

The menus that follow assume that you have selected and the system has identified
two CSATs connected via the Rx IF port and the ODU Redundancy Controller Box.

1:1 Monitor & Control


CSAT#1 CSAT#2 Redundancy-Box ()

Use the arrow keys to select CSAT#1, CSAT#2, or Redundancy-Box, and then press ENTER.

F.3.3.3.3.2.1 ODU: FSK-control 2CSATs CSAT#X


This submenu and its nested menus are identical in form and function for the
following menu structures:

ODU: FSK-control CSAT


ODU: FSK-control 2CSATs CSAT#X (where CSAT#X = CSAT#1, CSAT#2)

CSAT-5060/050 V1.02
Configuration Monitor Alarms Info ()

Use the arrow keys to select Configuration, Monitor, Alarms, or Info, and then press
ENTER.

Sect. F.3.3.3.3.1 ODU: FSK-control CSAT for complete information for these
nested menu choices.

F.3.3.3.3.2.2 ODU: FSK-control 2CSATs Redundancy-Box

Red: Online: ODU2 Mode:Auto Switch:N


TxSw:OK RxSw:OK 5V:5.0 12V:12.0

This menu provides operating mode and switchover controls. You may also view the following
read-only information here:

Which of the two CSATs in currently online (ODU1 or ODU2);

Waveguide Switch Tx and Rx status: OK or Ft (fault);

Redundancy Controller Box 5V and 12V values (to aid trouble-shooting system
problems).

F21

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

To set Operating Mode, use the arrow keys to select Mode, and then use the arrow
keys to select this mode as Auto or Manual:

AUTO mode When the Online ODU faults, the switchover is done automatically to
replace the faulty unit.

If the ODU Redundancy system is in AUTO mode, a forced switch-over can


only occur if the currently OFFLINE unit is fault-free.

MANUAL mode If selecting the mode as Manual, there is no automatic switchover if a


fault occurs.

To force a switchover to the other CSAT unit, use the arrow keys to select Switch: N, and
then use the arrow keys to select Y (Yes). Press ENTER when done.

F22

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.3.3.3.3.3 ODU: FSK-control KST

KST Select:
Configuration Information Alarms ()

Use the arrow keys to select Configuration, Information, or Alarms, and then press ENTER.

F.3.3.3.3.3.1 ODU: FSK-control KST Configuration

KST Config:
Tx Rx Miscellaneous ()

Use the arrow keys to select Tx, Rx, or Miscellaneous, and then press ENTER.

F.3.3.3.3.3.1.1 ODU: FSK-control KST Configuration Tx

Tx:Off Freq=13955 MHz Att=23 dB


AGC=Off ()

Use the arrow keys to select Tx, Freq, Att, or AGC, and then use the arrow keys to edit
that setting. Press ENTER when done.

F.3.3.3.3.3.1.2 ODU: FSK-control KST Configuration Rx

Rx: Freq=11950 MHz Att=20 dB Ref=087


Band=B ()

Note that Rx Band is not shown for the KST-2000A.


Use the arrow keys to select Freq, Att, Ref, or Band (KST-2000B only), and then use the
arrow keys to edit that setting. Press ENTER when done.

F.3.3.3.3.3.1.3 ODU: FSK-control KST Configuration


Miscellaneous

HPA:Off Fault-Logic=Summary
LNA:OFF Fault-Logic=Summary Cal:No

Use the arrow keys to select HPA, (HPA) Fault-Logic-Summary, LNA, (LNA) Fault-Logic-
Summary, or Cal, and then use the arrow keys to edit that setting:
Selection Setting

HPA (HPA power enable) Select Off or On.

F23

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

Selection Setting
This controls whether or not a HPA fault is indicated on t he Fault status, and ac tivates
Fault-Logic
the Summary Fault Relay. Select Summary or No-Summary.

LNA (LNA power enable) Select Off or On.


This controls whether or not a L NA fault is indicated on the Fault status, and l activates
Fault-Logic
the Summary Fault Relay. Select Summary or No-Summary.
To calibrate, select YES and press ENTER. Calibration allows the system to determine
Cal nominal LNB or LNB power consumption, performed at initial installation only. (Default is
NO.)

Press ENTER when done.

F.3.3.3.3.3.1.4 ODU: FSK-control KST Information

KST Info: Model Tx+Rx-Param


Misc Numbers ()

These read-only screens provide the ODUs current configuration information without risking
inadvertent changes.

Use the arrow keys to select Model, Tx+Rx-Param, Misc, or Numbers, and then press
ENTER.

Once any KST Info screen has been viewed, press ENTER or CLEAR to return to the previous
menu.

F.3.3.3.3.3.1.5 ODU: FSK-control KST Information Model

MODEL: KST-2000B
HPA: CEFD-SSPA

This screen displays the KST and HPA model numbers.

F.3.3.3.3.3.1.6 ODU: FSK-control KST Information Tx+Rx-Param

Info: Tx:Off 13955MHz 10dB


Rx: 11950MHz 20dB Ref:087

This screen displays the Tx and Rx states, Frequencies, and Attenuation, and the reference.

F24

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.3.3.3.3.3.1.7 ODU: FSK-control KST Information Misc

Info: HPA:Off Flt-Logic:No-Summ


Band:B LNA:Off FLT-Logic:Summary

This screen displays the HPA and LNA operational and fault logic summary settings.

Note that the Rx Band information is not shown for the KST-2000A.

F.3.3.3.3.3.1.8 ODU: FSK-control KST Information Numbers

M&C: F/W:9364-1B VER:01.01.03


assy:9357-1A S/N:021476493

Use the arrow keys to view the Up-Converter, Down-Converter and HPA assembly and
serial numbers as well as their firmware numbers/versions.

F.3.3.3.3.3.1.9 ODU: FSK-control KST Alarms

Current Status: Up:OK Ref:OK AGC:OK


P-Supplies:OK Dn:OK HPA:OK LNA:OK

This is Summary Status information. Use the arrow keys to select Up, Ref, AGC, Power-
Supplies, Down, HPA, or LNA, and then press ENTER. A detailed status screen, similar to the
following examples, is then shown:

Up-Converter: Comms:OK L-Synth:OK


Over-Temp:OK Ku-Synth:OK

Reference:Warm 72M-Lock:OK Range:NA


Source:IntT Xref-Lock:NA Phase:NA

AGC Status: Excess-Power-In:OK


Loop-Conv:OK Insuff-Power-In:OK

P-Supplies: 7V:OK 17V:OK


-7V:OK 12V:OK (EC)

Down-Converter: Comms:OK L-Synth:OK


Over-Temp:OK Ku-Synth:OK

F25

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

HPA: Comms:OK 9.75V:OK


Over-Temp:OK Bias:OK -5V:OK

Once any KST Alarms screen has been viewed, press ENTER or CLEAR to return to the previous
menu.

F.3.3.3.3.4 ODU: FSK-control BUC

The menus that follow assume that you have selected and the system has identified a
BUC connected via the Tx IF port.

BUC controls via FSK:


Configuration Status Advanced-FSK ()

Use the arrow keys to select Configuration, Status, or Advanced-FSK, and then press ENTER.

F.3.3.3.3.4.1 ODU: FSK-control BUC Configuration

BUC: Tx:On (Off,On)


Addr:01 (1-15) ()

Use the arrow keys to select Tx: or Addr:

On the top line For Tx: use the arrow keys to select Off or On.

On the bottom line For Addr: use the arrow keys to select an address from 01 to 15.
Press ENTER when done.

F.3.3.3.3.4.2 ODU: FSK-control BUC Status

BUC: Pwr=16.2dBm=00.0W Pclass=5 W


PLL=locked +045C Sw-Ver=01

This screen provides read-only status information for the BUC setup. Press ENTER or CLEAR to
return to the previous menu.

F.3.3.3.3.4.3 ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK

Advanced FSK:
CEFD BUC Type: LPOD (LPOD,2LPODs) ()

Use the arrow keys to select LPOD or 2LPODs, and then press ENTER.

F26

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.3.3.3.3.4.3.1 ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD


(2LPODs Online/Offline LPOD)

LPOD S/N: 123456789


Cnfg Monitor Alarms Stats Info Redun ()

This submenu and its nested menus are identical in form and function for the
following menu structures:

ODU: FSK-control Advanced-FSK LPOD


ODU: FSK-control Advanced-FSK 2LPODs Online LPOD
ODU: FSK-control Advanced-FSK 2LPODs Offline LPOD

Use the arrow keys to select Cnfg, Monitor, Alarms, Stats, Info, or Redun, and then press
ENTER.

F.3.3.3.3.4.3.1.1 ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD


(2LPODs Online/Offline LPOD) Cnfg

Configuration settings:
Amplifier LNB Mask Misc ()

Use the arrow keys to select Amplifier, LNB, Mask, or Misc, and then press ENTER.

ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD (2LPODs


Online/Offline LPOD) Cnfg Amplifier

Amplifier: Att=10.00 dB Amp=On


Mute=Disabled Att-Offset=00.00 dB ()

Use the arrow keys to select the setting to edit, and then use the arrow keys to edit
that setting:

Selection Setting
(Attenuation) 0 to 20 dB, in increments of .25dB. Limit and increments are variable
Att
based upon unit Info string.
Amp (Amplifier setting) Off or On

Mute (Mute Mode) Disabled(i.e., Tx off) or Enabled (i.e., Tx on)

Att-Offset (Attenuation Offset) 0 to 20 dB, in .25 dB increments

Press ENTER when done.

F27

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD (2LPODs


Online/Offline LPOD) Cnfg LNB

LNB Current: Src=On SwitchBiasTee=Thru


Window:30% Alarm=Disabled Cal=No()

Use the arrow keys to select the setting to edit, and then use the arrow keys to edit
the setting:

Selection Setting
Src (LNB Current Source) Disabled or Enabled.
SwitchBiasTee Off (mute LNB) or Thru (unmute LNB).
(LNB Current-Window) Selecting a value from 20% to 50% defines the allowable
Window LNB Current change before declaring a fault. Selecting 99% disables the Current
Window function.
(LNB Current Window Alarm Enable ) Disable or Enable the current window
Alarm
alarm.
(Calibrate-LNB-Current ) Select Yes and press ENTER to calibrate the LNB current.
(Default is No.)
Cal
Note: LNB Current Source must be Enabled before the LNB current can be
calibrated.

Press ENTER when done.

ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD (2LPODs


Online/Offline LPOD) Cnfg Mask

Mask: LFRFPwr=Masked ERLD=Masked ()


FanSpd=Masked LNBCD=Alarm LNB22V=Masked

First, use the arrow keys to select LFRFPower (Low Forward RF Power), ERLD (External
Reference Lock detect), FanSpd (Fan Speed), LNBCD (LNB Current Detect), or LNB22V (LNB 22V
Power Supply)

Then, for each selection, use the arrow keys to set that alarm to Fault, Alarm, or Masked.
Press ENTER when done.

ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD (2LPODs


Online/Offline LPOD) Configuration Misc

Misc: AFR=Enabled Ref-Adjust=087 ()


LowFwdPowerThreshold=00.00 Sync-Clock=No

Use the arrow keys to select the setting to edit, and then use the arrow keys to edit
the setting:

F28

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

Selection Setting
(Auto Fault Recovery) This defines how a LPOD reacts to momentary fault conditions:
AFR Disable LPOD mutes when faulted and remain muted.
Enable LPOD mutes when faulted, then unmutes once the fault goes away.
Select an Internal 10MHz Reference setting from 000 to 255.
Ref-Adjust NOTE: The Internal Reference is set in the factory to be very accurate with the default setting
of 087. This setting is provided to compensate for the long-term frequency drift of the
oscillator.
This sets the threshold for the low forward power alarm/fault. An alarm/fault is triggered if the
LowFwdPower
forward power drops below the specified value. Set this setting to 00.00 to disable the
Threshold
threshold.
Select YES and press ENTER to synchronize the LPOD RTC to the Modem RTC. (Default is
Sync-Clock
NO.)
Press ENTER when done.

F.3.3.3.3.4.3.1.2 ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD


(2LPODs Online/Offline LPOD) Monitor

Monitor: Tx Temperature FET Misc


Power-Supplies1 Power-Supplies2 ()

To view these read-only LPOD Monitor screens, use the arrow keys to select Tx, Temp,
FETs, Misc, or Power-Supplies, and then press ENTER.

Once any of these screens are viewed, press ENTER or CLEAR to return to the previous menu.

ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD (2LPODs


Online/Offline LPOD) Monitor Tx

Tx: RefTune=009.6 V FwdPower = +20.4 dBm


BUCTune=011.1 V

ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD (2LPODs


Online/Offline LPOD) Monitor Temperature

Temperature: Heat Sink=048.0C


External Air=030.0C

ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD (2LPODs


Online/Offline LPOD) Monitor FETs

RF Power FETs Total = 20.301 Amps

F29

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD (2LPODs


Online/Offline LPOD) Monitor Misc

Fan1Speed=100.0% Fan2Speed=100.0%
LNB Current Draw=005.5mA

ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD (2LPODs


Online/Offline LPOD) Monitor Power-Supplies1

P24V1=024.1 P24V2=024.0 LNVBT=022.1


P13VT=013.7 P10V1=010.3 A10V1=010.0

ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD (2LPODs


Online/Offline LPOD) Monitor Power-Supplies2

A10V2=N/A P7V8T=007.8 P5V8t=005.7


P2V5T=002.5 P1V2T=001.2 N5V8T=-05.6

F.3.3.3.3.4.3.1.3 ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD


(2LPODs Online/Offline LPOD) LPOD Alarms

Alarms:
Current-Alarms Stored-Events ()

Use the arrow keys to select Current-Alarms or Stored-Alarms, and then press ENTER.

ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD (2LPODs


Online/ Offline LPOD) Alarms Current-Alarms

P24V1=OK P24V2=OK LNBVT=OK P13VT=OK


P10V1=OK A10V1=OK A10V2=OK P7V8T=OK ()

Use the arrow keys to view additional Current Alarm status screens. Press ENTER or CLEAR
to return to the previous menu.

ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD (2LPODs


Online/Offline LPOD) Stored-Events
As events are compiled, the Stored-Events screen appears as shown here:

Reading Stored Events.... Please Wait

F30

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

Once all events are compiled, the Stored-Events screen appears as shown here:

Stored Events: Clear-All: No (No,Yes)


#084 Info - PWR ON 10/12/10 12:52:08

On the top line Use the arrow keys to select between log entries and the Clear-All option.

To clear the Stored -Events Log, use the arrow keys to select Clear-All, and then use the
arrow keys to select Yes. Press ENTER when done.

On the bottom line To view the Stored-Events Log: With the cursor on the entry number, use
the arrow keys to scroll through the entries. Up to 512 entries are stored.

Each entry provides the following information:

Item Comments

Info (Information)
Entry Type Fault
Clear (fault cleared)
Entry Number 001 through 511

Date European Day-Month-Year (DD-MM-YY) format

Time Hour:Minute:Second (HH:MM:SS) format

Description of the
Example: Info PWR ON
fault/information

F.3.3.3.3.4.3.1.4 ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD


(2LPODs Online/Offline LPOD) Statistics

Statistics:
Config Stored-Statistics ()

Use the arrow keys to select Config or Stored-Statistics, and then press ENTER.

ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD (2LPODs


Online/Offline LPOD) Statistics Config

Stats: Logging=Enabled Interval=10 min


Averaging=Disabled Clear-All=No ( )

Use the arrow keys to select Logging, Interval, Averaging, or Clear-All, and then use the
arrow keys to set that setting:

F31

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

Selection Setting
Logging Enabled or Disabled.
Interval The Loggi ng I nterval i s t he per iod of t ime ov er w hich per formance s tatistics ar e
measured. S et t his i nterval as 00 to di sable t he f eature ( i.e., no l ogging) or ,
otherwise, def ine t he l ogging i nterval f rom 10 through 90 minutes i n 10 -minute
increments.
Averaging Enabled or Disabled.
Clear-All When prompted, select YES.

Press ENTER when done.

ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD (2LPODs


Online/Offline LPOD) Statistics Stored-Statistics
To enable statistics logging, see the LPOD Statistics: Config menu. As statistics are compiled,
the Stored-Statistics screen appears as shown here:

Reading Stored Stats..... Please Wait

Once the statistics are compiled, the Stored-Statistics screen displays this data as shown here:

Stats001: 000.0C 040.0C 20.45dBm 10.00dB


10/01/10 12:52:08 On On Off 001.0 002.3V

Use the arrow keys to scroll backwards or forwards through the statistics log entries.
The top line displays:

The statistics log entry number (up to 512 entries may be stored)

Operating Temperature

Amplifier Temperature

Power

Attenuation

The bottom line displays:

Entry date (in DAY-MONTH-YEAR format)

Entry Time (in HH:MMSS format)

F32

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

On/Off state for RF Amplifier mode

On/Off state for Mute mode

Online state (Online/Offline)

LNB current

BUC Tuning Voltage

Press ENTER or CLEAR to return to the previous menu.

F.3.3.3.3.4.3.1.5 ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD


(2LPODs Online/Offline LPOD) Information

Info:
Model Amp LNB Mask Misc ()

These read-only screens provide you with the ODUs current configuration information without
risking inadvertent changes. Use the arrow keys to select Model, AMP, LNB, Mask, or Misc,
and then press ENTER.

For any LPOD Information screen: Once viewed, press ENTER or CLEAR to return to the previous
menu.

ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD (2LPODs


Online/Offline LPOD) Information Model

PS1032-1375145-K REF BUC V1.2.2


S/N: 101101068 VER: 1.3.1

This screen displays the LPOD model number, the unit serial number and its operating firmware.

ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD (2LPODs


Online/Offline LPOD) Information Amp

Amp Info: Att=20.00dB Amp=On


Mute=Disabled Att-Offset=00.00dB

This screen displays the RF Amplifier state, RF Mute state, Attenuation, and AUX Mute state.

F33

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD (2LPODs


Online/Offline LPOD) Information LNB

LNB Current: Src=On SwitchBiasTee=Off


Window:30% Alarm=Disabled

This screen displays the LNB Current information.

ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD (2LPODs


Online/Offline LPOD) Information Mask

Mask: LFRFPwr=Masked ERLD=Masked


FanSpd=Alarm LNBCD=Alarm LNB22V=Alarm

This screen displays the LPOD mask settings.

ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD (2LPODs


Online/Offline LPOD) Information Misc

Misc: AFR=Enabled Ref-Adjust=087


LowFwdPowerThreshold=00.00

This screen displays the Auto Fault Recovery state, the Internal 10MHz Reference setting, and
the Low Forward Power Threshold setting.

F.3.3.3.3.4.3.1.6 ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD


(2LPODs Online/Offline LPOD) Redun

Redundancy-Switch-Mode=1:1 Red TX+RX


Force-Online=N Online-State=Offline()

Use the arrow keys to select the setting to edit, and then use the arrow keys to edit
that setting:
Selection Setting

Redundancy-Switch-Mode Off, 1:1 Red Tx, 1:1 Red TX+RX, Manual.

Select Yes to force Offline unit to generate a redundant switchover.


Force-Online
Otherwise, select No.
Online-State Read-only. Displays status as Online or Offline.

Press ENTER when done.

F34

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.3.3.3.3.4.3.1.7 ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK 2LPODs

The menus that follow assume that you have selected and the system has
identified two LPODs connected via the Tx IF port.

1:1 Monitor & Control


Online LPOD Offline LPOD ()

Use the arrow keys to select Online LPOD or Offline LPOD, and then press ENTER.

ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK 2LPODs Online


LPOD

ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK 2LPODs Offline


LPOD

LPOD S/N: 123456789


Cnfg Monitor Alarms Stats Info Redun ()

Use the arrow keys to select Cnfg, Monitor, Alarms, Stats, Info, or Redun, and then press
ENTER.

Sect. F.3.3.3.3.4.3.1 ODU: FSK-control BUC Advanced-FSK LPOD for complete


information for these nested menu choices.

F35

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.4 ODU Operations via the CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface
The CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modems embedded HTTP Interface provides an
easy to use application to configure and monitor all aspects of an ODU. See
Chapter 6. ETHERNET-BASED REMOTE PRODUCT MANAGEMENT for complete
instructions on using this interface.

The Comtech EF Data LPOD Amplifier / Block Up Converter is not supported by the
CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface at this time.

A user-supplied web browser allows the full monitor and control (M&C) of an installed Comtech
EF Data CSAT-5060 or KST-2000A/B Transceiver (ODU), installed in standalone or 1:1
Redundancy configurations, from the CDM-625s Web Server Interface. This embedded web
application is designed for, and works best with, Microsofts Internet Explorer Version 7.0 or
higher.

F.4.1 Web Server Interface and Menu Tree


Type the CDM-625s IP Address into the Address area of the user-supplied web browser, and
then enter a valid User Name and Password is accepted. You will see the CDM-625 Web Server
Interface splash page (Figure F-3). Note that the Base Modem and Packet Processor Firmware
Versions shown in this example are subject to change.

Figure F-3. CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface Home Page


The Figure F-4 menu tree illustrates the ODU options available through the CDM-625 Web Server
(HTTP) Interface. The CDM-625 Web Server Interface provides access to six (6) navigation tabs

F36

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

(shown in blue). Beyond this top-level row of navigation tabs, the diagram illustrates the available
primary (green) and nested (yellow) page tabs that afford you more specific functionality.

Tabs not specific to ODU operation appear dimmed and are explicitly defined in Chapter 6.
ETHERNET-BASED REMOTE PRODUCT MANAGEMENT. Click a navigation tab to continue.

Pages marked with double asterisks (**) are operable only when BUCs or LNBs
are installed.

Figure F-4. CDM-625 Web Server (HTTP) Interface Menu Tree (FW Ver. 2.3.1)

F37

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.4.2 Web Page Descriptions

F.4.2.1 Configuration | BUC (Block Up Converter) Page


When a Block Up Converter (BUC) is available, use this page to configure its operating settings
and to view the BUC status for L-Band operation.

Figure F-5. Configuration | BUC page

BUC Configuration
BUC Power Enable, 10 MHz Ref Enable, and Output Power Enable Use the drop-down
lists to turn these functions ON or OFF.

BUC Low and High Current Limit Assign a value (in mA) ranging from 0 to 4000.

Tx LO (Low Oscillator) Frequency Assign a value (in MHz) to the Tx LO Frequency, and then
use the drop-down list to designate the value as a HIGH (+) or LOW (-) limit.

BUC Address Assign a value for the BUC Address from 1 to 15.

Click [Submit BUC Controls] to save the setting changes made in this section.

BUC Status
This section refreshes automatically every ten seconds. These status settings are read-only and
cannot be changed.

F38

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.4.2.2 Configuration | LNB (Low Noise Block Down Converter)


When a Low Noise Block Down Converter (LNB) is available, use this page to configure its
operating settings and to view the LNB status for L-Band operation.

Figure F-6. Configuration | LNB page

LNB Control
LNB DC Power and LNB Reference Enable Use the drop-down lists to turn either function
ON or OFF.

LNB Low and High Current Threshold Assign a value (in mA) ranging from 0 to 500 for
either function.

Rx LO (Low Oscillator) Frequency Assign a value (in MHz) to the Rx LO Frequency, and
then use the drop-down list to designate the value as a HIGH (+) or LOW (-) limit.

Click [Submit LNB Controls] to save these settings.

LNB Status (Refreshes every 5 seconds)


This section refreshes automatically every five seconds. These status settings are read-only and
cannot be changed.

F39

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.4.2.3 Status | Modem Logs | Base Modem Page


Use this page to control how the CDM-625 processes ODU fault and alarm masking settings.

Figure F-7. Status | Modem Logs | Base Modem page

Events Log
Unread Events Displays the total number of unread stored events in the scrollable events
window. As you display stored event groups, this number decrements accordingly.

Read Next Five Events Click to buffer the next group of five stored events into the
scrollable events window.

Clear Events Log Click to wipe clean the stored events log.

Initialize Events Pointer Click to reset the logs internal pointer.

Click [Submit] to save these settings.

F40

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

Statistics Log
Read Next Five Statistics Click to buffer the next group of five stored events into the
scrollable statistics window.

Clear Statistics Log Click to wipe clean the stored statistics log.

Initialize Statistics Pointer Click to reset the logs internal pointer.

Unread Statistics Displays the total number of unread stored statistics in the scrollable
statistics window. As stored statistics are displayed, this number decrements accordingly.

Click [Submit] to save these settings.

Alarm Mask
Use the available option buttons to define a designated BUC or LNB alarm as Masked or Active,
and then click [Submit Alarm Mask] to save these changes.

F41

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.4.2.4 ODU Pages


All ODU pages are viewable with all three levels of user login. However, you may
submit changes to the ODU | Config and ODU | Utilities pages only if you have
Administrative or Read/Write privileges.

When configuring the CDM-625 for 70/140 MHz operation, use the ODU (Outdoor Unit) pages
to control and monitor the CSAT-5060 or KST-2000A/B Outdoor Unit that is connected via FSK
to the CDM-625.

ODU Comms must be Enabled, and the CDM-625 must be configured for 70/140
MHz operation, in order to fully access the ODU | Config, ODU | Status, and
ODU | Utilities pages.

If the CDM-625 is otherwise configured for L-Band operation and selection of the
ODU | Config, ODU | Status, and ODU | Utilities pages is attempted, the
following error message displays:

When you configure the CDM-625 for L-Band operation, use the ODU | Enable page to enable
FSK operation for BUC products.

Click the Enable, Config, Status, or Utilities tab to continue.

F42

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.4.2.4.1 ODU | Enable


Use this page to enable or disable communications with CSAT-5060 or KST-2000A/B ODUs for
70/140 MHz operation, or LPOD BUCs for L-Band operation (see Sect. F.4.2.1 Configuration |
BUC (Block Up Converter)).

Figure F-8. ODU | Enable page

ODU Comms
Use the drop-down list to select ODU operation as Disabled or Enabled, and then click [Submit].

If you encounter a communications issue e.g., an ODU is either physically not present or the
ODU Comms cable is not connected to the CDM-625 the following error page displays after
clicking [Submit]:

Take steps to troubleshoot the ODU setup before attempting to enable ODU operations from
this page. See the pertinent ODU Installation and Operation Manual for further information.

F43

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.4.2.4.2 ODU | Config Pages


When you configure either the Comtech EF Data CSAT-5060 or KST-2000A/B as the ODU, you
may use this page to configure operating settings specific to the active unit. Otherwise, when
you attempt to access this page without first enabling ODU communications per the previous
section, the following error page displays:

F.4.2.4.2.1 ODU | Config (CSAT-5060)


Figure F-9 shows the ODU | Config page as it appears with you configure the Comtech EF Data
CSAT-5060 as the ODU. Use this page to configure the primary ODUs Transmit and Receive
Parameters.

Figure F-9. ODU | Config page (CSAT-5060)

F44

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

ODU Selection
If you use ODUs in redundancy, you may toggle this page between the Online and Offline units.
Use the drop-down list to select CSAT #1 or CSAT #2, and then click [Select ODU]. A message in
the right hand column of this section identifies which unit is ONLINE.

Up Converter Parameters
Frequency Enter a value in MHz.

Attenuation Enter a value in dB.

Slope Mode From the drop-down list, select Manual or Calibrated.

Slope Adjust (Manual Mode Only) Select the desired setting from the drop-down list.

Mute From the drop-down list, select Disable or Enable.

Gain Offset (1:1 Redundancy Only) Select the desired setting from the drop-down list.

Amplifier From the drop-down list, select On or Off.

Down Converter Parameters


Frequency Enter a value in MHz.

Attenuation Enter a value in dB.

Slope Mode From the drop-down list, select Manual or Calibrated.

Slope Adjust (Manual Mode Only) Select the desired setting from the drop-down list.

Mute From the drop-down list, select Disable or Enable.

Gain Offset (1:1 Redundancy Only) Select the desired setting from the drop-down list.

Unit Parameters
Mute Mode From the drop-down list, select Muted after freq change or Unmuted after
freq change.

Auto Fault Recovery, Cold Start, and Ext Reference Fault Logic From the drop-down lists,
select Disable or Enable.

Reference Oscillator Adjust Enter a value from 0-255.

F45

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

LNA Parameters
Current Alarm Window Enter a value of 20-50, or 99 to disable this feature.

Current Source From the drop-down list, select Disable or Enable.

Fault Logic From the drop-down list, select Summary or No Summary.

ODU Circuit Identification


Enter an ODU Circuit Identification name of up to 24 alphanumeric characters.

Click [Submit] to save these settings.

F46

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.4.2.4.2.2 ODU | Config (KST-2000A/B)


Figure F-10 shows the ODU | Config page as it appears when you configure the Comtech EF
Data KST-2000A/B as the ODU. Use this page to configure the primary ODUs Transmit and
Receive Parameters.

Figure F-10. ODU | Config page (KST-2000A/B)

Up Converter
Frequency Enter a value in MHz.

Attenuation Enter a value in dB.

Output From the drop-down list, select On or Off.

Down Converter
Frequency Enter a value in MHz.

Attenuation Enter a value in dB.

Rx Band (For KST-2000B Only) From the drop-down list, select band A (10950 to 11700
MHz), band B (11700 to 12200 MHz), or band C (12250 to 12750 MHz).

HPA
HPA Power Enable From the drop-down list, select On or Off.

HPA Fault Logic From the drop-down list, select Summary or No Summary.

F47

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

LNA
LNA Power Enable From the drop-down list, select On or Off.

LNA Fault Logic From the drop-down list, select Summary or No Summary.

Unit
AGC (Automatic Gain Control) From the drop-down list, select On or Off.

Reference Oscillator Adjust Enter a value from 0-255.

Circuit ID Enter a Circuit Identification name of up to 24 alphanumeric characters.

Lock Mode From the drop-down list, select On or Off.

Click [Submit] to save these settings.

F48

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.4.2.4.3 ODU | Status

The appearance of the ODU | Status page adjusts to the type of ODU that is
configured for operation with the CDM-625.

Use this page to review read-only status windows pertaining to the current operating condition
for either the Comtech EF Data CSAT-5060 or the KST-2000A/B ODU.

F.4.2.4.3.1 ODU | Status (CSAT-5060)


Figure F-11 shows the ODU | Status page as it appears when you configure the Comtech EF
Data CSAT-5060 as the ODU. Use this page to review read-only status reports pertaining to the
ODUs Maintenance Parameters; Alarms; and the number of Unread Events in the Events Log.

Figure F-11. ODU | Status page (CSAT-5060)

ODU Selection
If you use ODUs in redundancy, you may toggle this page between the Online and Offline units.
Use the drop-down list to select CSAT #1 or CSAT #2, and then click [Select ODU]. A message
identifies the currently active unit as ONLINE in the right-hand column of this section.

F49

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.4.2.4.3.2 ODU | Status (KST-2000A/B)


Figure F-12 shows the read-only ODU | Status page as it appears when you configure the
Comtech EF Data KST-2000A/B as the ODU.

Figure F-12. ODU | Status page (KST-2000A/B)

ODU Type / HPA Type


The section identifies the installed equipment types.

The remainder of this page provides configuration and operational status information (e.g., OK /
FT = Fault) for the following settings:

Summary Fault Status LNA (Low-Noise Amplifier Common Equipment

AGC (Automatic Gain Control) Up Converter Down Converter

Reference HPA (High Power Amplifier)

F50

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.4.2.4.4 ODU | Utilities

The appearance of the ODU | Utilities page adjusts to the type of ODU that is
configured for operation with the CDM-625.

Use this page to configure various ODU utility functions for either the Comtech EF Data
CSAT-5060 or the KST-2000A/B ODU.

F.4.2.4.4.1 ODU | Utilities (CSAT-5060)


Figure F-13 shows the ODU | Utilities page as it appears when you configure the Comtech EF
Data CSAT-5060 as the ODU.

Figure F-13. ODU | Utilities page (CSAT-5060)

ODU Selection
If you use ODUs in redundancy, you may toggle this page between the Online and Offline units.
Use the drop-down list to select CSAT #1 or CSAT #2, and then click [Select ODU]. A message
identifies the currently active unit as ONLINE in the right-hand column of this section.

Force 1:1 Switch


If you use ODUs in redundancy, and the selected unit is currently the Online unit, click [Force 1:1
Switch] to force a switchover so the unit will then be in Offline (standby) mode. The command is
only valid for the Online unit in a 1:1 pair.

F51

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

Recalibrate LNA Current


Click to recalibrate the LNA Current.

Redundancy Box Mode


Select Automatic or Manual, and then click [Submit].

ODU Date & Time


Enter a date in the form DD/MM/YY (where DD = day [01 to 31], MM = month [01 to 12],
and YY = year [00 to 99]).

Enter a time using HH:MM:SS format (where HH = hour [00 to 23], MM = minutes [00 to 59],
and SS = seconds [00 to 59]).

Click [Enter Date/Time] once you enter the desired date and time in this section.

ODU Stored Events


This section includes a scrollable window, which provides a visual record of the ODU stored
events.

Unread Events Displays the total number of unread stored events in the scrollable events
window. As stored event groups are displayed, this number decrements accordingly.

Read Next Five Events Click to buffer the next group of five stored events into the
scrollable events window.

Clear Stored Events Click to wipe clean the stored events log.

Initialize Events Pointer Click to reset the logs internal pointer.

Click [Submit] to save these settings.

F52

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.4.2.4.4.2 ODU | Utilities (KST-2000A/B)


Figure F-14 shows the read-only ODU | Utilities page as it appears when you configure the
Comtech EF Data KST-2000A/B as the ODU.

Figure F-14. ODU | Utilities page (KST-2000A/B)

ODU Type / HPA Type


This section identifies the installed equipment types.

The remainder of this page identifies the configured ODU chassis installed component assembly
numbers and serial numbers, and firmware numbers and versions.

F53

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.5 ODU Operations via the CDM-625 Telnet Command Line Interface (CLI)

Appendix E. TELNET COMMAND LINE INTERFACE (CLI) OPERATION

The Telnet Command Line Interface (referred to hereafter as the Telnet CLI or the CLI) (Figure
F-15) is an Ethernet-based user menu system for the CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem
equipped with an installed and enabled optional IP Packet Processor card. The CLI facilitates
configuration, monitoring, and control of a CSAT-5060 Transceiver (ODU), installed in standalone
or 1:1 Redundancy configurations, using a user-supplied terminal emulator.

1. The CDM-625 Telnet Command Line Interface (CLI) is accessible only when the
optional IP Packet Processor is installed and enabled.

2. The CDM-625 Telnet CLI uses Telnet TCP Port 107. Be sure to specify this port
when configuring your terminal emulator for CLI operation.

3. For best results Comtech EF Data recommends PuTTY or Tera Term as the
preferred terminal emulators.

4. The Telnet CLIs Remote Access Mode must be set to [Ethernet] in order to use
the Telnet CLI for ODU operations.

Figure F-15. CDM-625 Telnet Command Line Interface (CLI)


(Left) Tera Term CLI Example
(Right) PuTTY CLI Example

F54

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.5.1 ODU Operations using the Telnet CLI


1. ODU Comms must be Enabled, and the CDM-625 must be configured for 70/140
MHz operation in order to fully use the Telnet CLI ODU menus.

2. The Comtech EF Data KST-2000A/B Transceiver and LPOD Amplifier / Block Up


Converter are not supported by the Telnet CLI at this time.

F.5.1.1 Home (Main) Menu

The Home Menu serves as the CLIs primary navigation page. Press the E hot key to access the
ODU submenus.

Hot Key Description Function


A Administration Access administrative configuration submenu
B Modem Access modem configuration submenu
C Network Access network configuration submenu
D WAN Access WAN configuration submenu
E Outdoor Unit (ODU) Access ODU comms, CSAT-5060 configuration submenus
F Redundancy Access 1:1 or 1:N redundancy configuration submenu
Enter alphanumeric Circuit ID; view read-only CDM-625 operations information
G General Information
screens
Access Base Modem and Packet Processor stored events and statistics logs,
H Logs
alarms control submenus
I Statistics Access CDM-625 operational statistics submenus
J Contact View read-only Customer Support contact information screen
K Remote Mode Open the Remote Access Mode setting

F55

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.5.1.2 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) Submenu


After configuring the CDM-625 for 70/140 MHz operation, you may use the ODU (Outdoor
Unit) pages to control and monitor the CSAT-5060 Outdoor Unit that is connected via FSK to the
CDM-625.

Open the Outdoor Unit (ODU) submenu from the Home menu. This submenu contains the
following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A ODU Comms Enabled Use the arrow keys to select Disabled or Enabled
B CSAT-5060 Open the CSAT-5060 submenu See Sect. F.5.1.2.1

Press a hot key to open the dialog window or the submenu. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to
the Home submenu.

F56

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.5.1.2.1 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 Submenu

Open the nested CSAT-5060 submenu from the Outdoor Unit (ODU) submenu. This submenu
contains the following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry Sect.
Key
A Select Use the arrow keys to select Csat1 or Csat2 N/A
B Up Converter Settings (1/2)
Configure an Up Converter F.5.1.2.1.1
C Up Converter Settings (2/2)
D Down Converter Settings (1/2)
Configure a Down Converter F.5.1.2.1.2
E Down Converter Settings (2/2)
F Unit Settings (1/2)
Configure an ODU F.5.1.2.1.3
G Unit Settings (2/2)
H LNA Settings Configure a Low Noise Amplifier F.5.1.2.1.4
I Status Review ODU Status Information F.5.1.2.1.5
J Logs Review and manage Event Logs F.5.1.2.1.6
K Redundancy Configure ODUs for 1:N Redundancy F.5.1.2.1.7
Set device time and date, review the units firmware
L Utilities F.5.1.2.1.8
version and serial number

Press a hot key to open a dialog window or configuration page. See the specified appendix
section for further configuration options. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the ODU submenu.

F57

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.5.1.2.1.1 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > Up Converter
Settings 1/2, 2/2
After configuring the CDM-625 for L-Band operation, and when a Block Up
Converter (BUC) is installed, you may use this page to configure BUC operating
settings and to view the BUC operational status.

Open the Up Converter Settings 1/2 page or the Up Converter Settings2/2 page from the nested
CSAT-5060 submenu.

The Up Converter Settings 1/2 page contains the following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Tx Frequency Enter a value from 5845.000 to 6725.000 MHz
B Tx Attenuation Enter a value from 0.00 to 25.00 dB
C Tx Slope Mode Use the arrow keys to select Manual or Calibrated
D Tx Slope Value Enter a value from 0.0 to 1.0 units

The Up Converter Settings 2/2 page contains the following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Tx Mute Use the arrow keys to select Disabled or Enabled
B Tx Amplifier Use the arrow keys to select Off or On
C Tx Gain Offset Enter a value from -4.00 to 0.00 dBm

Typical for either page, press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to
return to the nested CSAT-5060 submenu.

F58

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.5.1.2.1.2 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > Down Converter
Settings 1/2, 2/2
After configuring the CDM-625 for L-Band operation, and when a Low Noise Block
Down Converter (LNB) is installed, you may use this page to configure LNB
operating settings and to view the LNB operational status.

Open the Down Converter Settings 1/2 page or the Down Converter Settings 2/2 page from the
nested CSAT-5060 submenu.

The Down Converter Settings 1/2 page contains the following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Rx Frequency Enter a value from 3400.000 to 4200.000 MHz
B Rx Attenuation Enter a value from 0.00 to 20.00 dB
C Rx Slope Mode Use the arrow keys to select Manual or Calibrated
D Rx Slope Value Enter a value from 0.0 to 1.0 units

The Down Converter Settings 2/2 page contains the following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Rx Mute Use the arrow keys to select Disabled or Enabled
B Rx Gain Offset Enter a value from -4.00 to 0.00 dBm

Typical for either page, press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to
return to the nested CSAT-5060 submenu.

F59

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.5.1.2.1.3 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > Unit Settings 1/2, 2/2

Open the Unit Settings 1/2 page or the Unit Settings 2/2 page from the nested CSAT-5060
submenu.

The Unit Settings 1/2 page contains the following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
Use the arrow keys to select Unmuted After Freq Change or
A Unit Mute Mode
Muted After Freq Change
B Unit Auto Fault Recovery Use the arrow keys to select Disabled or Enabled
C Unit Cold Start Use the arrow keys to select Disabled or Enabled

The Unit Settings 2/2 page contains the following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Unit Ext Ref Fault Logic Use the arrow keys to select No Summary or Summary
B Unit Ref Osc Adjust Enter a value from 0 to 255
C Circuit ID Enter an identifying label for the ODU here

Typical for either page, press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to
return to the nested CSAT-5060 submenu.

F60

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.5.1.2.1.4 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > LNA Settings

Open the LNA Settings page from the nested CSAT-5060 submenu. This page contains the
following options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
Enter a value as follows:
A Unit LNA Current Window Range 1 20 to 50
Range 2 99 to 99
Use the arrow keys to select Disabled, Enabled, or Enabled
B Unit LNA Current Window
When Online
C Unit LNA Fault Logic Use the arrow keys to select No Summary or Summary

Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the nested CSAT-
5060 submenu.

F61

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.5.1.2.1.5 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > Status

Open the read-only Status page from the nested CSAT-5060 submenu. This page provides the
following information:

Item Description
Online State Identifies the unit as Online or Offline
Maintenance Parameters Info needed
Unit Faults Lists the curren t number of unit faults
Lists the number of unread events that are currently stored in the Events
Number Unread Events
Log

Press [ESC] to return to the nested CSAT-5060 submenu.

F62

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.5.1.2.1.6 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > Logs

Open the Logs page from the nested CSAT-5060 submenu. This page contains the following
options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Reset Event Pointer Typical for either entry Use the arrow keys to select No or
B Clear Event Log Yes

Press a hot key to open a dialog window.

Stored Events: The page additionally provides a listing of the latest five stored events. Each
event consists of a description, its time in HHMMSS format, and the date in DDMMYY format.
Press [F5] to update this page with the next five events. Accessing event items in this manner
causes the Number U nread E vents count on the CSAT-5060 > Status page to decrement
accordingly.

Press [ESC] to return to the nested CSAT-5060 submenu.

F63

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


CDM-625 Advanced Satellite Modem Revision 13
Appendix F MN-CDM625

F.5.1.2.1.7 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > Redundancy

Open the Redundancy page from the nested CSAT-5060 submenu. Redundant ODU
configuration options are as follows:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Unit Red Force Switch Use the arrow keys to select No or Yes
B Unit Redundancy Mode Use the arrow keys to select Manual or Auto

Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the nested CSAT-
5060 submenu.

F.5.1.2.1.8 Home > Outdoor Unit (ODU) > CSAT-5060 > Utilities

Open the Utilities page from the nested CSAT-5060 submenu. This page contains the following
options:

Hot
Dialog Window Option Entry
Key
A Device Time Enter a time in the form HH:MM:SS
B Device Date Enter a date in the form DD/MM/YY

The page additionally provides the model number, software version, and unit serial number of
the recognized ODU.

Press a hot key to open a dialog window. Otherwise, press [ESC] to return to the nested CSAT-
5060 submenu.

F64

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


METRIC CONVERSIONS

Units of Length

Unit Millimeter Centimeter Inch Foot Yard Meter Kilometer Mile

1 millimeter 1 0.1 0.0394 0.0033 0.0011 0.001 1 x 10-6 6.214 x 10-7

1 centimeter 10 1 0.3937 0.0328 0.0109 0.01 1 x 10-5 6.214 x 10-6

1 inch 25.4 2.54 1 0.0833 0.0278 0.0254 2.54 x 10-5 1.578 x 10-5

1 foot 304.8 30.48 12 1 0.3333 0.3048 3.048 x 10-4 1.894 x 10-4

1 yard 914.4 91.44 36 3 1 0.9144 9.144 x 10-4 5.682 x 10-4

1 meter 1000 100 39.37 3.2808 1.0936 1 0.001 6.214 x 10-4

1 kilometer 1 x 106 1 x 105 3.938 x 104 3.281 109 3 1000 1 0.6214

1 mile 1.609 x 106 1.609 x 105 6.336 x 104 5280 176 0 1609 1.609 1

Temperature Conversions

Temperature Fahrenheit Centigrade Formulas

Water freezes 32 0 C = (F - 32) * 0.555

Water boils 212 100 F = (C * 1.8) + 32

Absolute zero -459.69 -273.16

Units of Weight

Ounce Ounce Pound Pound


Unit Gram Kilogram
Avoirdupois Troy Avoirdupois Troy

1 gram 1 0.03527 0.03215 0.002205 0.002679 0.001

1 oz. avoir. 28.35 1 0.9115 0.0625 0.07595 0.02835

1 oz. troy 31.10 1.097 1 0.06857 0.08333 0.03110

1 lb. avoir. 453.6 16.0 14.58 1 1.215 0.4536

1 lb. Troy 373.2 13.17 12.0 0.8229 1 0.3732

1 kilogram 1000 35.27 32.1 5 2.205 2.67 9 1

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine


2114 WEST 7TH STREET TEMPE ARIZONA 85281 USA
480 333 2200 PHONE
480 333 2161 FAX

Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine

You might also like